NETGEAR Switch M4100 12GF User Manual

ProSafe Managed Switch  
Command Line Interface (CLI)  
User Manual  
10.0.1  
M7100-24X  
M4100-24G-POE+  
M4100-26G  
M4100-26-POE  
M4100-26G-POE  
M4100-50G  
M4100-50-POE  
M4100-50G-POE+  
M4100-12GF  
M4100-12G-POE+  
M4100-D12G  
M4100-D10-POE  
M4100-D12G-POE+  
350 East Plumeria Drive  
San Jose, CA 95134  
USA  
February 2013  
202-11166-02  
1.0  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Contents  
3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Chapter 14 Command List  
6
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1.  
Using the Command-Line Interface  
1
The command-line interface (CLI) is a text-based way to manage and monitor the system.  
You can access the CLI by using a direct serial connection or by using a remote logical  
connection with telnet or SSH.  
This chapter describes the CLI syntax, conventions, and modes. It contains the following  
sections:  
7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Licensing and Command Support  
As shown in the following table, some command groups, or commands, require a license and  
some are supported on particular switch models. For those requiring a license, license keys  
are available from your VAR or NETGEAR authorized e-commerce portal. License activation  
is described in the Software Setup Manual.  
Command Group or Command  
M4100  
M7100  
Not supported  
Not supported  
Not supported  
Not supported  
Not supported  
Not supported  
Not supported  
Not supported  
Not supported  
Not supported  
Not supported  
Not supported  
Not supported  
Not supported  
Not supported  
Not supported  
Not supported  
Not supported  
Not supported  
Not supported  
Not supported  
Not supported  
Not supported  
Not supported  
Not supported  
Not supported  
Not supported  
Not supported  
Not supported  
Not supported  
Not supported  
Not supported  
Not supported  
Not supported  
Not supported  
Not supported  
Not supported  
Not supported  
Not supported  
Supported on PoE  
models only  
Supported  
Supported  
Supported  
Not supported  
Supported  
Supported  
Supported  
Supported  
Not supported  
Not Supported  
Supported  
Supported  
Supported  
Supported  
Using the Command-Line Interface  
8
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Command Group or Command  
M4100  
M7100  
Supported  
Supported  
Supported  
Supported  
Command Syntax  
A command is one or more words that might be followed by one or more parameters.  
Parameters can be required or optional values.  
Some commands, such as show network or clear vlan,do not require parameters.  
Other commands, such as network parms, require that you supply a value after the  
command. You must type the parameter values in a specific order, and optional parameters  
follow required parameters. The following example describes the network parms  
command syntax:  
Format  
network parms <ipaddr> <netmask> [gateway]  
network parmsis the command name.  
<ipaddr>and <netmask> are parameters and represent required values that you  
must enter after you type the command keywords.  
[gateway] is an optional parameter, so you are not required to enter a value in place of  
the parameter.  
The New Template User Manual lists each command by the command name and provides a  
brief description of the command. Each command reference also contains the following  
information:  
Format shows the command keywords and the required and optional parameters.  
Mode identifies the command mode you must be in to access the command.  
Default shows the default value, if any, of a configurable setting on the device.  
The showcommands also contain a description of the information that the command shows.  
Command Conventions  
In this document, the command name is in boldfont. Parameters are in italic font. You  
must replace the parameter name with an appropriate value, which might be a name or  
number. Parameters are order-dependent.  
Using the Command-Line Interface  
9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
The parameters for a command might include mandatory values, optional values, or keyword  
choices. Table 1 describes the conventions this document uses to distinguish between value  
types.  
Table 1. Parameter Conventions  
Symbol  
Example  
Description  
<value>  
<> angle brackets  
Indicates that you must enter a value in place of the  
brackets and text inside them.  
[value]  
[] square brackets  
{} curly braces  
| Vertical bars  
Indicates an optional parameter that you can enter in  
place of the brackets and text inside them.  
{choice1 |  
choice2}  
Indicates that you must select a parameter from the list of  
choices.  
choice1 | choice2  
Separates the mutually exclusive choices.  
Indicates a choice within an optional element.  
[{choice1 |  
choice2}]  
[{}] Braces within  
square brackets  
Common Parameter Values  
Parameter values might be names (strings) or numbers. To use spaces as part of a name  
parameter, enclose the name value in double quotes. For example, the expression “System  
Name with Spaces” forces the system to accept the spaces. Empty strings (““) are not valid  
user-defined strings. Table 2 describes common parameter values and value formatting.  
Table 2. Parameter Descriptions  
Parameter  
Description  
ipaddr  
This parameter is a valid IP address. You can enter the IP address in the following formats:  
a (32 bits)  
a.b (8.24 bits)  
a.b.c (8.8.16 bits)  
a.b.c.d (8.8.8.8)  
In addition to these formats, the CLI accepts decimal, hexadecimal, and octal formats  
through the following input formats (where n is any valid hexadecimal, octal, or decimal  
number):  
0xn (CLI assumes hexadecimal format)  
0n (CLI assumes octal format with leading zeros)  
n (CLI assumes decimal format)  
FE80:0000:0000:0000:020F:24FF:FEBF:DBCB, or  
FE80:0:0:0:20F:24FF:FEBF:DBCB, or  
FE80::20F24FF:FEBF:DBCB, or  
ipv6-address  
FE80:0:0:0:20F:24FF:128:141:49:32  
For more information, refer to RFC 3513.  
Interface or  
slot/port  
Valid slot and port number separated by forward slashes. For example, 0/1 represents slot  
number 0 and port number 1.  
Using the Command-Line Interface  
10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Table 2. Parameter Descriptions (Continued)  
Parameter  
Description  
Logical Interface  
Represents a logical slot and port number. This is applicable in the case of a port-channel  
(LAG). You can use the logical slot/port to configure the port-channel.  
Character strings  
Use double quotation marks to identify character strings, for example, “System Name with  
Spaces”. An empty string (“”) is not valid.  
Slot/Port Naming Convention  
Managed switch software references physical entities such as cards and ports by using a  
slot/port naming convention. The software also uses this convention to identify certain logical  
entities, such as Port-Channel interfaces.  
The slot number has two uses. In the case of physical ports, it identifies the card containing  
the ports. In the case of logical and CPU ports it also identifies the type of interface or port.  
Table 3. Type of Slots  
Slot Type  
Description  
Physical slot numbers  
Physical slot numbers begin with zero, and are allocated up to the maximum  
number of physical slots.  
Logical slot numbers  
CPU slot numbers  
Logical slots immediately follow physical slots and identify port-channel (LAG) or  
router interfaces.  
The CPU slots immediately follow the logical slots.  
The port identifies the specific physical port or logical interface being managed on a given  
slot.  
Table 4. Type of Ports  
Port Type  
Description  
Physical Ports  
Logical Interfaces  
The physical ports for each slot are numbered sequentially starting from zero.  
Port-channel or link aggregation group (LAG) interfaces are logical interfaces that  
are only used for bridging functions.  
VLAN routing interfaces are only used for routing functions.  
Loopback interfaces are logical interfaces that are always up.  
Tunnel interfaces are logical point-to-point links that carry encapsulated packets.  
CPU ports  
CPU ports are handled by the driver as one or more physical entities located on  
physical slots.  
Using the Command-Line Interface  
11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Note: In the CLI, loopback and tunnel interfaces do not use the slot/port  
format. To specify a loopback interface, you use the loopback ID. To  
specify a tunnel interface, you use the tunnel ID.  
Using a Command’s “No” Form  
The nokeyword is a specific form of an existing command and does not represent a new or  
distinct command. Almost every configuration command has a noform. In general, use the  
noform to reverse the action of a command or reset a value back to the default. For example,  
the no shutdown configuration command reverses the shutdown of an interface. Use the  
command without the keyword noto reenable a disabled feature or to enable a feature that  
is disabled by default. Only the configuration commands are available in the noform.  
Managed Switch Modules  
Managed switch software consists of flexible modules that can be applied in various  
combinations to develop advanced Layer 2/3/4+ products. The commands and command  
modes available on your switch depend on the installed modules. Additionally, for some show  
commands, the output fields might change based on the modules included in the software.  
The software suite includes the following modules:  
Switching (Layer 2)  
Routing (Layer 3)  
IPv6—IPv6 routing  
Multicast  
Quality of Service  
Management (CLI, web UI, and SNMP)  
IPv6 Management—Allows management of the device through an IPv6 through an IPv6  
address without requiring the IPv6 Routing package in the system. The management  
address can be associated with the network port (front-panel switch ports) and a routine  
interface (port or VLAN).  
Stacking  
Not all modules are available for all platforms or software releases.  
Command Modes  
The CLI groups commands into modes according to the command function. Each of the  
command modes supports specific software commands. The commands in one mode are not  
available until you switch to that particular mode, except for the User EXEC mode  
Using the Command-Line Interface  
12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
commands. You can execute the User EXEC mode commands in the Privileged EXEC  
mode.  
The command prompt changes in each command mode to help you identify the current  
mode. Table 5 describes the command modes and the prompts visible in that mode.  
Note: The command modes available on your switch depend on the  
software modules that are installed. For example, a switch that does  
not support BGPv4 does not have the Router BGPv4 Command  
Mode.  
Table 5. CLI Command Modes  
Command Mode Prompt  
Mode Description  
Switch>  
User EXEC  
Contains a limited set of commands to view  
basic system information.  
Switch#  
Privileged EXEC  
Allows you to issue any EXECcommand, enter  
the VLAN mode, or enter the Global  
Configuration mode.  
Switch (Config)#  
Global Config  
Groups general setup commands and permits  
you to make modifications to the running  
configuration.  
Switch (Vlan)#  
VLAN Config  
Groups all the VLAN commands.  
Interface Config  
Switch (Interface <slot/port>)#  
Manages the operation of an interface and  
provides access to the router interface  
configuration commands.  
Switch (Interface Loopback <id>)#  
Use this mode to set up a physical port for a  
specific logical connection operation.  
Switch (Interface Tunnel <id>)#  
Switch (line)#  
Line Config  
Contains commands to configure outbound  
telnet settings and console interface settings.  
Policy Map  
Config  
Switch (Config-policy-map)#  
Contains the QoS Policy-Map configuration  
commands.  
Policy Class  
Config  
Switch (Config-policy-class-map)#  
Consists of class creation, deletion, and  
matching commands. The class match  
commands specify Layer 2, Layer 3, and  
general match criteria.  
Class Map Config Switch (Config-class-map)#  
Contains the QoS class map configuration  
commands for IPv4.  
Ipv6_Class-Map  
Config  
Switch (Config-class-map)#  
Contains the QoS class map configuration  
commands for IPv6.  
Using the Command-Line Interface  
13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Table 5. CLI Command Modes (Continued)  
Command Mode Prompt  
Mode Description  
Router OSPF  
Config  
Switch (Config-router)#  
Contains the OSPF configuration commands.  
Router OSPFv3  
Config  
Switch (Config rtr)#  
Contains the OSPFv3 configuration commands.  
Router RIP Config Switch (Config-router)#  
Contains the RIP configuration commands.  
MAC Access-list  
Config  
Switch (Config-mac-access-list)#  
Allows you to create a MAC Access-List and to  
enter the mode containing MAC Access-List  
configuration commands.  
TACACS Config  
Switch (Tacacs)#  
Contains commands to configure properties for  
the TACACS servers.  
DHCP Pool  
Config  
Switch (Config dhcp-pool)#  
Switch (Config dhcp6-pool)#  
Switch (Config stack)#  
Contains the DHCP server IP address pool  
configuration commands.  
DHCPv6 Pool  
Config  
Contains the DHCPv6 server IPv6 address pool  
configuration commands.  
Stack Global  
Config Mode  
Allows you to access the Stack Global Config  
Mode.  
ARP Access-List  
Config Mode  
Switch (Config-arp-access-list)#  
Contains commands to add ARP ACL rules in  
an ARP Access List.  
Table 6 explains how to enter or exit each mode.  
Table 6. CLI Mode Access and Exit  
Command Mode Access Method  
Exit or Access Previous Mode  
User EXEC  
This is the first level of access.  
To exit, enter logout.  
Privileged EXEC  
From the User EXEC mode, enter To exit to the User EXEC mode, enter exit or  
enable.  
press Ctrl-Z.  
Global Config  
VLAN Config  
Interface Config  
From the Privileged EXEC mode,  
enter configure.  
To exit to the Privileged EXEC mode, enter exit,  
or press Ctrl-Z.  
From the Privileged EXEC mode,  
enter vlan database.  
To exit to the Privileged EXEC mode, enter exit,  
or press Ctrl-Z.  
From the Global Config mode,  
enter  
interface <slot/port>or  
interface loopback <id>or  
interface tunnel <id>  
To exit to the Global Config mode, enter exit. To  
return to the Privileged EXEC mode, enter  
Ctrl-Z.  
Line Config  
From the Global Config mode,  
enter  
lineconfig.  
To exit to the Global Config mode, enter exit. To  
return to the Privileged EXEC mode, enter  
Ctrl-Z.  
Using the Command-Line Interface  
14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Table 6. CLI Mode Access and Exit (Continued)  
Command Mode Access Method  
Exit or Access Previous Mode  
Policy-Map  
Config  
From the Global Config mode,  
enter  
policy-map <name> in.  
To exit to the Global Config mode, enter exit. To  
return to the Privileged EXEC mode, enter  
Ctrl-Z.  
Policy-Class-Map From the Policy Map mode enter  
To exit to the Policy Map mode, enter exit. To  
return to the Privileged EXEC mode, enter  
Ctrl-Z.  
Config  
class.  
Class-Map  
Config  
From the Global Config mode,  
enter  
To exit to the Global Config mode, enter exit. To  
return to the Privileged EXEC mode, enter  
Ctrl-Z.  
class-map, and specify the  
optional keyword ipv4to specify  
the Layer 3 protocol for this class.  
more information.  
Ipv6-Class-Map  
Config  
From the Global Config mode,  
enter  
To exit to the Global Config mode, enter exit. To  
return to the Privileged EXEC mode, enter  
Ctrl-Z.  
class-map and specify the  
optional keyword ipv6to specify  
the Layer 3 protocol for this class.  
more information.  
Router OSPF  
Config  
From the Global Config mode,  
enter  
router ospf.  
To exit to the Global Config mode, enter exit. To  
return to the Privileged EXEC mode, enter  
Ctrl-Z.  
Router OSPFv3  
Config  
From the Global Config mode,  
enter  
ipv6 router ospf.  
To exit to the Global Config mode, enter exit. To  
return to the Privileged EXEC mode, enter  
Ctrl-Z.  
Router RIP  
Config  
From the Global Config mode,  
enter  
router rip.  
To exit to the Global Config mode, enter exit. To  
return to the Privileged EXEC mode, enter  
Ctrl-Z.  
MAC Access-list  
Config  
From the Global Config mode,  
enter  
mac access-list extended  
<name>.  
To exit to the Global Config mode, enter exit. To  
return to the Privileged EXEC mode, enter  
Ctrl-Z.  
TACACS Config  
From the Global Config mode,  
To exit to the Global Config mode, enter exit. To  
enter tacacs-server host  
return to the Privileged EXEC mode, enter  
<ip-addr>, where <ip-addr>is Ctrl-Z.  
the IP address of the TACACS  
server on your network.  
DHCP Pool  
Config  
From the Global Config mode,  
enter  
To exit to the Global Config mode, enter exit. To  
return to the Privileged EXEC mode, enter  
ip dhcp pool<pool-name>.  
Ctrl-Z.  
DHCPv6 Pool  
Config  
From the Global Config mode,  
enter  
To exit to the Global Config mode, enter exit. To  
return to the Privileged EXEC mode, enter  
ip dhcpv6 pool<pool-name>. Ctrl-Z.  
Using the Command-Line Interface  
15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Table 6. CLI Mode Access and Exit (Continued)  
Command Mode Access Method  
Exit or Access Previous Mode  
Stack Global  
Config Mode  
From the Global Config mode,  
enter the stack command.  
To exit to the Global Config mode, enter the exit  
command. To return to the Privileged EXEC  
mode, enter Ctrl-Z.  
ARP Access-List  
Config Mode  
From the Global Config mode,  
enter the arp access-list exit command. To return to the Privileged  
command. EXEC mode, enter Ctrl-Z.  
To exit to the Global Config mode, enter the  
Command Completion and Abbreviation  
Command completion finishes spelling the command when you type enough letters of a  
command to uniquely identify the command keyword. Once you have entered enough letters,  
press the SPACEBAR or TAB key to complete the word.  
Command abbreviation allows you to execute a command when you have entered there are  
enough letters to uniquely identify the command. You must enter all of the required keywords  
and parameters before you enter the command.  
CLI Error Messages  
If you enter a command and the system is unable to execute it, an error message appears.  
Table 7 describes the most common CLI error messages.  
Table 7. CLI Error Messages  
Message Text  
Description  
% Invalid input detected at '^' marker.  
Indicates that you entered an incorrect or unavailable command.  
The carat (^) shows where the invalid text is detected. This  
message also appears if any of the parameters or values are not  
recognized.  
Command not found / Incomplete  
command. Use a question mark (?) to  
list commands.  
Indicates that you did not enter the required keywords or values.  
Ambiguous command  
Indicates that you did not enter enough letters to uniquely identify  
the command.  
Using the Command-Line Interface  
16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
CLI Line-Editing Conventions  
Table 8 describes the key combinations you can use to edit commands or increase the  
speed of command entry. You can access this list from the CLI by entering helpfrom the  
User or Privileged EXEC modes.  
Table 8. CLI Editing Conventions  
Key Sequence  
DEL or Backspace  
Ctrl-A  
Description  
Delete previous character  
Go to beginning of line  
Ctrl-E  
Go to end of line  
Ctrl-F  
Go forward one character  
Go backward one character  
Delete current character  
Delete to beginning of line  
Delete to end of line  
Ctrl-B  
Ctrl-D  
Ctrl-U, X  
Ctrl-K  
Ctrl-W  
Delete previous word  
Ctrl-T  
Transpose previous character  
Go to previous line in history buffer  
Rewrites or pastes the line  
Go to next line in history buffer  
Prints last deleted character  
Enables serial flow  
Ctrl-P  
Ctrl-R  
Ctrl-N  
Ctrl-Y  
Ctrl-Q  
Ctrl-S  
Disables serial flow  
Ctrl-Z  
Return to root command prompt  
Command-line completion  
Go to next lower command prompt  
List available commands, keywords, or parameters  
Tab, <SPACE>  
Exit  
?
Using CLI Help  
Enter a question mark (?) at the command prompt to display the commands available in the  
current mode.  
(switch) >?  
Using the Command-Line Interface  
17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
enable  
help  
logout  
ping  
quit  
show  
Enter into user privilege mode.  
Display help for various special keys.  
Exit this session. Any unsaved changes are lost.  
Send ICMP echo packets to a specified IP address.  
Exit this session. Any unsaved changes are lost.  
Display Switch Options and Settings.  
Telnet to a remote host.  
telnet  
Enter a question mark (?) after each word you enter to display available command keywords  
or parameters.  
(switch) #network ?  
javamode  
mgmt_vlan  
parms  
Enable/Disable.  
Configure the Management VLAN ID of the switch.  
Configure Network Parameters of the router.  
Select DHCP, BootP, or None as the network config  
protocol.  
protocol  
If the help output shows a parameter in angle brackets, you must replace the parameter with  
a value.  
(switch) #network parms ?  
<ipaddr>  
Enter the IP address.  
If there are no additional command keywords or parameters, or if more parameters are  
optional, the following message appears in the output:  
<cr>  
Press Enter to execute the command  
You can also enter a question mark (?) after typing one or more characters of a word to list  
the available command or parameters that begin with the letters, as shown in the following  
example:  
(switch) #show m?  
mac-addr-table  
mac-address-table  
monitor  
Accessing the CLI  
You can access the CLI by using a direct console connection or by using a telnet or SSH  
connection from a remote management host.  
For the initial connection, you must use a direct connection to the console port. You cannot  
access the system remotely until the system has an IP address, subnet mask, and default  
gateway. You can set the network configuration information manually, or you can configure  
the system to accept these settings from a BOOTP or DHCP server on your network. For  
more information, see Network Interface Commands on page 626.  
Using the Command-Line Interface  
18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
The commands in this chapter are in three functional groups:  
Show commands display switch settings, statistics, and other information.  
Configuration commands configure features and options of the switch. Every switch  
command has a show command that displays the configuration setting.  
Clear commands clear some or all of the settings to factory defaults.  
Switching Commands  
20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Port Configuration Commands  
This section describes the commands you use to view and configure port settings.  
interface  
This command gives you access to the Interface Config mode, which allows you to enable or  
modify the operation of an interface (port).  
Format  
Mode  
interface <slot/port>  
Global Config  
interface vlan  
This command gives you access to the vlan virtual interface mode, which allows certain port  
configurations (for example, the IP address) to be applied to the VLAN interface. Type a  
question mark (?) after entering the interface configuration mode to see the available options.  
Format  
Mode  
interface vlan <vlan id>  
Global Config  
interface lag  
This command gives you access to the LAG (link aggregation, or port channel) virtual  
interface, which allows certain port configurations to be applied to the LAG interface. Type a  
question mark (?) after entering the interface configuration mode to see the available options.  
Note: The IP address cannot be assigned to a LAG virtual interface. The  
interface must be put under a VLAN group and an IP address  
assigned to the VLAN group.  
Format  
Mode  
interface lag <lag id>  
Global Config  
auto-negotiate  
This command enables automatic negotiation on a port.  
Default  
enabled  
Format  
Mode  
auto-negotiate  
Interface Config  
Switching Commands  
21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no auto-negotiate  
This command disables automatic negotiation on a port.  
Note: Automatic sensing is disabled when automatic negotiation is  
disabled.  
auto-negotiate all  
This command enables automatic negotiation on all ports.  
Default  
enabled  
Format  
Mode  
auto-negotiate all  
Global Config  
no auto-negotiate all  
This command disables automatic negotiation on all ports.  
Format  
Mode  
no auto-negotiate all  
Global Config  
description  
Use this command to create an alpha-numeric description of the port.  
Format  
description <description>  
Mode  
Interface Config  
mtu  
Use the mtucommand to set the maximum transmission unit (MTU) size, in bytes, for frames  
that ingress or egress the interface. You can use the mtucommand to configure jumbo frame  
support for physical and port-channel (LAG) interfaces. For the standard 7000 series  
implementation, the MTU size is a valid integer between 1522–9216 for tagged packets and  
a valid integer between 1518–9216 for untagged packets.  
Note: To receive and process packets, the Ethernet MTU must include  
any extra bytes that Layer-2 headers might require. To configure the  
IP MTU size, which is the maximum size of the IP packet (IP Header  
+ IP payload), see ip mtu on page 233.  
Switching Commands  
22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Default  
1518 (untagged)  
Format  
Mode  
mtu <1518-9216>  
Interface Config  
no mtu  
This command sets the default MTU size (in bytes) for the interface.  
Format  
no mtu  
Mode  
Interface Config  
shutdown  
This command disables a port.  
Note: You can use the shutdowncommand on physical and port-channel  
(LAG) interfaces, but not on VLAN routing interfaces.  
Format  
shutdown  
Mode  
Interface Config  
no shutdown  
This command enables a port.  
Format  
no shutdown  
Mode  
Interface Config  
shutdown all  
This command disables all ports.  
Note: You can use the shutdown all command on physical and  
port-channel (LAG) interfaces, but not on VLAN routing interfaces.  
Format  
Mode  
shutdown all  
Global Config  
Switching Commands  
23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no shutdown all  
This command enables all ports.  
Format  
no shutdown all  
Mode  
Global Config  
speed  
This command sets the speed and duplex setting for the interface.  
Format  
speed [{auto}] [{<100 | 10 | 10G> {<half-duplex | full-duplex>}}]  
Mode  
Interface Config  
Acceptable  
Values  
Definition  
100h  
100f  
10h  
100BASE-T half duplex  
100BASE-T full duplex  
10BASE-T half duplex  
10BASE-T full duplex  
10GBase-T full duplex  
10Gbase-T half duplex  
10f  
10Gh  
10Gf  
speed all  
This command sets the speed and duplex setting for all interfaces.  
Format  
speed all [{auto}] [{<100 | 10> {<half-duplex | full-duplex>}}]  
Mode  
Global Config  
Acceptable  
Values  
Definition  
100h  
100f  
10h  
100BASE-T half duplex  
100BASE-T full duplex  
10BASE-T half duplex  
10BASE-T full duplex  
10GBase-T full duplex  
10Gbase-T half duplex  
10f  
10Gh  
10Gf  
Switching Commands  
24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show port advertise  
Use this command to display the local administrative link advertisement configuration, local  
operational link advertisement, and the link partner advertisement for an interface. It also  
displays priority Resolution for speed and duplex as per 802.3 Annex 28B.3. It displays the  
autonegotiation state, Phy Master/Slave Clock configuration, and Link state of the port.  
If the link is down, the Clock is displayed as No Link, and a dash is displayed against the  
Oper Peer advertisement, and Priority Resolution. If autonegotiation is disabled, the admin  
Local Link advertisement, operational local link advertisement, operational peer  
advertisement, and Priority resolution fields are not displayed.  
If this command is executed without the optional slot/port parameter, it displays the  
autonegotiation state and operational Local link advertisement for all the ports. Operational  
link advertisement will display speed only if it is supported by both local as well as link  
partner. If autonegotiation is disabled, operational local link advertisement is not displayed.  
Format  
Mode  
show port advertise [slot/port]  
Privileged EXEC  
Example: The following commands show the command output with and without the optional  
parameter:  
(switch)#show port advertise 0/1  
Port: 0/1  
Type: Gigabit - Level  
Link State: Down  
Auto Negotiation: Enabled  
Clock: Auto  
1000f 1000h 100f 100h 10f 10h  
----- ----- ---- ---- --- ---  
Admin Local Link Advertisement no  
Oper Local Link Advertisement no  
no  
no  
no  
-
yes no yes no  
yes no yes no  
yes yes yes yes  
Oper Peer Advertisement  
Priority Resolution  
no  
-
yes -  
- -  
(Netgear Switch)#show port advertise  
Port  
Type  
Neg  
Operational Link Advertisement  
--------- ------------------------------ ----------- ------------------------------  
0/1 Gigabit - Level  
0/2 Gigabit - Level  
0/3 Gigabit - Level  
Enabled 1000f, 100f, 100h, 10f, 10h  
Enabled 1000f, 100f, 100h, 10f, 10h  
Enabled 1000f, 100f, 100h, 10f, 10h  
show port  
This command displays port information.  
Format  
Mode  
show port {<slot/port> | all}  
Privileged EXEC  
Switching Commands  
25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Interface  
Valid slot and port number separated by forward slashes.  
Type  
If not blank, this field indicates that this port is a special type of port. The possible  
values are:  
Mirror - this port is a monitoring port. For more information, see Port Mirroring on  
PC Mbr- this port is a member of a port-channel (LAG).  
Probe - this port is a probe port.  
Admin Mode  
The Port control administration state. The port must be enabled in order for it to be  
allowed into the network. - May be enabled or disabled. The factory default is enabled.  
Physical Mode  
The desired port speed and duplex mode. If autonegotiation support is selected, the  
duplex mode and speed is set from the auto-negotiation process. Note that the  
maximum capability of the port (full-duplex -100M) is advertised. Otherwise, this object  
determines the port's duplex mode and transmission rate. The factory default is Auto.  
Physical Status  
Link Status  
Link Trap  
The port speed and duplex mode.  
The Link is up or down.  
This object determines whether to send a trap when link status changes. The factory  
default is enabled.  
LACP Mode  
LACP is enabled or disabled on this port.  
show port protocol  
This command displays the Protocol-Based VLAN information for either the entire system, or  
for the indicated group.  
Format  
Mode  
show port protocol {<groupid> | all}  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Group Name  
The group name of an entry in the Protocol-based VLAN table.  
The group identifier of the protocol group.  
The type of protocol(s) for this group.  
Group ID  
Protocol(s)  
VLAN  
The VLAN associated with this Protocol Group.  
Lists the slot/port interface(s) that are associated with this Protocol Group.  
Interface(s)  
Switching Commands  
26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show port description  
This command displays the port description for every port.  
Format  
show port description <slot/port>  
Mode  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Interface  
Valid slot and port number separated by forward slashes  
Shows the port description configured via the “description” command  
Description  
show port status  
This command displays the Protocol-Based VLAN information for either the entire system, or  
for the indicated group.  
Format  
Mode  
show port status {<slot/port> | all}  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Interface  
Valid slot and port number separated by forward slashes.  
“Copper” or “Fiber” for combo port.  
Media Type  
STP Mode  
Indicate the spanning tree mode of the port.  
Either “Auto” or fixed speed and duplex mode.  
The actual speed and duplex mode.  
Whether the link is Up or Down.  
Physical Mode  
Physical Status  
Link Status  
Loop Status  
Whether the port is in loop state or not.  
Whether the remote side is using flow control or not.  
Partner Flow  
Control  
Loopback Interface Commands  
The commands in this section describe how to create, delete, and manage loopback  
interfaces. A loopback interface is always expected to be up. This interface can provide the  
source address for sent packets and can receive both local and remote packets. The  
loopback interface is typically used by routing protocols.  
IPv6 address to the loopback interface, see ipv6 address on page 359.  
Switching Commands  
27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
interface loopback  
Use this command to enter the Interface Config mode for a loopback interface. The range of  
the loopback ID is 0–7.  
Format  
Mode  
interface loopback <loopback-id>  
Global Config  
no interface loopback  
This command removes the loopback interface and associated configuration parameters for  
the specified loopback interface.  
Format  
Mode  
no interface loopback <loopback-id>  
Global Config  
show interface loopback  
This command displays information about configured loopback interfaces.  
Format  
Mode  
show interface loopback [<loopback-id>]  
Privileged EXEC  
If you do not specify a loopback ID, the following information appears for each loopback  
interface on the system:  
Term  
Definition  
Loopback ID  
Interface  
The loopback ID associated with the rest of the information in the row.  
The interface name.  
IP Address  
The IPv4 address of the interface.  
The number of packets received on this interface.  
Received  
Packets  
Sent Packets  
IPv6 Address  
The number of packets transmitted from this interface.  
The IPv6 address of this interface.  
If you specify a loopback ID, the following information appears:  
Term  
Definition  
Interface Link  
Status  
Shows whether the link is up or down.  
IP Address  
The IPv4 address of the interface.  
IPv6 is enabled  
(disabled)  
Shows whether IPv6 is enabled on the interface.  
Switching Commands  
28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
IPv6 Prefix is  
The IPv6 address of the interface.  
MTU size  
The maximum transmission size for packets on this interface, in bytes.  
Switching Commands  
29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Spanning Tree Protocol (STP) Commands  
This section describes the commands you use to configure Spanning Tree Protocol (STP).  
STP helps prevent network loops, duplicate messages, and network instability.  
spanning-tree  
This command sets the spanning-tree operational mode to enabled.  
Default  
enabled  
Format  
Mode  
spanning-tree  
Global Config  
no spanning-tree  
This command sets the spanning-tree operational mode to disabled. While disabled, the  
spanning-tree configuration is retained and can be changed, but is not activated.  
Format  
Mode  
no spanning-tree  
Global Config  
spanning-tree auto-edge  
This command enables auto-edge on the interface or range of interfaces. When enabled, the  
interface becomes an edge port if it does not see BPDUs for edge delay time.  
Default  
enabled  
Format  
Mode  
spanning-tree auto-edge  
Interface Config  
no spanning-tree auto-edge  
This command disables auto-edge on the interface or range of interfaces.  
Format  
Mode  
no spanning-tree auto-edge  
Interface Config  
spanning-tree bpdufilter  
Use this command to enable BPDU Filter on an interface or range of interfaces.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
spanning-tree bpdufilter  
Interface Config  
Switching Commands  
30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no spanning-tree bpdufilter  
Use this command to disable BPDU Filter on the interface or range of interfaces.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
no spanning-tree bpdufilter  
Interface Config  
spanning-tree bpdufilter default  
Use this command to enable BPDU Filter on all the edge port interfaces.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
spanning-tree bpdufilter  
Global Config  
no spanning-tree bpdufilter default  
Use this command to disable BPDU Filter on all the edge port interfaces.  
Default  
enabled  
Format  
Mode  
no spanning-tree bpdufilter default  
Global Config  
spanning-tree bpduflood  
Use this command to enable BPDU Flood on the interface.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
spanning-tree bpduflood  
Interface Config  
no spanning-tree bpduflood  
Use this command to disable BPDU Flood on the interface.  
Format  
Mode  
no spanning-tree bpduflood  
Interface Config  
Switching Commands  
31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
spanning-tree bpduguard  
Use this command to enable BPDU Guard on the switch.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
spanning-tree bpduguard  
Global Config  
no spanning-tree bpduguard  
Use this command to disable BPDU Guard on the switch.  
Format  
Mode  
no spanning-tree bpduguard  
Global Config  
spanning-tree bpdumigrationcheck  
Use this command to force a transmission of rapid spanning tree (RSTP) and multiple  
spanning tree (MSTP) BPDUs. Use the <slot/port> parameter to transmit a BPDU from a  
specified interface, or use the allkeyword to transmit BPDUs from all interfaces. This  
command forces the BPDU transmission when you execute it, so the command does not  
change the system configuration or have a “no” version.  
Format  
Mode  
spanning-tree bpdumigrationcheck {<slot/port> | all}  
Global Config  
spanning-tree configuration name  
This command sets the Configuration Identifier Name for use in identifying the configuration  
that this switch is currently using. The <name>is a string of up to 32 characters.  
Default  
base MAC address in hexadecimal notation  
Format  
Mode  
spanning-tree configuration name<name>  
Global Config  
no spanning-tree configuration name  
This command resets the Configuration Identifier Name to its default.  
Format  
Mode  
no spanning-tree configuration name  
Global Config  
Switching Commands  
32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
spanning-tree configuration revision  
This command sets the Configuration Identifier Revision Level for use in identifying the  
configuration that this switch is currently using. The Configuration Identifier Revision Level is  
a number in the range of 0–65535.  
Default  
0
Format  
Mode  
spanning-tree configuration revision<0-65535>  
Global Config  
no spanning-tree configuration revision  
This command sets the Configuration Identifier Revision Level for use in identifying the  
configuration that this switch is currently using to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no spanning-tree configuration revision  
Global Config  
spanning-tree edgeport  
This command specifies that this port is an Edge Port within the Common and Internal  
Spanning Tree. This allows this port to transition to Forwarding State without delay.  
Default  
Format  
Mode  
enabled  
spanning-tree edgeport  
Interface Config  
no spanning-tree edgeport  
This command specifies that this port is not an Edge Port within the Common and Internal  
Spanning Tree.  
Format  
Mode  
no spanning-tree edgeport  
Interface Config  
spanning-tree forceversion  
This command sets the Force Protocol Version parameter to a new value.  
Default  
802.1s  
Format  
Mode  
spanning-tree forceversion<802.1d | 802.1s | 802.1w>  
Global Config  
Use 802.1d to specify that the switch transmits ST BPDUs rather than MST BPDUs (IEEE  
802.1d functionality supported).  
Switching Commands  
33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Use 802.1s to specify that the switch transmits MST BPDUs (IEEE 802.1s functionality  
supported).  
Use 802.1w to specify that the switch transmits RST BPDUs rather than MST BPDUs  
(IEEE 802.1w functionality supported).  
no spanning-tree forceversion  
This command sets the Force Protocol Version parameter to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no spanning-tree forceversion  
Global Config  
spanning-tree forward-time  
This command sets the Bridge Forward Delay parameter to a new value for the Common and  
Internal Spanning Tree. The forward-time value is in seconds within a range of 4–30, with the  
value being greater than or equal to “(Bridge Max Age / 2) + 1”.  
Default  
15  
Format  
Mode  
spanning-tree forward-time<4-30>  
Global Config  
no spanning-tree forward-time  
This command sets the Bridge Forward Delay parameter for the Common and Internal  
Spanning Tree to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no spanning-tree forward-time  
Global Config  
spanning-tree guard  
This command selects whether loop guard or root guard is enabled on an interface. If neither  
is enabled, the port operates in accordance with the multiple spanning tree protocol.  
Default  
none  
Format  
Mode  
spanning-tree guard { none | root | loop }  
Interface Config  
no spanning-tree guard  
This command disables loop guard or root guard on the interface.  
Format  
Mode  
no spanning-tree guard  
Interface Config  
Switching Commands  
34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
spanning-tree tcnguard  
This command enables the propagation of received topology change notifications and topology  
changes to other ports.  
Default  
disable  
Format  
Mode  
spanning-tree tcnguard  
Interface Config  
no spanning-tree tcnguard  
This command disables the propagation of received topology change notifications and topology  
changes to other ports.  
Format  
Mode  
no spanning-tree tcnguard  
Interface Config  
spanning-tree max-age  
This command sets the Bridge Max Age parameter to a new value for the Common and  
Internal Spanning Tree. The max-age value is in seconds within a range of 6–40, with the  
value being less than or equal to 2 x (Bridge Forward Delay - 1).  
Default  
20  
Format  
Mode  
spanning-tree max-age<6-40>  
Global Config  
no spanning-tree max-age  
This command sets the Bridge Max Age parameter for the Common and Internal Spanning  
Tree to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no spanning-tree max-age  
Global Config  
spanning-tree max-hops  
This command sets the MSTP Max Hops parameter to a new value for the Common and  
Internal Spanning Tree. The max-hops value is a range from 6 to 40.  
Default  
20  
Format  
Mode  
spanning-tree max-hops <1-127>  
Global Config  
Switching Commands  
35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no spanning-tree max-hops  
This command sets the Bridge Max Hops parameter for the Common and Internal Spanning  
Tree to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no spanning-tree max-hops  
Global Config  
spanning-tree mst  
This command sets the Path Cost or Port Priority for this port within the multiple spanning  
tree instance or in the Common and Internal Spanning Tree. If you specify an <mstid>  
parameter that corresponds to an existing multiple spanning tree instance, the configurations  
are done for that multiple spanning tree instance. If you specify 0 (defined as the default CIST  
ID) as the <mstid>, the configurations are done for the Common and Internal Spanning Tree  
instance.  
If you specify the cost option, the command sets the path cost for this port within a multiple  
spanning tree instance or the Common and Internal Spanning Tree instance, depending on  
the <mstid>parameter. You can set the path cost as a number in the range of 1–200000000  
or auto. If you select auto the path cost value is set based on Link Speed.  
If you specify the external-cost option, this command sets the external-path cost for MST  
instance ‘0’ that is, CIST instance. You can set the external cost as a number in the range of  
1–200000000 or auto. If you specify auto, the external path cost value is set based on Link  
Speed.  
If you specify the port-priority option, this command sets the priority for this port within a  
specific multiple spanning tree instance or the Common and Internal Spanning Tree instance,  
depending on the <mstid>parameter. The port-priority value is a number in the range of  
0–240 in increments of 16.  
Default  
• cost—auto  
• external-cost—auto  
• port-priority—128  
Format  
Mode  
spanning-tree mst<mstid> {{cost <1-200000000> | auto} |  
{external-cost <1-200000000> | auto} | port-priority <0-240>}  
Interface Config  
no spanning-tree mst  
This command sets the Path Cost or Port Priority for this port within the multiple spanning  
tree instance, or in the Common and Internal Spanning Tree to the respective default values.  
If you specify an <mstid>parameter that corresponds to an existing multiple spanning tree  
instance, you are configuring that multiple spanning tree instance. If you specify 0 (defined as  
the default CIST ID) as the <mstid>, you are configuring the Common and Internal  
Spanning Tree instance.  
Switching Commands  
36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
If you specify cost, this command sets the path cost for this port within a multiple spanning  
tree instance or the Common and Internal Spanning Tree instance, depending on the  
<mstid>parameter, to the default value, that is, a path cost value based on the Link Speed.  
If you specify external-cost, this command sets the external path cost for this port for mst ‘0’  
instance, to the default value, that is, a path cost value based on the Link Speed.  
If you specify port-priority, this command sets the priority for this port within a specific  
multiple spanning tree instance or the Common and Internal Spanning Tree instance,  
depending on the <mstid>parameter, to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no spanning-tree mst <mstid> <cost | external-cost | port-priority>  
Interface Config  
spanning-tree mst instance  
This command adds a multiple spanning tree instance to the switch. The parameter  
<mstid>is a number within a range of 1–4094, that corresponds to the new instance ID to  
be added. The maximum number of multiple instances supported by the switch is 4.  
Default  
none  
Format  
Mode  
spanning-tree mst instance <mstid>  
Global Config  
no spanning-tree mst instance  
This command removes a multiple spanning tree instance from the switch and reallocates all  
VLANs allocated to the deleted instance to the Common and Internal Spanning Tree. The  
parameter <mstid>is a number that corresponds to the desired existing multiple spanning  
tree instance to be removed.  
Format  
Mode  
no spanning-tree mst instance <mstid>  
Global Config  
spanning-tree mst priority  
This command sets the bridge priority for a specific multiple spanning tree instance. The  
parameter <mstid>is a number that corresponds to the desired existing multiple spanning  
tree instance. The priority value is a number within a range of 0–61440 in increments of  
4096.  
If you specify 0 (defined as the default CIST ID) as the <mstid>, this command sets the  
Bridge Priority parameter to a new value for the Common and Internal Spanning Tree. The  
bridge priority value is a number within a range of 0–61440. The twelve least significant bits  
Switching Commands  
37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
are masked according to the 802.1s specification. This causes the priority to be rounded  
down to the next lower valid priority.  
Default  
32768  
Format  
Mode  
spanning-tree mst priority<mstid> <0-61440>  
Global Config  
no spanning-tree mst priority  
This command sets the bridge priority for a specific multiple spanning tree instance to the  
default value. The parameter <mstid>is a number that corresponds to the desired existing  
multiple spanning tree instance.  
If 0 (defined as the default CIST ID) is passed as the <mstid>, this command sets the  
Bridge Priority parameter for the Common and Internal Spanning Tree to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no spanning-tree mst priority<mstid>  
Global Config  
spanning-tree mst vlan  
This command adds an association between a multiple spanning tree instance and one or  
more VLANs so that the VLAN(s) are no longer associated with the Common and Internal  
Spanning Tree. The parameter <mstid>is a number that corresponds to the desired  
existing multiple spanning tree instance. The vlan range can be specified as a list or as a  
range of values. To specify a list of VLANs, enter a list of VLAN IDs, each separated by a  
comma with no spaces in between. To specify a range of VLANs, separate the beginning and  
ending VLAN ID with a dash ("-").  
Format  
Mode  
spanning-tree mst vlan <mstid> <vlanid>  
Global Config  
no spanning-tree mst vlan  
This command removes an association between a multiple spanning tree instance and one  
or more VLANs so that the VLAN(s) are again associated with the Common and Internal  
Spanning Tree.  
Format  
Mode  
no spanning-tree mst vlan <mstid> <vlanid>  
Global Config  
Switching Commands  
38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
spanning-tree port mode  
This command sets the Administrative Switch Port State for this port to enabled.  
Default  
enabled  
Format  
Mode  
spanning-tree port mode  
Interface Config  
no spanning-tree port mode  
This command sets the Administrative Switch Port State for this port to disabled.  
Format  
Mode  
no spanning-tree port mode  
Interface Config  
spanning-tree port mode all  
This command sets the Administrative Switch Port State for all ports to enabled.  
Default  
enabled  
Format  
Mode  
spanning-tree port mode all  
Global Config  
no spanning-tree port mode all  
This command sets the Administrative Switch Port State for all ports to disabled.  
Format  
Mode  
no spanning-tree port mode all  
Global Config  
spanning-tree edgeport all  
This command specifies that every port is an Edge Port within the Common and Internal  
Spanning Tree. This allows all ports to transition to Forwarding State without delay.  
Format  
Mode  
spanning-tree edgeport all  
Global Config  
no spanning-tree edgeport all  
This command disables Edge Port mode for all ports within the Common and Internal  
Spanning Tree.  
Format  
Mode  
no spanning-tree edgeport all  
Global Config  
Switching Commands  
39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
spanning-tree bpduforwarding  
Normally a switch will not forward Spanning Tree Protocol (STP) BPDU packets if STP is  
disabled. However, if in some network setup, the user wishes to forward BDPU packets  
received from other network devices, this command can be used to enable the forwarding.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
spanning-tree bpduforwarding  
Global Config  
no spanning-tree bpduforwarding  
This command will cause the STP BPDU packets received from the network to be dropped if  
STP is disabled.  
Format  
Mode  
no spanning-tree bpduforwarding  
Global Config  
show spanning-tree  
This command displays spanning tree settings for the Common and Internal Spanning Tree.  
The following details are displayed.  
Format  
Mode  
show spanning-tree  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Bridge Priority  
Specifies the bridge priority for the Common and Internal Spanning Tree (CST). The  
value lies between 0 and 61440. It is displayed in multiples of 4096.  
Bridge Identifier  
The bridge identifier for the CST. It is made up using the bridge priority and the base  
MAC address of the bridge.  
Time Since  
Topology  
Change  
Time in seconds.  
Topology  
Change Count  
Number of times changed.  
Topology  
Change  
Boolean value of the Topology Change parameter for the switch indicating if a topology  
change is in progress on any port assigned to the Common and Internal Spanning Tree.  
Designated  
Root  
The bridge identifier of the root bridge. It is made up from the bridge priority and the base  
MAC address of the bridge.  
Root Path Cost  
Value of the Root Path Cost parameter for the Common and Internal Spanning Tree.  
Switching Commands  
40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Root Port  
Identifier  
Identifier of the port to access the Designated Root for the CST  
Root Port Max  
Age  
Derived value.  
Derived value.  
Root Port  
Bridge Forward  
Delay  
Hello Time  
Configured value of the parameter for the CST.  
Bridge Hold  
Time  
Minimum time between transmission of Configuration Bridge Protocol Data Units  
(BPDUs).  
Bridge Max  
Hops  
Bridge max-hops count for the device.  
CST Regional  
Root  
Bridge Identifier of the CST Regional Root. It is made up using the bridge priority and the  
base MAC address of the bridge.  
Regional Root  
Path Cost  
Path Cost to the CST Regional Root.  
Associated  
FIDs  
List of forwarding database identifiers currently associated with this instance.  
List of VLAN IDs currently associated with this instance.  
Associated  
VLANs  
show spanning-tree brief  
This command displays spanning tree settings for the bridge. The following information  
appears.  
Format  
Mode  
show spanning-tree brief  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Bridge Priority  
Configured value.  
Bridge Identifier  
The bridge identifier for the selected MST instance. It is made up using the  
bridge priority and the base MAC address of the bridge.  
Bridge Max Age  
Configured value.  
Bridge Max Hops  
Bridge Hello Time  
Bridge Forward Delay  
Bridge Hold Time  
Bridge max-hops count for the device.  
Configured value.  
Configured value.  
Minimum time between transmission of Configuration Bridge Protocol Data  
Units (BPDUs).  
Switching Commands  
41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show spanning-tree interface  
This command displays the settings and parameters for a specific switch port within the  
Common and Internal Spanning Tree. The <slot/port> is the desired switch port. The  
following details are displayed on execution of the command.  
Format  
show spanning-tree interface<slot/port>  
Mode  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Hello Time  
Admin hello time for this port.  
Enabled or disabled.  
Port Mode  
BPDU Guard Effect  
Root Guard  
Enabled or disabled.  
Enabled or disabled.  
Enabled or disabled.  
Loop Guard  
TCN Guard  
Enable or disable the propagation of received topology change notifications and  
topology changes to other ports.  
BPDU Filter Mode  
BPDU Flood Mode  
Auto Edge  
Enabled or disabled.  
Enabled or disabled.  
To enable or disable the feature that causes a port that has not seen a BPDU for  
‘edge delay’ time, to become an edge port and transition to forwarding faster.  
Port Up Time Since  
Counters Last Cleared  
Time since port was reset, displayed in days, hours, minutes, and seconds.  
Spanning Tree Protocol Bridge Protocol Data Units sent.  
STP BPDUs  
Transmitted  
STP BPDUs Received  
Spanning Tree Protocol Bridge Protocol Data Units received.  
Rapid Spanning Tree Protocol Bridge Protocol Data Units sent.  
RSTP BPDUs  
Transmitted  
RSTP BPDUs Received  
Rapid Spanning Tree Protocol Bridge Protocol Data Units received.  
Multiple Spanning Tree Protocol Bridge Protocol Data Units sent.  
MSTP BPDUs  
Transmitted  
MSTP BPDUs Received  
Multiple Spanning Tree Protocol Bridge Protocol Data Units received.  
show spanning-tree mst port detailed  
This command displays the detailed settings and parameters for a specific switch port within  
a particular multiple spanning tree instance. The parameter <mstid>is a number that  
Switching Commands  
42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
corresponds to the desired existing multiple spanning tree instance. The <slot/port> is  
the desired switch port.  
Format  
show spanning-tree mst port detailed <mstid> <slot/port>  
Mode  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
MST Instance ID  
Port Identifier  
The ID of the existing MST instance.  
The port identifier for the specified port within the selected MST instance. It is made up  
from the port priority and the interface number of the port.  
Port Priority  
The priority for a particular port within the selected MST instance. The port priority is  
displayed in multiples of 16.  
PortForwarding  
State  
Current spanning tree state of this port.  
Port Role  
Each enabled MST Bridge Port receives a Port Role for each spanning tree. The port  
role is one of the following values: Root Port, Designated Port, Alternate Port, Backup  
Port, Master Port, or Disabled Port  
Auto-Calculate  
Port Path Cost  
Indicates whether auto calculation for port path cost is enabled.  
Port Path Cost  
Configured value of the Internal Port Path Cost parameter.  
The Identifier of the designated root for this port.  
Designated  
Root  
Root Path Cost  
The path cost to get to the root bridge for this instance. The root path cost is zero if the  
bridge is the root bridge for that instance.  
Designated  
Bridge  
Bridge Identifier of the bridge with the Designated Port.  
DesignatedPort  
Identifier  
Port on the Designated Bridge that offers the lowest cost to the LAN.  
Loop  
Inconsistent  
State  
The current loop inconsistent state of this port in this MST instance. When in loop  
inconsistent state, the port has failed to receive BPDUs while configured with loop guard  
enabled. Loop inconsistent state maintains the port in a "blocking" state until a  
subsequent BPDU is received.  
Transitions Into  
Loop  
The number of times this interface has transitioned into loop inconsistent state.  
Inconsistent  
State  
Transitions Out  
of Loop  
The number of times this interface has transitioned out of loop inconsistent state.  
Inconsistent  
State  
Switching Commands  
43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
If you specify 0 (defined as the default CIST ID) as the <mstid>, this command displays the  
settings and parameters for a specific switch port within the Common and Internal Spanning  
Tree. The <slot/port> is the desired switch port. In this case, the following are displayed.  
Term  
Definition  
Port Identifier  
Port Priority  
The port identifier for this port within the CST.  
The priority of the port within the CST.  
The forwarding state of the port within the CST.  
PortForwarding  
State  
Port Role  
The role of the specified interface within the CST.  
Auto-Calculate  
Port Path Cost  
Indicates whether auto calculation for port path cost is enabled or not (disabled).  
Port Path Cost  
The configured path cost for the specified interface.  
Auto-Calculate  
External Port  
Path Cost  
Indicates whether auto calculation for external port path cost is enabled.  
External Port  
Path Cost  
The cost to get to the root bridge of the CIST across the boundary of the region. This  
means that if the port is a boundary port for an MSTP region, the external path cost is  
used.  
Designated  
Root  
Identifier of the designated root for this port within the CST.  
Root Path Cost  
The root path cost to the LAN by the port.  
The bridge containing the designated port.  
Designated  
Bridge  
DesignatedPort  
Identifier  
Port on the Designated Bridge that offers the lowest cost to the LAN.  
Topology  
Change  
Acknowledgem  
ent  
Value of flag in next Configuration Bridge Protocol Data Unit (BPDU) transmission  
indicating if a topology change is in progress for this port.  
Hello Time  
Edge Port  
The hello time in use for this port.  
The configured value indicating if this port is an edge port.  
Edge Port  
Status  
The derived value of the edge port status. True if operating as an edge port; false  
otherwise.  
Point To Point  
MAC Status  
Derived value indicating if this port is part of a point to point link.  
The regional root identifier in use for this port.  
CST Regional  
Root  
CST Internal  
Root Path Cost  
The internal root path cost to the LAN by the designated external port.  
Loop  
Inconsistent  
State  
The current loop inconsistent state of this port in this MST instance. When in loop  
inconsistent state, the port has failed to receive BPDUs while configured with loop guard  
enabled. Loop inconsistent state maintains the port in a "blocking" state until a  
subsequent BPDU is received.  
Switching Commands  
44  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Transitions Into  
Loop  
The number of times this interface has transitioned into loop inconsistent state.  
Inconsistent  
State  
Transitions Out  
of Loop  
The number of times this interface has transitioned out of loop inconsistent state.  
Inconsistent  
State  
show spanning-tree mst port summary  
This command displays the settings of one or all ports within the specified multiple spanning  
tree instance. The parameter <mstid>indicates a particular MST instance. The parameter  
{<slot/port> | all}indicates the desired switch port or all ports.  
If you specify 0 (defined as the default CIST ID) as the <mstid>, the status summary  
displays for one or all ports within the Common and Internal Spanning Tree.  
Format  
Mode  
show spanning-tree mst port summary<mstid> {<slot/port> | all}  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
MST Instance ID  
Interface  
STP Mode  
Type  
The MST instance associated with this port.  
Valid slot and port number separated by forward slashes.  
Indicates whether spanning tree is enabled or disabled on the port.  
Currently not used.  
STP State  
Port Role  
Desc  
The forwarding state of the port in the specified spanning tree instance.  
The role of the specified port within the spanning tree.  
Indicates whether the port is in loop inconsistent state or not. This field is blank if the loop  
guard feature is not available.  
show spanning-tree mst port summary active  
This command displays settings for the ports within the specified multiple spanning tree  
instance that are active links.  
Format  
Mode  
show spanning-tree mst port summary<mstid> active  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Switching Commands  
45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
mstid  
The ID of the existing MST instance.  
Interface  
STP Mode  
Type  
slot/port  
Indicates whether spanning tree is enabled or disabled on the port.  
Currently not used.  
STP State  
Port Role  
Desc  
The forwarding state of the port in the specified spanning tree instance.  
The role of the specified port within the spanning tree.  
Indicates whether the port is in loop inconsistent state or not. This field is blank if the loop  
guard feature is not available.  
show spanning-tree mst summary  
This command displays summary information about all multiple spanning tree instances in  
the switch. On execution, the following details are displayed.  
Format  
Mode  
show spanning-tree mst summary  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
MSTInstanceID  
List  
List of multiple spanning trees IDs currently configured.  
For each  
MSTID:  
• Associated  
FIDs  
• List of forwarding database identifiers associated with this instance.  
• List of VLAN IDs associated with this instance.  
• Associated  
VLANs  
show spanning-tree summary  
This command displays spanning tree settings and parameters for the switch. The following  
details are displayed on execution of the command.  
Format  
Mode  
show spanning-tree summary  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Switching Commands  
46  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Spanning Tree  
Adminmode  
Enabled or disabled.  
Spanning Tree  
Version  
Version of 802.1 currently supported (IEEE 802.1s, IEEE 802.1w, or IEEE 802.1d) based  
upon the Force Protocol Version parameter.  
BPDU Guard  
Mode  
Enabled or disabled.  
BPDU Filter  
Mode  
Enabled or disabled.  
Configuration  
Name  
Identifier used to identify the configuration currently being used.  
Identifier used to identify the configuration currently being used.  
A generated Key used in the exchange of the BPDUs.  
Configuration  
Revision Level  
Configuration  
Digest Key  
Configuration  
Format Selector  
Specifies the version of the configuration format being used in the exchange of BPDUs.  
The default value is zero.  
MST Instances  
List of all multiple spanning tree instances configured on the switch.  
show spanning-tree vlan  
This command displays the association between a VLAN and a multiple spanning tree  
instance. The <vlanid>corresponds to an existing VLAN ID.  
Format  
Mode  
show spanning-tree vlan <vlanid>  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
VLAN Identifier  
The VLANs associated with the selected MST instance.  
Associated  
Instance  
Identifier for the associated multiple spanning tree instance or “CST” if associated with  
the Common and Internal Spanning Tree.  
VLAN Commands  
This section describes the commands you use to configure VLAN settings.  
Switching Commands  
47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
vlan database  
This command gives you access to the VLAN Config mode, which allows you to configure  
VLAN characteristics.  
Format  
Mode  
vlan database  
Privileged EXEC  
network mgmt_vlan  
This command configures the Management VLAN ID.  
Default  
1
Format  
Mode  
network mgmt_vlan <1-4093>  
Privileged EXEC  
no network mgmt_vlan  
This command sets the Management VLAN ID to the default.  
Format  
Mode  
no network mgmt_vlan  
Privileged EXEC  
vlan  
This command creates a new VLAN and assigns it an ID. The ID is a valid VLAN  
identification number (ID 1 is reserved for the default VLAN). The vlan-list contains VlanId's in  
range <1-4093>. Separate non-consecutive IDs with ',' and no spaces and no zeros in  
between the range; Use '-' for range.  
Format  
vlan <vlan-list>  
Mode  
VLAN Config  
no vlan  
This command deletes an existing VLAN. The ID is a valid VLAN identification number (ID 1  
is reserved for the default VLAN). The vlan-list contains VlanId's in range <1-4093>.  
Separate non-consecutive IDs with ',' and no spaces and no zeros in between the range; Use  
'-' for range.  
Format  
Mode  
no vlan <vlan-list>  
VLAN Config  
Switching Commands  
48  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
vlan acceptframe  
This command sets the frame acceptance mode per interface. For VLAN Only mode,  
untagged frames or priority frames received on this interface are discarded. For Admit All  
mode, untagged frames or priority frames received on this interface are accepted and  
assigned the value of the interface VLAN ID for this port. With either option, VLAN tagged  
frames are forwarded in accordance with the IEEE 802.1Q VLAN Specification.  
Default  
all  
Format  
Mode  
vlan acceptframe {untaggedonly | vlanonly | all}  
Interface Config  
no vlan acceptframe  
This command resets the frame acceptance mode for the interface to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no vlan acceptframe  
Interface Config  
vlan ingressfilter  
This command enables ingress filtering. If ingress filtering is disabled, frames received with  
VLAN IDs that do not match the VLAN membership of the receiving interface are admitted  
and forwarded to ports that are members of that VLAN.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
vlan ingressfilter  
Interface Config  
no vlan ingressfilter  
This command disables ingress filtering. If ingress filtering is disabled, frames received with  
VLAN IDs that do not match the VLAN membership of the receiving interface are admitted  
and forwarded to ports that are members of that VLAN.  
Format  
Mode  
no vlan ingressfilter  
Interface Config  
Switching Commands  
49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
vlan makestatic  
This command changes a dynamically created VLAN (one that is created by GVRP  
registration) to a static VLAN (one that is permanently configured and defined). The ID is a  
valid VLAN identification number. VLAN range is 2-4093.  
Format  
vlan makestatic <2-4093>  
Mode  
VLAN Config  
vlan name  
This command changes the name of a VLAN. The name is an alphanumeric string of up to 32  
characters, and the ID is a valid VLAN identification number. ID range is 1-4093.  
Default  
• VLAN ID 1 - default  
• other VLANS - blank string  
Format  
Mode  
vlan name <1-4093> <name>  
VLAN Config  
no vlan name  
This command sets the name of a VLAN to a blank string.  
Format  
Mode  
no vlan name <1-4093>  
VLAN Config  
vlan participation  
This command configures the degree of participation for a specific interface in a VLAN. The  
ID is a valid VLAN identification number, and the interface is a valid interface number.  
Format  
Mode  
vlan participation {exclude | include | auto} <1-4093>  
Interface Config  
Participation options are:  
Participation  
Options  
Definition  
include  
exclude  
The interface is always a member of this VLAN. This is equivalent to registration fixed.  
The interface is never a member of this VLAN. This is equivalent to registration  
forbidden.  
auto  
The interface is dynamically registered in this VLAN by GVRP. The interface will not  
participate in this VLAN unless a join request is received on this interface. This is  
equivalent to registration normal.  
Switching Commands  
50  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
vlan participation all  
This command configures the degree of participation for all interfaces in a VLAN. The ID is a  
valid VLAN identification number.  
Format  
Mode  
vlan participation all {exclude | include | auto} <1-4093>  
Global Config  
You can use the following participation options:  
Participation  
Definition  
Options  
include  
The interface is always a member of this VLAN. This is equivalent to registration fixed.  
exclude  
auto  
The interface is never a member of this VLAN. This is equivalent to registration  
forbidden.  
The interface is dynamically registered in this VLAN by GVRP. The interface will not  
participate in this VLAN unless a join request is received on this interface. This is  
equivalent to registration normal.  
vlan port acceptframe all  
This command sets the frame acceptance mode for all interfaces.  
Default  
all  
Format  
Mode  
vlan port acceptframe all {vlanonly | all}  
Global Config  
The modes defined as follows:  
Mode  
Definition  
VLAN Only  
mode  
Untagged frames or priority frames received on this interface are discarded.  
Admit All mode  
Untagged frames or priority frames received on this interface are accepted and assigned  
the value of the interface VLAN ID for this port.  
With either option, VLAN tagged frames are forwarded in accordance with the IEEE 802.1Q  
VLAN Specification.  
no vlan port acceptframe all  
This command sets the frame acceptance mode for all interfaces to Admit All. For Admit All  
mode, untagged frames or priority frames received on this interface are accepted and  
Switching Commands  
51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
assigned the value of the interface VLAN ID for this port. With either option, VLAN tagged  
frames are forwarded in accordance with the IEEE 802.1Q VLAN Specification.  
Format  
Mode  
no vlan port acceptframe all  
Global Config  
vlan port ingressfilter all  
This command enables ingress filtering for all ports. If ingress filtering is disabled, frames  
received with VLAN IDs that do not match the VLAN membership of the receiving interface  
are admitted and forwarded to ports that are members of that VLAN.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
vlan port ingressfilter all  
Global Config  
no vlan port ingressfilter all  
This command disables ingress filtering for all ports. If ingress filtering is disabled, frames  
received with VLAN IDs that do not match the VLAN membership of the receiving interface  
are admitted and forwarded to ports that are members of that VLAN.  
Format  
Mode  
no vlan port ingressfilter all  
Global Config  
vlan port pvid all  
This command changes the VLAN ID for all interface.  
Default  
1
Format  
Mode  
vlan port pvid all <1-4093>  
Global Config  
no vlan port pvid all  
This command sets the VLAN ID for all interfaces to 1.  
Format  
Mode  
no vlan port pvid all  
Global Config  
Switching Commands  
52  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
vlan port tagging all  
This command configures the tagging behavior for all interfaces in a VLAN to enabled. If  
tagging is enabled, traffic is transmitted as tagged frames. If tagging is disabled, traffic is  
transmitted as untagged frames. The ID is a valid VLAN identification number.  
Format  
Mode  
vlan port tagging all <1-4093>  
Global Config  
no vlan port tagging all  
This command configures the tagging behavior for all interfaces in a VLAN to disabled. If  
tagging is disabled, traffic is transmitted as untagged frames. The ID is a valid VLAN  
identification number.  
Format  
Mode  
no vlan port tagging all  
Global Config  
vlan protocol group  
This command adds protocol-based VLAN groups to the system. When it is created, the  
protocol group will be assigned a unique number (1-128) that will be used to identify the  
group in subsequent commands.  
Format  
Mode  
vlan protocol group <1-128>  
Global Config  
no vlan protocol group  
This command removes a protocol group.  
Format  
Mode  
no vlan protocol group <1-128>  
Global Config  
vlan protocol group name  
This command assigns a name to a protocol-based VLAN group. The groupname variable  
can be a character string of 0–16 characters.  
Format  
Mode  
vlan protocol group name <1-128> <groupname>  
Global Config  
Switching Commands  
53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no vlan protocol group name  
This command removes the name from a protocol-based VLAN group.  
Format  
Mode  
no vlan protocol group name <1-128>  
Global Config  
vlan protocol group add protocol  
This command adds the protocol to the protocol-based VLAN identified by groupid. A group  
may have more than one protocol associated with it. Each interface and protocol combination  
can only be associated with one group. If adding a protocol to a group causes any conflicts  
with interfaces currently associated with the group, this command fails and the protocol is not  
added to the group. The possible values for protocol-list includes the keywords ip, arp, and  
ipx and hexadecimal or decimal values ranging from 0x0600 (1536) to 0xFFFF (65535). The  
protocol list can accept up to 16 protocols separated by a comma.  
Default  
none  
Format  
Mode  
vlan protocol group add protocol <groupid> ethertype  
{<protocol-list>|arp|ip|ipx}  
Global Config  
no vlan protocol group add protocol  
This command removes the <protocol> from this protocol-based VLAN group that is  
identified by this <groupid>. The possible values for protocol are ip, arp, and ipx.  
Format  
Mode  
no vlan protocol group add protocol <groupid> ethertype  
{<protocol-list>|arp|ip|ipx}  
Global Config  
protocol group  
This command attaches a <vlanid>to the protocol-based VLAN identified by <groupid>.  
A group may only be associated with one VLAN at a time, however the VLAN association can  
be changed.  
Default  
none  
Format  
Mode  
protocol group <groupid> <vlanid>  
VLAN Config  
Switching Commands  
54  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no protocol group  
This command removes the <vlanid> from this protocol-based VLAN group that is  
identified by this <groupid>.  
Format  
Mode  
no protocol group <groupid> <vlanid>  
VLAN Config  
protocol vlan group  
This command adds the physical interface to the protocol-based VLAN identified by  
<groupid>. You can associate multiple interfaces with a group, but you can only associate  
each interface and protocol combination with one group. If adding an interface to a group  
causes any conflicts with protocols currently associated with the group, this command fails  
and the interface(s) are not added to the group.  
Default  
none  
Format  
Mode  
protocol vlan group <groupid>  
Interface Config  
no protocol vlan group  
This command removes the interface from this protocol-based VLAN group that is identified  
by this <groupid>.  
Format  
Mode  
no protocol vlan group <groupid>  
Interface Config  
protocol vlan group all  
This command adds all physical interfaces to the protocol-based VLAN identified by  
<groupid>. You can associate multiple interfaces with a group, but you can only associate  
each interface and protocol combination with one group. If adding an interface to a group  
causes any conflicts with protocols currently associated with the group, this command will fail  
and the interface(s) will not be added to the group.  
Default  
none  
Format  
Mode  
protocol vlan group all <groupid>  
Global Config  
Switching Commands  
55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no protocol vlan group all  
This command removes all interfaces from this protocol-based VLAN group that is identified  
by this <groupid>.  
Format  
no protocol vlan group all <groupid>  
Mode  
Global Config  
vlan pvid  
This command changes the VLAN ID per interface.  
Default  
1
Format  
Mode  
vlan pvid <1-4093>  
Interface Config  
no vlan pvid  
This command sets the VLAN ID per interface to 1.  
Format  
Mode  
no vlan pvid  
Interface Config  
vlan tagging  
This command configures the tagging behavior for a specific interface in a VLAN to enabled.  
If tagging is enabled, traffic is transmitted as tagged frames. If tagging is disabled, traffic is  
transmitted as untagged frames. The vlan-list contains VlanId's in range <1-4093>. Separate  
non-consecutive IDs with ',' and no spaces and no zeros in between the range; Use '-' for  
range.  
Format  
Mode  
vlan tagging <vlan-list>  
Interface Config  
no vlan tagging  
This command configures the tagging behavior for a specific interface in a VLAN to disabled.  
If tagging is disabled, traffic is transmitted as untagged frames. The vlan-list contains VlanId's  
in range <1-4093>. Separate non-consecutive IDs with ',' and no spaces and no zeros in  
between the range; Use '-' for range.  
Format  
Mode  
no vlan tagging <vlan-list>  
Interface Config  
Switching Commands  
56  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
vlan association subnet  
This command associates a VLAN to a specific IP-subnet.  
Format  
Mode  
vlan association subnet <ipaddr> <netmask> <1-4093>  
VLAN Config  
no vlan association subnet  
This command removes association of a specific IP-subnet to a VLAN.  
Format  
Mode  
no vlan association subnet <ipaddr> <netmask>  
VLAN Config  
vlan association mac  
This command associates a MAC address to a VLAN.  
Format  
Mode  
vlan association mac<macaddr> <1-4093>  
VLAN database  
no vlan association mac  
This command removes the association of a MAC address to a VLAN.  
Format  
Mode  
no vlan association mac<macaddr>  
VLAN database  
show vlan  
This command displays a list of all configured VLAN.  
Format  
show vlan  
Mode  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
VLAN ID  
A VLAN Identifier (VID) is associated with each VLAN. The range of the VLAN ID is  
1–4093.  
VLAN Name  
VLAN Type  
A string associated with this VLAN as a convenience. It can be up to 32 alphanumeric  
characters long, including blanks. The default is blank. VLAN ID 1 always has a name of  
“Default.” This field is optional.  
Type of VLAN, which can be Default (VLAN ID = 1) or static (one that is configured and  
permanently defined), or Dynamic (one that is created by GVRP registration).  
Switching Commands  
57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show vlan <vlanid>  
This command displays detailed information, including interface information, for a specific  
VLAN. The ID is a valid VLAN identification number.  
Format  
show vlan <vlanid>  
Mode  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
VLAN ID  
A VLAN Identifier (VID) is associated with each VLAN. The range of the VLAN ID is  
1–4093.  
VLAN Name  
A string associated with this VLAN as a convenience. It can be up to 32 alphanumeric  
characters long, including blanks. The default is blank. VLAN ID 1 always has a name of  
“Default.” This field is optional.  
VLAN Type  
Interface  
Current  
Type of VLAN, which can be Default (VLAN ID = 1) or static (one that is configured and  
permanently defined), or Dynamic (one that is created by GVRP registration).  
Valid slot and port number separated by forward slashes. It is possible to set the  
parameters for all ports by using the selectors on the top line.  
The degree of participation of this port in this VLAN. The permissible values are:  
Include - This port is always a member of this VLAN. This is equivalent to registration  
fixed in the IEEE 802.1Q standard.  
Exclude - This port is never a member of this VLAN. This is equivalent to registration  
forbidden in the IEEE 802.1Q standard.  
Autodetect - To allow the port to be dynamically registered in this VLAN via GVRP.  
The port will not participate in this VLAN unless a join request is received on this port.  
This is equivalent to registration normal in the IEEE 802.1Q standard.  
Configured  
The configured degree of participation of this port in this VLAN. The permissible values  
are:  
Include - This port is always a member of this VLAN. This is equivalent to registration  
fixed in the IEEE 802.1Q standard.  
Exclude - This port is never a member of this VLAN. This is equivalent to registration  
forbidden in the IEEE 802.1Q standard.  
Autodetect - To allow the port to be dynamically registered in this VLAN via GVRP.  
The port will not participate in this VLAN unless a join request is received on this port.  
This is equivalent to registration normal in the IEEE 802.1Q standard.  
Tagging  
The tagging behavior for this port in this VLAN.  
Tagged - Transmit traffic for this VLAN as tagged frames.  
Untagged - Transmit traffic for this VLAN as untagged frames.  
Switching Commands  
58  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show vlan brief  
This command displays a list of all configured VLANs.  
Format  
show vlan brief  
Mode  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
VLAN ID  
There is a VLAN Identifier (vlanid) associated with each VLAN. The range of the VLAN  
ID is 1–3965.  
VLAN Name  
VLAN Type  
A string associated with this VLAN as a convenience. It can be up to 32 alphanumeric  
characters long, including blanks. The default is blank. VLAN ID 1 always has a name of  
“Default.” This field is optional.  
Type of VLAN, which can be Default (VLAN ID = 1) or static (one that is configured and  
permanently defined), or a Dynamic (one that is created by GVRP registration).  
show vlan port  
This command displays VLAN port information.  
Format  
Mode  
show vlan port {<slot/port> | all}  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Interface  
Valid slot and port number separated by forward slashes. It is possible to set the  
parameters for all ports by using the selectors on the top line.  
Port VLAN ID  
The VLAN ID that this port will assign to untagged frames or priority tagged frames  
received on this port. The value must be for an existing VLAN. The factory default is 1.  
Acceptable  
Frame Types  
The types of frames that may be received on this port. The options are 'VLAN only' and  
'Admit All'. When set to 'VLAN only', untagged frames or priority tagged frames received  
on this port are discarded. When set to 'Admit All', untagged frames or priority tagged  
frames received on this port are accepted and assigned the value of the Port VLAN ID for  
this port. With either option, VLAN tagged frames are forwarded in accordance to the  
802.1Q VLAN specification.  
Ingress  
Filtering  
May be enabled or disabled. When enabled, the frame is discarded if this port is not a  
member of the VLAN with which this frame is associated. In a tagged frame, the VLAN is  
identified by the VLAN ID in the tag. In an untagged frame, the VLAN is the Port VLAN ID  
specified for the port that received this frame. When disabled, all frames are forwarded in  
accordance with the 802.1Q VLAN bridge specification. The factory default is disabled.  
GVRP  
May be enabled or disabled.  
Default Priority  
The 802.1p priority assigned to tagged packets arriving on the port.  
Switching Commands  
59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show vlan association subnet  
This command displays the VLAN associated with a specific configured IP-Address and net  
mask. If no IP address and net mask are specified, the VLAN associations of all the  
configured IP-subnets are displayed.  
Format  
show vlan association subnet [<ipaddr> <netmask>]  
Mode  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
IP Subnet  
The IP address assigned to each interface.  
The subnet mask.  
IP Mask  
VLAN ID  
A VLAN Identifier (VID) is associated with each VLAN.  
show vlan association mac  
This command displays the VLAN associated with a specific configured MAC address. If no  
MAC address is specified, the VLAN associations of all the configured MAC addresses are  
displayed.  
Format  
Mode  
show vlan association mac [<macaddr>]  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
MAC Address  
A MAC address for which the switch has forwarding and or filtering information. The  
format is 6 or 8 two-digit hexadecimal numbers that are separated by colons, for example  
01:23:45:67:89:AB. In an IVL system the MAC address will be displayed as 8 bytes.  
VLAN ID  
A VLAN Identifier (VID) is associated with each VLAN.  
Double VLAN Commands  
This section describes the commands you use to configure double VLAN (DVLAN). Double  
VLAN tagging is a way to pass VLAN traffic from one customer domain to another through a  
Metro Core in a simple and cost effective manner. The additional tag on the traffic helps  
differentiate between customers in the MAN while preserving the VLAN identification of the  
individual customers when they enter their own 802.1Q domain.  
Switching Commands  
60  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
dvlan-tunnel ethertype  
This command configures the ether-type for all interfaces. The ether-type may have the  
values of 802.1Q, vMAN, or custom. If the ether-type has a value of custom, the optional  
value of the custom ether type must be set to a value from 0 to 65535.  
Default  
vman  
Format  
Mode  
dvlan-tunnel ethertype {802.1Q | vman | custom} [0-65535]  
Global Config  
mode dot1q-tunnel  
This command is used to enable Double VLAN Tunneling on the specified interface.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
mode dot1q-tunnel  
Interface Config  
no mode dot1q-tunnel  
This command is used to disable Double VLAN Tunneling on the specified interface. By  
default, Double VLAN Tunneling is disabled.  
Format  
Mode  
no mode dot1q-tunnel  
Interface Config  
mode dvlan-tunnel  
Use this command to enable Double VLAN Tunneling on the specified interface.  
Note: When you use the mode dvlan-tunnelcommand on an  
interface, it becomes a service provider port. Ports that do not have  
double VLAN tunneling enabled are customer ports.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
mode dvlan-tunnel  
Interface Config  
Switching Commands  
61  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no mode dvlan-tunnel  
This command is used to disable Double VLAN Tunneling on the specified interface. By  
default, Double VLAN Tunneling is disabled.  
Format  
Mode  
no mode dvlan-tunnel  
Interface Config  
show dot1q-tunnel  
Use this command without the optional parameters to display all interfaces enabled for  
Double VLAN Tunneling. Use the optional parameters to display detailed information about  
Double VLAN Tunneling for the specified interface or all interfaces.  
Format  
Mode  
show dot1q-tunnel [interface {<slot/port> | all}]  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Interface  
Valid slot and port number separated by forward slashes.  
Mode  
The administrative mode through which Double VLAN Tunneling can be enabled or  
disabled. The default value for this field is disabled.  
EtherType  
A 2-byte hex EtherType to be used as the first 16 bits of the DVLAN tunnel. There are  
three different EtherType tags. The first is 802.1Q, which represents the commonly used  
value of 0x8100. The second is vMAN, which represents the commonly used value of  
0x88A8. If EtherType is not one of these two values, it is a custom tunnel value,  
representing any value in the range of 0–65535.  
show dvlan-tunnel  
Use this command without the optional parameters to display all interfaces enabled for  
Double VLAN Tunneling. Use the optional parameters to display detailed information about  
Double VLAN Tunneling for the specified interface or all interfaces.  
Format  
Mode  
show dvlan-tunnel [interface {<slot/port> | all}]  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Interface  
Valid slot and port number separated by forward slashes.  
Switching Commands  
62  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Mode  
The administrative mode through which Double VLAN Tunneling can be enabled or  
disabled. The default value for this field is disabled.  
EtherType  
A 2-byte hex EtherType to be used as the first 16 bits of the DVLAN tunnel. There are  
three different EtherType tags. The first is 802.1Q, which represents the commonly used  
value of 0x8100. The second is vMAN, which represents the commonly used value of  
0x88A8. If EtherType is not one of these two values, it is a custom tunnel value,  
representing any value in the range of 0–65535.  
Voice VLAN Commands  
This section describes the commands you use for Voice VLAN. Voice VLAN enables switch  
ports to carry voice traffic with defined priority to enable separation of voice and data traffic  
coming onto the port. The benefits of using Voice VLAN is to ensure that the sound quality of  
an IP phone could be safeguarded from deteriorating when the data traffic on the port is high.  
Also the inherent isolation provided by VLANs ensures that inter-VLAN traffic is under  
management control and that network- attached clients cannot initiate a direct attack on  
voice components. QoS-based on IEEE 802.1P Class of Service (CoS) uses classification  
and scheduling to sent network traffic from the switch in a predictable manner. The system  
uses the source MAC of the traffic traveling through the port to identify the IP phone data  
flow.  
voice vlan (Global Config)  
Use this command to enable the Voice VLAN capability on the switch.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
voice vlan  
Global Config  
no voice vlan (Global Config)  
Use this command to disable the Voice VLAN capability on the switch.  
Format  
Mode  
no voice vlan  
Global Config  
voice vlan (Interface Config)  
Use this command to enable the Voice VLAN capability on the interface.  
Default  
disabled  
Switching Commands  
63  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Format  
Mode  
voice vlan {<id> | dot1p <priority> | none | untagged}  
Interface Config  
You can configure Voice VLAN in any of the following ways:  
Parameter  
Description  
vlan-id  
Configure the IP phone to forward all voice traffic through the specified VLAN. Valid  
VLAN IDs are from 1 to 4093 (the maximum supported by the platform).  
dot1p  
Configure the IP phone to use 802.1p priority tagging for voice traffic and to use the  
default native VLAN (VLAN 0) to carry all traffic. Valid <priority>range is 0–7.  
none  
Allow the IP phone to use its own configuration to send untagged voice traffic.  
Configure the phone to send untagged voice traffic.  
untagged  
no voice vlan (Interface Config)  
Use this command to disable the Voice VLAN capability on the interface.  
Format  
Mode  
no voice vlan  
Interface Config  
voice vlan data priority  
Use this command to either trust or untrust the data traffic arriving on the Voice VLAN port.  
Default  
trust  
Format  
Mode  
voice vlan data priority {untrust | trust}  
Interface Config  
show voice vlan  
Format  
Mode  
show voice vlan [interface {<slot/port> | all}]  
Privileged EXEC  
When the interfaceparameter is not specified, only the global mode of the Voice VLAN is  
displayed.  
Term  
Definition  
Administrative  
Mode  
The Global Voice VLAN mode.  
Switching Commands  
64  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
When the interfaceis specified:.  
Term  
Definition  
Voice VLAN Interface Mode  
The admin mode of the Voice VLAN on the interface.  
The Voice VLAN ID  
Voice VLAN ID  
Voice VLAN Priority  
Voice VLAN Untagged  
Voice VLAN CoS Override  
Voice VLAN Status  
The do1p priority for the Voice VLAN on the port.  
The tagging option for the Voice VLAN traffic.  
The Override option for the voice traffic arriving on the port.  
The operational status of Voice VLAN on the port.  
Provisioning (IEEE 802.1p) Commands  
This section describes the commands you use to configure provisioning, which allows you to  
prioritize ports.  
vlan port priority all  
This command configures the port priority assigned for untagged packets for all ports  
presently plugged into the device. The range for the priority is 0-7. Any subsequent per port  
configuration will override this configuration setting.  
Format  
Mode  
vlan port priority all <priority>  
Global Config  
vlan priority  
This command configures the default 802.1p port priority assigned for untagged packets for a  
specific interface. The range for the priority is 0–7.  
Default  
0
Format  
Mode  
vlan priority <priority>  
Interface Config  
Protected Ports Commands  
This section describes commands you use to configure and view protected ports on a switch.  
Protected ports do not forward traffic to each other, even if they are on the same VLAN.  
However, protected ports can forward traffic to all unprotected ports in their group.  
Unprotected ports can forward traffic to both protected and unprotected ports. Ports are  
unprotected by default.  
Switching Commands  
65  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
If an interface is configured as a protected port, and you add that interface to a Port Channel  
or link aggregation group (LAG), the protected port status becomes operationally disabled on  
the interface, and the interface follows the configuration of the LAG port. However, the  
protected port configuration for the interface remains unchanged. Once the interface is no  
longer a member of a LAG, the current configuration for that interface automatically becomes  
effective.  
switchport protected (Global Config)  
Use this command to create a protected port group. The <groupid>parameter identifies the  
set of protected ports. Use the name <name>pair to assign a name to the protected port  
group. The name can be up to 32 alphanumeric characters long, including blanks. The  
default is blank.  
Note: Port protection occurs within a single switch. Protected port  
configuration does not affect traffic between ports on two different  
switches. No traffic forwarding is possible between two protected  
ports.  
Format  
Mode  
switchport protected <groupid> name <name>  
Global Config  
no switchport protected (Global Config)  
Use this command to remove a protected port group. The groupidparameter identifies the  
set of protected ports. Use the namekeyword to remove the name from the group.  
Format  
Mode  
NO switchport protected <groupid> name  
Global Config  
switchport protected (Interface Config)  
Use this command to add an interface to a protected port group. The <groupid>parameter  
identifies the set of protected ports to which this interface is assigned. You can only configure  
an interface as protected in one group.  
Note: Port protection occurs within a single switch. Protected port  
configuration does not affect traffic between ports on two different  
switches. No traffic forwarding is possible between two protected  
ports.  
Switching Commands  
66  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Default  
unprotected  
Format  
Mode  
switchport protected <groupid>  
Interface Config  
no switchport protected (Interface Config)  
Use this command to configure a port as unprotected. The groupidparameter identifies the  
set of protected ports to which this interface is assigned.  
Format  
Mode  
no switchport protected <groupid>  
Interface Config  
show switchport protected  
This command displays the status of all the interfaces, including protected and unprotected  
interfaces.  
Format  
Mode  
show switchport protected <groupid>  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Group ID  
The number that identifies the protected port group.  
Name  
An optional name of the protected port group. The name can be up to 32 alphanumeric  
characters long, including blanks. The default is blank.  
List of Physical  
Ports  
List of ports, which are configured as protected for the group identified with <groupid>. If  
no port is configured as protected for this group, this field is blank.  
show interfaces switchport  
This command displays the status of the interface (protected/unprotected) under the groupid.  
Format  
Mode  
show interfaces switchport <slot/port> <groupid>  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Name  
A string associated with this group as a convenience. It can be up to 32 alphanumeric  
characters long, including blanks. The default is blank. This field is optional.  
Protected port  
Indicates whether the interface is protected or not. It shows TRUE or FALSE. If the group  
is a multiple groups then, it shows TRUE in Group <groupid>.  
Switching Commands  
67  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Private VLAN  
The Private VLANs feature separates a regular VLAN domain into two or more subdomains.  
Each subdomain is defined (represented) by a primary VLAN and a secondary VLAN. The  
primary VLAN ID is the same for all subdomains that belong to a private VLAN. The  
secondary VLAN ID differentiates subdomains from each other and provides Layer 2 isolation  
between ports of the same private VLAN. The types of VLANs within a private VLAN are as  
follows:  
Primary VLAN—Forwards the traffic from the promiscuous ports to isolated ports,  
community ports, and other promiscuous ports in the same private VLAN. Only one  
primary VLAN can be configured per private VLAN. All ports within a private VLAN share  
primary VLAN.  
Isolated VLAN—A secondary VLAN that carries traffic from isolated ports to promiscuous  
ports. Only one isolated VLAN can be configured per private VLAN.  
Community VLAN—A secondary VLAN that forwards traffic between ports that belong to  
the same community and the promiscuous ports. There can be multiple community  
VLANs per private VLAN.  
Three types of port designations exist within a private VLAN:  
Promiscuous Ports—An endpoint connected to a promiscuous port is allowed to  
communicate with any endpoint within the private VLAN. Multiple promiscuous ports can  
be defined for a single private VLAN domain.  
Isolated Ports—An endpoint connected to an isolated port is allowed to communicate with  
endpoints connected to promiscuous ports only. Endpoints connected to adjacent  
isolated ports cannot communicate with each other.  
Community Ports—An endpoint connected to a community port is allowed to  
communicate with the endpoints within a community and with any configured  
promiscuous port. The endpoints that belong to one community cannot communicate with  
endpoints that belong to a different community or with endpoints connected to isolated  
ports.  
The Private VLANs can be extended across multiple switches through inter-switch/stack links  
that transport primary, community, and isolated VLANs between devices.  
switchport private-vlan  
This command is used to define a private-VLAN association for an isolated or community port  
or a mapping for a promiscuous port.  
Format  
switchport private-vlan {host-association <primary-vlan-id>  
<secondary-vlan-id> | mapping <primary-vlan-id> {add | remove}  
<secondary-vlan-list>}  
Mode  
Interface Config  
Switching Commands  
68  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
host-association  
Defines VLAN association for community or host ports.  
Defines the private VLAN mapping for promiscuous ports.  
Primary VLAN ID of a private VLAN.  
mapping  
primary-vlan-id  
secondary-vlan-id  
add  
Secondary (isolated or community) VLAN ID of a private VLAN.  
Associates the secondary VLAN with the primary one.  
Deletes the secondary VLANs from the primary VLAN association.  
A list of secondary VLANs to be mapped to a primary VLAN.  
remove  
secondary-vlan-list  
no switchport private-vlan  
This command is used to remove the private-VLAN association or mapping from the port.  
Format  
Mode  
no switchport private-vlan {host-association | mapping}  
Interface Config  
switchport mode private-vlan  
This command is used to configure a port as a promiscuous or host private VLAN port. Note  
that the properties of each mode can be configured even when the switch is not in that mode.  
However, they will only be applicable once the switch is in that particular mode.  
Format  
Mode  
switchport mode private-vlan {host | promiscuous}  
Interface Config  
General  
Default  
Term  
host  
Definition  
Configures an interface as a private VLAN host port. It can be either isolated or  
community port depending on the secondary VLAN it is associated with.  
promiscuous  
Configures an interface as a private VLAN promiscuous port. The promiscuous ports  
are members of the primary VLAN.  
no switchport mode  
This command is used to remove the private-VLAN association or mapping from the port.  
Format  
Mode  
no switchport mode private-vlan  
Interface Config  
Switching Commands  
69  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
private-vlan  
This command is used to configure the private VLANs and to configure the association  
between the primary private VLAN and secondary VLANs.  
Format  
private-vlan {association [add | remove] <secondary-vlan-list> |  
community | isolated | primary}  
Mode  
VLAN Config  
Term  
Definition  
association  
Associates the primary and secondary VLAN.  
secondary-vlan-list  
community  
isolated  
A list of secondary VLANs to be mapped to a primary VLAN.  
Designates a VLAN as a community VLAN.  
Designates a VLAN as the isolated VLAN.  
primary  
Designates a VLAN as the primary VLAN.  
no private-vlan  
This command is used to restore normal VLAN configuration.  
Format  
no private-vlan {association}  
Mode  
VLAN Config  
vlan  
Use this command to enter the private vlan configuration. The VLAN range is 1-4094.  
Format  
vlan <vlan-list>  
Mode  
Global Config  
show vlan  
This command displays information about the configured private VLANs including primary  
and secondary VLAN IDs, type (community, isolated, or primary) and the ports that belong to  
a private VLAN.  
Format  
Mode  
show vlan private-vlan [type]  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Switching Commands  
70  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Private -vlan  
Displays information about the configured private VLANs  
Displays only private VLAN ID and its type.  
Displays primary VLAN ID  
type  
Primary  
Secondary  
Type  
Displays secondary VLAN ID  
Displays secondary VLAN type  
Ports  
Displays ports which are associated with a private VLAN  
show interface ethernet <slot/port > switchport  
This command displays the private-VLAN mapping information for the switch interfaces.  
Format  
Mode  
show interface ethernet <slot/port> switchport  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Private-vlan host-association  
Private-vlan mapping  
Displays VLAN association for the private-VLAN host ports.  
Displays VLAN mapping for the private-VLAN promiscuous ports  
GARP Commands  
This section describes the commands you use to configure Generic Attribute Registration  
Protocol (GARP) and view GARP status. The commands in this section affect both GARP  
VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP) and Garp Multicast Registration Protocol (GMRP).  
GARP is a protocol that allows client stations to register with the switch for membership in  
VLANS (by using GVMP) or multicast groups (by using GVMP).  
set garp timer join  
This command sets the GVRP join time for one port (Interface Config mode) or all (Global  
Config mode) and per GARP. Join time is the interval between the transmission of GARP  
Protocol Data Units (PDUs) registering (or re-registering) membership for a VLAN or  
multicast group. This command has an effect only when GVRP is enabled. The time is from  
10 to 100 (centiseconds). The value 20 centiseconds is 0.2 seconds.  
Default  
20  
Format  
Mode  
set garp timer join <10-100>  
• Interface Config  
• Global Config  
Switching Commands  
71  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no set garp timer join  
This command sets the GVRP join time (for one or all ports and per GARP) to the default and  
only has an effect when GVRP is enabled.  
Format  
Mode  
no set garp timer join  
• Interface Config  
• Global Config  
set garp timer leave  
This command sets the GVRP leave time for one port (Interface Config mode) or all ports  
(Global Config mode) and only has an effect when GVRP is enabled. Leave time is the time  
to wait after receiving an unregister request for a VLAN or a multicast group before deleting  
the VLAN entry. This can be considered a buffer time for another station to assert registration  
for the same attribute in order to maintain uninterrupted service. The leave time is 20–600  
(centiseconds). The value 60 centiseconds is 0.6 seconds.  
Default  
60  
Format  
Mode  
set garp timer leave <20-600>  
• Interface Config  
• Global Config  
no set garp timer leave  
This command sets the GVRP leave time on all ports or a single port to the default and only  
has an effect when GVRP is enabled.  
Format  
Mode  
no set garp timer leave  
• Interface Config  
• Global Config  
set garp timer leaveall  
This command sets how frequently Leave All PDUs are generated. A Leave All PDU  
indicates that all registrations will be unregistered. Participants would need to rejoin in order  
to maintain registration. The value applies per port and per GARP participation. The time may  
range from 200 to 6000 (centiseconds). The value 1000 centiseconds is 10 seconds. You  
can use this command on all ports (Global Config mode) or a single port (Interface Config  
mode), and it only has an effect only when GVRP is enabled.  
Default  
1000  
Format  
Mode  
set garp timer leaveall <200-6000>  
• Interface Config  
• Global Config  
Switching Commands  
72  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no set garp timer leaveall  
This command sets how frequently Leave All PDUs are generated the default and only has  
an effect when GVRP is enabled.  
Format  
no set garp timer leaveall  
Mode  
• Interface Config  
• Global Config  
show garp  
This command displays GARP information.  
Format  
show garp  
Mode  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
GMRP Admin Mode  
GVRP Admin Mode  
The administrative mode of GARP Multicast Registration Protocol (GMRP) for the  
system.  
The administrative mode of GARP VLAN Registration Protocol (GVRP) for the  
system.  
GVRP Commands  
This section describes the commands you use to configure and view GARP VLAN  
Registration Protocol (GVRP) information. GVRP-enabled switches exchange VLAN  
configuration information, which allows GVRP to provide dynamic VLAN creation on trunk  
ports and automatic VLAN pruning.  
Note: If GVRP is disabled, the system does not forward GVRP messages.  
set gvrp adminmode  
This command enables GVRP on the system.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
set gvrp adminmode  
Privileged EXEC  
Switching Commands  
73  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no set gvrp adminmode  
This command disables GVRP.  
Format  
Mode  
no set gvrp adminmode  
Privileged EXEC  
set gvrp interfacemode  
This command enables GVRP on a single port (Interface Config mode) or all ports (Global  
Config mode).  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
set gvrp interfacemode  
• Interface Config  
• Global Config  
no set gvrp interfacemode  
This command disables GVRP on a single port (Interface Config mode) or all ports (Global  
Config mode). If GVRP is disabled, Join Time, Leave Time, and Leave All Time have no  
effect.  
Format  
Mode  
no set gvrp interfacemode  
• Interface Config  
• Global Config  
show gvrp configuration  
This command displays Generic Attributes Registration Protocol (GARP) information for one  
or all interfaces.  
Format  
Mode  
show gvrp configuration {<slot/port> | all}  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Interface  
Valid slot and port number separated by forward slashes.  
Join Timer  
The interval between the transmission of GARP PDUs registering (or re-registering)  
membership for an attribute. Current attributes are a VLAN or multicast group. There is  
an instance of this timer on a per-Port, per-GARP participant basis. Permissible values  
are 10–100 centiseconds (0.1 to 1.0 seconds). The factory default is 20 centiseconds  
(0.2 seconds). The finest granularity of specification is one centisecond (0.01 seconds).  
Switching Commands  
74  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Leave Timer  
The period of time to wait after receiving an unregister request for an attribute before  
deleting the attribute. Current attributes are a VLAN or multicast group. This may be  
considered a buffer time for another station to assert registration for the same attribute in  
order to maintain uninterrupted service. There is an instance of this timer on a per-Port,  
per-GARP participant basis. Permissible values are 20–600 centiseconds (0.2 to 6.0  
seconds). The factory default is 60 centiseconds (0.6 seconds).  
LeaveAll Timer  
This Leave All Time controls how frequently LeaveAll PDUs are generated. A LeaveAll  
PDU indicates that all registrations will shortly be deregistered. Participants will need to  
rejoin in order to maintain registration. There is an instance of this timer on a per-Port,  
per-GARP participant basis. The Leave All Period Timer is set to a random value in the  
range of LeaveAllTime to 1.5*LeaveAllTime. Permissible values are 200–6000  
centiseconds (2–60 seconds). The factory default is 1000 centiseconds (10 seconds).  
Port GVMRP  
Mode  
The GVRP administrative mode for the port, which is enabled or disabled (default). If this  
parameter is disabled, Join Time, Leave Time, and Leave All Time have no effect.  
GMRP Commands  
This section describes the commands you use to configure and view GARP Multicast  
Registration Protocol (GMRP) information. Like IGMP snooping, GMRP helps control the  
flooding of multicast packets. GMRP-enabled switches dynamically register and deregister  
group membership information with the MAC networking devices attached to the same  
segment. GMRP also allows group membership information to propagate across all  
networking devices in the bridged LAN that support Extended Filtering Services.  
Note: If GMRP is disabled, the system does not forward GMRP  
messages.  
set gmrp adminmode  
This command enables GARP Multicast Registration Protocol (GMRP) on the system.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
set gmrp adminmode  
Privileged EXEC  
no set gmrp adminmode  
This command disables GARP Multicast Registration Protocol (GMRP) on the system.  
Format  
Mode  
no set gmrp adminmode  
Privileged EXEC  
Switching Commands  
75  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
set gmrp interfacemode  
This command enables GARP Multicast Registration Protocol on a single interface (Interface  
Config mode) or all interfaces (Global Config mode). If an interface which has GARP enabled  
is enabled for routing or is enlisted as a member of a port-channel (LAG), GARP functionality  
is disabled on that interface. GARP functionality is subsequently re-enabled if routing is  
disabled and port-channel (LAG) membership is removed from an interface that has GARP  
enabled.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
set gmrp interfacemode  
• Interface Config  
• Global Config  
no set gmrp interfacemode  
This command disables GARP Multicast Registration Protocol on a single interface or all  
interfaces. If an interface which has GARP enabled is enabled for routing or is enlisted as a  
member of a port-channel (LAG), GARP functionality is disabled. GARP functionality is  
subsequently re-enabled if routing is disabled and port-channel (LAG) membership is  
removed from an interface that has GARP enabled.  
Format  
Mode  
no set gmrp interfacemode  
• Interface Config  
• Global Config  
show gmrp configuration  
This command displays Generic Attributes Registration Protocol (GARP) information for one  
or all interfaces.  
Format  
Mode  
show gmrp configuration {<slot/port> | all}  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Interface  
The slot/port of the interface that this row in the table describes.  
Join Timer  
The interval between the transmission of GARP PDUs registering (or re-registering)  
membership for an attribute. Current attributes are a VLAN or multicast group. There is  
an instance of this timer on a per-Port, per-GARP participant basis. Permissible values  
are 10–100 centiseconds (0.1 to 1.0 seconds). The factory default is 20 centiseconds  
(0.2 seconds). The finest granularity of specification is 1 centisecond (0.01 seconds).  
Switching Commands  
76  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Leave Timer  
The period of time to wait after receiving an unregister request for an attribute before  
deleting the attribute. Current attributes are a VLAN or multicast group. This may be  
considered a buffer time for another station to assert registration for the same attribute in  
order to maintain uninterrupted service. There is an instance of this timer on a per-Port,  
per-GARP participant basis. Permissible values are 20–600 centiseconds (0.2 to 6.0  
seconds). The factory default is 60 centiseconds (0.6 seconds).  
LeaveAll Timer  
This Leave All Time controls how frequently LeaveAll PDUs are generated. A LeaveAll  
PDU indicates that all registrations will shortly be deregistered. Participants will need to  
rejoin in order to maintain registration. There is an instance of this timer on a per-Port,  
per-GARP participant basis. The Leave All Period Timer is set to a random value in the  
range of LeaveAllTime to 1.5*LeaveAllTime. Permissible values are 200–6000  
centiseconds (2–60 seconds). The factory default is 1000 centiseconds (10 seconds).  
Port GMRP  
Mode  
The GMRP administrative mode for the port. It may be enabled or disabled. If this  
parameter is disabled, Join Time, Leave Time, and Leave All Time have no effect.  
show mac-address-table gmrp  
This command displays the GMRP entries in the Multicast Forwarding Database (MFDB)  
table.  
Format  
Mode  
show mac-address-table gmrp  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Mac Address  
A unicast MAC address for which the switch has forwarding and or filtering information.  
The format is 6 or 8 two-digit hexadecimal numbers that are separated by colons, for  
example 01:23:45:67:89:AB. In an IVL system the MAC address is displayed as 8 bytes.  
Type  
The type of the entry. Static entries are those that are configured by the end user.  
Dynamic entries are added to the table as a result of a learning process or protocol.  
Description  
Interfaces  
The text description of this multicast table entry.  
The list of interfaces that are designated for forwarding (Fwd:) and filtering (Flt:).  
Port-Based Network Access Control Commands  
This section describes the commands you use to configure port-based network access  
control (802.1x). Port-based network access control allows you to permit access to network  
services only to and devices that are authorized and authenticated.  
Switching Commands  
77  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
clear dot1x statistics  
This command resets the 802.1x statistics for the specified port or for all ports.  
Format  
Mode  
clear dot1x statistics{<slot/port> | all}  
Privileged EXEC  
clear radius statistics  
This command is used to clear all RADIUS statistics.  
Format  
Mode  
clear radius statistics  
Privileged EXEC  
dot1x eapolflood  
Use this command to enable EAPOL flood support on the switch.  
Format  
dot1x eapolflood  
Mode  
Global Config  
Default  
Disabled  
no dot1x eapolflood  
This command disables EAPOL flooding on the switch.  
Format  
Mode  
no dot1x eapolflood  
Global Config  
dot1x guest-vlan  
This command configures VLAN as guest vlan on a per port basis. The command specifies  
an active VLAN as an IEEE 802.1x guest VLAN. The range is 1 to the maximum VLAN ID  
supported by the platform.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
dot1x guest-vlan <vlan-id>  
Interface Config  
Switching Commands  
78  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no dot1x guest-vlan  
This command disables Guest VLAN on the interface.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
no dot1x guest-vlan  
Interface Config  
dot1x initialize  
This command begins the initialization sequence on the specified port. This command is only  
valid if the control mode for the specified port is “auto” or “mac-based”. If the control mode is  
not 'auto' or “mac-based”, an error will be returned.  
Format  
Mode  
dot1x initialize<slot/port>  
Privileged EXEC  
dot1x mac-auth-bypass  
This command enables MAC-Based Authentication Bypass (MAB) for 802.1x-unaware  
clients. MAB provides 802.1x-unaware clients controlled access to the network using the  
devices’ MAC address as an identifier. This requires that the known and allowable MAC  
address and corresponding access rights be pre-populated in the authentication server. MAB  
works only when the port control mode of the port is MAC-based.  
Format  
Mode  
dot1x mac-auth-bypass  
Interface Config  
no dot1x mac-auth-bypass  
This command disables MAB for 802.1x-unaware clients.  
Format  
Mode  
no dot1x mac-auth-bypass  
Interface Config  
dot1x max-req  
This command sets the maximum number of times the authenticator state machine on this  
port will transmit an EAPOL EAP Request/Identity frame before timing out the supplicant.  
The <count>value must be in the range 1 - 10.  
Default  
2
Format  
Mode  
dot1x max-req<count>  
Interface Config  
Switching Commands  
79  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no dot1x max-req  
This command sets the maximum number of times the authenticator state machine on this  
port will transmit an EAPOL EAP Request/Identity frame before timing out the supplicant.  
Format  
Mode  
no dot1x max-req  
Interface Config  
dot1x max-users  
Use this command to set the maximum number of clients supported on the port when  
MAC-based dot1x authentication is enabled on the port. The maximum users supported per  
port is dependent on the product. The <count>value is in the range 1 - 48.  
Default  
48  
Format  
Mode  
dot1x max-users<count>  
Interface Config  
no dot1x max-users  
This command resets the maximum number of clients allowed per port to its default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no dot1x max-req  
Interface Config  
dot1x port-control  
This command sets the authentication mode to use on the specified port. Select  
force-unauthorizedto specify that the authenticator PAE unconditionally sets the  
controlled port to unauthorized. Select force-authorizedto specify that the authenticator  
PAE unconditionally sets the controlled port to authorized. Select autoto specify that the  
authenticator PAE sets the controlled port mode to reflect the outcome of the authentication  
exchanges between the supplicant, authenticator, and the authentication server. If the  
mac-basedoption is specified, MAC-based dot1x authentication is enabled on the port.  
Default  
auto  
Format  
Mode  
dot1x port-control {force-unauthorized | force-authorized | auto |  
mac-based}  
Interface Config  
Switching Commands  
80  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no dot1x port-control  
This command sets the 802.1x port control mode on the specified port to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no dot1x port-control  
Interface Config  
dot1x port-control all  
This command sets the authentication mode to use on all ports. Select  
force-unauthorizedto specify that the authenticator PAE unconditionally sets the  
controlled port to unauthorized. Select force-authorizedto specify that the authenticator  
PAE unconditionally sets the controlled port to authorized. Select autoto specify that the  
authenticator PAE sets the controlled port mode to reflect the outcome of the authentication  
exchanges between the supplicant, authenticator, and the authentication server. If the  
mac-basedoption is specified, MAC-based dot1x authentication is enabled on the port.  
Default  
auto  
Format  
Mode  
dot1x port-control all {force-unauthorized | force-authorized | auto  
| mac-based}  
Global Config  
no dot1x port-control all  
This command sets the authentication mode on all ports to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no dot1x port-control all  
Global Config  
dot1x re-authenticate  
This command begins the re-authentication sequence on the specified port. This command is  
only valid if the control mode for the specified port is “auto” or “mac-based”. If the control  
mode is not “auto” or “mac-based”, an error will be returned.  
Format  
Mode  
dot1x re-authenticate <slot/port>  
Privileged EXEC  
dot1x re-authentication  
This command enables re-authentication of the supplicant for the specified port.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
dot1x re-authentication  
Interface Config  
Switching Commands  
81  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no dot1x re-authentication  
This command disables re-authentication of the supplicant for the specified port.  
Format  
Mode  
no dot1x re-authentication  
Interface Config  
dot1x system-auth-control  
Use this command to enable the dot1x authentication support on the switch. While disabled,  
the dot1x configuration is retained and can be changed, but is not activated.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
dot1x system-auth-control  
Global Config  
no dot1x system-auth-control  
This command is used to disable the dot1x authentication support on the switch.  
Format  
Mode  
no dot1x system-auth-control  
Global Config  
dot1x timeout  
This command sets the value, in seconds, of the timer used by the authenticator state  
machine on this port. Depending on the token used and the value (in seconds) passed,  
various timeout configurable parameters are set. The following tokens are supported:  
Tokens  
Definition  
guest-vlan-period  
The time, in seconds, for which the authenticator waits to see if any EAPOL packets are  
received on a port before authorizing the port and placing the port in the guest vlan (if  
configured). The guest vlan timer is only relevant when guest vlan has been configured  
on that specific port.  
reauth-period  
quiet-period  
tx-period  
The value, in seconds, of the timer used by the authenticator state machine on this port  
to determine when re-authentication of the supplicant takes place. The reauth-period  
must be a value in the range 1 - 65535.  
The value, in seconds, of the timer used by the authenticator state machine on this port  
to define periods of time in which it will not attempt to acquire a supplicant. The  
quiet-period must be a value in the range 0 - 65535.  
The value, in seconds, of the timer used by the authenticator state machine on this port  
to determine when to send an EAPOL EAP Request/Identity frame to the supplicant. The  
quiet-period must be a value in the range 1 - 65535.  
Switching Commands  
82  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Tokens  
Definition  
supp-timeout  
The value, in seconds, of the timer used by the authenticator state machine on this port  
to timeout the supplicant. The supp-timeout must be a value in the range 1 - 65535.  
server-timeout  
The value, in seconds, of the timer used by the authenticator state machine on this port  
to timeout the authentication server. The supp-timeout must be a value in the range 1 -  
65535.  
Default  
• guest-vlan-period: 90 seconds  
• reauth-period: 3600 seconds  
• quiet-period: 60 seconds  
• tx-period: 30 seconds  
• supp-timeout: 30 seconds  
• server-timeout: 30 seconds  
Format  
Mode  
dot1x timeout {{guest-vlan-period <seconds>} |{reauth-period  
<seconds>} | {quiet-period <seconds>} | {tx-period <seconds>} |  
{supp-timeout <seconds>} | {server-timeout <seconds>}}  
Interface Config  
no dot1x timeout  
This command sets the value, in seconds, of the timer used by the authenticator state  
machine on this port to the default values. Depending on the token used, the corresponding  
default values are set.  
Format  
Mode  
no dot1x timeout {guest-vlan-period | reauth-period | quiet-period |  
tx-period | supp-timeout | server-timeout}  
Interface Config  
dot1x unauthenticated-vlan  
Use this command to configure the unauthenticated VLAN associated with that port. The  
unauthenticated VLAN ID can be a valid VLAN ID from 0-Maximum supported VLAN ID  
(4093 for 7000 series). The unauthenticated VLAN must be statically configured in the VLAN  
database to be operational. By default, the unauthenticated VLAN is 0, i.e. invalid and not  
operational.  
Default  
0
Format  
Mode  
dot1x unauthenticated-vlan <vlan id>  
Interface Config  
Switching Commands  
83  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no dot1x unauthenticated-vlan  
This command resets the unauthenticated-vlan associated with the port to its default value.  
Format  
no dot1x unauthenticated-vlan  
Mode  
Interface Config  
dot1x user  
This command adds the specified user to the list of users with access to the specified port or  
all ports. The <user>parameter must be a configured user.  
Format  
Mode  
dot1x user <user> {<slot/port> | all}  
Global Config  
no dot1x user  
This command removes the user from the list of users with access to the specified port or all  
ports.  
Format  
Mode  
no dot1x user <user> {<slot/port> | all}  
Global Config  
clear dot1x authentication-history  
This command clears the authentication history table captured during successful and  
unsuccessful authentication on all interface or the specified interface.  
Format  
Mode  
clear dot1x authentication-history [slot/port]  
Global Config  
dot1x dynamic-vlan enable  
Use this command to enable the switch to create VLANs dynamically when a RADIUS  
assigned VLAN does not exist in the switch.  
Format  
Mode  
dot1x dynamic-vlan enable  
Global Config  
Default  
Disabled  
Switching Commands  
84  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no dot1x dynamic-vlan enable  
Use this command to disable the switch from creating VLANs dynamically when a RADIUS  
assigned VLAN does not exist in the switch.  
Format  
Mode  
no dot1x dynamic-vlan enable  
Global Config  
dot1x system-auth-control monitor  
Use this command to enable the 802.1X monitor mode on the switch. The purpose of Monitor  
mode is to help troubleshoot port-based authentication configuration issues without  
disrupting network access for hosts connected to the switch. In Monitor mode, a host is  
granted network access to an 802.1X-enabled port even if it fails the authentication process.  
The results of the process are logged for diagnostic purposes.  
Format  
Mode  
dot1x system-auth-control monitor  
Global Config  
Disabled  
Default  
no dot1x system-auth-control monitor  
Use this command to disable the 802.1X monitor on the switch.  
Format  
Mode  
no dot1x system-auth-control monitor  
Global Config  
show dot1x authentication-history  
This command displays 802.1X authentication events and information during successful and  
unsuccessful Dot1x authentication process for all interfaces or the specified interface. Use  
the optional keywords to display only failure authentication events in summary or in detail.  
Format  
Mode  
show dot1x authentication-history {slot/port | all} [failedauth-only]  
[detail]  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Time Stamp  
The exact time at which the event occurs.  
Physical Port on which the event occurs.  
The supplicant/client MAC address.  
Interface  
Mac-Address  
VLAN assigned  
The VLAN assigned to the client/port on authentication.  
Switching Commands  
85  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
VLAN assigned  
Reason  
The type of VLAN ID assigned, which can be Guest VLAN, Unauth, Default, RADIUS  
Assigned, or Monitor Mode VLAN ID.  
Auth Status  
Reason  
The authentication status.  
The actual reason behind the successful or failed authentication.  
show authentication methods  
This command displays information about the authentication methods.  
Format  
Mode  
show authentication methods  
Privileged EXEC  
The following is an example of this command:  
Login Authentication Method Lists  
________________________________  
Console_Default: None  
Network_Default:Local  
Enable Authentication Lists  
_____________________  
Console_Default: Enable None  
Network_Default:Enable  
Line Login Method List Enable Method Lists  
_____________________  
Console Console_Default Console_Default  
Telnet Network_Default Network_Default  
SSH Network_Default Network_Default  
http : Local  
https : Local  
dot1x :  
show dot1x  
This command is used to show a summary of the global dot1x configuration, summary  
information of the dot1x configuration for a specified port or all ports, the detailed dot1x  
configuration for a specified port and the dot1x statistics for a specified port - depending on  
the tokens used.  
Format  
Mode  
show dot1x[{summary {<slot/port> | all} | detail <slot/port> |  
statistics <slot/port>]  
Privileged EXEC  
Switching Commands  
86  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
If you do not use the optional parameters <slot/port>or <vlanid>, the command  
displays the global dot1x mode, the VLAN Assignment mode, and the Dynamic VLAN  
Creation mode.  
Term  
Definition  
Administrative  
Mode  
Indicates whether authentication control on the switch is enabled or disabled.  
VLAN  
Assignment  
Mode  
Indicates whether assignment of an authorized port to a RADIUS assigned VLAN is  
allowed (enabled) or not (disabled).  
Dynamic VLAN  
Creation Mode  
Indicates whether the switch can dynamically create a RADIUS-assigned VLAN if it does  
not currently exist on the switch.  
Monitor Mode  
Indicates whether the Dot1x Monitor mode on the switch is enabled or disabled.  
If you use the optional parameter summary {<slot/port> | all}, the dot1x  
configuration for the specified port or all ports are displayed.  
Term  
Definition  
Interface  
The interface whose configuration is displayed.  
Control Mode  
The configured control mode for this port. Possible values are force-unauthorized |  
force-authorized | auto | mac-based | authorized | unauthorized.  
Operating  
Control Mode  
The control mode under which this port is operating. Possible values are authorized |  
unauthorized.  
Reauthenticatio  
n Enabled  
Indicates whether re-authentication is enabled on this port.  
Port Status  
Indicates whether the port is authorized or unauthorized. Possible values are authorized  
| unauthorized.  
If you use the optional parameter 'detail<slot/port>', the detailed dot1x configuration  
for the specified port is displayed.  
Term  
Definition  
Port  
The interface whose configuration is displayed.  
Protocol Version  
The protocol version associated with this port. The only possible value is 1,  
corresponding to the first version of the dot1x specification.  
PAE Capabilities  
Control Mode  
The port access entity (PAE) functionality of this port. Possible values are Authenticator  
or Supplicant.  
The configured control mode for this port. Possible values are force-unauthorized |  
force-authorized | auto | mac-based.  
Authenticator  
PAE State  
Current state of the authenticator PAE state machine. Possible values are Initialize,  
Disconnected, Connecting, Authenticating, Authenticated, Aborting, Held,  
ForceAuthorized, and ForceUnauthorized. When MAC-based authentication is enabled  
on the port, this parameter is deprecated.  
Switching Commands  
87  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Backend  
Authentication  
State  
Current state of the backend authentication state machine. Possible values are  
Request, Response, Success, Fail, Timeout, Idle, and Initialize. When MAC-based  
authentication is enabled on the port, this parameter is deprecated.  
Quiet Period  
The timer used by the authenticator state machine on this port to define periods of time  
in which it will not attempt to acquire a supplicant. The value is expressed in seconds  
and will be in the range 0 and 65535.  
Transmit Period  
The timer used by the authenticator state machine on the specified port to determine  
when to send an EAPOL EAP Request/Identity frame to the supplicant. The value is  
expressed in seconds and will be in the range of 1 and 65535.  
Guest-VLAN ID  
The guest VLAN identifier configured on the interface.  
Guest VLAN  
Period  
The time in seconds for which the authenticator waits before authorizing and placing the  
port in the Guest VLAN, if no EAPOL packets are detected on that port.  
Supplicant  
Timeout  
The timer used by the authenticator state machine on this port to timeout the supplicant.  
The value is expressed in seconds and will be in the range of 1 and 65535.  
Server Timeout  
The timer used by the authenticator on this port to timeout the authentication server.  
The value is expressed in seconds and will be in the range of 1 and 65535.  
Maximum  
Requests  
The maximum number of times the authenticator state machine on this port will  
retransmit an EAPOL EAP Request/Identity before timing out the supplicant. The value  
will be in the range of 1 and 10.  
VLAN Id  
The VLAN assigned to the port by the radius server. This is only valid when the port  
control mode is not Mac-based.  
VLAN Assigned  
Reason  
The reason the VLAN identified in the VLAN Idfield has been assigned to the port.  
Possible values are RADIUS, Unauthenticated VLAN, Guest VLAN, default, and Not  
Assigned. When the VLAN Assigned Reason is ‘Not Assigned’, it means that the port  
has not been assigned to any VLAN by dot1x. This only valid when the port control  
mode is not MAC-based.  
Reauthentication  
Period  
The timer used by the authenticator state machine on this port to determine when  
reauthentication of the supplicant takes place. The value is expressed in seconds and  
will be in the range of 1 and 65535.  
Reauthentication  
Enabled  
Indicates if reauthentication is enabled on this port. Possible values are ‘True” or  
“False”.  
Key  
Transmission  
Enabled  
Indicates if the key is transmitted to the supplicant for the specified port. Possible values  
are True or False.  
Control Direction  
Maximum Users  
The control direction for the specified port or ports. Possible values are both or in.  
The maximum number of clients that can get authenticated on the port in the  
MAC-based dot1x authentication mode. This value is used only when the port control  
mode is not MAC-based.  
Unauthenticated  
VLAN ID  
Indicates the unauthenticated VLAN configured for this port. This value is valid for the  
port only when the port control mode is not MAC-based.  
Switching Commands  
88  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Session Timeout  
Indicates the time for which the given session is valid. The time period in seconds is  
returned by the RADIUS server on authentication of the port. This value is valid for the  
port only when the port control mode is not MAC-based.  
Session  
Termination  
Action  
This value indicates the action to be taken once the session timeout expires. Possible  
values are Default, Radius-Request. If the value is Default, the session is terminated  
the port goes into unauthorized state. If the value is Radius-Request, a reauthentication  
of the client authenticated on the port is performed. This value is valid for the port only  
when the port control mode is not MAC-based.  
The show dot1x detail <slot/port>command will display the following MAC-based  
dot1x fields if the port-control mode for that specific port is MAC-based. For each client  
authenticated on the port, the show dot1x detail <slot/port>command will display the  
following MAC-based dot1x parameters if the port-control mode for that specific port is  
MAC-based.  
Term  
Definition  
Supplicant  
MAC-Address  
The MAC-address of the supplicant.  
Authenticator  
PAE State  
Current state of the authenticator PAE state machine. Possible values are Initialize,  
Disconnected, Connecting, Authenticating, Authenticated, Aborting, Held,  
ForceAuthorized, and ForceUnauthorized.  
Backend  
Authentication  
State  
Current state of the backend authentication state machine. Possible values are Request,  
Response, Success, Fail, Timeout, Idle, and Initialize.  
VLAN-Assigned  
Logical Port  
The VLAN assigned to the client by the radius server.  
The logical port number associated with the client.  
If you use the optional parameter statistics<slot/port>, the following dot1x statistics  
for the specified port appear.  
Term  
Definition  
Port  
The interface whose statistics are displayed.  
EAPOL Frames  
Received  
The number of valid EAPOL frames of any type that have been received by this  
authenticator.  
EAPOL Frames  
Transmitted  
The number of EAPOL frames of any type that have been transmitted by this  
authenticator.  
EAPOL Start  
Frames  
Received  
The number of EAPOL start frames that have been received by this authenticator.  
The number of EAPOL logoff frames that have been received by this authenticator.  
The protocol version number carried in the most recently received EAPOL frame.  
EAPOL Logoff  
Frames  
Received  
Last EAPOL  
Frame Version  
Switching Commands  
89  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Last EAPOL  
Frame Source  
The source MAC address carried in the most recently received EAPOL frame.  
EAP  
Response/Id  
Frames  
The number of EAP response/identity frames that have been received by this  
authenticator.  
Received  
EAP Response  
Frames  
Received  
The number of valid EAP response frames (other than resp/id frames) that have been  
received by this authenticator.  
EAP Request/Id  
Frames  
Transmitted  
The number of EAP request/identity frames that have been transmitted by this  
authenticator.  
EAP Request  
Frames  
Transmitted  
The number of EAP request frames (other than request/identity frames) that have been  
transmitted by this authenticator.  
Invalid EAPOL  
Frames  
Received  
The number of EAPOL frames that have been received by this authenticator in which the  
frame type is not recognized.  
EAP Length  
Error Frames  
Received  
The number of EAPOL frames that have been received by this authenticator in which the  
frame type is not recognized.  
show dot1x clients  
This command displays 802.1x client information. This command also displays information  
about the number of clients that are authenticated using Monitor mode and using 802.1X.  
Format  
Mode  
show dot1x clients {<slot/port> | all}  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Clients  
Indicates the number of the Dot1x clients authenticated using Monitor mode.  
Authenticated  
using Monitor  
Mode  
Clients  
Authenticated  
using Dot1x  
Indicates the number of Dot1x clients authenticated using 802.1x authentication process.  
The logical port number associated with a client.  
Logical  
Interface  
Interface  
The physical port to which the supplicant is associated.  
User Name  
The user name used by the client to authenticate to the server.  
SupplicantMAC  
Address  
The supplicant device MAC address.  
Session Time  
The time since the supplicant is logged on.  
Switching Commands  
90  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Filter ID  
Identifies the Filter ID returned by the RADIUS server when the client was authenticated.  
This is a configured DiffServ policy name on the switch.  
VLAN ID  
The VLAN assigned to the port.  
VLAN Assigned  
The reason the VLAN identified in the VLAN ID field has been assigned to the port.  
Possible values are RADIUS, Unauthenticated VLAN, or Default. When the VLAN  
Assigned reason is Default, it means that the VLAN was assigned to the port because  
the PVID of the port was that VLAN ID.  
Session  
Timeout  
This value indicates the time for which the given session is valid. The time period in  
seconds is returned by the RADIUS server on authentication of the port. This value is  
valid for the port only when the port-control mode is not MAC-based.  
Session  
Termination  
Action  
This value indicates the action to be taken once the session timeout expires. Possible  
values are Default and Radius-Request. If the value is Default, the session is terminated  
and client details are cleared. If the value is Radius-Request, a reauthentication of the  
client is performed.  
show dot1x users  
This command displays 802.1x port security user information for locally configured users.  
Format  
Mode  
show dot1x users<slot/port>  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Users  
Users configured locally to have access to the specified port.  
802.1X Supplicant Commands  
802.1X (“dot1x”) supplicant functionality is on point-to-point ports. The administrator can  
configure the user name and password used in authentication and capabilities of the  
supplicant port.  
dot1x pae  
Use this command to set the port’s dot1x role. The port can serve as either a supplicant or an  
authenticator.  
Format  
Mode  
dot1x pae {supplicant | authenticator}  
Interface Config  
Switching Commands  
91  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
dot1x supplicant port-control  
Use this command to set the ports authorization state (Authorized or Unauthorized) either  
manually or by setting the port to auto-authorize upon startup. By default all the ports are  
authenticators. If the port’s attribute needs to be moved from <authenticator to supplicant> or  
<supplicant to authenticator>, use this command.  
Format  
dot1x supplicant port-control {auto | force-authorized |  
force_unauthorized}  
Mode  
Interface Config  
Term  
auto  
Description  
The port is in the Unauthorized state until it presents its user name and password  
credentials to an authenticator. If the authenticator authorizes the port, then it is placed  
in the Authorized state.  
force-authorized  
Sets the authorization state of the port to Authorized, bypassing the authentication  
process.  
force-  
unauthorized  
Sets the authorization state of the port to Unauthorized, bypassing the authentication  
process.  
no dot1x supplicant port-control  
Use this command to set the port-control mode to the default, auto.  
Default  
Auto  
Format  
Mode  
no dot1x supplicant port-control  
Interface Config  
dot1x supplicant max-start  
Use this command to configure the number of attempts that the supplicant makes to find the  
authenticator before the supplicant assumes that there is no authenticator.  
Default  
3
Format  
Mode  
dot1x supplicant max-start <1-10>  
Interface Config  
no dot1x supplicant max-start  
Use this command to set the max-start value to the default.  
Format  
Mode  
no dot1x supplicant max-start  
Interface Config  
Switching Commands  
92  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
dot1x supplicant timeout start-period  
Use this command to configure the start period timer interval to wait for the EAP identity  
request from the authenticator.  
Default  
30 seconds  
Format  
Mode  
dot1x supplicant timeout start-period <1-65535 seconds>  
Interface Config  
no dot1x supplicant timeout start-period  
Use this command to set the start-period value to the default.  
Format  
Mode  
no dot1x supplicant timeout start-period  
Interface Config  
dot1x supplicant timeout held-period  
Use this command to configure the held period timer interval to wait for the next  
authentication on previous authentication fail.  
Default  
30 seconds  
Format  
Mode  
dot1x supplicant timeout held-period <1-65535 seconds>  
Interface Config  
no dot1x supplicant timeout held-period  
Use this command to set the held-period value to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no dot1x supplicant timeout held-period  
Interface Config  
dot1x supplicant timeout auth-period  
Use this command to configure the authentication period timer interval to wait for the next  
EAP request challenge from the authenticator.  
Default  
30 seconds  
Format  
Mode  
dot1x supplicant timeout auth-period <1-65535 seconds>  
Interface Config  
Switching Commands  
93  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no dot1x supplicant timeout auth-period  
Use this command to set the auth-period value to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no dot1x supplicant timeout auth-period  
Interface Config  
dot1x supplicant user  
Use this command to map the given user to the port.  
Format  
Mode  
dot1x supplicant user  
Interface Config  
Storm-Control Commands  
This section describes commands you use to configure storm-control and view storm-control  
configuration information. A traffic storm is a condition that occurs when incoming packets  
flood the LAN, which creates performance degradation in the network. The Storm-Control  
feature protects against this condition.  
The 7000 series provides broadcast, multicast, and unicast story recovery for individual  
interfaces. Unicast Storm-Control protects against traffic whose MAC addresses are not  
known by the system. For broadcast, multicast, and unicast storm-control, if the rate of traffic  
ingressing on an interface increases beyond the configured threshold for that type, the traffic  
is dropped.  
To configure storm-control, you will enable the feature for all interfaces or for individual  
interfaces, and you will set the threshold (storm-control level) beyond which the broadcast,  
multicast, or unicast traffic will be dropped. The Storm-Control feature allows you to limit the  
rate of specific types of packets through the switch on a per-port, per-type, basis.  
Configuring a storm-control level also enables that form of storm-control. Disabling a  
storm-control level (using the “no” version of the command) sets the storm-control level back  
to the default value and disables that form of storm-control. Using the “no” version of the  
“storm-control” command (not stating a “level”) disables that form of storm-control but  
maintains the configured “level” (to be active the next time that form of storm-control is  
enabled.)  
Note: The actual rate of ingress traffic required to activate storm-control is  
based on the size of incoming packets and the hard-coded average  
packet size of 512 bytes - used to calculate a packet-per-second  
(pps) rate - as the forwarding-plane requires pps versus an absolute  
Switching Commands  
94  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
rate kbps. For example, if the configured limit is 10%, this is  
converted to ~25000 pps, and this pps limit is set in forwarding plane  
(hardware). You get the approximate desired output when 512bytes  
packets are used.  
storm-control broadcast  
Use this command to enable broadcast storm recovery mode for a specific interface. If the  
mode is enabled, broadcast storm recovery is active and, if the rate of L2 broadcast traffic  
ingressing on an interface increases beyond the configured threshold, the traffic will be  
dropped. Therefore, the rate of broadcast traffic will be limited to the configured threshold.  
Default  
enabled  
Format  
Mode  
storm-control broadcast  
Interface Config  
no storm-control broadcast  
Use this command to disable broadcast storm recovery mode for a specific interface.  
Format  
Mode  
no storm-control broadcast  
Interface Config  
storm-control broadcast level  
Use this command to configure the broadcast storm recovery threshold for an interface as a  
percentage of link speed and enable broadcast storm recovery. If the mode is enabled,  
broadcast storm recovery is active, and if the rate of L2 broadcast traffic ingressing on an  
interface increases beyond the configured threshold, the traffic is dropped. Therefore, the  
rate of broadcast traffic is limited to the configured threshold.  
If the ‘shutdown’ option is selected, and the broadcast traffic increases beyond the threshold,  
the interface shuts down instead of dropping packets. To recover the port, issue ‘no  
shutdown’ under the port manually.  
Default  
5
Format  
Mode  
storm-control broadcast level<0-100> {action [ratelimit | shutdown]}  
Interface Config  
Switching Commands  
95  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no storm-control broadcast level  
This command sets the broadcast storm recovery threshold to the default value for an  
interface and disables broadcast storm recovery.  
Format  
Mode  
no storm-control broadcast level  
Interface Config  
storm-control broadcast rate  
Use this command to configure the broadcast storm recovery threshold for an interface in  
packets per second. If the mode is enabled, broadcast storm recovery is active, and if the  
rate of L2 broadcast traffic ingressing on an interface increases beyond the configured  
threshold, the traffic is dropped. Therefore, the rate of broadcast traffic is limited to the  
configured threshold.  
Default  
0
Format  
Mode  
storm-control broadcast rate <0-14880000>  
Interface Config  
no storm-control broadcast rate  
This command sets the broadcast storm recovery threshold to the default value for an  
interface and disables broadcast storm recovery.  
Format  
Mode  
no storm-control broadcast rate  
Interface Config  
storm-control broadcast (Global)  
This command enables broadcast storm recovery mode for all interfaces. If the mode is  
enabled, broadcast storm recovery is active, and if the rate of L2 broadcast traffic ingressing  
on an interface increases beyond the configured threshold, the traffic will be dropped.  
Therefore, the rate of broadcast traffic will be limited to the configured threshold.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
storm-control broadcast  
Global Config  
no storm-control broadcast  
This command disables broadcast storm recovery mode for all interfaces.  
Format  
Mode  
no storm-control broadcast  
Global Config  
Switching Commands  
96  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
storm-control broadcast level (Global)  
This command configures the broadcast storm recovery threshold for all interfaces as a  
percentage of link speed and enables broadcast storm recovery. If the mode is enabled,  
broadcast storm recovery is active, and if the rate of L2 broadcast traffic ingressing on an  
interface increases beyond the configured threshold, the traffic will be dropped. Therefore,  
the rate of broadcast traffic will be limited to the configured threshold. This command also  
enables broadcast storm recovery mode for all interfaces.  
If the ‘shutdown’ option is selected, and the broadcast traffic increases beyond the threshold,  
the interface shuts down instead of dropping packets. To recover the port, issue ‘no  
shutdown’ under the port manually.  
Default  
5
Format  
Mode  
storm-control broadcast level<0-100>  
Global Config  
no storm-control broadcast level  
This command sets the broadcast storm recovery threshold to the default value for all  
interfaces and disables broadcast storm recovery.  
Format  
Mode  
no storm-control broadcast level  
Global Config  
storm-control broadcast rate (Global)  
Use this command to configure the broadcast storm recovery threshold for all interfaces in  
packets per second. If the mode is enabled, broadcast storm recovery is active, and if the  
rate of L2 broadcast traffic ingressing on an interface increases beyond the configured  
threshold, the traffic is dropped. Therefore, the rate of broadcast traffic is limited to the  
configured threshold.  
Default  
0
Format  
Mode  
storm-control broadcast rate <0-14880000>  
Global Config  
no storm-control broadcast rate  
This command sets the broadcast storm recovery threshold to the default value for all  
interfaces and disables broadcast storm recovery.  
Format  
Mode  
no storm-control broadcast rate  
Global Config  
Switching Commands  
97  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
storm-control multicast  
This command enables multicast storm recovery mode for an interface. If the mode is  
enabled, multicast storm recovery is active, and if the rate of L2 multicast traffic ingressing on  
an interface increases beyond the configured threshold, the traffic will be dropped. Therefore,  
the rate of multicast traffic will be limited to the configured threshold.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
storm-control multicast  
Interface Config  
no storm-control multicast  
This command disables multicast storm recovery mode for an interface.  
Format  
Mode  
no storm-control multicast  
Interface Config  
storm-control multicast level  
This command configures the multicast storm recovery threshold for an interface as a  
percentage of link speed and enables multicast storm recovery mode. If the mode is enabled,  
multicast storm recovery is active, and if the rate of L2 multicast traffic ingressing on an  
interface increases beyond the configured threshold, the traffic will be dropped. Therefore,  
the rate of multicast traffic will be limited to the configured threshold.  
Default  
5
Format  
Mode  
storm-control multicast level <0-100>  
Interface Config  
no storm-control multicast level  
This command sets the multicast storm recovery threshold to the default value for an  
interface and disables multicast storm recovery.  
Format  
Mode  
no storm-control multicast level <0-100>  
Interface Config  
storm-control multicast rate  
Use this command to configure the multicast storm recovery threshold for an interface in  
packets per second. If the mode is enabled, multicast storm recovery is active, and if the rate  
of L2 broadcast traffic ingressing on an interface increases beyond the configured threshold,  
Switching Commands  
98  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
the traffic is dropped. Therefore, the rate of multicast traffic is limited to the configured  
threshold.  
Default  
0
Format  
Mode  
storm-control multicast rate <0-14880000>  
Interface Config  
no storm-control multicast rate  
This command sets the multicast storm recovery threshold to the default value for an  
interface and disables multicast storm recovery.  
Format  
Mode  
no storm-control multicast rate  
Interface Config  
storm-control multicast (Global)  
This command enables multicast storm recovery mode for all interfaces. If the mode is  
enabled, multicast storm recovery is active, and if the rate of L2 multicast traffic ingressing on  
an interface increases beyond the configured threshold, the traffic will be dropped. Therefore,  
the rate of multicast traffic will be limited to the configured threshold.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
storm-control multicast  
Global Config  
no storm-control multicast  
This command disables multicast storm recovery mode for all interfaces.  
Format  
Mode  
no storm-control multicast  
Global Config  
storm-control multicast level (Global)  
This command configures the multicast storm recovery threshold for all interfaces as a  
percentage of link speed and enables multicast storm recovery mode. If the mode is enabled,  
multicast storm recovery is active, and if the rate of L2 multicast traffic ingressing on an  
interface increases beyond the configured threshold, the traffic will be dropped. Therefore,  
the rate of multicast traffic will be limited to the configured threshold.  
Default  
5
Format  
Mode  
storm-control multicast level<0-100>  
Global Config  
Switching Commands  
99  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no storm-control multicast level  
This command sets the multicast storm recovery threshold to the default value for all  
interfaces and disables multicast storm recovery.  
Format  
Mode  
no storm-control multicast level  
Global Config  
storm-control multicast rate (Global)  
Use this command to configure the multicast storm recovery threshold for all interfaces in  
packets per second. If the mode is enabled, multicast storm recovery is active, and if the rate  
of L2 broadcast traffic ingressing on an interface increases beyond the configured threshold,  
the traffic is dropped. Therefore, the rate of multicast traffic is limited to the configured  
threshold.  
Default  
0
Format  
Mode  
storm-control multicast rate <0-14880000>  
Global Config  
no storm-control broadcast rate  
This command sets the broadcast storm recovery threshold to the default value for all  
interfaces and disables broadcast storm recovery.  
Format  
Mode  
no storm-control broadcast rate  
Global Config  
storm-control unicast  
This command enables unicast storm recovery mode for an interface. If the mode is enabled,  
unicast storm recovery is active, and if the rate of unknown L2 unicast (destination lookup  
failure) traffic ingressing on an interface increases beyond the configured threshold, the traffic  
will be dropped. Therefore, the rate of unknown unicast traffic will be limited to the configured  
threshold.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
storm-control unicast  
Interface Config  
Switching Commands  
100  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no storm-control unicast  
This command disables unicast storm recovery mode for an interface.  
Format  
Mode  
no storm-control unicast  
Interface Config  
storm-control unicast level  
This command configures the unicast storm recovery threshold for an interface as a  
percentage of link speed, and enables unicast storm recovery. If the mode is enabled, unicast  
storm recovery is active, and if the rate of unknown L2 unicast (destination lookup failure)  
traffic ingressing on an interface increases beyond the configured threshold, the traffic will be  
dropped. Therefore, the rate of unknown unicast traffic will be limited to the configured  
threshold. This command also enables unicast storm recovery mode for an interface.  
Default  
5
Format  
Mode  
storm-control unicast level <0-100>  
Interface Config  
no storm-control unicast level  
This command sets the unicast storm recovery threshold to the default value for an interface  
and disables unicast storm recovery.  
Format  
Mode  
no storm-control unicast level  
Interface Config  
storm-control unicast rate  
Use this command to configure the unicast storm recovery threshold for an interface in  
packets per second. If the mode is enabled, unicast storm recovery is active, and if the rate of  
L2 broadcast traffic ingressing on an interface increases beyond the configured threshold,  
the traffic is dropped. Therefore, the rate of unicast traffic is limited to the configured  
threshold.  
Default  
0
Format  
Mode  
storm-control unicast rate <0-14880000>  
Interface Config  
Switching Commands  
101  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no storm-control unicast rate  
This command sets the unicast storm recovery threshold to the default value for an interface  
and disables unicast storm recovery.  
Format  
Mode  
no storm-control unicast rate  
Interface Config  
storm-control unicast (Global)  
This command enables unicast storm recovery mode for all interfaces. If the mode is  
enabled, unicast storm recovery is active, and if the rate of unknown L2 unicast (destination  
lookup failure) traffic ingressing on an interface increases beyond the configured threshold,  
the traffic will be dropped. Therefore, the rate of unknown unicast traffic will be limited to the  
configured threshold.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
storm-control unicast  
Global Config  
no storm-control unicast  
This command disables unicast storm recovery mode for all interfaces.  
Format  
Mode  
no storm-control unicast  
Global Config  
storm-control unicast level (Global)  
This command configures the unicast storm recovery threshold for all interfaces as a  
percentage of link speed, and enables unicast storm recovery. If the mode is enabled, unicast  
storm recovery is active, and if the rate of unknown L2 unicast (destination lookup failure)  
traffic ingressing on an interface increases beyond the configured threshold, the traffic will be  
dropped. Therefore, the rate of unknown unicast traffic will be limited to the configured  
threshold.  
Default  
5
Format  
Mode  
storm-control unicast level <0-100>  
Global Config  
Switching Commands  
102  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no storm-control unicast level  
This command sets the unicast storm recovery threshold to the default value and disables  
unicast storm recovery for all interfaces.  
Format  
Mode  
no storm-control unicast level  
Global Config  
storm-control unicast rate (Global)  
Use this command to configure the unicast storm recovery threshold for all interfaces in  
packets per second. If the mode is enabled, unicast storm recovery is active, and if the rate of  
L2 broadcast traffic ingressing on an interface increases beyond the configured threshold,  
the traffic is dropped. Therefore, the rate of unicast traffic is limited to the configured  
threshold.  
Default  
0
Format  
Mode  
storm-control unicast rate <0-14880000>  
Global Config  
no storm-control unicast rate  
This command sets the multicast storm recovery threshold to the default value for an  
interface and disables multicast storm recovery.  
Format  
Mode  
no storm-control unicast rate  
Global Config  
show storm-control  
This command displays switch configuration information. If you do not use any of the optional  
parameters, this command displays global storm control configuration parameters:  
Broadcast Storm Control Mode may be enabled or disabled. The factory default is  
disabled.  
Broadcast Storm Control Level The broadcast storm control level. The factory default is  
5%.  
Multicast Storm Control Mode may be enabled or disabled. The factory default is  
disabled.  
Multicast Storm Control Level The multicast storm control level. The factory default is  
5%.  
Unicast Storm Control Mode may be enabled or disabled. The factory default is  
disabled.  
Unicast Storm Control Level The unicast storm control level. The factory default is 5%.  
Switching Commands  
103  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Use the allkeyword to display the per-port configuration parameters for all interfaces, or  
specify the slot/portto display information about a specific interface.  
Format  
show storm-control [all | <slot/port>]  
Mode  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Bcast Mode  
Shows whether the broadcast storm control mode is enabled or disabled. The factory  
default is disabled.  
Bcast Level  
Mcast Mode  
Mcast Level  
Ucast Mode  
The broadcast storm control level.  
Shows whether the multicast storm control mode is enabled or disabled.  
The multicast storm control level.  
Shows whether the Unknown Unicast or DLF (Destination Lookup Failure) storm control  
mode is enabled or disabled.  
Ucast Level  
The Unknown Unicast or DLF (Destination Lookup Failure) storm control level.  
Flow Control Commands  
In 802.3x flow control, the MAC control PAUSE operation is specified in IEEE 802.3 Annex 31  
B. It allows traffic from one device to be throttled for a specified period of time and is defined  
for devices that are directly connected. A device that needs to inhibit transmission of data  
frames from another device on the LAN transmits a PAUSE frame as defined in the IEEE  
specification.  
This feature allows the user to configure the switch to use symmetric, asymmetric, or no flow  
control. Asymmetric flow control allows the switch to respond to received PAUSE frames, but  
the port cannot generate PAUSE frames. Symmetric flow control allows the switch to both  
respond to and generate MAC control PAUSE frames.  
flowcontrol {symmetric|asymmetric}  
Use this command to enable or disable the symmetric or asymmetric flow control on the  
switch. Use the no form of command to disable the symmetric or asymmetric flow control.  
Asymmetric here means that Tx Pause can never be enabled. Only Rx Pause can be  
enabled.  
Default  
Disabled  
Format  
Mode  
flowcontrol {symmetric|asymmetric}  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
Switching Commands  
104  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no flowcontrol  
Format  
Mode  
no flowcontrol  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
show flowcontrol  
Use this command to display the IEEE 802.3 Annex 31B flow control settings and status for a  
specific interface or all interfaces. It also displays 802.3 Tx and Rx pause counts. Priority  
Flow Control frames counts are not displayed. If the port is enabled for priority flow control,  
operational flow control status is displayed as “Inactive”. Operational flow control status for  
stacking ports is always displayed as “N/A”.  
Format  
Mode  
show flowcontrol [slot/port]  
Privileged Exec  
Examples:  
(switch)#show flowcontrol  
Admin Flow Control: Symmetric  
Port  
Flow Control  
Oper  
RxPause  
TxPause  
------ ------------  
-------- ---------  
0/1  
0/2  
Active  
Inactive  
310  
0
611  
0
(switch)#show flowcontrol interface 0/1  
Admin Flow Control: Symmetric  
Port  
Flow Control RxPause  
Oper  
TxPause  
--------- -------  
0/1 Active  
--------  
310  
-------  
611  
Port-Channel/LAG (802.3ad) Commands  
This section describes the commands you use to configure port-channels, which are also  
known as link aggregation groups (LAGs). Link aggregation allows you to combine multiple  
full-duplex Ethernet links into a single logical link. Network devices treat the aggregation as if  
it were a single link, which increases fault tolerance and provides load sharing. The LAG  
feature initially load shares traffic based upon the source and destination MAC address.  
Assign the port-channel (LAG) VLAN membership after you create a port-channel. If you do  
not assign VLAN membership, the port-channel might become a member of the  
management VLAN which can result in learning and switching issues.  
Switching Commands  
105  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
A port-channel (LAG) interface can be either static or dynamic, but not both. All members of a  
port channel must participate in the same protocols.) A static port-channel interface does not  
require a partner system to be able to aggregate its member ports.  
Note: If you configure the maximum number of dynamic port-channels  
(LAGs) that your platform supports, additional port-channels that you  
configure are automatically static.  
addport  
This command adds one port to the port-channel (LAG). The interface is a logical slot/port  
number or a group ID of a configured port-channel.  
Note: Before adding a port to a port-channel, set the physical mode of the  
port. For more information, see speed on page 24.  
Format  
Mode  
addport {<logical slot/port>|lag <lag-group-id>}  
Interface Config  
deleteport (Interface Config)  
This command deletes the port from the port-channel (LAG). The interface is a logical  
slot/port number or a group ID of a configured port-channel.  
Format  
Mode  
deleteport {<logical slot/port>|lag <lag-group-id>}  
Interface Config  
deleteport (Global Config)  
This command deletes all configured ports from the port-channel (LAG). The interface is a  
logical slot/port number of a configured port-channel. To clear the port channels, see clear  
Format  
Mode  
deleteport <logical slot/port>  
Global Config  
Switching Commands  
106  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
lacp admin key  
Use this command to configure the administrative value of the key for the port-channel. The  
value range of <key> is 0–65535.  
Default  
0x8000  
Format  
Mode  
lacp admin key <key>  
Interface Config  
Note: This command is only applicable to port-channel interfaces.  
no lacp admin key  
Use this command to configure the default administrative value of the key for the  
port-channel.  
Format  
Mode  
no lacp admin key  
Interface Config  
lacp collector max-delay  
Use this command to configure the port-channel collector max delay. The valid range of  
<delay> is 0-65535.  
Default  
0x8000  
Format  
Mode  
lacp collector max-delay <delay>  
Interface Config  
Note: This command is only applicable to port-channel interfaces.  
no lacp collector max delay  
Use this command to configure the default port-channel collector max delay.  
Format  
Mode  
no lacp collector max-delay  
Interface Config  
lacp actor admin  
Use this command to configure the LACP actor admin parameters.  
Switching Commands  
107  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
lacp actor admin key  
Use this command to configure the administrative value of the LACP actor admin key. The  
valid range for <key> is 0-65535.  
Default  
Internal Interface Number of this Physical Port  
Format  
Mode  
lacp actor admin key <key>  
Interface Config  
Note: This command is only applicable to physical interfaces.  
no lacp actor admin key  
Use this command to configure the default administrative value of the key.  
Format  
Mode  
no lacp actor admin key  
Interface Config  
lacp actor admin state individual  
Use this command to set LACP actor admin state to individual.  
Format  
Mode  
lacp actor admin state individual  
Interface Config  
Note: This command is only applicable to physical interfaces.  
no lacp actor admin state individual  
Use this command to set the LACP actor admin state to aggregation.  
Format  
Mode  
no lacp actor admin state individual  
Interface Config  
lacp actor admin state longtimeout  
Use this command to set LACP actor admin state to longtimeout.  
Format  
Mode  
lacp actor admin state longtimeout  
Interface Config  
Switching Commands  
108  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Note: This command is only applicable to physical interfaces.  
no lacp actor admin state longtimeout  
Use this command to set the LACP actor admin state to short timeout.  
Format  
Mode  
no lacp actor admin state longtimeout  
Interface Config  
Note: This command is only applicable to physical interfaces.  
lacp actor admin state passive  
Use this command to set the LACP actor admin state to passive.  
Format  
Mode  
lacp actor admin state passive  
Interface Config  
Note: This command is only applicable to physical interfaces.  
no lacp actor admin state passive  
Use this command to set the LACP actor admin state to active.  
Format  
Mode  
no lacp actor admin state passive  
Interface Config  
lacp actor port priority  
Use this command to configure the priority value assigned to the Aggregation Port. The valid  
range for <priority> is 0–255.  
Default  
0x80  
Format  
Mode  
lacp actor port priority <priority>  
Interface Config  
Note: This command is only applicable to physical interfaces.  
Switching Commands  
109  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no lacp actor port priority  
Use this command to configure the default priority value assigned to the Aggregation Port.  
Format  
Mode  
no lacp actor port priority  
Interface Config  
lacp actor system priority  
Use this command to configure the priority value associated with the LACP Actor’s  
SystemID. The range for <priority> is 0–65535.  
Default  
32768  
Format  
Mode  
lacp actor system priority <priority>  
Interface Config  
Note: This command is only applicable to physical interfaces.  
no lacp actor system priority  
Use this command to configure the priority value associated with the Actor’s SystemID.  
Format  
Mode  
no lacp actor system priority  
Interface Config  
lacp partner admin key  
Use this command to configure the administrative value of the Key for the protocol partner.  
The valid range for <key> is 0–65535.  
Default  
0x0  
Format  
Mode  
lacp partner admin key  
Interface Config  
Note: This command is only applicable to physical interfaces.  
Switching Commands  
110  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no lacp partner admin key  
Use this command to configure the administrative value of the Key for the protocol partner.  
Format  
Mode  
no lacp partner admin key <key>  
Interface Config  
lacp partner admin state individual  
Use this command to set LACP partner admin state to individual.  
Format  
Mode  
lacp partner admin state individual  
Interface Config  
Note: This command is only applicable to physical interfaces.  
no lacp partner admin state individual  
Use this command to set the LACP partner admin state to aggregation.  
Format  
Mode  
no lacp partner admin state individual  
Interface Config  
lacp partner admin state longtimeout  
Use this command to set LACP partner admin state to longtimeout.  
Format  
Mode  
lacp partner admin state longtimeout  
Interface Config  
Note: This command is only applicable to physical interfaces.  
no lacp partner admin state longtimeout  
Use this command to set the LACP partner admin state to short timeout.  
Format  
Mode  
no lacp partner admin state longtimeout  
Interface Config  
Note: This command is only applicable to physical interfaces.  
Switching Commands  
111  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
lacp partner admin state passive  
Use this command to set the LACP partner admin state to passive.  
Format  
Mode  
lacp partner admin state passive  
Interface Config  
Note: This command is only applicable to physical interfaces.  
no lacp partner admin state passive  
Use this command to set the LACP partner admin state to active.  
Format  
Mode  
no lacp partner admin state passive  
Interface Config  
lacp partner port id  
Use this command to configure the LACP partner port id. The valid range for <port-id> is  
0–65535.  
Default  
0x80  
Format  
Mode  
lacp partner portid <port-id>  
Interface Config  
Note: This command is only applicable to physical interfaces.  
no lacp partner port id  
Use this command to set the LACP partner port id to the default.  
Format  
Mode  
no lacp partner portid  
Interface Config  
lacp partner port priority  
Use this command to configure the LACP partner port priority. The valid range for  
<priority> is 0–255.  
Default  
0x0  
Switching Commands  
112  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Format  
Mode  
lacp partner port priority <priority>  
Interface Config  
Note: This command is only applicable to physical interfaces.  
no lacp partner port priority  
Use this command to configure the default LACP partner port priority.  
Format  
Mode  
no lacp partner port priority  
Interface Config  
lacp partner system id  
Use this command to configure the 6-octet MAC Address value representing the  
administrative value of the Aggregation Port’s protocol Partner’s System ID. The valid range  
of <system-id> is 00:00:00:00:00:00 - FF:FF:FF:FF:FF.  
Default  
00:00:00:00:00:00  
Format  
Mode  
lacp partner system id <system-id>  
Interface Config  
Note: This command is only applicable to physical interfaces.  
no lacp partner system id  
Use this command to configure the default value representing the administrative value of the  
Aggregation Port’s protocol Partner’s System ID.  
Format  
Mode  
no lacp partner system id  
Interface Config  
lacp partner system priority  
Use this command to configure the administrative value of the priority associated with the  
Partner’s System ID. The valid range for <priority> is 0–65535.  
Default  
0x0  
Format  
Mode  
lacp partner system priority <priority>  
Interface Config  
Switching Commands  
113  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Note: This command is applicable only to physical interfaces.  
no lacp partner system priority  
Use this command to configure the default administrative value of priority associated with the  
Partner’s System ID.  
Format  
Mode  
no lacp partner system priority  
Interface Config  
port-channel local-preference  
This command enables the local-preference mode on a port-channel (LAG) interface or  
range of interfaces. By default, the local-preference mode for a port-channel is disabled. This  
command can be used only on port-channel interfaces.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
port-channel local-preference  
Interface Config  
no port-channel local-preference  
This command disables the local-preference mode on a port-channel.  
Format  
Mode  
no port-channel local-preference  
Interface Config  
port-channel static  
This command enables the static mode on a port-channel (LAG) interface. By default the  
static mode for a new port-channel is disabled, which means the port-channel is dynamic.  
However if the maximum number of allowable dynamic port-channels are already present in  
the system, the static mode for a new port-channel enabled, which means the port-channel is  
static. You can only use this command on port-channel interfaces.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
port-channel static  
Interface Config  
Switching Commands  
114  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no port-channel static  
This command sets the static mode on a particular port-channel (LAG) interface to the  
default value. This command will be executed only for interfaces of type port-channel (LAG).  
Format  
Mode  
no port-channel static  
Interface Config  
port lacpmode  
This command enables Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) on a port.  
Default  
enabled  
Format  
Mode  
port lacpmode  
Interface Config  
no port lacpmode  
This command disables Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) on a port.  
Format  
Mode  
no port lacpmode  
Interface Config  
port lacpmode enable all  
This command enables Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) on all ports.  
Format  
Mode  
port lacpmode enable all  
Global Config  
no port lacpmode enable all  
This command disables Link Aggregation Control Protocol (LACP) on all ports.  
Format  
Mode  
no port lacpmode enable all  
Global Config  
port lacptimeout (Interface Config)  
This command sets the timeout on a physical interface of a particular device type (actoror  
partner) to either longor shorttimeout.  
Default  
long  
Format  
Mode  
port lacptimeout {actor | partner} {long | short}  
Interface Config  
Switching Commands  
115  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no port lacptimeout  
This command sets the timeout back to its default value on a physical interface of a particular  
device type (actoror partner).  
Format  
Mode  
no port lacptimeout {actor | partner}  
Interface Config  
port lacptimeout (Global Config)  
This command sets the timeout for all interfaces of a particular device type (actoror  
partner) to either longor shorttimeout.  
Default  
long  
Format  
Mode  
port lacptimeout {actor | partner} {long | short}  
Global Config  
no port lacptimeout  
This command sets the timeout for all physical interfaces of a particular device type (actor  
or partner) back to their default values.  
Format  
Mode  
no port lacptimeout {actor | partner}  
Global Config  
port-channel adminmode  
This command enables a port-channel (LAG). This command sets every configured  
port-channel with the same administrative mode setting.  
Format  
Mode  
port-channel adminmode all  
Global Config  
no port-channel adminmode  
This command disables a port-channel (LAG). This command clears every configured  
port-channel with the same administrative mode setting.  
Format  
Mode  
no port-channel adminmode [all]  
Global Config  
Switching Commands  
116  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
port-channel linktrap  
This command enables link trap notifications for the port-channel (LAG). The interface is a  
logical slot/port for a configured port-channel. The option allenables link trap  
notifications for all the configured port-channels.  
Default  
enabled  
Format  
Mode  
port-channel linktrap {<slot/port> | lag <lag-group-id> | all}  
Global Config  
no port-channel linktrap  
This command disables link trap notifications for the port-channel (LAG). The interface is a  
logical slot and port for a configured port-channel. The option all disables link trap  
notifications for all the configured port-channels.  
Format  
Mode  
no port-channel linktrap {<logical slot/port> | all}  
Global Config  
port-channel load-balance  
This command selects the load-balancing option used on a port-channel (LAG). Traffic is  
balanced on a port-channel (LAG) by selecting one of the links in the channel over which to  
transmit specific packets. The link is selected by creating a binary pattern from selected fields  
in a packet, and associating that pattern with a particular link.  
Load-balancing is not supported on every device. The range of options for load-balancing  
can vary per device. The managed switch also supports enhanced hashing mode, which has  
the following advantages:  
MODULO-N (where N is the number of active link members in a LAG) operation based on  
the number of ports in the LAG  
Packet attributes selection based on the packet type: For L2 packets, source and  
destination MAC address are used for hash computation. For L3 packets, source IP,  
destination IP address, TCP/UDP ports are used.  
Non-Unicast traffic and unicast traffic is hashed using a common hash algorithm  
Excellent load balancing performance.  
Default  
Format  
3
port-channel load-balance { 1 | 2 | 3 | 4 | 5 | 6 | 7} {<slot/port>  
|<all>}  
Mode  
Interface Config  
Global Config  
Switching Commands  
117  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
1
Definition  
Source MAC, VLAN, EtherType, and incoming port associated with the packet  
Destination MAC, VLAN, EtherType, and incoming port associated with the packet  
2
3
Source/Destination MAC, VLAN, EtherType, and incoming port associated with the  
packet  
4
Source IP and Source TCP/UDP fields of the packet  
Destination IP and Destination TCP/UDP Port fields of the packet  
Source/Destination IP and source/destination TCP/UDP Port fields of the packet  
Enhanced Hashing Mode  
5
6
7
<slot/port>| all  
Global Config Mode only: The interface is a logical slot/port number of a configured  
port-channel. "All" applies the command to all currently configured port-channels.  
no port-channel load-balance  
This command reverts to the default load balancing configuration.  
Format  
Mode  
no port-channel load-balance {<slot/port> | <all>}  
Interface Config  
Global Config  
Term  
Definition  
<slot/port>| all  
Global Config Mode only: The interface is a logical slot/port number of a configured  
port-channel. "All" applies the command to all currently configured port-channels.  
port-channel name  
This command defines a name for the port-channel (LAG). The interface is a logical slot/port  
for a configured port-channel, and <name>is an alphanumeric string up to 15 characters.  
Format  
Mode  
port-channel name {<logical slot/port> | <name>}  
Global Config  
port-channel system priority  
Use this command to configure port-channel system priority. The valid range of <priority> is  
0-65535.  
Default  
0x8000  
Switching Commands  
118  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Format  
Mode  
port-channel system priority <priority>  
Global Config  
no port-channel system priority  
Use this command to configure the default port-channel system priority value.  
Format  
Mode  
no port-channel system priority  
Global Config  
show lacp actor  
Use this command to display LACP actor attributes.  
Format  
Mode  
show lacp actor {<slot/port>|all}  
Global Config  
The following output parameters are displayed.  
Parameter  
Description  
System Priority  
Admin Key  
The system priority assigned to the Aggregation Port.  
The administrative value of the Key.  
Port Priority  
Admin State  
The priority value assigned to the Aggregation Port.  
The administrative values of the actor state as transmitted by the Actor in LACPDUs.  
show lacp partner  
Use this command to display LACP partner attributes.  
Format  
Mode  
show lacp partner {<slot/port>|all}  
Privileged EXEC  
The following output parameters are displayed.  
Parameter  
Description  
System Priority  
System ID  
The administrative value of priority associated with the Partner’s System ID.  
The value representing the administrative value of the Aggregation Port’s protocol  
Partner’s System ID.  
Admin Key  
The administrative value of the Key for the protocol Partner.  
Port Priority  
The administrative value of the port priority for the protocol Partner.  
Switching Commands  
119  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Parameter  
Port-ID  
Description  
The administrative value of the port number for the protocol Partner.  
The administrative values of the actor state for the protocol Partner.  
Admin State  
show port-channel brief  
This command displays the static capability of all port-channel (LAG) interfaces on the device  
as well as a summary of individual port-channel interfaces.  
Format  
Mode  
show port-channel brief  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
For each port-channel the following information is displayed:  
Term  
Definition  
Logical  
Interface  
The slot/port of the logical interface.  
Port-channel  
Name  
The name of port-channel (LAG) interface.  
Link-State  
Trap Flag  
Type  
Shows whether the link is up or down.  
Shows whether trap flags are enabled or disabled.  
Shows whether the port-channel is statically or dynamically maintained.  
The members of this port-channel.  
Mbr Ports  
Active Ports  
The ports that are actively participating in the port-channel.  
show port-channel  
This command displays an overview of all port-channels (LAGs) on the switch.  
Format  
Mode  
show port-channel {<logical slot/port> | all}  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Logical  
Interface  
Valid slot and port number separated by forward slashes.  
Port-Channel  
Name  
The name of this port-channel (LAG). You may enter any string of up to 15 alphanumeric  
characters.  
Link State  
Indicates whether the Link is up or down.  
Admin Mode  
May be enabled or disabled. The factory default is enabled.  
Switching Commands  
120  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Type  
Definition  
The status designating whether a particular port-channel (LAG) is statically or  
dynamically maintained.  
Static - The port-channel is statically maintained.  
Dynamic - The port-channel is dynamically maintained.  
Mbr Ports  
A listing of the ports that are members of this port-channel (LAG), in slot/port notation.  
There can be a maximum of eight ports assigned to a given port-channel (LAG).  
Device Timeout  
Port Speed  
For each port, lists the timeout (longor short) for Device Type (actoror partner).  
Speed of the port-channel port.  
Ports Active  
This field lists the ports that are actively participating in the port-channel (LAG).  
Load Balance  
Option  
The load balance option associated with this LAG. See port-channel load-balance on  
Local  
Preference  
Mode  
Indicates whether the local preference mode is enabled or disabled.  
show port-channel system priority  
Use this command to display the port-channel system priority.  
Format  
Mode  
show port-channel system priority  
Privileged EXEC  
Port Mirroring  
Port mirroring, which is also known as port monitoring, selects network traffic that you can  
analyze with a network analyzer, such as a SwitchProbe device or other Remote Monitoring  
(RMON) probe.  
monitor session  
This command configures a probe port and a monitored port for monitor session (port  
monitoring). Use the source interface <slot/port>parameter to specify the interface  
to monitor. Use rxto monitor only ingress packets, or use txto monitor only egress packets.  
If you do not specify an {rx | tx}option, the destination port monitors both ingress and  
egress packets. Use the destination interface <slot/port>to specify the interface  
to receive the monitored traffic. Use the modeparameter to enabled the administrative mode  
of the session. If enabled, the probe port monitors all the traffic received and transmitted on  
the physical monitored port.  
Format  
Mode  
monitor session <session-id> {source interface <slot/port> [{rx |  
tx}] | destination interface <slot/port> | mode}  
Global Config  
Switching Commands  
121  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no monitor session  
Use this command without optional parameters to remove the monitor session (port  
monitoring) designation from the source probe port, the destination monitored port and all  
VLANs. Once the port is removed from the VLAN, you must manually add the port to any  
desired VLANs. Use the source interface <slot/port>parameter or destination  
interface <slot/port>to remove the specified interface from the port monitoring  
session. Use the modeparameter to disable the administrative mode of the session  
Note: Since the current version of 7000 series software supports only one  
session, if you do not supply optional parameters, the behavior of  
this command is similar to the behavior of the no monitor  
command.  
Format  
no monitor session <session-id> [{source interface <slot/port> |  
destination interface <slot/port> | mode}]  
Mode  
Global Config  
no monitor  
This command removes all the source ports and a destination port for the and restores the  
default value for mirroring session mode for all the configured sessions.  
Note: This is a stand-alone “no” command. This command does not have  
a “normal” form.  
Default  
enabled  
Format  
Mode  
no monitor  
Global Config  
show monitor session  
This command displays the Port monitoring information for a particular mirroring session.  
Note: The <session-id>parameter is an integer value used to identify  
the session. In the current version of the software, the  
<session-id>parameter is always one (1)  
Switching Commands  
122  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Format  
Mode  
show monitor session<session-id>  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Session ID  
An integer value used to identify the session. Its value can be anything between 1 and  
the maximum number of mirroring sessions allowed on the platform.  
Admin Mode  
Probe Port  
Mirrored Port  
Type  
Indicates whether the Port Mirroring feature is enabled or disabled for the session  
identified with <session-id>. The possible values are Enabled and Disabled.  
Probe port (destination port) for the session identified with <session-id>. If probe port  
is not set, then this field is blank.  
The port, which is configured as mirrored port (source port) for the session identified with  
<session-id>. If no source port is configured for the session, then this field is blank.  
Direction in which source port configured for port mirroring. Types are tx for transmitted  
packets and rx for receiving packets.  
Static MAC Filtering  
The commands in this section describe how to configure static MAC filtering. Static MAC  
filtering allows you to configure destination ports for a static multicast MAC filter irrespective  
of the platform.  
macfilter  
This command adds a static MAC filter entry for the MAC address <macaddr>on the VLAN  
<vlanid>. The value of the <macaddr>parameter is a 6-byte hexadecimal number in the  
format of b1:b2:b3:b4:b5:b6. The following MAC addresses are restricted: 00:00:00:00:00:00,  
01:80:C2:00:00:00 to 01:80:C2:00:00:0F, 01:80:C2:00:00:20 to 01:80:C2:00:00:21, and  
FF:FF:FF:FF:FF:FF. The <vlanid>parameter must identify a valid VLAN.  
The number of static mac filters supported on the system is different for MAC filters where  
source ports are configured and MAC filters where destination ports are configured.  
For unicast MAC address filters and multicast MAC address filters with source port lists,  
the maximum number of static MAC filters supported is 20.  
For multicast MAC address filters with destination ports configured, the maximum number  
of static filters supported is 256.  
For example, for current platforms you can configure the following combinations:  
Unicast MAC and source port (max = 20)  
Multicast MAC and source port (max=20)  
Multicast MAC and destination port (only) (max=256)  
Multicast MAC and source ports and destination ports (max=20)  
Switching Commands  
123  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Format  
Mode  
macfilter <macaddr> <vlanid>  
Global Config  
no macfilter  
This command removes all filtering restrictions and the static MAC filter entry for the MAC  
address <macaddr>on the VLAN <vlanid>. The <macaddr>parameter must be specified  
as a 6-byte hexadecimal number in the format of b1:b2:b3:b4:b5:b6.  
The <vlanid>parameter must identify a valid VLAN.  
Format  
Mode  
no macfilter <macaddr> <vlanid>  
Global Config  
macfilter adddest  
Use this command to add the interface to the destination filter set for the MAC filter with the  
given <macaddr>and VLAN of <vlanid>. The <macaddr>parameter must be specified as  
a 6-byte hexadecimal number in the format of b1:b2:b3:b4:b5:b6. The <vlanid>parameter  
must identify a valid VLAN.  
Note: Configuring a destination port list is only valid for multicast MAC  
addresses.  
Format  
Mode  
macfilter adddest <macaddr> <vlanid>  
Interface Config  
no macfilter adddest  
This command removes a port from the destination filter set for the MAC filter with the given  
<macaddr>and VLAN of <vlanid>. The <macaddr>parameter must be specified as a  
6-byte hexadecimal number in the format of b1:b2:b3:b4:b5:b6. The <vlanid>parameter  
must identify a valid VLAN.  
Format  
Mode  
no macfilter adddest <macaddr> <vlanid>  
Interface Config  
macfilter adddest all  
This command adds all interfaces to the destination filter set for the MAC filter with the given  
<macaddr>and VLAN of <vlanid>. The <macaddr>parameter must be specified as a  
Switching Commands  
124  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
6-byte hexadecimal number in the format of b1:b2:b3:b4:b5:b6. The <vlanid>parameter  
must identify a valid VLAN.  
Note: Configuring a destination port list is only valid for multicast MAC  
addresses.  
Format  
Mode  
macfilter adddest all <macaddr> <vlanid>  
Global Config  
no macfilter adddest all  
This command removes all ports from the destination filter set for the MAC filter with the  
given <macaddr>and VLAN of <vlanid>. The <macaddr>parameter must be specified  
as a 6-byte hexadecimal number in the format of b1:b2:b3:b4:b5:b6. The <vlanid>  
parameter must identify a valid VLAN.  
Format  
Mode  
no macfilter adddest all <macaddr> <vlanid>  
Global Config  
macfilter addsrc  
This command adds the interface to the source filter set for the MAC filter with the MAC  
address of <macaddr> and VLAN of <vlanid>. The <macaddr>parameter must be specified  
as a 6-byte hexadecimal number in the format of b1:b2:b3:b4:b5:b6. The <vlanid>  
parameter must identify a valid VLAN.  
Format  
Mode  
macfilter addsrc <macaddr> <vlanid>  
Interface Config  
no macfilter addsrc  
This command removes a port from the source filter set for the MAC filter with the MAC  
address of <macaddr> and VLAN of <vlanid>. The <macaddr>parameter must be  
specified as a 6-byte hexadecimal number in the format of b1:b2:b3:b4:b5:b6. The  
<vlanid>parameter must identify a valid VLAN.  
Format  
Mode  
no macfilter addsrc <macaddr> <vlanid>  
Interface Config  
macfilter addsrc all  
This command adds all interfaces to the source filter set for the MAC filter with the MAC  
address of <macaddr>and <vlanid>. You must specify the <macaddr>parameter as a  
Switching Commands  
125  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
6-byte hexadecimal number in the format of b1:b2:b3:b4:b5:b6. The <vlanid>parameter  
must identify a valid VLAN.  
Format  
Mode  
macfilter addsrc all <macaddr> <vlanid>  
Global Config  
no macfilter addsrc all  
This command removes all interfaces to the source filter set for the MAC filter with the MAC  
address of <macaddr>and VLAN of <vlanid>. You must specify the <macaddr>  
parameter as a 6-byte hexadecimal number in the format of b1:b2:b3:b4:b5:b6.  
The <vlanid>parameter must identify a valid VLAN.  
Format  
Mode  
no macfilter addsrc all <macaddr> <vlanid>  
Global Config  
show mac-address-table static  
This command displays the Static MAC Filtering information for all Static MAC Filters. If you  
select <all>, all the Static MAC Filters in the system are displayed. If you supply a value for  
<macaddr>, you must also enter a value for <vlanid>, and the system displays Static  
MAC Filter information only for that MAC address and VLAN.  
Format  
Mode  
show mac-address-table static {<macaddr> <vlanid> | all}  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
MAC Address  
The MAC Address of the static MAC filter entry.  
The VLAN ID of the static MAC filter entry.  
The source port filter set's slot and port(s).  
VLAN ID  
Source Port(s)  
Note: Only multicast address filters will have destination port lists.  
show mac-address-table staticfiltering  
This command displays the Static Filtering entries in the Multicast Forwarding Database  
(MFDB) table.  
Format  
Mode  
show mac-address-table staticfiltering  
Privileged EXEC  
Switching Commands  
126  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Mac Address  
A unicast MAC address for which the switch has forwarding and or filtering information.  
As the data is gleaned from the MFDB, the address will be a multicast address. The  
format is 6 or 8 two-digit hexadecimal numbers that are separated by colons, for example  
01:23:45:67:89:AB. In an IVL system the MAC address will be displayed as 8 bytes.  
Type  
The type of the entry. Static entries are those that are configured by the end user.  
Dynamic entries are added to the table as a result of a learning process or protocol.  
Description  
Interfaces  
The text description of this multicast table entry.  
The list of interfaces that are designated for forwarding (Fwd:) and filtering (Flt:).  
DHCP L2 Relay Agent Commands  
You can enable the switch to operate as a DHCP Layer 2 relay agent to relay DHCP requests  
from clients to a Layer 3 relay agent or server. The Circuit ID and Remote ID can be added to  
DHCP requests relayed from clients to a DHCP server. This information is included in DHCP  
Option 82, as specified in sections 3.1 and 3.2 of RFC3046.  
dhcp l2relay  
Use this command to enable the DHCP Layer 2 Relay agent for an interface, a range of  
interfaces, or all interfaces. The subsequent commands mentioned in this section can be  
used only when the DHCP L2 relay is enabled.  
Format  
Modes  
dhcp l2relay  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
no dhcp l2relay  
Use this command to disable the DHCP Layer 2 relay agent for an interface or range of  
interfaces.  
Format  
Modes  
no dhcp l2relay  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
dhcp l2relay circuit-id vlan  
Use this parameter to set the DHCP Option-82 Circuit ID for a VLAN. When enabled, the  
interface number is added as the Circuit ID in DHCP option 82. Vlan-list range is 1–4093.  
Switching Commands  
127  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Separate non-consecutive IDs with a comma (,), and do not insert spaces or zeros in  
between the range. Use a dash (–) for the range.  
Format  
Mode  
dhcp l2relay circuit-id vlan <vlan-list>  
Global Config  
no dhcp l2relay circuit-id vlan  
Use this parameter to clear the DHCP Option-82 Circuit ID for a VLAN.  
Format  
Mode  
no dhcp l2relay circuit-id vlan <vlan-list>  
Global Config  
dhcp l2relay remote-id vlan  
Use this parameter to set the DHCP Option-82 Remote ID for a VLAN and subscribed service  
(based on subscription-name). The vlan–list range is 1–4093. Separate non-consecutive IDs  
with a comma (,), and do not insert spaces or zeros between the range. Use a dash (–) for  
the range.  
Format  
Mode  
dhcp l2relay remote-id <remote-id-string> vlan <vlan-list>  
Global Config  
no dhcp l2relay remote-id vlan  
Use this parameter to clear the DHCP Option-82 Remote ID for a VLAN and subscribed  
service (based on subscription-name).  
Format  
Mode  
no dhcp l2relay remote-id vlan vlan-list  
Global Config  
dhcp l2relay vlan  
Use this command to enable the DHCP L2 Relay agent for a set of VLANs. All DHCP packets  
which arrive on interfaces in the configured VLAN are subject to L2 Relay processing.  
vlan–list range is 1–4093. Separate non-consecutive IDs with a comma (,), and do not insert  
spaces or zeros between the range. Use a dash (–) for the range.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
dhcp l2relay vlan <vlan-list>  
Global Config  
Switching Commands  
128  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no dhcp l2relay vlan  
Use this command to disable the DHCP L2 Relay agent for a set of VLANs.  
Format  
Mode  
no dhcp l2relay vlan <vlan-list>  
Global Config  
dhcp l2relay trust  
Use this command to configure an interface or range of interfaces as trusted for Option-82  
reception.  
Default  
untrusted  
Format  
Mode  
dhcp l2relay trust  
Interface Config  
no dhcp l2relay trust  
Use this command to configure an interface to the default untrusted for Option-82 reception.  
Format  
Mode  
no dhcp l2relay trust  
Interface Config  
show dhcp l2relay all  
Use this command to display the summary of DHCP L2 Relay configuration.  
Format  
Mode  
show dhcp l2relay all  
Privileged EXEC  
Example: The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(switch) #show dhcp l2relay all  
DHCP L2 Relay is Enabled.  
Interface  
----------  
0/2  
0/4  
L2RelayMode  
-----------  
Enabled  
TrustMode  
--------------  
untrusted  
trusted  
Disabled  
VLAN Id  
---------  
3
5
6
7
8
9
L2 Relay  
CircuitId  
-----------  
Enabled  
Enabled  
Enabled  
Disabled  
Disabled  
Disabled  
Disabled  
RemoteId  
------------  
--NULL—  
--NULL—  
netgear  
--NULL—  
--NULL—  
--NULL—  
--NULL—  
----------  
Disabled  
Enabled  
Enabled  
Enabled  
Enabled  
Enabled  
Enabled  
10  
Switching Commands  
129  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show dhcp l2relay interface  
Use this command to display DHCP L2 relay configuration specific to interfaces.  
Format  
Mode  
show dhcp l2relay interface {all | interface-num}  
Privileged EXEC  
Example: The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(switch) #show dhcp l2relay interface all  
DHCP L2 Relay is Enabled.  
Interface  
----------  
0/2  
L2RelayMode  
-----------  
Enabled  
TrustMode  
--------------  
untrusted  
trusted  
0/4  
Disabled  
show dhcp l2relay stats interface  
Use this command to display statistics specific to DHCP L2 Relay configured interface.  
Format  
Mode  
show dhcp l2relay stats interface {all | interface-num}  
Privileged EXEC  
Example: The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(switch) #show dhcp l2relay stats interface all DHCP L2 Relay is Enabled.  
Interface UntrustedServer UntrustedClient TrustedServer  
MsgsWithOpt82 MsgsWithOpt82 MsgsWithoutOpt82 MsgsWithoutOpt82  
--------- --------------- ----------------- ----------------- --------------  
TrustedClient  
0/1  
0/2  
0/3  
0/4  
0/5  
0/6  
0/7  
0/8  
0/9  
0
0
0
0
0
3
0
0
0
0
0
0
12  
0
0
0
0
0
0
3
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
7
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
show dhcp l2relay agent-option vlan  
Use this command to display the DHCP L2 Relay Option-82 configuration specific to VLAN.  
Format  
Mode  
show dhcp l2relay agent-option vlan vlan-range  
Privileged EXEC  
Example: The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(switch) #show dhcp l2relay agent-option vlan 5-10  
DHCP L2 Relay is Enabled.  
VLAN Id  
L2 Relay  
CircuitId  
RemoteId  
---------  
----------  
-----------  
------------  
Switching Commands  
130  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
5
6
7
8
9
10  
Enabled  
Enabled  
Enabled  
Enabled  
Enabled  
Enabled  
Enabled  
Enabled  
Disabled  
Disabled  
Disabled  
Disabled  
--NULL—  
netgear  
--NULL—  
--NULL—  
--NULL—  
--NULL--  
DHCP Client Commands  
DHCP Client can include vendor and configuration information in DHCP client requests  
relayed to a DHCP server. This information is included in DHCP Option 60, Vendor Class  
Identifier. The information is a string of 128 octets.  
dhcp client vendor-id-option  
Use this command to enable the inclusion of DHCP Option-60, Vendor Class Identifier  
included in the requests transmitted to the DHCP server by the DHCP client operating in the  
switch.  
Format  
Mode  
dhcp client vendor-id-option  
Global Config  
no dhcp client vendor-id-option  
Use this command to disable the inclusion of DHCP Option-60, Vendor Class Identifier  
included in the requests transmitted to the DHCP server by the DHCP client operating in the  
switch.  
Format  
Mode  
no dhcp client vendor-id-option  
Global Config  
dhcp client vendor-id-option-string  
Use this command to set the DHCP Vendor Option-60 string to be included in requests  
transmitted to the DHCP server by the DHCP client operating in the switch.  
Format  
Mode  
dhcp client vendor-id-option-string <string>  
Global Config  
no dhcp client vendor-id-option-string  
Use this command to clear the DHCP Vendor Option-60 string.  
Format  
Mode  
no dhcp client vendor-id-option-string  
Global Config  
Switching Commands  
131  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show dhcp client vendor-id-option  
Use this command to display the configured administration mode of the vendor-id-option and  
the vendor-id string to be included in Option-43 in DHCP requests.  
Format  
Mode  
show dhcp client vendor-id-option  
Privileged EXEC  
Example: The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(switch) #show dhcp client vendor-id-option  
DHCP Client Vendor Identifier Option ........... Enabled  
DHCP Client Vendor Identifier Option string .... Client.  
DHCP Snooping Configuration Commands  
This section describes commands you use to configure DHCP Snooping.  
ip dhcp snooping  
Use this command to enable DHCP Snooping globally.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
ip dhcp snooping  
Global Config  
no ip dhcp snooping  
Use this command to disable DHCP Snooping globally.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip dhcp snooping  
Global Config  
ip dhcp snooping vlan  
Use this command to enable DHCP Snooping on a list of comma-separated VLAN ranges.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
ip dhcp snooping vlan <vlan-list>  
Global Config  
Switching Commands  
132  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no ip dhcp snooping vlan  
Use this command to disable DHCP Snooping on VLANs.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip dhcp snooping vlan <vlan-list>  
Global Config  
ip dhcp snooping verify mac-address  
Use this command to enable verification of the source MAC address with the client hardware  
address in the received DCHP message.  
Default  
enabled  
Format  
Mode  
ip dhcp snooping verify mac-address  
Global Config  
no ip dhcp snooping verify mac-address  
Use this command to disable verification of the source MAC address with the client hardware  
address.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip dhcp snooping verify mac-address  
Global Config  
ip dhcp snooping database  
Use this command to configure the persistent location of the DHCP Snooping database. This  
can be local or a remote file on a given IP machine.  
Default  
local  
Format  
Mode  
ip dhcp snooping database {local|tftp://hostIP/filename}  
Global Config  
ip dhcp snooping database write-delay  
Use this command to configure the interval in seconds at which the DHCP Snooping  
database will be persisted. The interval value ranges from 15 to 86,400 seconds.  
Default  
300 seconds  
Format  
Mode  
ip dhcp snooping database write-delay <in seconds>  
Global Config  
Switching Commands  
133  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no ip dhcp snooping database write-delay  
Use this command to set the write delay value to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip dhcp snooping database write-delay  
Global Config  
ip dhcp snooping binding  
Use this command to configure static DHCP Snooping binding.  
Format  
Mode  
ip dhcp snooping binding <mac-address> vlan <vlan id> <ip address>  
interface <interface id>  
Global Config  
no ip dhcp snooping binding <mac-address>  
Use this command to remove the DHCP static entry from the DHCP Snooping database.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip dhcp snooping binding <mac-address>  
Global Config  
ip verify binding  
Use this command to configure static IP source guard (IPSG) entries.  
Format  
Mode  
ip verify binding <mac-address> vlan <vlan id> <ip address> interface  
<interface id>  
Global Config  
no ip verify binding  
Use this command to remove the IPSG static entry from the IPSG database.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip verify binding <mac-address> vlan <vlan id> <ip address>  
interface <interface id>  
Global Config  
ip dhcp snooping limit  
Use this command to control the rate at which the DHCP Snooping messages come. The  
default rate is 15 pps with a range from 0 to 30 pps. The default burst level is 1 second with a  
range of 1–15 seconds.  
Default  
15 pps for rate limiting and 1 sec for burst interval  
Switching Commands  
134  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Format  
Mode  
ip dhcp snooping limit {rate pps [burst interval seconds]}  
Interface Config  
no ip dhcp snooping limit  
Use this command to set the rate at which the DHCP Snooping messages come, and the  
burst level, to the defaults.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip dhcp snooping limit  
Interface Config  
ip dhcp snooping log-invalid  
Use this command to control the logging DHCP messages filtration by the DHCP Snooping  
application.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
ip dhcp snooping log-invalid  
Interface Config  
no ip dhcp snooping log-invalid  
Use this command to disable the logging DHCP messages filtration by the DHCP Snooping  
application.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip dhcp snooping log-invalid  
Interface Config  
ip dhcp snooping trust  
Use this command to configure the port as trusted.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
ip dhcp snooping trust  
Interface Config  
no ip dhcp snooping trust  
Use this command to configure the port as untrusted.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip dhcp snooping trust  
Interface Config  
Switching Commands  
135  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
ip verify source  
Use this command to configure the IPSG source ID attribute to filter the data traffic in the  
hardware. Source ID is the combination of IP address and MAC address. Normal command  
allows data traffic filtration based on the IP address. With the “port-security” option, the data  
traffic will be filtered based on the IP and MAC addresses.  
Default  
the source ID is the IP address  
ip verify source {port-security}  
Format  
Mode  
Interface Config  
no ip verify source  
Use this command to disable the IPSG configuration in the hardware. You cannot disable  
port-security alone if it is configured.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip verify source  
Interface Config  
show ip dhcp snooping  
Use this command to display the DHCP Snooping global configurations and per port  
configurations.  
Format  
Mode  
show ip dhcp snooping  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Interface  
The interface for which data is displayed.  
Trusted  
If it is enabled, DHCP snooping considers the port as trusted. The factory default is  
disabled.  
Log Invalid Pkts  
If it is enabled, DHCP snooping application logs invalid packets on the specified  
interface.  
Example: The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(switch) #show ip dhcp snooping  
DHCP snooping is Disabled  
DHCP snooping source MAC verification is enabled  
DHCP snooping is enabled on the following VLANs:  
11 - 30, 40  
Interface Trusted  
Log Invalid Pkts  
--------- -------- ----------------  
Switching Commands  
136  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
0/1  
0/2  
0/3  
0/4  
0/6  
Yes  
No  
No  
No  
No  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
No  
show ip dhcp snooping binding  
Use this command to display the DHCP Snooping binding entries. To restrict the output, use  
the following options:  
Dynamic: Restrict the output based on DCHP snooping.  
Interface: Restrict the output based on a specific interface.  
Static: Restrict the output based on static entries.  
VLAN: Restrict the output based on VLAN.  
Format  
Mode  
show ip dhcp snooping binding [{static/dynamic}] [interface  
slot/port] [vlan id]  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
MAC Address  
Displays the MAC address for the binding that was added. The MAC address is the key  
to the binding database.  
IP Address  
VLAN  
Displays the valid IP address for the binding rule.  
The VLAN for the binding rule.  
Interface  
Type  
The interface to add a binding into the DHCP snooping interface.  
Binding type; statically configured from the CLI or dynamically learned.  
The remaining lease time for the entry.  
Lease (sec)  
Example: The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(switch) #show ip dhcp snooping binding  
Total number of bindings: 2  
MAC Address  
IP Address VLAN Interface Type Lease (Secs)  
------------------ ------------ ---- --------- ---- -------------  
00:02:B3:06:60:80 210.1.1.3  
00:0F:FE:00:13:04 210.1.1.4  
10 0/1  
10 0/1  
86400  
86400  
Switching Commands  
137  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show ip dhcp snooping database  
Use this command to display the DHCP Snooping configuration related to the database  
persistency.  
Format  
show ip dhcp snooping database  
Mode  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Agent URL  
Bindings database agent URL.  
Write Delay  
The maximum write time to write the database into local or remote.  
Example: The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(switch) #show ip dhcp snooping database  
agent url: /10.131.13.79:/sai1.txt  
write-delay: 5000  
show ip dhcp snooping interfaces  
Use this command to show the DHCP Snooping status of the interfaces.  
Format  
Mode  
show ip dhcp snooping interfaces  
Privileged EXEC  
show ip dhcp snooping statistics  
Use this command to list statistics for DHCP Snooping security violations on untrusted ports.  
Format  
Mode  
show ip dhcp snooping statistics  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Interface  
The IP address of the interface in slot/port format.  
MAC Verify  
Failures  
Represents the number of DHCP messages that were filtered on an untrusted interface  
because of source MAC address and client HW address mismatch.  
Switching Commands  
138  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Client Ifc  
Mismatch  
Represents the number of DHCP release and Deny messages received on the different  
ports than learned previously.  
DHCP Server  
Msgs Rec’d  
Represents the number of DHCP server messages received on Untrusted ports.  
Example: The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(switch) #show ip dhcp snooping statistics  
Interface  
MAC Verify Client Ifc DHCP Server  
Failures Mismatch Msgs Rec'd  
----------- ---------- ---------- -----------  
0/2  
0/3  
0/4  
0/5  
0/6  
0/7  
0/8  
0/9  
0/10  
0/11  
0/12  
0/13  
0/14  
0/15  
0/16  
0/17  
0/18  
0/19  
0/20  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
clear ip dhcp snooping binding  
Use this command to clear all DHCP Snooping bindings on all interfaces or on a specific  
interface.  
Format  
Mode  
clear ip dhcp snooping binding [interface <slot/port>]  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
clear ip dhcp snooping statistics  
Use this command to clear all DHCP Snooping statistics.  
Format  
Mode  
clear ip dhcp snooping statistics  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Switching Commands  
139  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show ip verify source  
Use this command to display the IPSG configurations on all ports.  
Format  
show ip verify source  
Mode  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Interface  
Interface address in slot/port format.  
Filter Type  
Is one of two values:  
• ip-mac: User has configured MAC address filtering on this interface.  
• ip: Only IP address filtering on this interface.  
IP Address  
IP address of the interface  
MAC Address  
If MAC address filtering is not configured on the interface, the MAC Address field is  
empty. If port security is disabled on the interface, then the MAC Address field displays  
“permit-all.”  
VLAN  
The VLAN for the binding rule.  
Example: The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(switch) #show ip verify source  
Interface Filter Type  
IP Address  
MAC Address  
Vlan  
--------- ----------- --------------- ----------------- -----  
0/1  
0/1  
ip-mac  
ip-mac  
210.1.1.3  
210.1.1.4  
00:02:B3:06:60:80  
00:0F:FE:00:13:04  
10  
10  
show ip source binding  
This command displays the IPSG bindings.  
Format  
Mode  
show ip source binding [{static/dynamic}] [interface slot/port] [vlan  
id]  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
MAC Address  
The MAC address for the entry that is added.  
The IP address of the entry that is added.  
IP Address  
Type  
Entry type; statically configured from CLI or dynamically learned from DHCP Snooping.  
Switching Commands  
140  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
VLAN  
VLAN for the entry.  
Interface  
IP address of the interface in slot/port format.  
The following shows sample CLI display output for the command.  
(switch) #show ip source binding  
MAC Address  
IP Address  
Type  
Vlan  
Interface  
----------------- --------------- ------------- ----- -------------  
00:00:00:00:00:08 1.2.3.4  
00:00:00:00:00:09 1.2.3.4  
00:00:00:00:00:0A 1.2.3.4  
dhcp-snooping  
dhcp-snooping  
dhcp-snooping  
2
3
4
0/1  
0/1  
0/1  
Dynamic ARP Inspection Commands  
Dynamic ARP Inspection (DAI) is a security feature that rejects invalid and malicious ARP  
packets. DAI prevents a class of man-in-the-middle attacks, where an unfriendly station  
intercepts traffic for other stations by poisoning the ARP caches of its unsuspecting  
neighbors. The miscreant sends ARP requests or responses mapping another station’s IP  
address to its own MAC address.  
DAI relies on DHCP snooping. DHCP snooping listens to DHCP message exchanges and  
builds a binding database of valid {MAC address, IP address, VLAN, and interface} tuples.  
When DAI is enabled, the switch drops ARP packets whose sender MAC address and  
sender IP address do not match an entry in the DHCP snooping bindings database. You can  
optionally configure additional ARP packet validation.  
ip arp inspection vlan  
Use this command to enable Dynamic ARP Inspection on a list of comma-separated VLAN  
ranges.  
Default  
Format  
Mode  
disabled  
ip arp inspection vlan vlan-list  
Global Config  
no ip arp inspection vlan  
Use this command to disable Dynamic ARP Inspection on a list of comma-separated VLAN  
ranges.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip arp inspection vlan vlan-list  
Global Config  
Switching Commands  
141  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
ip arp inspection validate  
Use this command to enable additional validation checks like source-mac validation,  
destination-mac validation, and ip address validation on the received ARP packets. Each  
command overrides the configuration of the previous command. For example, if a command  
enables src-mac and dst-mac validations, and a second command enables IP validation only,  
the src-mac and dst-mac validations are disabled as a result of the second command.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
ip arp inspection validate {[src-mac] [dst-mac] [ip]}  
Global Config  
no ip arp inspection validate  
Use this command to disable the additional validation checks on the received ARP packets.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip arp inspection validate {[src-mac] [dst-mac] [ip]}  
Global Config  
ip arp inspection vlan logging  
Use this command to enable logging of invalid ARP packets on a list of comma-separated  
VLAN ranges.  
Default  
Format  
Mode  
enabled  
ip arp inspection vlan vlan-list logging  
Global Config  
no ip arp inspection vlan logging  
Use this command to disable logging of invalid ARP packets on a list of comma-separated  
VLAN ranges.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip arp inspection vlan vlan-list logging  
Global Config  
ip arp inspection trust  
Use this command to configure an interface as trusted for Dynamic ARP Inspection.  
Default  
Format  
Mode  
enabled  
ip arp inspection trust  
Interface Config  
Switching Commands  
142  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no ip arp inspection trust  
Use this command to configure an interface as untrusted for Dynamic ARP Inspection.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip arp inspection trust  
Interface Config  
ip arp inspection limit  
Use this command to configure the rate limit and burst interval values for an interface.  
Configuring none for the limit means that the interface is not rate limited for Dynamic ARP  
Inspections.  
Note: The user interface will accept a rate limit for a trusted interface, but  
the limit will not be enforced unless the interface is configured to be  
untrusted.  
Default  
Format  
Mode  
15 pps for rate and 1 second for burst-interval  
ip arp inspection limit {rate pps [burst interval seconds] | none}  
Interface Config  
no ip arp inspection limit  
Use this command to set the rate limit and burst interval values for an interface to the default  
values of 15 pps and 1 second, respectively.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip arp inspection limit  
Interface Config  
ip arp inspection filter  
Use this command to configure the ARP ACL used to filter invalid ARP packets on a list of  
comma-separated VLAN ranges. If the static keyword is given, packets that do not match a  
permit statement are dropped without consulting the DHCP snooping bindings.  
Default  
Format  
Mode  
No ARP ACL is configured on a VLAN  
ip arp inspection filter acl-name vlan vlan-list [static]  
Global Config  
Switching Commands  
143  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no ip arp inspection filter  
Use this command to unconfigure the ARP ACL used to filter invalid ARP packets on a list of  
comma-separated VLAN ranges.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip arp inspection filter acl-name vlan vlan-list [static]  
Global Config  
arp access-list  
Use this command to create an ARP ACL.  
Format  
Mode  
arp access-list acl-name  
Global Config  
no arp access-list  
Use this command to delete a configured ARP ACL.  
Format  
Mode  
no arp access-list acl-name  
Global Config  
permit ip host mac host  
Use this command to configure a rule for a valid IP address and MAC address combination  
used in ARP packet validation.  
Format  
Mode  
permit ip host sender-ip mac host sender-mac  
ARP Access-list Config  
no permit ip host mac host  
Use this command to delete a rule for a valid IP and MAC combination.  
Format  
Mode  
no permit ip host sender-ip mac host sender-mac  
ARP Access-list Config  
show ip arp inspection  
Use this command to display the Dynamic ARP Inspection global configuration and  
configuration on all the VLANs. With the vlan-list argument (that is, comma-separated VLAN  
ranges), the command displays the global configuration and configuration on all the VLANs in  
Switching Commands  
144  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
the given VLAN list. The global configuration includes the source mac validation,  
destination mac validation, and invalid IP validation information.  
Format  
show ip arp inspection [vlan <vlan-list>]  
Mode  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Source MAC  
Validation  
Displays whether Source MAC Validation of ARP frame is enabled or disabled.  
Destination  
MAC Validation  
Displays whether Destination MAC Validation is enabled or disabled.  
IP Address  
Validation  
Displays whether IP Address Validation is enabled or disabled.  
VLAN  
The VLAN ID for each displayed row.  
Configuration  
Log Invalid  
ACL Name  
Static Flag  
Displays whether DAI is enabled or disabled on the VLAN.  
Displays whether logging of invalid ARP packets is enabled on the VLAN.  
The ARP ACL Name, if configured on the VLAN.  
If the ARP ACL is configured static on the VLAN.  
Example: The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(Switch) #show ip arp inspection vlan 10-12  
Source Mac Validation  
Destination Mac Validation : Disabled  
IP Address Validation : Disabled  
: Disabled  
Vlan  
----  
10  
Configuration  
-------------  
Enabled  
Log Invalid ACL Name Static flag  
----------- --------- ----------  
Enabled H2  
Enabled  
Enabled  
11  
12  
Disabled  
Enabled  
Disabled  
show ip arp inspection statistics  
Use this command to display the statistics of the ARP packets processed by Dynamic ARP  
Inspection. Give the vlan-list argument and the command displays the statistics on all  
DAI-enabled VLANs in that list. Give the single vlan argument and the command displays the  
statistics on that VLAN. If no argument is included, the command lists a summary of the  
forwarded and dropped ARP packets.  
Format  
Mode  
show ip arp inspection statistics [vlan vlan-list]  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Switching Commands  
145  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
VLAN  
The VLAN ID for each displayed row.  
Forwarded  
The total number of valid ARP packets forwarded in this VLAN.  
The total number of not valid ARP packets dropped in this VLAN.  
The number of packets dropped due to DHCP snooping binding database match failure.  
The number of packets dropped due to ARP ACL rule match failure.  
The number of packets permitted due to DHCP snooping binding database match.  
The number of packets permitted due to ARP ACL rule match.  
The number of packets dropped due to Source MAC validation failure.  
The number of packets dropped due to Destination MAC validation failure.  
The number of packets dropped due to invalid IP checks.  
Dropped  
DHCP Drops  
ACL Drops  
DHCP Permits  
ACL Permits  
Bad Src MAC  
Bad Dest MAC  
Invalid IP  
Example: The following shows example CLI display output for the command show ip arp inspection statistics  
which lists the summary of forwarded and dropped ARP packets on all DAI-enabled VLANs.  
VLAN Forwarded Dropped  
---- --------- -------  
10  
20  
90  
10  
14  
3
Example: The following shows example CLI display output for the command show ip arp inspection statistics vlan  
<vlan-list>.  
VLAN  
DHCP  
Drops  
ACL  
Drops  
DHCP  
Permits  
ACL  
Permits  
Bad Src Bad Dest Invalid  
MAC MAC IP  
----- -------- --------- ----------- --------- ---------- ----------- ---------  
10  
20  
11  
1
1
0
65  
8
25  
2
1
0
1
1
0
1
clear ip arp inspection statistics  
Use this command to reset the statistics for Dynamic ARP Inspection on all VLANs.  
Default  
none  
Format  
Mode  
clear ip arp inspection statistics  
Privileged EXEC  
show ip arp inspection interfaces  
Use this command to display the Dynamic ARP Inspection configuration on all the  
DAI-enabled interfaces. An interface is said to be enabled for DAI if at least one VLAN, that  
the interface is a member of, is enabled for DAI. Given a slot/port interface argument, the  
Switching Commands  
146  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
command displays the values for that interface whether the interface is enabled for DAI or  
not.  
Format  
show ip arp inspection interfaces [slot/port]  
Mode  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Interface  
The interface ID for each displayed row.  
Whether the interface is trusted or untrusted for DAI.  
The configured rate limit value in packets per second.  
The configured burst interval value in seconds.  
Trust State  
Rate Limit  
Burst Interval  
Example: The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(Switch) #show ip arp inspection interfaces  
Interface  
Trust State Rate Limit Burst Interval  
(pps) (seconds)  
--------------- ----------- ---------- ---------------  
0/1  
0/2  
Untrusted  
Untrusted  
15  
10  
1
10  
show arp access-list  
Use this command to display the configured ARP ACLs with the rules. Giving an ARP ACL  
name as the argument will display only the rules in that ARP ACL.  
Format  
Mode  
show arp access-list [acl-name]  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Example: The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(Switch) #show arp access-list  
ARP access list H2  
permit ip host 1.1.1.1 mac host 00:01:02:03:04:05  
permit ip host 1.1.1.2 mac host 00:03:04:05:06:07  
ARP access list H3  
ARP access list H4  
permit ip host 2.1.1.2 mac host 00:03:04:05:06:08  
Switching Commands  
147  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
IGMP Snooping Configuration Commands  
This section describes the commands you use to configure IGMP snooping. The software  
supports IGMP Versions 1, 2, and 3. The IGMP snooping feature can help conserve  
bandwidth because it allows the switch to forward IP multicast traffic only to connected hosts  
that request multicast traffic. IGMPv3 adds source filtering capabilities to IGMP versions 1  
and 2.  
set igmp  
This command enables IGMP Snooping on the system (Global Config Mode) or an interface  
(Interface Config Mode). This command also enables IGMP snooping on a particular VLAN  
(VLAN Config Mode) and can enable IGMP snooping on all interfaces participating in a  
VLAN.  
If an interface has IGMP Snooping enabled and you enable this interface for routing or enlist  
it as a member of a port-channel (LAG), IGMP Snooping functionality is disabled on that  
interface. IGMP Snooping functionality is re-enabled if you disable routing or remove  
port-channel (LAG) membership from an interface that has IGMP Snooping enabled.  
The IGMP application supports the following activities:  
Validation of the IP header checksum (as well as the IGMP header checksum) and  
discarding of the frame upon checksum error.  
Maintenance of the forwarding table entries based on the MAC address versus the IP  
address.  
Flooding of unregistered multicast data packets to all ports in the VLAN.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
set igmp  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
Format  
Mode  
set igmp<vlanid>  
VLAN Config  
no set igmp  
This command disables IGMP Snooping on the system, an interface, or a VLAN.  
Format  
Mode  
no set igmp  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
Switching Commands  
148  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Format  
Mode  
no set igmp <vlanid>  
VLAN Config  
set igmp interfacemode  
This command enables IGMP Snooping on all interfaces. If an interface has IGMP Snooping  
enabled and you enable this interface for routing or enlist it as a member of a port-channel  
(LAG), IGMP Snooping functionality is disabled on that interface. IGMP Snooping  
functionality is re-enabled if you disable routing or remove port-channel (LAG) membership  
from an interface that has IGMP Snooping enabled.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
set igmp interfacemode  
Global Config  
no set igmp interfacemode  
This command disables IGMP Snooping on all interfaces.  
Format  
Mode  
no set igmp interfacemode  
Global Config  
set igmp fast-leave  
This command enables or disables IGMP Snooping fast-leave admin mode on a selected  
interface or VLAN. Enabling fast-leave allows the switch to immediately remove the layer 2  
LAN interface from its forwarding table entry upon receiving an IGMP leave message for that  
multicast group without first sending out MAC-based general queries to the interface.  
You should enable fast-leave admin mode only on VLANs where only one host is connected  
to each layer 2 LAN port. This prevents the inadvertent dropping of the other hosts that were  
connected to the same layer 2 LAN port but were still interested in receiving multicast traffic  
directed to that group. Also, fast-leave processing is supported only with IGMP version 2  
hosts.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
set igmp fast-leave  
Interface Config  
Format  
Mode  
set igmp fast-leave<vlan_id>  
VLAN Config  
Switching Commands  
149  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no set igmp fast-leave  
This command disables IGMP Snooping fast-leave admin mode on a selected interface.  
Format  
no set igmp fast-leave  
Mode  
Interface Config  
Format  
Mode  
no set igmp fast-leave<vlan_id>  
VLAN Config  
set igmp groupmembership-interval  
This command sets the IGMP Group Membership Interval time on a VLAN, one interface, or  
all interfaces. The Group Membership Interval time is the amount of time in seconds that a  
switch waits for a report from a particular group on a particular interface before deleting the  
interface from the entry. This value must be greater than the IGMPv3 Maximum Response  
time value. The range is 2–3600 seconds.  
Default  
260 seconds  
Format  
Mode  
set igmp groupmembership-interval <2-3600>  
• Interface Config  
• Global Config  
Format  
Mode  
set igmp groupmembership-interval <vlan_id> <2-3600>  
VLAN Config  
no set igmp groupmembership-interval  
This command sets the IGMPv3 Group Membership Interval time to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no set igmp groupmembership-interval  
• Interface Config  
• Global Config  
Format  
Mode  
no set igmp groupmembership-interval <vlan_id>  
VLAN Config  
set igmp maxresponse  
This command sets the IGMP Maximum Response time for the system, or on a particular  
interface or VLAN. The Maximum Response time is the amount of time in seconds that a  
switch will wait after sending a query on an interface because it did not receive a report for a  
Switching Commands  
150  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
particular group in that interface. This value must be less than the IGMP Query Interval time  
value. The range is 1–25 seconds.  
Default  
10 seconds  
Format  
Mode  
set igmp maxresponse <1-25>  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
Format  
Mode  
set igmp maxresponse <vlan_id> <1-25>  
VLAN Config  
no set igmp maxresponse  
This command sets the max response time (on the interface or VLAN) to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no set igmp maxresponse  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
Format  
Mode  
no set igmp maxresponse <vlan_id>  
VLAN Config  
set igmp mcrtrexpiretime  
This command sets the Multicast Router Present Expiration time. The time is set for the  
system, on a particular interface or VLAN. This is the amount of time in seconds that a switch  
waits for a query to be received on an interface before the interface is removed from the list  
of interfaces with multicast routers attached. The range is 0–3600 seconds. A value of 0  
indicates an infinite time-out, that is, no expiration.  
Default  
0
Format  
Mode  
set igmp mcrtrexpiretime <0-3600>  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
Format  
Mode  
set igmp mcrtrexpiretime <vlan_id> <0-3600>  
VLAN Config  
Switching Commands  
151  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no set igmp mcrtrexpiretime  
This command sets the Multicast Router Present Expiration time to 0. The time is set for the  
system, on a particular interface or a VLAN.  
Format  
no set igmp mcrtrexpiretime  
Mode  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
Format  
Mode  
no set igmp mcrtrexpiretime <vlan_id>  
VLAN Config  
set igmp mrouter  
This command configures the VLAN ID (<vlanId>) that has the multicast router mode  
enabled.  
Format  
Mode  
set igmp mrouter <vlan_id>  
Interface Config  
no set igmp mrouter  
This command disables multicast router mode for a particular VLAN ID (<vlan_id>).  
Format  
Mode  
no set igmp mrouter <vlan_id>  
Interface Config  
set igmp mrouter interface  
This command configures the interface as a multicast router interface. When configured as a  
multicast router interface, the interface is treated as a multicast router interface in all VLANs.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
set igmp mrouter interface  
Interface Config  
no set igmp mrouter interface  
This command disables the status of the interface as a statically configured multicast router  
interface.  
Format  
Mode  
no set igmp mrouter interface  
Interface Config  
Switching Commands  
152  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
set igmp report-suppression  
Use this command to suppress the IGMP reports on a given VLAN ID. In order to optimize  
the number of reports traversing the network with no added benefits, a Report Suppression  
mechanism is implemented. When more than one client responds to an MGMD query for the  
same Multicast Group address within the max-response-time, only the first response is  
forwarded to the query and others are suppressed at the switch.  
Default  
Disabled  
Format  
Mode  
set igmp report-suppression <1-4093>  
VLAN Config  
no set igmp report-suppression  
Use this command to restore the system default.  
Format  
no set igmp report-suppression  
Mode  
VLAN Config  
set igmp header-validation  
If IGMP IP header validation is enabled, then 3 fields TTL (Time To Live), ToS (Type of  
Service), and Router Alert options are checked. The fields checked depend on the IGMP  
version. The TTL field is validated in all the versions (IGMPv1, IGMPv2 and IGMPv3). The  
Router Alert field is validated in IGMPv2 and IGMPv3. The ToS field is validated only in IGMP  
version3.  
Default  
Enabled  
Format  
Mode  
set igmp header-validation  
Global Config  
no set igmp header-validation  
This command disabled the IGMP IP header validation..  
Format  
no set igmp header-validation  
Mode  
Global Config  
Switching Commands  
153  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
mac address-table multicast forbidden-unregistered vlan  
Use this command to forbid forwarding unregistered multicast addresses (in other words,  
unknown multicast traffic) on a given VLAN ID.  
Default  
Disabled  
Format  
mac address-table multicast forbidden-unregistered vlan  
<1-4093>  
Mode  
Global Config  
no mac address-table multicast forbidden-unregistered vlan  
Use this command to restore the default.  
Format  
no mac address-table multicast forbidden-unregistered  
vlan  
Mode  
Global Config  
mac address-table multicast forward-unregistered vlan  
Use this command to enable forwarding unregistered multicast address (in other words,  
unknown multicast traffic) on a given VLAN ID.  
Format  
mac address-table multicast forward-unregistered vlan  
<1-4093>  
Mode  
Global Config  
mac address-table multicast forward-all vlan  
Use this command to enable forwarding of all multicast packets on a given VLAN ID.  
Format  
mac address-table multicast forward-all vlan <1-4093>  
Mode  
Global Config  
no mac address-table multicast forward-all vlan  
Use this command to restore the system default.  
Format  
no mac address-table multicast forward-all vlan  
Mode  
Global Config  
Switching Commands  
154  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show igmpsnooping  
This command displays IGMP Snooping information. Configured information is displayed  
whether or not IGMP Snooping is enabled.  
Format  
Mode  
show igmpsnooping [<slot/port> | <vlan_id>]  
Privileged EXEC  
When the optional arguments <slot/port>or <vlan_id>are not used, the command  
displays the following information:  
Term  
Definition  
Admin Mode  
Indicates whether or not IGMP Snooping is active on the switch.  
The number of multicast control frames that are processed by the CPU.  
Multicast  
Control Frame  
Count  
Interface  
Enabled for  
IGMP Snooping  
The list of interfaces on which IGMP Snooping is enabled.  
The list of VLANS on which IGMP Snooping is enabled.  
VLANS Enabled  
for IGMP  
Snooping  
When you specify the <slot/port> values, the following information appears:  
Term  
Definition  
IGMP Snooping  
Admin Mode  
Indicates whether IGMP Snooping is active on the interface.  
Fast Leave  
Mode  
Indicates whether IGMP Snooping Fast-leave is active on the interface.  
Group  
Membership  
Interval  
The amount of time in seconds that a switch will wait for a report from a particular group  
on a particular interface before deleting the interface from the entry. This value may be  
configured.  
Maximum  
Response Time  
The amount of time the switch waits after it sends a query on an interface because it did  
not receive a report for a particular group on that interface. This value may be configured.  
Multicast  
Router Expiry  
Time  
The amount of time to wait before removing an interface from the list of interfaces with  
multicast routers attached. The interface is removed if a query is not received. This value  
may be configured.  
When you specify a value for <vlan_id>, the following information appears:  
Term  
Definition  
VLAN ID  
The VLAN ID.  
IGMP Snooping  
Admin Mode  
Indicates whether IGMP Snooping is active on the VLAN.  
Switching Commands  
155  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Fast Leave  
Mode  
Indicates whether IGMP Snooping Fast-leave is active on the VLAN.  
Group  
Membership  
Interval  
The amount of time in seconds that a switch will wait for a report from a particular group  
on a particular interface, which is participating in the VLAN, before deleting the interface  
from the entry. This value may be configured.  
Maximum  
Response Time  
The amount of time the switch waits after it sends a query on an interface, participating in  
the VLAN, because it did not receive a report for a particular group on that interface. This  
value may be configured.  
Multicast  
Router Expiry  
Time  
The amount of time to wait before removing an interface that is participating in the VLAN  
from the list of interfaces with multicast routers attached. The interface is removed if a  
query is not received. This value may be configured.  
show igmpsnooping mrouter interface  
This command displays information about statically configured ports.  
Format  
Mode  
show igmpsnooping mrouter interface <slot/port>  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Interface  
The port on which multicast router information is being displayed.  
Indicates whether multicast router is statically enabled on the interface.  
Multicast  
Router  
Attached  
VLAN ID  
The list of VLANs of which the interface is a member.  
show igmpsnooping mrouter vlan  
This command displays information about statically configured ports.  
Format  
Mode  
show igmpsnooping mrouter vlan <slot/port>  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Interface  
The port on which multicast router information is being displayed.  
The list of VLANs of which the interface is a member.  
VLAN ID  
Switching Commands  
156  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show mac-address-table igmpsnooping  
This command displays the IGMP Snooping entries in the MFDB table.  
Format  
Mode  
show mac-address-table igmpsnooping  
Privileged EXEC  
show mac address-table multicast filtering  
Term  
Definition  
MAC Address  
A multicast MAC address for which the switch has forwarding or filtering information. The  
format is two-digit hexadecimal numbers that are separated by colons, for example  
01:23:45:67:89:AB. In an IVL system the MAC address is displayed as a MAC address  
and VLAN ID combination of 8 bytes.  
Type  
The type of the entry, which is either static (added by the user) or dynamic (added to the  
table as a result of a learning process or protocol).  
Description  
Interfaces  
The text description of this multicast table entry.  
The list of interfaces that are designated for forwarding (Fwd:) and filtering (Flt:).  
Use this command to display the multicast filtering details for a given VLAN.  
Format  
show mac address-table multicast filtering  
Mode  
Privileged EXEC  
Parameter  
vlan-id  
Description  
A valid VLAN ID  
The filtering mode  
mode  
The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(netgear switch) #show mac address-table multicast filtering 1  
VLAN-ID....... 1  
Mode.......... Forward-Forbidden-Unregistered  
IGMP Snooping Querier Commands  
IGMP Snooping requires that one central switch or router periodically query all end-devices  
on the network to announce their multicast memberships. This central device is the “IGMP  
Querier”. The IGMP query responses, known as IGMP reports, keep the switch updated with  
the current multicast group membership on a port-by-port basis. If the switch does not  
receive updated membership information in a timely fashion, it will stop forwarding multicasts  
to the port where the end device is located.  
This section describes commands used to configure and display information about IGMP  
Snooping Queriers on the network and, separately, on VLANs.  
Switching Commands  
157  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
set igmp querier  
Use this command to enable IGMP Snooping Querier on the system, using Global Config  
mode, or on a VLAN. Using this command, you can specify the IP Address that the Snooping  
Querier switch should use as the source address while generating periodic queries.  
If a VLAN has IGMP Snooping Querier enabled and IGMP Snooping is operationally disabled  
on it, IGMP Snooping Querier functionality is disabled on that VLAN. IGMP Snooping  
functionality is re-enabled if IGMP Snooping is operational on the VLAN.  
Note: The Querier IP Address assigned for a VLAN takes preference over  
global configuration.  
The IGMP Snooping Querier application supports sending periodic general queries on the  
VLAN to solicit membership reports.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
set igmp querier [<vlan-id>] [address ipv4_address]  
• Global Config  
• VLAN Mode  
no set igmp querier  
Use this command to disable IGMP Snooping Querier on the system. Use the optional  
addressparameter to reset the querier address to 0.0.0.0.  
Format  
Mode  
no set igmp querier [<vlan-id>] [address]  
• Global Config  
• VLAN Mode  
set igmp querier query-interval  
Use this command to set the IGMP Querier Query Interval time. It is the amount of time in  
seconds that the switch waits before sending another general query.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
set igmp querier query-interval <1-18000>  
Global Config  
Switching Commands  
158  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no set igmp querier query-interval  
Use this command to set the IGMP Querier Query Interval time to its default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no set igmp querier query-interval  
Global Config  
set igmp querier timer expiry  
Use this command to set the IGMP Querier timer expiration period. It is the time period that  
the switch remains in Non-Querier mode once it has discovered that there is a Multicast  
Querier in the network.  
Default  
60 seconds  
Format  
Mode  
set igmp querier timer expiry <60-300>  
Global Config  
no set igmp querier timer expiry  
Use this command to set the IGMP Querier timer expiration period to its default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no set igmp querier timer expiry  
Global Config  
set igmp querier version  
Use this command to set the IGMP version of the query that the snooping switch is going to  
send periodically.  
Default  
1
Format  
Mode  
set igmp querier version <1-2>  
Global Config  
no set igmp querier version  
Use this command to set the IGMP Querier version to its default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no set igmp querier version  
Global Config  
set igmp querier election participate  
Use this command to enable the Snooping Querier to participate in the Querier Election  
process when it discovers the presence of another Querier in the VLAN. When this mode is  
enabled, if the Snooping Querier finds that the other Querier’s source address is better (less)  
Switching Commands  
159  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
than the Snooping Querier’s address, it stops sending periodic queries. If the Snooping  
Querier wins the election, then it will continue sending periodic queries.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
set igmp querier election participate  
VLAN Config  
no set igmp querier election participate  
Use this command to set the Snooping Querier not to participate in querier election but go  
into non-querier mode as soon as it discovers the presence of another querier in the same  
VLAN.  
Format  
Mode  
no set igmp querier election participate  
VLAN Config  
show igmpsnooping querier  
Use this command to display IGMP Snooping Querier information. Configured information is  
displayed whether or not IGMP Snooping Querier is enabled.  
Format  
Mode  
show igmpsnooping querier [{detail | vlan <vlanid>}]  
Privileged EXEC  
When the optional argument <vlanid> is not used, the command displays the following  
information.  
Field  
Description  
Admin Mode  
Indicates whether or not IGMP Snooping Querier is active on the switch.  
The version of IGMP that will be used while sending out the queries.  
Admin Version  
Querier  
Address  
The IP Address which will be used in the IPv4 header while sending out IGMP queries. It  
can be configured using the appropriate command.  
Query Interval  
The amount of time in seconds that a Snooping Querier waits before sending out the  
periodic general query.  
Querier Timeout  
The amount of time to wait in the Non-Querier operational state before moving to a  
Querier state.  
Switching Commands  
160  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
When you specify a value for <vlanid>, the following additional information appears.  
Field  
Description  
VLAN Admin  
Mode  
Indicates whether iGMP Snooping Querier is active on the VLAN.  
VLAN  
Operational  
State  
Indicates whether IGMP Snooping Querier is in “Querier” or “Non-Querier” state. When  
the switch is in Querierstate, it will send out periodic general queries. When in  
Non-Querierstate, it will wait for moving to Querier state and does not send out any  
queries.  
VLAN  
Indicates the time to wait before removing a Leave from a host upon receiving a Leave  
request. This value is calculated dynamically from the Queries received from the  
network. If the Snooping Switch is in Querier state, then it is equal to the configured  
value.  
Operational  
Max Response  
Time  
QuerierElection  
Participation  
Indicates whether the IGMP Snooping Querier participates in querier election if it  
discovers the presence of a querier in the VLAN.  
Querier VLAN  
Address  
The IP address will be used in the IPv4 header while sending out IGMP queries on this  
VLAN. It can be configured using the appropriate command.  
Operational  
Version  
The version of IPv4 will be used while sending out IGMP queries on this VLAN.  
Indicates the IP address of the most recent Querier from which a Query was received.  
Last Querier  
Address  
Last Querier  
Version  
Indicates the IGMP version of the most recent Querier from which a Query was received  
on this VLAN.  
When the optional argument detailis used, the command shows the global information  
and the information for all Querier-enabled VLANs.  
MLD Snooping Commands  
This section describes commands used for MLD Snooping. In IPv4, Layer 2 switches can  
use IGMP Snooping to limit the flooding of multicast traffic by dynamically configuring Layer 2  
interfaces so that multicast traffic is forwarded only to those interfaces associated with IP  
multicast addresses. In IPv6, MLD Snooping performs a similar function. With MLD  
Snooping, IPv6 multicast data is selectively forwarded to a list of ports that want to receive  
the data, instead of being flooded to all ports in a VLAN. This list is constructed by snooping  
IPv6 multicast control packets.  
set mld  
Use this command to enable MLD Snooping on the system (Global Config Mode) or an  
Interface (Interface Config Mode). This command also enables MLD Snooping on a particular  
VLAN and enables MLD Snooping on all interfaces participating in a VLAN.  
If an interface has MLD Snooping enabled and you enable this interface for routing or enlist it  
as a member of a port-channel (LAG), MLD Snooping functionality is disabled on that  
Switching Commands  
161  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
interface. MLD Snooping functionality is re-enabled if you disable routing or remove port  
channel (LAG) membership from an interface that has MLD Snooping enabled.  
MLD Snooping supports the following activities:  
Validation of address version, payload length consistencies and discarding of the frame  
upon error.  
Maintenance of the forwarding table entries based on the MAC address versus the IPv6  
address.  
Flooding of unregistered multicast data packets to all ports in the VLAN.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
set mld vlanid  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
• VLAN Mode  
no set mld  
Use this command to disable MLD Snooping on the system.  
Format  
Mode  
set mld vlanid  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
• VLAN Mode  
set mld interfacemode  
Use this command to enable MLD Snooping on all interfaces. If an interface has MLD  
Snooping enabled and you enable this interface for routing or enlist it as a member of a  
port-channel (LAG), MLD Snooping functionality is disabled on that interface. MLD Snooping  
functionality is re-enabled if you disable routing or remove port-channel (LAG) membership  
from an interface that has MLD Snooping enabled.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
set mld interfacemode  
Global Config  
no set mld interfacemode  
Use this command to disable MLD Snooping on all interfaces.  
Format  
Mode  
no set mld interfacemode  
Global Config  
Switching Commands  
162  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
set mld fast-leave  
Use this command to enable MLD Snooping fast-leave admin mode on a selected interface  
or VLAN. Enabling fast-leave allows the switch to immediately remove the Layer 2 LAN  
interface from its forwarding table entry upon receiving and MLD done message for that  
multicast group without first sending out MAC-based general queries to the interface.  
Note: You should enable fast-leave admin mode only on VLANs where  
only one host is connected to each Layer 2 LAN port. This prevents  
the inadvertent dropping of the other hosts that were connected to  
the same layer 2 LAN port but were still interested in receiving  
multicast traffic directed to that group.  
Note: Fast-leave processing is supported only with MLD version 1 hosts.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
set mld fast-leave vlanid  
• Interface Config  
• VLAN Mode  
no set mld fast-leave  
Use this command to disable MLD Snooping fast-leave admin mode on a selected interface.  
Format  
Mode  
no set mld fast-leave vlanid  
• Interface Config  
• VLAN Mode  
set mld groupmembership-interval  
Use this command to set the MLD Group Membership Interval time on a VLAN, one interface  
or all interfaces. The Group Membership Interval time is the amount of time in seconds that a  
switch waits for a report from a particular group on a particular interface before deleting the  
interface from the entry. This value must be greater than the MLDv2 Maximum Response  
time value. The range is 2 to 3600 seconds.  
Default  
260 seconds  
Switching Commands  
163  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Format  
Mode  
set mld groupmembership-interval vlanid 2-3600  
• Interface Config  
• Global Config  
• VLAN Mode  
no set groupmembership-interval  
Use this command to set the MLDv2 Group Membership Interval time to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no set mld groupmembership-interval  
• Interface Config  
• Global Config  
• VLAN Mode  
set mld maxresponse  
Use this command to set the MLD Maximum Response time for the system, on a particular  
interface or VLAN. The Maximum Response time is the amount of time in seconds that a  
switch will wait after sending a query on an interface because it did not receive a report for a  
particular group in that interface. This value must be less than the MLD Query Interval time  
value. The range is 1–65 seconds.  
Default  
10 seconds  
Format  
Mode  
set mld maxresponse 1-65  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
• VLAN Mode  
no set mld maxresponse  
Use this command to set the max response time (on the interface or VLAN) to the default  
value.  
Format  
Mode  
no set mld maxresponse  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
• VLAN Mode  
set mld mcrtexpiretime  
Use this command to set the Multicast Router Present Expiration time. The time is set for the  
system, on a particular interface or VLAN. This is the amount of time in seconds that a switch  
waits for a query to be received on an interface before the interface is removed from the list of  
Switching Commands  
164  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
interfaces with multicast routers attached. The range is 0–3600 seconds. A value of 0  
indicates an infinite timeout, that is, no expiration.  
Default  
0
Format  
Mode  
set mld mcrtexpiretime vlanid 0-3600  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
no set mld mcrtexpiretime  
Use this command to set the Multicast Router Present Expiration time to 0. The time is set for  
the system, on a particular interface or a VLAN.  
Format  
Mode  
no set mld mcrtexpiretime vlanid  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
set mld mrouter  
Use this command to configure the VLAN ID for the VLAN that has the multicast router  
attached mode enabled.  
Format  
Mode  
set mld mrouter vlanid  
Interface Config  
no set mld mrouter  
Use this command to disable multicast router attached mode for a VLAN with a particular  
VLAN ID.  
Format  
Mode  
no set mld mrouter vlanid  
Interface Config  
set mld mrouter interface  
Use this command to configure the interface as a multicast router-attached interface. When  
configured as a multicast router interface, the interface is treated as a multicast  
router-attached interface in all VLANs.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
set mld mrouter interface  
Interface Config  
Switching Commands  
165  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no set mld mrouter interface  
Use this command to disable the status of the interface as a statically configured multicast  
router-attached interface.  
Format  
Mode  
no set mld mrouter interface  
Interface Config  
show mldsnooping  
Use this command to display MLD Snooping information. Configured information is displayed  
whether or not MLD Snooping is enabled.  
Format  
Mode  
show mldsnooping [slot/port | vlanid]  
Privileged EXEC  
When the optional arguments slot/portor vlanidare not used, the command displays  
the following information.  
Term  
Definition  
Admin Mode  
Indicates whether or not MLD Snooping is active on the switch.  
Interfaces on which MLD Snooping is enabled.  
Interfaces  
Enabled for  
MLD Snooping  
MLD Control  
Frame Count  
Displays the number of MLD Control frames that are processed by the CPU.  
VLANs on which MLD Snooping is enabled.  
VLANs Enabled  
for MLD  
Snooping  
When you specify the slot/portvalues, the following information displays.  
Term  
Definition  
MLD Snooping  
Admin Mode  
Indicates whether MLD Snooping is active on the interface.  
Fast Leave  
Mode  
Indicates whether MLD Snooping Fast Leave is active on the VLAN.  
Group  
Membership  
Interval  
Shows the amount of time in seconds that a switch will wait for a report from a particular  
group on a particular interface, which is participating in the VLAN, before deleting the  
interface from the entry. This value may be configured.  
Max Response  
Time  
Displays the amount of time the switch waits after it sends a query on an interface,  
participating in the VLAN, because it did not receive a report for a particular group on that  
interface. This value may be configured.  
Multicast  
Router Present  
Expiration Time  
Displays the amount of time to wait before removing an interface that is participating in  
the VLAN from the list of interfaces with multicast routers attached. The interface is  
removed if a query is not received. This value may be configured.  
Switching Commands  
166  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
When you specify a value for vlanid, the following information appears.  
Term  
Definition  
VLAN Admin  
Mode  
Indicates whether MLD Snooping is active on the VLAN.  
show mldsnooping mrouter interface  
Use this command to display information about statically configured multicast router attached  
interfaces.  
Format  
Mode  
show mldsnooping mrouter interface slot/port  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Interface  
Shows the interface on which multicast router information is being displayed.  
Indicates whether multicast router is statically enabled on the interface.  
Multicast  
Router  
Attached  
VLAN ID  
Displays the list of VLANs of which the interface is a member.  
show mldsnooping mrouter vlan  
Use this command to display information about statically configured multicast router-attached  
interfaces.  
Format  
Mode  
show mldsnooping mrouter vlan slot/port  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Interface  
Shows the interface on which multicast router information is being displayed.  
Displays the list of VLANs of which the interface is a member.  
VLAN ID  
show mac-address-table mldsnooping  
Use this command to display the MLD Snooping entries in the Multicast Forwarding  
Database (MFDB) table.  
Format  
Mode  
show mac-address-table mldsnooping  
Privileged EXEC  
Switching Commands  
167  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
VLAN ID  
The VLAN in which the MAC address is learned.  
MAC Address  
Type  
A multicast MAC address for which the switch has forwarding or filtering information. The  
format is 6 two-digit hexadecimal numbers that are separated by colons, for example  
01:23:45:67:89:AB.  
The type of entry, which is either static (added by the user) or dynamic (added to the  
table as a result of a learning process or protocol.)  
Description  
Interfaces  
The text description of this multicast table entry.  
The list of interfaces that are designated for forwarding (Fwd:) and filtering (Flt:).  
MLD Snooping Querier Commands  
In an IPv6 environment, MLD Snooping requires that one central switch or router periodically  
query all end-devices on the network to announce their multicast memberships. This central  
device is the MLD Querier. The MLD query responses, known as MLD reports, keep the  
switch updated with the current multicast group membership on a port-by-port basis. If the  
switch does not receive updated membership information in a timely fashion, it will stop  
forwarding multicasts to the port where the end device is located.  
This section describes the commands you use to configure and display information on MLD  
Snooping queries on the network and, separately, on VLANs.  
set mld querier  
Use this command to enable MLD Snooping Querier on the system (Global Config Mode) or  
on a VLAN. Using this command, you can specify the IP address that the snooping querier  
switch should use as a source address while generating periodic queries.  
If a VLAN has MLD Snooping Querier enabled and MLD Snooping is operationally disabled  
on it, MLD Snooping Querier functionality is disabled on that VLAN. MLD Snooping  
functionality is re-enabled if MLD Snooping is operational on the VLAN.  
The MLD Snooping Querier sends periodic general queries on the VLAN to solicit  
membership reports.  
Default  
Format  
Mode  
disabled  
set mld querier [vlan-id] [address ipv6_address]  
• Global Config  
• VLAN Mode  
Switching Commands  
168  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no set mld querier  
Use this command to disable MLD Snooping Querier on the system. Use the optional  
parameter addressto reset the querier address.  
no set mld querier [vlan-id][address]  
Format  
Mode  
• Global Config  
• VLAN Mode  
set mld querier query_interval  
Use this command to set the MLD Querier Query Interval time. This is the amount of time in  
seconds that the switch waits before sending another general query.  
Default  
Format  
Mode  
disabled  
set mld querier query_interval <1-18000>  
Global Config  
no set mld querier query_interval  
Use this command to set the MLD Querier Query Interval time to its default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no set mld querier query_interval  
Global Config  
set mld querier timer expiry  
Use this command to set the MLD Querier timer expiration period. This is the time period that  
the switch remains in Non-Querier mode once it discovers that there is a Multicast Querier in  
the network.  
Default  
Format  
Mode  
60 seconds  
set mld querier timer expiry <60-300>  
Global Config  
no set mld querier timer expiry  
Use this command to set the MLD Querier timer expiration period to its default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no set mld querier timer expiry  
Global Config  
Switching Commands  
169  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
set mld querier election participate  
Use this command to enable the Snooping Querier to participate in the Querier Election  
process when it discovers the presence of another Querier in the VLAN. When this mode is  
enabled, if the Snooping Querier finds that the other Querier’s source address is better (less)  
than the Snooping Querier’s address, it stops sending periodic queries. If the Snooping  
Querier wins the election, then it will continue sending periodic queries.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
set mld querier election participate  
VLAN Config  
no set mld querier election participate  
Use this command to set the snooping querier not to participate in querier election, but go  
into a non-querier mode as soon as it discovers the presence of another querier in the same  
VLAN.  
Format  
Mode  
no set mld querier election participate  
VLAN Config  
show mldsnooping querier  
Use this command to display MLD Snooping Querier information. Configured information is  
displayed whether or not MLD Snooping Querier is enabled.  
Format  
Mode  
show mldsnooping querier [{detail | vlan <vlanid>}]  
Privileged EXEC  
When the optional arguments vlandidare not used, the command displays the following  
information.  
Field  
Description  
Admin Mode  
Indicates whether or not MLD Snooping Querier is active on the switch.  
Admin Version  
Indicates the version of MLD that will be used while sending out the queries. This is  
defaulted to MLD v1 and it cannot be changed.  
Querier Address  
Query Interval  
Shows the IP address which will be used in the IPv6 header while sending out MLD  
queries. It can be configured using the appropriate command.  
Shows the amount of time in seconds that a Snooping Querier waits before sending  
out the periodic general query.  
Querier Timeout  
Displays the amount of time to wait in the Non-Querier operational state before moving  
to a Querier state.  
Switching Commands  
170  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
When you specify a value for vlanid, the following information appears.  
Field  
Description  
VLAN Admin  
Mode  
Indicates whether MLD Snooping Querier is active on the VLAN.  
VLAN Operational Indicates whether MLD Snooping Querier is in “Querier” or “Non-Querier” state. When  
State  
the switch is in Querier state, it will send out periodic general queries. When in  
Non-Querier state, it will wait for moving to Querier state and does not send out any  
queries.  
Operational Max  
Response Time  
Indicates the time to wait before removing a Leave from a host upon receiving a Leave  
request. This value is calculated dynamically from the Queries received from the  
network. If the Snooping Switch is in Querier state, then it is equal to the configured  
value.  
Querier Election  
Participate  
Indicates whether the MLD Snooping Querier participates in querier election if it  
discovers the presence of a querier in the VLAN.  
Querier VLAN  
Address  
The IP address will be used in the IPv6 header while sending out MLD queries on this  
VLAN. It can be configured using the appropriate command.  
Operational  
Version  
This version of IPv6 will be used while sending out MLD queriers on this VLAN.  
Last Querier  
Address  
Indicates the IP address of the most recent Querier from which a Query was received.  
Last Querier  
Version  
Indicates the MLD version of the most recent Querier from which a Query was received  
on this VLAN.  
When the optional argument detailis used, the command shows the global information  
and the information for all Querier-enabled VLANs.  
Port Security Commands  
This section describes the commands you use to configure Port Security on the switch. Port  
security, which is also known as port MAC locking, allows you to secure the network by  
locking allowable MAC addresses on a port. Packets with a matching source MAC address  
are forwarded normally, and all other packets are discarded.  
Note: To enable the SNMP trap specific to port security, see snmp-server  
Switching Commands  
171  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
port-security  
This command enables port locking at the system level (Global Config) or port level (Interface  
Config).  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
port-security  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
no port-security  
This command disables port locking for one (Interface Config) or all (Global Config) ports.  
Format  
Mode  
no port-security  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
port-security max-dynamic  
This command sets the maximum number of dynamically locked MAC addresses allowed on  
a specific port.  
Default  
600  
Format  
Mode  
port-security max-dynamic<maxvalue>  
Interface Config  
no port-security max-dynamic  
This command resets the maximum number of dynamically locked MAC addresses allowed  
on a specific port to its default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no port-security max-dynamic  
Interface Config  
port-security max-static  
This command sets the maximum number of statically locked MAC addresses allowed on a  
port  
.
Default  
20  
Format  
Mode  
port-security max-static<maxvalue>  
Interface Config  
Switching Commands  
172  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no port-security max-static  
This command sets maximum number of statically locked MAC addresses to the default  
value.  
Format  
Mode  
no port-security max-static  
Interface Config  
port-security mac-address  
This command adds a MAC address to the list of statically locked MAC addresses. The  
<vid>is the VLAN ID.  
Format  
Mode  
port-security mac-address <mac-address> <vid>  
Interface Config  
no port-security mac-address  
This command removes a MAC address from the list of statically locked MAC addresses.  
Format  
Mode  
no port-security mac-address <mac-address> <vid>  
Interface Config  
port-security mac-address move  
This command converts dynamically locked MAC addresses to statically locked addresses.  
Format  
Mode  
port-security mac-address move  
Interface Config  
port-security mac-address sticky  
This command enables sticky mode Port MAC Locking on a port. If accompanied by a MAC  
address and a VLAN id (for interface config mode only), it adds a sticky MAC address to the  
list of statically locked MAC addresses. These sticky addresses are converted back to  
dynamically locked addresses if sticky mode is disabled on the port. The <vid>is the VLAN  
ID. The Global command applies the sticky mode to all valid interfaces (physical and LAG).  
There is no global sticky mode as such.  
Sticky addresses that are dynamically learned will appear in show running config as  
port-security mac-address sticky <mac> <vid>entries. This distinguishes them  
from static entries.  
Format  
port-security mac-address sticky [<mac-address> <vid>]  
Modes  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
Switching Commands  
173  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no port-security mac-address sticky  
The no form removes the sticky mode. The sticky MAC address can be deleted by using the  
command no port-security mac-address <mac-address> <vid>.  
Format  
no port-security mac-address sticky [<mac-address>  
<vid>]  
Modes  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
show port-security  
This command displays the port-security settings. If you do not use a parameter, the  
command displays the settings for the entire system. Use the optional parameters to display  
the settings on a specific interface or on all interfaces.  
Format  
Mode  
show port-security [{<slot/port> | all}]  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Admin Mode  
Port Locking mode for the entire system. This field displays if you do not supply any  
parameters.  
For each interface, or for the interface you specify, the following information appears:  
Term  
Definition  
Admin Mode  
Dynamic Limit  
Static Limit  
Port Locking mode for the Interface.  
Maximum dynamically allocated MAC Addresses.  
Maximum statically allocated MAC Addresses.  
Whether violation traps are enabled.  
Violation Trap  
Mode  
show port-security dynamic  
This command displays the dynamically locked MAC addresses for the port.  
Format  
Mode  
show port-security dynamic[lag <lag-intf-num> | <slot/port>]  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
MAC Address  
MAC Address of dynamically locked MAC.  
Switching Commands  
174  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show port-security static  
This command displays the statically locked MAC addresses for port.  
Format  
show port-security static [lag <lag-intf-num> | <slot/port>]  
Mode  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
MAC Address  
MAC Address of statically locked MAC.  
show port-security violation  
This command displays the source MAC address of the last packet discarded on a locked  
port.  
Format  
Mode  
show port-security violation[lag <lag-intf-num> | <slot/port>]  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
MAC Address  
MAC Address of discarded packet on locked port.  
LLDP (802.1AB) Commands  
This section describes the command you use to configure Link Layer Discovery Protocol  
(LLDP), which is defined in the IEEE 802.1AB specification. LLDP allows stations on an 802  
LAN to advertise major capabilities and physical descriptions. The advertisements allow a  
network management system (NMS) to access and display this information.  
lldp transmit  
Use this command to enable the LLDP advertise capability.  
Default  
enabled  
Format  
Mode  
lldp transmit  
Interface Config  
no lldp transmit  
Use this command to return the local data transmission capability to the default.  
Format  
Mode  
no lldp transmit  
Interface Config  
Switching Commands  
175  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
lldp receive  
Use this command to enable the LLDP receive capability.  
Default  
enabled  
Format  
Mode  
lldp receive  
Interface Config  
no lldp receive  
Use this command to return the reception of LLDPDUs to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no lldp receive  
Interface Config  
lldp timers  
Use this command to set the timing parameters for local data transmission on ports enabled  
for LLDP. The <interval-seconds>determines the number of seconds to wait between  
transmitting local data LLDPDUs. The range is 1-32768 seconds. The <hold-value>is the  
multiplier on the transmit interval that sets the TTL in local data LLDPDUs. The multiplier  
range is 2-10. The <reinit-seconds>is the delay before re-initialization, and the range is  
1-0 seconds.  
Default  
• interval—30 seconds  
• hold—4  
• reinit—2 seconds  
Format  
Mode  
lldp timers [interval <interval-seconds>] [hold <hold-value>] [reinit  
<reinit-seconds>]  
Global Config  
no lldp timers  
Use this command to return any or all timing parameters for local data transmission on ports  
enabled for LLDP to the default values.  
Format  
Mode  
no lldp timers [interval] [hold] [reinit]  
Global Config  
lldp transmit-tlv  
Use this command to specify which optional type length values (TLVs) in the 802.1AB basic  
management set are transmitted in the LLDPDUs. Use sys-name to transmit the system  
name TLV. To configure the system name, see snmp-server on page 670. Use sys-descto  
transmit the system description TLV. Use sys-capto transmit the system capabilities TLV.  
Switching Commands  
176  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Use port-descto transmit the port description TLV. To configure the port description, see  
Default  
all optional TLVs are included  
Format  
Mode  
lldp transmit-tlv [sys-desc] [sys-name] [sys-cap] [port-desc]  
Interface Config  
no lldp transmit-tlv  
Use this command to remove an optional TLV from the LLDPDUs. Use the command without  
parameters to remove all optional TLVs from the LLDPDU.  
Format  
Mode  
no lldp transmit-tlv [sys-desc] [sys-name] [sys-cap] [port-desc]  
Interface Config  
lldp transmit-mgmt  
Use this command to include transmission of the local system management address  
information in the LLDPDUs.  
Default  
enabled  
Format  
Mode  
lldp transmit-mgmt  
Interface Config  
no lldp transmit-mgmt  
Use this command to include transmission of the local system management address  
information in the LLDPDUs. Use this command to cancel inclusion of the management  
information in LLDPDUs.  
Format  
Mode  
no lldp transmit-mgmt  
Interface Config  
lldp notification  
Use this command to enable remote data change notifications.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
lldp notification  
Interface Config  
Switching Commands  
177  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no lldp notification  
Use this command to disable notifications.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
no lldp notification  
Interface Config  
lldp notification-interval  
Use this command to configure how frequently the system sends remote data change  
notifications. The <interval>parameter is the number of seconds to wait between sending  
notifications. The valid interval range is 5-3600 seconds.  
Default  
5
Format  
Mode  
lldp notification-interval <interval>  
Global Config  
no lldp notification-interval  
Use this command to return the notification interval to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no lldp notification-interval  
Global Config  
clear lldp statistics  
Use this command to reset all LLDP statistics, including MED-related information.  
Format  
Mode  
clear lldp statistics  
Privileged Exec  
clear lldp remote-data  
Use this command to delete all information from the LLDP remote data table, including  
MED-related information.  
Format  
Mode  
clear lldp remote-data  
Global Config  
Switching Commands  
178  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show lldp  
Use this command to display a summary of the current LLDP configuration.  
Format  
show lldp  
Mode  
Privileged Exec  
Term  
Definition  
Transmit  
Interval  
How frequently the system transmits local data LLDPDUs, in seconds.  
Transmit Hold  
Multiplier  
The multiplier on the transmit interval that sets the TTL in local data LLDPDUs.  
Re-initialization  
Delay  
The delay before re-initialization, in seconds.  
Notification  
Interval  
How frequently the system sends remote data change notifications, in seconds.  
show lldp interface  
Use this command to display a summary of the current LLDP configuration for a specific  
interface or for all interfaces.  
Format  
Mode  
show lldp interface {<slot/port> | all}  
Privileged Exec  
Term  
Definition  
Interface  
The interface in a slot/port format.  
Link  
Shows whether the link is up or down.  
Shows whether the interface transmits LLDPDUs.  
Shows whether the interface receives LLDPDUs.  
Shows whether the interface sends remote data change notifications.  
Transmit  
Receive  
Notify  
TLVs  
Shows whether the interface sends optional TLVs in the LLDPDUs. The TLV codes can  
be 0 (Port Description), 1 (System Name), 2 (System Description), or 3 (System  
Capability).  
Mgmt  
Shows whether the interface transmits system management address information in the  
LLDPDUs.  
Switching Commands  
179  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show lldp statistics  
Use this command to display the current LLDP traffic and remote table statistics for a specific  
interface or for all interfaces.  
Format  
show lldp statistics{<slot/port> | all}  
Mode  
Privileged Exec  
Term  
Definition  
Last Update  
The amount of time since the last update to the remote table in days, hours, minutes, and  
seconds.  
Total Inserts  
Total Deletes  
Total Drops  
Total number of inserts to the remote data table.  
Total number of deletes from the remote data table.  
Total number of times the complete remote data received was not inserted due to  
insufficient resources.  
Total Ageouts  
Total number of times a complete remote data entry was deleted because the Time to  
Live interval expired.  
The table contains the following column headings:  
Term  
Definition  
Interface  
The interface in slot/port format.  
Transmit Total  
Receive Total  
Discards  
Total number of LLDP packets transmitted on the port.  
Total number of LLDP packets received on the port.  
Total number of LLDP frames discarded on the port for any reason.  
The number of invalid LLDP frames received on the port.  
Errors  
Ageouts  
Total number of times a complete remote data entry was deleted for the port because the  
Time to Live interval expired.  
TLV Discards  
The number of TLVs discarded.  
TLV Unknowns  
Total number of LLDP TLVs received on the port where the type value is in the reserved  
range, and not recognized.  
TLV MED  
TVL802.1  
TVL802.3  
Total number of LLDP MED TLVs received on the local ports.  
Total number of 802.1 LLDP TLVs received on the local ports.  
Total number of 802.3 LLDP TLVs received on the local ports.  
Switching Commands  
180  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show lldp remote-device  
Use this command to display summary information about remote devices that transmit  
current LLDP data to the system. You can show information about LLDP remote data  
received on all ports or on a specific port.  
Format  
show lldp remote-device {<slot/port> | all}  
Mode  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Local Interface  
The interface that received the LLDPDU from the remote device.  
An internal identifier to the switch to mark each remote device to the system.  
RemID  
Chassis ID  
The ID that is sent by a remote device as part of the LLDP message, it is usually a MAC  
address of the device.  
Port ID  
The port number that transmitted the LLDPDU.  
The system name of the remote device.  
System Name  
Example: The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(switch) #show lldp remote-device all  
LLDP Remote Device Summary  
Local  
Interface RemID  
Chassis ID  
Port ID  
System Name  
------- ------- -------------------- ------------------ ------------------  
0/1  
0/2  
0/3  
0/4  
0/5  
0/6  
0/7  
0/7  
0/7  
0/7  
0/7  
0/7  
0/8  
0/9  
0/10  
0/11  
0/12  
2
3
4
5
1
6
00:FC:E3:90:01:0F  
00:FC:E3:90:01:0F  
00:FC:E3:90:01:0F  
00:FC:E3:90:01:0F  
00:FC:E3:90:01:0F  
00:FC:E3:90:01:0F  
00:FC:E3:90:01:11  
00:FC:E3:90:01:12  
00:FC:E3:90:01:13  
00:FC:E3:90:01:14  
00:FC:E3:90:03:11  
00:FC:E3:90:04:11  
--More-- or (q)uit  
Switching Commands  
181  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show lldp remote-device detail  
Use this command to display detailed information about remote devices that transmit current  
LLDP data to an interface on the system.  
Format  
show lldp remote-device detail <slot/port>  
Mode  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Local Interface  
The interface that received the LLDPDU from the remote device.  
An internal identifier to the switch to mark each remote device to the system.  
Remote  
Identifier  
Chassis ID  
Subtype  
The type of identification used in the Chassis ID field.  
The chassis of the remote device.  
Chassis ID  
Port ID Subtype  
Port ID  
The type of port on the remote device.  
The port number that transmitted the LLDPDU.  
The system name of the remote device.  
System Name  
System  
Description  
Describes the remote system by identifying the system name and versions of hardware,  
operating system, and networking software supported in the device.  
Port  
Description  
Describes the port in an alpha-numeric format. The port description is configurable.  
Indicates the primary function(s) of the device.  
System  
Capabilities  
Supported  
System  
Capabilities  
Enabled  
Shows which of the supported system capabilities are enabled.  
Management  
Address  
For each interface on the remote device with an LLDP agent, lists the type of address the  
remote LLDP agent uses and specifies the address used to obtain information related to  
the device.  
Time To Live  
The amount of time (in seconds) the remote device's information received in the  
LLDPDU should be treated as valid information.  
Example: The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(Switch) #show lldp remote-device detail 0/7  
LLDP Remote Device Detail  
Local Interface: 0/7  
Remote Identifier: 2  
Chassis ID Subtype: MAC Address  
Chassis ID: 00:FC:E3:90:01:0F  
Port ID Subtype: MAC Address  
Switching Commands  
182  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Port ID: 00:FC:E3:90:01:11  
System Name:  
System Description:  
Port Description:  
System Capabilities Supported:  
System Capabilities Enabled:  
Time to Live: 24 seconds  
show lldp local-device  
Use this command to display summary information about the advertised LLDP local data.  
This command can display summary information or detail for each interface.  
Format  
Mode  
show lldp local-device {<slot/port> | all}  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Interface  
The interface in a slot/port format.  
The port ID associated with this interface.  
The port description associated with the interface.  
Port ID  
Port  
Description  
show lldp local-device detail  
Use this command to display detailed information about the LLDP data a specific interface  
transmits.  
Format  
Mode  
show lldp local-device detail <slot/port>  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Interface  
The interface that sends the LLDPDU.  
The type of identification used in the Chassis ID field.  
Chassis ID  
Subtype  
Chassis ID  
The chassis of the local device.  
Port ID Subtype  
Port ID  
The type of port on the local device.  
The port number that transmitted the LLDPDU.  
The system name of the local device.  
System Name  
System  
Description  
Describes the local system by identifying the system name and versions of hardware,  
operating system, and networking software supported in the device.  
Port  
Description  
Describes the port in an alpha-numeric format.  
Switching Commands  
183  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
System  
Capabilities  
Supported  
Indicates the primary function(s) of the device.  
System  
Capabilities  
Enabled  
Shows which of the supported system capabilities are enabled.  
Management  
Address  
The type of address and the specific address the local LLDP agent uses to send and  
receive information.  
LLDP-MED Commands  
Link Layer Discovery Protocol - Media Endpoint Discovery (LLDP-MED) (ANSI-TIA-1057)  
provides an extension to the LLDP standard. Specifically, LLDP-MED provides extensions for  
network configuration and policy, device location, Power over Ethernet (PoE) management  
and inventory management.  
lldp med  
Use this command to enable MED. By enabling MED, you will be effectively enabling the  
transmit and receive function of LLDP.  
Default  
enabled  
Format  
Mode  
lldp med  
Interface Config  
no lldp med  
Use this command to disable MED.  
Format  
Mode  
no lldp med  
Interface Config  
lldp med confignotification  
Use this command to configure all the ports to send the topology change notification.  
Default  
enabled  
Format  
Mode  
lldp med confignotification  
Interface Config  
Switching Commands  
184  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no ldp med confignotification  
Use this command to disable notifications.  
Format  
Mode  
no lldp med confignotification  
Interface Config  
lldp med transmit-tlv  
Use this command to specify which optional Type Length Values (TLVs) in the LLDP MED  
set will be transmitted in the Link Layer Discovery Protocol Data Units (LLDPDUs).  
Default  
By default, the capabilities and network policy TLVs are included.  
Format  
Mode  
lldp med transmit-tlv [capabilities] [ex-pd] [ex-pse] [inventory]  
[location] [network-policy]  
Interface Config  
Term  
Definition  
capabilities  
Transmit the LLDP capabilities TLV.  
Transmit the LLDP extended PD TLV.  
Transmit the LLDP extended PSE TLV.  
Transmit the LLDP inventory TLV.  
Transmit the LLDP location TLV.  
Transmit the LLDP network policy TLV.  
ex-pd  
ex-pse  
inventory  
location  
network-policy  
Note: The current implementation supports one network policy: the voice  
VLAN as defined by the voice vlancommands.  
no lldp med transmit-tlv  
Use this command to remove a TLV.  
Format  
Mode  
no lldp med transmit-tlv [capabilities] [network-policy] [ex-pse]  
[ex-pd] [location] [inventory]  
Interface Config  
Switching Commands  
185  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
lldp med all  
Use this command to configure LLDP-MED on all the ports  
Format  
Mode  
lldp med all  
Global Config  
no lldp med all  
Use this command to remove LLDP-MD on all ports.  
Format  
Mode  
no lldp med all  
Global Config  
lldp med confignotification all  
Use this command to configure all the ports to send the topology change notification.  
Format  
Mode  
lldp med confignotification all  
Global Config  
no lldp med confignotification all  
Use this command to disable all the ports to send the topology change notification.  
Format  
Mode  
no lldp med confignotification all  
Global Config  
lldp med faststartrepeatcount  
Use this command to set the value of the fast start repeat count. [count]is the number of  
LLDP PDUs that will be transmitted when the product is enabled. The range is 1 to 10.  
Default  
3
Format  
Mode  
lldp med faststartrepeatcount [count]  
Global Config  
no lldp med faststartrepeatcount  
Use this command to return to the factory default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no lldp med faststartrepeatcount  
Global Config  
Switching Commands  
186  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
lldp med transmit-tlv all  
Use this command to specify which optional Type Length Values (TLVs) in the LLDP MED  
set will be transmitted in the Link Layer Discovery Protocol Data Units (LLDPDUs).  
Default  
By default, the capabilities and network policy TLVs are included.  
Format  
Mode  
lldp med transmit-tlv all [capabilities] [ex-pd] [ex-pse] [inventory]  
[location] [network-policy]  
Global Config  
Term  
Definition  
capabilities  
Transmit the LLDP capabilities TLV.  
Transmit the LLDP extended PD TLV.  
Transmit the LLDP extended PSE TLV.  
Transmit the LLDP inventory TLV.  
Transmit the LLDP location TLV.  
Transmit the LLDP network policy TLV.  
ex-pd  
ex-pse  
inventory  
location  
network-policy  
no lldp med transmit-tlv  
Use this command to remove a TLV.  
Format  
Mode  
no lldp med transmit-tlv all [capabilities] [network-policy] [ex-pse]  
[ex-pd] [location] [inventory]  
Global Config  
show lldp med  
Use this command to display a summary of the current LLDP MED configuration.  
Format  
Mode  
show lldp med  
Privileged Exec  
Term  
Definition  
Fast Start  
Repeat Count  
The number of LLDP PDUs that will be transmitted when the protocol is enabled.  
Device Class  
The local device’s MED Classification. There are four different kinds of devices, three of  
them represent the actual end points (classified as Class I Generic[IP Communication  
Controller etc.], Class II Media Conference Bridge etc.], Class III Communication [IP  
Telephone etc.]. Class IV Network Connectivity Device, which is typically a LAN Switch,  
Router, IEEE 802.11 Wireless Access Point, etc.  
Switching Commands  
187  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Example: The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(switch) #show lldp med  
LLDP MED Global Configuration  
Fast Start Repeat Count: 3  
Device Class: Network Connectivity  
(switch) #  
show lldp med interface  
Use this command to display a summary of the current LLDP MED configuration for a specific  
interface. <slot/port>indicates a specific physical interface. allindicates all valid LLDP  
interfaces.  
Format  
Mode  
show lldp med interface {<slot/port> | all}  
Privileged Exec  
Term  
Definition  
Interface  
The interface in a slot/port format.  
Link  
Shows whether the link is up or down.  
ConfigMED  
OperMED  
ConfigNotify  
TLVsTx  
Shows if the LLPD-MED mode is enabled or disabled on this interface  
Shows if the LLPD-MED TLVs are transmitted or not on this interface.  
Shows if the LLPD-MED topology notification mode of this interface.  
Shows whether the interface sends optional TLVs in the LLDPDUs. The TLV codes  
can be 0 (Capabilities), 1 (Network Policy), 2 (Location), 3 (Extended PSE), 4  
(Extended Pd), or 5 (Inventory).  
Example: The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(Switch) #show lldp med interface all  
Interface Link  
configMED operMED ConfigNotify TLVsTx  
--------- ------ --------- -------- ------------ -----------  
0/1  
0/2  
0/3  
0/4  
0/5  
0/6  
0/7  
0/8  
0/9  
0/10  
0/11  
0/12  
Down  
Up  
Disabled Disabled Disabled  
Disabled Disabled Disabled  
Disabled Disabled Disabled  
Disabled Disabled Disabled  
Disabled Disabled Disabled  
Disabled Disabled Disabled  
Disabled Disabled Disabled  
Disabled Disabled Disabled  
Disabled Disabled Disabled  
Disabled Disabled Disabled  
Disabled Disabled Disabled  
Disabled Disabled Disabled  
0,1  
0,1  
0,1  
0,1  
0,1  
0,1  
0,1  
0,1  
0,1  
0,1  
0,1  
0,1  
Down  
Down  
Down  
Down  
Down  
Down  
Down  
Down  
Down  
Down  
Switching Commands  
188  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
0/13  
0/14  
Down  
Down  
Disabled Disabled Disabled  
Disabled Disabled Disabled  
0,1  
0,1  
TLV Codes: 0- Capabilities,  
2- Location,  
1- Network Policy  
3- Extended PSE  
5- Inventory  
4- Extended Pd,  
--More-- or (q)uit  
(Switch) #show lldp med interface 0/2  
Interface Link  
--------- ------ --------- -------- ------------ -----------  
0/2 Up Disabled Disabled Disabled 0,1  
configMED operMED ConfigNotify TLVsTx  
TLV Codes: 0- Capabilities,  
2- Location,  
1- Network Policy  
3- Extended PSE  
5- Inventory  
4- Extended Pd,  
(Routing) #  
show lldp med local-device detail  
This command displays detailed information about the LLDP data a specific interface  
transmits.  
Format  
show lldp med local-device detail <slot/port>  
Mode  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Media Application  
Type  
Shows the application type. Types are unknown, voice, voicesignaling, guestvoice,  
guestvoicesignaling, sfotphonevoice, videoconferencing, streamingvideo,  
videosignaling.  
Vlan ID  
Priority  
DSCP  
Shows the VLAN id associated with a particular policy type  
Shows the priority associated with a particular policy type.  
Shows the DSCP associated with a particular policy type.  
Unknown  
Indicates if the policy type is unknown. In this case, the VLAN ID, Priority and DSCP  
are ignored.  
Tagged  
Indicates if the policy type is using tagged or untagged VLAN.  
Shows the local hardware version.  
Shows the local firmware version.  
Shows the local software version.  
Shows the local serial number.  
Hardware Rev  
Firmware Rev  
Software Rev  
Serial Num  
Mfg Name  
Shows the manufacture name.  
Model Name  
Shows the model name.  
Example: The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
Switching Commands  
189  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
(Switch) #show lldp med local-device detail 0/8  
LLDP MED Local Device Detail  
Interface: 0/8  
Network Policies  
Media Policy Application Type : voice  
Vlan ID: 10  
Priority: 5  
DSCP: 1  
Unknown: False  
Tagged: True  
Media Policy Application Type : streamingvideo  
Vlan ID: 20  
Priority: 1  
DSCP: 2  
Unknown: False  
Tagged: True  
Inventory  
Hardware Rev: xxx xxx xxx  
Firmware Rev: xxx xxx xxx  
Software Rev: xxx xxx xxx  
Serial Num: xxx xxx xxx  
Mfg Name: xxx xxx xxx  
Model Name: xxx xxx xxx  
Asset ID: xxx xxx xxx  
Location  
Subtype: elin  
Info: xxx xxx xxx  
Extended POE  
Device Type: pseDevice  
Extended POE PSE  
Available: 0.3 Watts  
Source: primary  
Priority: critical  
Extended POE PD  
Required: 0.2 Watts  
Source: local  
Priority: low  
Switching Commands  
190  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show lldp med remote-device  
This command displays summary information about remote devices that transmit current  
LLDP MED data to the system. You can show information about LLDP remote data received  
on all ports or on a specific port.  
Format  
show lldp med remote-device {<slot/port> | all}  
Mode  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Interface  
The interface in a slot/port format.  
Device Class  
The Remote device’s MED Classification. There are four different kinds of devices, three  
of them represent the actual end points (classified as Class I Generic [IP Communication  
Controller etc.], Class II Media [Conference Bridge etc.], Class III Communication [IP  
Telephone etc]). The fourth device is Network Connectivity Device, which is typically a  
LAN Switch/Router, IEEE 802.1 Bridge, IEEE 802.11 Wireless Access Point etc.  
Example: The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(Switch) #show lldp med remote-device all  
LLDP MED Remote Device Summary  
Local  
Interface Remote ID Device Class  
--------- --------- ------------  
0/8  
0/9  
0/10  
0/11  
0/12  
1
2
3
4
5
Class I  
Not Defined  
Class II  
Class III  
Network Con  
show lldp med remote-device detail  
Use this command to display detailed information about remote devices that transmit current  
LLDP MED data to an interface on the system.  
Format  
Mode  
show lldp med remote-device detail <slot/port>  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Supported  
Capabilities  
Shows the supported capabilities that were received in MED TLV on this port.  
Enabled  
capabilities  
Shows the enabled capabilities that were enabled in MED TLV on this port.  
Switching Commands  
191  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Device Class  
Shows the device class as advertized by the device remotely connected to the port.  
Shows if network policy TLV is received in the LLDP frames on this port.  
Network Policy  
Information  
Media  
Application  
Type  
Shows the application type. Types of applications are unknown, voice, voicesignaling,  
guestvoice, guestvoicesignaling, sfotphonevoice, videoconferencing, streamingvideo,  
videosignaling.  
VLAN Id  
Priority  
DSCP  
Shows the VLAN id associated with a particular policy type.  
Shows the priority associated with a particular policy type.  
Shows the DSCP associated with a particular policy type.  
Unknown  
Indicates if the policy type is unknown. In this case, the VLAN id, Priority and DSCP are  
ignored.  
Tagged  
Indicates if the policy type is using tagged or untagged VLAN.  
Shows the hardware version of the remote device.  
Hardware  
Revision  
Firmware  
Revision  
Shows the firmware version of the remote device.  
Shows the software version of the remote device.  
Software  
Revision  
Serial Number  
Shows the serial number of the remote device.  
Manufacturer  
Name  
Shows the manufacture name of the remote device.  
Model Name  
Asset ID  
Shows the model name of the remote device.  
Shows the asset id of the remote device.  
Sub Type  
Shows the type of location information.  
Location  
Information  
Shows the location information as a string for a given type of location id  
Device Type  
Available  
Source  
Shows the remote device’s PoE device type connected to this port.  
Shows the remote port’s PSE power value in tenths of a watt.  
Shows the remote port’s PSE power source.  
Priority  
Shows the remote port’s PSE priority.  
Required  
Source  
Shows the remote port’s PD power requirement.  
Shows the remote port’s PD power source.  
Priority  
Shows the remote port’s PD power priority.  
Example: The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(Switch) #show lldp med remote-device detail 0/8  
Switching Commands  
192  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
LLDP MED Remote Device Detail  
Local Interface: 0/8  
Remote Identifier: 18  
Capabilities  
MED Capabilities Supported: capabilities, networkpolicy, location, extendedpse  
MED Capabilities Enabled: capabilities, networkpolicy  
Device Class: Endpoint Class I  
Network Policies  
Media Policy Application Type : voice  
Vlan ID: 10  
Priority: 5  
DSCP: 1  
Unknown: False  
Tagged: True  
Media Policy Application Type : streamingvideo  
Vlan ID: 20  
Priority: 1  
DSCP: 2  
Unknown: False  
Tagged: True  
Inventory  
Hardware Rev: xxx xxx xxx  
Firmware Rev: xxx xxx xxx  
Software Rev: xxx xxx xxx  
Serial Num: xxx xxx xxx  
Mfg Name: xxx xxx xxx  
Model Name: xxx xxx xxx  
Asset ID: xxx xxx xxx  
Location  
Subtype: elin  
Info: xxx xxx xxx  
Extended POE  
Device Type: pseDevice  
Extended POE PSE  
Available: 0.3 Watts  
Source: primary  
Priority: critical  
Extended POE PD  
Required: 0.2 Watts  
Source: local  
Priority: low  
Denial of Service Commands  
Switching Commands  
193  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
This section describes the commands you use to configure Denial of Service (DoS) Control.  
The software provides support for classifying and blocking specific types of Denial of Service  
attacks. You can configure your system to monitor and block these types of attacks:  
SIP=DIP: Source IP address = Destination IP address.  
First Fragment: TCP Header size smaller then configured value.  
TCP Fragment: IP Fragment Offset = 1.  
TCP Flag: TCP Flag SYN set and Source Port < 1024 or TCP Control Flags = 0 and TCP  
Sequence Number = 0 or TCP Flags FIN, URG, and PSH set and TCP Sequence  
Number = 0 or TCP Flags SYN and FIN set.  
L4 Port: Source TCP/UDP Port = Destination TCP/UDP Port.  
ICMP: Limiting the size of ICMP Ping packets.  
SMAC = DMAC: Source MAC address = Destination MAC address.  
TCP Port: Source TCP Port = Destination TCP Port.  
UDP Port: Source UDP Port = Destination UDP Port.  
TCP Flag & Sequence: TCP Flag SYN set and Source Port < 1024 or TCP Control Flags  
= 0 and TCP Sequence Number = 0 or TCP Flags FIN, URG, and PSH set and TCP  
Sequence Number = 0 or TCP Flags SYN and FIN set.  
TCP Offset: TCP Header Offset = 1.  
TCP SYN: TCP Flag SYN set.  
TCP SYN & FIN: TCP Flags SYN and FIN set.  
TCP FIN & URG & PSH: TCP Flags FIN and URG and PSH set and TCP Sequence  
Number = 0.  
ICMP V6: Limiting the size of ICMPv6 Ping packets.  
ICMP Fragment: Checks for fragmented ICMP packets.  
dos-control all  
This command enables Denial of Service protection checks globally.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
dos-control all  
Global Config  
no dos-control all  
This command disables Denial of Service prevention checks globally.  
Format  
Mode  
no dos-control all  
Global Config  
Switching Commands  
194  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
dos-control sipdip  
This command enables Source IP address = Destination IP address (SIP=DIP) Denial of  
Service protection. If the mode is enabled, Denial of Service prevention is active for this type  
of attack. If packets ingress with SIP=DIP, the packets will be dropped if the mode is enabled.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
dos-control sipdip  
Global Config  
no dos-control sipdip  
This command disables Source IP address = Destination IP address (SIP=DIP) Denial of  
Service prevention.  
Format  
Mode  
no dos-control sipdip  
Global Config  
dos-control firstfrag  
This command enables Minimum TCP Header Size Denial of Service protection. If the mode  
is enabled, Denial of Service prevention is active for this type of attack. If packets ingress  
having a TCP Header Size smaller then the configured value, the packets will be dropped if  
the mode is enabled.The default is disabled.If you enable dos-control firstfrag, but do not  
provide a Minimum TCP Header Size, the system sets that value to 20.  
Default  
disabled <20>  
Format  
Mode  
dos-control firstfrag [<0-255>]  
Global Config  
no dos-control firstfrag  
This command sets Minimum TCP Header Size Denial of Service protection to the default  
value of disabled.  
Format  
Mode  
no dos-control firstfrag  
Global Config  
Switching Commands  
195  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
dos-control tcpfrag  
This command enables TCP Fragment Denial of Service protection. If the mode is enabled,  
Denial of Service prevention is active for this type of attack. If packets ingress having IP  
Fragment Offset equal to one (1), the packets will be dropped if the mode is enabled.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
dos-control tcpfrag  
Global Config  
no dos-control tcpfrag  
This command disabled TCP Fragment Denial of Service protection.  
Format  
Mode  
no dos-control tcpfrag  
Global Config  
dos-control tcpflag  
This command enables TCP Flag Denial of Service protections. If the mode is enabled,  
Denial of Service prevention is active for this type of attacks. If packets ingress having TCP  
Flag SYN set and a source port less than 1024 or having TCP Control Flags set to 0 and TCP  
Sequence Number set to 0 or having TCP Flags FIN, URG, and PSH set and TCP Sequence  
Number set to 0 or having TCP Flags SYN and FIN both set, the packets will be dropped if  
the mode is enabled.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
dos-control tcpflag  
Global Config  
no dos-control tcpflag  
This command sets disables TCP Flag Denial of Service protections.  
Format  
Mode  
no dos-control tcpflag  
Global Config  
dos-control l4port  
This command enables L4 Port Denial of Service protections. If the mode is enabled, Denial  
of Service prevention is active for this type of attack. If packets ingress having Source  
TCP/UDP Port Number equal to Destination TCP/UDP Port Number, the packets will be  
dropped if the mode is enabled.  
Switching Commands  
196  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Note: Some applications mirror source and destination L4 ports - RIP for  
example uses 520 for both. If you enable dos-control l4port,  
applications such as RIP may experience packet loss which would  
render the application inoperable.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
dos-control l4port  
Global Config  
no dos-control l4port  
This command disables L4 Port Denial of Service protections.  
Format  
Mode  
no dos-control l4port  
Global Config  
dos-control icmp  
This command enables Maximum ICMP Packet Size Denial of Service protections. If the  
mode is enabled, Denial of Service prevention is active for this type of attack. If ICMP Echo  
Request (PING) packets ingress having a size greater than the configured value, the packets  
will be dropped if the mode is enabled.  
Default  
disabled <512>  
Format  
Mode  
dos-control icmp [<0-1023>]  
Global Config  
no dos-control icmp  
This command disables Maximum ICMP Packet Size Denial of Service protections.  
Format  
Mode  
no dos-control icmp  
Global Config  
dos-control smacdmac  
This command enables Source MAC address = Destination MAC address (SMAC=DMAC)  
Denial of Service protection. If the mode is enabled, Denial of Service prevention is active for  
Switching Commands  
197  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
this type of attack. If packets ingress with SMAC=DMAC, the packets will be dropped if the  
mode is enabled.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
dos-control smacdmac  
Global Config  
no dos-control smacdmac  
This command disables Source MAC address = Destination MAC address (SMAC=DMAC)  
Denial of Service protection.  
Format  
Mode  
no dos-control smacdmac  
Global Config  
dos-control tcpport  
This command enables TCP L4 source = destination port number (Source TCP Port =  
Destination TCP Port) Denial of Service protection. If the mode is enabled, Denial of Service  
prevention is active for this type of attack. If packets ingress with Source TCP Port =  
Destination TCP Port, the packets will be dropped if the mode is enabled.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
dos-control tcpport  
Global Config  
no dos-control tcpport  
This command disables TCP L4 source = destination port number (Source TCP Port =  
Destination TCP Port) Denial of Service protection.  
Format  
Mode  
no dos-control smacdmac  
Global Config  
dos-control udpport  
This command enables UDP L4 source = destination port number (Source UDP Port =  
Destination UDP Port) Denial of Service protection. If the mode is enabled, Denial of Service  
prevention is active for this type of attack. If packets ingress with Source UDP Port =  
Destination UDP Port, the packets will be dropped if the mode is enabled.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
dos-control udppport  
Global Config  
Switching Commands  
198  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no dos-control udpport  
This command disables UDP L4 source = destination port number (Source UDP Port =  
Destination UDP Port) Denial of Service protection.  
Format  
Mode  
no dos-control udppport  
Global Config  
dos-control tcpflagseq  
This command enables TCP Flag and Sequence Denial of Service protections. If the mode is  
enabled, Denial of Service prevention is active for this type of attack. If packets ingress  
having TCP Flag SYN set and a source port less than 1024 or having TCP Control Flags set  
to 0 and TCP Sequence Number set to 0 or having TCP Flags FIN, URG, and PSH set and  
TCP Sequence Number set to 0 or having TCP Flags SYN and FIN both set, the packets will  
be dropped if the mode is enabled.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
dos-control tcpflagseq  
Global Config  
no dos-control tcpflagseq  
This command sets disables TCP Flag and Sequence Denial of Service protection.  
Format  
Mode  
no dos-control tcpflagseq  
Global Config  
dos-control tcpoffset  
This command enables TCP Offset Denial of Service protection. If the mode is enabled,  
Denial of Service prevention is active for this type of attack. If packets ingress having TCP  
Header Offset equal to one (1), the packets will be dropped if the mode is enabled.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
dos-control tcpoffset  
Global Config  
no dos-control tcpoffset  
This command disabled TCP Offset Denial of Service protection.  
Format  
Mode  
no dos-control tcpoffset  
Global Config  
Switching Commands  
199  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
dos-control tcpsyn  
This command enables TCP SYN and L4 source = 0-1023 Denial of Service protection. If the  
mode is enabled, Denial of Service prevention is active for this type of attack. If packets  
ingress having TCP flag SYN set and an L4 source port from 0 to 1023, the packets will be  
dropped if the mode is enabled.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
dos-control tcpsyn  
Global Config  
no dos-control tcpsyn  
This command sets disables TCP SYN and L4 source = 0-1023 Denial of Service protection.  
Format  
Mode  
no dos-control tcpsyn  
Global Config  
dos-control tcpsynfin  
This command enables TCP SYN and FIN Denial of Service protection. If the mode is  
enabled, Denial of Service prevention is active for this type of attack. If packets ingress  
having TCP flags SYN and FIN set, the packets will be dropped if the mode is enabled.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
dos-control tcpsynfin  
Global Config  
no dos-control tcpsynfin  
This command sets disables TCP SYN & FIN Denial of Service protection.  
Format  
Mode  
no dos-control tcpsynfin  
Global Config  
dos-control tcpfinurgpsh  
This command enables TCP FIN and URG and PSH and SEQ=0 checking Denial of Service  
protections. If the mode is enabled, Denial of Service prevention is active for this type of  
attack. If packets ingress having TCP FIN, URG, and PSH all set and TCP Sequence  
Number set to 0, the packets will be dropped if the mode is enabled.  
Default  
disabled  
Switching Commands  
200  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Format  
Mode  
dos-control tcpfinurgpsh  
Global Config  
no dos-control tcpfinurgpsh  
This command sets disables TCP FIN and URG and PSH and SEQ=0 checking Denial of  
Service protections.  
Format  
Mode  
no dos-control tcpfinurgpsh  
Global Config  
dos-control icmpv4  
This command enables Maximum ICMPv4 Packet Size Denial of Service protections. If the  
mode is enabled, Denial of Service prevention is active for this type of attack. If ICMPv4 Echo  
Request (PING) packets ingress having a size greater than the configured value, the packets  
will be dropped if the mode is enabled.  
Default  
disabled <512>  
Format  
Mode  
dos-control icmpv4 <0-16384>  
Global Config  
no dos-control icmpv4  
This command disables Maximum ICMP Packet Size Denial of Service protections.  
Format  
Mode  
no dos-control icmpv4  
Global Config  
dos-control icmpv6  
This command enables Maximum ICMPv6 Packet Size Denial of Service protections. If the  
mode is enabled, Denial of Service prevention is active for this type of attack. If ICMPv6 Echo  
Request (PING) packets ingress having a size greater than the configured value, the packets  
will be dropped if the mode is enabled.  
Default  
disabled <512>  
Format  
Mode  
dos-control icmpv6 <0-16384>  
Global Config  
Switching Commands  
201  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no dos-control icmpv6  
This command disables Maximum ICMP Packet Size Denial of Service protections.  
Format  
Mode  
no dos-control icmpv6  
Global Config  
dos-control icmpfrag  
This command enables ICMP Fragment Denial of Service protection. If the mode is enabled,  
Denial of Service prevention is active for this type of attack. If packets ingress having  
fragmented ICMP packets, the packets will be dropped if the mode is enabled.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
dos-control icmpfrag  
Global Config  
no dos-control icmpfrag  
This command disabled ICMP Fragment Denial of Service protection.  
Format  
Mode  
no dos-control icmpfrag  
Global Config  
show dos-control  
This command displays Denial of Service configuration information.  
Format  
Mode  
show dos-control  
Privileged EXEC  
Note: Not all messages below are available in all 7000series managed  
switches.  
Term  
Definition  
First Fragment  
Mode  
May be enabled or disabled. The factory default is disabled.  
The factory default is 20.  
Min TCP Hdr  
Size <0-255>  
ICMP Mode  
May be enabled or disabled. The factory default is disabled.  
Switching Commands  
202  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Max ICMPv4 Pkt  
Size  
The range is 0-1023. The factory default is 512.  
The range is 0-16384. The factory default is 512.  
May be enabled or disabled. The factory default is disabled.  
Max ICMPv6 Pkt  
Size  
ICMP Fragment  
Mode  
L4 Port Mode  
TCP Port Mode  
UDP Port Mode  
SIPDIP Mode  
May be enabled or disabled. The factory default is disabled.  
May be enabled or disabled. The factory default is disabled.  
May be enabled or disabled. The factory default is disabled.  
May be enabled or disabled. The factory default is disabled.  
May be enabled or disabled. The factory default is disabled.  
SMACDMAC  
Mode  
TCP Flag Mode  
May be enabled or disabled. The factory default is disabled.  
May be enabled or disabled. The factory default is disabled.  
TCP FIN&URG&  
PSH Mode  
TCP Flag &  
Sequence Mode  
May be enabled or disabled. The factory default is disabled.  
TCP SYN Mode  
May be enabled or disabled. The factory default is disabled.  
May be enabled or disabled. The factory default is disabled.  
TCP SYN & FIN  
Mode  
TCP Fragment  
Mode  
May be enabled or disabled. The factory default is disabled.  
May be enabled or disabled. The factory default is disabled.  
TCP Offset  
Mode  
MAC Database Commands  
This section describes the commands you use to configure and view information about the  
MAC databases.  
bridge aging-time  
This command configures the forwarding database address aging timeout in seconds. The  
<seconds>parameter must be within the range of 10 to 1,000,000 seconds.  
Default  
300  
Format  
Mode  
bridge aging-time <10-1,000,000>  
Global Config  
Switching Commands  
203  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no bridge aging-time  
This command sets the forwarding database address aging timeout to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no bridge aging-time  
Global Config  
show forwardingdb agetime  
This command displays the timeout for address aging.  
Default  
300s  
Format  
Mode  
show forwardingdb agetime  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Address Aging  
Timeout  
This parameter displays the address aging timeout for the associated forwarding  
database.  
show mac-address-table multicast  
This command displays the Multicast Forwarding Database (MFDB) information. If you enter  
the command with no parameter, the entire table is displayed. You can display the table entry  
for one MAC Address by specifying the MAC address as an optional parameter.  
Format  
Mode  
show mac-address-table multicast <macaddr>  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
MAC Address  
A multicast MAC address for which the switch has forwarding and or filtering information.  
The format is two-digit hexadecimal numbers separated by colons, for example  
01:23:45:67:89:AB. In an IVL system the MAC address will be displayed as a MAC  
address and VLAN ID combination of 8 bytes.  
Type  
The type of the entry. Static entries are those that are configured by the end user.  
Dynamic entries are added to the table as a result of a learning process or protocol.  
Component  
The component that is responsible for this entry in the Multicast Forwarding Database.  
Possible values are IGMP Snooping, GMRP, and Static Filtering.  
Description  
Interfaces  
The text description of this multicast table entry.  
The list of interfaces that are designated for forwarding (Fwd:) and filtering (Flt:).  
Forwarding  
Interfaces  
The resultant forwarding list is derived from combining all the component’s forwarding  
interfaces and removing the interfaces that are listed as the static filtering interfaces.  
Switching Commands  
204  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show mac-address-table stats  
This command displays the Multicast Forwarding Database (MFDB) statistics.  
Format  
show mac-address-table stats  
Mode  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Max MFDB  
Table Entries  
The total number of entries that can possibly be in the Multicast Forwarding Database  
table.  
Most MFDB  
Entries Since  
Last Reset  
The largest number of entries that have been present in the Multicast Forwarding  
Database table. This value is also known as the MFDB high-water mark.  
Current Entries  
The current number of entries in the MFDB.  
ISDP Commands  
This section describes the commands you use to configure the industry standard Discovery  
Protocol (ISDP).  
isdp run  
This command enables ISDP on the switch.  
Default  
Enabled  
Format  
Mode  
isdp run  
Global Config  
no isdp run  
This command disables ISDP on the switch.  
Format  
Mode  
no isdp run  
Global Config  
isdp holdtime  
This command configures the hold time for ISDP packets that the switch transmits. The hold  
time specifies how long a receiving device should store information sent in the ISDP packet  
before discarding it. The range is given in seconds.  
Default  
180 seconds  
Switching Commands  
205  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Format  
Mode  
isdp holdtime <10-255>  
Global Config  
isdp timer  
This command sets the period of time between sending new ISDP packets. The range is  
given in seconds.  
Default  
30 seconds  
Format  
Mode  
isdp timer <5-254>  
Global Config  
isdp advertise-v2  
This command enables the sending of ISDP version 2 packets from the device.  
Default  
Enabled  
Format  
Mode  
isdp advertise-v2  
Global Config  
no isdp advertise-v2  
This command disables the sending of ISDP version 2 packets from the device.  
Format  
Mode  
no isdp advertise-v2  
Global Config  
isdp enable  
This command enables ISDP on the interface.  
Default  
Enabled  
Format  
Mode  
isdp enable  
Interface Config  
no isdp enable  
This command disables ISDP on the interface.  
Format  
Mode  
no isdp enable  
Interface Config  
Switching Commands  
206  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
clear isdp counters  
This command clears ISDP counters.  
Format  
Mode  
clear isdp counters  
Privileged EXEC  
clear isdp table  
This command clears entries in the ISDP table.  
Format  
Mode  
clear isdp table  
Privileged EXEC  
show isdp  
This command displays global ISDP settings.  
Format  
show isdp  
Mode  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Timer  
The frequency with which this device sends ISDP packets. This value is given in  
seconds.  
Hold Time  
Version 2  
The length of time the receiving device should save information sent by this device. This  
value is given in seconds.  
The setting for sending ISDPv2 packets. If disabled, version 1 packets are transmitted.  
Advertisements  
Device ID  
The Device ID advertised by this device. The format of this Device ID is characterized by  
the value of the Device ID Format object.  
Device ID  
Format  
Capability  
Indicates the Device ID format capability of the device.  
serialNumber indicates that the device uses a serial number as the format for its  
Device ID.  
macAddressindicates that the device uses a Layer 2 MAC address as the format for  
its Device ID.  
otherindicates that the device uses its platform-specific format as the format for its  
Device ID.  
Device ID  
Format  
Indicates the Device ID format of the device.  
serialNumberindicates that the value is in the form of an ASCII string containing the  
device serial number.  
macAddress indicates that the value is in the form of a Layer 2 MAC address.  
other indicates that the value is in the form of a platform specific ASCII string  
containing info that identifies the device. For example, ASCII string contains  
serialNumber appended/prepended with system name.  
Switching Commands  
207  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show isdp interface  
This command displays ISDP settings for the specified interface.  
Format  
show isdp interface {all | <slot/port>}  
Mode  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Mode  
ISDP mode enabled/disabled status for the interface(s).  
show isdp entry  
This command displays ISDP entries. If the device id is specified, then only entries for that  
device are shown.  
Format  
Mode  
show isdp entry {all | deviceid}  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Device ID  
The device ID associated with the neighbor which advertised the information.  
The IP address(es) associated with the neighbor.  
IP Addresses  
Platform  
Interface  
Port ID  
The hardware platform advertised by the neighbor.  
The interface (slot/port) on which the neighbor's advertisement was received.  
The port ID of the interface from which the neighbor sent the advertisement.  
The hold time advertised by the neighbor.  
Hold Time  
Version  
The software version that the neighbor is running.  
Advertisement  
Version  
The version of the advertisement packet received from the neighbor.  
Capability  
ISDP Functional Capabilities advertised by the neighbor.  
show isdp neighbors  
This command displays the list of neighboring devices.  
Format  
Mode  
show isdp neighbors [ {<slot/port> | detail} ]  
Privileged EXEC  
Switching Commands  
208  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Device ID  
The device ID associated with the neighbor which advertised the information.  
The IP addresses associated with the neighbor.  
IP Addresses  
Capability  
Platform  
ISDP functional capabilities advertised by the neighbor.  
The hardware platform advertised by the neighbor.  
Interface  
Port ID  
The interface (slot/port) on which the neighbor's advertisement was received.  
The port ID of the interface from which the neighbor sent the advertisement.  
The hold time advertised by the neighbor.  
Hold Time  
Advertisement  
Version  
The version of the advertisement packet received from the neighbor.  
Entry Last  
Changed Time  
Displays when the entry was last modified.  
Version  
The software version that the neighbor is running.  
Example: The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(Switch) #show isdp neighbors detail  
Device ID  
0001f45f1bc0  
Address(es):  
IP Address:  
10.27.7.57  
Capability  
Router Trans Bridge Switch IGMP  
Platform  
SecureStack C2  
Interface  
0/48  
Port ID  
ge.3.14  
Holdtime  
131  
Advertisement Version  
Entry last changed time  
Version :  
2
0 days 00:01:59  
05.00.56  
show isdp traffic  
This command displays ISDP statistics.  
Format  
show isdp traffic  
Mode  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
ISDP Packets Received  
ISDP Packets Transmitted  
ISDPv1 Packets Received  
Total number of ISDP packets received  
Total number of ISDP packets transmitted  
Total number of ISDPv1 packets received  
Switching Commands  
209  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
ISDPv1 Packets  
Transmitted  
Total number of ISDPv1 packets transmitted  
ISDPv2 Packets Received  
Total number of ISDPv2 packets received  
Total number of ISDPv2 packets transmitted  
ISDPv2 Packets  
Transmitted  
ISDP Bad Header  
Number of packets received with a bad header  
Number of packets received with a checksum error  
Number of packets which failed to transmit  
Number of invalid packets received  
ISDP Checksum Error  
ISDP Transmission Failure  
ISDP Invalid Format  
ISDP Table Full  
Number of times a neighbor entry was not added to the table due to a full  
database  
ISDP IP Address Table Full  
Displays the number of times a neighbor entry was added to the table  
without an IP address.  
debug isdp packet  
This command enables tracing of ISDP packets processed by the switch. ISDP must be  
enabled on both the device and the interface in order to monitor packets for a particular  
interface.  
Format  
Mode  
debug isdp packet [{receive | transmit}]  
Privileged EXEC  
no debug isdp packet  
This command disables tracing of ISDP packets on the receive or the transmit sides or on  
both sides.  
Format  
Mode  
no debug isdp packet [{receive | transmit}]  
Privileged EXEC  
Priority-Based Flow Control Commands  
Ordinarily, when flow control is enabled on a physical link, it applies to all traffic on the link.  
When congestion occurs, the hardware sends pause frames that temporarily suspend traffic  
flow. Pausing traffic helps prevent buffer overflow and dropped frames.  
Priority-based flow control provides a way to distinguish which traffic on physical link is  
paused when congestion occurs, based on the priority of the traffic. An interface can be  
configured to pause only high priority (i.e., loss-sensitive) traffic when necessary to prevent  
Switching Commands  
210  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
dropped frames, while allowing traffic that has greater loss tolerance to continue to flow on  
the interface.  
Priorities are differentiated by the priority field of the IEEE 802.1Q VLAN header, which  
identifies an IEEE 802.1p priority value. In NETGEAR Managed Switch, these priority values  
must be mapped to internal class-of-service (CoS) values.  
To enable priority-based flow control for a particular CoS value on an interface:  
Ensure that VLAN tagging is enabled on the interface so that the 802.1p priority values  
are carried through the network.  
Ensure that 802.1p priority values are mapped to IEEE 802.1Q CoS values.  
Use the datacenter-bridging priority-flow-control mode on command to enable  
priority-based flow control on the interface.  
Use the datacenter-bridging priority-flow-control priority command to specify the CoS  
values that should be paused ("no-drop") due to greater loss sensitivity. Unless  
configured as "no-drop," all CoS priorities are considered nonpausable ("drop") when  
priority-based flow control is enabled.  
When priority-flow-control is disabled, the interface defaults to the IEEE 802.3x flow control  
setting for the interface. When priority-based flow control is enabled, the interface will not  
pause any CoS unless there is at least one no-drop priority.  
datacenter-bridging  
Use this command to go into datacenter-bridging mode.  
Format  
Mode  
datacenter-bridging  
Interface Config  
priority-flow-control mode  
Use this command to enable or disable priority-based flow control on an interface.  
Format  
Mode  
priority-flow-control mode [on | off]  
Datacenter-Bridging Config  
Default  
Disabled  
priority-flow-control priority  
Use this command to specify the priority group(s) that should be paused when necessary to  
prevent dropped frames; i.e., the group to receive priority flow control. This configuration has  
no effect on interfaces not enabled for priority flow control.  
Switching Commands  
211  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
VLAN tagging must be enabled to carry the 802.1p value through the network. The number of  
lossless priorities supported is 2. Additionally, the mapping of class-of-service levels to  
802.1p priority values to must be set to one-to-one.  
Format  
priority-flow-control priority priority-list {drop | no-drop}  
Mode  
Interface Config  
drop  
Default  
show interface priority-flow-control  
This command displays a summary of the priority flow control configuration for a specified  
interface or all interfaces.  
Format  
Mode  
show interface priority-flow-control [interface <slot/port>]  
Privileged EXEC  
(Switch) #show interface priority-flow-control  
Port  
Drop  
Priorities  
No-Drop  
Priorities  
Operational  
Status  
------  
0/1  
0/2  
--------------- --------------- -----------  
0-7  
0-7  
Inactive  
Inactive  
Switching Commands  
212  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
3.  
Multicast VLAN Registration (MVR)  
3
This chapter contains the following sections:  
213  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
About MVR  
Internet Group Management Protocol (IGMP) Layer 3 is widely used for IPv4 network  
multicasting. In Layer 2 networks, IGMP uses resources inefficiently. For example, a Layer 2  
switch multicasts traffic to all ports, even if there are receivers connected to only a few ports.  
To address this problem, the IGMP Snooping protocol was developed. The problem still  
appears, though, when receivers are in different VLANs.  
MVR is intended to solve the problem of receivers in different VLANs. It uses a dedicated  
manually configured VLAN, called the multicast VLAN, to forward multicast traffic over a  
Layer 2 network with IGMP snooping.  
MVR Commands  
mvr  
This command enables MVR.  
Format  
Mode  
mvr  
Global Config  
Interface Config  
Default  
Disabled  
no mvr  
This command disables MVR.  
Format  
Mode  
no mvr  
Global Config  
Interface Config  
mvr group  
This command adds an MVR membership group. <A.B.C.D> is the IP multicast group being  
added.  
The count is the number of incremental multicast groups being added (the first multicast group is  
A.B.C.D). If a count is not specified, only one multicast group is added.  
Format  
Mode  
mvr group <A.B.C.D> [count]  
Global Config  
Multicast VLAN Registration (MVR)  
214  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no mvr group  
This command removes the MVR membership group.  
Format  
Mode  
no mvr group <A.B.C.D> [count]  
Global Config  
mvr mode  
This command changes the MVR mode type. If the mode is set to compatible, the switch does  
not learn multicast groups; they need to be configured by the operator as the protocol does not  
forward joins from the hosts to the router. To operate in this mode, the IGMP router needs to be  
statically configured to transmit all required multicast streams to the MVR switch. If the mode is  
set to dynamic, the switch learns existing multicast groups by snooping the IGMP queries from  
router on source ports and forwarding the IGMP joins from the hosts to the IGMP router on the  
multicast VLAN (with appropriate translation of the VLAN ID).  
Format  
Mode  
mvr mode { compatible |dynamic }  
Global Config  
Default  
compatible  
no mvr mode  
This command sets the mode type to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no mvr mode  
Global Config  
mvr querytime  
This command sets the MVR query response time.  
Format  
Mode  
mvr querytime<1-100>  
Global Config  
5
Default  
no mvr querytime  
This command sets the MVR query response time to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no mvr querytime  
Global Config  
Multicast VLAN Registration (MVR)  
215  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
mvr vlan  
This command sets the MVR multicast VLAN.  
Format  
Mode  
mvr vlan <1-4094>  
Global Config  
1
Default  
no mvr vlan  
This command sets the MVR multicast VLAN to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no mvr vlan  
Global Config  
mvr immediate  
This command enables MVR immediate leave mode. MVR has two modes of operating with the  
IGMP Leave messages: normal leave and immediate leave:  
In normal leave mode, when a leave is received, the general IGMP query is sent from a  
Layer 2 switch to the receiver port, where the leave was received. Then reports are  
received from other interested hosts that are also connected to that port, for example,  
using hub.  
In immediate leave mode, when a leave is received, the switch is immediately  
reconfigured not to forward a specific multicast stream to the port where a message is  
received. This mode is used only for ports where only one client might be connected.  
Format  
Mode  
mvr immediate  
Interface Config  
Disabled  
Default  
no mvr immediate  
This command sets the MVR multicast VLAN to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no mvr immediate  
Interface Config  
Multicast VLAN Registration (MVR)  
216  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
mvr type  
This command sets the MVR port type. When a port is set as source, it is the port to which the  
multicast traffic flows using the multicast VLAN. When a port is set to receiver, it is the port where  
a listening host is connected to the switch.  
Format  
Mode  
mvr type { receiver|source }  
Interface Config  
none  
Default  
no mvr type  
Use this command to set the MVR port type to none.  
Format  
Mode  
no mvr type  
Interface Config  
mvr vlan group  
Use this command to include the port in the specific MVR group. <mVLAN> is the multicast  
VLAN, and <A.B.C.D> is the IP multicast group  
Format  
Mode  
mvr vlan <mVLAN> group <A.B.C.D>  
Interface Config  
no mvr vlan  
Use this command to exclude the port from the specific MVR group.  
Format  
Mode  
no mvr vlan <mVLAN> group <A.B.C.D>  
Interface Config  
show mvr  
This command displays global MVR settings.  
Format  
Mode  
show mvr  
Privileged EXEC  
Multicast VLAN Registration (MVR)  
217  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
The following table explains the output parameters.  
Term  
Definition  
MVR Running  
MVR multicast VLAN  
MVR running state. It can be enabled or disabled.  
Current MVR multicast VLAN. It can be in the range from 1 to  
4094.  
MVR Max Multicast Groups  
MVR Current multicast groups  
MVR Query response time  
MVR Mode  
The maximum number of multicast groups supported by MVR.  
The current number of MVR groups allocated.  
The current MVR query response time.  
The current MVR mode. It can be compatible or dynamic.  
Example:  
(Switch)#show mvr  
MVR Running…........................... TRUE  
MVR multicast VLAN….................... 1200  
MVR Max Multicast Groups….............. 256  
MVR Current multicast groups….......... 1  
MVR Global query response time…........ 10 (tenths of sec)  
MVR Mode….............................. compatible  
show mvr members  
This command displays the MVR membership groups allocated. <A.B.C.D> is a valid multicast  
address in IPv4 dotted notation.  
Format  
Mode  
show mvr members [<A.B.C.D>]  
Privileged EXEC  
The following table describes the output parameters.  
Term  
Definition  
MVR Group IP  
Status  
MVR group multicast IP address.  
The status of the specific MVR group. It can be active or inactive.  
The list of ports that participates in the specified MVR group.  
Members  
Example:  
(switch)#show mvr members  
MVR Group IP  
------------------  
224.1.1.1  
Status  
---------------  
INACTIVE  
Members  
---------------------  
0/1, 0/2, 0/3  
Multicast VLAN Registration (MVR)  
218  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
(switch)#show mvr members 224.1.1.1  
MVR Group IP  
------------------  
224.1.1.1  
Status  
Members  
---------------  
INACTIVE  
---------------------  
0/1, 0/2, 0/3  
show mvr interface  
This command displays the MVR-enabled interfaces configuration.  
Format  
Mode  
show mvr interface [<interface-id > [members [vlan <vid>]] ]  
Privileged EXEC  
The following table explains the output parameters.  
Parameter  
Port  
Description  
Interface number  
Type  
The MVR port type. It can be none, receiver, or source type.  
Status  
The interface status. It consists of two characteristics:  
• active or inactive indicates whether the port is forwarding.  
• inVLAN or notInVLAN indicates whether the port is part of any VLAN.  
Immediate Leave  
The state of immediate mode. It can be enabled or disabled.  
Example:  
(switch)#show mvr interface  
Port Type  
--------- --------------- --------------------- --------------------  
0/9 RECEIVER ACTIVE/inVLAN DISABLED  
Status  
Immediate Leave  
(switch)#show mvr interface 0/9  
Type: RECEIVER Status: ACTIVE Immediate Leave: DISABLED  
(switch)#show mvr interface 0/23 members  
235.0.0.1 STATIC ACTIVE  
(switch)#show mvr interface 0/23 members vlan 12  
235.0.0.1 STATIC ACTIVE  
235.1.1.1 STATIC ACTIVE  
Multicast VLAN Registration (MVR)  
219  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show mvr traffic  
This command displays global MVR statistics.  
Format  
Mode  
show mvr traffic  
Privileged EXEC  
The following table explains the output parameters.  
Term  
Definition  
IGMP Query Received  
Number of received IGMP queries  
Number of received IGMP reports V1  
Number of received IGMP reports V2  
Number of received IGMP leaves  
IGMP Report V1 Received  
IGMP Report V2 Received  
IGMP Leave Received  
IGMP Query Transmitted  
IGMP Report V1 Transmitted  
IGMP Report V2 Transmitted  
IGMP Leave Transmitted  
IGMP Packet Receive Failures  
IGMP Packet Transmit Failures  
Number of transmitted IGMP queries  
Number of transmitted IGMP reports V1  
Number of transmitted IGMP reports V2  
Number of transmitted IGMP leaves  
Number of failures on receiving the IGMP packets  
Number of failures on transmitting the IGMP packets  
Example:  
(switch)#show mvr traffic  
IGMP Query Received…........................................ 2  
IGMP Report V1 Received….................................... 0  
IGMP Report V2 Received….................................... 3  
IGMP Leave Received…........................................ 0  
IGMP Query Transmitted…..................................... 2  
IGMP Report V1 Transmitted…................................. 0  
IGMP Report V2 Transmitted…................................. 3  
IGMP Leave Transmitted…..................................... 1  
IGMP Packet Receive Failures…............................... 0  
IGMP Packet Transmit Failures….............................. 0  
Multicast VLAN Registration (MVR)  
220  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
4.  
Routing Commands  
4
This chapter describes the routing commands available in the 7000 series CLI.  
Note: Some commands described in this chapter require a license. For  
more information, see Licensing and Command Support on page 8.  
This chapter contains the following sections:  
The commands in this chapter are in three functional groups:  
Show commands display switch settings, statistics, and other information.  
Configuration commands configure features and options of the switch. Every switch  
command has a show command that displays the configuration setting.  
Clear commands clear some or all of the settings to factory defaults.  
221  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Address Resolution Protocol (ARP) Commands  
This section describes the commands you use to configure ARP and to view ARP information  
about the switch. ARP associates IP addresses with MAC addresses and stores the  
information as ARP entries in the ARP cache.  
arp  
This command creates an ARP entry. The value for <ipaddress> is the IP address of a  
device on a subnet attached to an existing routing interface. <macaddr>is a unicast MAC  
address for that device.  
The format of the MAC address is 6 two-digit hexadecimal numbers that are separated by  
colons, for example 00:06:29:32:81:40.  
Format  
Mode  
arp <ipaddress> <macaddr>  
Global Config  
no arp  
This command deletes an ARP entry. The value for <arpentry>is the IP address of the  
interface. The value for <ipaddress>is the IP address of a device on a subnet attached to  
an existing routing interface. <macaddr>is a unicast MAC address for that device.  
Format  
Mode  
no arp <ipaddress> <macaddr>  
Global Config  
ip local-proxy-arp  
This command enables local-proxy-arp on interface or range of interfaces. The switch only  
responds if all next hops in its route to the destination are through interfaces other than the  
interface that received the ARP request. Enabling local proxy ARP removes this restriction..  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
ip local-proxy-arp  
Interface Config  
no ip local-proxy-arp  
This command disables local-proxy-arp on the interface or a range of interfaces.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip local-proxy-arp  
Interface Config  
Routing Commands  
222  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
ip proxy-arp  
This command enables proxy ARP on a router interface. Without proxy ARP, a device only  
responds to an ARP request if the target IP address is an address configured on the interface  
where the ARP request arrived. With proxy ARP, the device might also respond if the target  
IP address is reachable. The device responds only if all next hops in its route to the  
destination are through interfaces other than the interface that received the ARP request.  
Default  
enabled  
Format  
Mode  
ip proxy-arp  
Interface Config  
no ip proxy-arp  
This command disables proxy ARP on a router interface.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip proxy-arp  
Interface Config  
arp cachesize  
This command configures the ARP cache size. The ARP cache size value is a  
platform-specific integer value. The default size also varies depending on the platform.  
Format  
Mode  
arp cachesize <platform specific integer value>  
Global Config  
no arp cachesize  
This command configures the default ARP cache size.  
Format  
Mode  
no arp cachesize  
Global Config  
arp dynamicrenew  
This command enables the ARP component to automatically renew dynamic ARP entries  
when they age out.  
Default  
enabled  
Format  
Mode  
arp dynamicrenew  
Privileged EXEC  
Routing Commands  
223  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no arp dynamicrenew  
This command prevents dynamic ARP entries from renewing when they age out.  
Format  
no arp dynamicrenew  
Mode  
Privileged EXEC  
arp purge  
This command causes the specified IP address to be removed from the ARP cache. Only  
entries of type dynamic or gateway are affected by this command.  
Format  
Mode  
arp purge <ipaddr>  
Privileged EXEC  
arp resptime  
This command configures the ARP request response time-out.  
The value for <seconds>is a valid positive integer, which represents the IP ARP entry  
response time-out time in seconds. The range for <seconds> is between 1-10 seconds.  
Default  
1
Format  
Mode  
arp resptime <1-10>  
Global Config  
no arp resptime  
This command configures the default ARP request response time-out.  
Format  
Mode  
no arp resptime  
Global Config  
arp retries  
This command configures the ARP count of maximum request for retries.  
The value for <retries>is an integer, which represents the maximum number of requests  
for retries. The range for <retries>is an integer between 0-10 retries.  
Default  
4
Format  
Mode  
arp retries <0-10>  
Global Config  
Routing Commands  
224  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no arp retries  
This command configures the default ARP count of maximum request for retries.  
Format  
no arp retries  
Mode  
Global Config  
arp timeout  
This command configures the ARP entry ageout time.  
The value for <seconds>is a valid positive integer, which represents the IP ARP entry  
ageout time in seconds. The range for <seconds>is between 15-21600 seconds.  
Default  
1200  
Format  
Mode  
arp timeout <15-21600>  
Global Config  
no arp timeout  
This command configures the default ARP entry ageout time.  
Format  
Mode  
no arp timeout  
Global Config  
clear arp-cache  
This command causes all ARP entries of type dynamic to be removed from the ARP cache. If  
the gateway keyword is specified, the dynamic entries of type gateway are purged as well.  
Format  
Mode  
clear arp-cache [gateway]  
Privileged EXEC  
clear arp-switch  
Use this command to clear the contents of the switch’s Address Resolution Protocol (ARP)  
table that contains entries learned through the Management port. To observe whether this  
command is successful, pingfrom the remote system to the DUT. Issue the show arp  
switchcommand to see the ARP entries. Then issue the clear arp-switchcommand  
and check the show arp switchentries. There will be no more arp entries.  
Format  
Mode  
clear arp-switch  
Privileged EXEC  
Routing Commands  
225  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show arp  
This command displays the Address Resolution Protocol (ARP) cache. The displayed results  
are not the total ARP entries. To view the total ARP entries, the operator should view the  
show arp results with the show arp switchresults.  
Format  
show arp  
Mode  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Age Time  
(seconds)  
The time it takes for an ARP entry to age out. This is configurable. Age time is  
measured in seconds.  
Response Time  
(seconds)  
The time it takes for an ARP request timeout. This value is configurable. Response  
time is measured in seconds.  
Retries  
The maximum number of times an ARP request is retried. This value is configurable.  
The maximum number of entries in the ARP table. This value is configurable.  
Cache Size  
Dynamic Renew  
Mode  
Displays whether the ARP component automatically attempts to renew dynamic ARP  
entries when they age out.  
Total Entry Count  
Current / Peak  
The total entries in the ARP table and the peak entry count in the ARP table.  
Static Entry Count  
Configured/Active  
/ Max  
The static entry count in the ARP table, the active entry count in the ARP table, the  
active entry count in the ARP table, and maximum static entry count in the ARP table.  
The following are displayed for each ARP entry:  
Term  
Definition  
IP Address  
MAC Address  
Interface  
Type  
The IP address of a device on a subnet attached to an existing routing interface.  
The hardware MAC address of that device.  
The routing slot/port associated with the device ARP entry.  
The type that is configurable. The possible values are Local, Gateway, Dynamic and  
Static.  
Age  
The current age of the ARP entry since last refresh (in hh:mm:ss format)  
show arp brief  
This command displays the brief Address Resolution Protocol (ARP) table information.  
Format  
Mode  
show arp brief  
Privileged EXEC  
Routing Commands  
226  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Age Time  
(seconds)  
The time it takes for an ARP entry to age out. This value is configurable. Age time is  
measured in seconds.  
Response Time  
(seconds)  
The time it takes for an ARP request timeout. This value is configurable. Response time  
is measured in seconds.  
Retries  
The maximum number of times an ARP request is retried. This value is configurable.  
The maximum number of entries in the ARP table. This value is configurable.  
Cache Size  
DynamicRenew  
Mode  
Displays whether the ARP component automatically attempts to renew dynamic ARP  
entries when they age out.  
Total Entry  
Count Current /  
Peak  
The total entries in the ARP table and the peak entry count in the ARP table.  
Static Entry  
Count Current /  
Max  
The static entry count in the ARP table and maximum static entry count in the ARP table.  
show arp switch  
This command displays the contents of the switch’s Address Resolution Protocol (ARP)  
table.  
Format  
Mode  
show arp switch  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
IP Address  
The IP address of a device on a subnet attached to the switch.  
The hardware MAC address of that device.  
The routing slot/port associated with the device’s ARP entry.  
MAC Address  
Interface  
IP Routing Commands  
This section describes the commands you use to enable and configure IP routing on the  
switch.  
routing  
This command enables IPv4 and IPv6 routing for an interface. You can view the current  
value for this function with the show ip briefcommand. The value is labeled as “Routing  
Mode.”  
Default  
disabled  
Routing Commands  
227  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Format  
Mode  
routing  
Interface Config  
no routing  
This command disables routing for an interface.  
You can view the current value for this function with the show ip briefcommand. The  
value is labeled as “Routing Mode.”  
Format  
no routing  
Mode  
Interface Config  
ip routing  
This command enables the IP Router Admin Mode for the master switch.  
Format  
Mode  
ip routing  
Global Config  
no ip routing  
This command disables the IP Router Admin Mode for the master switch.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip routing  
Global Config  
ip address  
This command configures an IP address on an interface. You can also use this command to  
configure one or more secondary IP addresses on the interface. The command supports  
RFC 3021 and accepts using 31-bit prefixes on IPv4 point-to-point links. This command adds  
the label IP address in show ip interface.  
Note: The 31-bit subnet mask is only supported on routing interface. This  
feature is not supported on a network port because it acts as a host,  
not a router, on the management interface.  
Format  
Mode  
ip address <ipaddr> {subnetmask | /prefix-length} [secondary]  
Interface Config  
Routing Commands  
228  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Parameter  
ipaddr  
Description  
The IP address of the interface.  
subnetmask  
prefix-length  
A four-digit dotted-decimal number that represents the subnet mask of the interface  
Implements RFC 3021. Using the / notation of the subnet mask, this is an integer that  
indicates the length of the subnet mask. Range is 5–32 bits.  
no ip address  
This command deletes an IP address from an interface. The value for <ipaddr>is the IP  
address of the interface in a.b.c.d format where the range for a, b, c, and d is 1-255. The  
value for <subnetmask>is a 4-digit dotted-decimal number which represents the Subnet  
Mask of the interface. To remove all of the IP addresses (primary and secondary) configured  
on the interface, enter the command no ip address.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip address [{<ipaddr> <subnetmask | /prefix-length> [secondary]}]  
Interface Config  
ip address dhcp  
Use this command to enable the DHCPv4 client on an in-band interface so that it can acquire  
network information, such as the IP address, subnet mask, and default gateway from a  
network DHCP server. When DHCP is enabled on the interface, the system automatically  
deletes all manually configured IPv4 addresses on the interface.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
ip address dhcp  
Interface Config  
no ip address dhcp  
Use this command to release a leased address and disable DHCPv4 on an interface.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip address dhcp  
Interface Config  
ip default-gateway  
Use this command to manually configure a default gateway for the switch. Only one default  
gateway can be configured. If you use this command multiple times, each command replaces  
the previous value.  
Format  
Mode  
ip default-gateway <ipaddr>  
Global Config  
Routing Commands  
229  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no ip default-gateway  
Use this command to remove the default gateway address from the configuration.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip default-gateway <ipaddr>  
Interface Config  
release dhcp  
Use this command to force the DHCPv4 client to release the leased address from the  
specified interface.  
Format  
Mode  
release dhcp <slot/port>  
Privileged EXEC  
renew dhcp  
Use this command to force the DHCPv4 client to immediately renew an IPv4 address lease  
on the specified interface.  
Format  
Mode  
renew dhcp {<slot/port>|network-port}  
Privileged EXEC  
Note: This command can be used on in-band ports as well as network  
(out-of-band) port.  
show dhcp lease  
Use this command to display a list of IPv4 addresses currently leased from a DHCP server  
on a specific in-band interface or all in-band interfaces. This command does not apply to  
service or network ports.  
Format  
Mode  
show dhcp lease [interface <slot/port>]  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
IP address,  
Subnet mask  
The IP address and network mask leased from the DHCP server.  
DHCP Lease  
server  
The IPv4 address of the DHCP server that leased the address.  
State of the DHCPv4 Client on this interface.  
State  
DHCP transaction  
ID  
The transaction ID of the DHCPv4 Client.  
Routing Commands  
230  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Lease  
The time (in seconds) that the IP address was leased by the server.  
Renewal  
The time (in seconds) when the next DHCP renew Request is sent by DHCPv4 Client  
to renew the leased IP address.  
Rebind  
The time (in seconds) when the DHCP Rebind process starts.  
Retry count  
Number of times the DHCPv4 client sends a DHCP REQUEST message before the  
server responds.  
ip route  
This command configures a static route. The <ipaddr>parameter is a valid IP address,  
and <subnetmask> is a valid subnet mask. The <nexthopip>parameter is a valid IP  
address of the next hop router. Specifying Null0as nexthop parameter adds a static reject  
route. The optional <preference>parameter is an integer (value from 1 to 255) that allows  
you to specify the preference value (sometimes called “administrative distance”) of an  
individual static route. Among routes to the same destination, the route with the lowest  
preference value is the route entered into the forwarding database. By specifying the  
preference of a static route, you control whether a static route is more or less preferred than  
routes from dynamic routing protocols. The preference also controls whether a static route is  
more or less preferred than other static routes to the same destination. A route with a  
preference of 255 cannot be used to forward traffic.  
For the static routes to be visible, you must perform the following steps:  
Enable ip routing globally.  
Enable ip routing for the interface.  
Confirm that the associated link is also up.  
Default  
preference—1  
Format  
Mode  
ip route <ipaddr> <subnetmask> [<nexthopip> | Null0] [<preference>]  
Global Config  
no ip route  
This command deletes a single next hop to a destination static route. If you use the  
<nexthopip>parameter, the next hop is deleted. If you use the <preference>value, the  
preference value of the static route is reset to its default.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip route <ipaddr> <subnetmask> [{<nexthopip> [<preference>] |  
Null0}]  
Global Config  
Routing Commands  
231  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
ip route default  
This command configures the default route. The value for <nexthopip>is a valid IP  
address of the next hop router. The <preference>is an integer value from 1 to 255. A route  
with a preference of 255 cannot be used to forward traffic.  
Default  
preference—1  
Format  
Mode  
ip route default <nexthopip> [<preference>]  
Global Config  
no ip route default  
This command deletes all configured default routes. If the optional <nexthopip>parameter  
is designated, the specific next hop is deleted from the configured default route and if the  
optional preference value is designated, the preference of the configured default route is  
reset to its default.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip route default [{<nexthopip> | <preference>}]  
Global Config  
ip route distance  
This command sets the default distance (preference) for static routes. Lower route distance  
values are preferred when determining the best route. The ip routeand ip route  
defaultcommands allow you to optionally set the distance (preference) of an individual  
static route. The default distance is used when no distance is specified in these commands.  
Changing the default distance does not update the distance of existing static routes, even if  
they were assigned the original default distance. The new default distance will only be  
applied to static routes created after invoking the ip route distancecommand.  
Default  
1
Format  
Mode  
ip route distance <1-255>  
Global Config  
no ip route distance  
This command sets the default static route preference value in the router. Lower route  
preference values are preferred when determining the best route.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip route distance  
Global Config  
Routing Commands  
232  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
ip netdirbcast  
This command enables the forwarding of network-directed broadcasts. When enabled,  
network directed broadcasts are forwarded. When disabled they are dropped.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
ip netdirbcast  
Interface Config  
no ip netdirbcast  
This command disables the forwarding of network-directed broadcasts. When disabled,  
network directed broadcasts are dropped.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip netdirbcast  
Interface Config  
ip mtu  
This command sets the IP maximum transmission unit (MTU) on a routing interface. The IP  
MTU is the size of the largest IP packet that can be transmitted on the interface without  
fragmentation. The software currently does not fragment IP packets.  
Packets forwarded in hardware ignore the IP MTU.  
Packets forwarded in software are dropped if they exceed the IP MTU of the outgoing  
interface.  
Packets originated on the router, such as OSPF packets, might be fragmented by the IP  
stack. The IP stack uses its default IP MTU and ignores the value set using the ip mtu  
command.  
OSPF advertises the IP MTU in the Database Description packets it sends to its neighbors  
during database exchange. If two OSPF neighbors advertise different IP MTUs, they will not  
form an adjacency. (unless OSPF has been instructed to ignore differences in IP MTU with  
the ip ospf mtu-ignorecommand.)  
Note: The IP MTU size refers to the maximum size of the IP packet (IP  
Header + IP payload). It does not include any extra bytes that might  
be required for Layer-2 headers. To receive and process packets,  
the Ethernet MTU (see mtu on page 23) must take into account the  
size of the Ethernet header.  
Default  
1500 bytes  
Routing Commands  
233  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Format  
Mode  
ip mtu <68-9198>  
Interface Config  
no ip mtu  
This command resets the ip mtu to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip mtu <mtu>  
Interface Config  
encapsulation  
This command configures the link layer encapsulation type for the packet. The encapsulation  
type can be ethernetor snap.  
Default  
ethernet  
Format  
Mode  
encapsulation {ethernet | snap}  
Interface Config  
Note: Routed frames are always Ethernet encapsulated when a frame is  
routed to a VLAN.  
clear ip route all  
This command removes all the route entries learned over the network.  
Format  
Mode  
clear ip route all  
Privileged EXEC  
Protocol  
Tells which protocol added the specified route. The possibilities are: local, static, OSPF, or  
RIP.  
Total  
Number of  
Routes  
The total number of routes.  
clear ip route counters  
This command resets to zero the IPv4 routing table counters reported in show ip route  
summary. The command resets only the event counters. Counters that report the current  
state of the routing table, such as the number of routes of each type, are not reset.  
Format  
Mode  
clear ip route counters  
Privileged EXEC  
Routing Commands  
234  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show ip brief  
This command displays all the summary information of the IP, including the ICMP rate limit  
configuration and the global ICMP Redirect configuration.  
Format  
show ip brief  
Modes  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Default Time to Live  
The computed TTL (Time to Live) of forwarding a packet from the local router to the  
final destination.  
Routing Mode  
Shows whether the routing mode is enabled or disabled.  
The maximum number of next hops the packet can travel.  
The maximum number of routes the packet can travel.  
Maximum Next Hops  
Maximum Routes  
ICMP Rate Limit  
Interval  
Shows how often the token bucket is initialized with burst-size tokens.  
Burst-interval is from 0 to 2,147,483,647 milliseconds. The default burst-interval is  
1000 msec.  
ICMP Rate Limit  
Burst Size  
Shows the number of ICMPv4 error messages that can be sent during one  
burst-interval. The range is from 1 to 200 messages. The default value is 100  
messages.  
ICMP Echo Replies  
ICMP Redirects  
Shows whether ICMP Echo Replies are enabled or disabled.  
Shows whether ICMP Redirects are enabled or disabled.  
The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(Switch) #show ip brief  
Default Time to Live........................... 64  
Routing Mode................................... Disabled  
Maximum Next Hops.............................. 4  
Maximum Routes................................. 6000  
ICMP Rate Limit Interval....................... 1000 msec  
ICMP Rate Limit Burst Size..................... 100 messages  
ICMP Echo Replies.............................. Enabled  
ICMP Redirects................................. Enabled  
show ip interface  
This command displays all pertinent information about the IP interface.  
Format  
Modes  
show ip interface {<slot/port> | vlan <1-4093> | loopback <0-7>}  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Routing Commands  
235  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Routing  
Interface Status  
Determine the operational status of IPv4 routing Interface. The possible values are Up or  
Down.  
Primary IP  
Address  
The primary IP address and subnet masks for the interface. This value appears only if  
you configure it.  
Secondary IP  
Address  
One or more secondary IP addresses and subnet masks for the interface. This value  
appears only if you configure it.  
Method  
Shows whether the IP address was configured manually or acquired from a DHCP  
server.  
Routing Mode  
The administrative mode of router interface participation. The possible values are enable  
or disable. This value is configurable.  
Administrative  
Mode  
The administrative mode of the specified interface. The possible values of this field are  
enable or disable. This value is configurable.  
Forward Net  
Directed  
Broadcasts  
Displays whether forwarding of network-directed broadcasts is enabled or disabled. This  
value is configurable.  
Proxy ARP  
Displays whether Proxy ARP is enabled or disabled on the system.  
Local Proxy  
ARP  
Displays whether Local Proxy ARP is enabled or disabled on the interface.  
Active State  
Displays whether the interface is active or inactive. An interface is considered active if its  
link is up and it is in forwarding state.  
LinkSpeedData  
Rate  
An integer representing the physical link data rate of the specified interface. This is  
measured in Megabits per second (Mbps).  
MAC Address  
The burned in physical address of the specified interface. The format is 6 two-digit  
hexadecimal numbers that are separated by colons.  
Encapsulation  
Type  
The encapsulation type for the specified interface. The types are: Ethernet or SNAP.  
IP MTU  
The maximum transmission unit (MTU) size of a frame, in bytes.  
Shows the bandwidth of the interface.  
Bandwidth  
Destination  
Unreachables  
Displays whether ICMP Destination Unreachables might be sent (enabled or disabled).  
ICMP Redirects  
Displays whether ICMP Redirects might be sent (enabled or disabled).  
The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(Switch) >show ip interface 0/2  
Routing Interface Status....................... Down  
Method......................................... None  
Routing Mode................................... Disable  
Administrative Mode............................ Enable  
Forward Net Directed Broadcasts................ Disable  
Proxy ARP...................................... Enable  
Local Proxy ARP................................ Disable  
Active State................................... Inactive  
Routing Commands  
236  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Link Speed Data Rate........................... Inactive  
MAC address.................................... 02:14:6C:FF:00:DE  
Encapsulation Type............................. Ethernet  
IP MTU......................................... 1500  
Bandwidth...................................... 100000 kbps  
Destination Unreachables....................... Enabled  
ICMP Redirects................................. Disabled  
show ip interface brief  
This command displays summary information about IP configuration settings for all ports in  
the router.  
Format  
Modes  
show ip interface brief  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Interface  
Valid slot and port number separated by forward slashes.  
Routing operational state of the interface.  
State  
IP Address  
IP Mask  
The IP address of the routing interface in 32-bit dotted decimal format.  
The IP mask of the routing interface in 32-bit dotted decimal format.  
Netdir Bcast  
Indicates if IP forwards net-directed broadcasts on this interface. Possible values are  
Enable or Disable.  
MultiCast Fwd  
Method  
The multicast forwarding administrative mode on the interface. Possible values are  
Enable or Disable.  
Shows whether the IP address was configured manually or acquired from a DHCP  
server.  
show ip protocols  
This command lists a summary of the configuration and status for each unicast routing  
protocol. The command lists routing protocols that are configured and enabled. If a protocol  
is selected on the command line, the display is limited to that protocol.  
Format  
show ip protocols [ospf | rip]  
Mode  
Privileged EXEC  
Parameter  
OSPFv2  
Description  
Router ID  
The router ID configured for OSPFv2  
OSPF Admin Mode Whether OSPF is enabled or disabled globally  
Routing Commands  
237  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Parameter  
Description  
Maximum Paths  
The maximum number of next hops in an OSPF route  
Routing for  
Networks  
The address ranges configured with an OSPF network command  
Distance  
The administrative distance (or route preference) for intra-area, inter-area, and external  
routes  
Default Route  
Advertise  
Whether OSPF is configured to originate a default route  
Always  
Whether default advertisement depends on having a default route in the common routing  
table  
Metric  
The metric configured to be advertised with the default route  
The metric type for the default route  
Metric Type  
Redist Source  
Metric  
A type of routes that OSPF is redistributing  
The metric to advertise for redistributed routes of this type  
The metric type to advertise for redistributed routes of this type  
Whether OSPF redistributes subnets of classful addresses, or only classful prefixes  
Metric Type  
Subnets  
Dist List  
A distribute list used to filter routes of this type. Only routes that pass the distribute list are  
redistributed  
Number of Active  
Areas  
The number of OSPF areas with at least one interface running on this router. Also broken  
down by area type  
ABR Status  
ASBR Status  
RIP  
Whether the router is an area border router. A router is an area border router if it has  
interfaces that are up in more than one area  
Whether the router is an autonomous system boundary router. The router is an ASBR if it is  
redistributing any routes or originating a default route  
Split Horizon Mode Whether RIP advertises routes on the interface where they were received  
Default Metric  
The metric assigned to redistributed routes  
Default Route  
Advertise  
Whether this router is originating a default route  
Distance  
The administrative distance for RIP routes  
Redistribution  
A table showing information for each source protocol (connected, static, bgp, and ospf). For  
each of these sources the distribution list and metric are shown. Fields which are not  
configured are left blank. For ospf, configured ospf match parameters are also shown  
Interface  
The interfaces where RIP is enabled and the version sent and accepted on each interface  
Routing Commands  
238  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show ip route  
This command displays the routing table. The <ip-address>specifies the network for  
which the route is to be displayed and displays the best matching best-route for the address.  
The <mask>specifies the subnet mask for the given <ip-address>. When you use the  
longer-prefixeskeyword, the <ip-address>and <mask>pair becomes the prefix, and  
the command displays the routes to the addresses that match that prefix. Use the  
<protocol>parameter to specify the protocol that installed the routes. The value for  
<protocol>can be connected, ospf, rip, or static. Use the allparameter to display  
all routes including best and non-best routes. If you do not use the allparameter, the  
command only displays the best route.  
A “T” flag appended to a route indicates that it is an ECMP route, but only one of its next hops  
has been installed in the forwarding table. The forwarding table might limit the number of  
ECMP routes or the number of ECMP groups. When an ECMP route cannot be installed  
because such a limit is reached, the route is installed with a single next hop. Such truncated  
routes can be identified by a “T” after the interface name.  
Note: If you use the connectedkeyword for <protocol>, the all  
option is not available because there are no best or non-best  
connected routes.  
Format  
show ip route[{<ip-address> [<protocol>] | {<ip-address> <mask>  
[longer-prefixes] [<protocol>] | <protocol>} [all] | all}]  
Modes  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Route Codes  
The key for the routing protocol codes that might appear in the routing table output.  
The show ip routecommand displays the routing tables in the following format:  
Code IP-Address/Mask [Preference/Metric] via Next-Hop, Route-Timestamp, Interface  
The columns for the routing table display the following information:  
Term  
Code  
Definition  
The codes for the routing protocols that created the routes.  
The IP-Address and mask of the destination network corresponding to this route.  
IP-Address/Mask  
Preference  
The administrative distance associated with this route. Routes with low values are  
preferred over routes with higher values.  
Metric  
The cost associated with this route.  
Routing Commands  
239  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
via Next-Hop  
The outgoing router IP address to use when forwarding traffic to the next router (if any)  
in the path toward the destination.  
Route-Timestamp  
Interface  
The last updated time for dynamic routes. The format of Route-Timestamp will be  
• Days:Hours:Minutes if days > = 1  
• Hours:Minutes:Seconds if days < 1  
The outgoing router interface to use when forwarding traffic to the next destination. For  
reject routes, the next hop interface would be Null0 interface.  
To administratively control the traffic destined to a particular network and prevent it from  
being forwarded through the router, you can configure a static reject route on the router. Such  
traffic would be discarded and the ICMP destination unreachable message is sent back to the  
source. This is typically used for preventing routing loops. The reject route added in the RTO  
is of the type OSPF Inter-Area. Reject routes (routes of REJECT type installed by any  
protocol) are not redistributed by OSPF/RIP. Reject routes are supported in both OSPFv2  
and OSPFv3.  
The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(Switch) #show ip route  
Route Codes: R - RIP Derived, O - OSPF Derived, C - Connected, S - Static  
B - BGP Derived, IA - OSPF Inter Area  
E1 - OSPF External Type 1, E2 - OSPF External Type 2  
N1 - OSPF NSSA External Type 1, N2 - OSPF NSSA External Type 2  
C 1.1.1.0/24 [0/1] directly connected, 0/11  
C 2.2.2.0/24 [0/1] directly connected, 0/1  
C 5.5.5.0/24 [0/1] directly connected, 0/5  
S 7.0.0.0/8 [1/0] directly connected, Null0  
OIA 10.10.10.0/24 [110/6] via 5.5.5.2, 00h:00m:01s, 0/5  
C 11.11.11.0/24 [0/1] directly connected, 0/11  
S 12.0.0.0/8 [5/0] directly connected, Null0  
S 23.0.0.0/8 [3/0] directly connected, Null0  
show ip route ecmp-groups  
This command reports all current ECMP groups in the IPv4 routing table. An ECMP group is  
a set of two or more next hops used in one or more routes. The groups are numbered  
arbitrarily from 1 to n. The output indicates the number of next hops in the group and the  
number of routes that use the set of next hops. The output lists the IPv4 address and  
outgoing interface of each next hop in each group.  
Format  
Mode  
show ip route ecmp-groups  
Privileged EXEC  
Example  
(switch) #show ip route ecmp-groups  
Routing Commands  
240  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
ECMP Group 1 with 2 next hops (used by 1 route)  
172.20.33.100 on interface 2/33  
172.20.34.100 on interface 2/34  
ECMP Group 2 with 3 next hops (used by 1 route)  
172.20.32.100 on interface 2/32  
172.20.33.100 on interface 2/33  
172.20.34.100 on interface 2/34  
ECMP Group 3 with 4 next hops (used by 1 route)  
172.20.31.100 on interface 2/31  
172.20.32.100 on interface 2/32  
172.20.33.100 on interface 2/33  
172.20.34.100 on interface 2/34  
show ip route summary  
Use this command to display the routing table summary. Use the optional allparameter to  
show the number of all routes, including best and non-best routes. To include only the  
number of best routes, do not use the optional parameter.  
When the optional keyword allis given, some statistics, such as the number of routes from  
each source, include counts for alternate routes. An alternate route is a route that is not the  
most preferred route to its destination and therefore is not installed in the forwarding table.  
When this keyword is not given, the output reports only for the best routes.  
Format  
Modes  
show ip route summary [all]  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Connected  
Routes  
The total number of connected routes in the routing table.  
Static Routes  
RIP Routes  
Total number of static routes in the routing table.  
Total number of routes installed by RIP protocol.  
Total number of routes installed by OSPF protocol.  
Total number of reject routes installed by all protocols.  
Total number of routes in the routing table.  
OSPF Routes  
Reject Routes  
Total Routes  
Best Routes  
The number of best routes currently in the routing table. This number counts only the  
best route to each destination.  
Alternate  
Routes  
The number of alternate routes currently in the routing table. An alternate route is one  
that was not selected as the best route to its destination.  
Route Adds  
The number of routes added to the routing table.  
Route Modifies  
The number of routes that changed after they were initially added to the routing table.  
Routing Commands  
241  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Route Deletes  
The number of routes that deleted from the routing table.  
Unresolved  
Route Adds  
The number of route adds that failed because none of the route’s next hops were on a  
local subnet. Note that static routes can fail to be added to the routing table at startup  
because the routing interfaces are not up yet. This counter gets incremented in this case.  
The static routes are added to the routing table when the routing interfaces come up.  
Invalid Route  
Adds  
The number of routes that failed to be added to the routing table because the route was  
invalid. A log message is written for each of these failures.  
Failed Route  
Adds  
The number of routes that failed to be added to the routing table because of a resource  
limitation in the routing table.  
Reserved  
Locals  
The number of routing table entries reserved for a local subnet on a routing interface that  
is down. Space for local routes is always reserved so that local routes can be installed  
when a routing interface bounces.  
Unique Next  
Hops  
The number of distinct next hops used among all routes currently in the routing table.  
These include local interfaces for local routes and neighbors for indirect routes.  
Unique Next  
Hops High  
Water  
The highest count of unique next hops since the counters were last cleared.  
Next Hop  
Groups  
The current number of next hop groups in use by one or more routes. Each next hop  
group includes one or more next hops.  
Next Hop  
Groups High  
Water  
The highest count of next hop groups since the counters were last cleared.  
ECMP Groups  
ECMP Routes  
The number of next hop groups with multiple next hops.  
The number of routes with multiple next hops currently in the routing table.  
Truncated  
ECMP Routes  
The number of ECMP routes that are currently installed in the forwarding table with just  
one next hop. The forwarding table might limit the number of ECMP routes or the number  
of ECMP groups. When an ECMP route cannot be installed because the limit is reached,  
the route is installed with a single next hop.  
ECMP Retries  
The number of ECMP routes that have been installed in the forwarding table after initially  
being installed with a single next hop.  
Routes with n  
Next Hops  
The current number of routes with each number of next hops.  
The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(router) #show ip route summary  
Connected Routes............................... 7  
Static Routes.................................. 1  
RIP Routes..................................... 20  
OSPF Routes.................................... 1004  
Intra Area Routes............................ 4  
Inter Area Routes............................ 1000  
External Type-1 Routes....................... 0  
External Type-2 Routes....................... 0  
Reject Routes.................................. 0  
Routing Commands  
242  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Total routes................................... 1032  
Best Routes (High)............................. 1032 (1032)  
Alternate Routes............................... 0  
Route Adds..................................... 1010  
Route Modifies................................. 1  
Route Deletes.................................. 10  
Unresolved Route Adds.......................... 0  
Invalid Route Adds............................. 0  
Failed Route Adds.............................. 0  
Reserved Locals................................ 0  
Unique Next Hops (High)........................ 13 (13)  
Next Hop Groups (High)......................... 13 (14)  
ECMP Groups (High)............................. 2 (3)  
ECMP Routes.................................... 1001  
Truncated ECMP Routes.......................... 0  
ECMP Retries................................... 0  
Routes with 1 Next Hop......................... 31  
Routes with 2 Next Hops........................ 1  
Routes with 4 Next Hops........................ 1000  
show ip route preferences  
This command displays detailed information about the route preferences. Route preferences  
are used in determining the best route. Lower router preference values are preferred over  
higher router preference values. A route with a preference of 255 cannot be used to forward  
traffic.  
Format  
Modes  
show ip route preferences  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Local  
The local route preference value.  
The static route preference value.  
The OSPF Intra route preference value.  
The OSPF Inter route preference value.  
The OSPF External route preference value.  
The RIP route preference value.  
Static  
OSPF Intra  
OSPF Inter  
OSPF External  
RIP  
Routing Commands  
243  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show ip stats  
This command displays IP statistical information. Refer to RFC 1213 for more information  
about the fields that are displayed.  
Format  
Modes  
show ip stats  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
show routing heap summary  
This command displays a summary of the memory allocation from the routing heap. The  
routing heap is a chunk of memory set aside when the system boots for use by the routing  
applications.  
Format  
show routing heap summary  
Mode  
Privileged EXEC  
Parameter  
Description  
Heap Size  
The amount of memory, in bytes, allocated at startup for the routing heap.  
The number of bytes currently allocated.  
Memory In Use  
Memory on Free  
List  
The number of bytes currently on the free list. When a chunk of memory from the routing heap  
is freed, it is placed on a free list for future reuse.  
Memory Available  
in Heap  
The number of bytes in the original heap that have never been allocated.  
In Use High Water  
Mark  
The maximum memory in use since the system last rebooted.  
The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(netgear switch) #show routing heap summary  
Heap Size....................... 92594000 bytes  
Memory In Use................... 149598 bytes (0%)  
Memory on Free List............. 78721 bytes (0%)  
Memory Available in Heap........ 92365249 bytes (99%)  
In Use High Water Mark.......... 210788 bytes (0%)  
Router Discovery Protocol Commands  
This section describes the commands you use to view and configure Router Discovery  
Protocol settings on the switch. The Router Discovery Protocol enables a host to discover the  
IP address of routers on the subnet.  
Routing Commands  
244  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
ip irdp  
This command enables Router Discovery on an interface.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
ip irdp  
Interface Config  
no ip irdp  
This command disables Router Discovery on an interface.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip irdp  
Interface Config  
ip irdp multicast  
This command configures the address that the interface uses to send the router discovery  
advertisements. The address is 224.0.0.1, which is the all-hosts IP multicast address.  
Default  
224.0.0.1  
Format  
Mode  
ip irdp multicast  
Interface Config  
no ip irdp multicast  
This command configures the address used to advertise the router to the Broadcast address  
(255.255.255.155)..  
Format  
Mode  
no ip irdp multicast  
Interface Config  
ip irdp holdtime  
This command configures the value, in seconds, of the holdtime field of the router  
advertisement sent from this interface. The holdtime range is the value of  
<maxadvertinterval>to 9000 seconds.  
Default  
3 * maxinterval  
Format  
Mode  
ip irdp holdtime <maxadvertinterval-9000>  
Interface Config  
Routing Commands  
245  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no ip irdp holdtime  
This command configures the default value, in seconds, of the holdtime field of the router  
advertisement sent from this interface.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip irdp holdtime  
Interface Config  
ip irdp maxadvertinterval  
This command configures the maximum time, in seconds, allowed between sending router  
advertisements from the interface. The range for maxadvertinterval is 4–1800 seconds.  
Default  
600  
Format  
Mode  
ip irdp maxadvertinterval <4-1800>  
Interface Config  
no ip irdp maxadvertinterval  
This command configures the default maximum time, in seconds.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip irdp maxadvertinterval  
Interface Config  
ip irdp minadvertinterval  
This command configures the minimum time, in seconds, allowed between sending router  
advertisements from the interface. The range for minadvertinterval is three to the value of  
maxadvertinterval.  
Default  
0.75 * maxadvertinterval  
Format  
Mode  
ip irdp minadvertinterval <3-maxadvertinterval>  
Interface Config  
no ip irdp minadvertinterval  
This command sets the default minimum time to the default.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip irdp minadvertinterval  
Interface Config  
Routing Commands  
246  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
ip irdp preference  
This command configures the preferability of the address as a default router address, relative  
to other router addresses on the same subnet.  
Default  
0
Format  
Mode  
ip irdp preference <-2147483648 to 2147483647>  
Interface Config  
no ip irdp preference  
This command configures the default preferability of the address as a default router address,  
relative to other router addresses on the same subnet.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip irdp preference  
Interface Config  
show ip irdp  
This command displays the router discovery information for all interfaces, or a specified  
interface.  
Format  
Modes  
show ip irdp {<slot/port> | all}  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Interface  
The <slot/port>that matches the rest of the information in the row.  
Ad Mode  
The advertise mode, which indicates whether router discovery is enabled or disabled on  
this interface.  
Advertise  
Address  
The IP address to which the interface sends the advertisement.  
Max Int  
The maximum advertise interval, which is the maximum time, in seconds, allowed  
between sending router advertisements from the interface.  
Min Int  
The minimum advertise interval, which is the minimum time, in seconds, allowed  
between sending router advertisements from the interface.  
Hold Time  
Preference  
The amount of time, in seconds, that a system should keep the router advertisement  
before discarding it.  
The preference of the address as a default router address, relative to other router  
addresses on the same subnet.  
Routing Commands  
247  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Virtual LAN Routing Commands  
This section describes the commands you use to view and configure VLAN routing and to  
view VLAN routing status information.  
vlan routing  
This command enables routing on a VLAN. The vlanid value has a range from 1 to 4093. The  
[interface ID] value has a range from 1 to 128. Typically, you will not supply the interface ID  
argument, and the system automatically selects the interface ID. However, if you specify an  
interface ID that is already in use, the CLI displays an error message and does not create the  
VLAN interface.  
Format  
Mode  
vlan routing <vlanid> [interface ID]  
VLAN Config  
no vlan routing  
This command deletes routing on a VLAN. The <vlanid>value has a range from 1 to 4093.  
Format  
Mode  
no vlan routing <vlanid>  
VLAN Config  
show ip vlan  
This command displays the VLAN routing information for all VLANs with routing enabled.  
Format  
Modes  
show ip vlan  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
MAC Address  
used by  
Routing VLANs  
The MAC Address associated with the internal bridge-router interface (IBRI). The same  
MAC Address is used by all VLAN routing interfaces. It will be displayed above the  
per-VLAN information.  
VLAN ID  
The identifier of the VLAN.  
Logical  
Interface  
The logical slot/port associated with the VLAN routing interface.  
IP Address  
The IP address associated with this VLAN.  
Subnet Mask  
The subnet mask that is associated with this VLAN.  
Routing Commands  
248  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Virtual Router Redundancy Protocol Commands  
This section describes the commands you use to view and configure Virtual Router  
Redundancy Protocol (VRRP) and to view VRRP status information. VRRP helps provide  
failover and load balancing when you configure two devices as a VRRP pair.  
ip vrrp (Global Config)  
Use this command in Global Config mode to enable the administrative mode of VRRP on the  
router.  
Default  
none  
Format  
Mode  
ip vrrp  
Global Config  
no ip vrrp  
Use this command in Global Config mode to diable the default administrative mode of VRRP  
on the router.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip vrrp  
Global Config  
ip vrrp (Interface Config)  
Use this command in Interface Config mode to create a virtual router associated with the  
interface. The parameter <vrid> is the virtual router ID, which has an integer value range  
from 1 to 255.  
Format  
Mode  
ip vrrp <vrid>  
Interface Config  
no ip vrrp  
Use this command in Interface Config mode to delete the virtual router associated with the  
interface. The virtual Router ID, <vrid>, is an integer value that ranges from 1 to 255.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip vrrp <vrid>  
Interface Config  
Routing Commands  
249  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
ip vrrp mode  
This command enables the virtual router configured on the specified interface. Enabling the  
status field starts a virtual router. The parameter <vrid> is the virtual router ID which has an  
integer value ranging from 1 to 255.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
ip vrrp <vrid> mode  
Interface Config  
no ip vrrp mode  
This command disables the virtual router configured on the specified interface. Disabling the  
status field stops a virtual router.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip vrrp <vrid> mode  
Interface Config  
ip vrrp ip  
This command sets the virtual router IP address value for an interface. The value for  
<ipaddr> is the IP address which is to be configured on that interface for VRRP. The  
parameter <vrid> is the virtual router ID which has an integer value range from 1 to 255.  
You can use the optional [secondary] parameter to designate the IP address as a  
secondary IP address.  
Default  
none  
Format  
Mode  
ip vrrp <vrid> ip <ipaddr> [secondary]  
Interface Config  
no ip vrrp ip  
Use this command in Interface Config mode to delete a secondary IP address value from the  
interface. To delete the primary IP address, you must delete the virtual router on the  
interface.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip vrrp <vrid> <ipaddress> secondary  
Interface Config  
ip vrrp authentication  
This command sets the authorization details value for the virtual router configured on a  
specified interface, The parameter {none | simple} specifies the authoritization type for  
virtual router configured on the specified interface. The parameter {key}is optional, it is only  
Routing Commands  
250  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
required when authorization type is simple text apssword. The parameter <vrid>is the  
virtual router IFD which has an integer value range from 1 to 255.  
Default  
no authorization  
Format  
Mode  
ip vrrp <vrid> authentication {none | simple <key>}  
Interface Config  
no ip vrrp authentication  
This command sets the default authorization details value for the virtual router configured on  
a specified interface.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip vrrp <vrid> authentication  
Interface Config  
ip vrrp preempt  
This command sets the preemption mode value for the virtual router configured on a  
specified interface. The parameter <vrid> is the virtual router ID, which is an integer from 1  
to 255.  
Default  
enabled  
Format  
Mode  
ip vrrp <vrid> preempt  
Interface Config  
no ip vrrp preempt  
This command sets the default preemption mode value for the virtual router configured on a  
specified interface.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip vrrp <vrid> preempt  
Interface Config  
ip vrrp priority  
This command sets the priority of a router within a VRRP group. Higher values equal higher  
priority. The range is from 1 to 254. The parameter <vrid> is the virtual router ID, whose  
range is from 1 to 255.  
The router with the highest priority is elected master. If a router is configured with the address  
used as the address of the virtual router, the router is called the “address owner.” The priority  
of the address owner is always 255 so that the address owner is always master. If the master  
has a priority less than 255 (it is not the address owner) and you configure the priority of  
Routing Commands  
251  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
another router in the group higher than the master’s priority, the router will take over as  
master only if preempt mode is enabled.  
Default  
100 unless the router is the address owner, in which case its priority is automatically set to  
255.  
Format  
Mode  
ip vrrp <vrid> priority <1-254>  
Interface Config  
no ip vrrp priority  
This command sets the default priority value for the virtual router configured on a specified  
interface.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip vrrp <vrid> priority  
Interface Config  
ip vrrp timers advertise  
This command sets the frequency, in seconds, that an interface on the specified virtual router  
sends a virtual router advertisement.  
Default  
1
Format  
Mode  
ip vrrp <vrid> timers advertise <1-255>  
Interface Config  
no ip vrrp timers advertise  
This command sets the default virtual router advertisement value for an interface.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip vrrp <vrid> timers advertise  
Interface Config  
ip vrrp track interface  
Use this command to alter the priority of the VRRP router based on the availability of its  
interfaces. This command is useful for tracking interfaces that are not configured for VRRP.  
Only IP interfaces are tracked. A tracked interface is up if the IP on that interface is up.  
Otherwise, the tracked interface is down.  
When the tracked interface is down or the interface has been removed from the router, the  
priority of the VRRP router will be decremented by the value specified in the <priority>  
argument. When the interface is up for IP protocol, the priority will be incremented by the  
<priority> value.  
A VRRP configured interface can track more than one interface. When a tracked interface  
goes down, then the priority of the router will be decreased by 10 (the default priority  
Routing Commands  
252  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
decrement) for each downed interface. The default priority decrement is changed using the  
<priority> argument. The default priority of the virtual router is 100, and the default  
decrement priority is 10. By default, no interface are tracked. If you specify just the interface  
to be tracked, without giving the optional priority, the default priority will be set. The default  
priority decrement is 10.  
Default  
priority: 10  
Format  
Mode  
ip vrrp <vrid> track interface <slot/port> [decrement <priority>]  
Interface Config  
no ip vrrp track interface  
Use this command to remove the interface from the tracked list or to restore the priority  
decrement to its default.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip vrrp <vrid> track interface <slot/port> [decrement]  
Interface Config  
ip vrrp track ip route  
Use this command to track the route reachability. When the tracked route is deleted, the  
priority of the VRRP router will be decremented by the value specified in the <priority>  
argument. When the tracked route is added, the priority will be incremented by the same.  
A VRRP configured interface can track more than one route. When a tracked route goes  
down, then the priority of the router will be decreased by 10 (the default priority decrement)  
for each downed route. By default no routes are tracked. If you specify just the route to be  
tracked, without giving the optional priority, the default priority will be set. The default priority  
decrement is 10. The default priority decrement is changed using the <priority> argument.  
Default  
priority: 10  
Format  
Mode  
ip vrrp <vrid> track ip route <ip-address/prefix-length> [decrement  
<priority>]  
Interface Config  
no ip vrrp track ip route  
Use this command to remove the route from the tracked list or to restore the priority  
decrement to its default. When removing a tracked IP route from the tracked list, the priority  
should be incremented by the decrement value if the route is not reachable.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip vrrp <vrid> track ip route <ip-address/prefix-length>  
[decrement]  
Interface Config  
Routing Commands  
253  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
ip vrrp <vrid> accept-mode  
This command is used to allow a router to respond to ICMP Echo Requests sent to an  
address on a VRRP virtual router. VRRP supports responding to pings, but does not allow the  
VRRP Master to accept other types of packets. A new configuration option controls whether  
the router responds to Echo Requests sent to a VRRP IP address.  
The VRRP Master responds to both fragmented and unfragmented ICMP Echo Request  
packets. The VRRP Master responds to Echo Requests sent to the virtual router's primary  
address or any of its secondary addresses.  
Ping to a VRRP IP address only works from the host side (where the VRRP router is  
configured). There is no value in pinging to the VRRP IP from another interface because  
packet flow from the network to the host does not involve VRRP. This is used only to  
troubleshoot a connectivity problem for traffic originating on the VRRP protected LAN.  
Members of the virtual router who are in backup state discard ping packets destined to VRRP  
address(es), just as they discard any Ethernet frame sent to a VRRP MAC address. When  
the VRRP master responds with an Echo Reply, the source IPv4 address is the VRRP  
address and source MAC address is the virtual router's MAC address.  
There is a separate command "ip icmp echo-reply" that controls whether the router responds  
to ICMP Echo Requests. When Echo Replies are disabled using that command, the VRRP  
master does not respond to Echo Requests, even if this new option is enabled.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
ip vrrp <vrid> accept-mode  
Interface Config  
no ip vrrp vrid accept-mode  
This command is used to allow a router to respond to ICMP Echo Requests sent to an  
address on a VRRP virtual router.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip vrrp <vrid> accept-mode  
Interface Config  
show ip vrrp interface stats  
This command displays the statistical information about each virtual router configured on the  
switch.  
Format  
Modes  
show ip vrrp interface stats <slot/port> <vrid>  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Routing Commands  
254  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Uptime  
The time that the virtual router has been up, in days, hours, minutes, and seconds.  
The protocol configured on the interface.  
Protocol  
State  
Transitioned to  
Master  
The total number of times virtual router states has changed to MASTER.  
Advertisement  
Received  
The total number of VRRP advertisements received by this virtual router.  
Advertisement  
Interval Errors  
The total number of VRRP advertisements received for which advertisement interval is  
different than the configured value for this virtual router.  
Authentication  
Failure  
The total number of VRRP packets received that do not pass the authentication check.  
IP TTL errors  
The total number of VRRP packets received by the virtual router with IP TTL (time to live)  
not equal to 255.  
Zero Priority  
Packets  
The total number of VRRP packets received by virtual router with a priority of '0'.  
Received  
Zero Priority  
Packets Sent  
The total number of VRRP packets sent by the virtual router with a priority of '0'.  
The total number of VRRP packets received by the virtual router with invalid 'type' field.  
Invalid Type  
Packets  
Received  
Address List  
Errors  
The total number of VRRP packets received for which address list does not match the  
locally configured list for the virtual router.  
Invalid  
Authentication  
Type  
The total number of VRRP packets received with unknown authentication type.  
Authentication  
Type Mismatch  
The total number of VRRP advertisements received for which 'auth type' not equal to  
locally configured one for this virtual router.  
Packet Length  
Errors  
The total number of VRRP packets received with packet length less than length of VRRP  
header.  
show ip vrrp  
This command displays whether VRRP functionality is enabled or disabled on the switch. It  
also displays some global parameters which are required for monitoring. This command  
takes no options.  
Format  
Modes  
show ip vrrp  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Routing Commands  
255  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Admin Mode  
The administrative mode for VRRP functionality on the switch.  
Router  
Checksum  
Errors  
The total number of VRRP packets received with an invalid VRRP checksum value.  
Router Version  
Errors  
The total number of VRRP packets received with Unknown or unsupported version  
number.  
Router VRID  
Errors  
The total number of VRRP packets received with invalid VRID for this virtual router.  
show ip vrrp interface  
This command displays all configuration information and VRRP router statistics of a virtual  
router configured on a specific interface. Use the output of the command to verify the track  
interface and track IP route configurations.  
Format  
Modes  
show ip vrrp interface {<interface-name> <vrid> }  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Primary IP  
Address  
The configured IP address for the Virtual router.  
VMAC address  
The VMAC address of the specified router.  
Authentication  
type  
The authentication type for the specific virtual router.  
Priority  
The priority value for the specific virtual router, taking into account any priority  
decrements for tracked interfaces or routes.  
Configured  
Priority  
The priority configured through the ip vrrp <vrid> priority <1-254> command.  
Advertisement  
interval  
The advertisement interval in seconds for the specific virtual router.  
Pre-Empt Mode  
The preemption mode configured on the specified virtual router.  
The status (Enable or Disable) of the specific router.  
Administrative  
Mode  
State  
The state (Master/backup) of the virtual router.  
The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(Switch)#show ip vrrp interface 0/1 1  
Primary IP Address............................. 1.1.1.5  
VMAC Address................................... 00:00:5e:00:01:01  
Authentication Type............................ None  
Priority....................................... 100  
Configured priority.......................... 100  
Routing Commands  
256  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Advertisement Interval (secs).................. 1  
Pre-empt Mode.................................. Enable  
Administrative Mode............................ Disable  
Accept Mode.................................... Enable  
State.......................................... Initialized  
Track Interface State DecrementPriority  
--------------- ------ ------------------  
<0/1> down 10  
TrackRoute (pfx/len) StateDecrementPriority  
------------------------ ------ ------------------  
10.10.10.1/255.255.255.0 down 10  
show ip vrrp interface  
This command displays information about each virtual router configured on the switch. This  
command takes no options. It displays information about each virtual router.  
Format  
Modes  
show ip vrrp interface brief  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Interface  
Valid slot and port number separated by forward slashes.  
The router ID of the virtual router.  
VRID  
IP Address  
Mode  
The virtual router IP address.  
Indicates whether the virtual router is enabled or disabled.  
The state (Master/backup) of the virtual router.  
State  
DHCP and BOOTP Relay Commands  
This section describes the commands you use to configure BootP/DHCP Relay on the  
switch. A DHCP relay agent operates at Layer 3 and forwards DHCP requests and replies  
between clients and servers when they are not on the same physical subnet.  
bootpdhcprelay cidoptmode  
This command enables the circuit ID option mode for BootP/DHCP Relay on the system.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
bootpdhcprelay cidoptmode  
Global Config  
Routing Commands  
257  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no bootpdhcprelay cidoptmode  
This command disables the circuit ID option mode for BootP/DHCP Relay on the system.  
Format  
Mode  
no bootpdhcprelay cidoptmode  
Global Config  
bootpdhcprelay maxhopcount  
This command configures the maximum allowable relay agent hops for BootP/DHCP Relay  
on the system. The <hops>parameter has a range of 1–16.  
Default  
4
Format  
Mode  
bootpdhcprelay maxhopcount <1-16>  
Global Config  
no bootpdhcprelay maxhopcount  
This command configures the default maximum allowable relay agent hops for BootP/DHCP  
Relay on the system.  
Format  
Mode  
no bootpdhcprelay maxhopcount  
Global Config  
bootpdhcprelay minwaittime  
This command configures the minimum wait time in seconds for BootP/DHCP Relay on the  
system. When the BOOTP relay agent receives a BOOTREQUEST message, it MAY use the  
seconds-since-client-began-booting field of the request as a factor in deciding whether to  
relay the request or not. The parameter has a range of 0–100 seconds.  
Default  
0
Format  
Mode  
bootpdhcprelay minwaittime <0-100>  
Global Config  
no bootpdhcprelay minwaittime  
This command configures the default minimum wait time in seconds for BootP/DHCP Relay  
on the system.  
Format  
Mode  
no bootpdhcprelay minwaittime  
Global Config  
Routing Commands  
258  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show bootpdhcprelay  
This command displays the BootP/DHCP Relay information.  
Format  
show bootpdhcprelay  
Modes  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Maximum Hop  
Count  
The maximum allowable relay agent hops.  
Minimum Wait  
Time (Seconds)  
The minimum wait time.  
Admin Mode  
Indicates whether relaying of requests is enabled or disabled.  
The IP address for the BootP/DHCP Relay server.  
Server IP  
Address  
Circuit Id  
Option Mode  
The DHCP circuit Id option which might be enabled or disabled.  
The number or requests received.  
Requests  
Received  
Requests  
Relayed  
The number of requests relayed.  
Packets  
Discarded  
The number of packets discarded.  
IP Helper Commands  
This section describes the commands to configure a DHCP relay agent with multiple DHCP  
server addresses per routing interface, and to use different server addresses for client  
packets arriving on different interfaces on the relay agent.  
clear ip helper statistics  
Use this command to reset the statistics displayed in the show ip helper statistics  
command to zero.  
Format  
Mode  
clear ip helper statistics  
Privileged EXEC  
ip helper-address (Global Config)  
Use the Global Configuration ip helper-address command to have the switch forward User  
Datagram Protocol (UDP) broadcasts received on an interface. To disable the forwarding of  
broadcast packets to specific addresses, use the no form of this command.  
Routing Commands  
259  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
The ip helper-address command forwards specific UDP broadcast from one interface to  
another. You can define many helper addresses but the total number of address-port pairs is  
limited to 128 for the whole device. The setting of a helper address for a specific interface has  
precedence over a setting of a helper address for all interfaces.  
Ip-address: Destination broadcast or host address to be used when forwarding UDP  
broadcasts. You can specify 0.0.0.0 to indicate not to forward the UDP packet to any host  
and use "255.255.255.255" to broadcast the UDP packets to all hosts on the target subnet.  
udp-port-list: The broadcast packet destination UDP port number to forward. If not specified,  
packets for the default services are forwarded to the helper address. Valid range, 0-65535.  
Default  
Disabled  
Format  
ip helper-address <ip-address>  
{<1-65535>|dhcp|domain|isakmp|mobile-ip|nameserver|  
netbios-dgm|netbios-ns|ntp|pim-auto-rip|rip|tacacs|tftp|time}  
Mode  
Global Config  
no ip helper-address (Global Config)  
Use this command to remove the IP address from the previously configured list. The no  
command without an <ip-address> argument removes the entire list of helper addresses  
on that interface.  
Format  
no ip helper-address {<ip-address>}  
{<1-65535>|dhcp|domain|isakmp|mobile-ip|nameserver|  
netbios-dgm|netbios-ns|ntp|pim-auto-rip|rip|tacacs|tftp|time}  
Mode  
GlobalConfig  
ip helper enable  
Use this command to enable relay of UDP packets. This command can be used to  
temporarily disable IP helper without deleting all IP helper addresses. This command  
replaces the bootpdhcprelay enablecommand, but affects not only relay of DHCP  
packets, but also relay of any other protocols for which an IP helper address has been  
configured.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
ip helper enable  
Global Config  
no ip helper enable  
Use this command to disable relay of all UDP packets.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip helper enable  
Global Config  
Routing Commands  
260  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
ip helper-address  
Use this command to add a unicast helper address to the list of helper addresses on an  
interface. This is the address of a DHCP server. This command can be applied multiple times  
on the routing interface to form the helper addresses list until the list reaches the maximum  
supported helper addresses.  
Format  
ip helper-address <ip-address>  
{<1-65535>|dhcp|domain|isakmp|mobile-ip|nameserver|  
netbios-dgm|netbios-ns|ntp|pim-auto-rip|rip|tacacs|tftp|time}  
Mode  
Interface Config  
no ip helper-address  
Use this command to remove the IP address from the previously configured list. The no  
command without an <ip-address> argument removes the entire list of helper addresses  
on that interface.  
Format  
no ip helper-address {<ip-address>}  
{<1-65535>|dhcp|domain|isakmp|mobile-ip|nameserver|  
netbios-dgm|netbios-ns|ntp|pim-auto-rip|rip|tacacs|tftp|time}  
Mode  
Interface Config  
ip helper-address discard  
Use this command to drop matching packets.  
Format  
Mode  
ip helper-address discard  
{<1-65535>|dhcp|domain|isakmp|mobile-ip|nameserver|  
netbios-dgm|netbios-ns|ntp|pim-auto-rip|rip|tacacs|tftp|time}  
Interface Config  
no ip helper-address discard  
Use this command to permit the matching packets.  
Format  
no ip helper-address discard  
{<1-65535>|dhcp|domain|isakmp|mobile-ip|nameserver|  
netbios-dgm|netbios-ns|ntp|pim-auto-rip|rip|tacacs|tftp|time}  
Mode  
Interface Config  
show ip helper-address  
Use this command to display the configured helper addresses on the given interface.  
Format  
Mode  
show ip helper-address <interface>  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Routing Commands  
261  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(switch) #show ip helper-address 0/1  
Helper IP Address.............................. 1.2.3.4  
............................................... 1.2.3.5  
show ip helper statistics  
Use this command to display the number of DHCP and other UDP packets processed and  
relayed by the UDP relay agent.  
Format  
Mode  
show ip helper statistics  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
DHCP client  
messages received  
The number of valid messages received from a DHCP client. The count is  
incremented only if IP helper is enabled globally, the ingress routing interface is up,  
and the packet passes a number of validity checks, such as having a TTL>1 and  
having valid source and destination IP addresses.  
DHCP client  
messages relayed  
The number of DHCP client messages relayed to a server. If a message is relayed  
to multiple servers, the count is incremented once for each server.  
DHCP server  
messages received  
The number of DHCP responses received from the DHCP server. This count  
includes only messages that the DHCP server unicasts to the relay agent for relay  
to the client.  
DHCP server  
messages relayed  
The number of DHCP server messages relayed to a client.  
UDP clients  
messages received  
The number of valid UDP packets received. This count includes DHCP messages  
and all other protocols relayed. Conditions are similar to those for the first statistic in  
this table.  
UDP clients  
messages relayed  
The number of UDP packets relayed. This count includes DHCP messages relayed  
as well as all other protocols. The count is incremented for each server to which a  
packet is sent.  
DHCP message hop  
count exceeded max  
The number of DHCP client messages received whose hop count is larger than the  
maximum allowed. The maximum hop count is a configurable value listed in show  
bootpdhcprelay. A log message is written for each such failure. The DHCP relay  
agent does not relay these packets.  
DHCP message with  
secs field below min  
The number of DHCP client messages received whose secs field is less than the  
minimum value. The minimum secs value is a configurable value and is displayed in  
show bootpdhcprelay. A log message is written for each such failure. The DHCP  
relay agent does not relay these packets.  
DHCP message with  
giaddr set to local  
address  
The number of DHCP client messages received whose gateway address, giaddr, is  
already set to an IP address configured on one of the relay agent’s own IP  
addresses. In this case, another device is attempting to spoof the relay agent’s  
address. The relay agent does not relay such packets. A log message gives details  
for each occurrence.  
Routing Commands  
262  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Packets with expired  
TTL  
The number of packets received with TTL of 0 or 1 that might otherwise have been  
relayed.  
Packets that  
matched a discard  
entry  
The number of packets ignored by the relay agent because they match a discard  
relay entry.  
Open Shortest Path First (OSPF) Commands  
This section describes the commands you use to view and configure OSPF, which is a  
link-state routing protocol that you use to route traffic within a network.  
router ospf  
Use this command to enter Router OSPF mode.  
Format  
Mode  
router ospf  
Global Config  
enable (OSPF)  
This command resets the default administrative mode of OSPF in the router (active).  
Default  
enabled  
Format  
Mode  
enable  
Router OSPF Config  
no enable (OSPF)  
This command sets the administrative mode of OSPF in the router to inactive.  
Format  
Mode  
no enable  
Router OSPF Config  
network area (OSPF)  
Use this command to enable OSPFv2 on an interface and set its area ID if the IP address of  
an interface is covered by this network command.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
network <ip-address> <wildcard-mask> area <area-id>  
Router OSPF Config  
Routing Commands  
263  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no network area (OSPF)  
Use this command to disable the OSPFv2 on an interface if the IP address of an interface  
was earlier covered by this network command.  
Format  
Mode  
no network <ip-address> <wildcard-mask> area <area-id>  
Router OSPF Config  
ip ospf area  
Use this command to enable OSPFv2 and set the area ID of an interface. The <area-id> is  
an IP address formatted as a 4-digit dotted-decimal number or a decimal value in the range  
of <0-4294967295>. This command supersedes the effects of the network area  
command. It can also be used to configure the advertiseability of the secondary addresses  
on this interface into the OSPFv2 domain.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
ip ospf area <area-id> [secondaries none]  
Interface Config  
no ip ospf area  
Use this command to disable OSPF on an interface.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip ospf area [secondaries none]  
Interface Config  
1583compatibility  
This command enables OSPF 1583 compatibility.  
Note: 1583 compatibility mode is enabled by default. If all OSPF routers in  
the routing domain are capable of operating according to RFC 2328,  
OSPF 1583 compatibility mode should be disabled.  
Default  
enabled  
Format  
Mode  
1583compatibility  
Router OSPF Config  
Routing Commands  
264  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no 1583compatibility  
This command disables OSPF 1583 compatibility.  
Format  
Mode  
no 1583compatibility  
Router OSPF Config  
area default-cost (OSPF)  
This command configures the default cost for the stub area. You must specify the area ID  
and an integer value between 1-16,777,215.  
Format  
Mode  
area <areaid> default-cost <1-16777215>  
Router OSPF Config  
area nssa (OSPF)  
This command configures the specified area id to function as an NSSA.  
Format  
Mode  
area <areaid> nssa  
Router OSPF Config  
no area nssa  
This command disables nsa from the specified area id.  
Format  
Mode  
no area <areaid> nssa  
Router OSPF Config  
area nssa default-info-originate (OSPF)  
This command configures the metric value and type for the default route advertised into the  
NSSA. The optional metric parameter specifies the metric of the default route and is to be in  
a range of 1-16777214. If no metric is specified, the default value is 10. The metric type can  
be comparable (nssa-external 1) or non-comparable (nssa-external 2)  
Format  
Mode  
area <areaid> nssa default-info-originate [<metric>] [{comparable |  
non-comparable}]  
Router OSPF Config  
Routing Commands  
265  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no area nssa default-info-originate (OSPF)  
This command disables the default route advertised into the NSSA.  
Format  
Mode  
no area <areaid> nssa default-info-originate [<metric>] [{comparable  
| non-comparable}]  
Router OSPF Config  
area nssa no-redistribute (OSPF)  
This command configures the NSSA Area Border router (ABR) so that learned external  
routes will not be redistributed to the NSSA.  
Format  
Mode  
area <areaid> nssa no-redistribute  
Router OSPF Config  
no area nssa no-redistribute (OSPF)  
This command disables the NSSA ABR so that learned external routes are redistributed to  
the NSSA.  
Format  
Mode  
no area <areaid> nssa no-redistribute  
Router OSPF Config  
area nssa no-summary (OSPF)  
This command configures the NSSA so that the summary LSAs are not advertised into the  
NSSA.  
Format  
Mode  
area <areaid> nssa no-summary  
Router OSPF Config  
no area nssa no-summary (OSPF)  
This command disables nssa from the summary LSAs.  
Format  
Mode  
no area <areaid> nssa no-summary  
Router OSPF Config  
area nssa translator-role (OSPF)  
This command configures the translator role of the NSSA. A value of alwayscauses the  
router to assume the role of the translator the instant it becomes a border router and a value  
Routing Commands  
266  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
of candidatecauses the router to participate in the translator election process when it  
attains a border router status.  
Format  
Mode  
area <areaid> nssa translator-role {always | candidate}  
Router OSPF Config  
no area nssa translator (OSPF)  
This command disables the nssa translator role from the specified area id.  
Format  
Mode  
no area <areaid> nssa translator-role {always | candidate}  
Router OSPF Config  
area nssa translator-stab-intv (OSPF)  
This command configures the translator <stabilityinterval>of the NSSA. The  
<stabilityinterval> is the period of time that an elected translator continues to  
perform its duties after it determines that its translator status has been deposed by another  
router.  
Format  
Mode  
area <areaid> nssa translator-stab-intv <stabilityinterval>  
Router OSPF Config  
no area nssa translator-stab-intv (OSPF)  
This command disables the nssa translator’s <stabilityinterval>from the specified  
area id.  
Format  
Mode  
no area <areaid> nssa translator-stab-intv <stabilityinterval>  
Router OSPF Config  
area range (OSPF)  
Use this command in Router Configuration mode to configure a summary prefix that an area  
border router advertises for a specific area.  
Default  
No area ranges are configured by default. No cost is configured by default.  
Format  
area areaid range prefix netmask {summarylink |  
nssaexternallink} [advertise | not-advertise] [cost cost]  
Mode  
OSPFv2 Router Configuration  
Routing Commands  
267  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Parameter  
area-id  
Description  
The area identifier for the area whose networks are to be summarized.  
prefix netmask  
The summary prefix to be advertised when the ABR computes a route to one or more  
networks within this prefix in this area.  
summarylink  
nssaexternallink  
advertise  
When this keyword is given, the area range is used when summarizing prefixes advertised in  
type 3 summary LSAs.  
When this keyword is given, the area range is used when translating type 7 LSAs to type 5  
LSAs.  
[Optional] When this keyword is given, the summary prefix is advertised when the area range  
is active. This is the default.  
not-advertise  
[Optional] When this keyword is given, neither the summary prefix nor the contained prefixes  
are advertised when the area range is active. When the not-advertise option is given, any  
static cost previously configured is removed from the system configuration.  
cost  
[Optional] If an optional cost is given, OSPF sets the metric field in the summary LSA to the  
configured value rather than setting the metric to the largest cost among the networks  
covered by the area range. A static cost might only be configured if the area range is  
configured to advertise the summary. The range is 0–16,777,215. If the cost is set to  
16,777,215 for type 3 summarization, a type 3 summary LSA is not advertised, but contained  
networks are suppressed. This behavior is equivalent to specifying the not-advertise option. If  
the range is configured for type 7 to type 5 translation, a type 5 LSA is sent if the metric is set  
to 16,777,215; however, other routers will not compute a route from a type 5 LSA with this  
metric.  
no area range  
The no form of this command deletes a specified area range or reverts an option to its  
default.  
Format  
no area areaid range prefix netmask {summarylink |  
nssaexternallink} [advertise | not-advertise] [cost]  
Mode  
OSPFv2 Router Configuration  
area stub (OSPF)  
This command creates a stub area for the specified area ID. A stub area is characterized by  
the fact that AS External LSAs are not propagated into the area. Removing AS External LSAs  
and Summary LSAs can significantly reduce the link state database of routers within the stub  
area.  
Format  
Mode  
area <areaid> stub  
Router OSPF Config  
Routing Commands  
268  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no area stub  
This command deletes a stub area for the specified area ID.  
Format  
Mode  
no area <areaid> stub  
Router OSPF Config  
area stub no-summary (OSPF)  
This command configures the Summary LSA mode for the stub area identified by <areaid>.  
Use this command to prevent LSA Summaries from being sent.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
area <areaid> stub no-summary  
Router OSPF Config  
no area stub no-summary  
This command configures the default Summary LSA mode for the stub area identified by  
<areaid>.  
Format  
Mode  
no area <areaid> stub no-summary  
Router OSPF Config  
area virtual-link (OSPF)  
This command creates the OSPF virtual interface for the specified <areaid> and  
<neighbor>. The <neighbor> parameter is the Router ID of the neighbor.  
Format  
Mode  
area <areaid> virtual-link <neighbor>  
Router OSPF Config  
no area virtual-link  
This command deletes the OSPF virtual interface from the given interface, identified by  
<areaid> and <neighbor>. The <neighbor> parameter is the Router ID of the  
neighbor.  
Format  
Mode  
no area <areaid> virtual-link <neighbor>  
Router OSPF Config  
area virtual-link authentication  
This command configures the authentication type and key for the OSPF virtual interface  
identified by <areaid>and <neighbor>. The <neighbor> parameter is the Router ID of  
the neighbor. The value for <type> is either none, simple, or encrypt. The [key] is  
Routing Commands  
269  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
composed of standard displayable, non-control keystrokes from a Standard 101/102-key  
keyboard. The authentication key must be 8 bytes or less if the authentication type is simple.  
If the type is encrypt, the key might be up to 16 bytes. Unauthenticated interfaces do not need  
an authentication key. If the type is encrypt, a key id in the range of 0 and 255 must be  
specified. The default value for authentication type is none. Neither the default password key  
nor the default key id are configured.  
Default  
none  
Format  
Mode  
area <areaid> virtual-link <neighbor> authentication {none | {simple  
<key>} | {encrypt <key> <keyid>}}  
Router OSPF Config  
no area virtual-link authentication  
This command configures the default authentication type for the OSPF virtual interface  
identified by <areaid>and <neighbor>. The <neighbor>parameter is the Router ID of  
the neighbor.  
Format  
Mode  
no area <areaid> virtual-link <neighbor> authentication  
Router OSPF Config  
area virtual-link dead-interval (OSPF)  
This command configures the dead interval for the OSPF virtual interface on the virtual  
interface identified by <areaid>and <neighbor>.The <neighbor>parameter is the  
Router ID of the neighbor. The range for seconds is 1–65,535.  
Default  
40  
Format  
Mode  
area <areaid> virtual-link <neighbor> dead-interval <seconds>  
Router OSPF Config  
no area virtual-link dead-interval  
This command configures the default dead interval for the OSPF virtual interface on the  
virtual interface identified by <areaid>and <neighbor>. The <neighbor> parameter is  
the Router ID of the neighbor.  
Format  
Mode  
no area <areaid> virtual-link <neighbor> dead-interval  
Router OSPF Config  
Routing Commands  
270  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
area virtual-link hello-interval (OSPF)  
This command configures the hello interval for the OSPF virtual interface on the virtual  
interface identified by <areaid>and <neighbor>. The <neighbor>parameter is the  
Router ID of the neighbor. The range for <seconds>is 1–65535.  
Default  
10  
Format  
Mode  
area <areaid> virtual-link <neighbor> hello-interval <1-65535>  
Router OSPF Config  
no area virtual-link hello-interval  
This command configures the default hello interval for the OSPF virtual interface on the  
virtual interface identified by <areaid>and <neighbor>. The <neighbor>parameter is  
the Router ID of the neighbor.  
Format  
Mode  
no area <areaid> virtual-link <neighbor> hello-interval  
Router OSPF Config  
area virtual-link retransmit-interval (OSPF)  
This command configures the retransmit interval for the OSPF virtual interface on the virtual  
interface identified by <areaid>and <neighbor>. The <neighbor>parameter is the  
Router ID of the neighbor. The range for seconds is 0–3,600.  
Default  
5
Format  
Mode  
area <areaid> virtual-link <neighbor> retransmit-interval <seconds>  
Router OSPF Config  
no area virtual-link retransmit-interval  
This command configures the default retransmit interval for the OSPF virtual interface on the  
virtual interface identified by <areaid>and <neighbor>. The <neighbor> parameter is  
the Router ID of the neighbor.  
Format  
Mode  
no area <areaid> virtual-link <neighbor> retransmit-interval  
Router OSPF Config  
Routing Commands  
271  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
area virtual-link transmit-delay (OSPF)  
This command configures the transmit delay for the OSPF virtual interface on the virtual  
interface identified by <areaid>and <neighbor>. The <neighbor>parameter is the  
Router ID of the neighbor. The range for seconds is 0–3,600 (1 hour).  
Default  
1
Format  
Mode  
area <areaid> virtual-link <neighbor> transmit-delay <seconds>  
Router OSPF Config  
no area virtual-link transmit-delay  
This command resets the default transmit delay for the OSPF virtual interface to the default  
value.  
Format  
Mode  
no area <areaid> virtual-link <neighbor> transmit-delay  
Router OSPF Config  
auto-cost (OSPF)  
By default, OSPF computes the link cost of each interface from the interface bandwidth.  
Faster links have lower metrics, making them more attractive in route selection. The  
configuration parameters in the auto-cost reference bandwidthand bandwidth  
commands give you control over the default link cost. You can configure for OSPF an  
interface bandwidth that is independent of the actual link speed. A second configuration  
parameter allows you to control the ratio of interface bandwidth to link cost. The link cost is  
computed as the ratio of a reference bandwidth to the interface bandwidth (ref_bw / interface  
bandwidth), where interface bandwidth is defined by the bandwidthcommand. Because the  
default reference bandwidth is 100 Mbps, OSPF uses the same default link cost for all  
interfaces whose bandwidth is 100 Mbps or greater. Use the auto-costcommand to  
change the reference bandwidth, specifying the reference bandwidth in megabits per second  
(Mbps). The reference bandwidth range is 1-4294967 Mbps. The different reference  
bandwidth can be independently configured for OSPFv2 and OSPFv3.  
Default  
100 Mbps  
Format  
Mode  
auto-cost reference-bandwidth <1 to 4294967>  
Router OSPF Config  
no auto-cost reference-bandwidth (OSPF)  
Use this command to set the reference bandwidth to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no auto-cost reference-bandwidth  
Router OSPF Config  
Routing Commands  
272  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
bandwidth  
By default, OSPF computes the link cost of an interface as the ratio of the reference  
bandwidth to the interface bandwidth. Reference bandwidth is specified with the auto-cost  
command. For the OSPF link cost calculation, use the bandwidth command to specify the  
interface bandwidth. The bandwidth is specified in kilobits per second. If no bandwidth is  
configured, the bandwidth defaults to the actual interface bandwidth for port-based routing  
interfaces and to 10 Mbps for VLAN routing interfaces. This command does not affect the  
actual speed of an interface.  
Default  
actual interface bandwidth  
Format  
Mode  
bandwidth <1-10000000>  
Interface Config  
no bandwidth  
Use this command to set the interface bandwidth to its default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no bandwidth  
Interface Config  
capability opaque  
Use this command to enable Opaque Capability on the Router. The information contained in  
Opaque LSAs might be used directly by OSPF or indirectly by an application wishing to  
distribute information throughout the OSPF domain. The 7000 series supports the storing  
and flooding of Opaque LSAs of different scopes.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
capability opaque  
Router OSPF Config  
no capability opaque  
Use this command to disable opaque capability on the router.  
Format  
Mode  
no capability opaque  
Router OSPF Config  
clear ip ospf  
Use this command to disable and reenable OSPF.  
Format  
Mode  
clear ip ospf  
Privileged EXEC  
Routing Commands  
273  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
clear ip ospf configuration  
Use this command to reset the OSPF configuration to factory defaults.  
Format  
Mode  
clear ip ospf configuration  
Privileged EXEC  
clear ip ospf counters  
Use this command to reset global and interface statistics.  
Format  
Mode  
clear ip ospf counters  
Privileged EXEC  
clear ip ospf neighbor  
Use this command to drop the adjacency with all OSPF neighbors. On each neighbor’s  
interface, send a one way hello. Adjacencies might then be reestablished. To drop all  
adjacencies with a specific router ID, specify the neighbor’s Router ID using the optional  
parameter [neighbor-id].  
Format  
Mode  
clear ip ospf neighbor [neighbor-id]  
Privileged EXEC  
clear ip ospf neighbor interface  
To drop adjacency with all neighbors on a specific interface, use the optional parameter  
[slot/port]. To drop adjacency with a specific router ID on a specific interface, use the optional  
parameter [neighbor-id].  
Format  
Mode  
clear ip ospf neighbor interface [slot/port] [neighbor-id]  
Privileged EXEC  
clear ip ospf redistribution  
Use this command to flush all self-originated external LSAs. Reapply the redistribution  
configuration and reoriginate prefixes as necessary.  
Format  
Mode  
clear ip ospf redistribution  
Privileged EXEC  
clear ip ospf stub-router  
OSPF can enter stub router mode due to resource exhaustion (too many LSAs, too many  
routes, memory allocation failures, and so on). When this happens, the user can get out of  
this mode by issuing the command after the cause of the overload has been resolved.  
Routing Commands  
274  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Format  
Mode  
clear ip ospf stub-router  
Privileged EXEC  
default-information originate (OSPF)  
This command is used to control the advertisement of default routes.  
Default  
• metric—unspecified  
• type—2  
Format  
Mode  
default-information originate [always] [metric <0-16777214>]  
[metric-type {1 | 2}]  
Router OSPF Config  
no default-information originate (OSPF)  
This command is used to control the advertisement of default routes.  
Format  
Mode  
no default-information originate [metric] [metric-type]  
Router OSPF Config  
default-metric (OSPF)  
This command is used to set a default for the metric of distributed routes.  
Format  
Mode  
default-metric <1-16777214>  
Router OSPF Config  
no default-metric (OSPF)  
This command is used to set a default for the metric of distributed routes.  
Format  
Mode  
no default-metric  
Router OSPF Config  
distance ospf (OSPF)  
This command sets the route preference value of OSPF in the router. Lower route preference  
values are preferred when determining the best route. The type of OSPF route can be  
intra, inter, or external. All the external type routes are given the same preference  
value. The range of <preference> value is 1–255.  
Default  
110  
Routing Commands  
275  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Format  
Mode  
distance ospf {intra-area <1-255> | inter-area <1-255> | external  
<1-255>}  
Router OSPF Config  
no distance ospf  
This command sets the default route preference value of OSPF routes in the router. The type  
of OSPF can be intra, inter, or external. All the external type routes are given the same  
preference value.  
Format  
Mode  
no distance ospf {intra-area | inter-area | external}  
Router OSPF Config  
distribute-list out (OSPF)  
Use this command to specify the access list to filter routes received from the source protocol.  
Format  
Mode  
distribute-list <1-199> out {rip | static | connected}  
Router OSPF Config  
no distribute-list out  
Use this command to specify the access list to filter routes received from the source protocol.  
Format  
Mode  
no distribute-list <1-199> out {rip | static | connected}  
Router OSPF Config  
exit-overflow-interval (OSPF)  
This command configures the exit overflow interval for OSPF. It describes the number of  
seconds after entering overflow state that a router will wait before attempting to leave the  
overflow state. This allows the router to again originate non-default AS-external-LSAs. When  
set to 0, the router will not leave overflow state until restarted. The range for seconds is  
0–2,147,483,647 seconds.  
Default  
0
Format  
Mode  
exit-overflow-interval <seconds>  
Router OSPF Config  
no exit-overflow-interval  
This command configures the default exit overflow interval for OSPF.  
Format  
Mode  
no exit-overflow-interval  
Router OSPF Config  
Routing Commands  
276  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
external-lsdb-limit (OSPF)  
This command configures the external LSDB limit for OSPF. If the value is -1, there is no  
limit. When the number of non-default AS-external-LSAs in a router's link-state database  
reaches the external LSDB limit, the router enters overflow state. The router never holds  
more than the external LSDB limit non-default AS-external-LSAs in it database. The external  
LSDB limit must be set identically in all routers attached to the OSPF backbone and/or any  
regular OSPF area. The range for limit is -1 to 2147483647.  
Default  
-1  
Format  
Mode  
external-lsdb-limit <limit>  
Router OSPF Config  
no external-lsdb-limit  
This command configures the default external LSDB limit for OSPF.  
Format  
Mode  
no external-lsdb-limit  
Router OSPF Config  
log-adjacency-changes  
To enable logging of OSPFv2 neighbor state changes, use this command in router  
configuration mode. State changes are logged with INFORMATIONAL severity.  
Default  
Adjacency state changes are logged, but without the detail option.  
Format  
log-adjacency-changes [detail]  
Mode  
OSPFv2 Router Configuration  
Parameter  
detail  
Description  
(Optional) When this keyword is specified, all adjacency state changes are logged. Otherwise,  
OSPF only logs transitions to FULL state and when a backwards transition occurs.  
no log-adjacency-changes  
Use the no form of the command to disable state change logging.  
Format  
no log-adjacency-changes [detail]  
Mode  
OSPFv2 Router Configuration  
ip ospf authentication  
This command sets the OSPF Authentication Type and Key for the specified interface. The  
value of <type>is either none, simple, or encrypt. The <key> is composed of standard  
displayable, non-control keystrokes from a Standard 101/102-key keyboard. The  
Routing Commands  
277  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
authentication key must be 8 bytes or less if the authentication type is simple. If the type is  
encrypt, the key might be up to 16 bytes. If the type is encrypt a <keyid>in the range of 0  
and 255 must be specified. Unauthenticated interfaces do not need an authentication key or  
authentication key ID. There is no default value for this command.  
Format  
Mode  
ip ospf authentication {none | {simple <key>} | {encrypt <key>  
<keyid>}}  
Interface Config  
no ip ospf authentication  
This command sets the default OSPF Authentication Type for the specified interface.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip ospf authentication  
Interface Config  
ip ospf cost  
This command configures the cost on an OSPF interface. The <cost>parameter has a  
range of 1–65,535.  
Default  
10  
Format  
Mode  
ip ospf cost <1-65535>  
Interface Config  
no ip ospf cost  
This command configures the default cost on an OSPF interface.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip ospf cost  
Interface Config  
ip ospf database-filter all out  
Use this command in Interface Configuration mode to disable OSPFv2 LSA flooding on an  
interface.  
Default  
Disabled  
Format  
ip ospf database-filter all out  
Mode  
Interface Configuration  
Routing Commands  
278  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no ip ospf database-filter all out  
Use this command in Interface Configuration mode to enable OSPFv2 LSA flooding on an  
interface.  
Default  
Disabled  
Format  
Mode  
no ip ospf database-filter all out  
Interface Configuration  
ip ospf dead-interval  
This command sets the OSPF dead interval for the specified interface. The value for  
<seconds>is a valid positive integer, which represents the length of time in seconds that a  
router's Hello packets have not been seen before its neighbor routers declare that the router  
is down. The value for the length of time must be the same for all routers attached to a  
common network. This value should be some multiple of the Hello Interval (that is, 4). Valid  
values range in seconds from 1 to 2,147,483,647.  
Default  
40  
Format  
Mode  
ip ospf dead-interval <seconds>  
Interface Config  
no ip ospf dead-interval  
This command sets the default OSPF dead interval for the specified interface.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip ospf dead-interval  
Interface Config  
ip ospf hello-interval  
This command sets the OSPF hello interval for the specified interface. The value for seconds  
is a valid positive integer, which represents the length of time in seconds. The value for the  
length of time must be the same for all routers attached to a network. Valid values range from  
1 to 65,535.  
Default  
10  
Format  
Mode  
ip ospf hello-interval <seconds>  
Interface Config  
Routing Commands  
279  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no ip ospf hello-interval  
This command sets the default OSPF hello interval for the specified interface.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip ospf hello-interval  
Interface Config  
ip ospf network  
Use this command to configure OSPF to treat an interface as a point-to-point rather than  
broadcast interface. The broadcastoption sets the OSPF network type to broadcast. The  
point-to-point option sets the OSPF network type to point-to-point. OSPF treats  
interfaces as broadcast interfaces by default. (Loopback interfaces have a special loopback  
network type, which cannot be changed.) When there are only two routers on the network,  
OSPF can operate more efficiently by treating the network as a point-to-point network. For  
point-to-point networks, OSPF does not elect a designated router or generate a network link  
state advertisement (LSA). Both endpoints of the link must be configured to operate in  
point-to-point mode.  
Default  
broadcast  
Format  
Mode  
ip ospf network {broadcast|point-to-point}  
Interface Config  
no ip ospf network  
Use this command to return the OSPF network type to the default.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip ospf network  
Interface Config  
ip ospf priority  
This command sets the OSPF priority for the specified router interface. The priority of the  
interface is a priority integer from 0 to 255. A value of 0 indicates that the router is not eligible  
to become the designated router on this network.  
Default  
1, which is the highest router priority  
Format  
Mode  
ip ospf priority <0-255>  
Interface Config  
Routing Commands  
280  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no ip ospf priority  
This command sets the default OSPF priority for the specified router interface.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip ospf priority  
Interface Config  
ip ospf retransmit-interval  
This command sets the OSPF retransmit Interval for the specified interface. The retransmit  
interval is specified in seconds. The value for <seconds>is the number of seconds between  
link-state advertisement retransmissions for adjacencies belonging to this router interface.  
This value is also used when retransmitting database description and link-state request  
packets. Valid values range from 0 to 3600 (1 hour).  
Default  
5
Format  
Mode  
ip ospf retransmit-interval <0-3600>  
Interface Config  
no ip ospf retransmit-interval  
This command sets the default OSPF retransmit Interval for the specified interface.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip ospf retransmit-interval  
Interface Config  
ip ospf transmit-delay  
This command sets the OSPF Transit Delay for the specified interface. The transmit delay is  
specified in seconds. In addition, it sets the estimated number of seconds it takes to transmit  
a link state update packet over this interface. Valid values for <seconds>range from 1 to  
3600 (1 hour).  
Default  
1
Format  
Mode  
ip ospf transmit-delay <1-3600>  
Interface Config  
no ip ospf transmit-delay  
This command sets the default OSPF Transit Delay for the specified interface.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip ospf transmit-delay  
Interface Config  
Routing Commands  
281  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
ip ospf mtu-ignore  
This command disables OSPF maximum transmission unit (MTU) mismatch detection. OSPF  
Database Description packets specify the size of the largest IP packet that can be sent  
without fragmentation on the interface. When a router receives a Database Description  
packet, it examines the MTU advertised by the neighbor. By default, if the MTU is larger than  
the router can accept, the Database Description packet is rejected and the OSPF adjacency  
is not established.  
Default  
enabled  
Format  
Mode  
ip ospf mtu-ignore  
Interface Config  
no ip ospf mtu-ignore  
This command enables the OSPF MTU mismatch detection.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip ospf mtu-ignore  
Interface Config  
router-id (OSPF)  
This command sets a 4-digit dotted-decimal number uniquely identifying the router ospf id.  
The <ipaddress>is a configured value.  
Format  
Mode  
router-id <ipaddress>  
Router OSPF Config  
redistribute (OSPF)  
This command configures OSPF protocol to allow redistribution of routes from the specified  
source protocol/routers.  
Default  
• metric—unspecified  
• type—2  
• tag—0  
Format  
Mode  
redistribute {rip | static | connected} [metric <0-16777214>]  
[metric-type {1 | 2}] [tag <0-4294967295>] [subnets]  
Router OSPF Config  
Routing Commands  
282  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no redistribute  
This command configures OSPF protocol to prohibit redistribution of routes from the  
specified source protocol/routers.  
Format  
Mode  
no redistribute {rip | static | connected} [metric] [metric-type]  
[tag] [subnets]  
Router OSPF Config  
maximum-paths (OSPF)  
This command sets the number of paths that OSPF can report for a given destination where  
maxpathsis platform-dependent.  
Default  
4
Format  
Mode  
maximum-paths <maxpaths>  
Router OSPF Config  
no maximum-paths  
This command resets the number of paths that OSPF can report for a given destination back  
to its default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no maximum-paths  
Router OSPF Config  
passive-interface default (OSPF)  
Use this command to enable global passive mode by default for all interfaces. It overrides  
any interface level passive mode. OSPF will not form adjacencies over a passive interface.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
passive-interface default  
Router OSPF Config  
no passive-interface default  
Use this command to disable the global passive mode by default for all interfaces. Any  
interface previously configured to be passive reverts to non-passive mode.  
Format  
Mode  
no passive-interface default  
Router OSPF Config  
Routing Commands  
283  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
passive-interface (OSPF)  
Use this command to set the interface or tunnel as passive. It overrides the global passive  
mode that is effective on the interface or tunnel.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
passive-interface {<slot/port>}  
Router OSPF Config  
no passive-interface  
Use this command to set the interface or tunnel as non-passive. It overrides the global  
passive mode that is effective on the interface or tunnel.  
Format  
Mode  
no passive-interface {<slot/port>}  
Router OSPF Config  
timers pacing flood  
To adjust the rate at which OSPFv2 sends LS Update packets, use this command in router  
OSPFv2 global configuration mode. OSPF distributes routing information in Link State  
Advertisements (LSAs), which are bundled into Link State Update (LS Update) packets. To  
reduce the likelihood of sending a neighbor more packets than it can buffer, OSPF rate limits  
the transmission of LS Update packets. By default, OSPF sends up to 30 updates per second  
on each interface (1/the pacing interval). Use this command to adjust this packet rate.  
Default  
33 milliseconds  
Format  
timers pacing flood milliseconds  
Mode  
OSPFv2 Router Configuration  
Parameter  
Description  
milliseconds  
The average time between transmission of LS Update packets. The range is from 5 ms to 100  
ms. The default is 33 ms.  
no timers pacing flood  
To revert LSA transmit pacing to the default rate, use the no timers pacing flood command.  
Format  
no timers pacing flood  
Mode  
OSPFv2 Router Configuration  
Routing Commands  
284  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
timers pacing lsa-group  
To adjust how OSPF groups LSAs for periodic refresh, use this command in OSPFv2 Router  
Configuration mode. OSPF refreshes self-originated LSAs once every 30 minutes. When  
OSPF refreshes LSAs, it considers all self-originated LSAs whose age is from 1800 to 1800  
plus the pacing group size. Grouping LSAs for refresh allows OSPF to combine refreshed  
LSAs into a minimal number of LS Update packets. Minimizing the number of Update  
packets makes LSA distribution more efficient. When OSPF originates a new or changed  
LSA, it selects a random refresh delay for the LSA. When the refresh delay expires, OSPF  
refreshes the LSA. By selecting a random refresh delay, OSPF avoids refreshing a large  
number of LSAs at one time, even if a large number of LSAs are originated at one time.  
Default  
60 seconds  
Format  
Mode  
timers pacing lsa-group seconds  
OSPFv2 Router Configuration  
Parameter  
seconds  
Description  
Width of the window in which LSAs are refreshed. The range for the pacing group window is  
from 10 to 1800 seconds.  
timers spf  
Use this command to configure the SPF delay time and hold time. The valid range for both  
parameters is 0-65535 seconds.  
Default  
• delay-time—5  
• hold-time—10  
Format  
Mode  
timers spf <delay-time> <hold-time>  
Router OSPF Config  
Routing Commands  
285  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
trapflags (OSPF)  
Use this command to enable individual OSPF traps, enable a group of trap flags at a time, or  
enable all the trap flags at a time. The different groups of trapflags, and each group’s specific  
trapflags to enable or disable, are listed in Table 1.  
Table 1. Trapflags Groups  
Group  
errors  
Flags  
• authentication-failure  
• bad-packet  
• config-error  
• virt-authentication-failure  
• virt-bad-packet  
• virt-config-error  
if-rx  
lsa  
ir-rx-packet  
• lsa-maxage  
• lsa-originate  
overflow  
• lsdb-overflow  
• lsdb-approaching-overflow  
retransmit  
• packets  
• virt-packets  
rtb  
• rtb-entry-info  
state-change  
• if-state-change  
• neighbor-state-change  
• virtif-state-change  
• virtneighbor-state-change  
To enable the individual flag, enter the group namefollowed by that particular flag.  
To enable all the flags in that group, give the group name followed by all.  
To enable all the flags, give the command as trapflags all.  
Routing Commands  
286  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Default  
Format  
disabled  
trapflags {  
all |  
errors {all | authentication-failure | bad-packet | config-error |  
virt-  
authentication-failure | virt-bad-packet | virt-config-error} |  
if-rx {all | if-rx-packet} |  
lsa {all | lsa-maxage | lsa-originate} |  
overflow {all | lsdb-overflow | lsdb-approaching-overflow} |  
retransmit {all | packets | virt-packets} |  
rtb {all, rtb-entry-info} |  
state-change {all | if-state-change | neighbor-state-change |  
virtif-state-  
change | virtneighbor-state-change}  
}
Mode  
Router OSPF Config  
no trapflags  
Use this command to revert to the default reference bandwidth.  
To disable the individual flag, enter the group namefollowed by that particular flag.  
To disable all the flags in that group, give the group name followed by all.  
To disable all the flags, give the command as trapflags all.  
Format  
no trapflags {  
all |  
errors {all | authentication-failure | bad-packet | config-error |  
virt-  
authentication-failure | virt-bad-packet | virt-config-error} |  
if-rx {all | if-rx-packet} |  
lsa {all | lsa-maxage | lsa-originate} |  
overflow {all | lsdb-overflow | lsdb-approaching-overflow} |  
retransmit {all | packets | virt-packets} |  
rtb {all, rtb-entry-info} |  
state-change {all | if-state-change | neighbor-state-change |  
virtif-state-  
change | virtneighbor-state-change}  
}
Mode  
Router OSPF Config  
Routing Commands  
287  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show ip ospf  
This command displays information relevant to the OSPF router.  
Format  
show ip ospf  
Mode  
Privileged EXEC  
Note: Some of the information below displays only if you enable OSPF  
and configure certain features.  
Term  
Definition  
Router ID  
A 32-bit integer in dotted decimal format identifying the router, about which information is  
displayed. This is a configured value.  
OSPF Admin  
Mode  
Shows whether the administrative mode of OSPF in the router is enabled or disabled.  
This is a configured value.  
ASBR Mode  
Indicates whether the ASBR mode is enabled or disabled. Enable implies that the router  
is an autonomous system border router. Router automatically becomes an ASBR when it  
is configured to redistribute routes learnt from other protocol. The possible values for the  
ASBR status is enabled (if the router is configured to redistribute routes learned by other  
protocols) or disabled (if the router is not configured for the same).  
RFC 1583  
Compatibility  
Indicates whether 1583 compatibility is enabled or disabled. This is a configured value.  
External LSDB  
Limit  
The maximum number of non-default AS-external-LSA (link state advertisement) entries  
that can be stored in the link-state database.  
Exit Overflow  
Interval  
The number of seconds that, after entering overflow state, a router will attempt to leave  
overflow state.  
Spf Delay Time  
The number of seconds between two subsequent changes of LSAs, during which time  
the routing table calculation is delayed.  
Spf Hold Time  
The number of seconds between two consecutive spf calculations.  
Flood Pacing  
Interval  
The average time, in milliseconds, between LS Update packet transmissions on an  
interface. This is the value configured with the timers pacing flood command.  
LSA Refresh  
Group Pacing  
Time  
The size, in seconds, of the LSA refresh group window. This is the value configured with  
Opaque  
Capability  
Shows whether the router is capable of sending Opaque LSAs. This is a configured  
value.  
Autocost Ref  
BW  
Shows the value of auto-cost reference bandwidth configured on the router.  
Shows whether the router is an OSPF Area Border Router.  
ABR Status  
Routing Commands  
288  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
ASBR Status  
Reflects whether the ASBR mode is enabled or disabled. Enable implies that the router  
is an autonomous system border router. The router automatically becomes an ASBR  
when it is configured to redistribute routes learnt from other protocols. The possible  
values for the ASBR status is enabled (if the router is configured to redistribute routes  
learned by other protocols) or disabled (if the router is not configured for the same).  
Stub Router  
When OSPF runs out of resources to store the entire link state database, or any other  
state information, OSPF goes into stub router mode. As a stub router, OSPF reoriginates  
its own router LSAs, setting the cost of all nonstub interfaces to infinity. To restore OSPF  
to normal operation, disable and reenable OSPF.  
Exit Overflow  
Interval  
The number of seconds that, after entering overflow state, a router will attempt to leave  
overflow state.  
External LSDB  
Overflow  
When the number of non-default external LSAs exceeds the configured limit, External  
LSDB Limit, OSPF goes into LSDB overflow state. In this state, OSPF withdraws all of its  
self-originated non-default external LSAs. After the Exit Overflow Interval, OSPF leaves  
the overflow state, if the number of external LSAs has been reduced.  
External LSA  
Count  
The number of external (LS type 5) link-state advertisements in the link-state database.  
External LSA  
Checksum  
The sum of the LS checksums of external link-state advertisements contained in the  
link-state database.  
AS_OPAQUE  
LSA Count  
Shows the number of AS Opaque LSAs in the link-state database.  
AS_OPAQUE  
LSA Checksum  
Shows the sum of the LS Checksums of AS Opaque LSAs contained in the link-state  
database.  
New LSAs  
Originated  
The number of new link-state advertisements that have been originated.  
LSAs Received  
LSA Count  
The number of link-state advertisements received determined to be new instantiations.  
The total number of link state advertisements currently in the link state database.  
The maximum number of LSAs that OSPF can store.  
Maximum  
Number of  
LSAs  
LSA High Water  
Mark  
The maximum size of the link state database since the system started.  
Retransmit List  
Entries  
The total number of LSAs waiting to be acknowledged by all neighbors. An LSA might be  
pending acknowledgment from more than one neighbor.  
Maximum  
Number of  
Retransmit  
Entries  
The maximum number of LSAs that can be waiting for acknowledgment at any given  
time.  
Retransmit  
Entries High  
Water Mark  
The highest number of LSAs that have been waiting for acknowledgment.  
External LSDB  
Limit  
The maximum number of non-default AS-external-LSAs entries that can be stored in the  
link-state database.  
Default Metric  
Default value for redistributed routes.  
Routing Commands  
289  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Default Passive  
Setting  
Shows whether the interfaces are passive by default.  
Default Route  
Advertise  
Indicates whether the default routes received from other source protocols are advertised  
or not.  
Always  
Metric  
Shows whether default routes are always advertised.  
The metric of the routes being redistributed. If the metric is not configured, this field is  
blank.  
Metric Type  
Shows whether the routes are External Type 1 or External Type 2.  
Number of  
Active Areas  
The number of active OSPF areas. An “active” OSPF area is an area with at least one  
interface up.  
AutoCost Ref  
BW  
Shows the value of auto-cost reference bandwidth configured on the router.  
The maximum number of paths that OSPF can report for a given destination.  
Maximum Paths  
Redistributing  
This field is a heading and appears only if you configure the system to take routes  
learned from a non-OSPF source and advertise them to its peers.  
Source  
The source protocol/routes that are being redistributed. Possible values are static,  
connected, or RIP.  
Tag  
The decimal value attached to each external route.  
Subnets  
Distribute-List  
For redistributing routes into OSPF, the scope of redistribution for the specified protocol.  
The access list used to filter redistributed routes.  
The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(Switch) #show ip ospf  
Router ID.....................................2.2.2.2  
OSPF Admin Mode...............................Disable  
RFC 1583 Compatibility........................Enable  
External LSDB Limit...........................No Limit  
Exit Overflow Interval........................0  
Spf Delay Time................................5  
Spf Hold Time.................................10  
Opaque Capability.............................Disable  
AutoCost Ref BW...............................100 Mbps  
Default Passive Setting.......................Disabled  
Maximum Paths.................................4  
Default Metric................................Not configured  
Default Route Advertise.......................Disabled  
Always........................................FALSE  
Metric........................................Not configured  
Metric Type...................................External Type 2  
Routing Commands  
290  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Number of Active Areas......................... 3 (3 normal, 0 stub, 0 nssa)  
ABR Status....................................Disable  
ASBR Status...................................Disable  
Stub Router...................................FALSE  
External LSDB Overflow........................FALSE  
External LSA Count............................0  
External LSA Checksum.........................0  
AS_OPAQUE LSA Count...........................0  
AS_OPAQUE LSA Checksum........................0  
LSAs Originated...............................0  
LSAs Received.................................0  
LSA Count.....................................0  
Maximum Number of LSAs........................18200  
LSA High Water Mark...........................0  
Retransmit List Entries........................ 9078  
Maximum Number of Retransmit Entries........... 72800  
Retransmit Entries High Water Mark............. 72849  
show ip ospf abr  
This command displays the internal OSPF routing table entries to Area Border Routers  
(ABR). This command takes no options.  
Format  
Mode  
show ip ospf abr  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Type  
Definition  
The type of the route to the destination. It can be either:  
• intra — Intra-area route  
• inter — Inter-area route  
Router ID  
Cost  
Router ID of the destination.  
Cost of using this route.  
Area ID  
The area ID of the area from which this route is learned.  
Next hop toward the destination.  
Next Hop  
Next Hop Intf  
The outgoing router interface to use when forwarding traffic to the next hop.  
show ip ospf area  
This command displays information about the area. The <areaid>identifies the OSPF area  
that is being displayed.  
Format  
Modes  
show ip ospf area <areaid>  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Routing Commands  
291  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
AreaID  
The area id of the requested OSPF area.  
External  
Routing  
A number representing the external routing capabilities for this area.  
Spf Runs  
The number of times that the intra-area route table has been calculated using this area's  
link-state database.  
Area Border  
Router Count  
The total number of area border routers reachable within this area.  
Area LSA Count  
Total number of link-state advertisements in this area's link-state database, excluding AS  
External LSAs.  
Area LSA  
Checksum  
A number representing the Area LSA Checksum for the specified AreaID excluding the  
external (LS type 5) link-state advertisements.  
Import  
Summary LSAs  
Shows whether to import summary LSAs.  
OSPF Stub  
Metric Value  
The metric value of the stub area. This field displays only if the area is a configured as a  
stub area.  
The following OSPF NSSA-specific information displays only if the area is configured as an  
NSSA:  
Term  
Definition  
Import  
Summary LSAs  
Shows whether to import summary LSAs into the NSSA.  
Redistribute  
into NSSA  
Shows whether to redistribute information into the NSSA.  
Shows whether to advertise a default route into the NSSA.  
Default  
Information  
Originate  
Default Metric  
The metric value for the default route advertised into the NSSA.  
The metric type for the default route advertised into the NSSA.  
Default Metric  
Type  
Translator Role  
The NSSA translator role of the ABR, which is always or candidate.  
Translator  
Stability Interval  
The amount of time that an elected translator continues to perform its duties after it  
determines that its translator status has been deposed by another router.  
Translator State  
Shows whether the ABR translator state is disabled, always, or elected.  
Routing Commands  
292  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show ip ospf asbr  
This command displays the internal OSPF routing table entries to Autonomous System  
Boundary Routers (ASBR). This command takes no options.  
Format  
show ip ospf asbr  
Mode  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Type  
Definition  
The type of the route to the destination. It can be one of the following values:  
intra — Intra-area route  
inter — Inter-area route  
Router ID  
Cost  
Router ID of the destination.  
Cost of using this route.  
Area ID  
The area ID of the area from which this route is learned.  
Next hop toward the destination.  
Next Hop  
Next Hop Intf  
The outgoing router interface to use when forwarding traffic to the next hop.  
show ip ospf database  
This command displays information about the link state database when OSPF is enabled. If  
you do not enter any parameters, the command displays the LSA headers for all areas. Use  
the optional <areaid>parameter to display database information about a specific area. Use  
the optional parameters to specify the type of link state advertisements to display.  
Parameter  
Description  
asbr-summary  
Use asbr-summaryto show the autonomous system boundary router (ASBR) summary  
LSAs.  
external  
Use externalto display the external LSAs.  
Use networkto display the network LSAs.  
network  
nssa-external  
opaque-area  
opaque-as  
opaque-link  
router  
Use nssa-externalto display NSSA external LSAs.  
Use opaque-areato display area opaque LSAs.  
Use opaque-asto display AS opaque LSAs.  
Use opaque-linkto display link opaque LSAs.  
Use routerto display router LSAs.  
summary  
Use summaryto show the LSA database summary information.  
Routing Commands  
293  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Parameter  
adv-router  
Description  
Use adv-routerto show the LSAs that are restricted by the advertising router.  
self-originate  
Use self-originateto display the LSAs in that are self originated. The information  
below is only displayed if OSPF is enabled  
The information below is only displayed if OSPF is enabled.  
Format  
show ip ospf [<areaid>] database [{database-summary | [{asbr-summary  
| external | network | nssa-external | opaque-area | opaque-as |  
opaque-link | router | summary}] [{adv-router [<ipaddr>] |  
self-originate}]}]  
Mode  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
For each link-type and area, the following information is displayed:  
Term  
Definition  
Adv Router  
The Advertising Router. Is a 32 bit dotted decimal number representing the LSDB  
interface.  
Age  
A number representing the age of the link state advertisement in seconds.  
A number that represents which LSA is more recent.  
The total number LSA checksum.  
Sequence  
Checksum  
Options  
This is an integer. It indicates that the LSA receives special handling during routing  
calculations.  
Rtr Opt  
Router Options are valid for router links only.  
show ip ospf database database-summary  
Use this command to display the number of each type of LSA in the database for each area  
and for the router. The command also displays the total number of LSAs in the database.  
Format  
Modes  
show ip ospf database database-summary  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Router  
Total number of router LSAs in the OSPF link state database.  
Total number of network LSAs in the OSPF link state database.  
Total number of summary network LSAs in the database.  
Network  
Summary Net  
Summary ASBR  
Number of summary ASBR LSAs in the database.  
Routing Commands  
294  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Type-7 Ext  
Total number of Type-7 external LSAs in the database.  
Self-Originated  
Type-7  
Total number of self originated AS external LSAs in the OSPFv3 link state database.  
Opaque Link  
Opaque Area  
Subtotal  
Number of opaque link LSAs in the database.  
Number of opaque area LSAs in the database.  
Number of entries for the identified area.  
Number of opaque AS LSAs in the database.  
Number of entries for all areas.  
Opaque AS  
Total  
show ip ospf interface  
This command displays the information for the IFO object or virtual interface tables.  
Format  
Mode  
show ip ospf interface {<slot/port> | loopback <loopback-id> | vlan  
<1-4093>}  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
IP Address  
The IP address for the specified interface.  
Subnet Mask  
A mask of the network and host portion of the IP address for the OSPF interface.  
The secondary IP addresses if any are configured on the interface.  
Secondary IP  
Address(es)  
OSPF Admin  
Mode  
States whether OSPF is enabled or disabled on a router interface.  
OSPF Area ID  
The OSPF Area ID for the specified interface.  
OSPF Network  
Type  
The type of network on this interface that the OSPF is running on.  
Router Priority  
A number representing the OSPF Priority for the specified interface.  
Retransmit  
Interval  
A number representing the OSPF Retransmit Interval for the specified interface.  
Hello Interval  
Dead Interval  
A number representing the OSPF Hello Interval for the specified interface.  
A number representing the OSPF Dead Interval for the specified interface.  
LSA Ack  
Interval  
A number representing the OSPF LSA Acknowledgment Interval for the specified  
interface.  
Transit Delay  
Interval  
A number representing the OSPF Transit Delay for the specified interface.  
Authentication  
Type  
The OSPF Authentication Type for the specified interface are: none, simple, and encrypt.  
Routing Commands  
295  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Metric Cost  
The cost of the OSPF interface.  
Passive Status  
Shows whether the interface is passive or not.  
OSPF  
MTU-ignore  
Indicates whether to ignore MTU mismatches in database descriptor packets sent from  
neighboring routers.  
The information below will only be displayed if OSPF is enabled.  
Term  
Definition  
OSPF Interface  
Type  
Broadcast LANs, such as Ethernet and IEEE 802.5, take the value broadcast. The  
OSPF Interface Type will be 'broadcast'.  
State  
The OSPF Interface States are: down, loopback, waiting, point-to-point, designated  
router, and backup designated router.  
Designated  
Router  
The router ID representing the designated router.  
Backup  
Designated  
Router  
The router ID representing the backup designated router.  
Number of Link  
Events  
The number of link events.  
Local Link LSAs  
The number of Link Local Opaque LSAs in the link-state database.  
Local Link LSA  
Checksum  
The sum of LS Checksums of Link Local Opaque LSAs in the link-state database.  
show ip ospf interface brief  
This command displays brief information for the IFO object or virtual interface tables.  
Format  
Mode  
show ip ospf interface brief  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Interface  
Valid slot and port number separated by forward slashes.  
States whether OSPF is enabled or disabled on a router interface.  
OSPF Admin  
Mode  
OSPF Area ID  
Router Priority  
Hello Interval  
Dead Interval  
The OSPF Area Id for the specified interface.  
A number representing the OSPF Priority for the specified interface.  
A number representing the OSPF Hello Interval for the specified interface.  
A number representing the OSPF Dead Interval for the specified interface.  
Routing Commands  
296  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Retransmit  
Interval  
A number representing the OSPF Retransmit Interval for the specified interface.  
A number representing the OSPF Transit Delay for the specified interface.  
Retransmit  
Delay Interval  
LSA Ack  
Interval  
A number representing the OSPF LSA Acknowledgment Interval for the specified  
interface.  
show ip ospf interface stats  
This command displays the statistics for a specific interface. The information below will only  
be displayed if OSPF is enabled.  
Format  
Modes  
show ip ospf interface stats <slot/port>  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
OSPF Area ID  
The area id of this OSPF interface.  
Area Border  
Router Count  
The total number of area border routers reachable within this area. This is initially zero,  
and is calculated in each SPF pass.  
AS Border  
Router Count  
The total number of Autonomous System border routers reachable within this area.  
Area LSA Count  
The total number of link-state advertisements in this area's link-state database, excluding  
AS External LSAs.  
IP Address  
The IP address associated with this OSPF interface.  
OSPF Interface  
Events  
The number of times the specified OSPF interface has changed its state, or an error has  
occurred.  
Virtual Events  
The number of state changes or errors that occurred on this virtual link.  
Neighbor  
Events  
The number of times this neighbor relationship has changed state, or an error has  
occurred.  
External LSA  
Count  
The number of external (LS type 5) link-state advertisements in the link-state database.  
Sent Packets  
The number of OSPF packets transmitted on the interface.  
The number of valid OSPF packets received on the interface.  
Received  
Packets  
Discards  
The number of received OSPF packets discarded because of an error in the packet or an  
error in processing the packet.  
Bad Version  
The number of received OSPF packets whose version field in the OSPF header does not  
match the version of the OSPF process handling the packet.  
Routing Commands  
297  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Source Not On  
Local Subnet  
The number of received packets discarded because the source IP address is not within a  
subnet configured on a local interface.  
Note: This field only applies to OSPFv2.  
Virtual Link Not  
Found  
The number of received OSPF packets discarded where the ingress interface is in a  
non-backbone area and the OSPF header identifies the packet as belonging to the  
backbone, but OSPF does not have a virtual link to the packet’s sender.  
Area Mismatch  
The number of OSPF packets discarded because the area ID in the OSPF header is not  
the area ID configured on the ingress interface.  
Invalid  
Destination  
Address  
The number of OSPF packets discarded because the packet’s destination IP address is  
not the address of the ingress interface and is not the AllDrRouters or AllSpfRouters  
multicast addresses.  
Wrong  
Authentication  
Type  
The number of packets discarded because the authentication type specified in the OSPF  
header does not match the authentication type configured on the ingress interface.  
Note: This field only applies to OSPFv2.  
Authentication  
Failure  
The number of OSPF packets dropped because the sender is not an existing neighbor or  
the sender’s IP address does not match the previously recorded IP address for that  
neighbor.  
Note: This field only applies to OSPFv2.  
No Neighbor at  
Source Address  
The number of OSPF packets dropped because the sender is not an existing neighbor or  
the sender’s IP address does not match the previously recorded IP address for that  
neighbor.  
Note: Does not apply to Hellos.  
Invalid OSPF  
Packet Type  
The number of OSPF packets discarded because the packet type field in the OSPF  
header is not a known type.  
Hellos Ignored  
The number of received Hello packets that were ignored by this router from the new  
neighbors after the limit has been reached for the number of neighbors on an interface or  
on the system as a whole.  
The command lists the number of OSPF packets of each type sent and received on the  
interface.  
Packet Type  
Hello  
Sent  
6960  
3
Received  
6960  
3
Database Description  
LS Request  
1
1
LS Update  
141  
40  
42  
135  
LS Acknowledgment  
Routing Commands  
298  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show ip ospf neighbor  
This command displays information about OSPF neighbors. If you do not specify a neighbor  
IP address, the output displays summary information in a table. If you specify an interface or  
tunnel, only the information for that interface or tunnel displays. The <ip-address>is the IP  
address of the neighbor, and when you specify this, detailed information about the neighbor  
displays. The information below only displays if OSPF is enabled and the interface has a  
neighbor.  
Format  
Modes  
show ip ospf neighbor [interface <slot/port>] [<ip-address>]  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
If you do not specify an IP address, a table with the following columns displays for all  
neighbors or the neighbor associated with the interface that you specify:  
Term  
Definition  
Router ID  
Priority  
The 4-digit dotted-decimal number of the neighbor router.  
The OSPF priority for the specified interface. The priority of an interface is a priority  
integer from 0 to 255. A value of '0' indicates that the router is not eligible to become the  
designated router on this network.  
IP Address  
The IP address of the neighbor.  
Neighbor  
Interface  
The interface of the local router in slot/port format.  
State  
The state of the neighboring routers. The possible values are:  
• Down - initial state of the neighbor conversation - no recent information has been  
received from the neighbor.  
• Attempt - no recent information has been received from the neighbor but a more  
concerted effort should be made to contact the neighbor.  
• Init - an Hello packet has recently been seen from the neighbor, but bidirectional  
communication has not yet been established.  
• 2 way - communication between the two routers is bidirectional.  
• Exchange start - the first step in creating an adjacency between the two neighboring  
routers, the goal is to decide which router is the master and to decide upon the initial  
DD sequence number.  
• Exchange - the router is describing its entire link state database by sending Database  
Description packets to the neighbor.  
• Loading - Link State Request packets are sent to the neighbor asking for the more  
recent LSAs that have been discovered (but not yet received) in the Exchange state.  
• Full - the neighboring routers are fully adjacent and they will now appear in  
router-LSAs and network-LSAs.  
Dead Time  
The amount of time, in seconds, to wait before the router assumes that the neighbor is  
unreachable.  
Routing Commands  
299  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
If you specify an IP address for the neighbor router, the following fields display:  
Term  
Definition  
Interface  
Valid slot and port number separated by forward slashes.  
The IP address of the neighbor router.  
Neighbor IP  
Address  
Interface Index  
Area ID  
The interface ID of the neighbor router.  
The area ID of the OSPF area associated with the interface.  
Options  
An integer value that indicates the optional OSPF capabilities supported by the neighbor.  
The neighbor's optional OSPF capabilities are also listed in its Hello packets. This  
enables received Hello Packets to be rejected (that is, neighbor relationships will not  
even start to form) if there is a mismatch in certain crucial OSPF capabilities.  
Router Priority  
Dead Timer Due  
The OSPF priority for the specified interface. The priority of an interface is a priority  
integer from 0 to 255. A value of '0' indicates that the router is not eligible to become the  
designated router on this network.  
The amount of time, in seconds, to wait before the router assumes that the neighbor is  
unreachable.  
Up Time  
State  
Neighbor uptime; how long since the adjacency last reached the Full state.  
The state of the neighboring routers.  
Events  
The number of times this neighbor relationship has changed state, or an error has  
occurred.  
Retransmission  
Queue Length  
An integer representing the current length of the retransmission queue of the specified  
neighbor router Id of the specified interface.  
The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(Switch) #show ip ospf neighbor 170.1.1.50  
Interface.....................................0/17  
Neighbor IP Address...........................170.1.1.50  
Interface Index...............................17  
Area Id.......................................0.0.0.2  
Options.......................................0x2  
Router Priority...............................1  
Dead timer due in (secs)......................15  
Up Time.......................................0 days 2 hrs 8 mins 46 secs  
State.........................................Full/BACKUP-DR  
Events........................................4  
Retransmission Queue Length...................0  
Routing Commands  
300  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show ip ospf range  
This command displays information about the area ranges for the specified <areaid>. The  
<areaid>identifies the OSPF area whose ranges are being displayed.  
Format  
show ip ospf range <areaid>  
Modes  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Area ID  
The area id of the requested OSPF area.  
An IP address which represents this area range.  
A valid subnet mask for this area range.  
The type of link advertisement associated with this area range.  
IP Address  
Subnet Mask  
Lsdb Type  
Advertisement  
The status of the advertisement. Advertisement has two possible settings: enabled or  
disabled.  
show ip ospf statistics  
This command displays information about recent Shortest Path First (SPF) calculations. The  
SPF is the OSPF routing table calculation. The output lists the number of times the SPF has  
run for each OSPF area. A table follows this information. For each of the 15 most recent SPF  
runs, the table lists how long ago the SPF ran, how long the SPF took, and the reasons why  
the SPF was scheduled.  
Format  
Modes  
show ip ospf statistics  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Delta T  
How long ago the SPF ran. The time is in the format hh:mm:ss, giving the hours,  
minutes, and seconds since the SPF run.  
SPF Duration  
Reason  
How long the SPF took in milliseconds.  
The reason the SPF was scheduled. Reason codes are as follows:  
• R - a router LSA has changed  
• N - a network LSA has changed  
• SN - a type 3 network summary LSA has changed  
• SA - a type 4 ASBR summary LSA has changed  
• X - a type 5 or type 7 external LSA has changed  
Routing Commands  
301  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show ip ospf stub table  
This command displays the OSPF stub table. The information below will only be displayed if  
OSPF is initialized on the switch.  
Format  
show ip ospf stub table  
Modes  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Area ID  
A 32-bit identifier for the created stub area.  
Type of Service  
The Type of Service associated with the stub metric. Switch CLI only supports Normal  
TOS.  
Metric Val  
The metric value is applied based on the TOS. It defaults to the least metric of the Type  
of Service among the interfaces to other areas. The OSPF cost for a route is a function of  
the metric value.  
Import  
Summary LSA  
Controls the import of summary LSAs into stub areas.  
show ip ospf traffic  
This command displays OSPFv2 packet and LSA statistics and OSPFv2 message queue  
statistics. Packet statistics count the packets and LSAs since OSPFv2 counters were last  
cleared (using the command clear ip ospf counters).  
Note: The clear ip ospf counterscommand does not clear the  
message queue high water marks.  
Format  
show ip ospf traffic  
Mode  
Privileged EXEC  
Parameter  
Description  
OSPFv2 Packet  
Statistics  
The number of packets of each type sent and received since OSPF counters were last  
cleared.  
LSAs  
The number of LSAs retransmitted by this router since OSPF counters were last cleared.  
Retransmitted  
LS Update Max  
Receive Rate  
The maximum rate of LS Update packets received during any 5-second interval since OSPF  
counters were last cleared. The rate is in packets per second.  
LS Update Max  
Send Rate  
The maximum rate of LS Update packets transmitted during any 5-second interval since  
OSPF counters were last cleared. The rate is in packets per second.  
Routing Commands  
302  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Parameter  
Description  
Number of LSAs  
Received  
The number of LSAs of each type received since OSPF counters were last cleared.  
OSPFv2 Queue  
Statistics  
For each OSPFv2 message queue, the current count, the high water mark, the number of  
packets that failed to be enqueued, and the queue limit. The high water marks are not cleared  
when OSPF counters are cleared.  
The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(netgear switch) #show ip ospf traffic  
Time Since Counters Cleared: 4000 seconds  
OSPFv2 Packet Statistics  
Hello Database Desc LS Request LS Update LS ACK Total  
Recd: 500  
Sent: 400  
10  
8
20  
16  
50  
40  
20  
16  
600  
480  
LSAs Retransmitted................0  
LS Update Max Receive Rate........20 pps  
LS Update Max Send Rate...........10 pps  
Number of LSAs Received  
T1 (Router).......................10  
T2 (Network)......................0  
T3 (Net Summary)..................300  
T4 (ASBR Summary).................15  
T5 (External).....................20  
T7 (NSSA External)................0  
T9 (Link Opaque)..................0  
T10 (Area Opaque).................0  
T11 (AS Opaque)...................0  
Total.............................345  
OSPFv2 Queue Statistics  
Current  
0
2
24  
1
Max  
10  
12  
47  
8
Drops  
Limit  
500  
1680  
500  
Hello  
ACK  
Data  
Event  
0
0
0
0
1000  
show ip ospf virtual-link  
This command displays the OSPF Virtual Interface information for a specific area and  
neighbor. The <areaid>parameter identifies the area and the <neighbor>parameter  
identifies the neighbor's Router ID.  
Format  
show ip ospf virtual-link <areaid> <neighbor>  
Modes  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Area ID  
The area id of the requested OSPF area.  
The input neighbor Router ID.  
Neighbor  
Router ID  
Routing Commands  
303  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Hello Interval  
The configured hello interval for the OSPF virtual interface.  
The configured dead interval for the OSPF virtual interface.  
The configured transit delay for the OSPF virtual interface.  
Dead Interval  
Iftransit Delay  
Interval  
Retransmit  
Interval  
The configured retransmit interval for the OSPF virtual interface.  
The configured authentication type of the OSPF virtual interface.  
Authentication  
Type  
State  
The OSPF Interface States are: down, loopback, waiting, point-to-point, designated  
router, and backup designated router. This is the state of the OSPF interface.  
Neighbor State  
The neighbor state.  
show ip ospf virtual-link brief  
This command displays the OSPF Virtual Interface information for all areas in the system.  
Format  
Modes  
show ip ospf virtual-link brief  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Area ID  
The area id of the requested OSPF area.  
Neighbor  
The neighbor interface of the OSPF virtual interface.  
The configured hello interval for the OSPF virtual interface.  
The configured dead interval for the OSPF virtual interface.  
The configured retransmit interval for the OSPF virtual interface.  
Hello Interval  
Dead Interval  
Retransmit  
Interval  
Transit Delay  
The configured transit delay for the OSPF virtual interface.  
OSPF Graceful Restart Commands  
The OSPF protocol can be configured to participate in the checkpointing service, so that  
these protocols can execute a graceful restart when the management unit fails. In a graceful  
restart, the hardware to continues forwarding IPv4 packets using OSPF routes, while a  
backup switch takes over management unit responsibility.  
Graceful restart uses the concept of “helpful neighbors.” A fully adjacent router enters helper  
mode when it receives a link state announcement (LSA) from the restarting management unit  
indicating its intention of performing a graceful restart. In helper mode, a switch continues to  
advertise to the rest of the network that they have full adjacencies with the restarting router,  
Routing Commands  
304  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
avoiding announcement of a topology change and the potential for flooding of LSAs and  
shortest-path-first (SPF) runs, which determine OSPF routes. Helpful neighbors continue to  
forward packets through the restarting router. The restarting router relearns the network  
topology from its helpful neighbors.  
Graceful restart can be enabled for planned or unplanned restarts, or both. A planned restart  
is initiated by the operator through the management command initiate failover. The operator  
might initiate a failover to take the management unit out of service (for example, to address a  
partial hardware failure), to correct faulty system behavior that cannot be corrected through  
less severe management actions, or other reasons. An unplanned restart is an unexpected  
failover, caused by a fatal hardware failure of the management unit or a software hang or  
crash on the management unit.  
nsf  
Use this command to enable the OSPF graceful restart functionality on an interface. To  
disable graceful restart, use the no form of the command.  
Default  
Disabled  
Format  
Modes  
nsf [ietf] [planned-only]  
OSPF Router Configuration  
Parameter  
ietf  
Description  
This keyword is accepted but not required.  
planned-only  
This optional keyword indicates that OSPF should perform only a graceful restart when  
the restart is planned (that is, when the restart is a result of the initiate failover  
command).  
no nsf  
Use this command to disable graceful restart for all restarts.  
Format  
Modes  
no nsf  
OSPF Router Configuration  
nsf restart-interval  
Use this command to configure the number of seconds that the restarting router asks its  
neighbors to wait before exiting helper mode. This is called the “grace period.” The restarting  
router includes the grace period in its grace LSAs. For planned restarts (using the initiate  
failover command), the grace LSAs are sent prior to restarting the management unit,  
whereas for unplanned restarts, they are sent after reboot begins. The grace period must be  
Routing Commands  
305  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
set long enough to allow the restarting router to reestablish all of its adjacencies and  
complete a full database exchange with each of those neighbors.  
Default  
120 seconds  
Format  
Modes  
nsf [ietf] restart-interval <1-1800>  
OSPF Router Configuration  
Parameter  
ietf  
Description  
This keyword is accepted but not required.  
seconds  
The number of seconds that the restarting router asks its neighbors to wait before  
exiting helper mode. The range is from 1 to 1800 seconds.  
no nsfrestart-interval  
Use this command to revert the grace period to its default value.  
Format  
Modes  
no [ietf] nsf restart-interval  
OSPF Router Configuration  
nsf helper  
Use this command to enable helpful neighbor functionality for the OSPF protocol. You can  
enable this functionality for planned or unplanned restarts, or both.  
Default  
OSPF might act as a helpful neighbor for both planned and unplanned restarts  
nsf [ietf] helper [planned-only]  
Format  
Modes  
OSPF Router Configuration  
Parameter  
ietf  
Description  
This keyword is accepted but not required.  
planned-only  
This optional keyword indicates that OSPF should only help a restarting router  
performing a planned restart.  
no nsf helper  
Use this command to disable helpful neighbor functionality for OSPF.  
Format  
Modes  
no nsf [ietf] helper  
OSPF Router Configuration  
Routing Commands  
306  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
nsf helper disable  
Use this command to disable helpful neighbor functionality for OSPF.  
Note: The commands no nsf helperand nsf ietf helperdisable  
are functionally equivalent. The command nsf ietf helper  
disableis supported solely for compatibility with other network  
software CLI.  
Format  
nsf [ietf] helper disable  
Modes  
OSPF Router Configuration  
Parameter  
ietf  
Description  
This keyword is accepted but not required.  
nsf [ietf] helper strict-lsa-checking  
The restarting router is unable to react to topology changes. In particular, the restarting router  
will not immediately update its forwarding table; therefore, a topology change might introduce  
forwarding loops or black holes that persist until the graceful restart completes. By exiting the  
graceful restart on a topology change, a router tries to eliminate the loops or black holes as  
quickly as possible by routing around the restarting router. A helpful neighbor considers a link  
down with the restarting router to be a topology change, regardless of the strict LSA checking  
configuration. Use this command to require that an OSPF helpful neighbor exit helper mode  
whenever a topology change occurs.  
Default  
Format  
Modes  
Enabled  
nsf [ietf] helper strict-lsa-checking  
OSPF Router Configuration  
Parameter  
ietf  
Description  
This keyword is accepted but not required.  
no nsf [ietf] helper strict-lsa-checking  
Use this command to allow OSPF to continue as a helpful neighbor in spite of topology  
changes.  
Default  
Enabled  
Routing Commands  
307  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Format  
Modes  
nsf [ietf] helper strict-lsa-checking  
OSPF Router Configuration  
max-metric router-lsa  
To configure OSPF to enter stub router mode, use this command in Router OSPF Global  
Configuration mode. When OSPF is in stub router mode, as defined by RFC 3137, OSPF  
sets the metric in the nonstub links in its router LSA to LsInfinity. Other routers therefore  
compute long paths through the stub router, and prefer any alternate path. Doing so  
eliminates all transit traffic through the stub router, when alternate routes are available. Stub  
router mode is useful when adding or removing a router from a network or to avoid transient  
routes when a router reloads. You can administratively force OSPF into stub router mode.  
OSPF remains in stub router mode until you take OSPF out of stub router mode.  
Alternatively, you can configure OSPF to start in stub router mode for a configurable period of  
time after the router boots up.  
If you set the summary LSA metric to 16,777,215, other routers skip the summary LSA when  
they compute routes.  
If you have configured the router to enter stub router mode on startup (max-metric  
router-lsa on-startup) and enter max-metric router lsa, there is no change. If  
OSPF is administratively in stub router mode (the max-metric router-lsacommand has  
been given), and you configure OSPF to enter stub router mode on startup (max-metric  
router-lsa on-startup), OSPF exits stub router mode (assuming the startup period has  
expired) and the configuration is updated.  
Default  
OSPF is not in stub router mode by default  
Format  
max-metric router-lsa [on-startup seconds] [summary-lsa  
{metric}]  
Mode  
OSPFv2 Router Configuration  
Parameter  
on-startup  
seconds  
Description  
(Optional) OSPF starts in stub router mode after a reboot.  
(Required if on-startup) The number of seconds that OSPF remains in stub router  
mode after a reboot. The range is 5–86,400 seconds. There is no default value.  
summary-lsa  
metric  
(Optional) Set the metric in type 3 and type 4 summary LSAs to LsInfinity (0xFFFFFF).  
(Optional) Metric to send in summary LSAs when in stub router mode. The range is  
1–16,777,215. The default is 16,711,680 (0xFF0000).  
no max-metric router-lsa  
Use this command in OSPFv2 Router Configuration mode to disable stub router mode. The  
command clears either type of stub router mode (always or on-startup) and resets the  
summary-lsaoption. If OSPF is configured to enter global configuration mode on startup,  
and during normal operation you want to immediately place OSPF in stub router mode, issue  
Routing Commands  
308  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
the command no max-metric router-lsa on-startup. The command no  
max-metric router-lsa summary-lsacauses OSPF to send summary LSAs with  
metrics computed using normal procedures defined in RFC 2328.  
Format  
Mode  
no max-metric router-lsa [on-startup] [summary-lsa]  
OSPFv2 Router Configuration  
OSPF Interface Flap Dampening Commands  
Dampening  
Use this command to enable IP event dampening on a routing interface.  
Format  
dampening [half-life period] [reuse-threshold suppress-threshold  
max-suppress-time [restart restart-penalty]]  
Mode  
Interface Config  
Parameter  
Description  
Half-life period  
The number of seconds it takes for the penalty to reduce by half. The configurable range is  
1-30 seconds. Default value is 5 seconds.  
Reuse Threshold  
The value of the penalty at which the dampened interface is restored. The configurable range  
is 1-20,000. The default value is 1000.  
Suppress  
Threshold  
The value of the penalty at which the interface is dampened. The configurable range is 1-  
20,000. The default value is 2000.  
Max Suppress Time The maximum amount of time (in seconds) an interface can be in suppressed state after it  
stops flapping. The configurable range is 1-255 seconds. The default value is four times of  
half-life period. If half-period value is allowed to default, the maximum suppress time defaults  
to 20 seconds.  
Restart Penalty  
Penalty applied to the interface after the device reloads. The configurable range is 1- 20,000.  
The default value is 2000.  
no dampening  
This command disables IP event dampening on a routing interface.  
Format  
Mode  
no dampening  
Interface Config  
Routing Commands  
309  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show dampening interface  
This command summarizes the number of interfaces configured with dampening and the  
number of interfaces being suppressed.  
Format  
Mode  
show dampening interface  
Privileged EXEC  
The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(netgear switch)# show dampening interface  
2 interfaces are configured with dampening.  
1 interface is being suppressed.  
show interface dampening  
This command displays the status and configured parameters of the interfaces configured  
with dampening.  
Format  
show interface dampening  
Mode  
Privileged EXEC  
Parameter  
Flaps  
Description  
The number times the link state of an interface changed from UP to DOWN.  
Accumulated Penalty.  
Penalty  
Supp  
Indicates whether the interface is suppressed or not.  
Number of seconds until the interface is allowed to come up again.  
Configured half-life period.  
ReuseTm  
HalfL  
ReuseV  
SuppV  
Configured reuse-threshold.  
Configured suppress threshold.  
MaxSTm  
MaxPenalty  
Restart  
Configured maximum suppress time in seconds.  
Maximum possible penalty.  
Configured restart penalty.  
Note: The CLI command clear countersresets the flap count to zero.  
The interface CLI command no shutdownresets the suppressed  
state to False.  
Routing Commands  
310  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Any change in the dampening configuration resets the current  
penalty, reuse time, and suppressed state to their default values,  
meaning 0, 0, and FALSE respectively.  
The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(netgear switch)# show interface dampening  
Interface 0/2  
Flaps Penalty Supp ReuseTm HalfL ReuseV SuppV MaxSTm MaxP Restart  
0
0
FALSE  
0
5
1000  
2000  
20  
16000  
0
Interface 0/3  
Flaps Penalty Supp ReuseTm HalfL ReuseV SuppV MaxSTm MaxP Restart  
1865 TRUE 18 20 1000 2001 30 2828 1500  
6
Routing Information Protocol (RIP) Commands  
This section describes the commands you use to view and configure RIP, which is a  
distance-vector routing protocol that you use to route traffic within a small network.  
router rip  
Use this command to enter Router RIP mode.  
Format  
Mode  
router rip  
Global Config  
enable (RIP)  
This command resets the default administrative mode of RIP in the router (active).  
Default  
enabled  
Format  
Mode  
enable  
Router RIP Config  
no enable (RIP)  
This command sets the administrative mode of RIP in the router to inactive.  
Format  
Mode  
no enable  
Router RIP Config  
Routing Commands  
311  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
ip rip  
This command enables RIP on a router interface.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
ip rip  
Interface Config  
no ip rip  
This command disables RIP on a router interface.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip rip  
Interface Config  
auto-summary  
This command enables the RIP auto-summarization mode.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
auto-summary  
Router RIP Config  
no auto-summary  
This command disables the RIP auto-summarization mode.  
Format  
Mode  
no auto-summary  
Router RIP Config  
default-information originate (RIP)  
This command is used to control the advertisement of default routes.  
Format  
Mode  
default-information originate  
Router RIP Config  
no default-information originate (RIP)  
This command is used to control the advertisement of default routes.  
Format  
Mode  
no default-information originate  
Router RIP Config  
Routing Commands  
312  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
default-metric (RIP)  
This command is used to set a default for the metric of distributed routes.  
Format  
Mode  
default-metric <0-15>  
Router RIP Config  
no default-metric (RIP)  
This command is used to reset the default metric of distributed routes to its default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no default-metric  
Router RIP Config  
distance rip  
This command sets the route preference value of RIP in the router. Lower route preference  
values are preferred when determining the best route. A route with a preference of 255  
cannot be used to forward traffic.  
Default  
15  
Format  
Mode  
distance rip <1-255>  
Router RIP Config  
no distance rip  
This command sets the default route preference value of RIP in the router.  
Format  
Mode  
no distance rip  
Router RIP Config  
distribute-list out (RIP)  
This command is used to specify the access list to filter routes received from the source  
protocol.  
Default  
0
Format  
Mode  
distribute-list <1-199> out {ospf | static | connected}  
Router RIP Config  
Routing Commands  
313  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no distribute-list out  
This command is used to specify the access list to filter routes received from the source  
protocol.  
Format  
Mode  
no distribute-list <1-199> out {ospf | static | connected}  
Router RIP Config  
ip rip authentication  
This command sets the RIP Version 2 Authentication Type and Key for the specified  
interface. The value of <type>is either none, simple, or encrypt. The value for  
authentication key [key] must be 16 bytes or less. The [key] is composed of standard  
displayable, non-control keystrokes from a Standard 101/102-key keyboard. If the value of  
<type>is encrypt, a keyid in the range of 0 and 255 must be specified. Unauthenticated  
interfaces do not need an authentication key or authentication key ID.  
Default  
none  
Format  
Mode  
ip rip authentication {none | {simple <key>} | {encrypt <key>  
<keyid>}}  
Interface Config  
no ip rip authentication  
This command sets the default RIP Version 2 Authentication Type for an interface.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip rip authentication  
Interface Config  
ip rip receive version  
This command configures the interface to allow RIP control packets of the specified  
version(s) to be received.  
The value for <mode>is one of: rip1to receive only RIP version 1 formatted packets, rip2  
for RIP version 2, bothto receive packets from either format, or noneto not allow any RIP  
control packets to be received.  
Default  
both  
Format  
Mode  
ip rip receive version {rip1 | rip2 | both | none}  
Interface Config  
Routing Commands  
314  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no ip rip receive version  
This command configures the interface to allow RIP control packets of the default version(s)  
to be received.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip rip receive version  
Interface Config  
ip rip send version  
This command configures the interface to allow RIP control packets of the specified version  
to be sent. The value for <mode>is one of: rip1 to broadcast RIP version 1 formatted  
packets, rip1c (RIP version 1 compatibility mode) which sends RIP version 2 formatted  
packets via broadcast, rip2 for sending RIP version 2 using multicast, or noneto not allow  
any RIP control packets to be sent.  
Default  
ripi2  
Format  
Mode  
ip rip send version {rip1 | rip1c | rip2 | none}  
Interface Config  
no ip rip send version  
This command configures the interface to allow RIP control packets of the default version to  
be sent.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip rip send version  
Interface Config  
hostroutesaccept  
This command enables the RIP hostroutesaccept mode.  
Default  
enabled  
Format  
Mode  
hostroutesaccept  
Router RIP Config  
no hostroutesaccept  
This command disables the RIP hostroutesaccept mode.  
Format  
Mode  
no hostroutesaccept  
Router RIP Config  
Routing Commands  
315  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
split-horizon  
This command sets the RIP split horizon mode. Split horizon is a technique for avoiding  
problems caused by including routes in updates sent to the router from which the route was  
originally learned. The options are: None - no special processing for this case. Simple - a  
route will not be included in updates sent to the router from which it was learned. Poisoned  
reverse - a route will be included in updates sent to the router from which it was learned, but  
the metric will be set to infinity.  
Default  
simple  
Format  
Mode  
split-horizon {none | simple | poison}  
Router RIP Config  
no split-horizon  
This command sets the default RIP split horizon mode.  
Format  
Mode  
no split-horizon  
Router RIP Config  
redistribute (RIP)  
This command configures RIP protocol to redistribute routes from the specified source  
protocol/routers. There are five possible match options. When you submit the command  
redistribute ospf match <match-type>the match-type or types specified are added to any  
match types presently being redistributed. Internal routes are redistributed by default.  
Default  
• metric—not-configured  
• match—internal  
Format for redistribute ospf [metric <0-15>] [match [internal] [external 1]  
OSPF as  
source  
[external 2] [nssa-external 1] [nssa-external-2]]  
protocol  
Format for redistribute {static | connected} [metric <0-15>]  
othersource  
protocol  
Mode  
Router RIP Config  
no redistribute  
This command de-configures RIP protocol to redistribute routes from the specified source  
protocol/routers.  
Format  
no redistribute {ospf | static | connected} [metric] [match  
[internal] [external 1] [external 2] [nssa-external 1]  
[nssa-external-2]]  
Mode  
Router RIP Config  
Routing Commands  
316  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show ip rip  
This command displays information relevant to the RIP router.  
Format  
show ip rip  
Modes  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
RIP Admin  
Mode  
Enable or disable.  
Split Horizon  
Mode  
None, simple or poison reverse.  
Auto Summary  
Mode  
Enable or disable. If enabled, groups of adjacent routes are summarized into single  
entries, in order to reduce the total number of entries The default is enable.  
Host Routes  
Accept Mode  
Enable or disable. If enabled the router accepts host routes. The default is enable.  
Global Route  
Changes  
The number of route changes made to the IP Route Database by RIP. This does not  
include the refresh of a route's age.  
Global queries  
Default Metric  
The number of responses sent to RIP queries from other systems.  
The default metric of redistributed routes if one has already been set, or blank if not  
configured earlier. The valid values are 1–15.  
Default Route  
Advertise  
The default route.  
show ip rip interface brief  
This command displays general information for each RIP interface. For this command to  
display successful results routing must be enabled per interface (that is, ip rip).  
Format  
Modes  
show ip rip interface brief  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Interface  
Valid slot and port number separated by forward slashes.  
The IP source address used by the specified RIP interface.  
IP Address  
Send Version  
The RIP version(s) used when sending updates on the specified interface. The types are  
none, RIP-1, RIP-1c, or RIP-2.  
Receive Version  
The RIP version(s) allowed when receiving updates from the specified interface. The  
types are none, RIP-1, RIP-2, or Both  
Routing Commands  
317  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
RIP Mode  
The administrative mode of router RIP operation (enabled or disabled).  
The mode of the interface (up or down).  
Link State  
show ip rip interface  
This command displays information related to a particular RIP interface.  
Format  
Modes  
show ip rip interface {<slot/port> | vlan <1-4093>}  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Interface  
Valid slot and port number separated by forward slashes. This is a configured value.  
The IP source address used by the specified RIP interface. This is a configured value.  
IP Address  
Send Version  
The RIP version(s) used when sending updates on the specified interface. The types are  
none, RIP-1, RIP-1c, RIP-2. This is a configured value.  
Receive Version  
The RIP version(s) allowed when receiving updates from the specified interface. The  
types are none, RIP-1, RIP-2, or Both This is a configured value.  
RIP Admin  
Mode  
RIP administrative mode of router RIP operation; enable activates, disable deactivates it.  
This is a configured value.  
Link State  
Indicates whether the RIP interface is up or down. This is a configured value.  
Authentication  
Type  
The RIP Authentication Type for the specified interface. The types are none, simple, and  
encrypt. This is a configured value.  
Default Metric  
A number which represents the metric used for default routes in RIP updates originated  
on the specified interface. This is a configured value.  
The following information will be invalid if the link state is down.  
Term  
Definition  
Bad Packets  
Received  
The number of RIP response packets received by the RIP process which were  
subsequently discarded for any reason.  
Bad Routes  
Received  
The number of routes contained in valid RIP packets that were ignored for any reason.  
The number of triggered RIP updates sent on this interface.  
Updates Sent  
ICMP Throttling Commands  
This section describes the commands you use to configure options for the transmission of  
various types of ICMP messages.  
Routing Commands  
318  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
ip unreachables  
Use this command to enable the generation of ICMP Destination Unreachable messages. By  
default, the generation of ICMP Destination Unreachable messages is enabled.  
Default  
enable  
Format  
Mode  
ip unreachables  
Interface Config  
no ip unreachables  
Use this command to prevent the generation of ICMP Destination Unreachable messages.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip unreachables  
Interface Config  
ip redirects  
Use this command to enable the generation of ICMP Redirect messages by the router. By  
default, the generation of ICMP Redirect messages is disabled.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
ip redirects  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
no ip redirects  
Use this command to prevent the generation of ICMP Redirect messages by the router.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip redirects  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
ip icmp echo-reply  
Use this command to enable the generation of ICMP Echo Reply messages by the router. By  
default, the generation of ICMP Echo Reply messages is enabled.  
Default  
enabled  
Format  
Mode  
ip icmp echo-reply  
Global Config  
Routing Commands  
319  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no ip icmp echo-reply  
Use this command to prevent the generation of ICMP Echo Reply messages by the router.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip icmp echo-reply  
Global Config  
ip icmp error-interval  
Use this command to limit the rate at which IPv4 ICMP error messages are sent. The rate  
limit is configured as a token bucket, with two configurable parameters, burst-size and  
burst-interval.  
The burst-interval specifies how often the token bucket is initialized with burst-size tokens.  
burst-interval is from 0 to 2147483647 milliseconds (msec).  
The burst-size is the number of ICMP error messages that can be sent during one  
burst-interval. The range is from 1 to 200 messages.  
To disable ICMP rate limiting, set burst-interval to zero (0).  
Default  
burst-interval of 1000 msec.  
burst-size of 100 messages  
Format  
Mode  
ip icmp error-interval <burst-interval> [<burst-size>]  
Global Config  
no ip icmp error-interval  
Use the no form of the command to return burst-interval and burst-size to their default values.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip icmp error-interval  
Global Config  
Routing Commands  
320  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
5.  
IP Multicast Commands  
5
This chapter describes the IP Multicast commands available in the managed switch CLI.  
Note: Some commands described in this chapter require a license. For  
more information, see Licensing and Command Support on page 8.  
This chapter contains the following sections:  
The commands in this chapter are in two functional groups:  
Show commands display switch settings, statistics, and other information.  
Configuration commands configure features and options of the switch. Every switch  
command has a show command that displays the configuration setting.  
Multicast Commands  
This section describes the commands you use to configure IP Multicast and to view IP  
Multicast settings and statistics.  
ip mcast boundary  
This command adds an administrative scope multicast boundary specified by  
<groupipaddr>and <mask>for which this multicast administrative boundary is applicable.  
<groupipaddr>is a group IP address and <mask>is a group IP mask.  
Format  
ip mcast boundary <groupipaddr> <mask>  
Mode  
Interface Config  
321  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no ip mcast boundary  
This command deletes an administrative scope multicast boundary specified by  
<groupipaddr>and <mask>for which this multicast administrative boundary is applicable.  
<groupipaddr>is a group IP address and <mask>is a group IP mask.  
Format  
no ip mcast boundary <groupipaddr> <mask>  
Mode  
Interface Config  
ip multicast  
This command sets the administrative mode of the IP multicast forwarder in the router to  
active.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
ip multicast  
Global Config  
no ip multicast  
This command sets the administrative mode of the IP multicast forwarder in the router to  
inactive.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip multicast  
Global Config  
ip multicast ttl-threshold  
This command is specific to IPv4. Use this command to apply the given Time-to-Live  
threshold value <ttlthreshold>to a routing interface. The <ttlthreshold>is the TTL  
threshold which is to be applied to the multicast Data packets which are to be forwarded from  
the interface. This command sets the Time-to-Live threshold value such that any data  
packets forwarded over the interface having TTL value below the configured value are  
dropped. The value for <ttlthreshold>ranges from 0 to 255.  
Default  
1
Format  
Mode  
ip multicast ttl-threshold <ttlvalue>  
Interface Config  
IP Multicast Commands  
322  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no ip multicast ttl-threshold  
This command applies the default <ttlthreshold>to a routing interface. The  
<ttlthreshold>is the TTL threshold which is to be applied to the multicast Data packets  
which are to be forwarded from the interface.  
Format  
no ip multicast ttl-threshold  
Mode  
Interface Config  
ip mroute  
This command configures an IPv4 Multicast Static Route for a Source.  
src-addris Source IP address of a multicast source or source IP route prefix.  
src-maskis Mask associated with the source IP address or source IP route prefix.  
rpf-addris IP address to be used as the RPF address. The interface associated with this  
IP address, thus, is used as the incoming interface for the mroute.  
preferenceis Administrative distance for the mroute. The lower values have better  
preference. If the static mroutehas the same distance as the other RPF sources, the static  
mroutewill take precedence. The range is from 0 to 255. The default is 0.  
Default  
No MRoute is configured on the system  
Format  
Mode  
ip mroute <src-addr> <src-mask> <rpf-addr> <preference>  
Global Config  
no ip mroute  
This command removes the configured IP Multicast Static Route.  
Format  
Mode  
noip mroute <src-addr>  
Global Config  
show ip mcast  
This command displays the system-wide multicast information.  
Format  
Modes  
show ip mcast  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Admin Mode  
The administrative status of multicast. Possible values are enabled or disabled.  
Protocol State  
The current state of the multicast protocol. Possible values are Operational or  
Non-Operational.  
IP Multicast Commands  
323  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Table Max Size  
The maximum number of entries allowed in the multicast table.  
Protocol  
The multicast protocol running on the router. Possible values are PIM-DM, PIM-SM, or  
DVMRP.  
Multicast  
Forwarding  
Cache Entry  
Count  
The number of entries in the multicast forwarding cache.  
show ip mcast boundary  
This command displays all the configured administrative scoped multicast boundaries.  
Format  
Modes  
show ip mcast boundary {<slot/port> | all}  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Interface  
Valid slot and port number separated by forward slashes.  
The group IP address.  
Group Ip  
Mask  
The group IP mask.  
show ip mcast interface  
This command displays the multicast information for the specified interface.  
Format  
Modes  
show ip mcast interface <slot/port>  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Interface  
Valid slot and port number separated by forward slashes.  
The time-to-live value for this interface.  
TTL  
show ip mcast mroute  
This command displays a summary or all the details of the multicast table.  
Format  
Modes  
show ip mcast mroute {detail | summary}  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
IP Multicast Commands  
324  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
If you use the detail parameter, the command displays the following fields:  
Term  
Definition  
Source IP  
Group IP  
Expiry Time  
Up Time  
The IP address of the multicast data source.  
The IP address of the destination of the multicast packet.  
The time of expiry of this entry in seconds.  
The time elapsed since the entry was created in seconds.  
The IP address of the RPF neighbor.  
RPF Neighbor  
Flags  
The flags associated with this entry.  
If you use the summaryparameter, the command displays the following fields:  
Term  
Definition  
Source IP  
Group IP  
Protocol  
The IP address of the multicast data source.  
The IP address of the destination of the multicast packet.  
The multicast routing protocol by which the entry was created.  
Incoming  
Interface  
The interface on which the packet for the source/group  
arrives.  
Outgoing  
Interface List  
The list of outgoing interfaces on which the packet  
is forwarded.  
show ip mcast mroute group  
This command displays the multicast configuration settings such as flags, timer settings,  
incoming and outgoing interfaces, RPF neighboring routers, and expiration times of all the  
entries in the multicast mroute table containing the given <groupipaddr>.  
Format  
Modes  
show ip mcast mroute group <groupipaddr> {detail |summary}  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Source IP  
The IP address of the multicast data source.  
The IP address of the destination of the multicast packet.  
The multicast routing protocol by which this entry was created.  
The interface on which the packet for this group arrives.  
Group IP  
Protocol  
Incoming  
Interface  
Outgoing  
Interface List  
The list of outgoing interfaces on which this packet is forwarded.  
IP Multicast Commands  
325  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show ip mcast mroute source  
This command displays the multicast configuration settings such as flags, timer settings,  
incoming and outgoing interfaces, RPF neighboring routers, and expiration times of all the  
entries in the multicast mroute table containing the given source IP address or source IP  
address and group IP address pair.  
Format  
Modes  
show ip mcast mroute source <sourceipaddr> {summary | detail}  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
If you use the detail parameter, the command displays the following column headings in  
the output table:  
Term  
Definition  
Source IP  
Group IP  
Expiry Time  
Up Time  
The IP address of the multicast data source.  
The IP address of the destination of the multicast packet.  
The time of expiry of this entry in seconds.  
The time elapsed since the entry was created in seconds.  
The IP address of the RPF neighbor.  
RPF Neighbor  
Flags  
The flags associated with this entry.  
If you use the summaryparameter, the command displays the following column headings in  
the output table:  
Term  
Definition  
Source IP  
Group IP  
Protocol  
The IP address of the multicast data source.  
The IP address of the destination of the multicast packet.  
The multicast routing protocol by which this entry was created.  
The interface on which the packet for this source arrives.  
Incoming  
Interface  
Outgoing  
Interface List  
The list of outgoing interfaces on which this packet is forwarded.  
DVMRP Commands  
This section provides a detailed explanation of the Distance Vector Multicast Routing  
Protocol (DVMRP) commands.  
IP Multicast Commands  
326  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
ip dvmrp(Global Config)  
This command sets administrative mode of DVMRP in the router to active.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
ip dvmrp  
Global Config  
no ip dvmrp(Global Config)  
This command sets administrative mode of DVMRP in the router to inactive.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip dvmrp  
Global Config  
ip dvmrp metric  
This command configures the metric for an interface. This value is used in the DVMRP  
messages as the cost to reach this network. This field has a range of 1–31.  
Default  
1
Format  
Mode  
ip dvmrp metric <metric>  
Interface Config  
no ip dvmrp metric  
This command resets the metric for an interface to the default value. This value is used in the  
DVMRP messages as the cost to reach this network.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip dvmrp metric  
Interface Config  
ip dvmrp trapflags  
This command enables the DVMRP trap mode.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
ip dvmrp trapflags  
Global Config  
IP Multicast Commands  
327  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no ip dvmrp trapflags  
This command disables the DVMRP trap mode.  
Format  
no ip dvmrp trapflags  
Mode  
Global Config  
ip dvmrp  
This command sets the administrative mode of DVMRP on an interface to active.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
ip dvmrp  
Interface Config  
no ip dvmrp  
This command sets the administrative mode of DVMRP on an interface to inactive.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip dvmrp  
Interface Config  
show ip dvmrp  
This command displays the system-wide information for DVMRP.  
Format  
Modes  
show ip dvmrp  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Admin Mode  
Indicates whether DVMRP is enabled or disabled.  
The version of DVMRP being used.  
Version  
Total Number of  
Routes  
The number of routes in the DVMRP routing table.  
Reachable  
Routes  
The number of entries in the routing table with non-infinite metrics.  
The following fields are displayed for each interface.  
Term  
Interface  
Definition  
Valid slot and port number separated by forward slashes.  
IP Multicast Commands  
328  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Interface-Mode  
The mode of this interface. Possible values are Enabled and Disabled.  
Operational-stat  
us  
The current state of DVMRP on this interface. Possible values are Operational or  
Non-Operational.  
show ip dvmrp interface  
This command displays the interface information for DVMRP on the specified interface.  
Format  
Modes  
show ip dvmrp interface <slot/port>  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Interface Mode  
Indicates whether DVMRP is enabled or disabled on the specified interface.  
The metric of this interface. This is a configured value.  
The IP address of the interface.  
Metric  
Local Address  
The following field is displayed only when DVMRP is operational on the interface.  
Term  
Generation ID  
Definition  
The Generation ID value for the interface. This is used by the neighboring routers to  
detect that the DVMRP table should be resent.  
The following fields are displayed only if DVMRP is enabled on this interface.  
Term  
Definition  
Received Bad  
Packets  
The number of invalid packets received.  
Received Bad  
Routes  
The number of invalid routes received.  
Sent Routes  
The number of routes that have been sent on this interface.  
show ip dvmrp neighbor  
This command displays the neighbor information for DVMRP.  
Format  
Modes  
show ip dvmrp neighbor  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
IP Multicast Commands  
329  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
IfIndex  
The value of the interface used to reach the neighbor.  
Nbr IP Addr  
State  
The IP address of the DVMRP neighbor for which this entry contains information.  
The state of the neighboring router. The possible values for this field are ACTIVE or  
DOWN.  
Up Time  
The time since this neighboring router was learned.  
Expiry Time  
The time remaining for the neighbor to age out. This field is not applicable if the State is  
DOWN.  
Generation ID  
Major Version  
Minor Version  
Capabilities  
The Generation ID value for the neighbor.  
The major version of DVMRP protocol of neighbor.  
The minor version of DVMRP protocol of neighbor.  
The capabilities of neighbor.  
Received  
Routes  
The number of routes received from the neighbor.  
Rcvd Bad Pkts  
The number of invalid packets received from this neighbor.  
The number of correct packets received with invalid routes.  
Rcvd Bad  
Routes  
show ip dvmrp nexthop  
This command displays the next hop information on outgoing interfaces for routing multicast  
datagrams.  
Format  
Modes  
show ip dvmrp nexthop  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Source IP  
The sources for which this entry specifies a next hop on an outgoing interface.  
Source Mask  
The IP Mask for the sources for which this entry specifies a next hop on an outgoing  
interface.  
Next Hop  
Interface  
The interface in slot/port format for the outgoing interface for this next hop.  
The network is a LEAF or a BRANCH.  
Type  
IP Multicast Commands  
330  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show ip dvmrp prune  
This command displays the table listing the router’s upstream prune information.  
Format  
show ip dvmrp prune  
Modes  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Group IP  
The multicast Address that is pruned.  
The IP address of the source that has pruned.  
Source IP  
Source Mask  
The network Mask for the prune source. It should be all 1s or both the prune source and  
prune mask must match.  
Expiry Time  
(secs)  
The expiry time in seconds. This is the time remaining for this prune to age out.  
show ip dvmrp route  
This command displays the multicast routing information for DVMRP.  
Format  
Modes  
show ip dvmrp route  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Source Address  
Source Mask  
The multicast address of the source group.  
The IP Mask for the source group.  
Upstream  
Neighbor  
The IP address of the neighbor which is the source for the packets for a specified  
multicast address.  
Interface  
Metric  
The interface used to receive the packets sent by the sources.  
The distance in hops to the source subnet. This field has a different meaning than the  
Interface Metric field.  
Expiry Time  
(secs)  
The expiry time in seconds, which is the time left for this route to age out.  
The time when a specified route was learnt, in seconds.  
Up Time (secs)  
PIM Commands  
This section describes the commands you use to configure Protocol Independent Multicast  
(PIM). PIM is a multicast routing protocol that provides scalable inter-domain multicast  
IP Multicast Commands  
331  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
routing across the Internet, independent of the mechanisms provided by any particular  
unicast routing protocol.  
ip pim dense (Global Config)  
This command enables the administrative mode of PIM-DM in the router.  
Default  
Disabled  
Format  
Mode  
ip pim dense  
Global Config  
no ip pim dense (Global Config)  
This command disables the administrative mode of PIM-DM in the router.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip pim dense  
Global Config  
ip pim (Interface Config)  
This command sets administrative mode of PIM on an interface to enabled.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
ip pim  
Interface Config  
no ip pim (Interface Config)  
This command sets administrative mode of PIM on an interface to disabled.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip pim  
Interface Config  
ip pim hello-interval  
This command configures the transmission frequency of PIM Hello messages between PIM  
enabled neighbors. This field has a range of 0–18,000 seconds.  
Default  
30  
Format  
Mode  
ip pim hello-interval <0-18000>  
Interface Config  
IP Multicast Commands  
332  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no ip pim hello-interval  
This command resets the transmission frequency of hello messages between PIM enabled  
neighbors to its default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip pim hello-interval  
Interface Config  
show ip pim interface  
This command displays the PIM Interface status parameters. If the interface number is not  
specified, this command displays the status parameters of all the PIM enabled interfaces.  
Format  
Modes  
show ip pim interface <slot/port>  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Mode  
Active PIM protocol  
Interface number.  
Interface  
Hello Interval  
Hello interval value. The frequency at which PIM hello messages are transmitted on this  
interface. By default, the value is 30 seconds.  
Join-prune  
Interval  
Join-prune interval value.  
DR Priority  
DR Priority configured on this Interface. This is not applicable if the interface mode is  
Dense  
BSR Border  
Is this interface configured as a BSR Border?  
Neighbor Count  
Number of PIM Neighbors learnt on this interface. This field is displayed only when the  
interface is operational.  
Designated  
-Router  
IP Address of the elected DR on the Interface. This field is displayed only when the  
interface is Operational.  
Example 1:  
(Switch) #show ip pim interface  
Interface 0/1  
Mode Sparse  
Hello Interval (secs) 30  
Join Prune Interval (secs) 60  
DR Priority 1  
BSR Border Disabled  
Neighbor Count 1  
Designated Router 192.168.10.1  
Example 2:  
(Switch) #show ip pim interface  
Interface 0/1  
Mode Dense  
Hello Interval (secs) 30  
IP Multicast Commands  
333  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Join Prune Interval (secs) 60  
DR Priority NA  
BSR Border Disabled  
Neighbor Count 1  
Designated Router NA  
show ip pim neighbor  
This command displays the neighbor information for PIM on the specified interface.  
Format  
Modes  
show ip pim neighbor <slot/port>  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Neighbor  
Address  
The IP address of the PIM neighbor.  
Interface  
Interface number. Valid slot and port number separated by forward slashes.  
The time since this neighbor has become active on this interface.  
Time remaining for the neighbor to expire.  
UpTime  
Expiry Time  
DR Priority  
DR Priority configured on this Interface [ PIM -SM only ].  
(Switch) #show ip pim neighbor 0/1  
Neighbor Addr Interface Uptime Expiry Time DR  
(hh:mm:ss) (hh:mm:ss) Priority  
--------------- --------- ----------- ----------- --------  
192.168.10.2 0/1 00:02:55 00:01:15 NA  
(Switch) #show ip pim neighbor  
Neighbor Addr Interface Uptime Expiry Time DR  
(hh:mm:ss) (hh:mm:ss) Priority  
--------------- --------- ----------- ----------- --------  
192.168.10.2 0/1 00:02:55 00:01:15 1  
192.168.20.2 0/2 00:03:50 00:02:10 1  
ip pim sparse(Global Config)  
This command is used to administratively enable PIM Sparse Mode (PIM-SM) multicast  
routing mode on the router.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
ip pim sparse  
Global Config  
IP Multicast Commands  
334  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no ip pim sparse(Global Config)  
This command is used to administratively disable PIM-SM multicast routing mode on the  
router.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip pim sparse  
Global Config  
ip pim bsr-border  
Use this command to prevent bootstrap router (BSR) messages from being sent or received  
through an interface.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
ip pim bsr-border  
Interface Config  
no ip pim bsr-border  
Use this command to disable the interface from being the BSR border.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip pim bsr-border  
Interface Config  
ip pim bsr-candidate  
This command is used to configure the router to announce its candidacy as a bootstrap  
router (BSR).  
Format  
Mode  
ip pim bsr-candidate interface [vlan | <slot/port>] <hash-mask  
length> <bsr-priority> [interval <interval>]  
Global Config  
Parameters  
Description  
hash-mask  
length  
Length of a mask (32 bits maximum) that is to be ANDed with the group address before  
the hash function is called. All groups with the same seed hash correspond to the same  
RP. For example, if this value was 24, only the first 24 bits of the group addresses matter.  
This allows you to get one RP for multiple groups.  
bar-priority  
interval  
Priority of the candidate BSR. The range is an integer from 0 to 255. The BSR with the  
larger priority is preferred. If the priority values are the same, the router with the larger IP  
address is the BSR. The default value is 0.  
The C-BSR advertisement interval. If the interval values are reduced from the default  
value of 60 seconds, there could be issues in the network (especially BSR) due to  
flooding of these packets. However, it will provide RP fast failover.  
IP Multicast Commands  
335  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no ip pim bsr-candidate  
This command is used to disable the router to announce its candidacy as a bootstrap router  
(BSR).  
Format  
Mode  
no ip pim bsr-candidate interface [vlan | <slot/port>]  
Global Config  
ip pim dr-priority  
Use this command to set the priority value for which a router is elected as the designated  
router (DR).  
Default  
1
Format  
Mode  
ip pim dr-priority <0-2147483647>  
Interface Config  
no ip pim dr-priority  
Use this command to disable the interface from being the BSR border.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip pim dr-priority  
Interface Config  
ip pim join-prune-interval  
This command is used to configure the interface join/prune interval for the PIM router. The  
join/prune interval is specified in seconds. This parameter can be configured to a value from  
0 to 18000.  
Default  
60  
Format  
Mode  
ip pim join-prune-interval <0-18000>  
Interface Config  
no ip pim join-prune-interval  
Use this command to set the join/prune interval to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip pim join-prune-interval  
Interface Config  
ip pim rp-address  
This command is used to statically configure the RP address for one or more multicast  
groups. The parameter <rp-address>is the IP address of the RP. The parameter  
IP Multicast Commands  
336  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
<groupaddress>is the group address supported by the RP. The parameter <groupmask>  
is the group mask for the group address. The optional keyword overrideindicates that if  
there is a conflict, the RP configured with this command prevails over the RP learned by  
BSR.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
ip pim rp-address <rp-address> <group-address> <group-mask>  
[override]  
Global Config  
no ip pim rp-address  
This command is used to statically remove the RP address for one or more multicast groups.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip pim rp-address <rp-address> <group-address> <group-mask>  
[override]  
Global Config  
ip pim rp-candidate  
This command is used to configure the router to advertise itself as a PIM candidate  
rendezvous point (RP) to the bootstrap router (BSR).  
Format  
Mode  
ip pim rp-candidate interface <interface-num> <group-address>  
<group-mask> {interval <interval>}  
Global Config  
Parameter  
Description  
interface-num  
The IP address associated with this interface type and number is advertised as a  
candidate RP address. This interface must be enabled with PIM.  
group-address,  
group-mask  
The multicast group address and prefix that are advertised in association with the RP  
address.  
interval  
(Optional) Indicates the RP candidate advertisement interval. The range is from 1 to  
16,383 seconds. The default is 60 seconds.  
no ip pim rp-candidate  
This command is used to disable the router to advertise itself as a PIM candidate rendezvous  
point (RP) to the bootstrap router (BSR).  
Format  
Mode  
no ip pim rp-candidate interface <interface-num>  
Global Config  
IP Multicast Commands  
337  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
ip pim ssm  
Use this command to define the Source Specific Multicast (SSM) range of IP multicast  
addresses.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
ip pim ssm {default | <group-address> <group-mask>}  
Global Config  
Parameter  
Description  
default-range  
Defines the SSM range access list to 232/8.  
no ip pim ssm  
This command is used to disable the Source Specific Multicast (SSM) range.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip pim ssm {default | <group-address> <group-mask>}  
Global Config  
ip pim-trapflags  
This command enables the PIM trap mode for both Sparse Mode (SM) and Dense Mode.  
(DM).  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
ip pim-trapflags  
Global Config  
no ip pim-trapflags  
This command sets the PIM trap mode to the default.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip pim-trapflags  
Global Config  
show ip pim  
This command displays the system-wide information for PIM (global configuration mode and  
interface status).  
Format  
Modes  
show ip pim  
Privileged EXEC  
IP Multicast Commands  
338  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
PIM Mode  
Configured mode of PIM protocol (enabled or disabled).  
Interface number.  
Interface  
Interface-Mode  
Enable status of the interface.  
Operational-Sta  
tus  
Operational Status of the Interface.  
Example 1:  
(Switch) #show ip pim  
PIM Mode Dense  
Interface Interface-Mode Operational-Status  
--------- -------------- ------------------  
0/1  
0/3  
Enabled  
Disabled  
Operational  
Non-Operational  
Example 2:  
(Switch) #show ip pim  
PIM Mode Sparse  
Interface Interface-Mode Operational-Status  
--------- -------------- ------------------  
0/1  
0/3  
Enabled  
Disabled  
Operational  
Non-Operational  
show ip pim ssm  
This command shows the configured source-specific IP multicast addresses.  
Format  
show ip pim ssm  
Mode  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Group Address  
Prefix Length  
The address of the SSM Group.  
Prefix Length of the SSM Group.  
(Switch) #show ip pim ssm  
Group Address/Prefix Length  
----------------------------  
232.0.0.0/8  
IP Multicast Commands  
339  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show ip pim bsr-router  
This command displays the bootstrap router (BSR) information. The output includes elected  
BSR information and information about the locally configured candidate rendezvous point  
(RP) advertisement.  
Format  
show ip pim bsr-router [candidate | elected]  
Mode  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
BSR Address  
IP address of the BSR.  
BSR Priority  
For candidate it is the configured priority and for elected BSR it is the learned priority..  
BSR Hash Mask  
Length  
Configured or learned hash mask length of the BSR.  
Next Bootstrap  
message  
Time (in hours, minutes, and seconds) in which to send the next bootstrap message  
from this BSR.  
Next Candidate RP  
Advertisement in  
Time (in hours, minutes, and seconds) in which the next CRP advertisement will be  
sent. This field is applicable only for the elected RP.  
(Switch) #show ip pim bsr-router candidate  
BSR Address 192.168.10.1  
BSR Priority 0  
BSR Hash Mask Length 32  
Next Bootstrap message (hh:mm:ss) NA  
Next Candidate RP Advertisement (hh:mm:ss)NA  
(Switch) #show ip pim bsr-router elected  
BSR Address 192.168.10.1  
BSR Priority 0  
BSR Hash Mask Length 32  
Next Bootstrap message (hh:mm:ss) 00:00:05  
Next Candidate RP Advertisement (hh:mm:ss)00:00:02  
show ip pim rp-hash  
This command displays the rendezvous point selected for the specified group address..  
Format  
Modes  
show ip pim rp-hash <group-address>  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
RP Address  
Address of the RP for the group specified.  
Origin from where this group mapping is learned.  
Type  
(Switch) # show ip pim rp-hash 224.1.2.0  
RP Address 192.168.10.1  
Type Static  
IP Multicast Commands  
340  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show ip pim rp mapping  
This command displays the mappings for the PIM group to the active rendezvous points..  
Format  
show ip pim rp mapping [<rp address> | candidate | static]  
Modes  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
RP Address  
The IP address of the RP for the group specified.  
Group Address  
Group Mask  
Origin  
Address of the multicast group  
Mask for the group address.  
Origin from where this group mapping is learned.  
Expiry time of the elected RP.  
Expiry Time  
Example 1:  
(Switch) #show ip pim rp mapping 192.168.10.1  
RP Address 192.168.10.1  
Group Address 224.1.2.1  
Group Mask 255.255.255.0  
Origin Static  
Expiry Time (hh:mm:ss) NA  
Example 2:  
(Switch) #show ip pim rp mapping  
RP Address 192.168.10.1  
Group Address 224.1.2.1  
Group Mask 255.255.255.0  
Origin Static  
Expiry Time (hh:mm:ss) NA  
RP Address 192.168.20.1  
Group Address 229.2.0.0  
Group Mask 255.255.0.0  
Origin Static  
Expiry Time (hh:mm:ss) NA  
Example 3:  
(Switch) #show ip pim rp mapping candidate  
RP Address 192.168.10.1  
Group Address 224.1.2.1  
Group Mask 255.255.255.0  
Origin BSR  
Expiry Time (hh:mm:ss) 00:00:08  
Example 4:  
(Switch) #show ip pim rp mapping static  
RP Address 192.168.20.1  
Group Address 229.2.0.0  
IP Multicast Commands  
341  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Group Mask 255.255.0.0  
Origin Static  
Expiry Time (hh:mm:ss) NA  
Internet Group Message Protocol (IGMP) Commands  
This section describes the commands you use to view and configure IGMP settings.  
ip igmp  
This command sets the administrative mode of IGMP in the system to active.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Modes  
ip igmp  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
no ip igmp  
This command sets the administrative mode of IGMP in the system to inactive.  
Format  
Modes  
no ip igmp  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
ip igmp version  
This command configures the version of IGMP for an interface. The value for <version>is  
either 1, 2 or 3.  
Default  
3
Format  
Modes  
ip igmp version <version>  
Interface Config  
no ip igmp version  
This command resets the version of IGMP to the default value.  
Format  
Modes  
no ip igmp version  
Interface Config  
IP Multicast Commands  
342  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
ip igmp last-member-query-count  
This command sets the number of Group-Specific Queries sent before the router assumes  
that there are no local members on the interface. The range for <count> is 1–20.  
Format  
Modes  
ip igmp last-member-query-count <count>  
Interface Config  
no ip igmp last-member-query-count  
This command resets the number of Group-Specific Queries to the default value.  
Format  
Modes  
noip igmp last-member-query-count  
Interface Config  
ip igmp last-member-query-interval  
This command configures the Maximum Response Time inserted in Group-Specific Queries  
which are sent in response to Leave Group messages. The range for <seconds> is 0–255  
tenths of a second.  
Default  
10 tenths of a second (1 second)  
Format  
Modes  
ip igmp last-member-query-interval <seconds>  
Interface Config  
no ip igmp last-member-query-interval  
This command resets the Maximum Response Time to the default value.  
Format  
Modes  
no ip igmp last-member-query-interval  
Interface Config  
ip igmp query-interval  
This command configures the query interval for the specified interface. The query interval  
determines how fast IGMP Host-Query packets are transmitted on this interface. The range  
for <queryinterval> is 1–3,600 seconds.  
Default  
125 seconds  
Format  
Modes  
ip igmp query-interval <seconds>  
Interface Config  
IP Multicast Commands  
343  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no ip igmp query-interval  
This command resets the query interval for the specified interface to the default value. This is  
the frequency at which IGMP Host-Query packets are transmitted on this interface.  
Format  
Modes  
no ip igmp query-interval  
Interface Config  
ip igmp query-max-response-time  
This command configures the maximum response time interval for the specified interface,  
which is the maximum query response time advertised in IGMPv2 queries on this interface.  
The time interval is specified in tenths of a second. The range for <maxresptime> is 0–255  
tenths of a second.  
Default  
100  
Format  
Mode  
ip igmp query-max-response-time <seconds>  
Interface Config  
no ip igmp query-max-response-time  
This command resets the maximum response time interval for the specified interface, which  
is the maximum query response time advertised in IGMPv2 queries on this interface to the  
default value. The maximum response time interval is reset to the default time.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip igmp query-max-response-time  
Interface Config  
ip igmp robustness  
This command configures the robustness that allows tuning of the interface. The robustness  
is the tuning for the expected packet loss on a subnet. If a subnet is expected to have a lot of  
loss, the Robustness variable might be increased for the interface. The range for  
<robustness> is 1–255.  
Default  
2
Format  
Mode  
ip igmp robustness <robustness>  
Interface Config  
no ip igmp robustness  
This command sets the robustness value to default.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip igmp robustness  
Interface Config  
IP Multicast Commands  
344  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
ip igmp startup-query-count  
This command sets the number of Queries sent out on startup, separated by the Startup  
Query Interval on the interface. The range for <count> is 1–20.  
Default  
2
Format  
Mode  
ip igmp startup-query-count <count>  
Interface Config  
no ip igmp startup-query-count  
This command resets the number of Queries sent out on startup, separated by the Startup  
Query Interval on the interface to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip igmp startup-query-count  
Interface Config  
ip igmp startup-query-interval  
This command sets the interval between General Queries sent on startup on the interface.  
The time interval value is in seconds. The range for <interval> is 1–300 seconds.  
Default  
31  
Format  
Mode  
ip igmp startup-query-interval <interval>  
Interface Config  
no ip igmp startup-query-interval  
This command resets the interval between General Queries sent on startup on the interface  
to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip igmp startup-query-interval  
Interface Config  
show ip igmp  
This command displays the system-wide IGMP information.  
Format  
Modes  
show ip igmp  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
IP Multicast Commands  
345  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
IGMP Admin  
Mode  
The administrative status of IGMP. This is a configured value.  
Valid slot and port number separated by forward slashes.  
Interface  
Interface-Mode  
Indicates whether IGMP is enabled or disabled on the interface. This is a configured  
value.  
Operational-Sta  
tus  
The current state of IGMP on this interface. Possible values are Operational or  
Non-Operational.  
show ip igmp groups  
This command displays the registered multicast groups on the interface. If [detail]is  
specified this command displays the registered multicast groups on the interface in detail.  
Format  
Mode  
show ip igmp groups <slot/port> [detail]  
Privileged EXEC  
If you do not use the detailkeyword, the following fields appear:  
Term  
Definition  
IP Address  
The IP address of the interface participating in the multicast group.  
The subnet mask of the interface participating in the multicast group.  
This displays whether IGMP is enabled or disabled on this interface.  
Subnet Mask  
Interface Mode  
The following fields are not displayed if the interface is not enabled:  
Term  
Definition  
Querier Status  
Groups  
This displays whether the interface has IGMP in Querier mode or Non-Querier mode.  
The list of multicast groups that are registered on this interface.  
If you use the detailkeyword, the following fields appear:  
Term  
Definition  
Multicast IP  
Address  
The IP address of the registered multicast group on this interface.  
Last Reporter  
The IP address of the source of the last membership report received for the specified  
multicast group address on this interface.  
Up Time  
The time elapsed since the entry was created for the specified multicast group address  
on this interface.  
Expiry Time  
The amount of time remaining to remove this entry before it is aged out.  
IP Multicast Commands  
346  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Version1 Host  
Timer  
The time remaining until the local router assumes that there are no longer any IGMP  
version 1 multicast members on the IP subnet attached to this interface. This could be an  
integer value or “-----” if there is no Version 1 host present.  
Version2 Host  
Timer  
The time remaining until the local router assumes that there are no longer any IGMP  
version 2 multicast members on the IP subnet attached to this interface. This could be an  
integer value or “-----” if there is no Version 2 host present.  
Group  
Compatibility  
Mode  
The group compatibility mode (v1, v2, or v3) for this group on the specified interface.  
show ip igmp interface  
This command displays the IGMP information for the interface.  
Format  
Modes  
show ip igmp interface <slot/port>  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Interface  
Valid slot and port number separated by forward slashes.  
The administrative status of IGMP.  
IGMP Admin  
Mode  
Interface Mode  
IGMP Version  
Indicates whether IGMP is enabled or disabled on the interface.  
The version of IGMP running on the interface. This value can be configured to create a  
router capable of running either IGMP version 1 or 2.  
Query Interval  
Query Max  
The frequency at which IGMP Host-Query packets are transmitted on this interface.  
The maximum query response time advertised in IGMPv2 queries on this interface.  
Response Time  
Robustness  
The tuning for the expected packet loss on a subnet. If a subnet is expected to be have a  
lot of loss, the Robustness variable may be increased for that interface.  
Startup Query  
Interval  
The interval between General Queries sent by a Querier on startup.  
Startup Query  
Count  
The number of Queries sent out on startup, separated by the Startup Query Interval.  
Last Member  
Query Interval  
The Maximum Response Time inserted into Group-Specific Queries sent in response to  
Leave Group messages.  
Last Member  
Query Count  
The number of Group-Specific Queries sent before the router assumes that there are no  
local members.  
IP Multicast Commands  
347  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show ip igmp interface membership  
This command displays the list of interfaces that have registered in the multicast group.  
Format  
show ip igmp interface membership <multiipaddr> [detail]  
Mode  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Interface  
Valid slot and port number separated by forward slashes.  
The IP address of the interface participating in the multicast group.  
The interface that has IGMP in Querier mode or Non-Querier mode.  
The group compatibility mode (v1, v2, or v3) for the specified group on this interface.  
Interface IP  
State  
Group  
Compatibility  
Mode  
Source Filter  
Mode  
The source filter mode (Include/Exclude) for the specified group on this interface. This is  
“-----” for IGMPv1 and IGMPv2 Membership Reports.  
If you use the detailkeyword, the following fields appear:  
Term  
Definition  
Interface  
Valid slot and port number separated by forward slashes.  
The group compatibility mode (v1, v2, or v3) for the specified group on this interface.  
Group  
Compatibility  
Mode  
Source Filter  
Mode  
The source filter mode (Include/Exclude) for the specified group on this interface. This is  
“-----” for IGMPv1 and IGMPv2 Membership Reports.  
Source Hosts  
The list of unicast source IP addresses in the group record of the IGMPv3 Membership  
Report with the specified multicast group IP address. This is “-----” for IGMPv1 and  
IGMPv2 Membership Reports.  
Expiry Time  
The amount of time remaining to remove this entry before it is aged out. This is “-----” for  
IGMPv1 and IGMPv2 Membership Reports.  
show ip igmp interface stats  
This command displays the IGMP statistical information for the interface. The statistics are  
only displayed when the interface is enabled for IGMP.  
Format  
Modes  
show ip igmp interface stats <slot/port>  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
IP Multicast Commands  
348  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Querier Status  
The status of the IGMP router, whether it is running in Querier mode or Non-Querier  
mode.  
Querier IP  
Address  
The IP address of the IGMP Querier on the IP subnet to which this interface is attached.  
The time since the interface Querier was last changed.  
Querier Up Time  
Querier Expiry  
Time  
The amount of time remaining before the Other Querier Present Timer expires. If the  
local system is the querier, the value of this object is zero.  
Wrong Version  
Queries  
The number of queries received whose IGMP version does not match the IGMP version  
of the interface.  
Number of  
Joins  
The number of times a group membership has been added on this interface.  
The current number of membership entries for this interface.  
Number of  
Groups  
IGMP Proxy Commands  
The IGMP Proxy is used by IGMP Router (IPv4 system) to enable the system to issue IGMP  
host messages on behalf of hosts that the system discovered through standard IGMP router  
interfaces. With IGMP Proxy enabled, the system acts as proxy to all the hosts residing on its  
router interfaces.  
ip igmp-proxy  
This command enables the IGMP Proxy on the router. To enable the IGMP Proxy on the  
router, you must enable multicast forwarding. Also, make sure that there are no multicast  
routing protocols enabled on the router.  
Format  
Mode  
ip igmp-proxy  
Interface Config  
no ip igmp-proxy  
This command disables the IGMP Proxy on the router.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip igmp-proxy  
Interface Config  
IP Multicast Commands  
349  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
ip igmp-proxy unsolicit-rprt-interval  
This command sets the unsolicited report interval for the IGMP Proxy router. This command  
is valid only when you enable IGMP Proxy on the interface. The value of <interval>can  
be 1-260 seconds.  
Default  
1
Format  
Mode  
ip igmp-proxy unsolicit-rprt-interval <interval>  
Interface Config  
no ip igmp-proxy unsolicit-rprt-interval  
This command resets the unsolicited report interval of the IGMP Proxy router to the default  
value.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip igmp-proxy unsolicit-rprt-interval  
Interface Config  
ip igmp-proxy reset-status  
This command resets the host interface status parameters of the IGMP Proxy router. This  
command is valid only when you enable IGMP Proxy on the interface.  
Format  
Mode  
ip igmp-proxy reset-status  
Interface Config  
show ip igmp-proxy  
This command displays a summary of the host interface status parameters. It displays the  
following parameters only when you enable IGMP Proxy.  
Format  
Modes  
show ip igmp-proxy  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Interface index  
The interface number of the IGMP Proxy.  
States whether the IGMP Proxy is enabled or not. This is a configured value.  
Admin Mode  
Operational  
Mode  
States whether the IGMP Proxy is operationally enabled or not. This is a status  
parameter.  
Version  
The present IGMP host version that is operational on the proxy interface.  
IP Multicast Commands  
350  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Number of  
Multicast  
Groups  
The number of multicast groups that are associated with the IGMP Proxy interface.  
Unsolicited  
Report Interval  
The time interval at which the IGMP Proxy interface sends unsolicited group membership  
report.  
Querier IP  
Address on  
Proxy Interface  
The IP address of the Querier, if any, in the network attached to the upstream interface  
(IGMP-Proxy interface).  
Older Version 1  
Querier Timeout  
The interval used to timeout the older version 1 queriers.  
The interval used to timeout the older version 2 queriers.  
The number of times the IGMP Proxy has been stopped and started.  
Older Version 2  
Querier Timeout  
Proxy Start  
Frequency  
Example: The following example shows CLI display output for the command.  
(Switch) #show ip igmp-proxy  
Interface Index............................................. 0/1  
Admin Mode................................................ Enable  
Operational Mode......................................... Enable  
Version......................................................... 3  
Num of Multicast Groups............................. 0  
Unsolicited Report Interval.......................... 1  
Querier IP Address on Proxy Interface........ 5.5.5.50  
Older Version 1 Querier Timeout................ 0  
Older Version 2 Querier Timeout................ 00::00:00  
Proxy Start Frequency................................. 1  
show ip igmp-proxy interface  
This command displays a detailed list of the host interface status parameters. It displays the  
following parameters only when you enable IGMP Proxy.  
Format  
Modes  
show ip igmp-proxy interface  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Interface Index  
The slot/port of the IGMP proxy.  
The column headings of the table associated with the interface are as follows:  
IP Multicast Commands  
351  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Ver  
Definition  
The IGMP version.  
Query Rcvd  
Report Rcvd  
Report Sent  
Leaves Rcvd  
Leaves Sent  
Number of IGMP queries received.  
Number of IGMP reports received.  
Number of IGMP reports sent.  
Number of IGMP leaves received. Valid for version 2 only.  
Number of IGMP leaves sent on the Proxy interface. Valid for version 2 only.  
Example: The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(Switch) #show ip igmp-proxy interface  
Interface Index................................ 0/1  
Ver Query Rcvd Report Rcvd Report Sent Leave Rcvd Leave Sent  
------------------------------------------------------------------  
1
2
3
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
-----  
0
-----  
-----  
0
-----  
show ip igmp-proxy groups  
This command displays information about the subscribed multicast groups that IGMP Proxy  
reported. It displays a table of entries with the following as the fields of each column.  
Format  
show ip igmp-proxy groups  
Modes  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Interface  
The interface number of the IGMP Proxy.  
Group Address  
Last Reporter  
The IP address of the multicast group.  
The IP address of host that last sent a membership report for the current group on the  
network attached to the IGMP Proxy interface (upstream interface).  
Up Time (in  
secs)  
The time elapsed since last created.  
Member State  
The status of the entry. Possible values are IDLE_MEMBER or DELAY_MEMBER.  
• IDLE_MEMBER - interface has responded to the latest group membership query for  
this group.  
• DELAY_MEMBER - interface is going to send a group membership report to respond  
to a group membership query for this group.  
IP Multicast Commands  
352  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Filter Mode  
Possible values are Include or Exclude.  
Sources  
The number of sources attached to the multicast group.  
Example: The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(Switch) #show ip igmp-proxy groups  
Interface Index................................ 0/1  
Group Address  
-------------  
225.4.4.4  
Last Reporter  
Up Time Member State Filter Mode Sources  
-------------- ---------- ------------- ------------- -------  
5.5.5.48  
5.5.5.48  
5.5.5.48  
5.5.5.48  
00:02:21 DELAY_MEMBER  
00:02:21 DELAY_MEMBER  
00:02:21 DELAY_MEMBER  
00:02:21 DELAY_MEMBER  
Include  
Include  
Exclude  
Include  
3
3
0
3
226.4.4.4  
227.4.4.4  
228.4.4.4  
show ip igmp-proxy groups detail  
This command displays complete information about multicast groups that IGMP Proxy  
reported. It displays a table of entries with the following as the fields of each column.  
Format  
show ip igmp-proxy groups detail  
Modes  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Interface  
The interface number of the IGMP Proxy.  
Group Address  
Last Reporter  
The IP address of the multicast group.  
The IP address of host that last sent a membership report for the current group, on the  
network attached to the IGMP-Proxy interface (upstream interface).  
Up Time (in  
secs)  
The time elapsed since last created.  
Member State  
The status of the entry. Possible values are IDLE_MEMBER or DELAY_MEMBER.  
• IDLE_MEMBER - interface has responded to the latest group membership query for  
this group.  
• DELAY_MEMBER - interface is going to send a group membership report to respond  
to a group membership query for this group.  
Filter Mode  
Sources  
Possible values are Include or Exclude.  
The number of sources attached to the multicast group.  
IP Multicast Commands  
353  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Group Source  
List  
The list of IP addresses of the sources attached to the multicast group.  
Time left before a source is deleted.  
Expiry Time  
Example: The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(Switch) #show ip igmp-proxy groups  
Interface Index................................ 0/1  
Group Address  
-------------  
225.4.4.4  
Last Reporter  
Up Time Member State Filter Mode Sources  
-------------- ----------- ------------ ------------ ---------  
5.5.5.48  
00:02:21 DELAY_MEMBER  
Expiry Time  
Include  
3
Group Source List  
-----------------  
5.1.2.3  
-----------------  
00:02:21  
6.1.2.3  
00:02:21  
7.1.2.3  
00:02:21  
226.4.4.4  
5.5.5.48  
00:02:21 DELAY_MEMBER  
Include  
3
Group Source List  
------------------  
2.1.2.3  
Expiry Time  
---------------  
00:02:21  
6.1.2.3  
00:01:44  
8.1.2.3  
00:01:44  
227.4.4.4  
5.5.5.48  
00:02:21 DELAY_MEMBER  
Exclude  
Include  
0
228.4.4.4  
5.5.5.48  
00:03:21 DELAY_MEMBER  
Expiry Time  
3
Group Source List  
------------------  
9.1.2.3  
---------------  
00:03:21  
6.1.2.3  
00:03:21  
7.1.2.3  
00:03:21  
IP Multicast Commands  
354  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6.  
IPv6 Commands  
6
This chapter describes the IPv6 commands available in the managed switch CLI.  
Note: Some commands described in this chapter require a license. For  
more information, see Licensing and Command Support on page 8.  
This chapter contains the following sections:  
The commands in this chapter are in three functional groups:  
Show commands display switch settings, statistics, and other information.  
Configuration commands configure features and options of the switch. Every switch  
command has a show command that displays the configuration setting.  
Clear commands clear some or all of the settings to factory defaults.  
Note: For information about IPv6 management commands, see IPv6  
355  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Tunnel Interface Commands  
The commands in this section describe how to create, delete, and manage tunnel interfaces.  
Several different types of tunnels provide functionality to facilitate the transition of IPv4  
networks to IPv6 networks. These tunnels are divided into two classes: configured and  
automatic. The distinction is that configured tunnels are explicitly configured with a  
destination or endpoint of the tunnel. Automatic tunnels, in contrast, infer the endpoint of the  
tunnel from the destination address of packets routed into the tunnel. To assign an IP  
address to the tunnel interface, see ip address on page 228. To assign an IPv6 address to  
the tunnel interface, see ipv6 address on page 359.  
interface tunnel  
Use this command to enter the Interface Config mode for a tunnel interface. The  
<tunnel-id>range is 0–7.  
Format  
Mode  
interface tunnel <tunnel-id>  
Global Config  
no interface tunnel  
This command removes the tunnel interface and associated configuration parameters for the  
specified tunnel interface.  
Format  
Mode  
no interface tunnel <tunnel-id>  
Global Config  
tunnel source  
This command specifies the source transport address of the tunnel, either explicitly or by  
reference to an interface.  
Format  
Mode  
tunnel source {<ipv4-address> | ethernet <slot/port>}  
Interface Config  
tunnel destination  
This command specifies the destination transport address of the tunnel.  
Format  
Mode  
tunnel destination {<ipv4-address>}  
Interface Config  
IPv6 Commands  
356  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
tunnel mode ipv6ip  
This command specifies the mode of the tunnel. With the optional 6to4 argument, the tunnel  
mode is set to 6to4 automatic. Without the optional 6to4 argument, the tunnel mode is  
configured.  
Format  
Mode  
tunnel mode ipv6ip [6to4]  
Interface Config  
show interface tunnel  
This command displays the parameters related to tunnel such as tunnel mode, tunnel source  
address, and tunnel destination address.  
Format  
Mode  
show interface tunnel [<tunnel-id>]  
Privileged EXEC  
If you do not specify a tunnel ID, the command shows the following information for each  
configured tunnel:  
Term  
Definition  
Tunnel ID  
The tunnel identification number.  
The name of the tunnel interface.  
The tunnel mode.  
Interface  
Tunnel Mode  
Source Address  
The source transport address of the tunnel.  
The destination transport address of the tunnel.  
Destination  
Address  
If you specify a tunnel ID, the command shows the following information for the tunnel:  
Term  
Definition  
Interface Link  
Status  
Shows whether the link is up or down.  
MTU Size  
The maximum transmission unit for packets on the interface.  
IPv6 Prefix is  
If you enable IPv6 on the interface and assign an address, the IPv6 address and prefix  
display.  
IPv6 Routing Commands  
This section describes the IPv6 commands you use to configure IPv6 on the system and on  
the interfaces. This section also describes IPv6 management commands and show  
commands.  
IPv6 Commands  
357  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
ipv6 hop-limit  
This command defines the unicast hop count used in ipv6 packets originated by the node.  
The value is also included in router advertisements. Valid values for <hops>are 1-255  
inclusive. The default “not configured” means that a value of zero is sent in router  
advertisements and a value of 64 is sent in packets originated by the node. Note that this is  
not the same as configuring a value of 64.  
Default  
not configured  
Format  
Mode  
ipv6 hop-limit <hops>  
Global Config  
no ipv6 hop-limit  
This command returns the unicast hop count to the default.  
Format  
Mode  
no ipv6 hop-limit  
Global Config  
ipv6 unicast-routing  
Use this command to enable the forwarding of IPv6 unicast datagrams.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
ipv6 unicast-routing  
Global Config  
no ipv6 unicast-routing  
Use this command to disable the forwarding of IPv6 unicast datagrams.  
Format  
Mode  
no ipv6 unicast-routing  
Global Config  
ipv6 enable  
Use this command to enable IPv6 routing on an interface, including tunnel and loopback  
interfaces, that has not been configured with an explicit IPv6 address. When you use this  
command, the interface is automatically configured with a link-local address. You do not need  
to use this command if you configured an IPv6 global address on the interface.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
ipv6 enable  
Interface Config  
IPv6 Commands  
358  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no ipv6 enable  
Use this command to disable IPv6 routing on an interface.  
Format  
Mode  
no ipv6 enable  
Interface Config  
ipv6 address  
Use this command to configure an IPv6 address on an interface, including tunnel and  
loopback interfaces, and to enable IPv6 processing on this interface. You can assign multiple  
globally reachable addresses to an interface by using this command. You do not need to  
assign a link-local address by using this command since one is automatically created. The  
<prefix>field consists of the bits of the address to be configured. The <prefix_length>  
designates how many of the high-order contiguous bits of the address make up the prefix.  
You can express IPv6 addresses in eight blocks. Also of note is that instead of a period, a  
colon now separates each block. For simplification, leading zeros of each 16-bit block can be  
omitted. One sequence of 16-bit blocks containing only zeros can be replaced with a double  
colon “::”, but not more than one at a time (otherwise it is no longer a unique representation).  
Dropping zeros: 3ffe:ffff:100:f101:0:0:0:1 becomes 3ffe:ffff:100:f101::1  
Local host: 0000:0000:0000:0000:0000:0000:0000:0001becomes ::1  
Any host: 0000:0000:0000:0000:0000:0000:0000:0000becomes ::  
The hexadecimal letters in the IPv6 addresses are not case-sensitive. An example of an IPv6  
prefix and prefix length is 3ffe:1::1234/64.  
The optional [eui-64] field designates that IPv6 processing on the interfaces was enabled  
using an EUI-64 interface ID in the low order 64 bits of the address. If you use this option, the  
value of <prefix_length> must be 64 bits.  
Format  
Mode  
ipv6 address<prefix>/<prefix_length> [eui64]  
Interface Config  
no ipv6 address  
Use this command to remove all IPv6 addresses on an interface or specified IPv6 address.  
The <prefix>parameter consists of the bits of the address to be configured. The  
<prefix_length>designates how many of the high-order contiguous bits of the address  
comprise the prefix. The optional [eui-64]field designates that IPv6 processing on the  
interfaces was enabled using an EUI-64 interface ID in the low order 64 bits of the address.  
If you do not supply any parameters, the command deletes all the IPv6 addresses on an  
interface.  
Format  
Mode  
no ipv6 address[<prefix>/<prefix_length>] [eui64]  
Interface Config  
IPv6 Commands  
359  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
ipv6 address autoconfig  
This command is used to enable stateless address autoconfiguration capability.  
Note: When unicast-routing is enabled, autoconfig mode does not work.  
Format  
Mode  
ipv6 address autoconfig  
Interface Config  
ipv6 address autoconfig  
This command disables the stateless autoconfiguration.  
Format  
Mode  
no ipv6 addressautoconfig  
Interface Config  
ipv6 address dhcp  
This command is used to enable DHCPv6 client capability.  
Format  
Mode  
ipv6 address autoconfig  
Interface Config  
no pv6 address dhcp  
The "no" form of this command disables the DHCPv6 client capability.  
Format  
Mode  
no ipv6 address autoconfig  
Interface Config  
ipv6 route  
Use this command to configure an IPv6 static route. The <ipv6-prefix>is the IPv6  
network that is the destination of the static route. The <prefix_length>is the length of the  
IPv6 prefix — a decimal value (usually 0-64) that shows how many of the high-order  
contiguous bits of the address comprise the prefix (the network portion of the address). A  
slash mark must precede the <prefix_length>. The <next-hop-address>is the IPv6  
address of the next hop that can be used to reach the specified network. Specifying Null0  
as nexthop parameter adds a static reject route. The <preference>parameter is a value  
the router uses to compare this route with routes from other route sources that have the  
same destination. The range for <preference> is 1 - 255, and the default value is 1. You  
can specify a <slot/port>or tunnel <tunnel_id>interface to identify direct static  
routes from point-to-point and broadcast interfaces. The interface must be specified when  
IPv6 Commands  
360  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
using a link-local address as the next hop. A route with a preference of 255 cannot be used to  
forward traffic.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
ipv6 route <ipv6-prefix>/<prefix_length> {<next-hop-address> | Null0  
| interface {<slot/port> | tunnel <tunnel_id>} <next-hop-address>}  
[<preference>]  
Mode  
Global Config  
no ipv6 route  
Use this command to delete an IPv6 static route. Use the command without the optional  
parameters to delete all static routes to the specified destination. Use the <preference>  
parameter to revert the preference of a route to the default preference.  
Format  
no ipv6 route <ipv6-prefix>/<prefix_length> [{<next-hop-address> |  
Null0 | interface {<slot/port> | tunnel <tunnel_id>}  
<next-hop-address> | <preference>}]  
Mode  
Global Config  
ipv6 route distance  
This command sets the default distance (preference) for IPv6 static routes. Lower route  
distance values are preferred when determining the best route. The ipv6 routecommand  
allows you to optionally set the distance (preference) of an individual static route. The default  
distance is used when no distance is specified in this command.  
Changing the default distance does not update the distance of existing static routes, even if  
they were assigned the original default distance. The new default distance will only be  
applied to static routes created after invoking the ipv6 route distancecommand.  
Default  
1
Format  
Mode  
ipv6 route distance <1-255>  
Global Config  
no ipv6 route distance  
This command resets the default static route preference value in the router to the original  
default preference. Lower route preference values are preferred when determining the best  
route.  
Format  
Mode  
no ipv6 route distance  
Global Config  
IPv6 Commands  
361  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
ipv6 mtu  
This command sets the maximum transmission unit (MTU) size, in bytes, of IPv6 packets on  
an interface. This command replaces the default or link MTU with a new MTU value.  
Note: The default MTU value for a tunnel interface is 1480. You cannot  
change this value  
.
Default  
0 or link speed (MTU value (1500))  
Format  
Mode  
ipv6 mtu <1280-1500>  
Interface Config  
no ipv6 mtu  
This command resets maximum transmission unit value to default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no ipv6 mtu  
Interface Config  
ipv6 nd dad attempts  
This command sets the number of duplicate address detection probes transmitted. Duplicate  
address detection verifies that an IPv6 address on an interface is unique.  
Default  
1
Format  
Mode  
ipv6 nd dad attempts <0 - 600>  
Interface Config  
no ipv6 nd dad attempts  
This command resets to number of duplicate address detection value to default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no ipv6 nd dad attempts  
Interface Config  
IPv6 Commands  
362  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
ipv6 nd managed-config-flag  
This command sets the “managed address configuration” flag in router advertisements.  
When the value is true, end nodes use DHCPv6. When the value is false, end nodes  
automatically configure addresses.  
Default  
false  
Format  
Mode  
ipv6 nd managed-config-flag  
Interface Config  
no ipv6 nd managed-config-flag  
This command resets the “managed address configuration” flag in router advertisements to  
the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no ipv6 nd managed-config-flag  
Interface Config  
ipv6 nd ns-interval  
This command sets the interval between router advertisements for advertised neighbor  
solicitations, in milliseconds. An advertised value of 0 means the interval is unspecified.  
Default  
0
Format  
Mode  
ipv6 nd ns-interval {<1000-4294967295> | 0}  
Interface Config  
no ipv6 nd ns-interval  
This command resets the neighbor solicit retransmission interval of the specified interface to  
the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no ipv6 nd ns-interval  
Interface Config  
ipv6 nd other-config-flag  
This command sets the “other stateful configuration” flag in router advertisements sent from  
the interface.  
Default  
false  
Format  
Mode  
ipv6 nd other-config-flag  
Interface Config  
IPv6 Commands  
363  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no ipv6 nd other-config-flag  
This command resets the “other stateful configuration” flag back to its default value in router  
advertisements sent from the interface.  
Format  
Mode  
no ipv6 nd other-config-flag  
Interface Config  
ipv6 nd ra-interval  
This command sets the transmission interval between router advertisements.  
Default  
600  
Format  
Mode  
ipv6 nd ra-interval-max <4- 1800>  
Interface Config  
no ipv6 nd ra-interval  
This command sets router advertisement interval to the default.  
Format  
Mode  
no ipv6 nd ra-interval-max  
Interface Config  
ipv6 nd ra-lifetime  
This command sets the value, in seconds, that is placed in the Router Lifetime field of the  
router advertisements sent from the interface. The <lifetime>value must be zero, or it  
must be an integer between the value of the router advertisement transmission interval and  
9000. A value of zero means this router is not to be used as the default router.  
Default  
1800  
Format  
Mode  
ipv6 nd ra-lifetime <lifetime>  
Interface Config  
no ipv6 nd ra-lifetime  
This command resets router lifetime to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no ipv6 nd ra-lifetime  
Interface Config  
IPv6 Commands  
364  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
ipv6 nd reachable-time  
This command sets the router advertisement time to consider a neighbor reachable after  
neighbor discovery confirmation. Reachable time is specified in milliseconds. A value of zero  
means the time is unspecified by the router.  
Default  
0
Format  
Mode  
ipv6 nd reachable-time <0–3600000>  
Interface Config  
no ipv6 nd reachable-time  
This command means that the reachable time is unspecified for the router.  
Format  
Mode  
no ipv6 nd reachable-time  
Interface Config  
ipv6 nd suppress-ra  
This command suppresses router advertisement transmission on an interface.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
ipv6 nd suppress-ra  
Interface Config  
no ipv6 nd suppress-ra  
This command enables router transmission on an interface.  
Format  
Mode  
no ipv6 nd suppress-ra  
Interface Config  
ipv6 nd router-preference  
This is used to configure router preference value in IPv6 router advertisements on an  
interface. This will indicate whether to prefer this router over other default routers.  
Default  
Format  
Mode  
Medium  
ipv6 nd router-preference <high/low/medium>  
Interface Config  
IPv6 Commands  
365  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
ipv6 nd router-preference  
This command will set the router preference to default.  
Format  
Mode  
no ipv6 router-preference  
Interface Config  
ipv6 unreachables  
Use this command to enable the generation of ICMPv6 Destination Unreachable messages.  
By default, the generation of ICMPv6 Destination Unreachable messages is enabled.  
Default  
enable  
Format  
Mode  
ipv6 unreachables  
Interface Config  
no ipv6 unreachables  
Use this command to prevent the generation of ICMPv6 Destination Unreachable messages.  
Format  
Mode  
no ipv6 unreachables  
Interface Config  
ipv6 icmp error-interval  
Use this command to limit the rate at which ICMPv6 error messages are sent. The rate limit is  
configured as a token bucket, with two configurable parameters, burst-size and burst-interval.  
The burst-interval specifies how often the token bucket is initialized with burst-size tokens.  
burst-interval is from 0 to 2,147,483,647 milliseconds (msec).  
The burst-size is the number of ICMPv6 error messages that can be sent during one  
burst-interval. The range is from 1 to 200 messages.  
To disable ICMP rate limiting, set burst-interval to zero (0).  
Default  
burst-interval of 1000 msec.  
burst-size of 100 messages  
Format  
Mode  
ipv6 icmp error-interval <burst-interval> [<burst-size>]  
Global Config  
IPv6 Commands  
366  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no ipv6 icmp error-interval  
Use the no form of the command to return burst-interval and burst-size to their default  
values.  
Format  
Mode  
no ipv6 icmp error-interval  
Global Config  
show ipv6 brief  
Use this command to display the IPv6 status of forwarding mode and IPv6 unicast routing  
mode.  
Format  
Mode  
show ipv6 brief  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
IPv6  
Forwarding  
Mode  
Shows whether the IPv6 forwarding mode is enabled.  
IPv6 Unicast  
Routing Mode  
Shows whether the IPv6 unicast routing mode is enabled.  
IPv6 Hop Limit  
Shows the unicast hop count used in IPv6 packets originated by the node. For more  
ICMPv6 Rate  
Limit Error  
Interval  
Shows how often the token bucket is initialized with burst-size tokens. For more  
ICMPv6 Rate  
Limit Burst Size  
Shows the number of ICMPv6 error messages that can be sent during one burst-interval.  
For more information, see ipv6 icmp error-interval on page 366.  
Maximum  
Routes  
Shows the maximum IPv6 route table size.  
Example: The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(Switch) #show ipv6 brief  
IPv6 Forwarding Mode........................... Enable  
IPv6 Unicast Routing Mode...................... Enable  
IPv6 Hop Limit................................. 0  
ICMPv6 Rate Limit Error Interval............... 1000 msec  
ICMPv6 Rate Limit Burst Size................... 100 messages  
Maximum Routes................................. 3000  
IPv6 Commands  
367  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show ipv6 interface  
Use this command to show the usability status of IPv6 interfaces and whether ICMPv6  
Destination Unreachable messages might be sent.  
Format  
Mode  
show ipv6 interface {brief | <slot/port> |tunnel <0-7> | loopback  
<0-7>}  
Privileged EXEC  
If you use the briefparameter, the following information displays for all configured IPv6  
interfaces:  
Term  
Definition  
Interface  
The interface in slot/port format.  
Shows whether the mode is enabled or disabled.  
IPv6 Routing  
Operational  
Mode  
IPv6  
Address/Length  
Shows the IPv6 address and length on interfaces with IPv6 enabled.  
If you specify an interface, the following information also appears.  
Term  
Definition  
IPv6 is enabled  
Routing Mode  
Appears if IPv6 is enabled on the interface.  
Shows whether IPv6 routing is enabled or disabled.  
Shows whether the interface administrative mode is enabled or disabled.  
Administrative  
Mode  
Bandwidth  
Shows bandwidth of the interface.  
The MTU size, in bytes.  
Interface  
Maximum  
Transmission  
Unit  
Router  
The number of consecutive duplicate address detection probes to transmit.  
Duplicate  
Address  
Detection  
Transmits  
Router  
Advertisement  
NS Interval  
The interval, in milliseconds, between router advertisements for advertised neighbor  
solicitations.  
Router  
Advertisement  
Lifetime  
Shows the router lifetime value of the interface in router advertisements.  
Router  
Advertisement  
Reachable Time  
The amount of time, in milliseconds, to consider a neighbor reachable after neighbor  
discovery confirmation.  
IPv6 Commands  
368  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Router  
Advertisement  
Interval  
The frequency, in seconds, that router advertisements are sent.  
Router  
Advertisement  
Managed  
Shows whether the managed configuration flag is set (enabled) for router advertisements  
on this interface.  
Config Flag  
Router  
Shows whether the other configuration flag is set (enabled) for router advertisements on  
this interface.  
Advertisement  
Other Config  
Flag  
Router  
Advertisement  
Suppress Flag  
Shows whether router advertisements are suppressed (enabled) or sent (disabled).  
IPv6  
Destination  
Unreachables  
Shows whether ICMPv6 Destination Unreachable messages might be sent (enabled) or  
not (disabled). For more information, see ipv6 nd router-preference on page 365.  
Example: The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(Switch) #show ipv6 interface 0/1  
Routing Mode................................... Disabled  
Administrative Mode............................ Enabled  
IPv6 Routing Operational Mode.................. Disabled  
Bandwidth...................................... 100000 kbps  
Interface Maximum Transmit Unit................ 1500  
Router Duplicate Address Detection Transmits... 1  
Router Advertisement NS Interval............... 0  
Router Advertisement Lifetime.................. 1800  
Router Advertisement Reachable Time............ 0  
Router Advertisement Interval.................. 600  
Router Advertisement Managed Config Flag....... Disabled  
Router Advertisement Other Config Flag......... Disabled  
Router Advertisement Suppress Flag............. Disabled  
IPv6 Destination Unreachables.................. Enabled  
No IPv6 prefixes configured.  
If an IPv6 prefix is configured on the interface, the following information also appears.  
Term  
Definition  
IFPv6 Prefix is  
The IPv6 prefix for the specified interface.  
The amount of time the advertised prefix is a preferred prefix.  
Preferred  
Lifetime  
Valid Lifetime  
Onlink Flag  
The amount of time the advertised prefix is valid.  
Shows whether the onlink flag is set (enabled) in the prefix.  
Autonomous  
Flag  
Shows whether the autonomous address-configuration flag (autoconfig) is set (enabled)  
in the prefix.  
IPv6 Commands  
369  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show ipv6 neighbor  
Use this command to display information about the IPv6 neighbors.  
Format  
show ipv6 neighbor  
Mode  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Interface  
The interface in slot/port format.  
IPV6 address of neighbor or interface.  
Link-layer Address.  
IPv6 Address  
MAC Address  
IsRtr  
Shows whether the neighbor is a router. If the value is TRUE, the neighbor is known to  
be a router, and FALSE otherwise. A value of FALSE might not mean Note that routers  
are not always known to be routers.  
Neighbor State  
Last Updated  
State of neighbor cache entry. Possible values are Incomplete, Reachable, Stale, Delay,  
Probe, and Unknown.  
The time in seconds that has elapsed since an entry was added to the cache.  
clear ipv6 neighbors  
Use this command to clear all entries IPv6 neighbor table or an entry on a specific interface.  
Use the <slot/port>parameter to specify the interface.  
Format  
Mode  
clear ipv6 neighbors [<slot/port>]  
Privileged EXEC  
show ipv6 route  
This command displays the IPv6 routing table The <ipv6-address>specifies a specific  
IPv6 address for which the best-matching route would be displayed. The  
<ipv6-prefix/ipv6-prefix-length> specifies a specific IPv6 network for which the  
matching route would be displayed. The <interface>specifies that the routes with  
next-hops on the <interface>be displayed. The <protocol>specifies the protocol that  
installed the routes. The <protocol>is one of the following keywords: connected, ospf,  
static. The allspecifies that all routes including best and non-best routes are displayed.  
Otherwise, only the best routes are displayed.  
A “T” flag appended to an IPv6 route indicates that it is an ECMP route, but only one of its  
next hops has been installed in the forwarding table. The forwarding table might limit the  
number of ECMP routes or the number of ECMP groups. When an ECMP route cannot be  
installed because the limit is reached, the route is installed with a single next hop. Such  
truncated routes can be identified by a “T” after the interface name.  
IPv6 Commands  
370  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Note: If you use the connected keyword for <protocol>, the all option is not  
available because there are no best or non-best connected routes.  
Format  
Modes  
show ipv6 route [{<ipv6-address> [<protocol>] |  
{{<ipv6-prefix/ipv6-prefix-length> | <slot/port>} [<protocol>] |  
<protocol> | summary} [all] | all}]  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Route Codes  
The key for the routing protocol codes that might appear in the routing table output.  
The show ipv6 routecommand displays the routing tables in the following format:  
Codes: C - connected, S - static  
O - OSPF Intra, OI - OSPF Inter, OE1 - OSPF Ext 1, OE2 - OSPF Ext 2  
ON1 - OSPF NSSA Ext Type 1, ON2 - OSPF NSSA Ext Type 2  
The columns for the routing table display the following information:  
Term  
Code  
Definition  
The code for the routing protocol that created this routing entry.  
IPv6-Prefix/IPv6-  
Prefix-Length  
The IPv6-Prefix and prefix-length of the destination IPv6 network corresponding to this  
route.  
Preference/Metric  
The administrative distance (preference) and cost (metric) associated with this route. An  
example of this output is [1/0], where 1 is the preference and 0 is the metric.  
Tag  
The decimal value of the tag associated with a redistributed route, if it is not 0.  
Next-Hop  
The outgoing router IPv6 address to use when forwarding traffic to the next router (if any)  
in the path toward the destination.  
Route-Timestamp  
Interface  
The last updated time for dynamic routes. The format of Route-Timestamp will be  
• Days:Hours:Minutes if days > = 1  
• Hours:Minutes:Seconds if days < 1  
The outgoing router interface to use when forwarding traffic to the next destination. For  
reject routes, the next hop interface would be Null0interface.  
To administratively control the traffic destined to a particular network and prevent it from  
being forwarded through the router, you can configure a static reject route on the router. Such  
traffic would be discarded and the ICMP destination unreachable message is sent back to the  
source. This is typically used for preventing routing loops. The reject route added in the RTO  
is of the type OSPF Inter-Area. Reject routes (routes of REJECT type installed by any  
protocol) are not redistributed by OSPF/RIP. Reject routes are supported in both OSPFv2  
and OSPFv3.  
IPv6 Commands  
371  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Example: The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(Switch) #show ipv6 route  
IPv6 Routing Table - 3 entries  
Codes: C - connected, S - static  
O - OSPF Intra, OI - OSPF Inter, OE1 - OSPF Ext 1, OE2 - OSPF Ext 2  
ON1 - OSPF NSSA Ext Type 1, ON2 - OSPF NSSA Ext Type 2  
S
C
2001::/64 [10/0] directly connected, Null0  
2003::/64 [0/0]  
via ::, 0/11  
S
2005::/64 [1/0]  
via 2003::2, 0/11  
C 5001::/64 [0/0]  
via ::, 0/5  
OE1 6001::/64 [110/1]  
via fe80::200:42ff:fe7d:2f19, 00h:00m:23s, 0/5  
OI 7000::/64 [110/6]  
via fe80::200:4fff:fe35:c8bb, 00h:01m:47s, 0/11  
show ipv6 route ecmp-groups  
This command reports all current ECMP groups in the IPv6 routing table. An ECMP group is  
a set of next hops used in one or more routes. The groups are numbered arbitrarily from 1 to  
n. The output indicates the number of next hops in the group and the number of routes that  
use the set of next hops. The output lists the IPv6 address and outgoing interface of each  
next hop in each group.  
Format  
Mode  
show ipv6 route ecmp-groups  
Privileged EXEC  
Example  
(switch) #show ipv6 route ecmp-groups  
ECMP Group 1 with 2 next hops (used by 1 route)  
2001:DB8:1::1 on interface 2/1  
2001:DB8:2::14 on interface 2/2  
ECMP Group 2 with 3 next hops (used by 1 route)  
2001:DB8:4::15 on interface 2/32  
2001:DB8:7::12 on interface 2/33  
2001:DB8:9::45 on interface 2/34  
IPv6 Commands  
372  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show ipv6 route preferences  
Use this command to show the preference value associated with the type of route. Lower  
numbers have a greater preference. A route with a preference of 255 cannot be used to  
forward traffic.  
Format  
show ipv6 route preferences  
Mode  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Local  
Preference of directly-connected routes.  
Preference of static routes.  
Static  
OSPF Intra  
OSPF Inter  
OSPF External  
Preference of routes within the OSPF area.  
Preference of routes to other OSPF routes that are outside of the area.  
Preference of OSPF external routes.  
show ipv6 route summary  
This command displays the summary of the routing table. Use allto display the count  
summary for all routes, including best and non-best routes. Use the command without  
parameters to display the count summary for only the best routes.  
When the optional keyword allis given, some statistics, such as the number of routes from  
each source, include counts for alternate routes. An alternate route is a route that is not the  
most preferred route to its destination and therefore is not installed in the forwarding table.  
When this keyword is not given, the output reports for only the best routes.  
Format  
Modes  
show ipv6 route summary [all]  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Connected  
Routes  
Total number of connected routes in the routing table.  
Static Routes  
OSPF Routes  
Reject Routes  
Total number of static routes in the routing table.  
Total number of routes installed by OSPFv3 protocol.  
Total number of reject routes installed by all protocols.  
Summarizes the number of routes with prefixes of different lengths.  
Number of  
Prefixes  
Total Routes  
Best Routes  
The total number of routes in the routing table.  
The number of best routes currently in the routing table. This number counts only the  
best route to each destination.  
IPv6 Commands  
373  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Alternate  
Routes  
The number of alternate routes currently in the routing table. An alternate route is a route  
that was not selected as the best route to its destination.  
Route Adds  
The number of routes added to the routing table.  
Route Modifies  
Route Deletes  
The number of routes that changed after they were initially added to the routing table.  
The number of routes deleted from the routing table.  
Unresolved  
Route Adds  
The number of route adds that failed because none of the route's next hops were on a  
local subnet. Note that static routes can fail to be added to the routing table at startup  
because the routing interfaces are not up yet. This counter gets incremented in this case.  
The static routes are added to the routing table when the routing interfaces come up.  
Invalid Route  
Adds  
The number of routes that failed to be added to the routing table because the route was  
invalid. A log message is written for each of these failures.  
Failed Route  
Adds  
The number of routes that failed to be added to the routing table because of a resource  
limitation in the routing table.  
Reserved  
Locals  
The number of routing table entries reserved for a local subnet on a routing interface that  
is down. Space for local routes is always reserved so that local routes can be installed  
when a routing interface bounces.  
Unique Next  
Hops  
The number of distinct next hops used among all routes currently in the routing table.  
These include local interfaces for local routes and neighbors for indirect routes.  
Unique Next  
Hops High  
Water  
The highest count of unique next hops since counters were last cleared.  
Next Hop  
Groups  
The current number of next hop groups in use by one or more routes. Each next hop  
group includes one or more next hops.  
Next Hop  
Groups High  
Water  
The highest count of next hop groups since counters were last cleared.  
ECMP Groups  
ECMP Routes  
The number of next hop groups with multiple next hops.  
The number of routes with multiple next hops currently in the routing table.  
Truncated  
ECMP Routes  
The number of ECMP routes that are currently installed in the forwarding table with just  
one next hop. The forwarding table might limit the number of ECMP routes or the number  
of ECMP groups. When an ECMP route cannot be installed because such a limit is  
reached, the route is installed with a single next hop.  
ECMP Retries  
The number of ECMP routes that have been installed in the forwarding table after initially  
being installed with a single next hop.  
Routes with n  
Next Hops  
The current number of routes with each number of next hops.  
The following example shows CLI display output for the command.  
(switch) #show ipv6 route summary  
Connected Routes............................... 4  
Static Routes.................................. 0  
6To4 Routes.................................... 0  
IPv6 Commands  
374  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
OSPF Routes.................................... 13  
Intra Area Routes............................ 0  
Inter Area Routes............................ 13  
External Type-1 Routes....................... 0  
External Type-2 Routes....................... 0  
Reject Routes.................................. 0  
Total routes................................... 17  
Best Routes (High)............................. 17 (17)  
Alternate Routes............................... 0  
Route Adds..................................... 44  
Route Deletes.................................. 27  
Unresolved Route Adds.......................... 0  
Invalid Route Adds............................. 0  
Failed Route Adds.............................. 0  
Reserved Locals................................ 0  
Unique Next Hops (High)........................ 8 (8)  
Next Hop Groups (High)......................... 8 (8)  
ECMP Groups (High)............................. 3 (3)  
ECMP Routes.................................... 12  
Truncated ECMP Routes.......................... 0  
ECMP Retries................................... 0  
Routes with 1 Next Hop......................... 5  
Routes with 2 Next Hops........................ 1  
Routes with 3 Next Hops........................ 1  
Routes with 4 Next Hops........................ 10  
Number of Prefixes:  
/64: 17  
show ipv6 vlan  
This command displays IPv6 VLAN routing interface addresses.  
Format  
Modes  
show ipv6 vlan  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
MAC Address  
used by  
Shows the MAC address.  
Routing VLANs  
The rest of the output for this command is displayed in a table with the following column  
headings:  
Column  
Definition  
Headings  
VLAN ID  
The VLAN ID of a configured VLAN.  
IPv6 Commands  
375  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Column  
Definition  
Headings  
Logical  
Interface  
The interface in slot/port format that is associated with the VLAN ID.  
The IPv6 prefix and prefix length associated with the VLAN ID.  
IPv6  
Address/Prefix  
Length  
show ipv6 traffic  
Use this command to show traffic and statistics for IPv6 and ICMPv6. Specify a logical,  
loopback, or tunnel interface to view information about traffic on a specific interface. If you do  
not specify an interface, the command displays information about traffic on all interfaces.  
Format  
Mode  
show ipv6 traffic [{<slot/port> | loopback <loopback-id> | tunnel  
<tunnel-id>}]  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Total Datagrams  
Received  
Total number of input datagrams received by the interface, including those  
received in error.  
Received Datagrams  
Locally Delivered  
Total number of datagrams successfully delivered to IPv6 user-protocols  
(including ICMP). This counter increments at the interface to which these  
datagrams were addressed, which might not necessarily be the input interface  
for some of the datagrams.  
Received Datagrams  
Discarded Due To  
Header Errors  
Number of input datagrams discarded due to errors in their IPv6 headers,  
including version number mismatch, other format errors, hop count exceeded,  
errors discovered in processing their IPv6 options, and so on.  
Received Datagrams  
Discarded Due To MTU  
Number of input datagrams that could not be forwarded because their size  
exceeded the link MTU of outgoing interface.  
Received Datagrams  
Discarded Due To No  
Route  
Number of input datagrams discarded because no route could be found to  
transmit them to their destination.  
Received Datagrams  
With Unknown Protocol  
Number of locally-addressed datagrams received successfully but discarded  
because of an unknown or unsupported protocol. This counter increments at  
the interface to which these datagrams were addressed, which might not be  
necessarily the input interface for some of the datagrams.  
Received Datagrams  
DiscardedDueToInvalid  
Address  
Number of input datagrams discarded because the IPv6 address in their IPv6  
header's destination field was not a valid address to be received at this entity.  
This count includes invalid addresses (for example, ::0) and unsupported  
addresses (for example, addresses with unallocated prefixes). Forentities  
which are not IPv6 routers and therefore do not forward datagrams, this  
counter includes datagrams discarded because the destination address was  
not a local address.  
Received Datagrams  
Discarded Due To  
Truncated Data  
Number of input datagrams discarded because datagram frame did not carry  
enough data.  
IPv6 Commands  
376  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Received Datagrams  
Discarded Other  
Number of input IPv6 datagrams for which no problems were encountered to  
prevent their continue processing, but which were discarded (for example, for  
lack of buffer space). Note that this counter does not include datagrams  
discarded while awaiting reassembly.  
Received Datagrams  
Reassembly Required  
Number of IPv6 fragments received which needed to be reassembled at this  
interface. Note that this counter increments at the interface to which these  
fragments were addressed, which might not be necessarily the input interface  
for some of the fragments.  
Datagrams Successfully  
Reassembled  
Number of IPv6 datagrams successfully reassembled. Note that this counter  
increments at the interface to which these datagrams were addressed, which  
might not be necessarily the input interface for some of the fragments.  
Datagrams Failed To  
Reassemble  
Number of failures detected by the IPv6 reassembly algorithm (for whatever  
reason: timed out, errors, and so on). Note that this is not necessarily a count of  
discarded IPv6 fragments since some algorithms (notably the algorithm in by  
combining them as they are received. This counter increments at the interface  
to which these fragments were addressed, which might not be necessarily the  
input interface for some of the fragments.  
Datagrams Forwarded  
Number of output datagrams which this entity received and forwarded to their  
final destinations. In entities which do not act as IPv6 routers, this counter will  
include only those packets which were Source-Routed via this entity, and the  
Source-Route processing was successful. Note that for a successfully  
forwarded datagram the counter of the outgoing interface increments.  
Datagrams Locally  
Transmitted  
Total number of IPv6 datagrams which local IPv6 user-protocols (including  
ICMP) supplied to IPv6 in requests for transmission. Note that this counter  
does not include any datagrams counted in ipv6IfStatsOutForwDatagrams.  
Datagrams Transmit  
Failed  
Number of output IPv6 datagrams for which no problem was encountered to  
prevent their transmission to their destination, but which were discarded (for  
example, for lack of buffer space). Note that this counter would include  
datagrams counted in ipv6IfStatsOutForwDatagrams if any such packets met  
this (discretionary) discard criterion.  
Fragments Created  
Number of output datagram fragments that have been generated as a result of  
fragmentation at this output interface.  
Datagrams Successfully  
Fragmented  
Number of IPv6 datagrams that have been successfully fragmented at this  
output interface.  
Datagrams Failed To  
Fragment  
Number of IPv6 datagrams that have been discarded because they needed to  
be fragmented at this output interface but could not be.  
Multicast Datagrams  
Received  
Number of multicast packets received by the interface.  
Number of multicast packets transmitted by the interface.  
Multicast Datagrams  
Transmitted  
Total ICMPv6 messages  
received  
Total number of ICMP messages received by the interface which includes all  
those counted by ipv6IfIcmpInErrors. Note that this interface is the interface to  
which the ICMP messages were addressed which might not be necessarily the  
input interface for the messages.  
IPv6 Commands  
377  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
ICMPv6 Messages with  
errors  
Number of ICMP messages which the interface received but determined as  
having ICMP-specific errors (bad ICMP checksums, bad length, and so on).  
ICMPv6 Destination  
Unreachable Messages  
Number of ICMP Destination Unreachable messages received by the interface.  
ICMPv6 Messages  
Prohibited  
Administratively  
Number of ICMP destination unreachable/communication administratively  
prohibited messages received by the interface.  
ICMPv6 Time Exceeded  
Messages  
Number of ICMP Time Exceeded messages received by the interface.  
Number of ICMP Parameter Problem messages received by the interface.  
Number of ICMP Packet Too Big messages received by the interface.  
Number of ICMP Echo (request) messages received by the interface.  
Number of ICMP Echo Reply messages received by the interface.  
Number of ICMP Router Solicit messages received by the interface.  
Number of ICMP Router Advertisement messages received by the interface.  
ICMPv6 Parameter  
Problem Messages  
ICMPv6 messages with  
too big packets  
ICMPv6 Echo Request  
Messages Received  
ICMPv6 Echo Reply  
Messages Received  
ICMPv6 Router Solicit  
Messages Received  
ICMPv6 Router  
Advertisement  
Messages Received  
ICMPv6 Neighbor Solicit  
Messages Received  
Number of ICMP Neighbor Solicit messages received by the interface.  
ICMPv6 Neighbor  
Advertisement  
Number of ICMP Neighbor Advertisement messages received by the interface.  
Messages Received  
ICMPv6 Redirect  
Messages Received  
Number of Redirect messages received by the interface.  
Transmitted  
Number of ICMPv6 Group Membership Query messages received by the  
interface.  
Total ICMPv6 Messages  
Transmitted  
Total number of ICMP messages which this interface attempted to send. Note  
that this counter includes all those counted by icmpOutErrors.  
ICMPv6 Messages Not  
Transmitted Due To  
Error  
Number of ICMP messages which this interface did not send due to problems  
discovered within ICMP such as a lack of buffers. This value should not include  
errors discovered outside the ICMP layer such as the inability of IPv6 to route  
the resultant datagram. In some implementations, there may be no types of  
error which contribute to this counter's value.  
ICMPv6 Destination  
Unreachable Messages  
Transmitted  
Number of ICMP Destination Unreachable messages sent by the interface.  
ICMPv6 Messages  
Prohibited  
Administratively  
Transmitted  
Number of ICMP destination unreachable/communication administratively  
prohibited messages sent.  
IPv6 Commands  
378  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
ICMPv6 Time Exceeded  
Messages Transmitted  
Number of ICMP Time Exceeded messages sent by the interface.  
Number of ICMP Parameter Problem messages sent by the interface.  
ICMPv6 Parameter  
Problem Messages  
Transmitted  
ICMPv6 Packet Too Big  
Messages Transmitted  
Number of ICMP Packet Too Big messages sent by the interface.  
ICMPv6 Echo Request  
Messages Transmitted  
Number of ICMP Echo (request) messages sent by the interface.ICMP echo  
messages sent.  
ICMPv6 Echo Reply  
Messages Transmitted  
Number of ICMP Echo Reply messages sent by the interface.  
Number of ICMP Router Solicitation messages sent by the interface.  
Number of ICMP Router Advertisement messages sent by the interface.  
ICMPv6 Router Solicit  
Messages Transmitted  
ICMPv6 Router  
Advertisement  
Messages Transmitted  
ICMPv6 Neighbor Solicit  
Messages Transmitted  
Number of ICMP Neighbor Solicitation messages sent by the interface.  
Number of ICMP Neighbor Advertisement messages sent by the interface.  
ICMPv6 Neighbor  
Advertisement  
Messages Transmitted  
ICMPv6 Redirect  
Messages Received  
Number of Redirect messages sent. For a host, this object will always be zero,  
since hosts do not send redirects.  
ICMPv6 Group  
Membership Query  
Messages Received  
Number of ICMPv6 Group Membership Query messages sent.  
Number of ICMPv6 Group Membership Response messages sent.  
Number of ICMPv6 Group Membership Reduction messages sent.  
Number of duplicate addresses detected by the interface.  
ICMPv6 Group  
Membership Response  
Messages Received  
ICMPv6 Group  
Membership Reduction  
Messages Received  
ICMPv6 Duplicate  
Address Detects  
clear ipv6 route counters  
This command resets to zero the IPv6 routing table counters reported in show ipv6 route  
summary. The command resets only the event counters. Counters that report the current  
state of the routing table, such as the number of routes of each type, are not reset.  
Format  
Mode  
clear ipv6 route counters  
Privileged EXEC  
IPv6 Commands  
379  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
clear ipv6 statistics  
Use this command to clear IPv6 statistics for all interfaces or for a specific interface, including  
loopback and tunnel interfaces. IPv6 statistics display in the output of the show ipv6  
traffic command. If you do not specify an interface, the counters for all IPv6 traffic  
statistics reset to zero.  
Format  
Mode  
clear ipv6 statistics [{<slot/port> | loopback <loopback-id> | tunnel  
<tunnel-id>}]  
Privileged EXEC  
OSPFv3 Commands  
This section describes the commands you use to configure OSPFv3, which is a link-state  
routing protocol that you use to route traffic within a network.  
ipv6 ospf  
This command enables OSPF on a router interface or loopback interface.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
ipv6 ospf  
Interface Config  
no ipv6 ospf  
This command disables OSPF on a router interface or loopback interface.  
Format  
Mode  
no ipv6 ospf  
Interface Config  
ipv6 ospf area  
This command sets the OSPF area to which the specified router interface belongs. The  
<areaid>is an IPv6 address, formatted as a 4-digit dotted-decimal number or a decimal  
value in the range of <0-4294967295>. The <areaid>uniquely identifies the area to which  
the interface connects. Assigning an area id, which does not exist on an interface, causes the  
area to be created with default values.  
Format  
Mode  
ipv6 ospf area <areaid>  
Interface Config  
IPv6 Commands  
380  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
ipv6 ospf cost  
This command configures the cost on an OSPF interface. The <cost>parameter has a  
range of 1–65,535.  
Default  
10  
Format  
Mode  
ipv6 ospf cost <1-65535>  
Interface Config  
no ipv6 ospf cost  
This command configures the default cost on an OSPF interface.  
Format  
Mode  
no ipv6 ospf cost  
Interface Config  
ipv6 ospf dead-interval  
This command sets the OSPF dead interval for the specified interface. The value for  
<seconds>is a valid positive integer, which represents the length of time in seconds that a  
router's Hello packets have not been seen before its neighbor routers declare that the router  
is down. The value for the length of time must be the same for all routers attached to a  
common network. This value should be some multiple of the Hello Interval (that is, 4). Valid  
values range for <seconds>is from 1 to 2147483647.  
Default  
40  
Format  
Mode  
ipv6 ospf dead-interval <seconds>  
Interface Config  
no ipv6 ospf dead-interval  
This command sets the default OSPF dead interval for the specified interface.  
Format  
Mode  
no ipv6 ospf dead-interval  
Interface Config  
ipv6 ospf hello-interval  
This command sets the OSPF hello interval for the specified interface. The value for  
<seconds>is a valid positive integer, which represents the length of time in seconds. The  
value for the length of time must be the same for all routers attached to a network. Valid  
values for <seconds>range from 1 to 65535.  
Default  
10  
IPv6 Commands  
381  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Format  
Mode  
ipv6 ospf hello-interval <seconds>  
Interface Config  
no ipv6 ospf hello-interval  
This command sets the default OSPF hello interval for the specified interface.  
Format  
Mode  
no ipv6 ospf hello-interval  
Interface Config  
ipv6 ospf mtu-ignore  
This command disables OSPF maximum transmission unit (MTU) mismatch detection. OSPF  
Database Description packets specify the size of the largest IP packet that can be sent  
without fragmentation on the interface. When a router receives a Database Description  
packet, it examines the MTU advertised by the neighbor. By default, if the MTU is larger than  
the router can accept, the Database Description packet is rejected and the OSPF adjacency  
is not established.  
Default  
enabled  
Format  
Mode  
ipv6 ospf mtu-ignore  
Interface Config  
no ipv6 ospf mtu-ignore  
This command enables the OSPF MTU mismatch detection.  
Format  
Mode  
no ipv6 ospf mtu-ignore  
Interface Config  
ipv6 ospf network  
This command changes the default OSPF network type for the interface. Normally, the  
network type is determined from the physical IP network type. By default all Ethernet  
networks are OSPF type broadcast. Similarly, tunnel interfaces default to point-to-point.  
When an Ethernet port is used as a single large bandwidth IP network between two routers,  
the network type can be point-to-point since there are only two routers. Using point-to-point  
as the network type eliminates the overhead of the OSPF designated router election. It is  
normally not useful to set a tunnel to OSPF network type broadcast.  
Default  
broadcast  
Format  
Mode  
ipv6 ospf network {broadcast | point-to-point}  
Interface Config  
IPv6 Commands  
382  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no ipv6 ospf network  
This command sets the interface type to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no ipv6 ospf network {broadcast | point-to-point}  
Interface Config  
ipv6 ospf priority  
This command sets the OSPF priority for the specified router interface. The priority of the  
interface is a priority integer from 0 to 255. A value of 0 indicates that the router is not eligible  
to become the designated router on this network.  
Default  
1, which is the highest router priority  
Format  
Mode  
ipv6 ospf priority <0-255>  
Interface Config  
no ipv6 ospf priority  
This command sets the default OSPF priority for the specified router interface.  
Format  
Mode  
no ipv6 ospf priority  
Interface Config  
ipv6 ospf retransmit-interval  
This command sets the OSPF retransmit Interval for the specified interface. The retransmit  
interval is specified in seconds. The value for <seconds>is the number of seconds between  
link-state advertisement retransmissions for adjacencies belonging to this router interface.  
This value is also used when retransmitting database description and link-state request  
packets. Valid values range from 0 to 3600 (1 hour).  
Default  
5
Format  
Mode  
ipv6 ospf retransmit-interval <seconds>  
Interface Config  
no ipv6 ospf retransmit-interval  
This command sets the default OSPF retransmit Interval for the specified interface.  
Format  
Mode  
no ipv6 ospf retransmit-interval  
Interface Config  
IPv6 Commands  
383  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
ipv6 ospf transmit-delay  
This command sets the OSPF Transit Delay for the specified interface. The transmit delay is  
specified in seconds. In addition, it sets the estimated number of seconds it takes to transmit  
a link state update packet over this interface. Valid values for <seconds>range from 1 to  
3600 (1 hour).  
Default  
1
Format  
Mode  
ipv6 ospf transmit-delay <seconds>  
Interface Config  
no ipv6 ospf transmit-delay  
This command sets the default OSPF Transit Delay for the specified interface.  
Format  
Mode  
no ipv6 ospf transmit-delay  
Interface Config  
ipv6 router ospf  
Use this command to enter Router OSPFv3 Config mode.  
Format  
Mode  
ipv6 router ospf  
Global Config  
area default-cost (OSPFv3)  
This command configures the monetary default cost for the stub area. The operator must  
specify the area id and an integer value between 1–16777215.  
Format  
Mode  
area <areaid> default-cost <1-16777215>  
Router OSPFv3 Config  
area nssa (OSPFv3)  
This command configures the specified areaid to function as an NSSA.  
Format  
Mode  
area <areaid> nssa  
Router OSPFv3 Config  
IPv6 Commands  
384  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no area nssa(OSPFv3)  
This command disables nssa from the specified area id.  
Format  
Mode  
no area <areaid> nssa  
Router OSPFv3 Config  
area nssa default-info-originate (OSPFv3)  
This command configures the metric value and type for the default route advertised into the  
NSSA. The optional metric parameter specifies the metric of the default route and is to be in  
a range of 1-16777214. If no metric is specified, the default value is 10. The metric type can  
be comparable (nssa-external 1) or non-comparable (nssa-external 2).  
Format  
Mode  
area <areaid> nssa default-info-originate [<metric>] [{comparable |  
non-comparable}]  
Router OSPFv3 Config  
no area nssa default-info-originate (OSPFv3)  
This command disables the default route advertised into the NSSA.  
Format  
Mode  
no area <areaid> nssa default-info-originate [<metric>] [{comparable  
| non-comparable}]  
Router OSPF Config  
area nssa no-redistribute (OSPFv3)  
This command configures the NSSA ABR so that learned external routes will not be  
redistributed to the NSSA.  
Format  
Mode  
area <areaid> nssa no-redistribute  
Router OSPFv3 Config  
no area nssa no-redistribute (OSPFv3)  
This command disables the NSSA ABR so that learned external routes are redistributed to  
the NSSA.  
Format  
Mode  
no area <areaid> nssa no-redistribute  
Router OSPF Config  
IPv6 Commands  
385  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
area nssa no-summary (OSPFv3)  
This command configures the NSSA so that summary LSAs are not advertised into the  
NSSA.  
Format  
Mode  
area <areaid> nssa no-summary  
Router OSPFv3 Config  
no area nssa no-summary (OSPFv3)  
This command disables nssa from the summary LSAs.  
Format  
Mode  
no area <areaid> nssa no-summary  
Router OSPF Config  
area nssa translator-role (OSPFv3)  
This command configures the translator role of the NSSA. A value of alwayscauses the  
router to assume the role of the translator the instant it becomes a border router and a value  
of candidatecauses the router to participate in the translator election process when it  
attains border router status.  
Format  
Mode  
area <areaid> nssa translator-role {always | candidate}  
Router OSPFv3 Config  
no area nssa translator-role (OSPFv3)  
This command disables the nssa translator role from the specified area id.  
Format  
Mode  
no area <areaid> nssa translator-role {always | candidate}  
Router OSPF Config  
area nssa translator-stab-intv (OSPFv3)  
This command configures the translator <stabilityinterval>of the NSSA. The  
<stabilityinterval>is the period of time that an elected translator continues to perform  
its duties after it determines that its translator status has been deposed by another router.  
Format  
Mode  
area <areaid> nssa translator-stab-intv <stabilityinterval>  
Router OSPFv3 Config  
IPv6 Commands  
386  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no area nssa translator-stab-intv (OSPFv3)  
This command disables the nssa translator’s <stabilityinterval>from the specified  
area id.  
Format  
Mode  
no area <areaid> nssa translator-stab-intv <stabilityinterval>  
Router OSPF Config  
area range (OSPFv3)  
This command creates a specified area range for a specified NSSA. The <ipaddr>is a valid  
IP address. The <subnetmask>is a valid subnet mask. The LSDB type must be specified  
by either summarylinkor nssaexternallink, and the advertising of the area range can  
be allowed or suppressed.  
Format  
Mode  
area <areaid>range <ipv6-prefix> <prefix-length> {summarylink |  
nssaexternallink} [advertise | not-advertise]  
Router OSPFv3 Config  
no area range(OSPFv3)  
This command deletes a specified area range. The <ipaddr>is a valid IP address. The  
<subnetmask> is a valid subnet mask.  
Format  
Mode  
no area <areaid>range<ipv6-prefix> <prefix-length>  
Router OSPFv3 Config  
area stub (OSPFv3)  
This command creates a stub area for the specified area ID. A stub area is characterized by  
the fact that AS External LSAs are not propagated into the area. Removing AS External LSAs  
and Summary LSAs can significantly reduce the link state database of routers within the stub  
area.  
Format  
Mode  
area <areaid> stub  
Router OSPFv3 Config  
no area stub(OSPFv3)  
This command deletes a stub area for the specified area ID.  
Format  
Mode  
no area <areaid> stub  
Router OSPFv3 Config  
IPv6 Commands  
387  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
area stub no-summary (OSPFv3)  
This command disables the import of Summary LSAs for the stub area identified by  
<areaid>.  
Default  
enabled  
Format  
Mode  
area <areaid> stub no-summary  
Router OSPFv3 Config  
no area stub no-summary(OSPFv3)  
This command sets the Summary LSA import mode to the default for the stub area identified  
by <areaid>.  
Format  
Mode  
no area <areaid> stub summarylsa  
Router OSPFv3 Config  
area virtual-link (OSPFv3)  
This command creates the OSPF virtual interface for the specified <areaid> and  
<neighbor>. The <neighbor>parameter is the Router ID of the neighbor.  
Format  
Mode  
area <areaid> virtual-link <neighbor>  
Router OSPFv3 Config  
no area virtual-link(OSPFv3)  
This command deletes the OSPF virtual interface from the given interface, identified by  
<areaid> and <neighbor>. The <neighbor>parameter is the Router ID of the neighbor.  
Format  
Mode  
no area <areaid> virtual-link <neighbor>  
Router OSPFv3 Config  
area virtual-link dead-interval (OSPFv3)  
This command configures the dead interval for the OSPF virtual interface on the virtual  
interface identified by <areaid>and <neighbor>.The <neighbor>parameter is the  
Router ID of the neighbor. The range for <seconds>is 1–65,535.  
Default  
40  
Format  
Mode  
area <areaid> virtual-link <neighbor> dead-interval <seconds>  
Router OSPFv3 Config  
IPv6 Commands  
388  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no area virtual-link dead-interval(OSPFv3)  
This command configures the default dead interval for the OSPF virtual interface on the  
virtual interface identified by <areaid>and <neighbor>. The <neighbor> parameter is  
the Router ID of the neighbor.  
Format  
Mode  
no area <areaid> virtual-link <neighbor> dead-interval  
Router OSPFv3 Config  
area virtual-link hello-interval (OSPFv3)  
This command configures the hello interval for the OSPF virtual interface on the virtual  
interface identified by <areaid>and <neighbor>. The <neighbor>parameter is the  
Router ID of the neighbor. The range for <seconds>is 1–65,535.  
Default  
10  
Format  
Mode  
area <areaid> virtual-link <neighbor> hello-interval <seconds>  
Router OSPFv3 Config  
no area virtual-link hello-interval(OSPFv3)  
This command configures the default hello interval for the OSPF virtual interface on the  
virtual interface identified by <areaid>and <neighbor>. The <neighbor>parameter is  
the Router ID of the neighbor.  
Format  
Mode  
no area <areaid> virtual-link <neighbor> hello-interval  
Router OSPFv3 Config  
area virtual-link retransmit-interval (OSPFv3)  
This command configures the retransmit interval for the OSPF virtual interface on the virtual  
interface identified by <areaid>and <neighbor>. The <neighbor>parameter is the  
Router ID of the neighbor. The range for <seconds>is 0–3,600.  
Default  
5
Format  
Mode  
area <areaid> virtual-link <neighbor> retransmit-interval <seconds>  
Router OSPFv3 Config  
IPv6 Commands  
389  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no area virtual-link retransmit-interval(OSPFv3)  
This command configures the default retransmit interval for the OSPF virtual interface on the  
virtual interface identified by <areaid>and <neighbor>. The <neighbor> parameter is  
the Router ID of the neighbor.  
Format  
Mode  
no area <areaid> virtual-link <neighbor> retransmit-interval  
Router OSPFv3 Config  
area virtual-link transmit-delay (OSPFv3)  
This command configures the transmit delay for the OSPF virtual interface on the virtual  
interface identified by <areaid>and <neighbor>. The <neighbor>parameter is the  
Router ID of the neighbor. The range for <seconds>is 0–3,600 (1 hour).  
Default  
1
Format  
Mode  
area <areaid> virtual-link <neighbor> transmit-delay <seconds>  
Router OSPFv3 Config  
no area virtual-link transmit-delay(OSPFv3)  
This command configures the default transmit delay for the OSPF virtual interface on the  
virtual interface identified by <areaid>and <neighbor>. The <neighbor>parameter is  
the Router ID of the neighbor.  
Format  
Mode  
no area <areaid> virtual-link <neighbor> transmit-delay  
Router OSPFv3 Config  
auto-cost (OSPFv3)  
By default, OSPF computes the link cost of each interface from the interface bandwidth.  
Faster links have lower metrics, making them more attractive in route selection. The  
configuration parameters in the auto-cost reference bandwidthand bandwidth  
commands give you control over the default link cost. You can configure for OSPF an  
interface bandwidth that is independent of the actual link speed. A second configuration  
parameter allows you to control the ratio of interface bandwidth to link cost. The link cost is  
computed as the ratio of a reference bandwidth to the interface bandwidth (ref_bw / interface  
bandwidth), where interface bandwidth is defined by the bandwidthcommand. Because the  
default reference bandwidth is 100 Mbps, OSPF uses the same default link cost for all  
interfaces whose bandwidth is 100 Mbps or greater. Use the auto-costcommand to  
change the reference bandwidth, specifying the reference bandwidth in megabits per second  
(Mbps). The reference bandwidth range is 1–4294967 Mbps. The different reference  
bandwidth can be independently configured for OSPFv2 and OSPFv3.  
Default  
100Mbps  
IPv6 Commands  
390  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Format  
Mode  
auto-cost reference-bandwidth <1 to 4294967>  
Router OSPFv3 Config  
no auto-cost reference-bandwidth (OSPFv3)  
Use this command to set the reference bandwidth to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no auto-cost reference-bandwidth  
Router OSPFv3 Config  
clear ipv6 ospf  
Use this command to disable and re-enable OSPF.  
Format  
Mode  
clear ipv6 ospf  
Privileged EXEC  
clear ipv6 ospf configuration  
Use this command to reset the OSPF configuration to factory defaults.  
Format  
Mode  
clear ipv6 ospf configuration  
Privileged EXEC  
clear ipv6 ospf counters  
Use this command to reset global and interface statistics.  
Format  
Mode  
clear ipv6 ospf counters  
Privileged EXEC  
clear ipv6 ospf neighbor  
Use this command to drop the adjacency with all OSPF neighbors. On each neighbor’s  
interface, send a one way hello. Adjacencies might then be reestablished. To drop all  
adjacencies with a specific router ID, specify the neighbor’s Router ID using the optional  
parameter [neighbor-id].  
Format  
Mode  
clear ipv6 ospf neighbor [neighbor-id]  
Privileged EXEC  
IPv6 Commands  
391  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
clear ipv6 ospf neighbor interface  
To drop adjacency with all neighbors on a specific interface, use the optional parameter  
[slot/port]. To drop adjacency with a specific router ID on a specific interface, use the optional  
parameter [neighbor-id].  
Format  
Mode  
clear ipv6 ospf neighbor interface [slot/port] [neighbor-id]  
Privileged EXEC  
clear ipv6 ospf redistribution  
Use this command to flush all self-originated external LSAs. Reapply the redistribution  
configuration and reoriginate prefixes as necessary.  
Format  
Mode  
clear ipv6 ospf redistribution  
Privileged EXEC  
default-information originate (OSPFv3)  
This command is used to control the advertisement of default routes.  
Default  
• metric—unspecified  
• type—2  
Format  
Mode  
default-information originates [always] [metric <1-16777214>]  
[metric-type {1 | 2}]  
Router OSPFv3 Config  
no default-information originates (OSPFv3)  
This command is used to control the advertisement of default routes.  
Format  
Mode  
no default-information originates [metric] [metric-type]  
Router OSPFv3 Config  
default-metric (OSPFv3)  
This command is used to set a default for the metric of distributed routes.  
Format  
Mode  
default-metric <1-16777214>  
Router OSPFv3 Config  
IPv6 Commands  
392  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no default-metric (OSPFv3)  
This command is used to set a default for the metric of distributed routes.  
Format  
Mode  
no default-metric  
Router OSPFv3 Config  
distance ospf (OSPFv3)  
This command sets the route preference value of OSPF route types in the router. Lower  
route preference values are preferred when determining the best route. The type of OSPF  
route can be intra, inter, or external. All the external type routes are given the same  
preference value. The range of <preference>value is 1–255.  
Default  
110  
Format  
Mode  
distance ospf {intra-area <1-255> | inter-area <1-255> | external  
<1-255>}  
Router OSPFv3 Config  
no distance ospf(OSPFv3)  
This command sets the default route preference value of OSPF routes in the router. The type  
of OSPF route can be intra, inter, or external. All the external type routes are given the same  
preference value.  
Format  
Mode  
no distance ospf {intra-area | inter-area | external}  
Router OSPFv3 Config  
enable (OSPFv3)  
This command resets the default administrative mode of OSPF in the router (active).  
Default  
enabled  
Format  
Mode  
enable  
Router OSPFv3 Config  
no enable (OSPFv3)  
This command sets the administrative mode of OSPF in the router to inactive.  
Format  
Mode  
no enable  
Router OSPFv3 Config  
IPv6 Commands  
393  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
exit-overflow-interval (OSPFv3)  
This command configures the exit overflow interval for OSPF. It describes the number of  
seconds after entering Overflow state that a router will wait before attempting to leave the  
overflow state. This allows the router to again originate non-default AS-external-LSAs. When  
set to 0, the router will not leave overflow state until restarted. The range for <seconds>is  
0–2,147,483,647 seconds.  
Default  
0
Format  
Mode  
exit-overflow-interval <seconds>  
Router OSPFv3 Config  
no exit-overflow-interval(OSPFv3)  
This command configures the default exit overflow interval for OSPF.  
Format  
Mode  
no exit-overflow-interval  
Router OSPFv3 Config  
external-lsdb-limit (OSPFv3)  
This command configures the external LSDB limit for OSPF. If the value is –1, there is no  
limit. When the number of non-default AS-external-LSAs in a router’s link-state database  
reaches the external LSDB limit, the router enters overflow state. The router never holds  
more than the external LSDB limit non-default AS-external-LSAs in it database. The external  
LSDB limit must be set identically in all routers attached to the OSPF backbone and/or any  
regular OSPF area. The range for <limit>is –1 to 2,147,483,647.  
Default  
-1  
Format  
Mode  
external-lsdb-limit <limit>  
Router OSPFv3 Config  
no external-lsdb-limit  
This command configures the default external LSDB limit for OSPF.  
Format  
Mode  
no external-lsdb-limit  
Router OSPFv3 Config  
IPv6 Commands  
394  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
maximum-paths (OSPFv3)  
This command sets the number of paths that OSPF can report for a given destination where  
maxpathsis platform-dependent.  
Default  
4
Format  
Mode  
maximum-paths <maxpaths>  
Router OSPFv3 Config  
no maximum-paths  
This command resets the number of paths that OSPF can report for a given destination back  
to its default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no maximum-paths  
Router OSPFv3 Config  
passive-interface default (OSPFv3)  
Use this command to enable global passive mode by default for all interfaces. It overrides  
any interface level passive mode. OSPF shall not form adjacencies over a passive interface.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
passive-interface default  
Router OSPFv3 Config  
no passive-interface default(OSPFv3)  
Use this command to disable the global passive mode by default for all interfaces. Any  
interface previously configured to be passive reverts to non-passive mode.  
Format  
Mode  
no passive-interface default  
Router OSPFv3 Config  
passive-interface (OSPFv3)  
Use this command to set the interface or tunnel as passive. It overrides the global passive  
mode that is effective on the interface or tunnel.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
passive-interface {<slot/port> | tunnel <tunnel-id>}  
Router OSPFv3 Config  
IPv6 Commands  
395  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no passive-interface(OSPFv3)  
Use this command to set the interface or tunnel as non-passive. It overrides the global  
passive mode that is effective on the interface or tunnel.  
Format  
Mode  
no passive-interface {<slot/port> | tunnel <tunnel-id>}  
Router OSPFv3 Config  
redistribute (OSPFv3)  
This command configures the OSPFv3 protocol to allow redistribution of routes from the  
specified source protocol/routers.  
Default  
• metric—unspecified  
• type—2  
• tag—0  
Format  
Mode  
redistribute {static | connected} [metric <0-16777214>] [metric-type  
{1 | 2}] [tag <0-4294967295>]  
Router OSPFv3 Config  
no redistribute(OSPFv3)  
This command configures OSPF protocol to prohibit redistribution of routes from the  
specified source protocol/routers.  
Format  
Mode  
no redistribute {static | connected} [metric] [metric-type] [tag]  
Router OSPFv3 Config  
router-id (OSPFv3)  
This command sets a 4-digit dotted-decimal number uniquely identifying the router ospf id.  
The <ipaddress>is a configured value.  
Format  
Mode  
router-id <ipaddress>  
Router OSPFv3 Config  
IPv6 Commands  
396  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
trapflags (OSPFv3)  
Use this command to enable individual OSPF traps, enable a group of trap flags at a time, or  
enable all the trap flags at a time. The different groups of trapflags, and each group’s specific  
trapflags to enable or disable, are listed in Table 2, Trapflag Groups (OSPFv3).  
Table 2. Trapflag Groups (OSPFv3)  
Group  
errors  
Flags  
• authentication-failure  
• bad-packet  
• config-error  
• virt-authentication-failure  
• virt-bad-packet  
• virt-config-error  
if-rx  
lsa  
ir-rx-packet  
• lsa-maxage  
• lsa-originate  
overflow  
• lsdb-overflow  
• lsdb-approaching-overflow  
retransmit  
• packets  
• virt-packets  
rtb  
• rtb-entry-info  
state-change  
• if-state-change  
• neighbor-state-change  
• virtif-state-change  
• virtneighbor-state-change  
To enable the individual flag, enter the group namefollowed by that particular flag.  
To enable all the flags in that group, give the group name followed by all.  
IPv6 Commands  
397  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
To enable all the flags, give the command as trapflags all.  
Default  
Format  
disabled  
trapflags {  
all |  
errors {all | authentication-failure | bad-packet | config-error |  
virt-  
authentication-failure | virt-bad-packet | virt-config-error} |  
if-rx {all | if-rx-packet} |  
lsa {all | lsa-maxage | lsa-originate} |  
overflow {all | lsdb-overflow | lsdb-approaching-overflow} |  
retransmit {all | packets | virt-packets} |  
rtb {all, rtb-entry-info} |  
state-change {all | if-state-change | neighbor-state-change |  
virtif-state-  
change | virtneighbor-state-change}  
}
Mode  
Router OSPFv3 Config  
no trapflags(OSPFv3)  
Use this command to revert to the default reference bandwidth.  
To disable the individual flag, enter the group namefollowed by that particular flag.  
To disable all the flags in that group, give the group name followed by all.  
To disable all the flags, give the command as trapflags all.  
Format  
no trapflags {  
all |  
errors {all | authentication-failure | bad-packet | config-error |  
virt-  
authentication-failure | virt-bad-packet | virt-config-error} |  
if-rx {all | if-rx-packet} |  
lsa {all | lsa-maxage | lsa-originate} |  
overflow {all | lsdb-overflow | lsdb-approaching-overflow} |  
retransmit {all | packets | virt-packets} |  
rtb {all, rtb-entry-info} |  
state-change {all | if-state-change | neighbor-state-change |  
virtif-state-  
change | virtneighbor-state-change}  
}
Mode  
Router OSPFv3 Config  
show ipv6 ospf  
This command displays information relevant to the OSPF router.  
Format  
Mode  
show ipv6 ospf  
Privileged EXEC  
IPv6 Commands  
398  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Note: Some of the information below displays only if you enable OSPF  
and configure certain features.  
Term  
Definition  
Router ID  
A 32-bit integer in dotted decimal format identifying the router, about which information is  
displayed. This is a configured value.  
OSPF Admin  
Mode  
Shows whether the administrative mode of OSPF in the router is enabled or disabled.  
This is a configured value.  
ABR Status  
Shows whether the router is an OSPF Area Border Router.  
ASBR Status  
Reflects whether the ASBR mode is enabled or disabled. Enable implies that the router  
is an autonomous system border router. Router automatically becomes an ASBR when it  
is configured to redistribute routes learnt from other protocol. The possible values for the  
ASBR status are enabled (if the router is configured to redistribute routes learned by  
other protocols) or disabled (if the router is not configured for the same).  
Stub Router  
When OSPF runs out of resources to store the entire link state database, or any other  
state information, OSPF goes into stub router mode. As a stub router, OSPF reoriginates  
its own router LSAs, setting the cost of all nonstub interfaces to infinity. To restore OSPF  
to normal operation, disable and reenable OSPF.  
Exit Overflow  
Interval  
The number of seconds that, after entering overflow state, a router will attempt to leave  
overflow state.  
External LSDB  
Overflow  
When the number of non-default external LSAs exceeds the configured limit, External  
LSDB Limit, OSPF goes into LSDB overflow state. In this state, OSPF withdraws all of its  
self-originated non-default external LSAs. After the Exit Overflow Interval, OSPF leaves  
the overflow state, if the number of external LSAs has been reduced.  
External LSA  
Count  
The number of external (LS type 5) link-state advertisements in the link-state database.  
External LSA  
Checksum  
The sum of the LS checksums of external link-state advertisements contained in the  
link-state database.  
New LSAs  
Originated  
The number of new link-state advertisements that have been originated.  
LSAs Received  
LSA Count  
The number of link-state advertisements received determined to be new instantiations.  
The total number of link state advertisements currently in the link state database.  
The maximum number of LSAs that OSPF can store.  
Maximum  
Number of  
LSAs  
LSA High Water  
Mark  
The maximum size of the link state database since the system started.  
Retransmit List  
Entries  
The total number of LSAs waiting to be acknowledged by all neighbors. An LSA might be  
pending acknowledgment from more than one neighbor.  
IPv6 Commands  
399  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Maximum  
Number of  
Retransmit  
Entries  
The maximum number of LSAs that can be waiting for acknowledgment at any given  
time.  
Retransmit  
Entries High  
Water Mark  
The highest number of LSAs that have been waiting for acknowledgment.  
External LSDB  
Limit  
The maximum number of non-default AS-external-LSAs entries that can be stored in the  
link-state database.  
Default Metric  
Default value for redistributed routes.  
Default Passive  
Setting  
Shows whether the interfaces are passive by default.  
Default Route  
Advertise  
Indicates whether the default routes received from other source protocols are advertised  
or not.  
Always  
Metric  
Shows whether default routes are always advertised.  
The metric for the advertised default routes. If the metric is not configured, this field is  
blank.  
Metric Type  
Shows whether the routes are External Type 1 or External Type 2.  
Number of  
Active Areas  
The number of active OSPF areas. An “active” OSPF area is an area with at least one  
interface up.  
AutoCost Ref  
BW  
Shows the value of the auto-cost reference bandwidth configured on the router.  
The maximum number of paths that OSPF can report for a given destination.  
Maximum Paths  
Redistributing  
This field is a heading and appears only if you configure the system to take routes  
learned from a non-OSPF source and advertise them to its peers.  
Source  
Shows source protocol/routes that are being redistributed. Possible values are static,  
connected, BGP, or RIP.  
Metric  
The metric of the routes being redistributed.  
Metric Type  
Tag  
Shows whether the routes are External Type 1 or External Type 2.  
The decimal value attached to each external route.  
Subnets  
Distribute-List  
For redistributing routes into OSPF, the scope of redistribution for the specified protocol.  
The access list used to filter redistributed routes.  
IPv6 Commands  
400  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show ipv6 ospf abr  
This command displays the internal OSPFv3 routes to reach Area Border Routers (ABR).  
This command takes no options.  
Format  
show ipv6 ospf abr  
Modes  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Type  
Definition  
The type of the route to the destination. It can be either:  
• intra — Intra-area route  
• inter — Inter-area route  
Router ID  
Cost  
Router ID of the destination.  
Cost of using this route.  
Area ID  
The area ID of the area from which this route is learned.  
Next hop toward the destination.  
Next Hop  
Next Hop Intf  
The outgoing router interface to use when forwarding traffic to the next hop.  
show ipv6 ospf area  
This command displays information about the area. The <areaid>identifies the OSPF area  
that is being displayed.  
Format  
Modes  
show ipv6 ospf area <areaid>  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
AreaID  
The area id of the requested OSPF area.  
A number representing the external routing capabilities for this area.  
External  
Routing  
Spf Runs  
The number of times that the intra-area route table has been calculated using this area's  
link-state database.  
Area Border  
Router Count  
The total number of area border routers reachable within this area.  
Area LSA Count  
Total number of link-state advertisements in this area's link-state database, excluding AS  
External LSAs.  
Area LSA  
Checksum  
A number representing the Area LSA Checksum for the specified AreaID excluding the  
external (LS type 5) link-state advertisements.  
IPv6 Commands  
401  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Stub Mode  
Represents whether the specified Area is a stub area or not. The possible values are  
enabled and disabled. This is a configured value.  
Import  
Summary LSAs  
Shows whether to import summary LSAs (enabled).  
OSPF Stub  
Metric Value  
The metric value of the stub area. This field displays only if the area is a configured as a  
stub area.  
The following OSPF NSSA-specific information displays only if the area is configured as an  
NSSA.  
Term  
Definition  
Import  
Summary LSAs  
Shows whether to import summary LSAs into the NSSA.  
Redistribute  
into NSSA  
Shows whether to redistribute information into the NSSA.  
Shows whether to advertise a default route into the NSSA.  
Default  
Information  
Originate  
Default Metric  
The metric value for the default route advertised into the NSSA.  
The metric type for the default route advertised into the NSSA.  
Default Metric  
Type  
Translator Role  
The NSSA translator role of the ABR, which is always or candidate.  
Translator  
Stability Interval  
The amount of time that an elected translator continues to perform its duties after it  
determines that its translator status has been deposed by another router.  
Translator State  
Shows whether the ABR translator state is disabled, always, or elected.  
show ipv6 ospf asbr  
This command displays the internal OSPFv3 routes to reach Autonomous System Boundary  
Routers (ASBR). This command takes no options.  
Format  
Modes  
show ipv6 ospf asbr  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Type  
Definition  
The type of the route to the destination. It can be either:  
• intra — Intra-area route  
• inter — Inter-area route  
Router ID  
Router ID of the destination.  
IPv6 Commands  
402  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Cost  
Definition  
Cost of using this route.  
Area ID  
The area ID of the area from which this route is learned.  
Next hop toward the destination.  
Next Hop  
Next Hop Intf  
The outgoing router interface to use when forwarding traffic to the next hop.  
show ipv6 ospf database  
This command displays information about the link state database when OSPFv3 is enabled.  
If you do not enter any parameters, the command displays the LSA headers for all areas.  
Use the optional <areaid>parameter to display database information about a specific area.  
Use the other optional parameters to specify the type of link state advertisements to display.  
Use externalto display the external LSAs. Use inter-areato display the inter-area  
LSAs. Use link to display the link LSAs. Use networkto display the network LSAs. Use  
nssa-external to display NSSA external LSAs. Use prefixto display intra-area Prefix LSAs.  
Use routerto display router LSAs. Use unknown area, unknown as, or unknown link  
to display unknown area, AS, or link-scope LSAs, respectively. Use <lsid>to specify the  
link state ID (LSID). Use adv-routerto show the LSAs that are restricted by the advertising  
router. Use self-originateto display the LSAs in that are self originated. The information  
below is only displayed if OSPF is enabled.  
Format  
show ipv6 ospf [<areaid>] database [{external | inter-area {prefix |  
router} | link | network | nssa-external | prefix | router | unknown  
{area | as | link}}] [<lsid>] [{adv-router [<rtrid>] |  
self-originate}]  
Modes  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
For each link-type and area, the following information is displayed.  
Term  
Definition  
Link Id  
A number that uniquely identifies an LSA that a router originates from all other self  
originated LSAs of the same LS type.  
Adv Router  
The Advertising Router. Is a 32 bit dotted decimal number representing the LSDB  
interface.  
Age  
A number representing the age of the link state advertisement in seconds.  
A number that represents which LSA is more recent.  
Sequence  
Checksum  
Options  
Rtr Opt  
The total number LSA checksum.  
An integer indicating that the LSA receives special handling during routing calculations.  
Router Options are valid for router links only.  
IPv6 Commands  
403  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show ipv6 ospf database database-summary  
Use this command to display the number of each type of LSA in the database and the total  
number of LSAs in the database.  
Format  
show ipv6 ospf database database-summary  
Modes  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Router  
Total number of router LSAs in the OSPFv3 link state database.  
Total number of network LSAs in the OSPFv3 link state database.  
Network  
Inter-area Prefix  
Total number of inter-area prefix LSAs in the OSPFv3 link state database.  
Total number of inter-area router LSAs in the OSPFv3 link state database.  
Inter-area  
Router  
Type-7 Ext  
Total number of NSSA external LSAs in the OSPFv3 link state database.  
Total number of link LSAs in the OSPFv3 link state database.  
Link  
Intra-area Prefix  
Link Unknown  
Area Unknown  
AS Unknown  
Type-5 Ext  
Total number of intra-area prefix LSAs in the OSPFv3 link state database.  
Total number of link-source unknown LSAs in the OSPFv3 link state database.  
Total number of area unknown LSAs in the OSPFv3 link state database.  
Total number of as unknown LSAs in the OSPFv3 link state database.  
Total number of AS external LSAs in the OSPFv3 link state database.  
Total number of self originated AS external LSAs in the OSPFv3 link state database.  
Self-Originated  
Type-5  
Total  
Total number of router LSAs in the OSPFv3 link state database.  
show ipv6 ospf interface  
This command displays the information for the IFO object or virtual interface tables.  
Format  
Modes  
show ipv6 ospf interface {<slot/port> | loopback <loopback-id> |  
tunnel <tunnel-id>}  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
IPv6 Address  
The IPv6 address of the interface.  
ifIndex  
The interface index number associated with the interface.  
Shows whether the admin mode is enabled or disabled.  
OSPF Admin  
Mode  
IPv6 Commands  
404  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
OSPF Area ID  
The area ID associated with this interface.  
Router Priority  
The router priority. The router priority determines which router is the designated router.  
The frequency, in seconds, at which the interface sends LSA.  
Retransmit  
Interval  
Hello Interval  
Dead Interval  
The frequency, in seconds, at which the interface sends Hello packets.  
The amount of time, in seconds, the interface waits before assuming a neighbor is down.  
LSA Ack  
Interval  
The amount of time, in seconds, the interface waits before sending an LSA  
acknowledgement after receiving an LSA.  
Iftransit Delay  
Interval  
The number of seconds the interface adds to the age of LSA packets before  
transmission.  
Authentication  
Type  
The type of authentication the interface performs on LSAs it receives.  
Metric Cost  
The priority of the path. Low costs have a higher priority than high costs.  
Shows whether the interface is passive or not.  
Passive Status  
OSPF  
MTU-ignore  
Shows whether to ignore MTU mismatches in database descriptor packets sent from  
neighboring routers.  
The following information only displays if OSPF is initialized on the interface:  
Term  
Definition  
OSPF Interface  
Type  
Broadcast LANs, such as Ethernet and IEEE 802.5, take the value broadcast. The OSPF  
Interface Type will be 'broadcast'.  
State  
The OSPF Interface States are: down, loopback, waiting, point-to-point, designated  
router, and backup designated router.  
Designated  
Router  
The router ID representing the designated router.  
Backup  
Designated  
Router  
The router ID representing the backup designated router.  
Number of Link  
Events  
The number of link events.  
Metric Cost  
The cost of the OSPF interface.  
show ipv6 ospf interface brief  
This command displays brief information for the IFO object or virtual interface tables.  
Format  
Modes  
show ipv6 ospf interface brief  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
IPv6 Commands  
405  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Interface  
Valid slot and port number separated by forward slashes.  
Admin Mode  
Area ID  
States whether OSPF is enabled or disabled on a router interface.  
The OSPF Area ID for the specified interface.  
Router Priority  
Hello Interval  
Dead Interval  
The router priority. The router priority determines which router is the designated router.  
The frequency, in seconds, at which the interface sends Hello packets.  
The amount of time, in seconds, the interface waits before assuming a neighbor is down.  
The frequency, in seconds, at which the interface sends LSA.  
Retransmit  
Interval  
Retransmit  
Delay Interval  
The number of seconds the interface adds to the age of LSA packets before  
transmission.  
LSA Ack  
Interval  
The amount of time, in seconds, the interface waits before sending an LSA  
acknowledgement after receiving an LSA.  
show ipv6 ospf interface stats  
This command displays the statistics for a specific interface. The command only displays  
information if OSPF is enabled.  
Format  
Modes  
show ipv6 ospf interface stats <slot/port>  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
OSPFv3 Area ID  
IPv6 Address  
The area id of this OSPF interface.  
The IP address associated with this OSPF interface.  
OSPFv3  
Interface Events  
The number of times the specified OSPF interface has changed its state, or an error has  
occurred.  
Virtual Events  
The number of state changes or errors that occurred on this virtual link.  
Neighbor  
Events  
The number of times this neighbor relationship has changed state, or an error has  
occurred.  
Packets  
Received  
The number of OSPFv3 packets received on the interface.  
The number of OSPFv3 packets sent on the interface.  
The total number of LSAs flooded on the interface.  
Packets  
Transmitted  
LSAs Sent  
IPv6 Commands  
406  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
LSA Acks  
Received  
The total number of LSA acknowledged from this interface.  
LSA Acks Sent  
Sent Packets  
The total number of LSAs acknowledged to this interface.  
The number of OSPF packets transmitted on the interface.  
The number of valid OSPF packets received on the interface.  
Received  
Packets  
Discards  
The number of received OSPF packets discarded because of an error in the packet or an  
error in processing the packet.  
Bad Version  
The number of received OSPF packets whose version field in the OSPF header does not  
match the version of the OSPF process handling the packet.  
Virtual Link Not  
Found  
The number of received OSPF packets discarded where the ingress interface is in a  
non-backbone area and the OSPF header identifies the packet as belonging to the  
backbone, but OSPF does not have a virtual link to the packet’s sender.  
Area Mismatch  
The number of OSPF packets discarded because the area ID in the OSPF header is not  
the area ID configured on the ingress interface.  
Invalid  
Destination  
Address  
The number of OSPF packets discarded because the packet’s destination IP address is  
not the address of the ingress interface and is not the AllDrRouters or AllSpfRouters  
multicast addresses.  
No Neighbor at  
Source Address  
The number of OSPF packets dropped because the sender is not an existing neighbor or  
the sender’s IP address does not match the previously recorded IP address for that  
neighbor. NOTE: Does not apply to Hellos.  
Invalid OSPF  
Packet Type  
The number of OSPF packets discarded because the packet type field in the OSPF  
header is not a known type.  
Hellos Ignored  
The number of received Hello packets that were ignored by this router from the new  
neighbors after the limit has been reached for the number of neighbors on an interface or  
on the system as a whole.  
See show ip ospf interface stats on page 297 for a sample output of the number of OSPF  
packets of each type sent and received on the interface.  
show ipv6 ospf neighbor  
This command displays information about OSPF neighbors. If you do not specify a neighbor  
IP address, the output displays summary information in a table. If you specify an interface or  
tunnel, only the information for that interface or tunnel displays. The <ip-address>is the IP  
address of the neighbor, and when you specify this, detailed information about the neighbor  
displays. The information below only displays if OSPF is enabled and the interface has a  
neighbor.  
Format  
Modes  
show ipv6 ospf neighbor [interface {<slot/port> | tunnel  
<tunnel_id>}][<ip-address>]  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
IPv6 Commands  
407  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
If you do not specify an IP address, a table with the following columns displays for all  
neighbors or the neighbor associated with the interface that you specify:  
Term  
Definition  
Router ID  
Priority  
The 4-digit dotted-decimal number of the neighbor router.  
The OSPF priority for the specified interface. The priority of an interface is a priority  
integer from 0 to 255. A value of '0' indicates that the router is not eligible to become the  
designated router on this network.  
Intf ID  
The interface ID of the neighbor.  
Interface  
State  
The interface of the local router in slot/port format.  
The state of the neighboring routers. The possible values are:  
• Down- initial state of the neighbor conversation - no recent information has been  
received from the neighbor.  
• Attempt - no recent information has been received from the neighbor but a more  
concerted effort should be made to contact the neighbor.  
• Init - an Hello packet has recently been seen from the neighbor, but bidirectional  
communication has not yet been established.  
• 2 way - communication between the two routers is bidirectional.  
• Exchange start - the first step in creating an adjacency between the two neighboring  
routers, the goal is to decide which router is the master and to decide upon the initial  
DD sequence number.  
• Exchange - the router is describing its entire link state database by sending Database  
Description packets to the neighbor.  
• Full - the neighboring routers are fully adjacent and they will now appear in  
router-LSAs and network-LSAs.  
Dead Time  
The amount of time, in seconds, to wait before the router assumes that the neighbor is  
unreachable.  
If you specify an IP address for the neighbor router, the following fields display:  
Term  
Definition  
Interface  
Area ID  
Options  
The interface of the local router in slot/port format.  
The area ID associated with the interface.  
An integer value that indicates the optional OSPF capabilities supported by the neighbor.  
These are listed in its Hello packets. This enables received Hello Packets to be rejected  
(that is, neighbor relationships will not even start to form) if there is a mismatch in certain  
crucial OSPF capabilities.  
Router Priority  
Dead Timer Due  
The router priority for the specified interface.  
The amount of time, in seconds, to wait before the router assumes that the neighbor is  
unreachable.  
State  
The state of the neighboring routers.  
IPv6 Commands  
408  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Events  
Number of times this neighbor relationship has changed state, or an error has occurred.  
Retransmission  
Queue Length  
An integer representing the current length of the retransmission queue of the specified  
neighbor router Id of the specified interface.  
show ipv6 ospf range  
This command displays information about the area ranges for the specified <areaid>. The  
<areaid>identifies the OSPF area whose ranges are being displayed.  
Format  
Modes  
show ipv6 ospf range <areaid>  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Area ID  
The area id of the requested OSPF area.  
An IP address which represents this area range.  
The type of link advertisement associated with this area range.  
The status of the advertisement: enabled or disabled.  
IP Address  
Lsdb Type  
Advertisement  
show ipv6 ospf stub table  
This command displays the OSPF stub table. The information below will only be displayed if  
OSPF is initialized on the switch.  
Format  
Modes  
show ipv6 ospf stub table  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Area ID  
A 32-bit identifier for the created stub area.  
Type of Service  
Type of Service associated with the stub metric. For this release, Normal TOS is the only  
supported type.  
Metric Val  
The metric value is applied based on the TOS. It defaults to the least metric of the Type  
of Service among the interfaces to other areas. The OSPF cost for a route is a function of  
the metric value.  
Import  
Summary LSA  
Controls the import of summary LSAs into stub areas.  
IPv6 Commands  
409  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show ipv6 ospf virtual-link  
This command displays the OSPF Virtual Interface information for a specific area and  
neighbor. The <areaid>parameter identifies the area and the <neighbor>parameter  
identifies the neighbor’s Router ID.  
Format  
show ipv6 ospf virtual-link <areaid> <neighbor>  
Modes  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Area ID  
The area id of the requested OSPF area.  
The input neighbor Router ID.  
Neighbor  
Router ID  
Hello Interval  
Dead Interval  
The configured hello interval for the OSPF virtual interface.  
The configured dead interval for the OSPF virtual interface.  
The configured transit delay for the OSPF virtual interface.  
Iftransit Delay  
Interval  
Retransmit  
Interval  
The configured retransmit interval for the OSPF virtual interface.  
The type of authentication the interface performs on LSAs it receives.  
Authentication  
Type  
State  
The OSPF Interface States are: down, loopback, waiting, point-to-point, designated  
router, and backup designated router. This is the state of the OSPF interface.  
Neighbor State  
The neighbor state.  
show ipv6 ospf virtual-link brief  
This command displays the OSPFV3 Virtual Interface information for all areas in the system.  
Format  
Modes  
show ipv6 ospf virtual-link brief  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Area ID  
The area id of the requested OSPFV3 area.  
The neighbor interface of the OSPFV3 virtual interface.  
The configured hello interval for the OSPFV3 virtual interface.  
The configured dead interval for the OSPFV3 virtual interface.  
Neighbor  
Hello Interval  
Dead Interval  
IPv6 Commands  
410  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Retransmit  
Interval  
The configured retransmit interval for the OSPFV3 virtual interface.  
The configured transit delay for the OSPFV3 virtual interface.  
Transit Delay  
OSPFv3 Graceful Restart Commands  
The managed switch implementation of OSPFv3 supports graceful restart as specified in  
RFC 5187 and RFC 3623. Graceful restart works together with managed switch non-stop  
forwarding (nsf) to enable the hardware to continue forwarding IPv6 packets using OSPFv3  
routes while a backup unit takes over management unit responsibility. When OSPF executes  
a graceful restart, it informs its neighbors that the OSPF control plane is restarting but will be  
back shortly. Helpful neighbors continue to advertise to the network that they have full  
adjacencies with the restarting router, avoiding announcement of a topology change, and  
related events (for example, flooding of LSAs and SPF runs). Helpful neighbors continue to  
forward packets through the restarting router. The restarting router relearns the network  
topology from its helpful neighbors.  
Graceful restart implements both the restarting router and helpful neighbor features  
described in RFC 3623.  
nsf (OSPFv3)  
This command enables OSPF graceful restart. The ietfparameter is used to distinguish the  
IETF standard implementation of graceful restart from other implementations. Since the IETF  
implementation is not the only one supported, this parameter is optional. The planned-only  
parameter indicates that OSPF performs a graceful restart only when the restart is planned  
(that is, when the restart results from the initiate failovercommand).  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
nsf [ ietf ] [ planned-only ]  
OSPFv3 Router Configuration mode  
no nsf [ietf] (OSPFv3)  
This command disables OSPF graceful restart.  
Format  
Mode  
no nsf [ ietf ]  
OSPFv3 Router Configuration mode  
nsf helper (OSPFv3)  
This command allows OSPF to act as a helpful neighbor for a restarting router. The  
planned-onlyparameter indicates that OSPF should only help a restarting router  
performing a planned restart.  
IPv6 Commands  
411  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
The grace LSA announcing the graceful restart includes the reason for the restart. Reasons 1  
(software restart) and 2 (software reload/upgrade) are considered planned restarts. Reasons  
0 (unknown) and 3 (switch to redundant control processor) are considered unplanned  
restarts.  
Default  
OSPF acts as a helpful neighbor for both planned and unplanned restarts  
Format  
Mode  
nsf helper [ planned-only ]  
OSPFv3 Router Configuration mode  
nsf ietf helper disable (OSPFv3)  
This command is functionally equivalent to no nsf helperand is supported solely for IS-CLI  
compatibility.  
Format  
Mode  
nsf ietf helper disable  
OSPFv3 Router Configuration mode  
no nsf helper (OSPFv3)  
This command prevents OSPF from acting as a helpful neighbor.  
Format  
Mode  
no nsf helper  
OSPFv3 Router Configuration mode  
nsf helper strict-lsa-checking (OSPFv3)  
This command requires that an OSPF helpful neighbor exit helper mode when a topology  
change occurs. The restarting router is unable to react to topology changes. In particular, the  
restarting router will not immediately update its forwarding table. Therefore, a topology  
change might introduce forwarding loops or black holes that persist until the graceful restart  
is completed. By exiting graceful restart when a topology change occurs, a router tries to  
eliminate the loops or black holes as quickly as possible by routing around the restarting  
router.  
The ietfparameter is used to distinguish the IETF standard implementation of graceful  
restart from other implementations. Since the IETF implementation is not the only one  
supported, this parameter is optional.  
A helpful neighbor considers a link down with the restarting router to be a topology change,  
regardless of the strict LSA checking configuration.  
Default  
A helpful neighbor exits helper mode when a topology change occurs.  
Format  
Mode  
nsf [ietf] helper strict-lsa-checking  
OSPFv3 Router Configuration mode  
IPv6 Commands  
412  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no nsf [ietf] helper strict-lsa-checking (OSPFv3)  
This command allows OSPF to continue as a helpful neighbor in spite of topology changes.  
nsf restart-interval (OSPFv3)  
This command configures the length of the grace period on the restarting router. The grace  
period must be set long enough to allow the restarting router to reestablish all of its  
adjacencies and complete a full database exchange with each of its neighbors.  
The ietfparameter is used to distinguish the IETF standard implementation of graceful  
restart from other implementations. Since the IETF implementation is not the only one  
supported, this parameter is optional. The secondsparameter represents the number of  
seconds that the restarting router asks its neighbors to wait before exiting helper mode. The  
restarting router includes the restart interval in its grace LSAs (range 1–1800 seconds).  
Default  
120s  
Format  
Mode  
nsf [ietf] restart-interval seconds  
OSPFv3 Router Configuration mode  
no [ietf] nsf restart-interval (OSPFv3)  
This command reverts the grace period to its default.  
DHCPv6 Commands  
This section describes the command you use to configure the DHCPv6 server on the system  
and to view DHCPv6 information.  
service dhcpv6  
This command enables DHCPv6 configuration on the router.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
service dhcpv6  
Global Config  
no service dhcpv6  
This command disables DHCPv6 configuration on router.  
Format  
Mode  
no service dhcpv6  
Global Config  
IPv6 Commands  
413  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
ipv6 dhcp server  
Use this command to configure DHCPv6 server functionality on an interface. The  
<pool-name>is the DHCPv6 pool containing stateless and/or prefix delegation parameters,  
rapid-commitis an option that allows for an abbreviated exchange between the client and  
server, and <pref-value>is a value used by clients to determine preference between  
multiple DHCPv6 servers. For a particular interface DHCPv6 server and DHCPv6 relay  
functions are mutually exclusive.  
Format  
Mode  
ipv6 dhcp server <pool-name> [rapid-commit] [preference <pref-value>]  
Interface Config  
ipv6 dhcp relay destination  
Use this command to configure an interface for DHCPv6 relay functionality. Use the  
destinationkeyword to set the relay server IPv6 address. The <relay-address>  
parameter is an IPv6 address of a DHCPv6 relay server. Use the interfacekeyword to set  
the relay server interface. The <relay-interface>parameter is an interface (slot/port) to  
reach a relay server. The optional remote-idis the Relay Agent Information Option “remote  
ID” sub-option to be added to relayed messages. This can either be the special keyword  
duid-ifid, which causes the “remote ID” to be derived from the DHCPv6 server DUID and  
the relay interface number, or it can be specified as a user-defined string.  
Note: If <relay-address> is an IPv6 global address, <relay-interface> is not  
required. If <relay-address> is a link-local or multicast address,  
<relay-interface> is required. Finally, if you do not specify a value for  
<relay-address>, you must specify a value for <relay-interface> and  
the DHCPV6-ALL-AGENTS multicast address (that is, FF02::1:2)  
is used to relay DHCPv6 messages to the relay server.  
Format  
Mode  
ipv6 dhcp relay {destination [<relay-address>] interface  
[<relay-interface>]| interface [<relay-interface>]} [remote-id  
(duid-ifid | <user-defined-string>)]  
Interface Config  
ipv6 dhcp pool  
Use this command from Global Config mode to enter IPv6 DHCP Pool Config mode. Use the  
exitcommand to return to Global Config mode. To return to the User EXEC mode, enter  
CTRL+Z. The <pool-name>should be less than 31 alpha-numeric characters. DHCPv6  
pools are used to specify information for DHCPv6 server to distribute to DHCPv6 clients.  
IPv6 Commands  
414  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
These pools are shared between multiple interfaces over which DHCPv6 server capabilities  
are configured.  
Format  
Mode  
ipv6 dhcp pool <pool-name>  
Global Config  
no ipv6 dhcp pool  
This command removes the specified DHCPv6 pool.  
Format  
Mode  
no ipv6 dhcp pool <pool-name>  
Global Config  
domain-name (IPv6)  
This command sets the DNS domain name provided to the DHCPv6 client by the DHCPv6  
server. The DNS domain name is configured for stateless server support and consists of no  
more than 31 alpha-numeric characters. The DHCPv6 pool can have up to eight domain  
names.  
Format  
Mode  
domain-name <dns-domain-name>  
IPv6 DHCP Pool Config  
no domain-name  
This command removes the DHCPv6 domain name from the DHCPv6 pool.  
Format  
Mode  
no domain-name <dns-domain-name>  
IPv6 DHCP Pool Config  
dns-server (IPv6)  
This command sets the ipv6 DNS server address, which is provided to dhcpv6 client by  
dhcpv6 server. DNS server address is configured for stateless server support. DHCPv6 pool  
can have multiple number of domain names with maximum of 8.  
Format  
Mode  
dns-server <dns-server-address>  
IPv6 DHCP Pool Config  
no dns-server  
This command will remove DHCPv6 server address from DHCPv6 server.  
Format  
Mode  
no dns-server <dns-server-address>  
IPv6 DHCP Pool Config  
IPv6 Commands  
415  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
prefix-delegation (IPv6)  
Multiple IPv6 prefixes can be defined within a pool for distributing to specific DHCPv6 Prefix  
delegation clients. Prefix is the delegated IPv6 prefix. DUID is the client’s unique DUID value  
(Example: 00:01:00:09:f8:79:4e:00:04:76:73:43:76'). Name is 31 characters textual client’s  
name, which is useful for logging or tracing only. Valid lifetime is the valid lifetime for the  
delegated prefix in seconds and preferred lifetime is the preferred lifetime for the delegated  
prefix in seconds.  
Default  
• valid-lifetime—2592000  
• preferred-lifetime—604800  
Format  
Mode  
prefix-delegation<prefix/prefixlength> <DUID> [name <hostname>]  
[valid-lifetime <0-4294967295>][preferred-lifetime < 0-4294967295>]  
IPv6 DHCP Pool Config  
no prefix-delegation  
This command deletes a specific prefix-delegation client.  
Format  
Mode  
no prefix-delegation<prefix/prefix-delegation> <DUID>  
IPv6 DHCP Pool Config  
show ipv6 dhcp  
This command displays the DHCPv6 server name and status.  
Format  
Mode  
show ipv6 dhcp  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
DHCPv6 is  
Enabled  
The status of the DHCPv6 server.  
(Disabled)  
Server DUID  
If configured, shows the DHCPv6 unique identifier.  
show ipv6 dhcp statistics  
This command displays the IPv6 DHCP statistics for all interfaces.  
Format  
Mode  
show ipv6 dhcp statistics  
Privileged EXEC  
IPv6 Commands  
416  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
DHCPv6 Solicit Packets  
Received  
Number of solicit received statistics.  
DHCPv6 Request Packets  
Received  
Number of request received statistics.  
Number of confirm received statistics.  
Number of renew received statistics.  
Number of rebind received statistics.  
Number of release received statistics.  
Number of decline received statistics.  
Number of inform received statistics.  
Number of relay forward received statistics.  
Number of relay-reply received statistics.  
Number of malformed packets statistics.  
Number of DHCP discarded statistics.  
Total number of DHCPv6 received statistics  
Number of advertise sent statistics.  
Number of reply sent statistics.  
DHCPv6 Confirm Packets  
Received  
DHCPv6 Renew Packets  
Received  
DHCPv6 Rebind Packets  
Received  
DHCPv6 Release Packets  
Received  
DHCPv6 Decline Packets  
Received  
DHCPv6 Inform Packets  
Received  
DHCPv6 Relay-forward  
Packets Received  
DHCPv6Relay-replyPackets  
Received  
DHCPv6 Malformed Packets  
Received  
Received DHCPv6 Packets  
Discarded  
Total DHCPv6 Packets  
Received  
DHCPv6 Advertisement  
Packets Transmitted  
DHCPv6 Reply Packets  
Transmitted  
DHCPv6 Reconfig Packets  
Transmitted  
Number of reconfigure sent statistics.  
Number of relay-reply sent statistics.  
Number of relay-forward sent statistics.  
Total number of DHCPv6 sent statistics.  
DHCPv6Relay-replyPackets  
Transmitted  
DHCPv6 Relay-forward  
Packets Transmitted  
Total DHCPv6 Packets  
Transmitted  
IPv6 Commands  
417  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show ipv6 dhcp interface  
This command displays DHCPv6 information for all relevant interfaces or the specified  
interface. If you specify an interface, you can use the optional statisticsparameter to  
view statistics for the specified interface.  
Format  
show ipv6 dhcp interface <slot/port> [statistics]  
Mode  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
IPv6 Interface  
The interface name in <slot/port> format.  
Shows whether the interface is a IPv6 DHCP relay or server.  
Mode  
If the interface mode is server, the following information displays.  
Term  
Definition  
Pool Name  
The pool name specifying information for DHCPv6 server distribution to DHCPv6 clients.  
The preference of the server.  
Server  
Preference  
Option Flags  
Shows whether rapid commit is enabled.  
If the interface mode is relay, the following information displays.  
Term  
Definition  
Relay Address  
The IPv6 address of the relay server.  
The relay server interface in <slot/port> format.  
Relay Interface  
Number  
Relay Remote  
ID  
If configured, shows the name of the relay remote.  
Shows whether rapid commit is configured.  
Option Flags  
If you use the statistics parameter, the command displays the IPv6 DHCP statistics for the  
specified interface. See show ipv6 dhcp statistics on page 416 for information about the  
output.  
clear ipv6 dhcp  
Use this command to clear DHCPv6 statistics for all interfaces or for a specific interface. Use  
the <slot/port>parameter to specify the interface.  
Format  
Mode  
clear ipv6 dhcp {statistics | interface <slot/port> statistics}  
Privileged EXEC  
IPv6 Commands  
418  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show ipv6 dhcp pool  
This command displays configured DHCP pool.  
Format  
show ipv6 dhcp pool<pool-name>  
Mode  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
DHCP Pool  
Name  
Unique pool name configuration.  
Client DUID  
Client’s DHCP unique identifier. DUID is generated using the combination of the local  
system burned-in MAC address and a timestamp value.  
Host  
Name of the client.  
Prefix/Prefix  
Length  
IPv6 address and mask length for delegated prefix.  
Preferred  
Lifetime  
Preferred lifetime in seconds for delegated prefix.  
Valid Lifetime  
Valid lifetime in seconds for delegated prefix.  
Address of DNS server address.  
DNS Server  
Address  
Domain Name  
DNS domain name.  
show ipv6 dhcp binding  
This command displays configured DHCP pool.  
Format  
Mode  
show ipv6 dhcp binding[<ipv6-address>]  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
DHCP Client  
Address  
Address of DHCP Client.  
DUID  
IAID  
String that represents the Client DUID.  
Identity Association ID.  
Prefix/Prefix  
Length  
IPv6 address and mask length for delegated prefix.  
Prefix Type  
IPV6 Prefix type (IAPD, IANA, or IATA).  
Address of DHCP Client.  
Client Address  
Client Interface  
Expiration  
IPv6 Address of DHCP Client.  
Address of DNS server address.  
IPv6 Commands  
419  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Valid Lifetime  
Valid lifetime in seconds for delegated prefix.  
Preferred  
Lifetime  
Preferred lifetime in seconds for delegated prefix.  
IPv6 Commands  
420  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7.  
IPv6 Multicast Commands  
7
This chapter describes the IPv6 multicast commands available in the managed switch CLI.  
Note: Some commands described in this chapter require a license. For  
more information, see Licensing and Command Support on page 8.  
This chapter contains the following sections:  
The commands in this chapter are in three functional groups:  
Show commands display switch settings, statistics, and other information.  
Configuration commands configure features and options of the switch. Every switch  
command has a show command that displays the configuration setting.  
Clear commands clear some or all of the settings to factory defaults.  
Note: There is no specific IP multicast enable for IPv6. Enabling of  
multicast at global config is common for both IPv4 and IPv6.  
421  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
IPv6 Multicast Forwarder Commands  
Note: There is no specific IP multicast enable for IPv6. Enabling of  
multicast at global config is common for both IPv4 and IPv6.  
show ipv6 mroute  
Use this command to show the mroute entries specific for IPv6. (This command is the IPv6  
equivalent of the IPv4 show ip mcaste mroutecommand.)  
Format  
Modes  
show ipv6 mroute {detail | summary}  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
If you use the detail parameter, the command displays the following Multicast Route Table  
fields:  
Term  
Definition  
Source IP  
Group IP  
Expiry Time  
Up Time  
The IP address of the multicast data source.  
The IP address of the destination of the multicast packet.  
The time of expiry of this entry in seconds.  
The time elapsed since the entry was created in seconds.  
The IP address of the RPF neighbor.  
RPF Neighbor  
Flags  
The flags associated with this entry.  
If you use the summaryparameter, the command displays the following fields:  
Term  
Definition  
Source IP  
Group IP  
Protocol  
The IP address of the multicast data source.  
The IP address of the destination of the multicast packet.  
The multicast routing protocol by which the entry was created.  
The interface on which the packet for the source/group arrives.  
Incoming  
Interface  
Outgoing  
Interface List  
The list of outgoing interfaces on which the packet is forwarded.  
IPv6 Multicast Commands  
422  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show ipv6 mroute group  
This command displays the multicast configuration settings specific to IPv6 such as flags,  
timer settings, incoming and outgoing interfaces, RPF neighboring routers, and expiration  
times of all the entries in the multicast mroute table containing the given group IPv6 address  
<group-address>.  
Format  
show ipv6 mroute group <group-address> {detail | summary}  
Modes  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Source IP  
The IP address of the multicast data source.  
The IP address of the destination of the multicast packet.  
The multicast routing protocol by which this entry was created.  
The interface on which the packet for this group arrives.  
Group IP  
Protocol  
Incoming  
Interface  
Outgoing  
Interface List  
The list of outgoing interfaces on which this packet is forwarded.  
show ipv6 mroute source  
This command displays the multicast configuration settings specific to IPv6 such as flags,  
timer settings, incoming and outgoing interfaces, RPF neighboring routers, and expiration  
times of all the entries in the multicast mroute table containing the given source IP address or  
source IP address and group IP address pair.  
Format  
Modes  
show ipv6 mroute source <source-address> {detail | summary}  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
If you use the detail parameter, the command displays the following column headings in  
the output table:  
Term  
Definition  
Source IP  
Group IP  
Expiry Time  
Up Time  
The IP address of the multicast data source.  
The IP address of the destination of the multicast packet.  
The time of expiry of this entry in seconds.  
The time elapsed since the entry was created in seconds.  
The IP address of the RPF neighbor.  
RPF Neighbor  
Flags  
The flags associated with this entry.  
IPv6 Multicast Commands  
423  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
If you use the summaryparameter, the command displays the following column headings in  
the output table:  
Term  
Definition  
Source IP  
Group IP  
Protocol  
The IP address of the multicast data source.  
The IP address of the destination of the multicast packet.  
The multicast routing protocol by which this entry was created.  
The interface on which the packet for this source arrives.  
Incoming  
Interface  
Outgoing  
Interface List  
The list of outgoing interfaces on which this packet is forwarded.  
IPv6 PIM Commands  
This section describes the Protocol Independent Multicast (PIM) commands that support the  
PIM version of IPv6.  
ipv6 pim dense(Global Config)  
Use this command to administratively enable PIM-DM Multicast Routing Mode across the  
router (Global Config).  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
ipv6 pim dense  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
no ipv6 pim dense (Global Config)  
Use this command to administratively disable PIM-DM Multicast Routing Mode either across  
the router (Global Config) or on a particular router (Interface Config).  
Format  
Mode  
no ipv6 pim dense  
Global Config  
ipv6 pim (Interface Config)  
Use this command to set the administrative mode of PIM on an interface to enabled.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
ipv6 pim  
Interface Config  
IPv6 Multicast Commands  
424  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no ipv6 pim (Interface Config)  
Use this command to set the administrative mode of PIM on an interface to disabled.  
Format  
Mode  
no ipv6 pim  
Interface Config  
ipv6 pim hello-interval  
Use this command to configure the PIM hello interval for the specified router interface. The  
hello-interval is specified in seconds and is in the range 10–18000.  
Default  
30  
Format  
Mode  
ipv6 pim hello-interval <10-18000>  
Interface Config  
no ipv6 pim hello-interval  
Use this command to set the PIM hello interval to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no ipv6 pim hello-interval  
Interface Config  
show ipv6 pim  
Use this command to display PIM Global Configuration parameters and PIM interface status.  
Format  
Mode  
show ipv6 pim  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
PIM Mode  
Configured mode of PIM protocol  
Data Threshold Rate  
Register Rate-limit  
Interface  
Rate (in kbps) of SPT Threshold  
Rate (in kbps) of Register Threshold  
Valid unit, slot, and port number separated by forward slashes  
Indicates whether PIM-DM is enabled or disabled on this interface  
Interface-Mode  
Operational-Status  
The current state of PIM-DM on this interface. Possible values are Operational or  
Non-Operational.  
Example: The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(Switch) #show ipv6 pim  
IPv6 Multicast Commands  
425  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
PIM Mode..................................... Dense  
Data Threshold Rate (Kbps)................... 0  
Register Rate-limit (Kbps)................... 0  
Interface Interface Mode Operational-Status  
--------- -------------- ----------------  
0/1  
Enabled  
Non-Operational  
show ipv6 pim neighbor  
Use this command to display the PIM neighbor information for all interfaces or for the  
specified interface.  
Format  
show ipv6 pim neighbor [<slot/port>|vlan]  
Modes  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Interface  
Valid slot and port number separated by forward slashes.  
The IP address of the neighbor on an interface.  
Neighbor  
Address  
Up Time  
The time since this neighbor has become active on this interface.  
The expiry time of the neighbor on this interface.  
Expiry Time  
DR Priority  
DR Priority configured on this interface (PM-SM only).  
Example: The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(Switch) #show ipv6 pim neighbor 0/1  
Interface Neighbor  
Address  
Up Time  
(hh:mm:ss)  
Expiry Time  
(hh:mm:ss)  
show ipv6 pim interface  
Use this command to display PIM configuration information for all interfaces or for the  
specified interface. If no interface is specified, configuration of all interfaces is displayed.  
Format  
show ipv6 pim interface [<slot/port>|vlan]  
Modes  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Mode  
Active PIM protocol.  
Interface number.  
Interface  
IPv6 Multicast Commands  
426  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Hello Interval  
Hello interval value. The frequency at which PIM hello messages are transmitted on  
this interface. By default, the value is 30 seconds.  
Join-prune Interval  
DR Priority  
Join-prune interval value.  
DR priority configured on this interface. This is not applicable if the interface mode is  
Dense.  
BSR Border  
Indicates whether the interface is configured as a BSR border.  
Neighbor Count  
Number of PIM neighbors discovered on the interface. This field is displayed only  
when the interface is operational.  
Designated-Router  
IP address of the elected DR on the interface. This field is displayed only when the  
interface is operational.  
(Switch) #show ipv6 pim interface 0/1  
Interface...................................... 0/1  
Mode........................................... Dense  
Hello Interval (secs).......................... 30  
Join Prune Interval (secs)..................... 60  
DR Priority.................................... 1  
BSR Border..................................... Disabled  
ipv6 pim bsr-border  
Use this command to prevent bootstrap router (BSR) messages from being sent or received  
through an interface.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
ipv6 pim bsr-border  
Interface Config  
no ipv6 pim bsr-border  
Use this command to disable the interface from being the BSR border.  
Format  
Mode  
no ipv6 pim bsr-border  
Interface Config  
ipv6 pim bsr-candidate  
Use this command to configure the router to announce its candidacy as a bootstrap router  
(BSR).  
Default  
None  
IPv6 Multicast Commands  
427  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Format  
Mode  
ipv6 pim bsr-candidate interface [<slot/port> | vlan <1-4093>]  
[hash-mask-length] [priority] [interval interval]  
Global Config  
Parameters  
Description  
hash-mask-length  
Length of a mask (32 bits maximum) that is to be ANDed with the group address before  
the hash function is called. All groups with the same seed hash correspond to the same  
RP. For example, if this value was 24, only the first 24 bits of the group addresses  
matter. This allows you to get one RP for multiple groups.  
priority  
interval  
Priority of the candidate BSR. The range is an integer from 0 to 255. The BSR with the  
larger priority is preferred. If the priority values are the same, the router with the larger  
IP address is the BSR. The default value is 0.  
(Optional) Indicates the BSR candidate advertisement interval. The range is from 1 to  
16,383 seconds. The default value is 60 seconds.  
no ipv6 pim bsr-candidate  
Use this command to disable the router to announce its candidacy as a bootstrap router  
(BSR).  
Format  
Mode  
no ipv6 pim bsr-candidate interface [<slot/port> | vlan <1-4093>]  
[hash-mask-length] [priority]  
Global Config  
ipv6 pim dr-priority  
Use this command to set the priority value for which a router is elected as the designated  
router (DR).  
Default  
1
Format  
Mode  
ipv6 pim dr-priority <0-2147483647>  
Interface Config  
no ipv6 pim dr-priority  
Use this command to disable the interface from being the BSR border.  
Format  
Mode  
no ipv6 pim dr-priority  
Interface Config  
IPv6 Multicast Commands  
428  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
ipv6 pim join-prune-interval  
Use this command to configure the interface join/prune interval for the PIM-SM router. The  
join/prune interval is specified in seconds. This parameter can be configured to a value from  
0 to 18000.  
Default  
60  
Format  
Mode  
ipv6 pim join-prune-interval <0-18000>  
Interface Config  
no ipv6 pim join-prune-interval  
Use this command to set the join/prune interval to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no ipv6 pim join-prune-interval  
Interface Config  
ipv6 pim rp-address  
Use this command to statically configure the RP address for one or more multicast groups.  
The parameter <rp-address>is the IP address of the RP. The parameter  
<groupaddress>is the group address supported by the RP. The parameter <groupmask>  
is the group mask for the group address. The optional keyword overrideindicates that if  
there is a conflict, the RP configured with this command prevails over the RP learned by  
BSR.  
Default  
0
Format  
Mode  
ipv6 pim rp-address <rp-address> <group-address> <group-mask>  
[override]  
Global Config  
no ipv6 pim rp-address  
Use this command to statically remove the RP address for one or more multicast groups.  
Format  
Mode  
no ipv6 pim rp-address <rp-address> <group-address> <group-mask>  
Global Config  
ipv6 pim rp-candidate  
Use this command to configure the router to advertise itself as a PIM candidate rendezvous  
point (RP) to the bootstrap router (BSR).  
Default  
None  
IPv6 Multicast Commands  
429  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Format  
Mode  
ipv6 pim rp-candidate interface <slot/port> <group-address>  
<group-mask>  
Global Config  
no ipv6 pim rp-candidate  
Use this command to disable the router to advertise itself as a PIM candidate rendezvous  
point (RP) to the bootstrap router (BSR).  
Format  
Mode  
no ipv6 pim rp-candidate interface <slot/port> <group-address>  
<group-mask>  
Global Config  
ipv6 pim ssm  
Use this command to define the Source Specific Multicast (SSM) range of IP multicast  
addresses.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
ipv6 pim ssm {default | <group-address/prefixlength> <group-mask>}  
Global Config  
Parameter  
default  
Description  
Defines the SSM range access list to 232/8.  
no ipv6 pim ssm  
Use this command to disable the Source Specific Multicast (SSM) range.  
Format  
Mode  
no ipv6 pim ssm  
Global Config  
show ipv6 pim bsr-router  
Use command to display the bootstrap router (BSR) information. The output includes elected  
BSR information and information about the locally configured candidate rendezvous point  
(RP) advertisement.  
Format  
Mode  
show ipv6 pim bsr-router [candidate | elected]  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
IPv6 Multicast Commands  
430  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
BSR Address  
IP address of the BSR.  
Uptime  
Length of time that this router has been up (in hours, minutes, and seconds).  
Priority as configured in the ip pim bsr-candidatecommand.  
BSR Priority  
Hash Mask  
Length  
Length of a mask (maximum 32 bits) that is to be ANDed with the group address  
before the hash function is called. This value is configured in the ip pim  
bsr-candidatecommand.  
Next Bootstrap  
Message In  
Time (in hours, minutes, and seconds) in which the next bootstrap message is due  
from this BSR.  
Next Candidate  
RP advertisement  
in  
Time (in hours, minutes, and seconds) in which the next candidate RP advertisement  
will be sent.  
show ipv6 pim rp-hash  
Use this command to display which rendezvous point (RP) is being used for a specified  
group.  
Format  
Modes  
show ipv6 pim rp-hash <group-address>  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
RP  
Definition  
The IP address of the RP for the group specified.  
Indicates the mechanism (BSR or static) by which the RP was selected.  
Origin  
show ipv6 pim rp mapping  
Use this command to display all group-to-RP mappings of which the router is aware (either  
configured or learned from the bootstrap router (BSR)). If no RP is specified, all active RPs  
are displayed.  
Format  
Modes  
show ipv6 pim rp mapping [rp address]  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
IPv6 MLD Commands  
IGMP/MLD Snooping is Layer 2 functionality but IGMP/MLD are Layer 3 multicast protocols.  
It requires that in a network setup there should be a multicast router (which can act as a  
querier) to be present to solicit the multicast group registrations. However some network  
setup does not need a multicast router as multicast traffic is destined to hosts within the same  
IPv6 Multicast Commands  
431  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
network. In this situation, the 7000 series has an IGMP/MLD Snooping Querier running on  
one of the switches and Snooping enabled on all the switches. For more information, see  
IGMP Snooping Configuration Commands on page 146 and MLD Snooping Commands on  
page 158.  
ipv6 mld router  
Use this command, in the administrative mode of the router, to enable MLD in the router.  
Default  
Disabled  
Format  
Mode  
ipv6 mld router  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
no ipv6 mld router  
Use this command, in the administrative mode of the router, to disable MLD in the router.  
Default  
Disabled  
Format  
Mode  
no ipv6 mld router  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
ipv6 mld query-interval  
Use this command to set the MLD router’s query interval for the interface. The query-interval  
is the amount of time between the general queries sent when the router is the querier on that  
interface. The range for <query-interval> is 1–3,600 seconds.  
Default  
125  
Format  
Mode  
ipv6 mld query-interval <query-interval>  
Interface Config  
no ipv6 mld query-interval  
Use this command to reset the MLD query interval to the default value for that interface.  
Format  
Mode  
no ipv6 mld query-interval  
Interface Config  
ipv6 mld query-max-response-time  
Use this command to set the MLD querier’s maximum response time for the interface and  
this value is used in assigning the maximum response time in the query messages that are  
IPv6 Multicast Commands  
432  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
sent on that interface. The range for <query-max-response-time>is 0–65,535  
milliseconds.  
Default  
10000 milliseconds  
Format  
Mode  
ipv6 mld query-max-response-time <query-max-response-time>  
Interface Config  
no ipv6 mld query-max-response-time  
This command resets the MLD query max response time for the interface to the default  
value.  
Format  
Mode  
no ipv6 mld query-max-response-time  
Interface Config  
ipv6 mld last-member-query-interval  
Use this command to set the last member query interval for the MLD interface, which is the  
value of the maximum response time parameter in the group-specific queries sent out of this  
interface. The range for <last-member-query-interval>is 1 - 65,535 milliseconds.  
Default  
1000 milliseconds  
Format  
Mode  
ipv6 mld last-member-query-interval <last-member-query-interval>  
Interface Config  
no ipv6 mld last-member-query-interval  
Use this command to reset the <last-member-query-interval> parameter of the  
interface to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no ipv6 mld last-member-query-interval  
Interface Config  
ipv6 mld last-member-query-count  
Use this command to set the number of listener-specific queries sent before the router  
assumes that there are no local members on the interface. The range for  
<last-member-query-count>is 1–20.  
Default  
2
Format  
Mode  
ipv6 mld last-member-query-count <last-member-query-count>  
Interface Config  
IPv6 Multicast Commands  
433  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no ipv6 mld last-member-query-count  
Use this command to reset the <last-member-query-count> parameter of the interface  
to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no ipv6 mld last-member-query-count  
Interface Config  
show ipv6 mld groups  
Use this command to display information about multicast groups that MLD reported. The  
information is displayed only when MLD is enabled on at least one interface. If MLD was not  
enabled on even one interface, there is no group information to be displayed.  
Format  
Mode  
show ipv6 mld groups {<slot/port> | <group-address>}  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
The following fields are displayed as a table when <slot/port> is specified.  
Field  
Description  
Group Address  
Interface  
The address of the multicast group.  
Interface through which the multicast group is reachable.  
Time elapsed in hours, minutes, and seconds since the multicast group has been known.  
Up Time  
Expiry Time  
Time left in hours, minutes, and seconds before the entry is removed from the MLD  
membership table.  
When <group-address> is specified, the following fields are displayed for each multicast  
group and each interface.  
Field  
Description  
Interface  
Interface through which the multicast group is reachable.  
The address of the multicast group.  
Group Address  
Last Reporter  
The IP Address of the source of the last membership report received for this multicast  
group address on that interface.  
Filter Mode  
The filter mode of the multicast group on this interface. The values it can take are  
includeand exclude.  
Version 1 Host  
Timer  
The time remaining until the router assumes that there are no longer any MLD version-1  
Hosts on the specified interface.  
Group Compat  
Mode  
The compatibility mode of the multicast group on this interface. The values it can take are  
MLDv1and MLDv2.  
IPv6 Multicast Commands  
434  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
The following table is displayed to indicate all the sources associated with this group.  
Field  
Description  
Source Address  
Uptime  
The IP address of the source.  
Time elapsed in hours, minutes, and seconds since the source has been known.  
Time left in hours, minutes, and seconds before the entry is removed.  
Expiry Time  
Example: The following shows examples of CLI display output for the commands.  
(Switch) #show ipv6 mld groups ?  
<group-address>  
<slot/port>  
Enter Group Address Info.  
Enter interface in slot/port format.  
(Switch) #show ipv6 mld groups 0/1  
Group Address.................................. FF43::3  
Interface...................................... 0/1  
Up Time (hh:mm:ss)............................. 00:03:04  
Expiry Time (hh:mm:ss)......................... ------  
(Switch) #show ipv6 mld groups ff43::3  
Interface...................................... 0/1  
Group Address.................................. FF43::3  
Last Reporter.................................. FE80::200:FF:FE00:3  
Up Time (hh:mm:ss)............................. 00:02:53  
Expiry Time (hh:mm:ss)......................... ------  
Filter Mode.................................... Include  
Version1 Host Timer............................ ------  
Group compat mode.............................. v2  
Source Address  
ExpiryTime  
----------------- -----------  
2003::10  
2003::20  
00:04:17  
00:04:17  
show ipv6 mld interface  
Use this command to display MLD-related information for the interface.  
Format  
Mode  
show ipv6 mld interface [<slot/port>]  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
IPv6 Multicast Commands  
435  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
The following information is displayed for each of the interfaces or for only the specified  
interface.  
Field  
Description  
Interface  
The interface number in slot/port format.  
Displays the configured administrative status of MLD.  
MLD Global  
Mode  
MLD  
Operational  
Mode  
The operational status of MLD on the interface.  
MLD Version  
Indicates the version of MLD configured on the interface.  
Indicates the configured query interval for the interface.  
Query Interval  
Query Max  
Response Time  
Indicates the configured maximum query response time (in seconds) advertised in MLD  
queries on this interface.  
Robustness  
Displays the configured value for the tuning for the expected packet loss on a subnet  
attached to the interface.  
Startup Query  
interval  
This valued indicates the configured interval between General Queries sent by a Querier  
on startup.  
Startup Query  
Count  
This value indicates the configured number of Queries sent out on startup, separated by  
the Startup Query Interval.  
Last Member  
Query Interval  
This value indicates the configured Maximum Response Time inserted into  
Group-Specific Queries sent in response to Leave Group messages.  
Last Member  
Query Count  
This value indicates the configured number of Group-Specific Queries sent before the  
router assumes that there are no local members.  
The following information is displayed if the operational mode of the MLD interface is  
enabled.  
Field  
Description  
Querier Status  
This value indicates whether the interface is an MLD querier or nonquerier on the subnet  
it is associated with.  
Querier  
Address  
The IP address of the MLD querier on the subnet the interface is associated with.  
Querier Up Time  
Time elapsed in seconds since the querier state has been updated.  
Time left in seconds before the Querier loses its title as querier.  
Querier Expiry  
Time  
Wrong Version  
Queries  
Indicates that the number of queries received whose MLD version does not match the  
MLD version of the interface.  
Number of  
Joins  
The number of times a group membership has been added on this interface.  
IPv6 Multicast Commands  
436  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Field  
Description  
Number of  
Leaves  
The number of times a group membership has been removed on this interface.  
The current number of membership entries for this interface.  
Number of  
Groups  
show ipv6 mld traffic  
Use this command to display MLD statistical information for the router.  
Format  
Mode  
show ipv6 mld traffic  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Field  
Description  
Valid MLD Packets Received  
Valid MLD Packets Sent  
Queries Received  
The number of valid MLD packets received by the router.  
The number of valid MLD packets sent by the router.  
The number of valid MLD queries received by the router.  
The number of valid MLD queries sent by the router.  
The number of valid MLD reports received by the router.  
The number of valid MLD reports sent by the router.  
The number of valid MLD leaves received by the router.  
The number of valid MLD leaves sent by the router.  
The number of bad checksum MLD packets received by the router.  
The number of malformed MLD packets received by the router.  
Queries Sent  
Reports Received  
Reports Sent  
Leaves Received  
Leaves Sent  
Bad Checksum MLD Packets  
Malformed MLD Packets  
IPv6 MLD-Proxy Commands  
MLD-Proxy is the IPv6 equivalent of IGMP-Proxy. MLD-Proxy commands allow you to  
configure the network device as well as to view device settings and statistics using either  
serial interface or telnet session. The operation of MLD-Proxy commands is the same as for  
IGMP-Proxy: MLD is for IPv6 and IGMP is for IPv4.MGMD is a term used to refer to both  
IGMP and MLD.  
IPv6 Multicast Commands  
437  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
ipv6 mld-proxy  
Use this command to enable MLD-Proxy on the router. To enable MLD-Proxy on the router,  
you must enable multicast forwarding. Also, make sure that there are no other multicast  
routing protocols enabled n the router.  
Format  
Mode  
ipv6 mld-proxy  
Interface Config  
no ipv6 mld-proxy  
Use this command to disable MLD-Proxy on the router.  
Format  
Mode  
no ipv6 mld-proxy  
Interface Config  
ipv6 mld-proxy unsolicit-rprt-interval  
Use this command to set the unsolicited report interval for the MLD-Proxy router. This  
command is only valid when you enable MLD-Proxy on the interface. The value of <interval>  
is 1-260 seconds.  
Default  
Format  
Mode  
1
ipv6 mld-proxy unsolicit-rprt-interval <interval>  
Interface Config  
no ipv6 mld-proxy unsolicited-report-interval  
Use this command to reset the MLD-Proxy router’s unsolicited report interval to the default  
value.  
Format  
Mode  
no ipv6 mld-proxy unsolicit-rprt-interval  
Interface Config  
ipv6 mld-proxy reset-status  
Use this command to reset the host interface status parameters of the MLD-Proxy router.  
This command is only valid when you enable MLD-Proxy on the interface.  
Format  
Mode  
ipv6 mld-proxy reset-status  
Interface Config  
IPv6 Multicast Commands  
438  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show ipv6 mld-proxy  
Use this command to display a summary of the host interface status parameters.  
Format  
Mode  
show ipv6 mld-proxy  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
The command displays the following parameters only when you enable MLD-Proxy.  
Field  
Description  
Interface Index  
Admin Mode  
The interface number of the MLD-Proxy.  
Indicates whether MLD-Proxy is enabled or disabled. This is a configured  
value.  
Operational Mode  
Indicates whether MLD-Proxy is operationally enabled or disabled. This is a  
status parameter.  
Version  
The present MLD host version that is operational on the proxy interface.  
Number of Multicast Groups  
The number of multicast groups that are associated with the MLD-Proxy  
interface.  
Unsolicited Report Interval  
The time interval at which the MLD-Proxy interface sends unsolicited group  
membership report.  
Querier IP Address on Proxy  
Interface  
The IP address of the Querier, if any, in the network attached to the  
upstream interface (MLD-Proxy interface).  
Older Version 1 Querier  
Timeout  
The interval used to timeout the older version 1 queriers.  
Proxy Start Frequency  
The number of times the MLD-Proxy has been stopped and started.  
Example: The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(Switch) #show ipv6 mld-proxy  
Interface Index............................................. 0/3  
Admin Mode................................................ Enable  
Operational Mode......................................... Enable  
Version......................................................... 3  
Num of Multicast Groups............................. 0  
Unsolicited Report Interval.......................... 1  
Querier IP Address on Proxy Interface........ fe80::1:2:5  
Older Version 1 Querier Timeout................ 00:00:00  
Proxy Start Frequency.................................  
IPv6 Multicast Commands  
439  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show ipv6 mld-proxy interface  
This command displays a detailed list of the host interface status parameters. It displays the  
following parameters only when you enable MLD-Proxy.  
Format  
show ipv6 mld-proxy interface  
Modes  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Interface Index  
The slot/port of the MLD-proxy.  
The column headings of the table associated with the interface are as follows:  
Term  
Definition  
Ver  
The MLD version.  
Query Rcvd  
Report Rcvd  
Report Sent  
Leaves Rcvd  
Leaves Sent  
Number of MLD queries received.  
Number of MLD reports received.  
Number of MLD reports sent.  
Number of MLD leaves received. Valid for version 2 only.  
Number of MLD leaves sent on the Proxy interface. Valid for version 2 only.  
Example: The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(Switch) #show ipv6 mld-proxy interface  
Interface Index................................ 0/1  
Ver Query Rcvd Report Rcvd Report Sent Leave Rcvd Leave Sent  
------------------------------------------------------------------  
1
2
2
3
0
0
0
4
0
2
-----  
-----  
show ipv6 mld-proxy groups  
Use this command to display information about multicast groups that the MLD-Proxy  
reported.  
Format  
Mode  
show ipv6 mld-proxy groups  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
IPv6 Multicast Commands  
440  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Field  
Description  
Interface  
The interface number of the MLD-Proxy.  
The IP address of the multicast group.  
Group Address  
Last Reporter  
The IP address of the host that last sent a membership report for the current group,  
on the network attached to the MLD-Proxy interface (upstream interface).  
Up Time (in secs)  
Member State  
The time elapsed in seconds since last created.  
The possible values are:  
Idle_Member. The interface has responded to the latest group membership query  
for this group.  
Delay_Member. The interface is going to send a group membership report to  
respond to a group membership query for this group.  
Filter Mode  
Sources  
Possible values are Include or Exclude.  
The number of sources attached to the multicast group.  
Example: The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(Switch) #show ipv6 mld-proxy groups  
Interface Index................................ 0/3  
Group Address  
-------------  
FF1E::1  
Last Reporter  
Up Time Member State  
Filter Mode Sources  
-------------- ---------- ----------------- -------------- -------  
FE80::100:2.3  
FE80::100:2.3  
FE80::100:2.3  
FE80::100:2.3  
00:01:40 DELAY_MEMBER  
00:02:40 DELAY_MEMBER  
00:01:40 DELAY_MEMBER  
00:02:44 DELAY_MEMBER  
Exclude  
Include  
Exclude  
Include  
2
1
0
4
FF1E::2  
FF1E::3  
FF1E::4  
show ipv6 mld-proxy groups detail  
Use this command to display information about multicast groups that MLD-Proxy reported.  
Format  
show ipv6 mld-proxy groups detail  
Mode  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Field  
Description  
Interface  
The interface number of the MLD-Proxy.  
Group Address  
Last Reporter  
The IP address of the multicast group.  
The IP address of the host that last sent a membership report for the current group,  
on the network attached to the MLD-Proxy interface (upstream interface).  
IPv6 Multicast Commands  
441  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Field  
Description  
Up Time (in secs)  
The time elapsed in seconds since last created.  
Member State  
The possible values are:  
Idle_Member. The interface has responded to the latest group membership query  
for this group.  
Delay_Member. The interface is going to send a group membership report to  
respond to a group membership query for this group.  
Filter Mode  
Possible values are Include or Exclude.  
Sources  
The number of sources attached to the multicast group.  
The list of IP addresses of the sources attached to the multicast group.  
The time left for a source to get deleted.  
Group Source List  
Expiry Time  
Example: The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(Switch) #show ipv6 igmp-proxy groups  
Interface Index................................ 0/3  
Group Address  
Last Reporter  
Up Time Member State  
Filter Mode Sources  
------------- ---------------- ----------- ----------------- ------------- -------  
FF1E::1  
FE80::100:2.3  
244  
DELAY_MEMBER  
Exclude  
2
Group Source List  
------------------  
2001::1  
Expiry Time  
---------------  
00:02:40  
2001::2  
--------  
FF1E::2  
FE80::100:2.3  
243  
DELAY_MEMBER Include  
1
Group Source List  
------------------  
3001::1  
Expiry Time  
---------------  
00:03:32  
3002::2  
00:03:32  
FF1E::3  
FF1E::4  
FE80::100:2.3  
FE80::100:2.3  
328  
255  
DELAY_MEMBER Exclude  
DELAY_MEMBER Include  
0
4
Group Source List  
------------------  
4001::1  
Expiry Time  
---------------  
00:03:40  
5002::2  
4001::2  
5002::2  
00:03:40  
00:03:40  
00:03:40  
IPv6 Multicast Commands  
442  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8.  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
8
This chapter describes the Quality of Service (QoS) commands available in the managed  
switch CLI.  
This chapter contains the following sections:  
The commands in this chapter are in two functional groups:  
Show commands display switch settings, statistics, and other information.  
Configuration commands configure features and options of the switch. Every switch  
command has a show command that displays the configuration setting.  
443  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Class of Service (CoS) Commands  
This section describes the commands you use to configure and view Class of Service (CoS)  
settings for the switch. The commands in this section allow you to control the priority and  
transmission rate of traffic.  
Note: Commands you issue in the Interface Config mode only affect a  
single interface. Commands you issue in the Global Config mode  
affect all interfaces.  
classofservice dot1p-mapping  
This command maps an 802.1p priority to an internal traffic class. The <userpriority>  
values can range from 0-7. The <trafficclass>values range from 0-6, although the  
actual number of available traffic classes depends on the platform. For more information  
about 802.1p priority, see Voice VLAN Commands on page 62.  
Format  
Modes  
classofservice dot1p-mapping <userpriority> <trafficclass>  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
no classofservice dot1p-mapping  
This command maps each 802.1p priority to its default internal traffic class value.  
Format  
Modes  
no classofservice dot1p-mapping  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
classofservice ip-dscp-mapping  
This command maps an IP DSCP value to an internal traffic class. The <ipdscp> value is  
specified as either an integer from 0 to 63, or symbolically through one of the following  
keywords: af11, af12, af13, af21, af22, af23, af31, af32, af33, af41, af42, af43, be, cs0, cs1,  
cs2, cs3, cs4, cs5, cs6, cs7, ef.  
The <trafficclass>values can range from 0-6, although the actual number of available  
traffic classes depends on the platform.  
Format  
Modes  
classofservice ip-dscp-mapping <ipdscp> <trafficclass>  
Global Config  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
444  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no classofservice ip-dscp-mapping  
This command maps each IP DSCP value to its default internal traffic class value.  
Format  
Modes  
no classofservice ip-dscp-mapping  
Global Config  
classofservice trust  
This command sets the Class of Service trust mode of an interface. You can set the mode to  
trust one of the Dot1p (802.1p), IP DSCP, or IP Precedence packet markings. You can also  
set the interface mode to untrusted. If you configure an interface to use Dot1p, the mode  
does not appear in the output of the show running configcommand because Dot1p is  
the default.  
Default  
dot1p  
Format  
Modes  
classofservice trust {dot1p | ip-dscp | ip-precedence | untrusted}  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
no classofservice trust  
This command sets the interface mode to the default value.  
Format  
Modes  
no classofservice trust  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
cos-queue min-bandwidth  
This command specifies the minimum transmission bandwidth guarantee for each interface  
queue. The total number of queues supported per interface is platform-specific. A value from  
0–100 (percentage of link rate) must be specified for each supported queue, with 0 indicating  
no guaranteed minimum bandwidth. The sum of all values entered must not exceed 100.  
Format  
Modes  
cos-queue min-bandwidth <bw-0> <bw-1> … <bw-n>  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
no cos-queue min-bandwidth  
This command restores the default for each queue's minimum bandwidth value.  
Format  
Modes  
no cos-queue min-bandwidth  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
445  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
cos-queue strict  
This command activates the strict priority scheduler mode for each specified queue.  
Format  
Modes  
cos-queue strict <queue-id-1> [<queue-id-2> … <queue-id-n>]  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
no cos-queue strict  
This command restores the default weighted scheduler mode for each specified queue.  
Format  
Modes  
no cos-queue strict <queue-id-1> [<queue-id-2> … <queue-id-n>]  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
cos-queue random-detect  
This command activates weighted random early discard (WRED) for each specified queue on  
the interface. Specific WRED parameters are configured using the randomdetect  
queue-parms and the random-detect exponential-weighting-constant commands. When  
specified in Interface Config' mode, this command affects a single interface only, whereas in  
Global Config mode, it applies to all interfaces. At least one, but no more than n, queue-id  
values are specified with this command.  
Duplicate queue-id values are ignored. Each queue-id value ranges from 0 to (n-1), where n  
is the total number of queues supported per interface. The number n is platform dependant  
and corresponds to the number of supported queues (traffic classes).  
Format  
Modes  
cos-queue random-detect queue-id-1 [queue-id-2 … queue-id-n]  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
no cos-queue random-detect  
Use this command to disable WRED and restore the default tail drop operation for the  
specified queues on all interfaces or one interface.  
Format  
Modes  
cos-queue random-detect queue-id-1 [queue-id-2 … queue-id-n]  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
446  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
random-detect exponential weighting-constant  
Use this command to configure the WRED decay exponent for a CoS queue interface.  
Format  
random-detect exponential-weighting-constant 0-15  
Modes  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
Default  
9
no random-detect exponential weighting-constant  
Use this command to reset the WRED decay exponent to the default value on all interfaces  
or one interface.  
Format  
Modes  
no random-detect exponential-weighting-constant 0-15  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
random-detect queue-parms  
Use this command to configure WRED parameters for each drop precedence level supported  
by a queue. Use it only when per-COS queue configuration is enabled (using the cos-queue  
random-detect command).  
min-thresh is the minimum threshold the queue depth (as a percentage) where WRED starts  
marking and dropping traffic.  
max-thresh is the maximum threshold is the queue depth (as a percentage) above which  
WRED marks / drops all traffic.  
drop-probability is the percentage probability that WRED will mark/drop a packet, when the  
queue depth is at the maximum threshold. (The drop probability increases linearly from 0 just  
before the minimum threshold, to this value at the maximum threshold, then goes to 100% for  
larger queue depths). Each parameter is specified for each possible drop precedence ("color"  
of TCP traffic).  
The last precedence applies to all non-TCP traffic. For example, in a 3-color system, four of  
each parameter specified: green TCP, yellow TCP, red TCP, and non-TCP, respectively.  
Format  
random-detect queue-parms queue-id-1 [queue-id-2 … queue-id-n]  
minthresh thresh-prec-1 … thresh-prec-n max-thresh thresh-prec-1 …  
threshprec-n drop-probability prob-prec-1 … prob-prec-n  
Modes  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
447  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no random-detect queue-parms  
Use this command to set the WRED configuration back to the default.  
Format  
Modes  
no random-detect queue-parms queue-id-1 [queue-id-2 … queue-id-n]  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
traffic-shape  
This command specifies the maximum transmission bandwidth limit for the interface as a  
whole. Also known as rate shaping, traffic shaping has the effect of smoothing temporary  
traffic bursts over time so that the transmitted traffic rate is bounded.  
Format  
Modes  
traffic-shape <bw>  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
no traffic-shape  
This command restores the interface shaping rate to the default value.  
Format  
Modes  
no traffic-shape  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
show classofservice dot1p-mapping  
This command displays the current Dot1p (802.1p) priority mapping to internal traffic classes  
for a specific interface. The <slot/port>parameter is optional and is only valid on  
platforms that support independent per-port Class of Service mappings. If specified, the  
802.1p mapping table of the interface is displayed. If omitted, the most recent global  
configuration settings are displayed. For more information, see Voice VLAN Commands on  
page 62.  
Format  
Mode  
show classofservice dot1p-mapping [<slot/port>]  
Privileged EXEC  
The following information is repeated for each user priority.  
Term  
Definition  
User Priority  
Traffic Class  
The 802.1p user priority value.  
The traffic class internal queue identifier to which the user priority value is mapped.  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
448  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show classofservice ip-precedence-mapping  
This command displays the current IP Precedence mapping to internal traffic classes for a  
specific interface. The slot/port parameter is optional and is only valid on platforms that  
support independent per-port Class of Service mappings. If specified, the IP Precedence  
mapping table of the interface is displayed. If omitted, the most recent global configuration  
settings are displayed.  
Format  
Mode  
show classofservice ip-precedence-mapping [<slot/port>]  
Privileged EXEC  
The following information is repeated for each user priority.  
Term  
Definition  
IP Precedence  
Traffic Class  
The IP Precedence value.  
The traffic class internal queue identifier to which the IP Precedence value is mapped.  
show classofservice ip-dscp-mapping  
This command displays the current IP DSCP mapping to internal traffic classes for the global  
configuration settings.  
Format  
Mode  
show classofservice ip-dscp-mapping  
Privileged EXEC  
The following information is repeated for each user priority.  
Term  
Definition  
IP DSCP  
The IP DSCP value.  
Traffic Class  
The traffic class internal queue identifier to which the IP DSCP value is mapped.  
show classofservice trust  
This command displays the current trust mode setting for a specific interface. The  
<slot/port>parameter is optional and is only valid on platforms that support independent  
per-port Class of Service mappings. If you specify an interface, the command displays the  
port trust mode of the interface. If you do not specify an interface, the command displays the  
most recent global configuration settings.  
Format  
Mode  
show classofservice trust [<slot/port>]  
Privileged EXEC  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
449  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Non-IP Traffic  
Class  
The traffic class used for non-IP traffic. This is only displayed when the COS trust mode  
is set to trust IP Precedence or IP DSCP (on platforms that support IP DSCP).  
Untrusted  
Traffic Class  
The traffic class used for all untrusted traffic. This is only displayed when the COS trust  
mode is set to 'untrusted'.  
show interfaces cos-queue  
This command displays the class-of-service queue configuration for the specified interface.  
The slot/port parameter is optional and is only valid on platforms that support independent  
per-port Class of Service mappings. If specified, the class-of-service queue configuration of  
the interface is displayed. If omitted, the most recent global configuration settings are  
displayed.  
Format  
Mode  
show interfaces cos-queue [<slot/port>]  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Queue Id  
An interface supports n queues numbered 0 to (n-1). The specific n value is  
platform-dependent.  
Minimum  
Bandwidth  
The minimum transmission bandwidth guarantee for the queue, expressed as a  
percentage. A value of 0 means bandwidth is not guaranteed and the queue operates  
using best-effort. This is a configured value.  
Scheduler Type  
Indicates whether this queue is scheduled for transmission using a strict priority or a  
weighted scheme. This is a configured value.  
Queue  
Management  
Type  
The queue depth management technique used for this queue (tail drop).  
If you specify the interface, the command also displays the following information.  
Term  
Definition  
Interface  
The slot/port of the interface. If displaying the global configuration, this output line is  
replaced with a Global Config indication.  
Interface  
Shaping Rate  
The maximum transmission bandwidth limit for the interface as a whole. It is independent  
of any per-queue maximum bandwidth value(s) in effect for the interface. This is a  
configured value.  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
450  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show interfaces random-detect  
This command displays the global WRED settings for each CoS queue. If you specify the  
slot/port, the command displays the WRED settings for each CoS queue on the specified  
interface.  
Format  
show interfaces random-detect [slot/port]  
Mode  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Queue ID  
An interface supports n queues numbered 0 to (n-1). The specific n value is  
platform-dependent.  
WREDMinimum  
Threshold  
The configured minimum threshold the queue depth (as a percentage) where WRED  
starts marking and dropping traffic.  
WRED  
Maximum  
Threshold  
The configured maximum threshold is the queue depth (as a percentage) above which  
WRED marks / drops all traffic.  
WRED Drop  
Probability  
The configured percentage probability that WRED will mark/drop a packet, when the  
queue depth is at the maximum threshold. (The drop probability increases linearly from 0  
just before the minimum threshold, to this value at the maximum threshold, then goes to  
100% for larger queue depths).  
Differentiated Services (DiffServ) Commands  
This section describes the commands you use to configure QOS Differentiated Services  
(DiffServ).  
You configure DiffServ in several stages by specifying three DiffServ components:  
1. Class  
a. Creating and deleting classes.  
b. Defining match criteria for a class.  
2. Policy  
a. Creating and deleting policies  
b. Associating classes with a policy  
c. Defining policy statements for a policy/class combination  
3. Service  
a. Adding and removing a policy to/from an inbound or outbound interface  
The DiffServ class defines the packet filtering criteria. The attributes of a DiffServ policy  
define the way the switch processes packets. You can define policy attributes on a per-class  
instance basis. The switch applies these attributes when a match occurs.  
Packet processing begins when the switch tests the match criteria for a packet. The switch  
applies a policy to a packet when it finds a class match within that policy.  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
451  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
The following rules apply when you create a DiffServ class:  
Each class can contain a maximum of one referenced (nested) class  
Class definitions do not support hierarchical service policies  
A given class definition can contain a maximum of one reference to another class. You can  
combine the reference with other match criteria. The referenced class is truly a reference and  
not a copy, because additions to a referenced class affect all classes that reference it.  
Changes to any class definition currently referenced by any other class must result in valid  
class definitions for all derived classes, otherwise the switch rejects the change. You can  
remove a class reference from a class definition.  
The only way to remove an individual match criterion from an existing class definition is to  
delete the class and re-create it.  
Note: The mark possibilities for policing include CoS, IP DSCP, and IP  
Precedence. While the latter two are only meaningful for IP packet  
types, CoS marking is allowed for both IP and non-IP packets, since  
it updates the 802.1p user priority field contained in the VLAN tag of  
the layer 2 packet header.  
diffserv  
This command sets the DiffServ operational mode to active. While disabled, the DiffServ  
configuration is retained and can be changed, but it is not activated. When enabled, DiffServ  
services are activated.  
Format  
diffserv  
Mode  
Global Config  
no diffserv  
This command sets the DiffServ operational mode to inactive. While disabled, the DiffServ  
configuration is retained and can be changed, but it is not activated. When enabled, DiffServ  
services are activated.  
Format  
Mode  
no diffserv  
Global Config  
DiffServ Class Commands  
Use the DiffServ class commands to define traffic classification. To classify traffic, you specify  
Behavior Aggregate (BA), based on DSCP and Multi-Field (MF) classes of traffic (name,  
match criteria)  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
452  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
This set of commands consists of class creation/deletion and matching, with the class match  
commands specifying Layer 3, Layer 2, and general match criteria. The class match criteria  
are also known as class rules, with a class definition consisting of one or more rules to  
identify the traffic that belongs to the class.  
Note: Once you create a class match criterion for a class, you cannot  
change or delete the criterion. To change or delete a class match  
criterion, you must delete and re-create the entire class.  
The CLI command root is class-map.  
class-map  
This command defines a DiffServ class of type match-all. When used without any match  
condition, this command enters the class-map mode. The <class-map-name>is a  
case-sensitive alphanumeric string from 1 to 31 characters uniquely identifying an existing  
DiffServ class.  
Note: The class-map-name defaultis reserved and must not be used.  
The class type of match-all indicates all of the individual match conditions must be true for  
a packet to be considered a member of the class. This command might be used without  
specifying a class type to enter the Class-Map Config mode for an existing DiffServ class.  
Note: The optional keywords [{ipv4 | ipv6}] specify the Layer 3  
protocol for this class. If not specified, this parameter defaults to  
ipv4. This maintains backward compatibility for configurations  
defined on systems before IPv6 match items were supported.  
Note: The CLI mode is changed to Class-Map Config or Ipv6-Class-Map  
Config when this command is successfully executed depending on  
the [{ipv4 | ipv6}] keyword specified.  
Format  
Mode  
class-map match-all <class-map-name> [{ipv4 | ipv6}]  
Global Config  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
453  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no class-map  
This command eliminates an existing DiffServ class. The <class-map-name>is the name  
of an existing DiffServ class. (The class name ‘default’ is reserved and is not allowed here.)  
This command might be issued at any time; if the class is currently referenced by one or  
more policies or by any other class, the delete action fails.  
Format  
Mode  
no class-map <class-map-name>  
Global Config  
class-map rename  
This command changes the name of a DiffServ class. The <class-map-name> is the  
name of an existing DiffServ class. The <new-class-map-name> parameter is a  
case-sensitive alphanumeric string from 1 to 31 characters uniquely identifying the class.  
Default  
none  
Format  
Mode  
class-map rename <class-map-name> <new-class-map-name>  
Global Config  
match ethertype  
This command adds to the specified class definition a match condition based on the value of  
the ethertype. The <ethertype>value is specified as one of the following keywords:  
appletalk, arp, ibmsna, ipv4, ipv6, ipx, mplsmcast, mplsucast, netbios,  
novell, pppoe, rarpor as a custom ethertype value in the range of 0x0600-0xFFFF.  
Format  
Mode  
match ethertype {<keyword> | custom <0x0600-0xFFFF>}  
Class-Map Config  
Ipv6-Class-Map Config  
match any  
This command adds to the specified class definition a match condition whereby all packets  
are considered to belong to the class.  
Default  
none  
Format  
Mode  
match any  
Class-Map Config  
Ipv6-Class-Map Config  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
454  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
match class-map  
This command adds to the specified class definition the set of match conditions defined for  
another class. The <refclassname>is the name of an existing DiffServ class whose match  
conditions are being referenced by the specified class definition.  
Default  
none  
Format  
Mode  
match class-map <refclassname>  
Class-Map Config  
Ipv6-Class-Map Config  
Note the following:  
The parameters <refclassname> and <class-map-name> cannot be the same.  
Only one other class might be referenced by a class.  
Any attempts to delete the <refclassname> class while the class is still referenced by any  
<class-map-name> fails.  
The combined match criteria of <class-map-name> and <refclassname> must be an  
allowed combination based on the class type.  
Any subsequent changes to the <refclassname> class match criteria must maintain this  
validity, or the change attempt fails.  
The total number of class rules formed by the complete reference class chain (including  
both predecessor and successor classes) must not exceed a platform-specific maximum.  
In some cases, each removal of a refclass rule reduces the maximum number of  
available rules in the class definition by one.  
no match class-map  
This command removes from the specified class definition the set of match conditions  
defined for another class. The <refclassname>is the name of an existing DiffServ class  
whose match conditions are being referenced by the specified class definition.  
Format  
Mode  
no match class-map <refclassname>  
Class-Map Config  
Ipv6-Class-Map Config  
match cos  
This command adds to the specified class definition a match condition for the Class of  
Service value (the only tag in a single tagged packet or the first or outer 802.1Q tag of a  
double VLAN tagged packet). The value might be from 0 to 7.  
Default  
none  
Format  
Mode  
match cos <0-7>  
Class-Map Config  
Ipv6-Class-Map Config  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
455  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
match secondary cos  
This command adds to the specified class definition a match condition for the secondary  
Class of Service value (the only tag in a single tagged packet or the first or outer 802.1Q tag  
of a double VLAN tagged packet). The value might be from 0 to 7.  
Default  
none  
Format  
Mode  
match secondary-cos <0-7>  
Class-Map Config  
match ip6flowlbl  
This command adds to the specified class definition a match condition based on the  
IP6flowlbl of a packet. The labelis the value to match in the Flow Label field of the IPv6  
header (range 0-1048575).  
Format  
Mode  
match ip6flowlbl <label>  
Ipv6-Class-Map Configuration mode  
match destination-address mac  
This command adds to the specified class definition a match condition based on the  
destination MAC address of a packet. The <macaddr>parameter is any layer 2 MAC  
address formatted as six, two-digit hexadecimal numbers separated by colons (for example,  
00:11:22:dd:ee:ff). The <macmask>parameter is a layer 2 MAC address bit mask, which  
need not to be contiguous, and is formatted as six, two-digit hexadecimal numbers separated  
by colons (for example, ff:07:23:ff:fe:dc).  
Default  
none  
Format  
Mode  
match destination-address mac <macaddr> <macmask>  
Class-Map Config  
Ipv6-Class-Map Config  
match dstip  
This command adds to the specified class definition a match condition based on the  
destination IP address of a packet. The <ipaddr>parameter specifies an IP address. The  
<ipmask>parameter specifies an IP address bit mask and must consist of a contiguous set  
of leading 1 bits.  
Default  
none  
Format  
Mode  
match dstip <ipaddr> <ipmask>  
Class-Map Config  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
456  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
match dstip6  
This command adds to the specified class definition a match condition based on the  
destination IPv6 address of a packet.  
Default  
none  
Format  
Mode  
match dstip6 <destination-ipv6-prefix/prefix-length>  
Ipv6-Class-Map Config  
match dstl4port  
This command adds to the specified class definition a match condition based on the  
destination layer 4 port of a packet using a single keyword or numeric notation. To specify the  
match condition as a single keyword, the value for <portkey> is one of the supported port  
name keywords. The currently supported <portkey>values are: domain, echo, ftp, ftpdata,  
http, smtp, snmp, telnet, tftp, www. Each of these translates into its equivalent port number.  
To specify the match condition using a numeric notation, one layer 4-port number is required.  
The port number is an integer from 0 to 65535.  
Default  
none  
Format  
Mode  
match dstl4port {<portkey> | <0-65535>}  
Class-Map Config  
Ipv6-Class-Map Config  
match ip dscp  
This command adds to the specified class definition a match condition based on the value of  
the IP DiffServ Code Point (DSCP) field in a packet, which is defined as the high-order six  
bits of the Service Type octet in the IP header (the low-order two bits are not checked).  
The <dscpval>value is specified as either an integer from 0 to 63, or symbolically through  
one of the following keywords: af11, af12, af13, af21, af22, af23, af31, af32, af33, af41, af42,  
af43, be, cs0, cs1, cs2, cs3, cs4, cs5, cs6, cs7, ef.  
Note: The ip dscp, ip precedence, and ip tos match conditions are  
alternative ways to specify a match criterion for the same Service  
Type field in the IP header, but with a slightly different user notation.  
Default  
none  
Format  
Mode  
match ip dscp <dscpval>  
Class-Map Config  
Ipv6-Class-Map Config  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
457  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
match ip precedence  
This command adds to the specified class definition a match condition based on the value of  
the IP Precedence field in a packet, which is defined as the high-order three bits of the  
Service Type octet in the IP header (the low-order five bits are not checked). The precedence  
value is an integer from 0 to 7.  
Note: The IP DSCP, IP Precedence, and IP ToS match conditions are  
alternative ways to specify a match criterion for the same Service  
Type field in the IP header, but with a slightly different user notation.  
Default  
none  
Format  
Mode  
match ip precedence <0-7>  
Class-Map Config  
match ip tos  
This command adds to the specified class definition a match condition based on the value of  
the IP TOS field in a packet, which is defined as all eight bits of the Service Type octet in the  
IP header. The value of <tosbits>is a two-digit hexadecimal number from 00 to ff. The  
value of <tosmask>is a two-digit hexadecimal number from 00 to ff. The <tosmask>  
denotes the bit positions in <tosbits>that are used for comparison against the IP TOS field  
in a packet. For example, to check for an IP TOS value having bits 7 and 5 set and bit 1 clear,  
where bit 7 is most significant, use a <tosbits>value of a0 (hex) and a <tosmask>of a2  
(hex).  
Note: The IP DSCP, IP Precedence, and IP ToS match conditions are  
alternative ways to specify a match criterion for the same Service  
Type field in the IP header, but with a slightly different user notation.  
Note: This “free form” version of the IP DSCP/Precedence/TOS match  
specification gives the user complete control when specifying which  
bits of the IP Service Type field are checked.  
Default  
none  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
458  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Format  
Mode  
match ip tos <tosbits> <tosmask>  
Class-Map Config  
match protocol  
This command adds to the specified class definition a match condition based on the value of  
the IP Protocol field in a packet using a single keyword notation or a numeric value notation.  
To specify the match condition using a single keyword notation, the value for  
<protocol-name>is one of the supported protocol name keywords. The currently  
supported values are: icmp, igmp, ip, tcp, udp. A value of ipmatches all protocol number  
values.  
To specify the match condition using a numeric value notation, the protocol number is a  
standard value assigned by IANA and is interpreted as an integer from 0 to 255.  
Note: This command does not validate the protocol number value against  
the current list defined by IANA.  
Default  
none  
Format  
Mode  
match protocol {<protocol-name> | <0-255>}  
Class-Map Config  
Ipv6-Class-Map Config  
match source-address mac  
This command adds to the specified class definition a match condition based on the source  
MAC address of a packet. The <address>parameter is any layer 2 MAC address formatted  
as six, two-digit hexadecimal numbers separated by colons (for example, 00:11:22:dd:ee:ff).  
The <macmask> parameter is a layer 2 MAC address bit mask, which might not be  
contiguous, and is formatted as six, two-digit hexadecimal numbers separated by colons (for  
example, ff:07:23:ff:fe:dc).  
Default  
none  
Format  
Mode  
match source-address mac <address> <macmask>  
Class-Map Config  
Ipv6-Class-Map Config  
match srcip  
This command adds to the specified class definition a match condition based on the source  
IP address of a packet. The <ipaddr>parameter specifies an IP address. The <ipmask>  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
459  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
parameter specifies an IP address bit mask and must consist of a contiguous set of leading 1  
bits.  
Default  
none  
Format  
Mode  
match srcip <ipaddr> <ipmask>  
Class-Map Config  
match srcip6  
This command adds to the specified class definition a match condition based on the source  
IP address of a packet.  
Default  
none  
Format  
Mode  
match srcip6 <source-ipv6-prefix/prefix-length>  
Ipv6-Class-Map Config  
match srcl4port  
This command adds to the specified class definition a match condition based on the source  
layer 4 port of a packet using a single keyword or numeric notation. To specify the match  
condition as a single keyword notation, the value for <portkey>is one of the supported port  
name keywords (listed below). The currently supported <portkey>values are: domain,  
echo, ftp, ftpdata, http, smtp, snmp, telnet, tftp, www. Each of these translates into its  
equivalent port number, which is used as both the start and end of a port range.  
To specify the match condition as a numeric value, one layer 4-port number is required. The  
port number is an integer from 0 to 65535.  
Default  
none  
Format  
Mode  
match srcl4port {<portkey> | <0-65535>}  
Class-Map Config  
Ipv6-Class-Map Config  
match vlan  
This command adds to the specified class definition a match condition based on the value of  
the layer 2 VLAN Identifier field (the 802.1Q tag of a VLAN tagged packet). The VLAN is an  
integer from 0 to 4095.  
Default  
none  
Format  
Mode  
match vlan {<0-4095>}  
Class-Map Config  
Ipv6-Class-Map Config  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
460  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
match secondary-vlan  
This command adds to the specified class definition a match condition based on the value of  
the layer 2 secondary VLAN Identifier field (the 802.1Q tag of a double VLAN tagged packet).  
The VLAN is an integer from 0 to 4095.  
Default  
none  
Format  
Mode  
match secondary-vlan {<0-4095>}  
Class-Map Config  
Ipv6-Class-Map Config  
DiffServ Policy Commands  
Use the DiffServ policy commands to specify traffic conditioning actions, such as policing and  
marking, to apply to traffic classes  
Use the policy commands to associate a traffic class that you define by using the class  
command set with one or more QoS policy attributes. Assign the class/policy association to  
an interface to form a service. Specify the policy name when you create the policy.  
Each traffic class defines a particular treatment for packets that match the class definition.  
You can associate multiple traffic classes with a single policy. When a packet satisfies the  
conditions of more than one class, preference is based on the order in which you add the  
classes to the policy. The first class you add has the highest precedence.  
This set of commands consists of policy creation/deletion, class addition/removal, and  
individual policy attributes.  
Note: The only way to remove an individual policy attribute from a class  
instance within a policy is to remove the class instance and re-add it  
to the policy. The values associated with an existing policy attribute  
can be changed without removing the class instance.  
The CLI command root is policy-map.  
assign-queue  
This command modifies the queue id to which the associated traffic stream is assigned. The  
queueidis an integer from 0 to n-1, where nis the number of egress queues supported by  
the device.  
Format  
Mode  
assign-queue <queueid>  
Policy-Class-Map Config  
Drop  
Incompatibilities  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
461  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
drop  
This command specifies that all packets for the associated traffic stream are to be dropped at  
ingress.  
Format  
drop  
Mode  
Policy-Class-Map Config  
Incompatibilities  
Assign Queue, Mark (all forms), Mirror, Police, Redirect  
mirror  
This command specifies that all incoming packets for the associated traffic stream are copied  
to a specific egress interface (physical port or LAG).  
Format  
mirror <slot/port>  
Policy-Class-Map Config  
Drop, Redirect  
Mode  
Incompatibilities  
redirect  
This command specifies that all incoming packets for the associated traffic stream are  
redirected to a specific egress interface (physical port or port-channel).  
Format  
redirect<slot/port>  
Policy-Class-Map Config  
Drop, Mirror  
Mode  
Incompatibilities  
conform-color  
Use this command to enable color-aware traffic policing and define the conform-color class  
map. Used with the police command where the fields for the conform level are specified. The  
<class-map-name>parameter is the name of an existing DiffServ class map.  
Note: This command might only be used after specifying a police  
command for the policy-class instance.  
Format  
Mode  
conform-color <class-map-name>  
Policy-Class-Map Config  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
462  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
class  
This command creates an instance of a class definition within the specified policy for defining  
treatment of the traffic class through subsequent policy attribute statements. The  
<classname>is the name of an existing DiffServ class.  
Note: This command causes the specified policy to create a reference to  
the class definition.  
Note: The CLI mode is changed to Policy-Class-Map Config when this  
command is successfully executed.  
Format  
class <classname>  
Mode  
Policy-Map Config  
no class  
This command deletes the instance of a particular class and its defined treatment from the  
specified policy. <classname>is the names of an existing DiffServ class.  
Note: This command removes the reference to the class definition for the  
specified policy.  
Format  
no class <classname>  
Mode  
Policy-Map Config  
mark cos  
This command marks all packets for the associated traffic stream with the specified Class of  
Service value in the priority field of the 802.1p header (the only tag in a single tagged packet  
or the first or outer 802.1Q tag of a double VLAN tagged packet). If the packet does not  
already contain this header, one is inserted. The CoS value is an integer from 0 to 7.  
Default  
Format  
1
mark-cos <0-7>  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
463  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Mode  
Policy-Class-Map Config  
Drop, Mark IP DSCP, IP Precedence, Police  
Incompatibilities  
mark cos-as-sec-cos  
This command marks outer VLAN tag priority bits of all packets as the inner VLAN tag  
priority, marking CoS as Secondary CoS. This essentially means that the inner VLAN tag  
CoS is copied to the outer VLAN tag CoS.  
Format  
Mode  
mark-cos-as-sec-cos  
Policy-Class-Map Config  
Incompatibilities  
Drop, Mark IP DSCP, IP Precedence, Police  
mark ip-dscp  
This command marks all packets for the associated traffic stream with the specified IP DSCP  
value.  
The <dscpval> value is specified as either an integer from 0 to 63, or symbolically through  
one of the following keywords: af11, af12, af13, af21, af22, af23, af31, af32, af33, af41, af42,  
af43, be, cs0, cs1, cs2, cs3, cs4, cs5, cs6, cs7, ef.  
Format  
mark ip-dscp <dscpval>  
Mode  
Policy-Class-Map Config  
Incompatibilities  
Drop, Mark CoS, Mark IP Precedence, Police  
mark ip-precedence  
This command marks all packets for the associated traffic stream with the specified IP  
Precedence value. The IP Precedence value is an integer from 0 to 7.  
Note: This command might not be used on IPv6 classes. IPv6 does not  
have a precedence field.  
Format  
Mode  
mark ip-precedence <0-7>  
Policy-Class-Map Config  
Incompatibilitie  
s
Drop, Mark CoS, Mark IP Precedence, Police  
Policy Type  
In  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
464  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
police-simple  
This command is used to establish the traffic policing style for the specified class. The simple  
form of the police command uses a single data rate and burst size, resulting in two outcomes:  
conform and violate. The conforming data rate is specified in kilobits-per-second (Kbps) and  
is an integer from 1 to 4294967295. The conforming burst size is specified in kilobytes (KB)  
and is an integer from 1 to 128.  
For each outcome, the only possible actions are drop, set-cos-transmit, set-dscp-transmit,  
set-prec-transmit, or transmit. In this simple form of the police command, the conform action  
defaults to transmit and the violate action defaults to drop.  
For set-dscp-transmit, a <dscpval>value is required and is specified as either an integer  
from 0 to 63, or symbolically through one of the following keywords: af11, af12, af13, af21,  
af22, af23, af31, af32, af33, af41, af42, af43, be, cs0, cs1, cs2, cs3, cs4, cs5, cs6, cs7, ef.  
For set-prec-transmit, an IP Precedence value is required and is specified as an integer from  
0-7.  
For set-cos-transmit an 802.1p priority value is required and is specified as an integer from  
0-7.  
Format  
police-simple {<1-4294967295> <1-128> conform-action {drop |  
set-prec-transmit <0-7> | set-dscp-transmit <0-63> |  
set-cos-transmit <0-7> | transmit} [violate-action {drop |  
set-prec-transmit <0-7> | set-dscp-transmit <0-63> |  
set-cos-transmit <0-7> | transmit}]}  
Mode  
Policy-Class-Map Config  
Drop, Mark (all forms)  
Incompatibilities  
police-two-rate  
This command is the two-rate form of the policecommand and is used to establish the  
traffic policing style for the specified class. For each outcome, the only possible actions are  
drop, set-cos-as-sec-cos, set-cos-transmit, set-sec-cos-transmit, set-dscp-transmit,  
set-prec-transmit, or transmit. In this two-rate form of the policecommand, the conform  
action defaults to send, the exceed action defaults to drop, and the violate action defaults to  
drop. These actions can be set with this command after the style is configured.  
Format  
police-two-rate {<1-4294967295> <1-128> <1-4294967295> <1-128>  
conform-action {drop | set-cos-as-sec-cos | set-cos-transmit <0-7>  
| set-sec-cos-transmit <0-7> | set-prec-transmit <0-7> |  
set-dscp-transmit <0-63> | transmit} exceed-action {drop |  
set-cos-as-sec-cos | set-cos-transmit <0-7> | set-sec-cos-transmit  
<0-7> | set-prec-transmit <0-7> | set-dscp-transmit <0-63> |  
transmit} violate-action {drop | set-cos-as-sec-cos |  
set-cos-transmit <0-7> | set-sec-cos-transmit <0-7> |  
set-prec-transmit <0-7> | set-dscp-transmit <0-63> | transmit}}  
Mode  
Policy-Class-Map Config  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
465  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
policy-map  
This command establishes a new DiffServ policy. The <policyname>parameter is a  
case-sensitive alphanumeric string from 1 to 31 characters uniquely identifying the policy.  
The type of policy is specific to the inbound traffic direction as indicated by the parameter  
Note: The CLI mode is changed to Policy-Map Config when this command  
is successfully executed.  
Format  
Mode  
policy-map <policyname> [in|out]  
Global Config  
no policy-map  
This command eliminates an existing DiffServ policy. The <policyname>parameter is the  
name of an existing DiffServ policy. This command might be issued at any time. If the policy is  
referenced by one or more interface service attachments, this delete attempt fails.  
Format  
Mode  
no policy-map <policyname>  
Global Config  
policy-map rename  
This command changes the name of a DiffServ policy. The <policyname> is the name of  
an existing DiffServ class. The <newpolicyname> parameter is a case-sensitive  
alphanumeric string from 1 to 31 characters uniquely identifying the policy.  
Format  
Mode  
policy-map rename <policyname> <newpolicyname>  
Global Config  
DiffServ Service Commands  
Use the DiffServ service commands to assign a DiffServ traffic conditioning policy, which you  
specified by using the policy commands, to an interface in the incoming direction  
The service commands attach a defined policy to a directional interface. You can assign only  
one policy at any one time to an interface in the inbound direction. DiffServ is not used in the  
outbound direction.  
This set of commands consists of service addition/removal.  
The CLI command root is service-policy.  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
466  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
service-policy  
This command attaches a policy to an interface in the inbound direction. The  
<policyname> parameter is the name of an existing DiffServ policy. This command causes  
a service to create a reference to the policy.  
Note: This command effectively enables DiffServ on an interface in the  
inbound direction. There is no separate interface administrative  
'mode' command for DiffServ.  
Note: This command fails if any attributes within the policy definition  
exceed the capabilities of the interface. Once a policy is successfully  
attached to an interface, any attempt to change the policy definition,  
that would result in a violation of the interface capabilities, causes  
the policy change attempt to fail.  
Format  
Modes  
service-policy {in|out} <policymapname>  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
Note: Each interface can have one policy attached.  
no service-policy  
This command detaches a policy from an interface in the inbound direction. The  
<policyname>parameter is the name of an existing DiffServ policy.  
Note: This command causes a service to remove its reference to the  
policy. This command effectively disables DiffServ on an interface in  
the inbound direction. There is no separate interface administrative  
'mode' command for DiffServ.  
Format  
Modes  
no service-policy in <policymapname>  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
467  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
DiffServ Show Commands  
Use the DiffServ show commands to display configuration and status information for classes,  
policies, and services. You can display DiffServ information in summary or detailed formats.  
The status information is only shown when the DiffServ administrative mode is enabled.  
show class-map  
This command displays all configuration information for the specified class. The  
<class-name> is the name of an existing DiffServ class.  
Format  
Modes  
show class-map <class-name>  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
If the class-name is specified the following fields are displayed:  
Term  
Definition  
Class Name  
Class Type  
The name of this class.  
A class type of ‘all’ means every match criterion defined for the class is evaluated  
simultaneously and must all be true to indicate a class match.  
Class Layer3  
Protocol  
The Layer 3 protocol for this class. Possible values are IPv4 and IPv6.  
Match Criteria  
The Match Criteria fields are only displayed if they have been configured. Not all  
platforms support all match criteria values. They are displayed in the order entered by  
the user. The fields are evaluated in accordance with the class type. The possible Match  
Criteria fields are: Destination IP Address, Destination Layer 4 Port, Destination MAC  
Address, Ethertype, Source MAC Address, VLAN, Class of Service, Every, IP DSCP, IP  
Precedence, IP TOS, Protocol Keyword, Reference Class, Source IP Address, and  
Source Layer 4 Port.  
Values  
The values of the Match Criteria.  
If you do not specify the Class Name, this command displays a list of all defined DiffServ  
classes. The following fields are displayed:  
Term  
Definition  
Class Name  
The name of this class. (Note that the order in which classes are displayed is not  
necessarily the same order in which they were created.)  
Class Type  
A class type of ‘all’ means every match criterion defined for the class is evaluated  
simultaneously and must all be true to indicate a class match.  
Reference  
Class Name  
The name of an existing DiffServ class whose match conditions are being referenced by  
the specified class definition.  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
468  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show diffserv  
This command displays the DiffServ General Status Group information, which includes the  
current administrative mode setting as well as the current and maximum number of rows in  
each of the main DiffServ private MIB tables. This command takes no options.  
Format  
show diffserv  
Mode  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
DiffServ Admin mode  
The current value of the DiffServ administrative mode.  
Class Table Size  
Current /Max  
The current number of entries (rows) and the maximum allowed entries (rows) in  
the Class Table.  
Class Rule Table Size  
Current /Max  
The current number of entries (rows) and the maximum allowed entries (rows) in  
the Class Rule Table.  
Policy Table Size  
Current /Max  
The current number of entries (rows) and the maximum allowed entries (rows) in  
the Policy Table.  
Policy Instance Table  
Size Current /Max  
Current number of entries (rows) and the maximum allowed entries (rows) in  
the Policy Instance Table.  
Policy Attribute Table  
Size Current /Max  
Current number of entries (rows) and the maximum allowed entries (rows) in the  
Policy Attribute Table.  
Service Table Size  
Current /Max  
The current number of entries (rows) i and the maximum allowed entries (rows) in  
the Service Table.  
show policy-map  
This command displays all configuration information for the specified policy. The  
<policyname>is the name of an existing DiffServ policy.  
Format  
Mode  
show policy-map [policyname]  
Privileged EXEC  
If the Policy Name is specified the following fields are displayed:  
Term  
Definition  
Policy Name  
Policy Type  
The name of this policy.  
The policy type (Only inbound policy definitions are supported for this platform.)  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
469  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
The following information is repeated for each class associated with this policy (only the  
policy attributes that are configured are displayed):  
Term  
Definition  
Assign Queue  
Directs traffic stream to the specified QoS queue. This allows a traffic classifier to specify  
which one of the supported hardware queues are used for handling packets belonging to  
the class.  
Class Name  
The name of this class.  
Committed  
Burst Size (KB)  
The committed burst size, used in simple policing.  
CommittedRate  
(Kbps)  
The committed rate, used in simple policing,  
Conform Action  
The current setting for the action taken on a packet considered to conform to the policing  
parameters. This is not displayed if policing is not in use for the class under this policy.  
Conform COS  
The CoS mark value if the conform action is set-cos-transmit.  
The DSCP mark value if the conform action is set-dscp-transmit.  
Conform DSCP  
Value  
Conform IP  
Precedence  
Value  
The IP Precedence mark value if the conform action is set-prec-transmit.  
Drop  
Drop a packet upon arrival. This is useful for emulating access control list operation  
using DiffServ, especially when DiffServ and ACL cannot co-exist on the same interface.  
Mark CoS  
Mark IP DSCP  
The Class of Service value that is set in the 802.1p header of inbound packets. This is  
not displayed if the mark cos was not specified.  
The mark/re-mark value used as the DSCP for traffic matching this class. This is not  
displayed if mark ip description is not specified.  
Mark IP  
Precedence  
The mark/re-mark value used as the IP Precedence for traffic matching this class. This is  
not displayed if mark ip precedence is not specified.  
Mirror  
Copies a classified traffic stream to a specified egress port (physical port or LAG). This  
can occur in addition to any marking or policing action. It might also be specified along  
with a QoS queue assignment.  
Non-Conform  
Action  
The current setting for the action taken on a packet considered to not conform to the  
policing parameters. This is not displayed if policing not in use for the class under this  
policy.  
Non-Conform  
COS  
The CoS mark value if the non-conform action is set-cos-transmit.  
The DSCP mark value if the non-conform action is set-dscp-transmit.  
The IP Precedence mark value if the non-conform action is set-prec-transmit.  
Non-Conform  
DSCP Value  
Non-ConformIP  
Precedence  
Value  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
470  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Policing Style  
The style of policing, if any, used (simple).  
Redirect  
Forces a classified traffic stream to a specified egress port (physical or LAG). This can  
occur in addition to any marking or policing action. It might also be specified along with a  
QoS queue assignment.  
If the Policy Name is not specified this command displays a list of all defined DiffServ  
policies. The following fields are displayed:  
Term  
Definition  
Policy Name  
The name of this policy. (The order in which the policies are displayed is not necessarily  
the same order in which they were created.)  
Policy Type  
The policy type (Only inbound is supported).  
Class Members  
List of all class names associated with this policy.  
show diffserv service  
This command displays policy service information for the specified interface and direction.  
The <slot/port> parameter specifies a valid slot/port number for the system.  
Format  
Mode  
show diffserv service <slot/port> [in | out]  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
DiffServ Admin  
Mode  
The current setting of the DiffServ administrative mode. An attached policy is only in  
effect on an interface while DiffServ is in an enabled mode.  
Interface  
Direction  
Valid slot and port number separated by forward slashes.  
The traffic direction of this interface service.  
Operational  
Status  
The current operational status of this DiffServ service interface.  
Policy Name  
Policy Details  
The name of the policy attached to the interface in the indicated direction.  
Attached policy details, whose content is identical to that described for the show  
policy-map <policymapname> command (content not repeated here for brevity).  
show diffserv service brief  
This command displays all interfaces in the system to which a DiffServ policy has been  
attached. The inbound direction parameter is optional.  
Format  
Mode  
show diffserv service brief [in | out]  
Privileged EXEC  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
471  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
DiffServ Admin  
Mode  
The current setting of the DiffServ administrative mode. An attached policy is only active  
on an interface while DiffServ is in an enabled mode.  
The following information is repeated for interface and direction (only those interfaces  
configured with an attached policy are shown):  
Term  
Definition  
Interface  
Valid slot and port number separated by forward slashes.  
The traffic direction of this interface service.  
Direction  
OperStatus  
Policy Name  
The current operational status of this DiffServ service interface.  
The name of the policy attached to the interface in the indicated direction.  
show policy-map interface  
This command displays policy-oriented statistics information for the specified interface and  
direction. The <slot/port> parameter specifies a valid interface for the system.  
Note: This command is only allowed while the DiffServ administrative  
mode is enabled.  
Format  
Mode  
show policy-map interface <slot/port> [in | out]  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Interface  
Valid slot and port number separated by forward slashes.  
The traffic direction of this interface service.  
The current operational status of this DiffServ service interface.  
Direction  
Operational  
Status  
Policy Name  
The name of the policy attached to the interface in the indicated direction.  
The following information is repeated for each class instance within this policy:  
Term  
Definition  
Class Name  
The name of this class instance.  
In Discarded  
Packets  
A count of the packets discarded for this class instance for any reason due to DiffServ  
treatment of the traffic class.  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
472  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show service-policy  
This command displays a summary of policy-oriented statistics information for all interfaces  
in the specified direction.  
Format  
Mode  
show service-policy {in|out}  
Privileged EXEC  
The following information is repeated for each interface and direction (only those interfaces  
configured with an attached policy are shown):  
Term  
Definition  
Interface  
Valid slot and port number separated by forward slashes.  
The current operational status of this DiffServ service interface.  
Operational  
Status  
Policy Name  
The name of the policy attached to the interface.  
MAC Access Control List (ACL) Commands  
This section describes the commands you use to configure MAC ACL settings. MAC ACLs  
ensure that only authorized users have access to specific resources and block any  
unwarranted attempts to reach network resources.  
The following rules apply to MAC ACLs:  
The maximum number of ACLs you can create is hardware-dependent. The limit applies  
to all ACLs, regardless of type.  
The system supports only Ethernet II frame types.  
The maximum number of rules per MAC ACL is hardware-dependent.  
mac access-list extended  
This command creates a MAC access control list (ACL) identified by <name>, consisting of  
classification fields defined for the Layer 2 header of an Ethernet frame. The <name>  
parameter is a case-sensitive alphanumeric string from 1 to 31 characters uniquely  
identifying the MAC access list.  
If a MAC ACL by this name exists, this command enters Mac-Access-List config mode to  
allow updating the existing MAC ACL.  
Note: The CLI mode changes to Mac-Access-List Config mode when you  
successfully execute this command.  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
473  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Format  
Mode  
mac access-list extended <name>  
Global Config  
no mac access-list extended  
This command deletes a MAC ACL identified by <name>from the system.  
Format  
Mode  
no mac access-list extended <name>  
Global Config  
mac access-list extended rename  
This command changes the name of a MAC access control list (ACL). The <name>  
parameter is the name of an existing MAC ACL. The <newname>parameter is a  
case-sensitive alphanumeric string from 1 to 31 characters uniquely identifying the MAC  
access list.  
This command fails if a MAC ACL by the name <newname>exists.  
Format  
Mode  
mac access-list extended rename <name> <newname>  
Global Config  
{deny | permit} (MAC ACL)  
This command creates a new rule for the current MAC access list. Each rule is appended to  
the list of configured rules for the list.  
Note: The 'no' form of this command is not supported, since the rules  
within a MAC ACL cannot be deleted individually. Rather, the entire  
MAC ACL must be deleted and respecified.  
Note: An implicit 'deny all' MAC rule always terminates the access list.  
A rule might either deny or permit traffic according to the specified classification fields. At a  
minimum, the source and destination MAC value must be specified, each of which might be  
substituted using the keyword any to indicate a match on any value in that field. The  
remaining command parameters are all optional, but the most frequently used parameters  
appear in the same relative order as shown in the command format.  
The Ethertype might be specified as either a keyword or a four-digit hexadecimal value from  
0x0600-0xFFFF. The currently supported <ethertypekey>values are: appletalk, arp,  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
474  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
ibmsna, ipv4, ipv6, ipx, mplsmcast, mplsucast, netbios, novell, pppoe, rarp. Each of these  
translates into its equivalent Ethertype value(s).  
The time-range parameter allows imposing time limitation on the MAC ACL rule as  
defined by the parameter <time-range-name>. If a time range with the specified namedoes  
not exist and the MAC ACL containing this ACL rule is applied to an interface orbound to a  
VLAN, then the ACL rule is applied immediately. If a time range withspecified name exists  
and the MAC ACL containing this ACL rule is applied to aninterface or bound to a VLAN, then  
the ACL rule is applied when the time-range withspecified name becomes active. The ACL  
rule is removed when the time-range withspecified name becomes inactive.  
Ethertype Keyword  
appletalk  
arp  
Corresponding Value  
0x809B  
0x0806  
ibmsna  
ipv4  
0x80D5  
0x0800  
ipv6  
0x86DD  
ipx  
0x8037  
mplsmcast  
mplsucast  
netbios  
novell  
0x8848  
0x8847  
0x8191  
0x8137, 0x8138  
0x8863, 0x8864  
0x8035  
pppoe  
rarp  
The vlan and cos parameters refer to the VLAN identifier and 802.1p user priority fields,  
respectively, of the VLAN tag. For packets containing a double VLAN tag, this is the first (or  
outer) tag.  
The assign-queue parameter allows specification of a particular hardware queue for handling  
traffic that matches this rule. The allowed <queue-id>value is 0-(n-1), where n is the  
number of user configurable queues available for the hardware platform. The  
assign-queueparameter is valid only for a permitrule.  
Note: The special command form {deny | permit} any any is used to match  
all Ethernet layer 2 packets, and is the equivalent of the IP access  
list “match every” rule.  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
475  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Format  
Mode  
{deny|permit} {<srcmac> | any} {<dstmac> | any} [<ethertypekey> |  
<0x0600-0xFFFF>] [vlan {eq <0-4095>}] [cos <0-7>] [[log] [time-range  
<time-range-name>][assign-queue <queue-id>]] [{mirror | redirect}  
<slot/port>]  
Mac-Access-List Config  
mac access-group  
This command either attaches a specific MAC access control list (ACL) identified by <name>  
to an interface, or associates it with a VLAN ID, in a given direction. The <name>parameter  
must be the name of an existing MAC ACL.  
An optional sequence number might be specified to indicate the order of this mac access list  
relative to other mac access lists already assigned to this interface and direction. A lower  
number indicates higher precedence order. If a sequence number is already in use for this  
interface and direction, the specified mac access list replaces the currently attached mac  
access list using that sequence number. If the sequence number is not specified for this  
command, a sequence number that is one greater than the highest sequence number  
currently in use for this interface and direction is used.  
This command specified in Interface Config mode only affects a single interface, whereas the  
Global Config mode setting is applied to all interfaces. The VLAN keyword is only valid in the  
Global Config mode. The Interface Config mode command is available only on platforms that  
support independent per-port Class of Service queue configuration.  
An optional control-plane is specified to apply the MAC ACL on the CPU port. The control  
packets, like BPDU, are also dropped because of the implicit deny all rule added to the end of  
the list. To overcome this, permit rules must be added to allow the control packets.  
Note: The <out> option might or might not be available, depending on the  
platform.  
The control-plane keyword is available only in Global Config mode.  
Format  
Modes  
mac access-group <name> {{control-plane|in|out} vlan vlan-id  
{in|out}} [sequence <1-4294967295>]  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
476  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no mac access-group  
This command removes a MAC ACL identified by <name>from the interface in a given  
direction.  
Format  
Modes  
no mac access-group <name> {{control-plane|in|out} vlan vlan-id  
{in|out}}  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
show mac access-lists  
This command displays a MAC access list and all of the rules that are defined for the MAC  
ACL. Use the [name]parameter to identify a specific MAC ACL to display.  
Format  
Mode  
show mac access-lists [name]  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Rule Number  
The ordered rule number identifier defined within the MAC ACL.  
The action associated with each rule. The possible values are Permit or Deny.  
The source MAC address for this rule.  
Action  
Source MAC  
Address  
Destination  
MAC Address  
The destination MAC address for this rule.  
Ethertype  
VLAN ID  
COS  
The Ethertype keyword or custom value for this rule.  
The VLAN identifier value or range for this rule.  
The COS (802.1p) value for this rule.  
Log  
Displays when you enable logging for the rule.  
The queue identifier to which packets matching this rule are assigned.  
Assign Queue  
Mirror Interface  
The slot/port to which packets matching this rule are copied.  
The slot/port to which packets matching this rule are forwarded.  
Redirect  
Interface  
Time Range  
name  
Displays the name of the time-range if the MAC ACL rule has referenced a time range.  
Status (Active/Inactive) of the MAC ACL rule  
Rule Status  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
477  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
IP Access Control List (ACL) Commands  
This section describes the commands you use to configure IP ACL settings. IP ACLs ensure  
that only authorized users have access to specific resources and block any unwarranted  
attempts to reach network resources.  
The following rules apply to IP ACLs:  
Managed switch software does not support IP ACL configuration for IP packet fragments.  
The maximum number of ACLs you can create is hardware-dependent. The limit applies  
to all ACLs, regardless of type.  
The maximum number of rules per IP ACL is hardware-dependent.  
Wildcard masking for ACLs operates differently from a subnet mask. A wildcard mask is  
in essence the inverse of a subnet mask. With a subnet mask, the mask has ones (1's) in  
the bit positions that are used for the network address, and has zeros (0's) for the bit  
positions that are not used. In contrast, a wildcard mask has (0’s) in a bit position that  
must be checked. A ‘1’ in a bit position of the ACL mask indicates the corresponding bit  
can be ignored.  
access-list  
This command creates an IP access control list (ACL) that is identified by the access list  
number, which is 1-99 for standard ACLs or 100-199 for extended ACLs.  
IP Standard ACL:  
Format  
access-list<1-99> {deny | permit} {every | <srcip> <srcmask>} [log]  
[rate-limit <1-4294967295> <1-128>][assign-queue <queue-id>]  
[{mirror | redirect} <slot/port>]  
Mode  
Global Config  
IP Extended ACL:  
Format  
access-list <100-199> {deny | permit} {every | {{icmp | igmp | ip |  
tcp | udp | <number>} <srcip> <srcmask>[{eq {<portkey> | <0-65535>}  
<dstip> <dstmask> [{eq {<portkey>| <0-65535>}] [precedence  
<precedence> | tos <tos> <tosmask> | dscp <dscp>] [log] [rate-limit  
<1-4294967295> <1-128>] [assign-queue <queue-id>] [{mirror |  
redirect} <slot/port>]  
Mode  
Global Config  
Parameter  
Description  
<1-99> or <100-199>  
Range 1–99 is the access list number for an IP standard ACL.  
Range 100–199 is the access list number for an IP extended ACL.  
{deny | permit}  
every  
Specifies whether the IP ACL rule permits or denies an action.  
Match every packet  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
478  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Parameter  
Description  
{icmp | igmp | ip | tcp | udp  
| <number>}  
Specifies the protocol to filter for an extended IP ACL rule.  
<srcip> <srcmask>  
Specifies a source IP address and source netmask for match  
condition of the IP ACL rule.  
[{eq {<portkey> |  
<0-65535>}]  
Specifies the source layer 4-port match condition for the IP ACL rule.  
You can use the port number, which ranges from 0-65,535, or you  
specify the <portkey>, which can be one of the following  
keywords: domain, echo, ftp, ftpdata, http, smtp,  
snmp, telnet, tftp, and www-http. Each of these keywords  
translates into its equivalent port number, which is used as both the  
start and end of a port range.  
<dstip> <dstmask>  
Specifies a destination IP address and netmask for match condition  
of the IP ACL rule.  
[precedence <precedence> |  
tos <tos> <tosmask> | dscp  
<dscp>]  
Specifies the TOS for an IP ACL rule depending on a match of  
precedence or DSCP values using the parameters dscp,  
precedence, tos/tosmask.  
[log]  
Specifies that this rule is to be logged.  
rate-limit  
The user can specify a simple rate limiter for packets matching an  
ACL “permit” rule. The user needs to specify the burst size in kbytes  
and allowed rate of traffic in kbps. The conforming traffic is allowed  
to transmit, and non-conforming traffic is dropped. This action is  
ignored for any “deny” rule, since by definition matching packets are  
dropped.  
[assign-queue <queue-id>]  
Specifies the assign-queue, which is the queue identifier to which  
packets matching this rule are assigned.  
[{mirror | redirect}  
<slot/port>]  
Specifies the mirror or redirect interface which is the slot/port to  
which packets matching this rule are copied or forwarded,  
respectively.  
no access-list  
This command deletes an IP ACL that is identified by the parameter <accesslistnumber>  
from the system. The range for <accesslistnumber>1-99 for standard access lists and  
100-199 for extended access lists.  
Format  
Mode  
no access-list <accesslistnumber>  
Global Config  
ip access-list  
This command creates an extended IP access control list (ACL) identified by <name>,  
consisting of classification fields defined for the IP header of an IPv4 frame. The <name>  
parameter is a case-sensitive alphanumeric string from 1 to 31 characters uniquely  
identifying the IP access list.  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
479  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
If an IP ACL by this name exists, this command enters IPv4-Access_List config mode to allow  
updating the existing IP ACL.  
Note: The CLI mode changes to IPv4-Access-List Config mode when you  
successfully execute this command.  
Format  
Mode  
ip access-list <name>  
Global Config  
no ip access-list  
This command deletes the IP ACL identified by <name> from the system.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip access-list <name>  
Global Config  
ip access-list rename  
This command changes the name of an IP access control list (ACL). The <name> parameter  
is the names of an existing IP ACL. The <newname> parameter is a case-sensitive  
alphanumeric string from 1 to 31 characters uniquely identifying the IP access list.  
This command fails is an IP ACL by the name <newname> exists.  
Format  
Mode  
ip access-list rename <name> <newname>  
Global Config  
{deny | permit} (IP ACL)  
This command creates a new rule for the current IP access list. Each rule is appended to the  
list of configured rules for the list.  
Note: The “no” form of this command is not supported, since the rules  
within an IP ACL cannot be deleted individually. Rather, the entire IP  
ACL must be deleted and respecified.  
Note: An implicit “deny all” IP rule always terminates the access list.  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
480  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Note: The mirrorparameter allows traffic matching this rule to be copied  
to the specified <slot/port>, while the redirect parameter allows  
traffic matching this rule to be forwarded to the specified  
<slot/port>. The assign-queueand redirectparameters  
are valid only for a permitrule.  
A rule might either deny or permit traffic according to the specified classification fields. At a  
minimum, either every keyword or the protocol, source address, and destination address  
values must be specified. The source and destination IP address fields might be specified  
using the keyword ‘any’ to indicate a match on any value in that field. The remaining  
command parameters are all optional, but the most frequently used parameters appear in the  
same relative order as shown in the command format.  
The assign-queue parameter allows specification of a particular hardware queue for handling  
traffic that matches this rule. The allowed <queue-id>value is 0-(n-1), where n is the  
number of user configurable queues available for the hardware platform. The  
assign-queueparameter is valid only for a permitrule.  
The time-range parameter allows imposing time limitation on the IP ACL rule as defined by  
the parameter <time-range-name>. If a time range with the specified name does not exist  
and the IP ACL containing this ACL rule is applied to an interface or bound to a VLAN, then  
the ACL rule is applied immediately. If a time range with specified name exists and the IP  
ACL containing this ACL rule is applied to an interface or bound to a VLAN, then the ACL rule  
is applied when the time-range with specified name becomes active. The ACL rule is  
removed when the time-range with specified name becomes inactive.  
The user can specify a simple rate limiter for packets matching an ACL “permit” rule. The  
user needs to specify the burst size in kbytes and allowed rate of traffic in kbps. The  
conforming traffic is allowed to transmit, and non-conforming traffic is dropped. This action is  
ignored for any “deny” rule, since by definition matching packets are dropped.  
Format  
{deny | permit} {every | {{icmp | igmp | ip | tcp | udp | <number>}  
<srcip> <srcmask>[{eq {<portkey> | <0-65535>} <dstip> <dstmask> [{eq  
{<portkey>| <0-65535>}] [precedence <precedence> | tos <tos>  
<tosmask> | dscp <dscp>] [log] [rate-limit <1-4294967295> <1-128>]  
[timerange <time-range-name>] [assign-queue <queue-id>] [{mirror |  
redirect}  
[lag <lag-group-id> | <slot/port>]  
Mode  
Ipv4-Access-List Config  
ip access-group  
This command either attaches a specific IP ACL identified by <accesslistnumber>to an  
interface or associates with a VLAN ID in a given direction. The parameter <name>is the  
name of the access control list.  
An optional sequence number might be specified to indicate the order of this IP access list  
relative to other IP access lists already assigned to this interface and direction. A lower  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
481  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
number indicates higher precedence order. If a sequence number is already in use for this  
interface and direction, the specified access list replaces the currently attached IP access list  
using that sequence number. If the sequence number is not specified for this command, a  
sequence number that is one greater than the highest sequence number currently in use for  
this interface and direction is used.  
Note: The <out> option might not be available, depending on the platform.  
Default  
none  
Format  
ip access-group {<accesslistnumber>|<name>}  
{{control-plane|in|out}|vlan <vlan-id> {in|out}}[sequence  
<1-4294967295>]  
Modes  
• Interface Config  
• Global Config  
no ip access-group  
This command removes a specified IP ACL from an interface.  
Default  
none  
Format  
Mode  
no ip access-group <accesslistnumber> {{control-plane|in|out}|vlan  
<vlan-id> {in|out}}  
• Interface Config  
• Global Config  
acl-trapflags  
This command enables the ACL trap mode.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
acl-trapflags  
Global Config  
no acl-trapflags  
This command disables the ACL trap mode.  
Format  
Mode  
no acl-trapflags  
Global Config  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
482  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show ip access-lists  
This command displays an IP ACL <accesslistnumber>is the number used to identify  
the IP ACL.  
Format  
Mode  
show ip access-lists <accesslistnumber>  
Privileged EXEC  
Note: Only the access list fields that you configure are displayed.  
Term  
Definition  
Rule Number  
Action  
The number identifier for each rule that is defined for the IP ACL.  
The action associated with each rule. The possible values are Permit or Deny.  
Match All  
Indicates whether this access list applies to every packet. Possible values are True or  
False.  
Protocol  
The protocol to filter for this rule.  
The source IP address for this rule.  
Source IP  
Address  
Source IP Mask  
The source IP Mask for this rule.  
The source port for this rule.  
Source L4 Port  
Keyword  
Destination IP  
Address  
The destination IP address for this rule.  
The destination IP Mask for this rule.  
The destination port for this rule.  
Destination IP  
Mask  
Destination L4  
Port Keyword  
IP DSCP  
The value specified for IP DSCP.  
IP Precedence  
IP TOS  
The value specified IP Precedence.  
The value specified for IP TOS.  
Log  
Displays when you enable logging for the rule.  
The queue identifier to which packets matching this rule are assigned.  
The slot/port to which packets matching this rule are copied.  
The slot/port to which packets matching this rule are forwarded.  
Assign Queue  
Mirror Interface  
Redirect  
Interface  
Time Range  
Name  
Displays the name of the time-range if the ACL rule has referenced a time range.  
Status (Active/Inactive) of the ACL rule.  
Rule Status  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
483  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show access-lists  
This command displays IP ACLs, IPv6 ACLs, and MAC access control lists information for a  
designated interface and direction.  
Format  
show access-lists interface <slot/port> [in|out]  
Mode  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
ACL Type  
Type of access list (IP, IPv6, or MAC).  
ACL ID  
Access List name for a MAC or IPv6 access list or the numeric identifier for an IP access  
list.  
Sequence  
Number  
An optional sequence number might be specified to indicate the order of this access list  
relative to other access lists already assigned to this interface and direction. A lower  
number indicates higher precedence order. If a sequence number is already in use for  
this interface and direction, the specified access list replaces the currently attached  
access list using that sequence number. If the sequence number is not specified by the  
user, a sequence number that is one greater than the highest sequence number currently  
in use for this interface and direction is used. Valid range is (1–4,294,967,295).  
IPv6 Access Control List (ACL) Commands  
This section describes the commands you use to configure IPv6 ACL settings. IPv6 ACLs  
ensure that only authorized users have access to specific resources and block any  
unwarranted attempts to reach network resources.  
The following rules apply to IPv6 ACLs:  
The maximum number of ACLs you create is 100, regardless of type.  
The system supports only Ethernet II frame types.  
The maximum number of rules per IPv6 ACL is hardware-dependent.  
ipv6 access-list  
This command creates an IPv6 access control list (ACL) identified by <name>, consisting of  
classification fields defined for the IP header of an IPv6 frame. The <name>parameter is a  
case-sensitive alphanumeric string from 1 to 31 characters uniquely identifying the IPv6  
access list.  
If an IPv6 ACL by this name exists, this command enters IPv6-Access-List config mode to  
allow updating the existing IPv6 ACL.  
Note: The CLI mode changes to IPv6-Access-List Config mode when you  
successfully execute this command.  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
484  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Format  
Mode  
ipv6 access-list <name>  
Global Config  
no ipv6 access-list  
This command deletes the IPv6 ACL identified by <name>from the system.  
Format  
Mode  
no ipv6 access-list <name>  
Global Config  
ipv6 access-list rename  
This command changes the name of an IPv6 ACL. The <name>parameter is the name of an  
existing IPv6 ACL. The <newname>parameter is a case-sensitive alphanumeric string from  
1 to 31 characters uniquely identifying the IPv6 access list.  
This command fails is an IPv6 ACL by the name <newname>already exists.  
Format  
Mode  
ipv6 access-list rename <name> <newname>  
Global Config  
{deny | permit} (IPv6)  
This command creates a new rule for the current IPv6 access list. Each rule is appended to  
the list of configured rules for the list.  
Note: The ‘no’ form of this command is not supported, since the rules  
within an IPv6 ACL cannot be deleted individually. Rather, the entire  
IPv6 ACL must be deleted and respecified.  
Note: An implicit ‘deny all’ IPv6 rule always terminates the access list.  
A rule might either deny or permit traffic according to the specified classification fields. At a  
minimum, either the ‘everykeyword or the protocol, source address, and destination  
address values must be specified. The source and destination IPv6 address fields might be  
specified using the keyword ‘anyto indicate a match on any value in that field. The  
remaining command parameters are all optional, but the most frequently used parameters  
appear in the same relative order as shown in the command format.  
The assign-queue parameter allows specification of a particular hardware queue for handling  
traffic that matches this rule. The allowed <queue-id>value is 0-(n-1), where nis the  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
485  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
number of user configurable queues available for the hardware platform. The  
assign-queueparameter is valid only for a permit rule.  
The mirrorparameter allows the traffic matching this rule to be copied to the specified  
<slot/port>, while the redirect parameter allows the traffic matching this rule to be  
forwarded to the specified <slot/port>. The assign-queueand redirectparameters  
are only valid for a permitrule.  
The time-range parameter allows imposing time limitation on the IPv6 ACL rule as defined by  
the parameter <time-range-name>. If a time range with the specified name does not exist  
and the IPv6 ACL containing this ACL rule is applied to an interface or bound to a VLAN, then  
the ACL rule is applied immediately. If a time range with specified name exists and the IPv6  
ACL containing this ACL rule is applied to an interface or bound to a VLAN, then the ACL rule  
is applied when the time-range with specified name becomes active. The ACL rule is  
removed when the time-range with specified name becomes inactive.  
Format  
{deny | permit} {every | {{icmp | igmp | ipv6 | tcp | udp |  
<number>}[log] [timerange  
<time-range-name>] [assign-queue <queue-id>] [{mirror | redirect}  
<slot/port>]  
Mode  
IPv6-Access-List Config  
ipv6 traffic-filter  
This command either attaches a specific IPv6 ACL identified by <name>to an interface or  
associates with a VLAN ID in a given direction. The <name> parameter must be the name of  
an existing IPv6 ACL.  
An optional sequence number might be specified to indicate the order of this mac access list  
relative to other IPv6 access lists already assigned to this interface and direction. A lower  
number indicates higher precedence order. If a sequence number is already in use for this  
interface and direction, the specifiedIPv6 access list replaces the currently attached IPv6  
access list using that sequence number. If the sequence number is not specified for this  
command, a sequence number that is one greater than the highest sequence number  
currently in use for this interface and direction is used.  
This command specified in Interface Config mode only affects a single interface, whereas the  
Global Config mode setting is applied to all interfaces. The vlankeyword is only valid in the  
Global Config mode. The Interface Config mode command is only available on platforms that  
support independent per-port Class of Service queue configuration.  
Note: You should be aware that the <out> option may or may not be  
available, depending on the platform.  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
486  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Format  
Modes  
ipv6 traffic-filter <name> {{control-plane|in|out}|vlan <vlan-id>  
{in|out}} [sequence <1-4294967295>]  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
no ipv6 traffic-filter  
This command removes an IPv6 ACL identified by <name>from the interface(s) in a given  
direction.  
Format  
Modes  
no ipv6 traffic-filter <name> {{control-plane|in|out}|vlan <vlan-id>  
{in|out}}  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
show ipv6 access-lists  
This command displays an IPv6 access list and all of the rules that are defined for the IPv6  
ACL. Use the [name]parameter to identify a specific IPv6 ACL to display.  
Format  
Mode  
show ipv6 access-lists [name]  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Rule Number  
The ordered rule number identifier defined within the IPv6 ACL.  
The action associated with each rule. The possible values are Permit or Deny.  
Action  
Match All  
Indicates whether this access list applies to every packet. Possible values are True or  
False.  
Protocol  
The protocol to filter for this rule.  
The source IP address for this rule.  
Source IP  
Address  
Source L4 Port  
Keyword  
The source port for this rule.  
Destination IP  
Address  
The destination IP address for this rule.  
The destination port for this rule.  
Destination L4  
Port Keyword  
IP DSCP  
The value specified for IP DSCP.  
Flow Label  
Log  
The value specified for IPv6 Flow Label.  
Displays when you enable logging for the rule.  
The queue identifier to which packets matching this rule are assigned.  
Assign Queue  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
487  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Mirror Interface  
The slot/port to which packets matching this rule are copied.  
The slot/port to which packets matching this rule are forwarded.  
Redirect  
Interface  
Time Range  
Name  
Displays the name of the time-range if the IPv6 ACL rule has referenced a time range.  
Status(Active/Inactive) of the IPv6 ACL rule.  
Rule Status  
Time Range Commands for Time-Based ACLs  
Time-based ACLs allow one or more rules within an ACL to be based on time. Each ACL rule  
within an ACL, except for the implicit deny allrule, can be configured to be active and  
operational only during a specific time period. The time range commands allow you to define  
specific times of the day and week to implement time-based ACLs. The time range is  
identified by a name and can then be referenced by an ACL rule defined with in an ACL.  
time-range  
Use this command to create a time range identified by name, consisting of one absolute time  
entry and/or one or more periodic time entries. The nameparameter is a case-sensitive,  
alphanumeric string from 1 to 31 characters that uniquely identifies the time range. An  
alpha-numeric string is defined as consisting of only alphabetic, numeric, dash, underscore,  
or space characters. If a time range by this name exists, this command enters Time-Range  
config mode to allow updating the time range entries  
Note: When you successfully execute this command, the CLI mode  
changes to Time-Range Config mode.  
Format  
Mode  
time-range <name>  
Global Config  
no time-range  
Use this command to delete a time-range identified by name.  
Format  
Mode  
no time-range <name>  
Global Config  
absolute  
Use this command to add an absolute time entry to a time range. Only one absolute time  
entry is allowed per time-range. The timeparameter is based on the currently configured  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
488  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
time zone. The [start time date]parameters indicate the time and date at which the  
configuration that referenced the time range starts going into effect. The time is expressed in  
a 24-hour clock, in the form of hours:minutes. For example, 8:00 is 8:00 am and 20:00 is 8:00  
pm. The date is expressed in the format day month year. If no start time and date are  
specified, the configuration statement is in effect immediately. The [end time date]  
parameters indicate the time and date at which the configuration that referenced the time  
range is no longer in effect. The end time and date must be after the start time and date. If no  
end time and date are specified, the configuration statement is in effect indefinitely.  
Format  
absolute {[start time date] [end time date]}  
Mode  
Time-Range Config  
no absolute  
Use this command to delete the absolute time entry in the time range.  
Format  
no absolute  
Mode  
Time-Range Config  
periodic  
Use this command to add a periodic time entry to a time range. The timeparameter is based  
off the currently configured time zone. The first occurrence of the days-of-the-week  
argument is the starting day(s) from which the configuration that referenced the time range  
starts going into effect. The second occurrence is the ending day or days from which the  
configuration that referenced the time range is no longer in effect. If the end days-of-the-week  
are the same as the start, they can be omitted This argument can be any single day or  
combinations of days: Monday, Tuesday, Wednesday, Thursday, Friday, Saturday, Sunday.  
Other possible values are:  
daily—Monday through Sunday  
weekdays—Monday through Friday  
weekend—Saturday and Sunday  
If the ending days of the week are the same as the starting days of the week, they can be  
omitted. The first occurrence of the time argument is the starting hours:minutes which the  
configuration that referenced the time range starts going into effect. The second occurrence  
is the ending hours:minutes at which the configuration that referenced the time range is no  
longer in effect. The hours:minutes are expressed in a 24-hour clock. For example, 8:00 is  
8:00 am and 20:00 is 8:00 pm  
The frequency is how often this periodic entry will become active. If the value is set to 0, the  
timer schedule will be treated as absolute.  
Format  
Mode  
periodic <frequency> {days-of-the-week time} to {[days-of-the-week] time}  
Time-Range Config  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
489  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no periodic  
Use this command to delete a periodic time entry from a time range.  
Format  
Mode  
no periodic <frequency>{days-of-the-week time} to {[days-of-the-week] time}  
Time-Range Config  
periodic {start|end} time  
Use this command to configure the start/end time for the time-range.  
Format  
Mode  
periodic {start|end} time  
Time-Range Config  
show time-range  
Use this command to display a time range and all the absolute/periodic time entries that are  
defined for the time range. Use the name parameter to identify a specific time range to  
display. When name is not specified, all the time ranges defined in the system are displayed.  
Format  
Mode  
show time-range  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Number of Time  
Ranges  
Number of time ranges configured in the system.  
Time Range Name  
Time Range Status  
Absolute start  
Absolute end  
Name of the time range.  
Status of the time range (active/inactive).  
Start time and day for absolute time entry.  
End time and day for absolute time entry.  
Number of periodic entries in a time-range.  
Start time and day for periodic entry.  
End time and day for periodic entry.  
Periodic Entries  
Periodic start  
Periodic end  
AutoVOIP  
AutoVoIP detects the VoIP streams and put the VoIP streams in the specific VLAN (auto-voip  
VLAN) and provides higher Class of Service to the VoIP streams automatically (both data  
and signaling). It detects the VoIP streams in two modes.  
Protocol-based Auto VoIP  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
490  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
In a VoIP system, various signaling protocols are used to establish the connection between  
two VoIP devices. The supported signaling protocols are SIP, H.323, and SCCP.  
OUI-based Auto VoIP  
The OUI-based Auto VoIP feature prioritizes VoIP packets based on the OUI bytes in the  
source MAC address. A default list of OUIs is maintained. User is also allowed to configure  
OUIs that need prioritization apart from the default OUI list. Up to 128 OUIs are allowed on  
the device or system, including the default OUIs.  
Note: If voice VLAN and Auto-VoIP are enabled at the same time, one of  
them is operational. If the connected phone is LLDP-MED capable,  
voice VLAN has precedence over the Auto VoIP and Auto VoIP is  
operational if the phone does not support LLDP-MED.  
auto-voip {protocol-based | oui-based}  
This command is used to configure auto VoIP mode. The supported modes are  
protocol-based and oui-based. Protocol-based auto VoIP prioritizes the voice data based on  
the layer 4 port used for the voice session. OUI-based auto VOIP prioritizes the phone traffic  
based on the known OUI of the phone.  
Format  
Mode  
auto-voip {protocol-based | oui-based}  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
Default  
oui-based  
no auto-voip {protocol-based | oui-based}  
This command is used to set default mode.  
Format  
Mode  
no auto-voip {protocol-based | oui-based}  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
auto-voip oui  
This command is used to configure an OUI for Auto VoIP. The traffic from the configured OUI  
will get the highest priority over the other traffic.  
Format  
Mode  
auto-voip oui <oui-prefix> oui-desc <string>  
Global Config  
Default  
A list of known OUIs is present  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
491  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no auto-voip oui  
This command is to delete already configured OUI.  
Format  
Mode  
no auto-voip oui <oui-prefix>  
Global Config  
auto-voip vlan  
This command is used to configure the global Auto VoIP VLAN id. The VLAN behavior is  
depend on the configured auto VoIP mode.  
Format  
Mode  
auto-voip vlan <vlanid>  
Global Config  
Default  
None  
no auto-voip vlan  
This command is used to set the auto-voip VLAN to the default 2.  
Format  
Mode  
no auto-voip vlan  
Global Config  
auto-voip oui-based priority  
This command is used to configure the global OUI based auto VoIP priority. If the phone OUI  
is matches one of the configured OUI, the priority of traffic from the phone is changed to OUI  
priority configured through this command.  
Format  
Mode  
auto-voip oui-based priority <priority-value>  
Global Config  
Default  
Highest available priority  
no auto-voip oui-based priority  
This command is used to set the priority to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no auto-voip oui-based priority <priority-value>  
Global Config  
auto-voip protocol-based {remark | traffic-class}  
This command is used to configure the global protocol based auto-VoIP remarking  
priority/traffic-class. If the remark priority is configured, the voice data of the session is  
remarked with the priority configured through this command.  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
492  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Note: The administrator has to enable tagging on auto-VoIP-enabled ports  
to remark the voice data when it is egressed.  
Format  
Mode  
auto-voip protocol-based {remark <remark-priority> | traffic-class  
<tc>}  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
Default  
Traffic-class 7  
no auto-voip protocol-based {remark | traffic-class}  
This command is used to set the traffic-class to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no auto-voip protocol-based {remark <remark- priority> |  
traffic-class <tc>}  
• Global Config  
• Interface Config  
show auto-voip  
Use this command to display the auto VoIP settings on the interface or interfaces of the switch.  
Format  
Mode  
show auto-voip {protocol-based|oui-based} interface {slot/port|all}  
Privileged EXEC  
Field  
VoIP  
Description  
The global VoIP VLAN ID.  
Prioritize Type  
Class Value  
The type of prioritization used on voice traffic.  
If the Prioritization Type is configured as traffic-class, this value is the  
queue value.  
If the Prioritization Type is configured as remark, this value is 802.1p  
priority used to remark the voice traffic.  
Priority  
The 802.1p priority. This field is valid for OUI auto VoIP.  
The Auto VoIP mode on the interface.  
AutoVoIPMode  
Example 1: The following shows an example of a CLI display output for the command.  
(switch)# show auto-voip protocol-based interface all  
VoIP VLAN Id................................... 2  
Prioritization Type............................ traffic-class  
Class Value.................................... 7  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
493  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Interface Auto VoIP Operational Status  
Mode  
--------- -------------- ------------------  
0/1  
0/2  
0/3  
0/4  
Disabled  
Disabled  
Disabled  
Disabled  
Down  
Down  
Down  
Down  
Example: The following shows an example of a CLI display output for the command.  
(Netgear Switch)# show auto-voip oui-based interface all  
VoIP VLAN Id................................... 2  
Priority....................................... 7  
Interface Auto VoIP Operational Status  
Mode  
--------- -------------- ------------------  
0/1  
0/2  
0/3  
0/4  
0/5  
Disabled  
Disabled  
Disabled  
Disabled  
Disabled  
Down  
Down  
Down  
Down  
Down  
show auto-voip oui-table  
This command lists all of the configured OUIs.  
Format  
Mode  
show auto-voip oui-table  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
OUI  
Definition  
OUI of the source MAC address  
Default or Configured entry.  
Description of the OUI  
Status  
OUI Description  
Example: show auto-voip oui-table  
OUI  
Status  
Description  
---------  
00:01:E3  
00:03:6B  
00:01:01  
----------  
Default  
Default  
---------  
SIEMENS  
CISCO1  
Configured  
VoIP phone  
iSCSI Commands  
The tasks involved in providing automated QoS preferential treatment of iSCSI flows can be  
divided into the following categories:  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
494  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Detecting the establishment and termination of iSCSI sessions and connections by  
snooping packets used in the iSCSI protocol.  
Maintaining a database of currently active iSCSI sessions and connections to store data  
about the participants. This allows the formulation of classifier rules giving the data  
packets for the session the desired QoS treatment.  
Installing and removing classifier rule sets as needed for the iSCSI session traffic.  
Monitoring activity in the iSCSI sessions to allow for aging out session entries if the  
session termination packets are not received.  
The means of detecting the establishment and termination of iSCSI sessions is  
accomplished by installing classifier rules to trap iSCSI protocol packets to the CPU for  
examination. This protocol uses well-known TCP ports for initiators to contact targets with  
3260 and 860. Additional port numbers or “port number/target IP address” can also be  
configured for monitoring if an installation uses ports other than the well-known ports. The  
well-known ports are configured as part of the default configuration of the component and  
can be removed if desired by the user.  
iscsi enable  
The iscsi enable Global Configuration mode command globally enables iSCSI awareness.  
Format  
iscsi enable  
Global Config  
Disabled  
Mode  
Default  
no iscsi enable  
This command is to disable iSCSI awareness use the no form of this command. When User  
uses this command, iSCSI resources will be released.  
Format  
Mode  
no iscsi enable  
Global Config  
Disabled  
Default  
iscsi target port  
This command configures iSCSI port/s, target addresses, and names.  
Note: When working with private iSCSI ports (not IANA assigned iSCSI  
ports 3260/860), it is recommended to specify the target IP address  
as well, so the switch will only snoop frames with which the TCP  
destination port is one of the configured TCP ports, and the  
destination IP is the target’s IP address. This way the CPU is not to  
be falsely loaded by non-iSCSI flows (if by chance other applications  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
495  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
also choose to use these {unreserved} ports).  
When a port is already defined and not bound to an IP, and the User  
wants to bind it to an IP, the User should first remove it by using the  
no form of the command and then add it again, this time together  
with the relevant IP.  
Target names are only for display when using show iscsi command.  
These names are not use to match (or for doing any sanity check)  
with the iSCSI session information acquired by snooping.  
Maximum of 16 TCP ports can be configured either bound to IP or  
not.  
Format  
iscsi target port tcp-port-1 [tcp-port-2.… tcp-port-8] [address  
ip-address] [name targetname]  
Mode  
Global Config  
Default  
3260 and 860, but they can be removed as any other configured target  
Term  
Definition  
tcp-port  
TCP port number or list of TCP port numbers on which iSCSI target/s listen to  
requests. Up to 16 TCP ports can be defined in the system in one command or by  
using multiple commands.  
ip-address  
targetname  
IP address of the iSCSI target. When the no form is used, and the tcp port to be  
deleted is one bound to a specific IP address, the address field must be present.  
iSCSI name of the iSCSI target. The name can be statically configured; however, it can  
be obtained from iSNS or from sendTargets response. The initiator must present both  
its iSCSI Initiator Name and the iSCSI Target Name to which it wishes to connect in the  
first login request of a new session or connection.  
no iscsi target port  
This command is to delete iSCSI port/s, target, use the no form of this command.  
Format  
Mode  
no iscsi target port tcp-port-1 [tcp-port-2.… tcp-port-8] [address  
ip-address]  
Global Config  
iscsi cos  
The iscsi cos Global Configuration mode command sets the Quality of Service profile that will  
be applied to iSCSI flows.  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
496  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Note: SCSI flows are assigned by default to the highest VPT/DSCP  
mapped to the highest queue not used for stack management or  
voice VLAN. The user should also take care of configuring the  
relevant Class of Service parameters for the queue in order to  
complete the setting.  
Setting the VPT/DSCP sets the QoS profile which determines the  
egress queue to which the frame is mapped. The switch default  
setting for egress queues scheduling is Weighted Round Robin  
(WRR).  
The user might complete the QoS setting by configuring the relevant  
ports to work in other scheduling and queue management modes via  
the Class of Service settings. Depending on the platform, these  
choices might include strict priority for the queue used for iSCSI  
traffic. The downside of strict priority is that, in certain circumstances  
(under heavy high priority traffic), other lower priority traffic might get  
starved. In WRR the queue to which the flow is assigned to can be  
set to get the required percentage.  
Format  
Mode  
iscsi cos traffic-class {vpt <vpt> | dscp <dscp>} [remark]  
Global Config  
Term  
Definition  
traffic-class  
The traffic class used for assigning iSCSI traffic to a queue.  
The VLAN Priority Tag or DSCP to assign iSCSI session packets.  
Mark the iSCSI frames with the configured VPT/DSCP when egressing the switch.  
vpt/dscp  
remark  
no iscsi cos  
This command is to set the Quality of Service profile of SCSI flows to default.  
Format  
Mode  
no iscsi cos  
Global Config  
iscsi aging time  
The iscsi aging time Global Configuration mode command sets aging time for iSCSI  
sessions.  
Behavior when changing aging time:  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
497  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
When aging time is increased - Current sessions will be timed out according to the new  
value.  
When aging time is decreased - Any sessions that have been dormant for a time  
exceeding the new setting will be immediately deleted from the table. All other sessions  
will continue to be monitored against the new time-out value.  
Format  
Mode  
iscsi aging time <time>  
Global Config  
Default  
5 minutes  
Term  
Definition  
time  
The number in minutes a session is not active prior to its removal. (Range: 1-43,200)  
no iscsi aging time  
This command is to reset the aging time to the default.  
Format  
Mode  
no iscsi aging time  
Global Config  
show iscsi  
This command displays the iSCSI settings.  
Format  
Mode  
show iscsi  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Example:  
The following example displays the iSCSI settings.  
Console # show iscsi  
iSCSI enabled  
iSCSI vpt is 5, remark  
Session aging time: 60 min  
Maximum number of sessions is 256  
-----------------------------------------------------------  
iSCSI targets and TCP ports:  
---------------------------  
TCP Port Target IP Address Name  
860  
3260  
5000  
30001  
30033  
30033  
172.16.1.1  
172.16.1.10  
172.16.1.25  
iqn.1993-11.com.disk-vendor:diskarrays.sn.45678.tape:sys1.xyz  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
498  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show iscsi sessions  
The show iscsi sessions Privileged EXEC mode command displays the iSCSI sessions.  
Format  
show iscsi sessions [detailed]  
Mode  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Default  
If not specified, sessions are displayed in short mode (not detailed)  
Term  
Definition  
detailed  
Displayed list is detailed when this option is used.  
Example:  
The following example displays the iSCSI sessions.  
Console # show iscsi sessions  
Target: iqn.1993-11.com.disk-vendor:diskarrays.sn.45678  
-----------------------------------------------------------  
Initiator: iqn.1992-04.com.os-vendor.plan9:cdrom.12  
ISID: 11  
Initiator: iqn.1995-05.com.os-vendor.plan9:cdrom.10  
ISID: 222  
-----------------------------------------------------------  
Target: iqn.103-1.com.storage-vendor:sn.43338.  
storage.tape:sys1.xyz  
Session 3:  
Initiator: iqn.1992-04.com.os-vendor.plan9:cdrom.12  
Session 4:  
Initiator: iqn.1995-05.com.os-vendor.plan9:cdrom.10  
-----------------------------------------------------------  
Console# show iscsi sessions detailed  
Target: iqn.1993-11.com.disk-vendor:diskarrays.sn.45678  
-----------------------------------------------------------  
Session 1:  
Initiator: iqn.1992-04.com.os  
vendor.plan9:cdrom.12.storage:sys1.xyz  
-----------------------------------------------------------  
Time started: 17-Jul-2008 10:04:50  
Time for aging out: 10 min  
ISID: 11  
Initiator  
IP address  
172.16.1.3  
172.16.1.4  
172.16.1.5  
Session 2:  
Initiator  
TCP port  
49154  
49155  
49156  
Target  
IP address  
172.16.1.20 30001  
172.16.1.21 30001  
172.16.1.22 30001  
Target  
IP port  
-----------------------------------------------------------  
Initiator: iqn.1995-05.com.os-vendor.plan9:cdrom.10  
Time started: 17-Aug-2008 21:04:50  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
499  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Time for aging out: 2 min  
ISID: 22  
Initiator  
IP address  
Initiator  
TCP port  
Target  
IP address  
Target  
IP port  
172.16.1.30 49200  
172.16.1.30 49201  
172.16.1.20 30001  
172.16.1.21 30001  
Quality of Service (QoS) Commands  
500  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9.  
Power over Ethernet (PoE) Commands  
9
This chapter contains the following sections:  
About PoE  
Power over Ethernet describes a technology to pass electrical power safely along with data  
on existing Ethernet cabling. The PSE or power supply equipment is the device or switch that  
delivers electrical power, and the PD or powered device is the end device that powers up  
through the power delivered along the Ethernet cable.  
This technology is governed by two standards:  
IEEE 802.3af-2003. This is the original standard, also known as the low-power standard,  
which mandates delivery of up to 15.4 watts by the PSE. Because of power dissipation,  
only 12.95 watts are assured to be available at the powered device (PD). The PD needs  
to be designed so that it can accept power over Ethernet cabling. Category 3 cables can  
be used to deliver power to the PD. However, with the advent of 802.11n, the newer  
wireless APs required more power. To account for this, a newer standard was developed  
in 2009, known as 802.3at.  
IEEE 802.3at-2009. This is the newer standard, also known as PoE+. This is also known  
as the high-power standard, which mandates delivery of up to 34.2 watts by the PSE.  
Because of power dissipation, PoE+ provides only a maximum of 25.5 watts at the  
powered device. Some PSEs can provide up to 51 watts. Before this standard became  
available in 2009, the industry started using different implementations to allow for more  
power. All these needed to be brought under the purview of the newer 802.3at standard.  
501  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
PoE Commands  
poe  
Use this command to enable the Power over Ethernet (PoE) functionality on a global basis or per  
interface.  
Format  
Mode  
poe  
Global Config  
Interface Config  
Default  
enabled  
no poe  
Use this command to disable the Power over Ethernet (PoE) functionality on a global basis or per  
interface.  
Format  
Mode  
no poe  
Global Config  
Interface Config  
poe detection  
Use this command to configure the detection type on a global basis or per interface. It is used to  
configure which types of PDs will be detected and powered by the switch. There are three  
options:  
ieee—Detect resistive-type devices (IEEE standard)  
pre-ieee—Legacy capacitive detection only (nonstandard)  
auto—Perform resistive detection first (IEEE standard) and capacitive detection  
(pre-IEEE standard)  
Format  
Mode  
poe detection { ieee | pre-ieee | auto}  
Global Config  
Interface Config  
Default  
auto  
Power over Ethernet (PoE) Commands  
502  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no poe detection  
Use this command to set the detection mode to the default on a global basis or per interface.  
Format  
Mode  
no poe detection  
Global Config  
Interface Config  
poe high-power  
Use this command to switch a port from 802.3af mode to high-power mode. This mode is used to  
power up devices that require more power than the current IEEE 802.3af power (more than  
12.95 watts at the PD). There are three options:  
legacy—Use this mode if the device can power up (more than 12.95 watts) with higher  
current and it cannot identify itself as a Class 4 device.  
Pre-dot3at—Use this mode if the device cannot identify itself as a Class 4 device and it  
does not have LLDP support.  
Dot3at—Use this mode if the device is a Class 4 device capable of figuring out power  
requirements through 2-event classification or LLDP.  
Format  
Mode  
poe high-power {legacy | pre-dot3at | dot3at}  
Interface Config  
dot3at  
Default  
no poe high-power  
Use this command to disable the high-power mode. The port will support only IEEE 902.3af  
devices.  
This command works on a global basis or per interface.  
Format  
Mode  
no poe high-power  
Interface Config  
poe power limit  
Use this command to configure the type of power limit for a port. If the power limit type is  
“user-defined,” the command also allows you to configure a maximum power limit.  
There are three options:  
class-based—Allows the port to draw up to the maximum power based on the  
classification of the device connected.  
none—Allows the port to draw up to Class 0 maximum power if it is in low-power mode  
and up to Class 4 maximum power if it is in high-power mode.  
Power over Ethernet (PoE) Commands  
503  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
user-defined—Allows you to define the maximum power to the port. This can be a  
value from 3 through 32 watts.  
Format  
poe power limit { class-based | none | user-defined [<3000 - 32000>] }  
Mode  
Global Config  
Interface Config  
Default  
User-defined, with a maximum of 30 watts  
no poe power limit  
Use this command to set the power limit type to the default. It also sets the maximum power limit  
to the default if the power limit type is user-defined.  
Format  
Mode  
no poe power limit [user-defined]  
Global Config  
Interface Config  
poe power management  
Use this command to configure the power management mode based on each individual PoE unit  
or on all PoE units.  
Both the power management modes mentioned here will power up a device based on first come,  
first served. When the available power is less than the power limit defined on a port, no more  
power will be delivered.  
Static and dynamic modes differ in how the available power is calculated, as follows:  
Static Power Management  
Available power = power limit of the source - total allocated power  
Where total allocated power is calculated as the power limit configured on the port.  
Dynamic Power Management  
Available power = power limit of the source - total allocated power  
Where total allocated power is calculated as the amount of power consumed by the port.  
For example:  
Assume that the power limit of the source is 300 watts. One port is powered up and is drawing 3  
watts of power. The power limit defined on the port is user-defined as 15 watts. In this case, the  
available power for static and dynamic would be as follows:  
Static Power Management  
Available power = 300 watts - 15 watts = 285 watts  
Power over Ethernet (PoE) Commands  
504  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Dynamic Power Management  
Available power = 300 watts - 3 watts = 297 watts  
Format  
Mode  
poe power management {<unit>|all} {dynamic | static}  
Global Config  
dynamic  
Default  
no poe power management  
Use this command to set the power management mode to the default.  
Format  
Mode  
no poe power management {<unit>|all}  
Global Config  
poe priority  
Use this command to configure the priority on a specific port. This is used for power  
management purposes. The switch might not be able to supply power to all connected devices,  
so the port priority is used to determine which ports will supply power if adequate power capacity  
is not available for all enabled ports. For ports that have the same priority level, the lower  
numbered port will have higher priority. There are three options:  
Crit—Critical priority  
High—High priority  
Low—Low priority  
Format  
Mode  
poe priority { Crit | High | Low }  
Global Config  
Interface Config  
Default  
low  
no poe priority  
Use this command to set the priority to the default.  
Format  
Mode  
no poe priority  
Global Config  
Interface Config  
poe reset  
Use this command to reset the PoE state of every port (in global mode) or a specific port (in  
interface mode). When the PoE port status is shown to be in an error state, this command can be  
used to reset the PoE port. The command can also reset the power-delivering ports. Note that  
Power over Ethernet (PoE) Commands  
505  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
this command takes effect only once after it is executed and cannot be saved across power  
cycles.  
Format  
Mode  
poe reset  
Global Config  
Interface Config  
poe timer schedule name  
Use this command to allow you to attach a timer schedule to a PoE port.  
You can define a time schedule using the existing time range commands. This schedule has start  
and stop times. When this timer schedule is applied to a PoE-enabled port, the capability of the  
port to deliver power is affected. At the scheduled start time, the PoE port is disabled such that it  
cannot deliver any power. At the scheduled stop time, the PoE port is reenabled so that it can  
deliver power.  
Note: For information about creating a timer schedule, see Time Range  
Format  
Mode  
poe timer schedule <name>  
Interface Config  
Power over Ethernet (PoE) Commands  
506  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no poe timer schedule name  
Use this command to detach the schedule from the port.  
Format  
Mode  
no poe timer schedule  
Interface Config  
poe usagethreshold  
Use this command to set a threshold (as a percentage) for the total amount of power that can be  
delivered by the switch. For example, if the switch can deliver up to a maximum of 300 watts, a  
usage threshold of 90% ensures that only 270 watts are used for delivering power to devices.  
This ensures that more power is not drawn than the switch can provide.  
When the usage threshold is set, all the PDs are brought down and then brought back up. If the  
consumed power is less than the threshold power (in the preceding case, 270 watts), then the  
devices continue to power up. If the consumed power is 269 watts or less, the next device is  
powered up. The moment consumed power exceeds the threshold power (270 watts), no other  
devices can power up.  
This command allows you to set the usage threshold based on each individual PoE unit or all  
PoE units.  
Format  
Mode  
poe usagethreshold {<unit>|all} <1-99>  
Global Config  
90  
Default  
no poe usagethreshold  
Use this command to set the usage threshold to a default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no poe usagethreshold {<unit>|all}  
Global Config  
poe traps  
Use this command to enable logging of specific PoE-related events, such as a PoE port  
powering a device, the threshold being exceeded, and so on.  
Format  
Mode  
poe traps  
Global Config  
Enable  
Default  
Power over Ethernet (PoE) Commands  
507  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no poe traps  
Use this command to disable logging the PoE traps.  
Format  
Mode  
no poe traps  
Global Config  
show poe  
Use this command to get global information regarding the PoE status.  
Format  
Mode  
show poe  
Privileged EXEC  
User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Firmware Version The firmware version of the PoE controller on the switch.  
PSE Main  
Indicates the status of the PoE controller:  
Operational Status  
• ON—Indicates that the PoE controller is actively delivering power.  
• OFF—Indicates that the PoE controller is not delivering power.  
• FAULTY—Indicates that the PoE controller is not functioning.  
Total Power (Main Indicates the maximum amount of power that can be delivered by this PoE unit when  
AC) on system power.  
Total Power (RPS) Indicates the maximum amount of power that can be delivered by this PoE unit when  
on RPS.  
Total Power (PD)  
Power Source  
Indicates the maximum amount of power that can be delivered by this PoE unit when  
on the PD source. This field is applicable only for the GSM5212P.  
Indicates the power source being used: main AC, RPS, or PD. If PD is used as a  
source, “PD <portNo>” is displayed.  
Threshold Power System can power up one port, if consumed power is less than this power. That is,  
the consumed power can be between the total power and threshold power values.  
The threshold power value is effected by changing the system usage threshold.  
Total Power  
Consumed  
Indicates the total amount of power being delivered to all the devices plugged into the  
switch.  
Usage Threshold Indicates the usage threshold level.  
Power  
Indicates the management mode used by the PoE controller.  
Management  
Mode  
Auto Reset Mode Indicates whether the PoE ports will be automatically reset in case of an error on a  
port.  
Traps  
Configures the traps.  
Power over Ethernet (PoE) Commands  
508  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Example:  
(switch) #show poe  
Firmware Version............................... 1.0.0.2  
PSE Main Operational Status.................... ON  
Total Power (Main AC).......................... 380  
Total Power (RPS).............................. 300  
Total Power (PD) .............................. 25  
Power Source................................... Main AC  
Threshold Power................................ 342  
Total Power Consumed........................... 7  
Usage Threshold................................ 90  
Power Management Mode.......................... Dynamic  
Configure port Auto Reset Mode................. Disable  
Traps.......................................... Enable  
show poe port configuration  
Use this command to see how the PoE ports are configured. You can display information based  
on each individual port or all the ports collectively.  
Format  
Mode  
show poe port configuration [<port> |All]  
Privileged EXEC  
User EXEC  
(Switch) #show poe port configuration all  
Admin  
Mode Priority Limit  
(W)  
------ ------- -------- ------ -------------- ------------- ---------------------  
Power  
Power Limit  
High Power  
Detection  
Intf  
Type  
Mode  
Type  
0/1 Enable  
0/2 Enable  
Low  
Low  
15.400 User Defined  
15.400 User Defined  
Disable  
Disable  
Auto  
Auto  
(Switch) #show poe port configuration 0/2  
Admin  
Power Power Limit  
Limit Type  
(W)  
------ ------- -------- ------ -------------- ------------- ---------------------  
High Power  
Detection  
Intf  
Mode Priority  
Mode  
Type  
0/2 Enable  
Low  
15.400 User Defined Disable  
Auto  
Power over Ethernet (PoE) Commands  
509  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show poe port info  
Use this command to get information about the status of the PoE ports. You can display  
information based on each individual port or all the ports collectively. The command displays only  
PSE-capable ports.  
Format  
Mode  
show poe port info [<port> |all]  
Privileged EXEC  
User EXEC  
Term  
Intf  
Definition  
Interface on which PoE is configured.  
Class  
Class of the powered device according to the IEEE802.3af and IEEE802.3at definition.  
Class Usage Max Power (watts)  
0 Default 0.44-12.95  
1 Optional 0.44-3.84  
2 Optional 3.84-6.49  
3 Optional 6.49-12.95  
4 Optional 12.95-25.5  
Power  
The power supplied to the powered device (in watts).  
The current supplied to the powered device (in mA).  
Output  
Current (mA)  
Output  
The voltage supplied to the powered device (in volts).  
Voltage (volts)  
Status  
The Status field reports the state of power supplied to the port. The possible values are:  
• Disabled—The PoE function is disabled on this port.  
• Searching—The port is detecting the PoE device.  
• Delivering Power—The port is providing power to the PoE device.  
• Fault—The POE device is not IEEE compliant; no power is provided.  
Test—The port is in testing state.  
• Other Fault—The port has experienced problems other than compliance issues.  
When a port begins to deliver power, there is a trap indicating so. When a port stops  
delivering power, there is a trap indicating so.  
Example:  
(switch) #show poe port info all  
High  
Max  
Power  
(W)  
Output  
Current  
(mA)  
Output  
Voltage  
(volt)  
-------  
00.00  
Intf  
Power  
Class  
Power  
(W)  
Status  
Fault  
Status  
------ ------- ----- ------- ------ -------  
0/1 Yes 32.0 Unknown 00.000  
------------------ ---------------  
Searching No Error  
0
(Switch) #show poe port info 0/33  
Power over Ethernet (PoE) Commands  
510  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
High  
Max  
Power  
(W)  
Output  
Current  
(mA)  
Output  
Voltage  
(volt)  
-------  
53.3  
Intf  
Power  
Class  
Power  
(W)  
Status  
Fault  
Status  
------ ------- -----  
0/33 No 18.0  
------- ------ -------  
04.400 84  
------------------ ---------------  
Delivering Power No Error  
2
show poe pd  
Use this command to get information about the PD ports. You can display information based on  
each individual port or all the PD ports collectively.  
Note: Only the GSM5212P supports this command.  
Format  
Mode  
show poe pd [<port> | all]  
Privileged EXEC  
User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Intf  
Show the PD device interface number, only 0/1 or 0/2 on the GSM5212P.  
In other devices, the table is empty. If <port-id> is not specified, all PD  
ports are displayed.  
Mode  
Displays the port POE role and is always PD.  
Class  
Displays the POE class.  
Detection Mode  
PD detection mode when getting power from the PSE:  
1-event—PSE detects the PD in 1-event mode (802.1f)  
2-event—PSE detects the PD in 2-event mode (802.1at)  
LLDP—PSE detects the PD in LLDP mode (802.1at)  
Status  
Shows whether the port 0/1 or 0/2 is providing power:  
Powered—Receiving power from PSE  
Off—No power from the PSE (when main AC is in used)  
Example:  
(switch) #show poe pd all  
Intf  
----  
0/1  
Mode  
-----  
PD  
Class  
Detection Mode  
Status  
--------- ----------------  
----------  
powered  
powered  
class 4  
class 4  
2-event  
LLDP  
0/2  
PD  
Power over Ethernet (PoE) Commands  
511  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
10.  
Utility Commands  
10  
This chapter describes the utility commands available in the CLI.  
This chapter contains the following sections:  
Link Local Protocol Filtering Commands (not supported on M4100 switches)  
The commands in this chapter are in four functional groups:  
Show commands display switch settings, statistics, and other information.  
Configuration commands configure features and options of the switch. Every switch  
command has a show command that displays the configuration setting.  
Copy commands transfer or save configuration and informational files to and from the  
switch.  
Clear commands clear some or all of the settings to factory defaults.  
512  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Auto Install Commands  
This section describes the Auto Install Commands. Auto Install is a software feature which  
provides for the configuration of a switch automatically when the device is initialized and no  
configuration file is found on the switch. The Auto Install process requires DHCP to be  
enabled by default in order for it to be completed. The downloaded config file is not  
automatically saved to startup-config. An administrator must explicitly issue a save request in  
order to save the configuration. The Auto Install process depends upon the configuration of  
other devices in the network, including a DHCP or BOOTP server, a TFTP server and, if  
necessary, a DNS server.  
There are three steps to Auto Install:  
1. Configuration or assignment of an IP address for the device.  
2. Assignment of a TFTP server.  
3. Obtain a configuration file for the device from the TFTP server.  
show autoinstall  
This command displays the status of the Auto Config process.  
Format  
Mode  
show autoinstall  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
AutoInstall  
Mode  
The administrator mode is enabled or disabled.  
AutoSave  
Modet  
If this option is enabled, the downloaded config file will be saved. Otherwise,  
administrator must explicitly issue a "copy running-config startup-config" command in  
order to save the configuration.  
AutoInstall  
Retry Count  
the number of attempts to download a configuration.  
The status of the AutoInstall.  
AutoInstall  
State  
Example  
(switch) #show autoinstall  
AutoInstall Mode............................... Stopped  
AutoSave Mode.................................. Disabled  
AutoInstall Persistant Mode.................... Enabled  
AutoInstall Retry Count........................ 3  
AutoInstall State.............................. Waiting for boot options  
Utility Commands  
513  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
boot host auto-save  
This command is used to enable automatically saving the downloaded configuration on the  
switch.  
Default  
Disabled  
Format  
Mode  
boot host auto-save  
Privileged EXEC  
no boot host auto-save  
This command is used to disable automatically saving the downloaded configuration on the  
switch.  
Format  
Mode  
no boot host auto-save  
Privileged EXEC  
boot autoinstall start  
The command is used to start Auto Install on the switch. Auto Install tries to download a  
config file from a TFTP server.  
Format  
Mode  
boot autoinstall start  
Privileged EXEC  
boot autoinstall stop  
The command is used to A user might terminate the Auto Install process at any time prior to  
the downloading of the config file. This is most optimally done when the switch is  
disconnected from the network, or if the requisite configuration files have not been configured  
on TFTP servers. Termination of the Auto Install process ends further periodic requests for a  
host-specific file.  
Format  
Mode  
boot autoinstall stop  
Privileged EXEC  
boot host retry-count  
This command is used to set the number of attempts to download a configuration. The valid  
range is from 1 to 6.  
Default  
3
Format  
Mode  
boot host retry-count <count>  
Privileged EXEC  
Utility Commands  
514  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no boot host retry-count  
This command is used to reset the number to the default. The default number is 3.  
Format  
Mode  
no boot host retry-count  
Privileged EXEC  
boot host dhcp  
This command is used to enable AutoInstall on the switch for the next reboot cycle. The  
command does not change the current behavior of AutroInstall and saves the command to  
NVRAM.  
Default  
Enabled3  
Format  
Mode  
boot host dhcp  
Privileged EXEC  
no boot host dhcp  
This command is used to disable AutoInstall on the switch for the next reboot cycle. The  
command does not change the current behavior of AutroInstall and saves the command to  
NVRAM  
Format  
Mode  
no boot host dhcp  
Privileged EXEC  
erase startup-config  
Use this command to erase the text-based configuration file stored in non-volatile memory. If  
the switch boots and no startup-config file is found, the AutoInstall process automatically  
begins.  
Format  
Mode  
erase startup-config  
Privileged EXEC  
Dual Image Commands  
The software supports a dual image feature that allows the switch to have two software  
images in the permanent storage. You can specify which image is the active image to be  
loaded in subsequent reboots. This feature allows reduced down-time when you upgrade or  
downgrade the software.  
Utility Commands  
515  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
delete  
This command deletes the supplied image file from the permanent storage. The image to be  
deleted must be a backup image. If this image is the active image, or if this image is  
activated, an error message displays. The optional <unit>parameter is valid only on  
Stacks. Error will be returned, if this parameter is provided, on Standalone systems. In a  
stack, the <unit>parameter identifies the node on which this command must be executed.  
When this parameter is not supplied, the command is executed on all nodes in a Stack.  
Format  
Mode  
delete [<unit>] {image1 | image2}  
Privileged EXEC  
boot system  
This command activates the specified image. It will be the active-image for subsequent  
reboots and will be loaded by the boot loader. The current active-image is marked as the  
backup-image for subsequent reboots. The optional <unit>parameter is valid only in  
Stacking, where the unit parameter identifies the node on which this command must be  
executed. When this parameter is not supplied, the command is executed on all nodes in a  
Stack.  
Format  
Mode  
boot system[<unit>] <image-file-name>  
Privileged EXEC  
show bootvar  
This command displays the version information and the activation status for the current active  
and backup images on the supplied unit (node) of the Stack. If you do not specify a unit  
number, the command displays image details for all nodes on the Stack. The command also  
displays any text description associated with an image. This command, when used on a  
Standalone system, displays the switch activation status. For a standalone system, the unit  
parameter is not valid.  
Format  
Mode  
show bootvar [<unit>]  
Privileged EXEC  
filedescr  
This command associates a given text description with an image. Any existing description will  
be replaced. For stacking, the [<unit>]parameter identifies the node on which this  
command must be executed. When this parameter is not supplied, the command is executed  
on all nodes in a Stack.  
Format  
Mode  
filedescr [<unit>] {image1 | image2} <text-description>  
Privileged EXEC  
Utility Commands  
516  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
update bootcode  
This command updates the bootcode (boot loader) on the switch. The bootcode is read from  
the active-image for subsequent reboots. The optional <unit>parameter is valid only on  
Stacks. Error will be returned, if this parameter is provided, on Standalone systems. For  
Stacking, the <unit>parameter identifies the node on which this command must be  
executed. When this parameter is not supplied, the command is executed on all nodes in a  
Stack.  
Format  
Mode  
update bootcode [<unit>]  
Privileged EXEC  
System Information and Statistics Commands  
This section describes the commands you use to view information about system features,  
components, and configurations.  
show arp switch  
This command displays the contents of the IP stack’s Address Resolution Protocol (ARP)  
table. The IP stack only learns ARP entries associated with the management interfaces -  
network or service ports. ARP entries associated with routing interfaces are not listed.  
Format  
Mode  
show arp switch  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
IP Address  
IP address of the management interface or another device on the management network.  
Hardware MAC address of that device.  
MAC Address  
Interface  
For a service port the output is Management. For a network port, the output is the  
slot/port of the physical interface.  
show eventlog  
This command displays the event log, which contains error messages from the system. The  
event log is not cleared on a system reset. The <unit> is the switch identifier.  
Format  
Mode  
show eventlog [<unit>]  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
File  
Definition  
The file in which the event originated.  
The line number of the event.  
Line  
Utility Commands  
517  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Task Id  
The task ID of the event.  
The event code.  
Code  
Time  
Unit  
The time this event occurred.  
The unit for the event.  
Note: Event log information is retained across a switch reset.  
show hardware  
This command displays inventory information for the switch.  
Note: The show version command and the show hardware command  
display the same information. In future releases of the software, the  
show hardware command will not be available. For a description of  
the command output, see the command show version on page 518.  
Format  
Mode  
show hardware  
Privileged EXEC  
show version  
This command displays inventory information for the switch.  
Note: The show version command will replace the show hardware  
command in future releases of the software.  
Format  
Mode  
show version  
Privileged EXEC  
Utility Commands  
518  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Switch  
Description  
Text used to identify the product name of this switch.  
Machine Type  
Machine Model  
Serial Number  
FRU Number  
Manufacturer  
The machine model as defined by the Vital Product Data.  
The machine model as defined by the Vital Product Data  
The unique box serial number for this switch.  
The field replaceable unit number.  
Manufacturer descriptor field.  
Burned in MAC  
Address  
Universally assigned network address.  
Software  
Version  
The release.version.revision number of the code currently running on the switch.  
The additional packages incorporated into this system.  
Additional  
Packages  
show interface  
This command displays a summary of statistics for a specific interface or a count of all CPU  
traffic based upon the argument.  
Format  
Mode  
show interface {<slot/port> | switchport | lag <lag-intf-num>}  
Privileged EXEC  
The display parameters, when the argument is <slot/port>or lag, are as follows:  
Parameters  
Definition  
Packets  
Received  
Without Error  
The total number of packets (including broadcast packets and multicast packets)  
received by the processor.  
Packets  
Received With  
Error  
The number of inbound packets that contained errors preventing them from being  
deliverable to a higher-layer protocol.  
Broadcast  
Packets  
Received  
The total number of packets received that were directed to the broadcast address. Note  
that this does not include multicast packets.  
Packets  
Transmitted  
Without Error  
The total number of packets transmitted out of the interface.  
Transmit  
Packets Errors  
The number of outbound packets that could not be transmitted because of errors.  
The best estimate of the total number of collisions on this Ethernet segment.  
Collisions  
Frames  
Time Since  
Counters Last  
Cleared  
The elapsed time, in days, hours, minutes, and seconds since the statistics for this port  
were last cleared.  
Utility Commands  
519  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
The display parameters, when the argument is “switchport” are as follows:  
Term  
Definition  
Packets  
Received  
Without Error  
The total number of packets (including broadcast packets and multicast packets)  
received by the processor.  
Broadcast  
Packets  
Received  
The total number of packets received that were directed to the broadcast address. Note  
that this does not include multicast packets.  
Packets  
Received With  
Error  
The number of inbound packets that contained errors preventing them from being  
deliverable to a higher-layer protocol.  
Packets  
Transmitted  
Without Error  
The total number of packets transmitted out of the interface.  
Broadcast  
Packets  
Transmitted  
The total number of packets that higher-level protocols requested to be transmitted to the  
Broadcast address, including those that were discarded or not sent.  
TransmitPacket  
Errors  
The number of outbound packets that could not be transmitted because of errors.  
AddressEntries  
Currently In Use  
The total number of Forwarding Database Address table entries now active on the  
switch, including learned and static entries.  
VLAN Entries  
Currently In Use  
The number of VLAN entries presently occupying the VLAN table.  
Time Since  
Counters Last  
Cleared  
The elapsed time, in days, hours, minutes, and seconds since the statistics for this  
switch were last cleared.  
show interface counters  
This command reports key summary statistics for all ports (physical, CPU, and port-channel).  
Format  
show interface counters  
Mode  
Privileged EXEC  
The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(Routing) #show interface counters  
Port  
InOctets  
InUcastPkts  
InMcastPkts  
InBcastPkts  
--------- ---------------- ---------------- ---------------- ----------------  
0/1  
0/2  
0/3  
0/4  
0/5  
0/6  
0/7  
0/8  
0/9  
0/10  
0/11  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
31  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
39  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
15098  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
Utility Commands  
520  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show interface ethernet  
This command displays detailed statistics for a specific interface or for all CPU traffic based  
upon the argument.  
Format  
Mode  
show interface ethernet{slot/port | switchport}  
Privileged EXEC  
When you specify a value for slot/port, the command displays the following information.  
Term  
Packets Received  
Definition  
Total Packets Received (Octets) - The total number of octets of data (including those in  
bad packets) received on the network (excluding framing bits but including Frame Check  
Sequence (FCS) octets). This object can be used as a reasonable estimate of Ethernet  
utilization. If greater precision is desired, the etherStatsPkts and etherStatsOctets objects  
should be sampled before and after a common interval. The result of this equation is the  
value Utilization which is the percent utilization of the Ethernet segment on a scale of  
0–100 percent.  
Packets Received 64 Octets - The total number of packets (including bad packets)  
received that were 64 octets in length (excluding framing bits but including FCS octets).  
Packets Received 65–127 Octets - The total number of packets (including bad packets)  
received that were from 65 through 127 octets in length inclusive (excluding framing bits  
but including FCS octets).  
Packets Received 128–255 Octets - The total number of packets (including bad packets)  
received that were from 128 through 255 octets in length inclusive (excluding framing bits  
but including FCS octets).  
Packets Received 256–511 Octets - The total number of packets (including bad packets)  
received that were from 256 through 511 octets in length inclusive (excluding framing bits  
but including FCS octets).  
Packets Received 512–1023 Octets - The total number of packets (including bad packets)  
received that were from 512 through 1023 octets in length inclusive (excluding framing bits  
but including FCS octets).  
Packets Received 1024–1518 Octets - The total number of packets (including bad  
packets) received that were from 1024 through 1518 octets in length inclusive (excluding  
framing bits but including FCS octets).  
Packets Received > 1518 Octets - The total number of packets received that were longer  
than 1522 octets (excluding framing bits, but including FCS octets) and were otherwise well  
formed.  
Packets RX and TX 64 Octets - The total number of packets (including bad packets)  
received and transmitted that were 64 octets in length (excluding framing bits but including  
FCS octets).  
Utility Commands  
521  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
(cont)  
Packets RX and TX 65–127 Octets - The total number of packets (including bad packets)  
received and transmitted that were from 65 through 127 octets in length inclusive  
(excluding framing bits but including FCS octets).  
Packets RX and TX 128–255 Octets - The total number of packets (including bad  
packets) received and transmitted that were from 128 through 255 octets in length inclusive  
(excluding framing bits but including FCS octets).  
Packets RX and TX 256–511 Octets - The total number of packets (including bad packets)  
received and transmitted that were from 256 through 511 octets in length inclusive  
(excluding framing bits but including FCS octets).  
Packets RX and TX 512–1023 Octets - The total number of packets (including bad  
packets) received and transmitted that were from 512 through 1023 octets in length  
inclusive (excluding framing bits but including FCS octets).  
Packets RX and TX 1024–1518 Octets - The total number of packets (including bad  
packets) received and transmitted that were from 1024 through 1518 octets in length  
inclusive (excluding framing bits but including FCS octets).  
Packets RX and TX 1519–1522 Octets - The total number of packets (including bad  
packets) received and transmitted that were from 1519 through 1522 octets in length  
inclusive (excluding framing bits but including FCS octets).  
Packets RX and TX 1523–2047 Octets - The total number of packets received and  
transmitted that were from 1523 through 2047 octets in length inclusive (excluding framing  
bits, but including FCS octets) and were otherwise well formed.  
Packets RX and TX 2048–4095 Octets - The total number of packets received that were  
from 2048 through 4095 octets in length inclusive (excluding framing bits, but including  
FCS octets) and were otherwise well formed.  
Packets RX and TX 4096–9216 Octets - The total number of packets received that were  
from 4096 through 9216 octets in length inclusive (excluding framing bits, but including  
FCS octets) and were otherwise well formed.  
Packets Received  
Successfully  
Total Packets Received Without Error - The total number of packets received that were  
without errors.  
Unicast Packets Received - The number of subnetwork-unicast packets delivered to a  
higher-layer protocol.  
Multicast Packets Received - The total number of good packets received that were  
directed to a multicast address. Note that this number does not include packets directed to  
the broadcast address.  
Broadcast Packets Received - The total number of good packets received that were  
directed to the broadcast address. Note that this does not include multicast packets.  
Receive Packets  
Discarded  
The number of inbound packets which were chosen to be discarded even though no errors had  
been detected to prevent their being deliverable to a higher-layer protocol. One possible reason  
for discarding such a packet could be to free up buffer space.  
Utility Commands  
522  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Packets Received  
with MAC Errors  
Total Packets Received with MAC Errors - The total number of inbound packets that  
contained errors preventing them from being deliverable to a higher-layer protocol.  
Jabbers Received - The total number of packets received that were longer than 1518  
octets (excluding framing bits, but including FCS octets), and had either a bad Frame  
Check Sequence (FCS) with an integral number of octets (FCS Error) or a bad FCS with a  
non-integral number of octets (Alignment Error). Note that this definition of jabber is  
different than the definition in IEEE-802.3 section 8.2.1.5 (10BASE5) and section 10.3.1.4  
(10BASE2). These documents define jabber as the condition where any packet exceeds 20  
ms. The allowed range to detect jabber is 20–150 ms.  
Fragments/Undersize Received - The total number of packets received that were less  
than 64 octets in length (excluding framing bits but including FCS octets).  
Alignment Errors - The total number of packets received that had a length (excluding  
framing bits, but including FCS octets) of from 64 through 1518 octets, inclusive, but had a  
bad Frame Check Sequence (FCS) with a non-integral number of octets.  
Rx FCS Errors - The total number of packets received that had a length (excluding framing  
bits, but including FCS octets) of from 64 through 1518 octets, inclusive, but had a bad  
Frame Check Sequence (FCS) with an integral number of octets.  
Overruns - The total number of frames discarded as this port was overloaded with  
incoming packets, and could not keep up with the inflow.  
Received Packets  
Not Forwarded  
Total Received Packets Not Forwarded - A count of valid frames received which were  
discarded (in other words, filtered) by the forwarding process  
Local Traffic Frames - The total number of frames dropped in the forwarding process  
because the destination address was located off of this port.  
802.3x Pause Frames Received - A count of MAC Control frames received on this  
interface with an opcode indicating the PAUSE operation. This counter does not increment  
when the interface is operating in half-duplex mode.  
Unacceptable Frame Type - The number of frames discarded from this port due to being  
an unacceptable frame type.  
Multicast Tree Viable Discards - The number of frames discarded when a lookup in the  
multicast tree for a VLAN occurs while that tree is being modified.  
Reserved Address Discards - The number of frames discarded that are destined to an  
IEEE 802.1 reserved address and are not supported by the system.  
Broadcast Storm Recovery - The number of frames discarded that are destined for  
FF:FF:FF:FF:FF:FF when Broadcast Storm Recovery is enabled.  
CFI Discards - The number of frames discarded that have CFI bit set and the addresses in  
RIF are in non-canonical format.  
Upstream Threshold - The number of frames discarded due to lack of cell descriptors  
available for that packet's priority level.  
Utility Commands  
523  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Packets  
Transmitted  
Octets  
Total Packets Transmitted (Octets) - The total number of octets of data (including those  
in bad packets) received on the network (excluding framing bits but including FCS octets).  
This object can be used as a reasonable estimate of Ethernet utilization. If greater  
precision is desired, the etherStatsPkts and etherStatsOctets objects should be sampled  
before and after a common interval. -----  
Packets Transmitted 64 Octets - The total number of packets (including bad packets)  
received that were 64 octets in length (excluding framing bits but including FCS octets).  
Packets Transmitted 65-127 Octets - The total number of packets (including bad packets)  
received that were from 65 through 127 octets in length inclusive (excluding framing bits  
but including FCS octets).  
Packets Transmitted 128-255 Octets - The total number of packets (including bad  
packets) received that were from 128 through 255 octets in length inclusive (excluding  
framing bits but including FCS octets).  
Packets Transmitted 256-511 Octets - The total number of packets (including bad  
packets) received that were from 256 through 511 octets in length inclusive (excluding  
framing bits but including FCS octets).  
Packets Transmitted 512-1023 Octets - The total number of packets (including bad  
packets) received that were from 512 through 1023 octets in length inclusive (excluding  
framing bits but including FCS octets).  
Packets Transmitted 1024-1518 Octets - The total number of packets (including bad  
packets) received that were from 1024 through 1518 octets in length inclusive (excluding  
framing bits but including FCS octets).  
Packets Transmitted > 1518 Octets - The total number of packets transmitted that were  
longer than 1518 octets (excluding framing bits, but including FCS octets) and were  
otherwise well formed.  
Max Frame Size - The maximum size of the Info (non-MAC) field that this port will receive  
or transmit.  
Packets  
Transmitted  
Successfully  
Total Packets Transmitted Successfully- The number of frames that have been  
transmitted by this port to its segment.  
Unicast Packets Transmitted - The total number of packets that higher-level protocols  
requested be transmitted to a subnetwork-unicast address, including those that were  
discarded or not sent.  
Multicast Packets Transmitted - The total number of packets that higher-level protocols  
requested be transmitted to a Multicast address, including those that were discarded or not  
sent.  
Broadcast Packets Transmitted - The total number of packets that higher-level protocols  
requested be transmitted to the Broadcast address, including those that were discarded or  
not sent.  
Transmit Packets The number of outbound packets which were chosen to be discarded even though no errors  
Discarded  
had been detected to prevent their being deliverable to a higher-layer protocol. A possible  
reason for discarding a packet could be to free up buffer space.  
Transmit Errors  
Total Transmit Errors - The sum of Single, Multiple, and Excessive Collisions.  
Tx FCS Errors - The total number of packets transmitted that had a length (excluding  
framing bits, but including FCS octets) of from 64 through 1518 octets, inclusive, but had a  
bad Frame Check Sequence (FCS) with an integral number of octets.  
Oversized - The total number of frames that exceeded the max permitted frame size. This  
counter has a max increment rate of 815 counts per sec. at 10 Mb/s.  
Underrun Errors - The total number of frames discarded because the transmit FIFO buffer  
became empty during frame transmission.  
Utility Commands  
524  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Transmit Discards Total Transmit Packets Discards - The sum of single collision frames discarded, multiple  
collision frames discarded, and excessive frames discarded.  
Single Collision Frames - A count of the number of successfully transmitted frames on a  
particular interface for which transmission is inhibited by exactly one collision.  
Multiple Collision Frames - A count of the number of successfully transmitted frames on  
a particular interface for which transmission is inhibited by more than one collision.  
Excessive Collisions - A count of frames for which transmission on a particular interface  
fails due to excessive collisions.  
Port Membership Discards - The number of frames discarded on egress for this port due  
to egress filtering being enabled.  
Protocol  
Statistics  
802.3x Pause Frames Transmitted - A count of MAC Control frames transmitted on this  
interface with an opcode indicating the PAUSE operation. This counter does not increment  
when the interface is operating in half-duplex mode.  
GVRP PDUs Received - The count of GVRP PDUs received in the GARP layer.  
GVRP PDUs Transmitted - The count of GVRP PDUs transmitted from the GARP layer.  
GVRP Failed Registrations - The number of times attempted GVRP registrations could  
not be completed.  
GMRP PDUs Received - The count of GMRP PDUs received in the GARP layer.  
GMRP PDUs Transmitted - The count of GMRP PDUs transmitted from the GARP layer.  
GMRP Failed Registrations - The number of times attempted GMRP registrations could  
not be completed.  
STP BPDUs Transmitted - Spanning Tree Protocol Bridge Protocol Data Units sent.  
STP BPDUs Received - Spanning Tree Protocol Bridge Protocol Data Units received.  
RST BPDUs Transmitted - Rapid Spanning Tree Protocol Bridge Protocol Data Units  
sent.  
RSTP BPDUs Received - Rapid Spanning Tree Protocol Bridge Protocol Data Units  
received.  
MSTP BPDUs Transmitted - Multiple Spanning Tree Protocol Bridge Protocol Data Units  
sent.  
MSTP BPDUs Received - Multiple Spanning Tree Protocol Bridge Protocol Data Units  
received.  
Dot1x Statistics  
EAPOL Frames Transmitted - The number of EAPOL frames of any type that have been  
transmitted by this authenticator.  
EAPOL Frames Received - The number of valid EAPOL frames of any type that have  
been received by this authenticator.  
Time Since  
Counters Last  
Cleared  
The elapsed time, in days, hours, minutes, and seconds since the statistics for this port were  
last cleared.  
Utility Commands  
525  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
If you use the switchportkeyword, the following information appears.  
Term  
Definition  
Octets Received  
The total number of octets of data received by the processor (excluding framing bits but  
including FCS octets).  
Total Packets  
The total number of packets (including broadcast packets and multicast packets) received by  
Received Without the processor.  
Error  
Unicast Packets  
Received  
The number of subnetwork-unicast packets delivered to a higher-layer protocol.  
Multicast Packets The total number of packets received that were directed to a multicast address. Note that this  
Received  
number does not include packets directed to the broadcast address.  
Broadcast  
The total number of packets received that were directed to the broadcast address. Note that  
Packets Received this does not include multicast packets.  
Receive Packets  
Discarded  
The number of inbound packets which were chosen to be discarded even though no errors had  
been detected to prevent their being deliverable to a higher-layer protocol. A possible reason  
for discarding a packet could be to free up buffer space.  
Octets  
The total number of octets transmitted out of the interface, including framing characters.  
Transmitted  
Packets  
The total number of packets transmitted out of the interface.  
Transmitted  
without Errors  
Unicast Packets  
Transmitted  
The total number of packets that higher-level protocols requested be transmitted to a  
subnetwork-unicast address, including those that were discarded or not sent.  
Multicast Packets The total number of packets that higher-level protocols requested be transmitted to a Multicast  
Transmitted  
address, including those that were discarded or not sent.  
Broadcast  
Packets  
The total number of packets that higher-level protocols requested be transmitted to the  
Broadcast address, including those that were discarded or not sent.  
Transmitted  
Most Address  
The highest number of Forwarding Database Address Table entries that have been learned by  
Entries Ever Used this switch since the most recent reboot.  
Address Entries  
in Use  
The number of Learned and static entries in the Forwarding Database Address Table for this  
switch.  
Maximum VLAN  
Entries  
The maximum number of Virtual LANs (VLANs) allowed on this switch.  
Most VLAN  
Entries Ever Used  
The largest number of VLANs that have been active on this switch since the last reboot.  
The number of presently active VLAN entries on this switch that have been created statically.  
Static VLAN  
Entries  
Dynamic VLAN  
Entries  
The number of presently active VLAN entries on this switch that have been created by GVRP  
registration.  
Utility Commands  
526  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
VLAN Deletes  
The number of VLANs on this switch that have been created and then deleted since the last  
reboot.  
Time Since  
Counters Last  
Cleared  
The elapsed time, in days, hours, minutes, and seconds since the statistics for this switch were  
last cleared.  
show mac-addr-table  
This command displays the forwarding database entries. These entries are used by the  
transparent bridging function to determine how to forward a received frame.  
Enter allor no parameter to display the entire table. Enter a MAC Address and VLAN ID to  
display the table entry for the requested MAC address on the specified VLAN. Enter the  
countparameter to view summary information about the forwarding database table. Use the  
interface <slot/port> parameter to view MAC addresses on a specific interface. Use  
the vlan <vlan_id>parameter to display information about MAC addresses on a specified  
VLAN.  
Format  
Mode  
show mac-addr-table [{<macaddr> <vlan_id> | all | count | interface  
<slot/port> | vlan <vlan_id>}]  
Privileged EXEC  
The following information displays if you do not enter a parameter, the keyword all, or the  
MAC address and VLAN ID. If you enter vlan <vlan_id>, only the Mac Address, Interface,  
and Status fields appear.  
Term  
Definition  
Mac Address  
A unicast MAC address for which the switch has forwarding and or filtering information.  
The format is 6 or 8 two-digit hexadecimal numbers that are separated by colons, for  
example 01:23:45:67:89:AB. In an IVL system the MAC address will be displayed as  
8 bytes.  
Interface  
The port through which this address was learned.  
Utility Commands  
527  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Interface Index  
This object indicates the ifIndex of the interface table entry associated with this port.  
Status  
The status of this entry. The meanings of the values are:  
Static. The value of the corresponding instance was added by the system or a user  
when a static MAC filter was defined. It cannot be relearned.  
Learned. The value of the corresponding instance was learned by observing the  
source MAC addresses of incoming traffic, and is currently in use.  
Management. The value of the corresponding instance (system MAC address) is also  
the value of an existing instance of dot1dStaticAddress. It is identified with interface  
0/1. and is currently used when enabling VLANs for routing.  
Self. The value of the corresponding instance is the address of one of the switch’s  
physical interfaces (the system’s own MAC address).  
GMRP Learned. The value of the corresponding was learned via GMRP and applies  
to Multicast.  
Other. The value of the corresponding instance does not fall into one of the other  
categories.  
If you enter the interface <slot/port> parameter, in addition to the MAC Address and  
Status fields, the following field appears:  
Term  
VLAN ID  
Definition  
The VLAN on which the MAC address was learned.  
The following information displays if you enter the countparameter:  
Term  
Definition  
Dynamic  
Address count  
Number of MAC addresses in the forwarding database that were automatically learned.  
Static Address  
(User-defined)  
count  
Number of MAC addresses in the forwarding database that were manually entered by a  
user.  
Total MAC  
Addresses in  
use  
Number of MAC addresses currently in the forwarding database.  
Number of MAC addresses the forwarding database can handle.  
Total MAC  
Addresses  
available  
process cpu threshold  
Use this command to configure the CPU utilization thresholds. The Rising and Falling  
thresholds are specified as a percentage of CPU resources. The utilization monitoring time  
period can be configured from 5 seconds to 86,400 seconds in multiples of 5 seconds. The  
CPU utilization threshold configuration is saved across a switch reboot. Configuring the  
Utility Commands  
528  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
falling utilization threshold is optional. If the falling CPU utilization parameters are not  
configured, they take the same value as the rising CPU utilization parameters.  
Format  
process cpu threshold type total rising <1-100> interval  
<5-86400> {falling <1-100> interval <5-86400>}  
Mode  
Global Config  
Parameter  
Description  
rising threshold  
The percentage of CPU resources that, when exceeded for the configured rising interval,  
triggers a notification. The range is 1–100. The default is 0 (disabled).  
rising interval  
The duration of the CPU rising threshold violation, in seconds, that must be met to trigger a  
notification. The range is 5–86,400. The default is 0 (disabled).  
falling threshold  
The percentage of CPU resources that, when usage falls below this level for the configured  
interval, triggers a notification. The range is 1–100. The default is 0 (disabled). A notification is  
triggered when the total CPU utilization falls below this level for a configured period of time.  
The falling utilization threshold notification is made only if a rising threshold notification was  
previously done. The falling utilization threshold must always be equal or less than the rising  
threshold value. The CLI does not allow setting the falling threshold to be greater than the  
rising threshold.  
falling interval  
The duration of the CPU falling threshold, in seconds, that must be met to trigger a  
notification. The range is 5–86,400. The default is 0 (disabled).  
show process cpu  
This command provides the percentage utilization of the CPU by different tasks.  
Note: It is not necessarily the traffic to the CPU, but different tasks that  
keep the CPU busy.  
Format  
Mode  
show process cpu  
Privileged EXEC  
The following shows example CLI display output.  
(Switch) #show process cpu  
Memory Utilization Report  
status  
bytes  
------ ----------  
free 192980480  
alloc 53409968  
Task Utilization Report  
Task  
Utilization  
----------------------- -----------  
bcmL2X.0 0.75%  
Utility Commands  
529  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
bcmCNTR.0  
bcmLINK.0  
DHCP snoop  
Dynamic ARP Inspection  
dot1s_timer_task  
dhcpsPingTask  
0.20%  
0.35%  
0.10%  
0.10%  
0.10%  
0.20%  
show mbuf total  
This command shows the total system buffer pools status.  
Format  
Mode  
show mbuf total  
Privileged EXEC  
The following shows an example of CLI display output for the command.  
(switch) #show mbuf total  
mbufSize  
9284 (0x2444)  
Current Time  
MbufsFree  
MbufsRxUsed  
0x1897fa  
150  
0
Total Rx Norm Alloc Attempts 26212  
Total Rx Mid2 Alloc Attempts 4087  
Total Rx Mid1 Alloc Attempts 188943  
Total Rx High Alloc Attempts 384555  
Total Tx Alloc Attempts  
2478536  
Total Rx Norm Alloc Failures 0  
Total Rx Mid2 Alloc Failures 0  
Total Rx Mid1 Alloc Failures 0  
Total Rx High Alloc Failures 0  
Total Tx Alloc Failures  
0
show running-config  
Use this command to display or capture the current setting of different protocol packages  
supported on the switch. This command displays or captures commands with settings and  
configurations that differ from the default value. To display or capture the commands with  
settings and configurations that are equal to the default value, include the [all] option.  
Note: Show running-config does not display the User Password, even if  
you set one different from the default.  
The output is displayed in the script format, which can be used to configure another switch  
with same configuration. If the optional <scriptname>is provided with a file name  
extension of “.scr”, the output is redirected to a script file.  
Utility Commands  
530  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Note: If you issue the show running-config command from a serial  
connection, access to the switch through remote connections (such  
as Telnet) is suspended while the output is being generated and  
displayed.  
Note: If you use a text-based configuration file, the show  
running-configcommand will only display configured physical  
interfaces, that is, if any interface only contains the default  
configuration, that interface will be skipped from the show  
running-configcommand output. This is true for any  
configuration mode that contains nothing but default configuration.  
That is, the command to enter a particular config mode, followed  
immediately by its ‘exit’ command, are both omitted from the show  
running-configcommand output (and hence from the  
startup-config file when the system configuration is saved.)  
If all the flags in a particular group are enabled, the command displays trapflags <group  
name> all.  
If some, but not all, of the flags in that group are enabled, the command displays trapflags  
<groupname> <flag-name>.  
Format  
Mode  
show running-config [all | <scriptname>]  
Privileged EXEC  
show running-config interface  
This command shows the current configuration on a particular interface. The interface could  
be a physical port or a virtual port—like a LAG or VLAN. The output captures how the  
configuration differs from the factory default value.  
Format  
show running-config interface {<slot/port>} | VLAN <id> | LAG <id>}  
Mode  
Interface Config  
show sysinfo  
This command displays switch information.  
Format  
Mode  
show sysinfo  
Privileged EXEC  
Utility Commands  
531  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Switch  
Description  
Text used to identify this switch.  
System Name  
Name used to identify the switch. The factory default is blank. To configure the system  
System  
Location  
Text used to identify the location of the switch. The factory default is blank. To configure  
the system location, see snmp-server on page 670.  
System Contact  
Text used to identify a contact person for this switch. The factory default is blank. To  
configure the system location, see snmp-server on page 670.  
System Object  
ID  
The base object ID for the switch’s enterprise MIB.  
System Up Time  
MIBs Supported  
The time in days, hours, and minutes since the last switch reboot.  
A list of MIBs supported by this agent.  
show tech-support  
Use this command to display system and configuration information when you contact  
technical support. The output of this command combines the output of the following  
commands:  
show version  
show sysinfo  
show port all  
show isdp neighbors  
show logging  
show event log  
show logging buffered  
show trap log  
Format  
Mode  
show tech-support  
Privileged EXEC  
show tech-support techsupport  
This command without the techsupportparameter displays system and configuration  
information about the console. To generate the information in a file, specify the  
techsupportparameter.  
Format  
Mode  
show tech-support techsupport  
Privileged EXEC  
Utility Commands  
532  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
length  
Use this command to set the pagination length to value number of lines for the sessions  
specified by configuring on different Line Config modes (telnet, ssh, and console) and is  
persistent.  
Default  
24  
Format  
Mode  
length <0|5-48>  
Line Config  
no length value  
Use this command to set the pagination length to the default value number of lines.  
Format  
no length  
Mode  
Line Config  
terminal length  
Use this command to set the number of lines of output to be displayed on the screen, i.e.  
pagination, for the show running-configand show running-config allcommands.  
The terminal length size is either zero or a number in the range of 5–48. After the  
user-configured number of lines is displayed in one page, the system prompts the user  
--More-- or (q)uit.” Press q or Q to quit, or press any key to display the next set  
of <5-48> lines. The command terminal length 0 disables pagination and, as a result,  
the output of the show running-config command is displayed immediately.  
Default  
24 lines per page  
Format  
Mode  
terminal length <0|5-48>  
Privileged EXEC  
no terminal length  
Use this command to set the terminal length to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no terminal length  
Privileged EXEC  
show terminal length  
Use this command to display the value of the user-configured terminal length size.  
Format  
Mode  
show terminal length  
Privileged EXEC  
Utility Commands  
533  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
memory free low-watermark processor  
Use this command to get notifications when the CPU free memory falls below the configured  
threshold. A notification is generated when the free memory falls below the threshold.  
Another notification is generated once the available free memory rises to 10 percent above  
the specified threshold. To prevent generation of excessive notifications when the CPU free  
memory fluctuates around the configured threshold, only one Rising or Falling memory  
notification is generated over a period of 60 seconds. The threshold is specified in kilobytes.  
The CPU free memory threshold configuration is saved across a switch reboot.  
Format  
memory free low-watermark processor <1-1034956>  
Mode  
Global Config  
Parameter  
Description  
low-watermark  
When CPU free memory falls below this threshold, a notification message is triggered.  
The range is 1 to the maximum available memory on the switch. The default is 0  
(disabled).  
Logging Commands  
This section describes the commands you use to configure system logging, and to view logs  
and the logging settings.  
logging buffered  
This command enables logging to an in-memory log that keeps up to 128 logs.  
Default  
disabled; critical when enabled  
Format  
Mode  
logging buffered  
Global Config  
no logging buffered  
This command disables logging to in-memory log.  
Format  
Mode  
no logging buffered  
Global Config  
Utility Commands  
534  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
logging buffered wrap  
This command enables wrapping of in-memory logging when the log file reaches full  
capacity. Otherwise when the log file reaches full capacity, logging stops.  
Default  
enabled  
Format  
Mode  
logging buffered wrap  
Privileged EXEC  
no logging buffered wrap  
This command disables wrapping of in-memory logging and configures logging to stop when  
the log file capacity is full.  
Format  
Mode  
no logging buffered wrap  
Privileged EXEC  
logging cli-command  
This command enables the CLI command logging feature, which enables the 7000 series  
software to log all CLI commands issued on the system.  
Default  
enabled  
Format  
Mode  
logging cli-command  
Global Config  
no logging cli-command  
This command disables the CLI command Logging feature.  
Format  
Mode  
no logging cli-command  
Global Config  
logging console  
This command enables logging to the console. You can specify the <severitylevel>  
value as either an integer from 0 to 7 or symbolically through one of the following keywords:  
emergency(0), alert(1), critical(2), error(3), warning(4), notice(5), info(6),  
or debug(7).  
Default  
disabled; critical when enabled  
Format  
Mode  
logging console [severitylevel]  
Global Config  
Utility Commands  
535  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no logging console  
This command disables logging to the console.  
Format  
Mode  
no logging console  
Global Config  
logging host  
This command enables logging to a host. You can configure up to eight hosts. The  
<ipaddr|hostname>is the IP address of the logging host. The <addresstype>indicates  
the type of address ipv4 or ipv6 or dns being passed. The <port>value is a port number  
from 1 to 65535. You can specify the <severitylevel>value as either an integer from 0 to  
7 or symbolically through one of the following keywords: emergency(0), alert(1),  
critical(2), error(3), warning(4), notice(5), info(6), or debug(7).  
The end user can configure either an IPv4 or IPv6 address or a host name for a Syslog  
collector among the list of servers.  
Default  
• port—514  
• level—critical (2)  
Format  
Mode  
logging host <ipaddr|hostname> <addresstype>  
[<port>][<severitylevel>]  
Global Config  
logging host remove  
indexes.  
Format  
Mode  
logging host remove <hostindex>  
Global Config  
logging syslog  
This command enables syslog logging. The <portid>parameter is an integer with a range  
of 1-65535.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
logging syslog [port <portid>]  
Global Config  
Utility Commands  
536  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no logging syslog  
This command disables syslog logging.  
Format  
Mode  
no logging syslog  
Global Config  
logging syslog source-interface  
This command configures the syslog source-interface.  
Format  
Mode  
logging syslog source-interface {<u/s/p> | {loopback <loopback-id>}  
| {tunnel <tunnel-id>}}  
Global Config  
show logging  
This command displays logging configuration information.  
Format  
Mode  
show logging  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Logging Client  
Local Port  
The port on the collector/relay to which syslog messages are sent.  
CLI Command  
Logging  
Shows whether CLI Command logging is enabled.  
Shows whether console logging is enabled.  
Console  
Logging  
Console  
Logging  
Severity Filter  
The minimum severity to log to the console log. Messages with an equal or lower  
numerical severity are logged.  
Buffered  
Logging  
Shows whether buffered logging is enabled.  
Syslog Logging  
Shows whether syslog logging is enabled.  
Log Messages  
Received  
Number of messages received by the log process. This includes messages that are  
dropped or ignored.  
Log Messages  
Dropped  
Number of messages that could not be processed due to error or lack of resources.  
Number of messages sent to the collector/relay.  
Log Messages  
Relayed  
Utility Commands  
537  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show logging buffered  
This command displays buffered logging (system startup and system operation logs).  
Format  
show logging buffered  
Mode  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Buffered  
(In-Memory)  
Logging  
Shows whether the In-Memory log is enabled or disabled.  
Buffered  
Logging  
Wrapping  
Behavior  
The behavior of the In Memory log when faced with a log full situation.  
The count of valid entries in the buffered log.  
Buffered Log  
Count  
show logging hosts  
This command displays all configured logging hosts.  
Format  
Mode  
show logging hosts  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Host Index  
(Used for deleting hosts.)  
IP address or hostname of the logging host.  
IP Address /  
Hostname  
Severity Level  
The minimum severity to log to the specified address. The possible values are  
emergency (0), alert (1), critical (2), error (3), warning (4), notice (5), info (6), or debug  
(7).  
Port  
The server port number, which is the port on the local host from which syslog messages  
are sent.  
Host Status  
The state of logging to configured syslog hosts. If the status is disable, no logging occurs.  
show logging traplogs  
This command displays SNMP trap events and statistics.  
Format  
Mode  
show logging traplogs  
Privileged EXEC  
Utility Commands  
538  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Number of  
Traps Since  
Last Reset  
The number of traps since the last boot.  
Trap Log  
Capacity  
The number of traps the system can retain.  
Number of  
TrapsSinceLog  
Last Viewed  
The number of new traps since the command was last executed.  
Log  
The log number.  
System Time Up  
Trap  
How long the system had been running at the time the trap was sent.  
The text of the trap message.  
logging persistent  
Use this command to configure the Persistent logging for the switch. The severity level of  
logging messages is specified at severity level. Possible values for severity level are  
(emergency|0, alert|1, critical|2, error|3, warning|4, notice|5,  
info|6, debug|7).  
Default  
Disable  
Format  
Mode  
logging persistent <severity level>  
Global Config  
no logging persistent  
Use this command to disable the persistent logging in the switch.  
Format  
Mode  
no logging persistent  
Global Config  
Email Alerting and Mail Server Commands  
logging email  
This command enables email alerting and sets the lowest severity level for which log  
messages are emailed. If you specify a severity level, log messages at or above this severity  
level, but below the urgent severity level, are emailed in a non-urgent manner by collecting  
them together until the log time expires. You can specify the severitylevel value as either an  
integer from 0 to 7 or symbolically through one of the following keywords: emergency(0),  
alert(1), critical(2), error(3), warning(4), notice(5), info(6), or debug(7).  
Default  
Disabled; when enabled, log messages at or above severity Warning (4) are emailed  
Utility Commands  
539  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Format  
Mode  
logging email [<severitylevel>]  
Global Config  
no logging email  
This command disables email alerting.  
Format  
Mode  
no logging email  
Global Config  
logging email urgent  
This command sets the lowest severity level at which log messages are emailed immediately  
in a single email message. Specify the severitylevel value as either an integer from 0 to 7 or  
symbolically through one of the following keywords: emergency(0), alert(1), critical  
(2), error(3), warning(4), notice(5), info(6), or debug(7). Specify noneto indicate  
that log messages are collected and sent in a batch email at a specified interval.  
Default  
Alert (1) and emergency (0) messages are sent immediately  
Format  
Mode  
logging email urgent {<severitylevel> | none }  
Global Config  
no logging email urgent  
This command resets the urgent severity level to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no logging email urgent  
Global Config  
logging email message-type to-addr  
This command configures the email address to which messages are sent. The message  
types supported are urgent, non-urgent, and both. For each supported severity level,  
multiple email addresses can be configured. The to-email-addr variable is a standard email  
address, for example [email protected].  
Format  
Mode  
logging email message-type {urgent |non-urgent |both}  
to-addr <to-email-addr>  
Global Config  
Utility Commands  
540  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no logging email message-type to-addr  
This command removes the configured to-addr field of email.  
Format  
Mode  
no logging email message-type {urgent |non-urgent |both}  
to-addr <to-email-addr>  
Global Config  
logging email from-addr  
This command configures the email address of the sender (the switch).  
Default  
Format  
Mode  
logging email from-addr <from-email-addr>  
Global Config  
no logging email from-addr  
This command removes the configured email source address.  
Format  
Mode  
no logging email from-addr <from-email-addr>  
Global Config  
logging email message-type subject  
This command configures the subject line of the email for the specified type.  
Default  
Format  
Mode  
For urgent messages: Urgent Log Messages  
For non-urgent messages: Non-Urgent Log Messages  
logging email message-type {urgent |non-urgent |both} subject  
<subject>  
Global Config  
no logging email message-type subject  
This command removes the configured email subject for the specified message type and  
restores it to the default email subject.  
Format  
Mode  
no logging email message-type {urgent |non-urgent |both} subject  
Global Config  
Utility Commands  
541  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
logging email logtime  
This command configures how frequently non-urgent email messages are sent. Non-urgent  
messages are collected and sent in a batch email at the specified interval. The valid range is  
every 30- 1440 minutes.  
Default  
30 minutes  
Format  
Mode  
logging email logtime <minutes>  
Global Config  
no logging email logtime  
This command resets the non-urgent log time to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no logging email logtime  
Global Config  
logging traps  
This command sets the severity at which SNMP traps are logged and sent in an email.  
Specify the severitylevel value as either an integer from 0 to 7 or symbolically through one of  
the following keywords: emergency(0), alert(1), critical(2), error(3), warning(4),  
notice(5), info(6), or debug(7).  
Default  
Info (6) messages and higher are logged.  
Format  
Mode  
logging traps <severitylevel>  
Global Config  
no logging traps  
This command resets the SNMP trap logging severity level to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no logging traps  
Global Config  
logging email test message-type  
This command sends an email to the SMTP server to test the email alerting function.  
Format  
Mode  
logging email test message-type {urgent |non-urgent |both}  
message-body <message-body>  
Global Config  
Utility Commands  
542  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show logging email config  
This command displays information about the email alert configuration.  
Format  
show logging email config  
Mode  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Email Alert Logging  
The administrative status of the feature: enabled or disabled  
The email address of the sender (the switch).  
Email Alert From  
Address  
Email Alert Urgent  
Severity Level  
The lowest severity level that is considered urgent. Messages of this type are  
sent immediately.  
Email Alert Non Urgent  
Severity Level  
The lowest severity level that is considered non-urgent. Messages of this type,  
up to the urgent level, are collected and sent in a batch email. Log messages  
that are less severe are not sent in an email message at all.  
Email Alert Trap Severity  
Level  
The lowest severity level at which traps are logged.  
The amount of time to wait between non-urgent messages.  
The configured email recipients.  
Email Alert Notification  
Period  
Email Alert To Address  
Table  
Email Alert Subject Table  
The subject lines included in urgent (Type 1) and non-urgent (Type 2)  
messages.  
For Msg Type urgent,  
subject is  
The configured email subject for sending urgent messages.  
The configured email subject for sending non-urgent messages.  
For Msg Type  
non-urgent, subject is  
show logging email statistics  
This command displays email alerting statistics.  
Format  
Mode  
show logging email statistics  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Email Alert Operation  
Status  
The operational status of the email alerting feature.  
No of Email Failures  
The number of email messages that have attempted to be sent but were  
unsuccessful.  
Utility Commands  
543  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
No of Email Sent  
The number of email messages that were sent from the switch since the  
counter was cleared.  
Time Since Last Email  
Sent  
The amount of time that has passed since the last email was sent from the  
switch.  
clear logging email statistics  
This command resets the email alerting statistics.  
Format  
Mode  
clear logging email statistics  
Privileged EXEC  
mail-server  
Use this command to configure the SMTP server to which the switch sends email alert  
messages and change the mode to Mail Server Configuration mode. The server address can  
be in the IPv4, IPv6, or DNS name format.  
Format  
Mode  
mail-server {ip-address | ipv6-address | hostname}  
Global Config  
no mail-server  
Use this command to remove the specified SMTP server from the configuration.  
Format  
Mode  
no mail-server {ip-address | ipv6-address | hostname}  
Global Config  
security  
Use this command to set the email alerting security protocol by enabling the switch to use  
TLS authentication with the SMTP Server. If the TLS mode is enabled on the switch but the  
SMTP server does not support TLS mode, no email is sent to the SMTP server.  
Default  
none  
Format  
Mode  
security {tlsv1 | none}  
Mail Server Config  
Utility Commands  
544  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
port  
Use this command to configure the TCP port to use for communication with the SMTP server.  
The recommended port for TLSv1 is 465, and for no security (i.e. none) it is 25. However, any  
nonstandard port in the range 1–65,535 is also allowed.  
Default  
25  
Format  
Mode  
port {465 | 25 | 1–65535}  
Mail Server Config  
username  
Use this command to configure the login ID that the switch uses to authenticate with the  
SMTP server.  
Default  
admin  
Format  
Mode  
username name  
Mail Server Config  
password  
Use this command to configure the password that the switch uses to authenticate with the  
SMTP server.  
Format  
Mode  
password password  
Mail Server Config  
show mail-server config  
Use this command to display information about the email alert configuration.  
Format  
Mode  
show mail-server {ip-address | hostname | all } config  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
No of mail  
servers  
The number of SMTP servers configured on the switch.  
configured  
Email Alert Mail  
Server Address  
The IPv4/IPv6 address or DNS hostname of the configured SMTP server.  
The TCP port the switch uses to send email to the SMTP server.  
Email Alert Mail  
Server Port  
Email Alert  
Security  
Protocol  
The security protocol (TLS or none) the switch uses to authenticate with the SMTP  
server.  
Utility Commands  
545  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Email Alert  
Username  
The username the switch uses to authenticate with the SMTP server.  
The password the switch uses to authenticate with the SMTP server.  
Email Alert  
Password  
System Utility and Clear Commands  
This section describes the commands you use to help troubleshoot connectivity issues and to  
restore various configurations to their factory defaults.  
traceroute  
Use the traceroutecommand to discover the routes that packets actually take when  
traveling to their destination through the network on a hop-by-hop basis. Traceroute  
continues to provide a synchronous response when initiated from the CLI.  
Default  
• count: 3 probes  
• interval: 3 seconds  
• size: 0 bytes  
• port: 33434  
• maxTtl: 30 hops  
• maxFail: 5 probes  
• initTtl: 1 hop  
Format  
Mode  
traceroute <ipaddr|hostname> [initTtl <initTtl>] [maxTtl <maxTtl>]  
[maxFail <maxFail>] [interval <interval>] [count <count>]  
[port <port>] [size <size>] [source{ip-address|<slot/port> | loopback  
<0-7>}]  
Privileged EXEC  
Using the options described below, you can specify the initial and maximum time-to-live (TTL)  
in probe packets, the maximum number of failures before termination, the number of probes  
sent for each TTL, and the size of each probe.  
Parameter  
Description  
ipaddr|hostname  
The ipaddr value should be a valid IP address. The hostname value should  
be a valid hostname.  
initTtl  
Use initTtlto specify the initial time-to-live (TTL), the maximum number of router  
hops between the local and remote system. Range is 0–255.  
maxTtl  
Use maxTtleto specify the maximum TTL. Range is 1–255.  
maxFail  
Use maxFailto terminate the traceroute after failing to receive a response for this  
number of consecutive probes. Range is 0–255.  
Utility Commands  
546  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Parameter  
interval  
Description  
Use intervalto specify the time between probes, in seconds. Range is 1–60  
seconds.  
count  
port  
Use the optional countparameter to specify the number of probes to send for each  
TTL value. Range is 1–10 probes.  
Use the optional portparameter to specify destination UDP port of the probe. This  
should be an unused port on the remote destination system. Range is 1–65,535.  
size  
Use the optional sizeparameter to specify the size, in bytes, of the payload of the  
Echo Requests sent. Range is 0–65507 bytes.  
source  
Use the optional sourceparameter to specify the source IP address or interface for  
the traceroute.  
The following are examples of the CLI command.  
traceroute Success:  
(Switch) # traceroute 10.240.10.115 initTtl 1 maxTtl 4 maxFail 0 interval 1 count 3 port  
33434 size 43  
Traceroute to 10.240.10.115 ,4 hops max 43 byte packets:  
1 10.240.4.1 708 msec  
2 10.240.10.115 0 msec  
41 msec  
0 msec  
11 msec  
0 msec  
Hop Count = 1 Last TTL = 2 Test attempt = 6 Test Success = 6  
traceroute Failure:  
(Switch) # traceroute 10.40.1.1 initTtl 1 maxFail 0 interval 1 count 3  
port 33434 size 43  
Traceroute to 10.40.1.1 ,30 hops max 43 byte packets:  
1 10.240.4.1 19 msec  
2 10.240.1.252 0 msec  
3 172.31.0.9 277 msec  
4 10.254.1.1 289 msec  
5 10.254.21.2 287 msec  
6 192.168.76.2 290 msec  
7 0.0.0.0 0 msec *  
18 msec  
0 msec  
276 msec  
327 msec  
293 msec  
291 msec  
9 msec  
1 msec  
277 msec  
282 msec  
296 msec  
289 msec  
Hop Count = 6 Last TTL = 7 Test attempt = 19 Test Success = 18  
traceroute ipv6  
Use the traceroutecommand to discover the routes that packets actually take when  
traveling to their destination through the network on a hop-by-hop basis. The  
<ipv6-address|hostname> parameter must be a valid IPv6 address or hostname. The  
optional <port> parameter is the UDP port used as the destination of packets sent as part  
Utility Commands  
547  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
of the traceroute. This port should be an unused port on the destination system. The range  
for <port> is zero (0) to 65535. The default value is 33434.  
Default  
port: 33434  
Format  
Mode  
traceroute ipv6 <ipv6-address|hostname> [port <port>]  
Privileged EXEC  
clear config  
This command resets the configuration to the factory defaults without powering off the switch.  
When you issue this command, a prompt appears to confirm that the reset should proceed.  
When you enter y, you automatically reset the current configuration on the switch to the  
default values. It does not reset the switch.  
Format  
Mode  
clear config  
Privileged EXEC  
clear eventlog  
This command clears all event messages maintained in the switch.  
Format  
Mode  
clear eventlog  
Privileged EXEC  
clear mac-addr-table  
This command clears the dynamically learned MAC addresses of the switch.  
Format  
Mode  
clear mac-addr-table  
Privileged EXEC  
clear logging buffered  
This command clears the messages maintained in the system log.  
Format  
Mode  
clear logging buffered  
Privileged EXEC  
Utility Commands  
548  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
clear counters  
This command clears the statistics for a specified <slot/port>, for all the ports, or for the  
entire switch based upon the argument.  
Format  
Mode  
clear counters {<slot/port> | all}  
Privileged EXEC  
clear igmpsnooping  
This command clears the tables managed by the IGMP Snooping function and attempts to  
delete these entries from the Multicast Forwarding Database.  
Format  
Mode  
clear igmpsnooping  
Privileged EXEC  
clear pass  
This command resets all user passwords to the factory defaults without powering off the  
switch. You are prompted to confirm that the password reset should proceed.  
Format  
Mode  
clear pass  
Privileged EXEC  
clear port-channel  
This command clears all port-channels (LAGs).  
Format  
Mode  
clear port-channel  
Privileged EXEC  
clear traplog  
This command clears the trap log.  
Format  
Mode  
clear traplog  
Privileged EXEC  
clear vlan  
This command resets VLAN configuration parameters to the factory defaults.  
Format  
Mode  
clear vlan  
Privileged EXEC  
Utility Commands  
549  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
             
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
enable password  
This command prompts you to change the Privileged EXEC password. Passwords are a  
maximum of 64 alphanumeric characters. The password is case-sensitive. The option  
[encrypted] allows the administrator to transfer the enable password between devices without  
having to know the password. In this case, the <password> parameter must be exactly 128  
hexadecimal characters.  
Format  
enable password <password> [encrypted]  
Mode  
Privileged EXEC  
logout  
This command closes the current telnet connection or resets the current serial connection.  
Note: Save configuration changes before logging out.  
Format  
logout  
Modes  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
ping  
Use this command to determine whether another computer is on the network. Ping provides  
a synchronous response when initiated from the CLI and web interfaces.  
Default  
• The default count is 1.  
• The default interval is 3 seconds.  
• The default size is 0 bytes.  
Format  
Modes  
ping <ipaddress|hostname> [count <count>] [interval <interval>] [size  
<size>]  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Utility Commands  
550  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Using the options described below, you can specify the number and size of Echo Requests  
and the interval between Echo Requests.  
Parameter  
Description  
count  
Use the countparameter to specify the number of ping packets (ICMP Echo requests)  
that are sent to the destination address specified by the <ip-address> field. The  
range for <count>is 1–15 requests.  
interval  
size  
Use the interval parameter to specify the time between Echo Requests, in seconds.  
Range is 1–60 seconds.  
Use the sizeparameter to specify the size, in bytes, of the payload of the Echo  
Requests sent. Range is 0–65,507 bytes.  
The following are examples of the CLI command.  
ping success:  
(Switch) #ping 10.254.2.160 count 3 interval 1 size 255  
Pinging 10.254.2.160 with 255 bytes of data:  
Received response for icmp_seq = 0. time= 275268 usec  
Received response for icmp_seq = 1. time= 274009 usec  
Received response for icmp_seq = 2. time= 279459 usec  
----10.254.2.160 PING statistics----  
3 packets transmitted, 3 packets received, 0% packet loss  
round-trip (msec) min/avg/max = 274/279/276  
ping failure:  
In Case of Unreachable Destination:  
(Switch) # ping 192.168.254.222 count 3 interval 1 size 255  
Pinging 192.168.254.222 with 255 bytes of data:  
Received Response: Unreachable Destination  
Received Response :Unreachable Destination  
Received Response :Unreachable Destination  
----192.168.254.222 PING statistics----  
3 packets transmitted,3 packets received, 0% packet loss  
round-trip (msec) min/avg/max = 0/0/0  
In Case Of Request TimedOut:  
(Switch) # ping 1.1.1.1 count 1 interval 3  
Pinging 1.1.1.1 with 0 bytes of data:  
----1.1.1.1 PING statistics----  
1 packets transmitted,0 packets received, 100% packet loss  
round-trip (msec) min/avg/max = 0/0/0  
ping ipv6  
Use this command to determine whether another computer is on the network. Ping provides  
a synchronous response when initiated from the CLI and web interfaces. To use this  
Utility Commands  
551  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
command, configure the switch for network (in-band) connection. The source and target  
devices must have the ping utility enabled and running on top of TCP/IP. The switch can be  
pinged from any IP workstation with which the switch is connected through the default VLAN  
(VLAN 1), as long as there is a physical path between the switch and the workstation. The  
terminal interface sends three pings to the target station. Use the ipv6-address|hostname  
parameter to ping an interface by using the global IPv6 address of the interface. Use the  
optional sizekeyword to specify the size of the ping packet. You can utilize the ping or  
traceroute facilities over the service/network ports when using an IPv6 global address  
ipv6-global-address|hostname. Any IPv6 global address or gateway assignments to  
these interfaces will cause IPv6 routes to be installed within the IP stack such that the ping or  
traceroute request is routed out the service/network port properly. When referencing an IPv6  
link-local address, you must also specify the network port interface by using the network  
parameter.  
Defaults  
• The default count is 1.  
• The default interval is 3 seconds.  
• The default size is 0 bytes.  
ping ipv6 {<ipv6-global-address|<hostname>} [size <datagram-size>]  
Format  
Modes  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
ping ipv6 interface  
Use this command to determine whether another computer is on the network. To use this  
command, configure the switch for network (in-band) connection. The source and target  
devices must have the ping utility enabled and running on top of TCP/IP. The switch can be  
pinged from any IP workstation with which the switch is connected through the default VLAN  
(VLAN 1), as long as there is a physical path between the switch and the workstation. The  
terminal interface sends three pings to the target station. Use the interfacekeyword to ping  
an interface by using the link-local address or the global IPv6 address of the interface. You  
can use a loopback, network port, or physical interface as the source. Use the optional size  
keyword to specify the size of the ping packet. The ipv6-addressis the link local IPv6  
address of the device you want to query.  
ping ipv6 interface {<slot/port> | loopback <loopback-id> |network}  
<link-local-address> [size <datagram-size>]  
Format  
Modes  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Utility Commands  
552  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
quit  
This command closes the current telnet connection or resets the current serial connection.  
The system asks you whether to save configuration changes before quitting.  
Format  
quit  
Modes  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
reload  
This command resets the switch without powering it off. Reset means that all network  
connections are terminated and the boot code executes. The switch uses the stored  
configuration to initialize the switch. You are prompted to confirm that the reset should  
proceed. The LEDs on the switch indicate a successful reset.  
Format  
reload  
Mode  
Privileged EXEC  
save  
This command makes the current configuration changes permanent by writing the  
configuration changes to system NVRAM.  
Format  
save  
Mode  
Privileged EXEC  
copy  
The copy command uploads and downloads files to and from the switch. You can also use  
the copy command to manage the dual images (image1 and image2) on the file system.  
Upload and download files from a server by using TFTP or Xmodem. SFTP and SCP are  
available as additional transfer methods if the software package supports secure  
management.  
Format  
Mode  
copy<source> <destination>  
Privileged EXEC  
Replace the <source>and <destination>parameters with the options in table below.  
For the <url>source or destination, use one of the following values:  
{xmodem | tftp://<ipaddr|hostname>|<ip6address|hostname>/<filepath>/<filename> [noval]  
| sftp|scp://<username>@<ipaddr>|<ipv6address>|<filepath>|<filename>}  
Use the ias-users keyword to download the IAS user database file. When the IAS user’s file  
is downloaded, the switch IAS user's database is replaced with the users and their attributes  
in the downloaded file.  
Utility Commands  
553  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
In the copy url ias-users command, for url, use one of the following for the IAS user's file:  
{ { tftp://<ipaddr | hostname> | <ipv6address | hostname> /<filepath>/<filename> } | {  
sftp | scp://<username>@<ipaddress>/<filepath>/<filename>} }  
The maximum length for the file path is 160 characters, and the maximum length for the file  
name is 31 characters.  
For TFTP, SFTP, and SCP, the <ipaddr|hostname>parameter is the IP address or host  
name of the server, <filepath>is the path to the file, and <filename> is the name of the  
file you want to upload or download. For SFTP and SCP, the <username> parameter is the  
username for logging into the remote server via SSH.  
Note: <ip6address>is also a valid parameter for routing packages that  
support IPv6.  
For switches that support a USB device, the copy command can be used to transfer files from  
and to the USB device. The syntax for the USB file is: usb://<filename>. The USB device  
can be either a source or destination in the copycommand. It cannot be used as both source  
and destination in a given copycommand.  
Note: Remember to upload the existing Switch CLI.cfg file off the switch  
prior to loading a new release image in order to make a backup.  
Parameters for the copycommand are listed in the following table:  
Source  
Destination  
<url>  
Description  
nvram:techsupport  
nvram:backup-config  
Uploads the Technical Support file.  
nvram:startup-config  
Copies the backup configuration to the startup  
configuration.  
nvram:clibanner  
<url>  
Copies the CLI banner to a server.  
nvram:cpupktcapture.pcap <url>  
Uploads the CPU packets capture file.  
Copies the error log file to a server.  
Copies the log file to a server.  
nvram:errorlog  
nvram:log  
<url>  
<url>  
nvram:script <scriptname> <url>  
Copies a specified configuration script file to a server.  
nvram:startup-config  
nvram:backup-config  
Copies the startup configuration to the backup  
configuration.  
nvram:startup-config  
<url>  
Copies the startup configuration to a server.  
Utility Commands  
554  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Source  
Destination  
Description  
nvram:traplog  
system:running-config  
<url>  
<url>  
Copies the trap log file to a server.  
Saves the running configuration to nvram.  
Downloads the CLI banner to the system.  
nvram:startup-config  
nvram:clibanner  
<url>  
nvram:script  
<destfilename>  
Downloads a configuration script file to the system.  
During the download of a configuration script, the copy  
command validates the script. In case of any error, the  
command lists all the lines at the end of the validation  
process and prompts you to confirm before copying  
the script file.  
<url>  
<url>  
nvram:script  
<destfilename> noval  
When you use this option, the copy command will not  
validate the downloaded script file. An example of the  
CLI command follows:  
(NETGEAR Switch) #copy tftp://1.1.1.1/file.scr  
nvram:script file.scr  
nvram:sshkey-dsa  
Downloads an SSH key file. For more information, see  
<url>  
<url>  
<url>  
<url>  
<url>  
nvram:sshkey-rsa1  
nvram:sshkey-rsa2  
Downloads an SSH key file.  
Downloads an SSH key file.  
nvram:sslpem-dhweak Downloads an HTTP secure-server certificate.  
nvram:sslpem-dhstrong Downloads an HTTP secure-server certificate.  
nvram:sslpem-root  
Downloads an HTTP secure-server certificate. For  
more information, see Hypertext Transfer Protocol  
<url>  
<url>  
<url>  
<url>  
<url>  
<url>  
nvram:sslpem-server  
nvram:startup-config  
nvram:system-image  
nvram:license-key  
ias-users  
Downloads an HTTP secure-server certificate.  
Downloads the startup configuration file to the system.  
Downloads a code image to the system.  
Download the license date to the system.  
Downloads IAS users file by sftp, scp, or tftp  
{image1 | image2}  
Download an image from the remote server to either  
image. In a stacking environment, the downloaded  
image is distributed to the stack nodes.  
{image1 | image2}  
image1  
<url>  
Upload either image to the remote server.  
Copy image1to image2.  
image2  
image1  
image2  
Copy image2to image1.  
Utility Commands  
555  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Source  
Destination  
Description  
{image1 | image2}  
unit://<unit>/{image1 |  
image2}  
Copy an image from the management node to a given  
node in a Stack. Use the unit parameter to specify the  
node to which the image should be copied.  
{image1 | image2}  
unit://*/{image1 |  
image2}  
Copy an image from the management node to all of  
the nodes in a Stack.  
write memory  
Use this command to save running configuration changes to NVRAM so that the changes  
you make will persist across a reboot. This command is the same as copy  
system:running config nvram:startup-config.  
Format  
Mode  
write memory  
Privileged EXEC  
Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) Commands  
This section describes the commands you use to automatically configure the system time  
and date by using SNTP.  
sntp broadcast client poll-interval  
This command sets the poll interval for SNTP broadcast clients in seconds as a power of two  
where <poll-interval> can be a value from 6 to 10.  
Default  
6
Format  
Mode  
sntp broadcast client poll-interval <poll-interval>  
Global Config  
no sntp broadcast client poll-interval  
This command resets the poll interval for SNTP broadcast client back to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no sntp broadcast client poll-interval  
Global Config  
Utility Commands  
556  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
sntp client mode  
This command enables Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) client mode and might set the  
mode to either broadcast or unicast.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
sntp client mode [broadcast | unicast]  
Global Config  
no sntp client mode  
This command disables Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) client mode.  
Format  
Mode  
no sntp client mode  
Global Config  
sntp client port  
This command sets the SNTP client port id to a value from 1-65,535.  
Default  
123  
Format  
Mode  
sntp client port <portid>  
Global Config  
no sntp client port  
This command resets the SNTP client port back to its default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no sntp client port  
Global Config  
sntp unicast client poll-interval  
This command sets the poll interval for SNTP unicast clients in seconds as a power of two  
where <poll-interval>can be a value from 6 to 10.  
Default  
6
Format  
Mode  
sntp unicast client poll-interval <poll-interval>  
Global Config  
Utility Commands  
557  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no sntp unicast client poll-interval  
This command resets the poll interval for SNTP unicast clients to its default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no sntp unicast client poll-interval  
Global Config  
sntp unicast client poll-timeout  
This command will set the poll timeout for SNTP unicast clients in seconds to a value from  
1-30.  
Default  
5
Format  
Mode  
sntp unicast client poll-timeout <poll-timeout>  
Global Config  
no sntp unicast client poll-timeout  
This command will reset the poll timeout for SNTP unicast clients to its default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no sntp unicast client poll-timeout  
Global Config  
sntp unicast client poll-retry  
This command will set the poll retry for SNTP unicast clients to a value from 0 to 10.  
Default  
1
Format  
Mode  
sntp unicast client poll-retry <poll-retry>  
Global Config  
no sntp unicast client poll-retry  
This command will reset the poll retry for SNTP unicast clients to its default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no sntp unicast client poll-retry  
Global Config  
Utility Commands  
558  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
sntp server  
This command configures an SNTP server (a maximum of three). The optional priority can be  
a value of 1-3, the version a value of 1-4, and the port id a value of 1-65535.  
Format  
Mode  
sntp server <ipaddress|ipv6address| hostname> [<priority> [<version>  
[<portid>]]]  
Global Config  
no sntp server  
This command deletes an server from the configured SNTP servers.  
Format  
Mode  
no sntp server remove <ipaddress|ipv6address| hostname>  
Global Config  
clock timezone  
When using SNTP/NTP time servers to update the switch’s clock, the time data received  
from the server is based on Coordinated Universal Time (UTC) which is the same as  
Greenwich Mean Time (GMT). This might not be the time zone in which the switch is located.  
Use the clock timezone command to configure a time zone specifying the number of hours  
and optionally the number of minutes difference from UTC. To set the switch clock to UTC,  
use the no form of the command.  
Format  
Mode  
clock timezone zone-name +/-hours-offset [+/-minutes-offset]  
Global Config  
Default  
no clock timezone  
Term  
Definition  
zone-name  
A name to associate with the time zone  
Number of hours difference with UTC  
Number of minutes difference with UTC  
hours-offset  
minutes-offset  
no clock timezone  
This command sets the switch to UTC time.  
Format  
Mode  
no clock timezone  
Global Config  
Utility Commands  
559  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
clock set  
This command sets the system time and date.  
Format  
Mode  
clock set <hh:mm:ss>  
clock set <mm/dd/yyyy>  
Global Config  
clock summer-time recurring  
Use the clock summer-time recurring command to set the summertime offset to UTC  
recursively every year. If the optional parameters are not specified, they are read as either '0'  
or '\0', as appropriate.  
Use the following parameters to configure the summer-time.  
USA—the US Daylight saving time setting is used (Start --- March, 2nd sunday 02:00 AM,  
End --- Nov, 1st sunday, 2:00 AM)  
EU—the European Union Daylight savings time is used (Start --- March, 5th Sunday  
02:00 AM, End --- October, 5th Sunday, 3:00 AM)  
week—Week of the month. (Range: 1-5, first, last)  
day—Day of the week. (Range: The first three letters by name; sun, for example.)  
month—Month. (Range: The first three letters by name; jan, for example.)  
hh:mm—Time in 24-hour format in hours and minutes. (Range: hh:0-23, mm: 0-59)  
offset—Number of minutes to add during the summertime. (Range:1-1440)  
acronym—The acronym for the time zone to be displayed when summertime is in effect.  
(Range: Up to four characters)  
Format  
Mode  
clock summer-time recurring {USA | EU | {week day month hh:mm week  
day month hh:mm}} [offset offset ] [zone acronym]  
Global Config  
For example:  
(Switch)(Config)# clock summer-time recurring 1 sun jan  
00:10 2 mon mar 10:00 offset 1 zone ABC  
clock summer-time date  
Use the clock summer-time date command to set the summertime offset to UTC. If the  
optional parameters are not specified, they are read as either '0' or '\0', as appropriate.  
date—Day of the month. (Range: 1-31)  
month—Month. (Range: The first three letters by name; jan, for example.)  
year—Year. (Range: 2000-2097)  
hh:mm—Time in 24-hour format in hours and minutes. (Range: hh: 0-23, mm: 0-59)  
Utility Commands  
560  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
offset—Number of minutes to add during the summertime. (Range:1-1440)  
acronym—The acronym for the time zone to be displayed when summertime is in effect.  
(Range: Up to four characters)  
Format  
clock summer-time date {date | month} {month | date} year hh:mm  
{date| month} {month | date} year hh:mm [offset offset ] [zone  
acronym]  
Mode  
Global Config  
For example:  
(Switch)(config)# clock summer-time date 1 Apr 2007  
02:00 28 Oct 2007 offset 90 zone EST  
or  
(Switch) (config)# clock summer-time date Apr 1 2007  
02:00 Oct 28 2007 offset 90 zone EST  
no clock summer-time  
Use the no clock summer-time command to reset the summertime offset.  
Format  
Mode  
no clock summer-time  
Global Config  
For example:  
console(config)#no clock summer-time  
show sntp  
This command is used to display SNTP settings and status.  
Format  
Mode  
show sntp  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Last Update  
Time  
Time of last clock update.  
Last Unicast  
Attempt Time  
Time of last transmit query (in unicast mode).  
Last Attempt  
Status  
Status of the last SNTP request (in unicast mode) or unsolicited message (in broadcast  
mode).  
Utility Commands  
561  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Broadcast  
Count  
Current number of unsolicited broadcast messages that have been received and  
processed by the SNTP client since last reboot.  
Multicast Count  
Current number of unsolicited multicast messages that have been received and  
processed by the SNTP client since last reboot.  
show sntp client  
This command is used to display SNTP client settings.  
Format  
Mode  
show sntp client  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Client  
Supported  
Modes  
Supported SNTP Modes (Broadcast, Unicast, or Multicast).  
SNTP Version  
Port  
The highest SNTP version the client supports.  
SNTP Client Port.  
Client Mode  
Configured SNTP Client Mode.  
show sntp server  
This command is used to display SNTP server settings and configured servers.  
Format  
Mode  
show sntp server  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Server Host  
Address  
IP address or hostname of configured SNTP Server.  
Server Type  
Address Type of Server.  
Server Stratum  
Claimed stratum of the server for the last received valid packet.  
Server  
Reference ID  
Reference clock identifier of the server for the last received valid packet.  
Server Mode  
SNTP Server mode.  
Server  
Maximum  
Entries  
Total number of SNTP Servers allowed.  
Server Current  
Entries  
Total number of SNTP configured.  
Utility Commands  
562  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
For each configured server:  
Term  
Definition  
Host Address  
IP address or hostname of configured SNTP Server.  
Address Type of configured SNTP server.  
IP priority type of the configured server.  
Address Type  
Priority  
Version  
SNTP Version number of the server. The protocol version used to query the server in  
unicast mode.  
Port  
Server Port Number.  
Last Attempt  
Time  
Last server attempt time for the specified server.  
Last Update  
Status  
Last server attempt status for the server.  
Number of requests to the server.  
Total Unicast  
Requests  
Failed Unicast  
Requests  
Number of failed requests from server.  
show clock  
Use the show clock command in Privileged EXEC or User EXEC mode to display the time  
and date from the system clock. Use the show clock detail command to show the time zone  
and summertime configuration.  
Format  
show clock [detail]  
Mode  
User EXEC  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Time  
Definition  
The time provided by the time source.  
The time source type.  
Time Source  
If option detail is specified, these terms are displayed  
Time Zone  
The time zone configured.  
Summer Time  
Indicate if the summer time is enabled.  
Utility Commands  
563  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
DHCP Server Commands  
This section describes the commands you to configure the DHCP server settings for the  
switch. DHCP uses UDP as its transport protocol and supports a number of features that  
facilitate in administration address allocations.  
ip dhcp pool  
This command configures a DHCP address pool name on a DHCP server and enters DHCP  
pool configuration mode.  
Default  
none  
Format  
Mode  
ip dhcp pool <name>  
Global Config  
no ip dhcp pool  
This command removes the DHCP address pool. The name should be previously configured  
pool name.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip dhcp pool <name>  
Global Config  
client-identifier  
This command specifies the unique identifier for a DHCP client. Unique-identifier is a valid  
notation in hexadecimal format. In some systems, such as Microsoft DHCP clients, the client  
identifier is required instead of hardware addresses. The unique-identifier is a concatenation  
of the media type and the MAC address. For example, the Microsoft client identifier for  
Ethernet address c819.2488.f177 is 01c8.1924.88f1.77 where 01 represents the Ethernet  
media type. For more information, refer to the “Address Resolution Protocol Parameters”  
section of RFC 1700, Assigned Numbers for a list of media type codes.  
Default  
none  
Format  
Mode  
client-identifier <uniqueidentifier>  
DHCP Pool Config  
no client-identifier  
This command deletes the client identifier.  
Format  
Mode  
no client-identifier  
DHCP Pool Config  
Utility Commands  
564  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
client-name  
This command specifies the name for a DHCP client. Name is a string consisting of standard  
ASCII characters.  
Default  
none  
Format  
Mode  
client-name <name>  
DHCP Pool Config  
no client-name  
This command removes the client name.  
Format  
Mode  
no client-name  
DHCP Pool Config  
default-router  
This command specifies the default router list for a DHCP client. {address1, address2…  
address8} are valid IP addresses, each made up of four decimal bytes ranging from 0 to  
255. IP address 0.0.0.0 is invalid.  
Default  
none  
Format  
Mode  
default-router <address1> [<address2>....<address8>]  
DHCP Pool Config  
no default-router  
This command removes the default router list.  
Format  
Mode  
no default-router  
DHCP Pool Config  
dns-server  
This command specifies the IP servers available to a DHCP client. Address parameters are  
valid IP addresses; each made up of four decimal bytes ranging from 0 to 255. IP address  
0.0.0.0 is invalid.  
Default  
none  
Format  
Mode  
dns-server <address1> [<address2>....<address8>]  
DHCP Pool Config  
Utility Commands  
565  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no dns-server  
This command removes the DNS Server list.  
Format  
Mode  
no dns-server  
DHCP Pool Config  
hardware-address  
This command specifies the hardware address of a DHCP client. Hardware-address is the  
MAC address of the hardware platform of the client consisting of 6 bytes in dotted  
hexadecimal format. Type indicates the protocol of the hardware platform. It is 1 for 10 MB  
Ethernet and 6 for IEEE 802.  
Default  
ethernet  
Format  
Mode  
hardware-address <hardwareaddress> <type>  
DHCP Pool Config  
no hardware-address  
This command removes the hardware address of the DHCP client.  
Format  
Mode  
no hardware-address  
DHCP Pool Config  
host  
This command specifies the IP address and network mask for a manual binding to a DHCP  
client. Address and Mask are valid IP addresses; each made up of four decimal bytes ranging  
from 0 to 255. IP address 0.0.0.0 is invalid. The prefix-length is an integer from 0 to 32.  
Default  
none  
Format  
Mode  
host <address> [{<mask> | <prefix-length>}]  
DHCP Pool Config  
no host  
This command removes the IP address of the DHCP client.  
Format  
Mode  
no host  
DHCP Pool Config  
Utility Commands  
566  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
lease  
This command configures the duration of the lease for an IP address that is assigned from a  
DHCP server to a DHCP client. The overall lease time should be between 1-86400 minutes.  
If you specify infinite, the lease is set for 60 days. You can also specify a lease duration.  
Daysis an integer from 0 to 59. Hoursis an integer from 0 to 23. Minutesis an integer from  
0 to 59.  
Default  
1 (day)  
Format  
Mode  
lease [{<days> [<hours>] [<minutes>] | infinite}]  
DHCP Pool Config  
no lease  
This command restores the default value of the lease time for DHCP Server.  
Format  
Mode  
no lease  
DHCP Pool Config  
network (DHCP Pool Config)  
Use this command to configure the subnet number and mask for a DHCP address pool on  
the server. Network-number is a valid IP address, made up of four decimal bytes ranging  
from 0 to 255. IP address 0.0.0.0 is invalid. Mask is the IP subnet mask for the specified  
address pool. The prefix-length is an integer from 0 to 32.  
Default  
none  
Format  
Mode  
network <networknumber> [{<mask> | <prefixlength>}]  
DHCP Pool Config  
no network  
This command removes the subnet number and mask.  
Format  
no network  
Mode  
DHCP Pool Config  
bootfile  
The command specifies the name of the default boot image for a DHCP client. The  
<filename>specifies the boot image file.  
Format  
Mode  
bootfile <filename>  
DHCP Pool Config  
Utility Commands  
567  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no bootfile  
This command deletes the boot image name.  
Format  
Mode  
no bootfile  
DHCP Pool Config  
domain-name  
This command specifies the domain name for a DHCP client. The <domain>specifies the  
domain name string of the client.  
Default  
none  
Format  
Mode  
domain-name <domain>  
DHCP Pool Config  
no domain-name  
This command removes the domain name.  
Format  
Mode  
no domain-name  
DHCP Pool Config  
netbios-name-server  
This command configures NetBIOS Windows Internet Naming Service (WINS) name servers  
that are available to DHCP clients.  
One IP address is required, although one can specify up to eight addresses in one command  
line. Servers are listed in order of preference (address1 is the most preferred server,  
address2 is the next most preferred server, and so on).  
Default  
none  
Format  
Mode  
netbios-name-server <address> [<address2>...<address8>]  
DHCP Pool Config  
no netbios-name-server  
This command removes the NetBIOS name server list.  
Format  
Mode  
no netbios-name-server  
DHCP Pool Config  
Utility Commands  
568  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
netbios-node-type  
The command configures the NetBIOS node type for Microsoft Dynamic Host Configuration  
Protocol (DHCP) clients. type specifies the NetBIOS node type. Valid types are:  
b-node—Broadcast  
p-node—Peer-to-peer  
m-node—Mixed  
h-node—Hybrid (recommended)  
Default  
none  
Format  
Mode  
netbios-node-type <type>  
DHCP Pool Config  
no netbios-node-type  
This command removes the NetBIOS node Type.  
Format  
Mode  
no netbios-node-type  
DHCP Pool Config  
next-server  
This command configures the next server in the boot process of a DHCP client.The  
<address>parameter is the IP address of the next server in the boot process, which is  
typically a TFTP server.  
Default  
inbound interface helper addresses  
Format  
Mode  
next-server <address>  
DHCP Pool Config  
no next-server  
This command removes the boot server list.  
Format  
Mode  
no next-server  
DHCP Pool Config  
option  
The optioncommand configures DHCP Server options. The <code>parameter specifies  
the DHCP option code and ranges from 1-254. The <ascii string>parameter specifies  
an NVT ASCII character string. ASCII character strings that contain white space must be  
delimited by quotation marks. The hex <string>parameter specifies hexadecimal data. In  
hexadecimal, character strings are two hexadecimal digits. You can separate each byte by a  
Utility Commands  
569  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
period (for example, a3.4f.22.0c), colon (for example, a3:4f:22:0c), or white space (for  
example, a3 4f 22 0c).  
Default  
none  
Format  
Mode  
option <code> {ascii string | hex <string1> [<string2>...<string8>]  
| ip <address1> [<address2>...<address8>]}  
DHCP Pool Config  
no option  
This command removes the DHCP Server options. The <code>parameter specifies the  
DHCP option code.  
Format  
Mode  
no option <code>  
DHCP Pool Config  
ip dhcp excluded-address  
This command specifies the IP addresses that a DHCP server should not assign to DHCP  
clients. Low-address and high-address are valid IP addresses; each made up of four decimal  
bytes ranging from 0 to 255. IP address 0.0.0.0is invalid.  
Default  
none  
Format  
Mode  
ip dhcp excluded-address <lowaddress> [highaddress]  
Global Config  
no ip dhcp excluded-address  
This command removes the excluded IP addresses for a DHCP client. Low-address and  
high-address are valid IP addresses; each made up of four decimal bytes ranging from 0 to  
255. IP address 0.0.0.0 is invalid.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip dhcp excluded-address <lowaddress> [highaddress]  
Global Config  
ip dhcp ping packets  
Use this command to specify the number, in a range from 2-10, of packets a DHCP server  
sends to a pool address as part of a ping operation. By default the number of packets sent to  
a pool address is 2, which is the smallest allowed number when sending packets. Setting the  
number of packets to 0 disables this command.  
Default  
2
Utility Commands  
570  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Format  
Mode  
ip dhcp ping packets <0,2-10>  
Global Config  
no ip dhcp ping packets  
This command prevents the server from pinging pool addresses and sets the number of  
packets to 0.  
Default  
0
Format  
Mode  
no ip dhcp ping packets  
Global Config  
service dhcp  
This command enables the DHCP server.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
service dhcp  
Global Config  
no service dhcp  
This command disables the DHCP server.  
Format  
Mode  
no service dhcp  
Global Config  
ip dhcp bootp automatic  
This command enables the allocation of the addresses to the bootp client. The addresses are  
from the automatic address pool.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
ip dhcp bootp automatic  
Global Config  
no ip dhcp bootp automatic  
This command disables the allocation of the addresses to the bootp client. The address are  
from the automatic address pool.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip dhcp bootp automatic  
Global Config  
Utility Commands  
571  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
ip dhcp conflict logging  
This command enables conflict logging on DHCP server.  
Default  
enabled  
Format  
Mode  
ip dhcp conflict logging  
Global Config  
no ip dhcp conflict logging  
This command disables conflict logging on DHCP server.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip dhcp conflict logging  
Global Config  
clear ip dhcp binding  
This command deletes an automatic address binding from the DHCP server database. If “*”  
is specified, the bindings corresponding to all the addresses are deleted. <address>is a  
valid IP address made up of four decimal bytes ranging from 0 to 255. IP address 0.0.0.0  
is invalid.  
Format  
Mode  
clear ip dhcp binding {<address> | *}  
Privileged EXEC  
clear ip dhcp server statistics  
This command clears DHCP server statistics counters.  
Format  
Mode  
clear ip dhcp server statistics  
Privileged EXEC  
clear ip dhcp conflict  
The command is used to clear an address conflict from the DHCP Server database. The  
server detects conflicts using a ping. DHCP server clears all conflicts If the asterisk (*)  
character is used as the address parameter.  
Default  
none  
Format  
Mode  
clear ip dhcp conflict {<address> | *}  
Privileged EXEC  
Utility Commands  
572  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show ip dhcp binding  
This command displays address bindings for the specific IP address on the DHCP server. If  
no IP address is specified, the bindings corresponding to all the addresses are displayed.  
Format  
show ip dhcp binding [<address>]  
Modes  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
IP address  
The IP address of the client.  
The MAC Address or the client identifier.  
Hardware  
Address  
Lease  
expiration  
The lease expiration time of the IP address assigned to the client.  
The manner in which IP address was assigned to the client.  
Type  
show ip dhcp global configuration  
This command displays address bindings for the specific IP address on the DHCP server. If  
no IP address is specified, the bindings corresponding to all the addresses are displayed.  
Format  
Modes  
show ip dhcp global configuration  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Service DHCP  
The field to display the status of dhcp protocol.  
Number of Ping  
Packets  
The maximum number of Ping Packets that will be sent to verify that an ip address id not  
already assigned.  
Conflict  
Logging  
Shows whether conflict logging is enabled or disabled.  
BootP  
Automatic  
Shows whether BootP for dynamic pools is enabled or disabled.  
show ip dhcp pool configuration  
This command displays pool configuration. If allis specified, configuration for all the pools  
is displayed.  
Format  
Modes  
show ip dhcp pool configuration {<name> | all}  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Utility Commands  
573  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Field  
Definition  
Pool Name  
The name of the configured pool.  
Pool Type  
The pool type.  
Lease Time  
DNS Servers  
Default Routers  
The lease expiration time of the IP address assigned to the client.  
The list of DNS servers available to the DHCP client .  
The list of the default routers available to the DHCP client  
The following additional field is displayed for Dynamic pool type:  
Field  
Network  
Definition  
The network number and the mask for the DHCP address pool.  
The following additional fields are displayed for Manual pool type:  
Field  
Definition  
Client Name  
The name of a DHCP client.  
The unique identifier of a DHCP client.  
The hardware address of a DHCP client.  
Client Identifier  
Hardware  
Address  
Hardware  
Address Type  
The protocol of the hardware platform.  
Host  
The IP address and the mask for a manual binding to a DHCP client.  
show ip dhcp server statistics  
This command displays DHCP server statistics.  
Format  
Modes  
show ip dhcp server statistics  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Field  
Definition  
Automatic  
Bindings  
The number of IP addresses that have been automatically mapped to the MAC  
addresses of hosts that are found in the DHCP database.  
Expired  
Bindings  
The number of expired leases.  
Malformed  
Bindings  
The number of truncated or corrupted messages that were received by the DHCP server.  
Utility Commands  
574  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Message Received:  
Message  
Definition  
DHCP  
DISCOVER  
The number of DHCPDISCOVER messages the server has received.  
The number of DHCPREQUEST messages the server has received.  
DHCP  
REQUEST  
DHCP DECLINE  
The number of DHCPDECLINE messages the server has received.  
The number of DHCPRELEASE messages the server has received.  
DHCP  
RELEASE  
DHCP INFORM  
The number of DHCPINFORM messages the server has received.  
Message Sent:  
Message  
Definition  
DHCP OFFER  
DHCP ACK  
The number of DHCPOFFER messages the server sent.  
The number of DHCPACK messages the server sent.  
The number of DHCPNACK messages the server sent.  
DHCP NACK  
show ip dhcp conflict  
This command displays address conflicts logged by the DHCP Server. If no IP address is  
specified, all the conflicting addresses are displayed.  
Format  
Modes  
show ip dhcp conflict [<ip-address>]  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
IP address  
The IP address of the host as recorded on the DHCP server.  
Reporting Host  
Hardware  
The hardware address of the host that reported the conflict.  
Address  
Detection  
Method  
The manner in which the IP address of the hosts were found on the DHCP Server.  
The time when the conflict was found.  
Detection time  
DNS Client Commands  
These commands are used in the Domain Name System (DNS), an Internet directory  
service. DNS is how domain names are translated into IP addresses. When enabled, the  
DNS client provides a hostname lookup service to other components.  
Utility Commands  
575  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
ip domain lookup  
Use this command to enable the DNS client.  
Default  
enabled  
Format  
Mode  
ip domain lookup  
Global Config  
no ip domain lookup  
Use this command to disable the DNS client.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip domain lookup  
Global Config  
ip domain name  
Use this command to define a default domain name that the software uses to complete  
unqualified host names (names with a domain name). By default, no default domain name is  
configured in the system. <name> may not be longer than 255 characters and should not  
include an initial period. This <name> should be used only when the default domain name list,  
configured using the ip domain listcommand, is empty.  
Default  
none  
Format  
Mode  
ip domain name <name>  
Global Config  
Example: The CLI command ip domain name yahoo.comwill configure yahoo.com as a default domain name.  
For an unqualified hostname xxx, a DNS query is made to find the IP address corresponding to xxx.yahoo.com.  
no ip domain name  
Use this command to remove the default domain name configured using the ip domain  
namecommand.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip domain name  
Global Config  
ip domain list  
Use this command to define a list of default domain names to complete unqualified names.  
By default, the list is empty. Each name must be no more than 256 characters, and should  
not include an initial period. The default domain name, configured using the ip domain  
Utility Commands  
576  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
namecommand, is used only when the default domain name list is empty. A maximum of 32  
names can be entered in to this list.  
Default  
none  
Format  
Mode  
ip domain list <name>  
Global Config  
no ip domain list  
Use this command to delete a name from a list.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip domain list <name>  
Global Config  
ip name server  
Use this command to configure the available name servers. Up to eight servers can be  
defined in one command or by using multiple commands. The parameter  
<server-address>is a valid IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. The preference of the  
servers is determined by the order they were entered.  
Format  
Mode  
ip name-server <server-address1> [server-address2...server-address8]  
Global Config  
no ip name server  
Use this command to remove a name server.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip name-server [server-address1...server-address8]  
Global Config  
ip host  
Use this command to define static host name-to-address mapping in the host cache. <name>  
is host name. <ip address> is the IP address of the host.  
Default  
none  
Format  
Mode  
ip host <name> <ipaddress>  
Global Config  
Utility Commands  
577  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no ip host  
Use this command to remove the name-to-address mapping.  
Format  
no ip host <name>  
Mode  
Global Config  
ipv6 host  
Use this command to define static host name-to-IPv6 address mapping in the host cache.  
<name> is host name. <v6 address> is the IPv6 address of the host.  
Default  
none  
Format  
Mode  
ipv6 host <name> <v6 address>  
Global Config  
no ipv6 host  
Use this command to remove the static host name-to-IPv6 address mapping in the host  
cache.  
Format  
Mode  
no ipv6 host <name>  
Global Config  
ip domain retry  
Use this command to specify the number of times to retry sending Domain Name System  
(DNS) queries. The parameter <number> indicates the number of times to retry sending a  
DNS query to the DNS server. This number ranges from 0 to 100.  
Default  
2
Format  
Mode  
ip domain retry <number>  
Global Config  
no ip domain retry  
Use this command to return to the default.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip domain retry <number>  
Global Config  
Utility Commands  
578  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
ip domain timeout  
Use this command to specify the amount of time to wait for a response to a DNS query. The  
parameter <seconds> specifies the time, in seconds, to wait for a response to a DNS query.  
<seconds> ranges from 0 to 3600.  
Default  
3
Format  
Mode  
ip domain timeout <seconds>  
Global Config  
no ip domain timeout  
Use this command to return to the default setting.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip domain timeout <seconds>  
Global Config  
clear host  
Use this command to delete entries from the host name-to-address cache. This command  
clears the entries from the DNS cache maintained by the software. This command clears  
both IPv4 and IPv6 entries.  
Format  
clear host {<name> | all}  
Mode  
Privileged EXEC  
Field  
Description  
name  
A particular host entry to remove. <name> ranges from 1-255 characters.  
all  
Removes all entries.  
show hosts  
Use this command to display the default domain name, a list of name server hosts, the static  
and the cached list of host names and addresses <name> ranges from 1-255 characters.  
This command displays both IPv4 and IPv6 entries.  
Format  
show hosts [name]  
Mode  
User EXEC  
Field  
Description  
Host Name  
Domain host name.  
Default Domain  
Default domain name.  
Utility Commands  
579  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Field  
Description  
Default Domain  
List  
Default domain list.  
Domain Name  
Lookup  
DNS client enabled/disabled.  
Number of  
Retries  
Number of time to retry sending Domain Name System (DNS) queries.  
Amount of time to wait for a response to a DNS query.  
Configured name servers.  
Retry Timeout  
Period  
Name Servers  
Example: The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
<Switch> show hosts  
Host name......................... Device  
Default domain.................... gm.com  
Default domain list............... yahoo.com, Stanford.edu, rediff.com  
Domain Name lookup................ Enabled  
Number of retries................. 5  
Retry timeout period.............. 1500  
Name servers (Preference order)... 176.16.1.18 176.16.1.19  
Configured host name-to-address mapping:  
Host  
Addresses  
------------------------------ ------------------------------  
accounting.gm.com  
Host  
--------------- -------- ------  
www.stanford.edu 72  
176.16.8.8  
Total Elapsed  
Type  
--------  
IP  
Addresses  
--------------  
171.64.14.203  
3
Packet Capture Commands  
Packet capture commands assist in troubleshooting protocol-related problems with the  
management CPU. The packets to and from the management CPU can be captured in an  
internally allocated buffer area for export to a PC host for protocol analysis. Public domain  
packet analysis tools like Ethereal can be used to decode and review the packets in detail.  
Capturing can be performed in a variety of modes, either transmit-side only, receive-side only,  
or both. The number of packets captured will depend on the size of the captured packets.  
capture {start|stop}  
Use the command capture startto manually start capturing CPU packets for packet  
trace. Capturing packets is stopped automatically when 128 packets are captured and have  
not yet been displayed during a capture session. It is guaranteed that packets not displayed  
and not saved will not be lost when capturing is in progress. Use the command capture  
stopto manually stop capturing CPU packets for packet trace before the moment when 128  
Utility Commands  
580  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
packets are captured and capturing packets is stopped automatically.The packet capture  
operates in three modes:  
Capture file  
Remote capture  
Capture line  
The command is not persistent across a reboot cycle.  
Format  
Mode  
capture {start|stop} {transmit|receive|all}  
Privileged EXEC  
capture {file|remote|line}  
Use this command to configure file capture options. The command is persistent across a  
reboot cycle.  
Default  
Remote  
Format  
Mode  
capture {file|remote|line}  
Global Config  
Parameter  
file  
Description  
In capture file mode, the captured packets are stored in a file on NVRAM. The maximum file  
size defaults to 524,288 bytes. The switch can transfer the file to a TFTP server via TFTP,  
SFTP, SCP via CLI, web and SNMP. The file is formatted in pcap format, is named  
cpuPktCapture.pcap, and can be examined using network analyzer tools such as  
Wireshark® by Ethereal®. Starting a file capture automatically terminates any remote capture  
sessions and line capturing. After the packet capture is activated, the capture proceeds until the  
capture file reaches its maximum size, or until the capture is stopped manually using the CLI  
command capture stop.  
remote  
In remote capture mode, the captured packets are redirected in real time to an external  
computer running the Wireshark tool for Microsoft® Windows®. A packet capture server runs on  
the switch side and sends the captured packets via a TCP connection to the Wireshark tool.  
The remote capture can be enabled or disabled using the CLI. There should be a Windows  
computer with the Wireshark tool to display the captured file. When using the remote capture  
mode, the switch does not store any captured data locally on its file system. You can configure  
the IP port number for connecting Wireshark to the switch. The default port number is 2002. If a  
firewall is installed between the Wireshark PC and the switch, these ports must be allowed to  
pass through the firewall. You must configure the firewall to allow the Wireshark computer to  
initiate TCP connections to the switch. If the socket connection to Wireshark has been  
established, the captured CPU packets are written to the data socket. Wireshark receives the  
packets and processes it to display. This continues until the session is terminated by either end.  
Starting a remote capture session automatically terminates the file capture and line capturing.  
line  
In capture line mode, the captured packets are saved in real-time mode into the RAM and can  
be displayed on the CLI. Starting a line capture automatically terminates any remote capture  
session and capturing into a file.  
Utility Commands  
581  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no capture  
Use this command to reset the capture mode to remote mode.  
Format  
Mode  
no capture  
Global Config  
capture remote port  
Use this command to configure file capture options. The command is persistent across a  
reboot cycle.  
Default  
2002  
Format  
Mode  
capture remote port <port-id>  
Global Config  
no capture remote port  
Use this command to reset the remote port to the default (2002).  
Format  
Mode  
no capture report port  
Global Config  
capture file size  
Use this command to configure file capture options. The command is persistent across a  
reboot cycle. The range is from 2 to 512 Kbytes.  
Default  
512Kbytes  
Format  
Mode  
capture file size <file-size>  
Global Config  
no capture file size  
Use this command to reset the file size to the default (512Kbytes).  
Format  
Mode  
no capture file size  
Global Config  
capture line wrap  
There are two methods to configure capturing CPU packets into RAM: capture line  
wrapand no capture line wrap. Use the capture line wrapcommand to stop  
automatically capturing packets when 128 packets are saved and have not yet been  
Utility Commands  
582  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
displayed during the capturing session. When capturing is in progress, unsaved,  
not-yet-displayed packets will not be lost.  
Default  
Disabled  
Format  
Mode  
capture line wrap  
Global Config  
no capture line wrap  
Use this command to disable the capture line wrap mode.  
Format  
Mode  
no capture line wrap  
Global Config  
show capture packets  
Use this command to display packets captured and saved to RAM. It is possible to capture  
and save into RAM, packets that are received or transmitted through the CPU. A maximum  
128 packets can be saved into RAM per capturing session. A maximum 128 bytes per packet  
can be saved into the RAM. If a packet holds more than 128 bytes, only the first 128 bytes  
are saved; data more than 128 bytes is skipped and cannot be displayed in the CLI.  
Capturing packets is stopped automatically when 128 packets are captured and have not yet  
been displayed during a capture session. Captured packets are not retained after a reload  
cycle.  
Format  
Mode  
show capture packets  
Privileged EXEC  
Serviceability Packet Tracing Commands  
These commands improve the capability of network engineers to diagnose conditions  
affecting their managed switch product.  
CAUTION:  
The output of the debugcommands can be long and might adversely  
affect system performance.  
debug arp  
Use this command to enable ARP debug protocol messages.  
Default  
disabled  
Utility Commands  
583  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Format  
Mode  
debug arp  
Privileged EXEC  
no debug arp  
Use this command to disable ARP debug protocol messages.  
Format  
Mode  
no debug arp  
Privileged EXEC  
debug auto-voip  
Use this command to enable Auto VOIP debug messages. Use the optional parameters to  
trace H323, SCCP, or SIP packets respectively.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
debug auto-voip [H323|SCCP|SIP]  
Privileged EXEC  
no debug auto-voip  
Use this command to disable Auto VOIP debug messages.  
Format  
Mode  
no debug auto-voip  
Privileged EXEC  
debug clear  
This command disables all previously enabled “debug” traces.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
debug clear  
Privileged EXEC  
debug console  
This command enables the display of “debug” trace output on the login session in which it is  
executed. Debug console display must be enabled in order to view any trace output. The  
output of debug trace commands will appear on all login sessions for which debug console  
has been enabled. The configuration of this command remains in effect for the life of the login  
session. The effect of this command is not persistent across resets.  
Default  
disabled  
Utility Commands  
584  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Format  
Mode  
debug console  
Privileged EXEC  
no debug console  
This command disables the display of “debug” trace output on the login session in which it is  
executed.  
Format  
Mode  
no debug console  
Privileged EXEC  
debug crashlog  
Use this command to view information contained in the crash log file that the system  
maintains when it experiences an unexpected reset. The crash log file contains the following  
information:  
Call stack information in both primitive and verbose forms  
Log Status  
Buffered logging  
Event logging  
Persistent logging  
System Information (output of sysapiMbufDump)  
Message Queue Debug Information  
Memory Debug Information  
Memory Debug Status  
OS Information (output of osapiShowTasks)  
/proc information (meminfo, cpuinfo, interrupts, version and net/sockstat)  
Format  
debug crashlog {[kernel] crashlog-number [upload url] | proc |  
verbose | deteall}  
Mode  
Privileged EXEC  
Disabled  
Default  
Parameter  
kernel  
Definition  
View the crash log file for the kernel.  
crashlog-number  
Specifies the file number to view. The system maintains up to four copies, and the valid  
range is 1–4.  
upload url  
To upload the crash log to a TFTP server, use the uploadkeyword and specify the  
required TFTP server information.  
Utility Commands  
585  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Parameter  
proc  
Definition  
View the application process crashlog.  
Enable the verbose crashlog  
verbose  
deleteall  
Delete all crash log files on the system.  
debug dhcp packet  
Use this command to display “debug” information about DHCPv4 client activities and trace  
DHCPv4 packets to and from the local DHCPv4 client.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
debug dhcp packet [transmit | receive]  
Privileged EXEC  
no debug dhcp  
Use this command to disable the display of “debug” trace output for DHCPv4 client activity.  
Format  
Mode  
no debug dhcp packet [transmit | receive]  
Privileged EXEC  
debug dot1x packet  
Use this command to enable dot1x packet debug trace.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
debug dot1x  
Privileged EXEC  
no debug dot1x packet  
Use this command to disable dot1x packet debug trace.  
Format  
Mode  
no debug dot1x  
Privileged EXEC  
debug igmpsnooping packet  
This command enables tracing of IGMP Snooping packets received and transmitted by the  
switch.  
Default  
disabled  
Utility Commands  
586  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Format  
Mode  
debug igmpsnooping packet  
Privileged EXEC  
no debug igmpsnooping packet  
This command disables tracing of IGMP Snooping packets.  
Format  
Mode  
no debug igmpsnooping packet  
Privileged EXEC  
debug igmpsnooping packet transmit  
This command enables tracing of IGMP Snooping packets transmitted by the switch.  
Snooping should be enabled on the device and the interface in order to monitor packets for a  
particular interface.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
debug igmpsnooping packet transmit  
Privileged EXEC  
A sample output of the trace message is shown below.  
<15> JAN 01 02:45:06 192.168.17.29-1 IGMPSNOOP[185429992]: igmp_snooping_debug.c(116)  
908 % Pkt TX - Intf: 0/20(20), Vlan_Id:1 Src_Mac: 00:03:0e:00:00:00 Dest_Mac:  
01:00:5e:00:00:01 Src_IP: 9.1.1.1 Dest_IP: 225.0.0.1 Type: V2_Membership_Report Group:  
225.0.0.1  
The following parameters are displayed in the trace message:  
Parameter  
TX  
Definition  
A packet transmitted by the device.  
Intf  
The interface that the packet went out on. Format used is slot/port (internal interface  
number). Unit is always shown as 1 for interfaces on a non-stacking device.  
Src_Mac  
Dest_Mac  
Src_IP  
Source MAC address of the packet.  
Destination multicast MAC address of the packet.  
The source IP address in the IP header in the packet.  
The destination multicast IP address in the packet.  
Dest_IP  
Utility Commands  
587  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Parameter  
Type  
Definition  
The type of IGMP packet. Type can be one of the following:  
Membership Query – IGMP Membership Query  
V1_Membership_Report – IGMP Version 1 Membership Report  
V2_Membership_Report – IGMP Version 2 Membership Report  
V3_Membership_Report – IGMP Version 3 Membership Report  
V2_Leave_Group – IGMP Version 2 Leave Group  
Group  
Multicast group address in the IGMP header.  
no debug igmpsnooping transmit  
This command disables tracing of transmitted IGMP snooping packets.  
Format  
Mode  
no debug igmpsnooping transmit  
Privileged EXEC  
debug igmpsnooping packet receive  
This command enables tracing of IGMP Snooping packets received by the switch. Snooping  
should be enabled on the device and the interface in order to monitor packets for a particular  
interface.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
debug igmpsnooping packet receive  
Privileged EXEC  
A sample output of the trace message is shown below.  
<15> JAN 01 02:45:06 192.168.17.29-1 IGMPSNOOP[185429992]: igmp_snooping_debug.c(116)  
908 % Pkt RX - Intf: 0/20(20), Vlan_Id:1 Src_Mac: 00:03:0e:00:00:10 Dest_Mac:  
01:00:5e:00:00:05 Src_IP: 11.1.1.1 Dest_IP: 225.0.0.5 Type: Membership_Query Group:  
225.0.0.5  
The following parameters are displayed in the trace message:  
Parameter  
RX  
Definition  
A packet received by the device.  
Intf  
The interface that the packet went out on. Format used is slot/port (internal interface  
number). Unit is always shown as 1 for interfaces on a non-stacking device.  
Src_Mac  
Dest_Mac  
Src_IP  
Source MAC address of the packet.  
Destination multicast MAC address of the packet.  
The source IP address in the ip header in the packet.  
The destination multicast ip address in the packet.  
Dest_IP  
Utility Commands  
588  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Parameter  
Type  
Definition  
The type of IGMP packet. Type can be one of the following:  
Membership_Query – IGMP Membership Query  
V1_Membership_Report – IGMP Version 1 Membership Report  
V2_Membership_Report – IGMP Version 2 Membership Report  
V3_Membership_Report – IGMP Version 3 Membership Report  
V2_Leave_Group – IGMP Version 2 Leave Group  
Group  
Multicast group address in the IGMP header.  
no debug igmpsnooping receive  
This command disables tracing of received IGMP Snooping packets.  
Format  
Mode  
no debug igmpsnooping receive  
Privileged EXEC  
debug ip acl  
Use this command to enable debug of IP Protocol packets matching the ACL criteria.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
debug ip acl <acl Number>  
Privileged EXEC  
no debug ip acl  
Use this command to disable debug of IP Protocol packets matching the ACL criteria.  
Format  
Mode  
no debug ip acl <acl Number>  
Privileged EXEC  
debug ip dvmrp packet  
Use this command to trace DVMRP packet reception and transmission. receive traces only  
received DVMRP packets and transmit traces only transmitted DVMRP packets. When  
neither keyword is used in the command, then all DVMRP packet traces are dumped. Vital  
information such as source address, destination address, control packet type, packet length,  
and the interface on which the packet is received or transmitted is displayed on the console.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
debug ip dvmrp packet [receive|transmit]  
Privileged EXEC  
Utility Commands  
589  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no debug ip dvmrp packet  
Use this command to disable debug tracing of DVMRP packet reception and transmission.  
Format  
Mode  
no debug ip dvmrp packet [receive|transmit]  
Privileged EXEC  
debug ip igmp packet  
Use this command to trace IGMP packet reception and transmission. receive traces only  
received IGMP packets and transmit traces only transmitted IGMP packets. When neither  
keyword is used in the command, then all IGMP packet traces are dumped. Vital information  
such as source address, destination address, control packet type, packet length, and the  
interface on which the packet is received or transmitted is displayed on the console.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
debug ip igmp packet [receive|transmit]  
Privileged EXEC  
no debug ip igmp packet  
Use this command to disable debug tracing of IGMP packet reception and transmission.  
Format  
Mode  
no debug ip igmp packet [receive|transmit]  
Privileged EXEC  
debug ip mcache packet  
Use this command for tracing MDATA packet reception and transmission. receive traces only  
received data packets and transmit traces only transmitted data packets. When neither  
keyword is used in the command, then all data packet traces are dumped. Vital information  
such as source address, destination address, packet length, and the interface on which the  
packet is received or transmitted is displayed on the console.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
debug ip mcache packet [receive|transmit]  
Privileged EXEC  
no debug ip mcache packet  
Use this command to disable debug tracing of MDATA packet reception and transmission.  
Format  
Mode  
no debug ip mcache packet [receive|transmit]  
Privileged EXEC  
Utility Commands  
590  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
debug ip pimdm packet  
Use this command to trace PIMDM packet reception and transmission. receive traces only  
received PIMDM packets and transmit traces only transmitted PIMDM packets. When  
neither keyword is used in the command, then all PIMDM packet traces are dumped. Vital  
information such as source address, destination address, control packet type, packet length,  
and the interface on which the packet is received or transmitted is displayed on the console.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
debug ip pimdm packet [receive|transmit]  
Privileged EXEC  
no debug ip pimdm packet  
Use this command to disable debug tracing of PIMDM packet reception and transmission.  
Format  
Mode  
no debug ip pimdm packet [receive|transmit]  
Privileged EXEC  
debug ip pimsm packet  
Use this command to trace PIMSM packet reception and transmission. receive traces only  
received PIMSM packets and transmit traces only transmitted PIMSM packets. When  
neither keyword is used in the command, then all PIMSM packet traces are dumped. Vital  
information such as source address, destination address, control packet type, packet length,  
and the interface on which the packet is received or transmitted is displayed on the console.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
debug ip pimsm packet [receive|transmit]  
Privileged EXEC  
no debug ip pimsm packet  
Use this command to disable debug tracing of PIMSM packet reception and transmission.  
Format  
Mode  
no debug ip pimsm packet [receive|transmit]  
Privileged EXEC  
debug ip vrrp  
Use this command to enable VRRP debug protocol messages.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
debug ip vrrp  
Privileged EXEC  
Utility Commands  
591  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no debug ip vrrp  
Use this command to disable VRRP debug protocol messages.  
Format  
Mode  
no debug ip vrrp  
Privileged EXEC  
debug ipv6 dhcp  
Use this command to display “debug” information about DHCPv6 client activities and trace  
DHCPv6 packets to and from the local DHCPv6 client.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
debug ipv6 dhcp  
Privileged EXEC  
no ipv6 debug dhcp  
Use this command to disable the display of “debug” trace output for DHCPv6 client activity.  
Format  
Mode  
no debug ipv6 dhcp  
Privileged EXEC  
debug ipv6 mcache packet  
Use this command for tracing MDATAv6 packet reception and transmission. receive traces  
only received data packets and transmit traces only transmitted data packets. When neither  
keyword is used in the command, then all data packet traces are dumped. Vital information  
such as source address, destination address, packet length, and the interface on which the  
packet is received or transmitted is displayed on the console.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
debug ipv6 mcache packet [receive|transmit]  
Privileged EXEC  
no debug ipv6 mcache packet  
Use this command to disable debug tracing of MDATAv6 packet reception and transmission.  
Format  
Mode  
no debug ipv6 mcache packet [receive|transmit]  
Privileged EXEC  
Utility Commands  
592  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
debug ipv6 mld packet  
Use this command to trace MLDv6 packet reception and transmission. receive traces only  
received MLDv6 packets and transmit traces only transmitted MLDv6 packets. When neither  
keyword is used in the command, then all MLDv6 packet traces are dumped. Vital  
information such as source address, destination address, control packet type, packet length,  
and the interface on which the packet is received or transmitted is displayed on the console.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
debug ipv6 mld packet [receive|transmit]  
Privileged EXEC  
no debug ipv6 mld packet  
Use this command to disable debug tracing of MLDv6 packet reception and transmission.  
Format  
Mode  
no debug ipv6 mld packet [receive|transmit]  
Privileged EXEC  
debug ipv6 pimdm packet  
Use this command to trace PIMDMv6 packet reception and transmission. receive traces only  
received PIMDMv6 packets and transmit traces only transmitted PIMDMv6 packets. When  
neither keyword is used in the command, then all PIMDMv6 packet traces are dumped. Vital  
information such as source address, destination address, control packet type, packet length,  
and the interface on which the packet is received or transmitted is displayed on the console.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
debug ipv6 pimdm packet [receive|transmit]  
Privileged EXEC  
no debug ipv6 pimdm packet  
Use this command to disable debug tracing of PIMDMv6 packet reception and transmission.  
debug ipv6 pimsm packet  
Use this command to trace PIMSMv6 packet reception and transmission. receive traces only  
received PIMSMv6 packets and transmit traces only transmitted PIMSMv6 packets. When  
neither keyword is used in the command, then all PIMSMv6 packet traces are dumped. Vital  
information such as source address, destination address, control packet type, packet length,  
and the interface on which the packet is received or transmitted is displayed on the console.  
Default  
disabled  
Utility Commands  
593  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Format  
Mode  
debug ipv6 pimsm packet [receive|transmit]  
Privileged EXEC  
no debug ipv6 pimsm packet  
Use this command to disable debug tracing of PIMSMv6 packet reception and transmission.  
Format  
Mode  
no debug ipv6 pimsm packet [receive|transmit]  
Privileged EXEC  
debug lacp packet  
This command enables tracing of LACP packets received and transmitted by the switch.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
debug lacp packet  
Privileged EXEC  
A sample output of the trace message is shown below.  
<15> JAN 01 14:04:51 10.254.24.31-1 DOT3AD[183697744]: dot3ad_debug.c(385) 58 %%  
Pkt TX - Intf: 0/1(1), Type: LACP, Sys: 00:11:88:14:62:e1, State: 0x47, Key:  
0x36  
no debug lacp packet  
This command disables tracing of LACP packets.  
Format  
Mode  
no debug lacp packet  
Privileged EXEC  
debug mldsnooping packet  
Use this command to trace MLD snooping packet reception and transmission. receive traces  
only received MLD snooping packets and transmit traces only transmitted MLD snooping  
packets. When neither keyword is used in the command, then all MLD snooping packet  
traces are dumped. Vital information such as source address, destination address, control  
packet type, packet length, and the interface on which the packet is received or transmitted is  
displayed on the console.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
debug mldsnooping packet [receive|transmit]  
Privileged EXEC  
Utility Commands  
594  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no debug mldsnooping packet  
Use this command to disable debug tracing of MLD snooping packet reception and  
transmission.  
debug ospf packet  
This command enables tracing of OSPF packets received and transmitted by the switch.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
debug ospf packet  
Privileged EXEC  
Sample outputs of the trace messages are shown below.  
<15> JAN 02 11:03:31 10.50.50.1-2 OSPF[46300472]: ospf_debug.c(297) 25430 % Pkt RX -  
Intf:2/0/48 Src  
Ip:192.168.50.2 DestIp:224.0.0.5 AreaId:0.0.0.0 Type:HELLO NetMask:255.255.255.0  
DesigRouter:0.0.0.0 Backup:0.0.0.0  
<15> JAN 02 11:03:35 10.50.50.1-2 OSPF[46300472]: ospf_debug.c(293) 25431 % Pkt TX -  
Intf:2/0/48 Src  
Ip:10.50.50.1 DestIp:192.168.50.2 AreaId:0.0.0.0 Type:DB_DSCR Mtu:1500 Options:E  
Flags: I/M/MS Seq:126166  
<15> JAN 02 11:03:36 10.50.50.1-2 OSPF[46300472]: ospf_debug.c(297) 25434 % Pkt RX -  
Intf:2/0/48 Src  
Ip:192.168.50.2 DestIp:192.168.50.1 AreaId:0.0.0.0 Type:LS_REQ Length: 1500  
<15> JAN 02 11:03:36 10.50.50.1-2 OSPF[46300472]: ospf_debug.c(293) 25435 % Pkt TX -  
Intf:2/0/48 Src  
Ip:10.50.50.1 DestIp:192.168.50.2 AreaId:0.0.0.0 Type:LS_UPD Length: 1500  
<15> JAN 02 11:03:37 10.50.50.1-2 OSPF[46300472]: ospf_debug.c(293) 25441 % Pkt TX -  
Intf:2/0/48 Src  
Ip:10.50.50.1 DestIp:224.0.0.6 AreaId:0.0.0.0 Type:LS_ACK Length: 1500  
The following parameters are displayed in the trace message:  
Parameter  
TX/RX  
Definition  
TX refers to a packet transmitted by the device. RX refers to packets received by the  
device.  
Intf  
The interface that the packet came in or went out on. Format used is slot/port (internal  
interface number).  
SrcIp  
The source IP address in the IP header of the packet.  
The destination IP address in the IP header of the packet.  
DestIp  
Utility Commands  
595  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Parameter  
AreaId  
Definition  
The area ID in the OSPF header of the packet.  
Type  
Could be one of the following:  
HELLO– Hello packet  
DB_DSCR– Database descriptor  
LS_REQ– LS Request  
LS_UPD– LS Update  
LS_ACK– LS Acknowledge  
The remaining fields in the trace are specific to the type of OSPF Packet.  
HELLO packet field definitions:  
Parameter  
Definition  
Netmask  
The netmask in the hello packet.  
Designated Router IP address.  
Backup router IP address.  
DesignRouter  
Backup  
DB_DSCR packet field definitions:  
Field  
Definition  
MTU  
MTU  
Options  
Flags  
Options in the OSPF packet.  
Could be one or more of the following:  
I – Init  
M – More  
MS – Master/Slave  
Seq  
Sequence Number of the DD packet.  
LS_REQ packet field definitions.  
Field  
Definition  
Length  
Length of packet  
LS_UPD packet field definitions.  
Field  
Length  
Definition  
Length of packet  
Utility Commands  
596  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
LS_ACK packet field definitions.  
Field  
Definition  
Length  
Length of packet  
no debug ospf packet  
This command disables tracing of OSPF packets.  
Format  
Mode  
no debug ospf packet  
Privileged EXEC  
debug ipv6 ospfv3 packet  
Use this command to enable OSPFv3 packet debug trace.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
debug ipv6 ospfv3 packet  
Privileged EXEC  
no debug ipv6 ospfv3 packet  
Use this command to disable tracing of OSPFv3 packets.  
Format  
Mode  
no debug ipv6 ospfv3 packet  
Privileged EXEC  
debug ping packet  
This command enables tracing of ICMP echo requests and responses. The command traces  
pings on the network port/ serviceport for switching packages. For routing packages, pings  
are traced on the routing ports as well.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
debug ping packet  
Privileged EXEC  
A sample output of the trace message is shown below.  
<15> JAN 01 00:21:22 192.168.17.29-1 SIM[181040176]: sim_debug.c(128) 20 % Pkt TX - Intf:  
0/1(1),  
SRC_IP:10.50.50.2, DEST_IP:10.50.50.1, Type:ECHO_REQUEST  
<15> JAN 01 00:21:22 192.168.17.29-1 SIM[182813968]: sim_debug.c(82) 21 % Pkt RX - Intf:  
0/1(1), S  
RC_IP:10.50.50.1, DEST_IP:10.50.50.2, Type:ECHO_REPLY  
Utility Commands  
597  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
The following parameters are displayed in the trace message:  
Parameter  
Definition  
TX/RX  
TX refers to a packet transmitted by the device. RX refers to packets received by the  
device.  
Intf  
The interface that the packet came in or went out on. Format used is slot/port (internal  
interface number). Unit is always shown as 1 for interfaces on a non-stacking device.  
SRC_IP  
DEST_IP  
Type  
The source IP address in the IP header in the packet.  
The destination IP address in the IP header in the packet.  
Type determines whether or not the ICMP message is a REQUEST or a RESPONSE.  
no debug ping packet  
This command disables tracing of ICMP echo requests and responses.  
Format  
Mode  
no debug ping packet  
Privileged EXEC  
debug rip packet  
This command turns on tracing of RIP requests and responses. This command takes no  
options. The output is directed to the log file.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
debug rip packet  
Privileged EXEC  
A sample output of the trace message is shown below.  
<15> JAN 01 00:35:15 192.168.17.29-1 RIP[181783160]: rip_map_debug.c(96) 775 %  
Pkt RX on Intf: 0/1(1), Src_IP:43.1.1.1 Dest_IP:43.1.1.2  
Rip_Version: RIPv2 Packet_Type:RIP_RESPONSE  
ROUTE 1): Network: 10.1.1.0 Mask: 255.255.255.0 Metric: 1  
ROUTE 2): Network: 40.1.0.0 Mask: 255.255.0.0 Metric: 1  
ROUTE 3): Network: 10.50.50.0 Mask: 255.255.255.0 Metric: 1  
ROUTE 4): Network: 41.1.0.0 Mask: 255.255.0.0 Metric: 1  
ROUTE 5): Network:42.0.0.0 Mask:255.0.0.0 Metric:1  
Another 6 routes present in packet not displayed.  
Utility Commands  
598  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
The following parameters are displayed in the trace message:  
Parameter  
Definition  
TX/RX  
TX refers to a packet transmitted by the device. RX refers to packets received by the  
device.  
Intf  
The interface that the packet came in or went out on. Format used is slot/port (internal  
interface number). Unit is always shown as 1 for interfaces on a non-stacking device.  
Src_IP  
The source IP address in the IP header of the packet.  
The destination IP address in the IP header of the packet.  
RIP version used <RIPv1 or RIPv2>.  
Dest_IP  
Rip_Version  
Packet_Type  
Routes  
Type of RIP packet. <RIP_REQUEST or RIP_RESPONSE>.  
Up to 5 routes in the packet are displayed in the following format:  
Network: <a.b.c.d> Mask <a.b.c.d> Next_Hop <a.b.c.d> Metric <a>  
The next hop is only displayed if it is different from 0.0.0.0.  
For RIPv1 packets, Mask is always 0.0.0.0.  
Number of  
routes not  
printed  
Only the first five routes present in the packet are included in the trace. There is another  
notification of the number of additional routes present in the packet that were not  
included in the trace.  
no debug rip packet  
This command disables tracing of RIP requests and responses.  
Format  
Mode  
no debug rip packet  
Privileged EXEC  
debug sflow packet  
Use this command to enable sFlow debug packet trace.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
debug sflow packet  
Privileged EXEC  
no debug sflow packet  
Use this command to disable sFlow debug packet trace.  
Format  
Mode  
no debug sflow packet  
Privileged EXEC  
Utility Commands  
599  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
debug spanning-tree bpdu  
This command enables tracing of spanning tree BPDUs received and transmitted by the  
switch.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
debug spanning-tree bpdu  
Privileged EXEC  
no debug spanning-tree bpdu  
This command disables tracing of spanning tree BPDUs.  
Format  
Mode  
no debug spanning-tree bpdu  
Privileged EXEC  
debug spanning-tree bpdu receive  
This command enables tracing of spanning tree BPDUs received by the switch. Spanning  
tree should be enabled on the device and on the interface in order to monitor packets for a  
particular interface.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
debug spanning-tree bpdu receive  
Privileged EXEC  
A sample output of the trace message is shown below.  
<15> JAN 01 01:02:04 192.168.17.29-1 DOT1S[191096896]: dot1s_debug.c(1249) 101 % Pkt RX  
- Intf: 0/9(9), Source_Mac: 00:11:88:4e:c2:10 Version: 3, Root Mac: 00:11:88:4e:c2:00,  
Root Priority: 0x8000 Path Cost: 0  
The following parameters are displayed in the trace message:  
Parameter  
RX  
Definition  
A packet received by the device.  
Intf  
The interface that the packet came in on. Format used is slot/port (internal interface  
number). Unit is always shown as 1 for interfaces on a non-stacking device.  
Source_Mac  
Version  
Source MAC address of the packet.  
Spanning tree protocol version (0-3). 0 refers to STP, 2 RSTP and 3 MSTP.  
MAC address of the CIST root bridge.  
Root_Mac  
Root_Priority  
Priority of the CIST root bridge. The value is between 0 and 61440. It is displayed in hex  
in multiples of 4096.  
Path_Cost  
External root path cost component of the BPDU.  
Utility Commands  
600  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no debug spanning-tree bpdu receive  
This command disables tracing of received spanning tree BPDUs.  
Format  
Mode  
no debug spanning-tree bpdu receive  
Privileged EXEC  
debug spanning-tree bpdu transmit  
This command enables tracing of spanning tree BPDUs transmitted by the switch. Spanning  
tree should be enabled on the device and on the interface in order to monitor packets on a  
particular interface.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
debug spanning-tree bpdu transmit  
Privileged EXEC  
A sample output of the trace message is shown below.  
<15> JAN 01 01:02:04 192.168.17.29-1 DOT1S[191096896]: dot1s_debug.c(1249) 101 % Pkt TX  
- Intf: 0/7(7), Source_Mac: 00:11:88:4e:c2:00 Version: 3, Root_Mac: 00:11:88:4e:c2:00,  
Root_Priority: 0x8000 Path_Cost: 0  
The following parameters are displayed in the trace message:  
Parameter  
TX  
Definition  
A packet transmitted by the device.  
Intf  
The interface that the packet went out on. Format used is slot/port (internal interface  
number). Unit is always shown as 1 for interfaces on a non-stacking device.  
Source_Mac  
Version  
Source MAC address of the packet.  
Spanning tree protocol version (0-3). 0 refers to STP, 2 RSTP and 3 MSTP.  
MAC address of the CIST root bridge.  
Root_Mac  
Root_Priority  
Priority of the CIST root bridge. The value is from 0 through 61,440. It is displayed in hex  
in multiples of 4096.  
Path_Cost  
External root path cost component of the BPDU.  
no debug spanning-tree bpdu transmit  
This command disables tracing of transmitted spanning tree BPDUs.  
Format  
Mode  
no debug spanning-tree bpdu transmit  
Privileged EXEC  
Utility Commands  
601  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
debug udld packet  
This command enables debugging on the received and transmitted UDLD PDU’s.  
Format  
default udld packet receive  
Privileged EXEC  
Mode  
Default  
Disabled  
no debug udld packet  
This command disables debugging on the received and transmitted UDLD PDU’s.  
Format  
Mode  
debug udld packet receive  
Privileged EXEC  
debug udld packet receive  
This command enables debugging on the received UDLD PDU’s.  
Format  
Mode  
default udld packet receive  
Privileged EXEC  
Default  
Disabled  
no debug udld packet receive  
This command disables debugging on the received UDLD PDU’s.  
Format  
Mode  
debug udld packet receive  
Privileged EXEC  
debug udld packet transmit  
This command enables debugging on the transmitted UDLD PDU’s.  
Format  
Mode  
default udld packet transmit  
Privileged EXEC  
Default  
Disabled  
no debug udld packet transmit  
This command enables debugging on the transmitted UDLD PDU’s.  
Format  
Mode  
debug udld packet transmit  
Privileged EXEC  
Utility Commands  
602  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
debug aaa accounting  
This command is useful for debugging accounting configuration and functionality in User  
Manager.  
Format  
Mode  
debug aaa accounting  
Privileged EXEC  
no debug aaa accounting  
Use this command to turn off debugging of User Manager accounting functionality.  
Format  
Mode  
no debug aaa accounting  
Privileged EXEC  
debug aaa authorization  
This command is useful for debugging authorization configuration and functionality in User  
Manager.  
Format  
Mode  
debug aaa authorization [commands|exec]  
Privileged EXEC  
no debug aaa authorization  
Use this command to turn off debugging of User Manager authorization functionality.  
Format  
Mode  
no debug aaa authorization  
Privileged EXEC  
Cable Test Command  
The cable test feature enables you to determine the cable connection status on a selected  
port.  
Note: The cable test feature is supported only for copper cable. It is not  
supported for optical fiber cable. If the port has an active link while  
the cable test is run, the link can go down for the duration of the test.  
Utility Commands  
603  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
cablestatus  
This command returns the status of the specified port.  
Format  
Mode  
cablestatus <slot/port>  
Privileged EXEC  
Field  
Description  
Cable Status  
One of the following statuses is returned:  
Normal: The cable is working correctly.  
Open: The cable is disconnected or there is a faulty connector.  
Short: There is an electrical short in the cable.  
Cable Test Failed: The cable status could not be determined. The cable may in fact  
be working.  
Cable Length  
If this feature is supported by the PHY for the current link speed, the cable length is  
displayed as a range between the shortest estimated length and the longest estimated  
length. Note that if the link is down and a cable is attached to a 10/100 Ethernet adapter,  
then the cable status may display as Open or Short because some Ethernet adapters  
leave unused wire pairs unterminated or grounded. Unknown is displayed if the cable  
length could not be determined.  
sFlow Commands  
®
sFlow is the standard for monitoring high-speed switched and routed networks. sFlow  
technology is built into network equipment and gives complete visibility into network activity,  
enabling effective management and control of network resources.  
sflow receiver  
Use this command to configure the sFlow collector parameters (owner string, receiver  
timeout, max datagram size, IP address, and port).  
Format  
sflow receiver <rcvr_idx> owner <owner-string> [timeout  
<rcvr_timeout> | notimeout] max datagram <size> ip/ipv6 <ip> port  
<port>  
Mode  
Global Config  
Utility Commands  
604  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Field  
Description  
Receiver Owner  
The identity string for the receiver, the entity making use of this sFlowRcvrTable entry.  
The range is 127 characters. The default is a null string. The empty string indicates that  
the entry is currently unclaimed and the receiver configuration is reset to the default  
values. An entity wishing to claim an sFlowRcvrTable entry must ensure that the entry is  
unclaimed before trying to claim it. The entry is claimed by setting the owner string to a  
non-null value. The entry must be claimed before assigning a receiver to a sampler or  
poller.  
Receiver  
Timeout  
The time, in seconds, remaining before the sampler or poller is released and stops  
sending samples to receiver. A management entity wanting to maintain control of the  
sampler is responsible for setting a new value before the old one expires. The allowed  
range is 0-4294967295 seconds. The default is zero (0).  
Receiver Max  
Datagram Size  
The maximum number of data bytes that can be sent in a single sample datagram. The  
management entity should set this value to avoid fragmentation of the sFlow datagrams.  
The allowed range is 200 –9,116). The default is 1400.  
Receiver IP  
The sFlow receiver IP address. If set to 0.0.0.0, no sFlow datagrams will be sent. The  
default is 0.0.0.0.  
Receiver Port  
The destination Layer4 UDP port for sFlow datagrams. The range is 1-65535. The  
default is 6343.  
no sflow receiver  
Use this command to set the sFlow collector parameters back to the defaults.  
Format  
Mode  
no sflow receiver <indx> {ip <ip-address> | maxdatagram <size> | owner  
<string> timeout <interval> | port <14-port>}  
Global Config  
sflow sampler  
A data source configured to collect flow samples is called a poller. Use this command to  
configure a new sFlow sampler instance for this data source if <rcvr_idx> is valid.  
Format  
Mode  
sflow sampler {<rcvr-indx> | rate <sampling-rate> | maxheadersize  
<size>}  
Interface Config  
Utility Commands  
605  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Field  
Description  
Receiver Index  
The sFlow Receiver for this sFlow sampler to which flow samples are to be sent. A value  
of zero (0) means that no receiver is configured, no packets will be sampled. Only active  
receivers can be set. If a receiver expires, then all samplers associated with the receiver  
will also expire. Possible values are 1-8. The default is 0.  
Maxheadersize  
Sampling Rate  
The maximum number of bytes that should be copied from the sampler packet. The  
range is 20-256. The default is 128. When set to zero (0), all the sampler parameters are  
set to their corresponding default value.  
The statistical sampling rate for packet sampling from this source. A sampling rate of 1  
counts all packets. A value of zero (0) disables sampling. A value of N means that out of  
N incoming packets, 1 packet will be sampled. The range is 1024-65536 and 0. The  
default is 0.  
no sflow sampler  
Use this command to reset the sFlow sampler instance to the default settings.  
Format  
Mode  
no sflow sampler {<rcvr-indx> | rate <sampling-rate> | maxheadersize  
<size>}  
Interface Config  
sflow poller  
A data source configured to collect counter samples is called a poller. Use this command to  
enable a new sFlow poller instance for this data source if <rcvr_idx> is valid.  
Format  
sflow poller {<rcvr-indx> | interval <poll-interval>}  
Mode  
Interface Config  
Field  
Description  
Receiver Index  
Enter the sFlow Receiver associated with the sampler/poller. A value of zero (0) means  
that no receiver is configured. The range is 1-8. The default is 0.  
Poll Interval  
Enter the sFlow instance polling interval. A poll interval of zero (0) disables counter  
sampling. When set to zero (0), all the poller parameters are set to their corresponding  
default value. The range is 0-86400. The default is 0. A value of N means once in N  
seconds a counter sample is generated.  
no sflow poller  
Use this command to reset the sFlow poller instance to the default settings.  
Format  
Mode  
no sflow poller {<rcvr-indx> | interval <poll-interval>}  
Interface Config  
Utility Commands  
606  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show sflow agent  
The sFlow agent collects time-based sampling of network interface statistics and flow-based  
samples. These are sent to the configured sFlow receivers. Use this command to display the  
sFlow agent information.  
Format  
show sflow agent  
Mode  
Privileged EXEC  
Field  
Description  
sFlow Version  
Uniquely identifies the version and implementation of this MIB. The version string must  
have the following structure: MIB Version; Organization; Software Revision where:  
• MIB Version: ‘1.3’, the version of this MIB.  
• Organization: Netgear.  
• Revision: 1.0  
IP Address  
The IP address associated with this agent.  
Example: The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(switch) #show sflow agent  
sFlow Version.................................. 1.3;Netgear;1.0  
IP Address..................................... 10.131.12.66  
show sflow pollers  
Use this command to display the sFlow polling instances created on the switch. Use “-” for  
range.  
Format  
Mode  
show sflow pollers  
Privileged EXEC  
Field  
Description  
Poller Data  
Source  
The sFlowDataSource (slot/port) for this sFlow sampler. This agent will support Physical  
ports only.  
Receiver Index  
Poller Interval  
The sFlowReceiver associated with this sFlow counter poller.  
The number of seconds between successive samples of the counters associated with  
this data source.  
Utility Commands  
607  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show sflow receivers  
Use this command to display configuration information related to the sFlow receivers.  
Format  
show sflow receivers [<index>]  
Mode  
Privileged EXEC  
Field  
Description  
Receiver Index  
The sFlow Receiver associated with the sampler/poller.  
The identity string for receiver, the entity making use of this sFlowRcvrTable entry.  
Owner String  
Time Out  
The time (in seconds) remaining before the receiver is released and stops sending  
samples to sFlow receiver.  
Max Datagram  
Size  
The maximum number of bytes that can be sent in a single sFlow datagram.  
Port  
The destination Layer4 UDP port for sFlow datagrams.  
The sFlow receiver IP address.  
IP Address  
Address Type  
The sFlow receiver IP address type. For an IPv4 address, the value is 1 and for an IPv6  
address, the value is 2.  
Datagram  
Version  
The sFlow protocol version to be used while sending samples to sFlow receiver.  
Example: The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(switch) #show sflow receivers 1  
Receiver Index................................. 1  
Owner String...................................  
Time out....................................... 0  
IP Address:.................................... 0.0.0.0  
Address Type................................... 1  
Port........................................... 6343  
Datagram Version............................... 5  
Maximum Datagram Size.......................... 1400  
show sflow samplers  
Use this command to display the sFlow sampling instances created on the switch.  
Format  
Mode  
show sflow samplers  
Privileged EXEC  
Utility Commands  
608  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Field  
Description  
Sampler Data  
Source  
The sFlowDataSource (slot/port) for this sFlow sampler. This agent will support Physical  
ports only.  
Receiver Index  
The sFlowReceiver configured for this sFlow sampler.  
Packet  
Sampling Rate  
The statistical sampling rate for packet sampling from this source.  
Max Header  
Size  
The maximum number of bytes that should be copied from a sampled packet to form a  
flow sample.  
Software License Commands  
License commands allow you to configure advanced features on some layer2 managed  
switches. The following table lists the software license matrix for the layer2 managed  
switches. For details, see Licensing and Command Support on page 8.  
Switch  
IPv4 Routing  
IPv6 Routing  
IP Multicast  
Managed Switches  
Licensed  
Licensed  
Licensed  
Note: The software license allows the user to download a license file only  
on the Master unit. The file cannot be downloaded on a Slave unit.  
There are two options to download the license file to the switch:  
Use the Copy command to download the license file through the CLI.  
Go to the Maintenance > Download page to download the licence file through the GUI.  
show license  
This command displays the license status.  
License Date indicates the date of the license. License Status indicates whether license is  
active or inactive.  
Format  
Mode  
show license  
Privileged EXEC  
Example: The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(Managed Switches) #show license  
License date : Apr-9-2010  
License copy : 1  
License Status: Active  
Description : License key is active.  
Utility Commands  
609  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
(Managed Switches) #  
show license features  
This command displays the features that are licensed on the switch  
Format  
Mode  
show license features  
Privileged EXEC  
Example: The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(Managed Switches) #show license features  
IGMP  
MCAST  
PIMDM  
DVMRP  
PIMSM  
OSPFV3  
IPV6  
IP Address Conflict Commands  
ip address-conflict-detect run  
This command triggers the switch to run active address conflict detection by sending  
gratuitous ARP packets for IPv4 addresses on the switch.  
Note: This command takes effect only once after it is executed and cannot  
be saved across power cycles.  
Format  
Mode  
ip address-conflict-detect run  
Global Config  
show ip address-conflict  
This command displays the status information corresponding to the last detected address  
conflict.  
Term  
Definition  
Address  
Conflict  
Detection  
Status  
Identifies whether the switch has detected an address conflict on any IP address.  
Last Conflicting  
IP Address  
The IP Address that was last detected as conflicting on any interface.  
Utility Commands  
610  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Last Conflicting  
MAC Address  
The MAC Address of the conflicting host that was last detected on any interface.  
Time Since  
Conflict  
Detected  
The time in days, hours, minutes and seconds since the last address conflict was  
detected.  
clear ip address-conflict-detect  
This command clears the detected address conflict status information.  
Format  
Mode  
clear ip address-conflict-detect  
Privileged EXEC  
Link Local Protocol Filtering Commands  
Link Local Protocol Filtering (LLPF) allows the switch to filter out multiple proprietary protocol  
PDUs, such as Port Aggregation Protocol (PAgP), if the problems occur with proprietary  
protocols running on standards-based switches. If certain protocol PDUs cause unexpected  
results, LLPF can be enabled to prevent those protocol PDUs from being processed by the  
switch. These commands are not supported on M4100 switches.  
llpf blockall  
Use this command to block LLPF protocol(s) on a port. Use blockallto filter all PDUs with a  
DMAC of 01:00:00:0C:CC:CX on the interface. Use blockisdpto filter the ISDP packets on  
the interface. Use blockvtpto filter the VTP packets on the interface. Use blockdtpto filter  
the DTP packets on the interface. Use blockudldto filter the UDLD packets on the interface.  
Use blockpagpto filter the PAGP packets on the interface. Use blocksstpto filter the SSTP  
packets on the interface.  
Format  
llpf {blockisdp | blockvtp | blockdtp | blockudld | blockpagp  
| blocksstp | blockall }  
Mode  
Interface Config  
Disable  
Default  
no llpf  
Use this command to unblock LLPF protocol(s) on a port.  
Utility Commands  
611  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show llpf interface all  
Use this command to display the status of LLPF rules configured on a particular port or on all  
ports.  
Format  
show llpf interface [all | slot/port]  
Mode  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Block ISDP  
Shows whether the port blocks ISDP PDUs.  
Shows whether the port blocks VTP PDUs.  
Shows whether the port blocks DTP PDUs.  
Shows whether the port blocks UDLD PDUs.  
Shows whether the port blocks PAGP PDUs.  
Shows whether the port blocks SSTP PDUs.  
Shows whether the port blocks all proprietary PDUs available for the LLDP feature.  
Block VTP  
Block DTP  
Block UDLD  
Block PAGP  
Block SSTP  
Block All  
RMON Stats and History Commands  
The various MIBs within RFC 2819, 3273, and 3434 are arranged into groups. The managed  
switch supports some of the groups in these RFCs but not all. The managed switch complies  
with MODULE-COMPLIANCE and OBJECT-GROUP definitions within these RFCs for  
supporting individual groups.  
The managed switch supports the following groups:  
RFC 2819  
Group 1 - Statistics  
Contains cumulative traffic and error statistics.  
Group 2 - History  
Generates reports from periodic traffic sampling that are useful for analyzing trends. This  
group includes History Control Group and Ethernet History Group.  
Group 3 - Alarm  
Enables the definition and setting of thresholds for various counters. Thresholds can be  
passed in either a rising or falling direction on existing MIB objects, primarily those in the  
Statistics group. An alarm is triggered when a threshold is crossed and the alarm is  
passed to the Event group. The Alarm requires the Event Group.  
Utility Commands  
612  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Group 9 - Event  
Controls the actions that are taken when an event occurs. RMON events occur when:  
A threshold (alarm) is exceeded  
There is a match on certain filters.  
RFC 3273  
Group 1 - Media Independent Group  
Contains media-independent statistics that provide information for full and/or half-duplex  
links as well as high capacity links.  
Group 2 - Ether Stats High Capacity Group  
Contains the High Capacity RMON extensions to RMON-1 etherStatsTable (RFC 2819  
Group 1).  
Group 3 - Ether History High Capacity Group  
Contains the High Capacity RMON extensions to RMON-1 etherHistoryTable (RFC 2819  
Group 2).  
RFC 3434  
Group 1 - High Capacity Alarm Control Group  
Controls the configuration of alarms for high capacity MIB object instances.  
Group 2 - High Capacity Alarm Capabilities Group  
Describes the high capacity alarm capabilities provided by the agent.  
Group 3 - High Capacity Alarm Notifications Group  
Provides new rising and falling threshold notifications for high capacity objects.  
rmon alarm  
This command sets the RMON alarm entry in the RMON alarm MIB group.  
Format  
Mode  
rmon alarm alarm number variable sample interval sampling type  
rising-threshold value falling-threshold value startup  
rising/falling/rising-falling owner string  
Global Config  
Parameter  
Description  
Alarm Number  
Alarm Variable  
The Alarm number which identifies an Alarm.  
The object identifier of the particular variable to be sampled. Only variables that resolve to an  
ASN.1 primitive type of integer.  
Utility Commands  
613  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Parameter  
Description  
Sample Interval  
The interval in seconds over which the data is sampled and compared with the rising and  
falling thresholds. The range is 0 to 2147483647. The default is 0.  
Alarm Sample Type The alarm sample type. The method of sampling the selected variable and calculating the  
value to be compared against thresholds. Possible types are Absolute or Delta.  
Alarm Rising  
The alarm rising threshold for the sample statistics.  
Threshold Value  
Alarm Falling  
The alarm falling threshold for the sample statistics.  
Threshold Value  
Alarm Startup  
Alarm  
The alarm that may be sent. Possible values are Rising Alarm, Falling Alarm or both.  
Alarm Owner string The alarm owner. The owner string associated with the alarm entry.  
no rmon alarm  
This command deletes the rmon alarm entry.  
Format  
Mode  
no rmon alarm <alarm number>  
Global Config  
rmon hcalarm  
This command sets the rmon hcalarm entry in the High Capacity RMON alarm mib group.  
Format  
rmon hcalarm <alarm number> <variable> <sample interval>  
<sampling type> rising-threshold high <value> low  
<value> falling-threshold high <value> low <value>  
startup <rising/falling/rising-falling> owner <string>  
Mode  
Global Config  
Parameter  
Description  
hcalarm alarm  
number  
The identifier of the hcalarm instance.  
High Capacity  
Alarm Variable  
The object identifier of the particular variable to be sampled. Only variables that resolve to an  
ASN.1 primitive type of integer.  
High Capacity  
Alarm interval  
The interval in seconds over which the data is sampled and compared with the rising and  
falling thresholds. The range is 1to 2147483647.  
High Capacity  
The method of sampling the selected variable and calculating the value to be compared  
Alarm Sample Type against thresholds. Possible types are Absolute or Delta.  
Rising-Threshold  
High Value  
High capacity alarm rising threshold absolute value high. The upper 32 bits of the absolute  
value for threshold for the sampled statistics.  
Utility Commands  
614  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Parameter  
Description  
Rising-Threshold  
Low Value  
High capacity alarm rising threshold absolute value low. The lower 32 bits of the absolute  
value for threshold for the sampled statistics.  
Falling-Threshold  
High Value  
High capacity alarm falling threshold absolute value high. The upper 32 bits of the absolute  
value for threshold for the sampled statistic.  
Falling-Threshold  
Low Value  
High capacity alarm falling threshold absolute value high. The upper 32 bits of the absolute  
value for threshold for the sampled statistic.  
Rising/Falling/  
Rising-Falling  
High capacity alarm startup alarm that may be sent. Possible values are Rising Alarm, Falling  
Alarm or both.  
Owner String  
High capacity alarm owner. The owner string associated with the entry.  
no rmon hcalarm  
This command deletes the rmon hcalarm entry.  
Format  
no rmon hcalarm <alarm number>  
Mode  
Global Config  
rmon event  
This command sets the rmon event entry in the RMON event mib group.  
Format  
rmon event <event number> [description|log|owner|trap]  
Mode  
Global Config  
Parameter  
Description  
Event Number  
Event Type  
Event identifier  
The type of notification that the probe will make about the event. Possible values are:  
None  
Log  
SNMP Trap  
Log and SNMP Trap  
no rmon event  
This command deletes the rmon event entry.  
Format  
Mode  
no rmon event <event number>  
Global Config  
Utility Commands  
615  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
rmon collection history  
This command sets the history control parameters of the RMON historyControl mib group.  
Format  
Mode  
rmon collection history <index number> buckets <1-65535> | interval <1-3600> |  
owner <owner>  
Interface Config  
no rmon collection history  
This command deletes the history control group entry with the specified index number.  
Format  
Mode  
no rmon collection history <index number>  
Interface Config  
show rmon  
This command displays the entries in the RMON alarm table.  
Format  
Mode  
show rmon {alarms | alarm <alarm-index>}  
Privileged Exec  
show rmon collection history  
This command displays the entries in the RMON history control table.  
Format  
Mode  
show rmon collection history  
Privileged Exec  
show rmon events  
This command displays the entries in the RMON event table.  
Format  
Mode  
show rmon events  
Privileged Exec  
Example:  
(Switch) # show rmon events  
Index Description  
-------------------------------------------------------------------------------  
test log public MIB 0 days 0 h:0 m:0 s  
Type  
Community Owner  
Last time sent  
1
Utility Commands  
616  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show rmon history  
This command displays the specified entry in the RMON history table.  
Format  
Mode  
show rmon history <index> {errors|other|throughput}  
Privileged Exec  
Example:  
(Swtich) # show rmon history 1 throughput  
Sample set: 1  
Maximum table size: 270  
Time  
Octets  
Packets Broadcast Multicast Util  
-------------------- ---------- --------- --------- ---------- --------  
show rmon log  
This command displays the entries in the RMON log table.  
Format  
Mode  
show rmon log  
Privileged Exec  
Example:  
(Switch) # show rmon log  
Maximum table size: 100  
Event Description  
Time  
------------------------------------------------  
show rmon statistics interface  
This command displays the RMON statistics for the given interface.  
Format  
Mode  
show rmon statistics interface <slot/port>  
Privileged Exec  
Example:  
(switch) # show rmon statistics interface 0/1  
Interface: 0/1  
Dropped: 0  
Octets: 0 Packets: 0  
Broadcast: 0 Multicast: 0  
CRC Align Errors: 0 Collisions: 0  
Undersize Pkts: 0 Oversize Pkts: 0  
Fragments: 0 Jabbers: 0  
64 Octets: 0 65 - 127 Octets: 0  
128 - 255 Octets: 0 256 - 511 Octets: 0  
512 - 1023 Octets: 0 1024 - 1518 Octets: 0  
Utility Commands  
617  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show rmon {hcalarms | hcalarm <alarm index>}  
This command displays the entries in the RMON hcAlarmTable.  
Format  
Mode  
show rmon {hcalarms | hcalarm <alarm index>}  
Privileged Exec  
UDLD Commands  
The UDLD feature detects unidirectional links physical ports. A unidirectional link is a  
forwarding anomaly in a Layer 2 communication channel in which a bi-directional link stops  
passing traffic in one direction. UDLD must be enabled on both sides of the link in order to  
detect a unidirectional link. The UDLD protocol operates by exchanging packets containing  
information about neighboring devices.  
udld enable  
This command enables UDLD globally on the switch.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
udld enable  
Global Config  
no udld enable  
This command disables udld globally on the switch.  
Format  
Mode  
no udld enable  
Global Config  
udld message time  
This command configures the interval between UDLD probe messages on ports that are in  
the advertisement phase. The range is from 7 to 90 seconds.  
Default  
15  
Format  
Mode  
udld message time <interval>  
Global Config  
Utility Commands  
618  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
udld timeout interval  
This command configures the time interval after which UDLD link is considered to be  
unidirectional. The range is from 5 to 60 seconds.  
Default  
5
Format  
Mode  
udld timeout interval <interval>  
Global Config  
udld enable  
This command enables UDLD on the specified interface.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
udld enable  
Interface Config  
no udld enable  
This command disables udld on the specified interface.  
Format  
Mode  
no udld enable  
Interface Config  
udld port  
This command selects the UDLD mode operating on this interface. If the keyword  
“aggressive” is not entered, the port operates in normal mode.  
Default  
normal  
Format  
Mode  
udld port [aggressive]  
Interface Config  
udld reset  
This command resets all interfaces that have been shutdown by UDLD.  
Format  
Mode  
udld reset  
Privileged EXEC  
Utility Commands  
619  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show udld  
This command displays the global settings of UDLD.  
Format  
Mode  
show udld  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Admin Mode  
The global administrative mode of UDLD.  
Message  
Interval  
The time period (in seconds) between the transmission of UDLD probe packets.  
Timeout Interval  
The time period (in seconds) before making decision that link is unidirectional.  
show udld <slot/port>  
This command displays the UDLD settings for the specified <slot/port>. If the “all” keyword is  
entered, it displays information for all ports.  
Format  
Mode  
show udld {< slot/port> | all }  
Privileged EXEC  
User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Slot/Port  
The identifying <slot/port> of the interface.  
Admin Mode  
The administrative mode of UDLD configured on this interface. This is either “Enabled” or  
“Disabled”.  
UDLD Mode  
UDLD Status  
The UDLD mode configured on this interface. This is either “Normal” or “Aggressive.”.  
The status of the link as determined by UDLD. The options are:  
“Undetermined” - UDLD has not collected enough information to determine the state  
of the port  
“Not applicable” - UDLD is disabled, either globally or on the port  
“Shutdown” - UDLD has detected a unidirectional link and shutdown the port, That  
is, the port is in an errDisabled state.  
“Bidirectional” - UDLD has detected a bidirectional link.  
“Undetermined(Link Down)” - The port would transition into this state when the port  
link physically goes down due to any reasons other than the port been put into  
D-Disable mode by UDLD protocol on the switch.  
USB commands  
If there is an USB flash device in the USB slot, the commands display the device status and  
content.  
Utility Commands  
620  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show usb device  
This command displays USB flash device details.  
Format  
show USB device  
Mode  
Privileged EXEC  
Parameter  
Description  
Device Status  
This field specifies the current status of device. Following are possible device status  
states:  
Active. Device is plugged in and the device is recognized if device is not mounted.  
• Inactive. Device is not mounted.  
Invalid. Device is not present or invalid device is plugged in.  
Manufacturer  
Serial Number  
Manufacturer details.  
Serial number of the device.  
Version of the USB device.  
USB Version  
Compliance  
Class Code  
Device Class  
Subclass Code  
Protocol  
Device SubClass  
Device Protocol  
Vendor ID  
Vendor specifies details of device-Vendor ID  
Vendor specifies details of device-Product ID  
Product ID  
Example: The following is the output if the device is plugged into the USB slot.  
(switch) #show USB device  
Device Status………………………………………………… Active  
Manufacturer…………………………………………………… xxxx  
Serial Number………………………………………………… yyyyy  
USB Version Compliance………………………… 2.0  
Class Code………………………………………………………… abc  
Subclass Code………………………………………………… acb  
Protocol……………………………………………………………… 0x0  
Vendor ID…………………………………………………………… zzzzz  
Product ID………………………………………………………… aaaaa  
dir usb  
This command displays USB device contents and memory statistics.  
Format  
Mode  
dir usb  
Privileged EXEC  
Utility Commands  
621  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Parameter  
Filename  
Description  
File name  
File size  
Filesize  
Total Size  
Bytes Used  
Bytes Free  
USB flash device storage size  
Indicates size of memory used on the device.  
Indicates size of memory free on the device  
Example:  
(switch) #dir USB:  
Filename Filesize Modification Time  
F1.cfg  
256  
4/22/2009 8:00:12  
Total Size: xxxx  
Bytes Used: yyyy  
Bytes Free: zzzz  
Utility Commands  
622  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11.  
Management Commands  
11  
This chapter describes the management commands available in the managed switch CLI.  
This chapter contains the following sections:  
The commands in this chapter are in three functional groups:  
Show commands display switch settings, statistics, and other information.  
Configuration commands configure features and options of the switch. Every switch  
command has a show command that displays the configuration setting.  
Clear commands clear some or all of the settings to factory defaults.  
623  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Configuring the Switch Management CPU  
To manage the switch via the web GUI or telnet, an IP address needs to be assigned to the  
switch management CPU. Whereas there are CLI commands that can be used to do this,  
ezconfig simplifies the task. The tool is applicable to all NETGEAR 7000-series managed  
switches, and allows you to configure the following parameters:  
1. The administrator’s user password and administrator-enable password  
2. Management CPU IP address and network mask  
3. System name and location information  
The tool is interactive and uses questions to guide you through the steps required to perform  
its task. At the end of the session, it will ask you if you want to save the changed information.  
To see exactly what has been changed by ezconfig at the end of the session, use the show  
running-config command.  
To perform any switch configuration other than the items listed above, use other CLI  
commands or the web GUI.  
ezconfig  
This command sets the IP address, subnet mask, and gateway of the device. The IP address  
and the gateway must be on the same subnet.  
Format  
Mode  
ezconfig  
Privileged EXEC  
Management Commands  
624  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
The following is an example of an ezconfig session.  
NETGEAR EZ Configuration Utility  
--------------------------------  
Hello and Welcome!  
This utility will walk you thru assigning the IP address for the switch  
management CPU. It will allow you to save the changes at the end. After  
the session, simply use the newly assigned IP address to access the Web  
GUI using any public domain Web browser.  
Admin password not defined. Do you want to change the password?  
(Y/N/Q) y  
Enter new password:********  
Confirm new password:********  
Password Changed!  
The 'enable' password required for switch configuration via the command  
line interface is currently not configured. Do you wish to change it  
(Y/N/Q)? y  
Enter new password:********  
Confirm new password:********  
Password Changed!  
Assigning an IP address to your switch management  
Current IP Address Configuration  
--------------------------------  
IP address: 0.0.0.0  
Subnet mask: 0.0.0.0  
Gateway address: 0.0.0.0  
Would you like to assign an IP address now (Y/N/Q)? y  
IP Address: 10.10.10.1  
Subnet mask: 255.255.255.0  
Gateway address: 10.10.10.10  
Do you want to assign switch name and location information (Y/N/Q)? y  
System Name: testunit1  
System Location: testlab  
System Contact: Bud Lightyear  
There are changes detected, do you wish to save the changes permanently  
(Y/N)? y  
The configuration changes have been saved successfully. Please enter  
'show running-config' to see the final configuration.  
Thanks for using EzConfig!  
Management Commands  
625  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Network Interface Commands  
This section describes the commands you use to configure a logical interface for  
management access. To configure the management VLAN, see step on page 47.  
enable (Privileged EXEC access)  
Use this command to access the Privileged EXEC mode. From the Privileged EXEC mode,  
you can configure the network interface.  
Format  
Mode  
enable  
User EXEC  
network parms  
Use this command to set the IP address, subnet mask, and gateway of the device. The IP  
address and the gateway must be on the same subnet.  
Format  
Mode  
network parms <ipaddr> <netmask> [<gateway>]  
Privileged EXEC  
network protocol  
Use this command to specify the network configuration protocol to be used. If you modify this  
value, change is effective immediately. If you use the bootp parameter, the switch  
periodically sends requests to a BootP server until a response is received. If you use the  
dhcpparameter, the switch periodically sends requests to a DHCP server until a response is  
received. If you use the noneparameter, you must configure the network information for the  
switch manually.  
Default  
none  
Format  
Mode  
network protocol {none | bootp | dhcp}  
Privileged EXEC  
network mac-address  
Use this command to set locally administered MAC addresses. The following rules apply:  
Bit 6 of byte 0 (called the U/L bit) indicates whether the address is universally  
administered (b'0') or locally administered (b'1').  
Bit 7 of byte 0 (called the I/G bit) indicates whether the destination address is an individual  
address (b'0') or a group address (b'1').  
The second character, of the twelve character macaddr, must be 2, 6, A or E.  
Management Commands  
626  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
A locally administered address must have bit 6 On (b'1') and bit 7 Off (b'0').  
Format  
Mode  
network mac-address <macaddr>  
Privileged EXEC  
network mac-type  
Use this command to specify whether the switch uses the burned in MAC address or the  
locally administered MAC address.  
Default  
burnedin  
Format  
Mode  
network mac-type {local | burnedin}  
Privileged EXEC  
no network mac-type  
Use this command to reset the value of MAC address to its default.  
Format  
Mode  
no network mac-type  
Privileged EXEC  
network javamode  
Use this command to specify whether the switch should allow access to the Java applet in  
the header frame of the Web interface. When access is enabled, the Java applet can be  
viewed from the Web interface. When access is disabled, the user cannot view the Java  
applet.  
Default  
enabled  
Format  
Mode  
network javamode  
Privileged EXEC  
no network javamode  
Use this command to disallow access to the Java applet in the header frame of the Web  
interface. When access is disabled, the user cannot view the Java applet.  
Format  
Mode  
no network javamode  
Privileged EXEC  
show network  
Use this command to display configuration settings associated with the switch’s network  
interface. The network interface is the logical interface used for in-band connectivity with the  
switch via any of the switch's front panel ports. The configuration parameters associated with  
Management Commands  
627  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
the switch's network interface do not affect the configuration of the front panel ports through  
which traffic is switched or routed. The network interface is always considered to be up,  
whether any member ports are up; therefore, the show network command will always show  
“Interface Status” as “Up”.  
Format  
show network  
Modes  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Interface Status  
IP Address  
The network interface status; it is always considered to be “up”.  
The IP address of the interface. The factory default value is 0.0.0.0.  
The IP subnet mask for this interface. The factory default value is 0.0.0.0.  
The default gateway for this IP interface. The factory default value is 0.0.0.0.  
Subnet Mask  
Default  
Gateway  
IPv6  
Administrative  
Mode  
Whether enabled or disabled.  
IPv6  
Address/Length  
The IPv6 address and length.  
IPv6 Default  
Router  
The IPv6 default router address.  
Burned In MAC  
Address  
The burned in MAC address used for in-band connectivity.  
Locally  
Administered  
MAC Address  
If desired, a locally administered MAC address can be configured for in-band  
connectivity. To take effect, 'MAC Address Type' must be set to 'Locally Administered'.  
Enter the address as twelve hexadecimal digits (6 bytes) with a colon between each  
byte. Bit 1 of byte 0 must be set to a 1 and bit 0 to a 0, i.e. byte 0 should have the  
following mask 'xxxx xx10'. The MAC address used by this bridge when it must be  
referred to in a unique fashion. It is recommended that this be the numerically smallest  
MAC address of all ports that belong to this bridge. However it is only required to be  
unique. When concatenated with dot1dStpPriority a unique BridgeIdentifier is formed  
which is used in the Spanning Tree Protocol.  
MAC Address  
Type  
The MAC address which should be used for in-band connectivity. The choices are the  
burned in or the Locally Administered address. The factory default is to use the burned in  
MAC address.  
The following shows example CLI display output for the network port.  
(Netgear Switch) #show network  
Interface Status............................... Always Up  
IP Address..................................... 10.250.3.1  
Subnet Mask.................................... 255.255.255.0  
Default Gateway................................ 10.250.3.3  
IPv6 Administrative Mode....................... Enabled  
IPv6 Address/Length is ........................ FE80::210:18FF:FE82:337/64  
IPv6 Address/Length is ........................ 3099::1/64  
Management Commands  
628  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
IPv6 Address/Length is ........................ 3099::210:18FF:FE82:337/64  
IPv6 Default Router is ........................ FE80::204:76FF:FE73:423A  
Burned In MAC Address.......................... 00:10:18:82:03:37  
Locally Administered MAC Address............... 00:00:00:00:00:00  
MAC Address Type............................... Burned In  
Network Configuration Protocol Current......... None  
Management VLAN ID............................. 1  
Web Mode....................................... Enable  
Java Mode...................................... Enable  
Console Port Access Commands  
This section describes the commands you use to configure the console port. You can use a  
serial cable to connect a management host directly to the console port of the switch.  
configuration  
Use this command to access Global Config mode. From Global Config mode, you can  
configure various system settings, including user accounts. You can also enter other  
command modes, including Line Config mode.  
Format  
Mode  
configuration  
Privileged EXEC  
line  
Use this command to access Line Config mode, which allows you to configure various Telnet  
settings, ssh settings, and the console port.  
Format  
Mode  
line {console | telnet | ssh}  
Global Config  
serial baudrate  
Use this command to specify the communication rate of the terminal interface. The supported  
rates are 1200, 2400, 4800, 9600, 19200, 38400, 57600, 115200.  
Default  
115200  
Format  
Mode  
serial baudrate {1200 | 2400 | 4800 | 9600 | 19200 | 38400 | 57600 |  
115200}  
Line Config  
Management Commands  
629  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no serial baudrate  
Use this command to set the communication rate of the terminal interface.  
Format  
Mode  
no serial baudrate  
Line Config  
serial timeout  
Use this command to specify the maximum connect time (in minutes) without console activity.  
A value of 0 indicates that a console can be connected indefinitely. The time range is 0–160.  
Default  
5
Format  
Mode  
serial timeout <0-160>  
Line Config  
no serial timeout  
Use this command to set the maximum connect time (in minutes) without console activity.  
Format  
Mode  
no serial timeout  
Line Config  
login authentication  
Use this command in line configuration mode to specify a login authentication method list for  
remote telnet or console.  
Format  
Mode  
login authentication {default | list-name}  
Line Config  
no login authentication  
Use this command to return to the default specified by the login authentication  
command.  
Format  
Mode  
no login authentication {default | list-name}  
Line Config  
Management Commands  
630  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
enable authentication  
Use this command in line configuration mode to specify an authentication method list when  
the user accesses a higher privilege level in remote telnet or console.  
Format  
Mode  
enable authentication {default | list-name}  
Line Config  
no enable authentication  
Use this command to return to the default specified by the enable authentication  
command.  
Format  
Mode  
no enable authentication {default | list-name}  
Line Config  
show serial  
Use this command to display serial communication settings for the switch.  
Format  
show serial  
Modes  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Serial Port  
Login Timeout  
(minutes)  
The time, in minutes, of inactivity on a Serial port connection, after which the Switch will  
close the connection. Any numeric value from 0 through 160 is allowed, the factory  
default is 5. A value of 0 disables the timeout.  
Baud Rate (bps)  
The default baud rate at which the serial port will try to connect. The available values are  
1200, 2400, 4800, 9600, 19200, 38400,57600, and 115,200 baud. The factory default is  
9600 baud.  
Character Size  
(bits)  
The number of bits in a character. The number of bits is always 8.  
Flow Control  
Whether Hardware Flow-Control is enabled or disabled. Hardware Flow Control is  
always disabled.  
Stop Bits  
The number of Stop bits per character. The number of Stop bits is always 1.  
The parity method used on the serial port. The parity method is always None.  
Parity Type  
Telnet Commands  
This section describes the commands you use to configure and view Telnet settings. You can  
use Telnet to manage the device from a remote management host.  
Management Commands  
631  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
ip telnet server enable  
Use this command to enable Telnet connections to the system and to enable the Telnet  
Server Admin Mode. This command opens the Telnet listening port.  
Default  
enabled  
Format  
Mode  
ip telnet server enable  
Privileged EXEC  
no ip telnet server enable  
Use this command to disable Telnet access to the system and to disable the Telnet Server  
Admin Mode. This command closes the Telnet listening port and disconnects all open Telnet  
sessions.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip telnet server enable  
Privileged EXEC  
telnet  
Use this command to establish a new outbound Telnet connection to a remote host. The host  
value must be a valid IP address or host name. Valid values for port should be a valid  
decimal integer in the range of 0–65,535, where the default value is 23. If [debug] is used,  
the current Telnet options enabled is displayed. The optional line parameter sets the  
outbound Telnet operational mode as ‘linemode’ where, by default, the operational mode is  
‘character mode’. The noecho option disables local echo.  
Format  
Modes  
telnet <ip-address|hostname> <port> [debug] [line] [noecho]  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
transport input telnet  
Use this command to regulate new Telnet sessions. If enabled, new Telnet sessions can be  
established until there are no more sessions available. An established session remains  
active until the session is ended or an abnormal network error ends the session.  
Note: If the Telnet Server Admin Mode is disabled, Telnet sessions cannot  
be established. Use the ip telnet server enablecommand to  
enable Telnet Server Admin Mode.  
Management Commands  
632  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Default  
enabled  
Format  
Mode  
transport input telnet  
Line Config  
no transport input telnet  
Use this command to prevent new Telnet sessions from being established.  
Format  
Mode  
no transport input telnet  
Line Config  
transport output telnet  
Use this command to regulate new outbound Telnet connections. If enabled, new outbound  
Telnet sessions can be established until the system reaches the maximum number of  
simultaneous outbound Telnet sessions allowed. An established session remains active until  
the session is ended or an abnormal network error ends it.  
Default  
enabled  
Format  
Mode  
transport output telnet  
Line Config  
no transport output telnet  
Use this command to prevent new outbound Telnet connection from being established.  
Format  
Mode  
no transport output telnet  
Line Config  
session-limit  
Use this command to specify the maximum number of simultaneous outbound Telnet  
sessions. A value of 0 indicates that no outbound Telnet session can be established.  
Default  
5
Format  
Mode  
session-limit <0-5>  
Line Config  
Management Commands  
633  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no session-limit  
Use this command to set the maximum number of simultaneous outbound Telnet sessions to  
the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no session-limit  
Line Config  
session-timeout  
Use this command to set the Telnet session timeout value. The timeout value unit of time is  
minutes.  
Default  
5
Format  
Mode  
session-timeout <1-160>  
Line Config  
no session-timeout  
Use this command to set the Telnet session timeout value to the default. The timeout value  
unit of time is minutes.  
Format  
Mode  
no session-timeout  
Line Config  
telnetcon maxsessions  
Use this command to specify the maximum number of Telnet connection sessions that can  
be established. A value of 0 indicates that no Telnet connection can be established. The  
range is 0-5.  
Default  
4
Format  
Mode  
telnetcon maxsessions <0-4>  
Privileged EXEC  
no telnetcon maxsessions  
Use this command to set the maximum number of Telnet connection sessions that can be  
established to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no telnetcon maxsessions  
Privileged EXEC  
Management Commands  
634  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
telnetcon timeout  
Use this command to set the Telnet connection session timeout value, in minutes. A session  
is active as long as the session has not been idle for the value set. The time is a decimal  
value from 1 to 160.  
Note: When you change the timeout value, the new value is applied to all  
active and inactive sessions immediately. Any sessions that have  
been idle longer than the new timeout value are disconnected  
immediately.  
Default  
5
Format  
Mode  
telnetcon timeout <1-160>  
Privileged EXEC  
no telnetcon timeout  
Use this command to set the Telnet connection session timeout value to the default.  
Note: Changing the timeout value for active sessions does not become  
effective until the session is reaccessed. Also, any keystroke  
activates the new timeout duration.  
Format  
Mode  
no telnetcon timeout  
Privileged EXEC  
show telnet  
Use this command to display the current outbound Telnet settings. In other words, these  
settings apply to Telnet connections initiated from the switch to a remote system.  
Format  
Modes  
show telnet  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Management Commands  
635  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Outbound  
Telnet Login  
Timeout  
The number of minutes an outbound Telnet session is allowed to remain inactive before  
being logged off.  
Maximum  
Number of  
The number of simultaneous outbound Telnet connections allowed.  
Outbound  
Telnet Sessions  
Allow New  
Outbound  
Indicates whether outbound Telnet sessions will be allowed.  
Telnet Sessions  
show telnetcon  
Use this command to display the current inbound Telnet settings. In other words, these  
settings apply to Telnet connections initiated from a remote system to the switch.  
Format  
Modes  
show telnetcon  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Remote  
This object indicates the number of minutes a remote connection session is allowed to  
remain inactive before being logged off. Might be specified as a number from 1 to 160.  
The factory default is 5.  
Connection  
Login Timeout  
(minutes)  
Maximum  
Number of  
Remote  
This object indicates the number of simultaneous remote connection sessions allowed.  
The factory default is 5.  
Connection  
Sessions  
Allow New  
Telnet Sessions  
New Telnet sessions will not be allowed when this field is set to no. The factory default  
value is yes.  
Secure Shell (SSH) Commands  
This section describes the commands you use to configure SSH access to the switch. Use  
SSH to access the switch from a remote management host.  
Note: The system allows a maximum of five SSH sessions.  
Management Commands  
636  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
ip ssh  
Use this command to enable SSH access to the system. (This command is the short form of  
the ip ssh server enablecommand.)  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
ip ssh  
Privileged EXEC  
ip ssh protocol  
Use this command to set or remove protocol levels (or versions) for SSH. Either SSH1 (1),  
SSH2 (2), or both SSH 1 and SSH 2 (1 and 2) can be set.  
Default  
1 and 2  
Format  
Mode  
ip ssh protocol [1] [2]  
Privileged EXEC  
ip ssh server enable  
Use this command to enable the IP secure shell server.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
ip ssh server enable  
Privileged EXEC  
no ip ssh server enable  
Use this command to disable the IP secure shell server.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip ssh server enable  
Privileged EXEC  
sshcon maxsessions  
Use this command to specify the maximum number of SSH connection sessions that can be  
established. A value of 0 indicates that no ssh connection can be established. The range is  
0–5.  
Default  
5
Format  
Mode  
sshcon maxsessions <0-5>  
Privileged EXEC  
Management Commands  
637  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no sshcon maxsessions  
Use this command to set the maximum number of allowed SSH connection sessions to the  
default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no sshcon maxsessions  
Privileged EXEC  
sshcon timeout  
Use this command to set the SSH connection session timeout value, in minutes. A session is  
active as long as the session has been idle for the value set. The time is a decimal value from  
1 to 160.  
Changing the timeout value for active sessions does not become effective until the session is  
re accessed. Also, any keystroke activates the new timeout duration.  
Default  
5
Format  
Mode  
sshcon timeout <1-160>  
Privileged EXEC  
no sshcon timeout  
Use this command to set the SSH connection session timeout value, in minutes, to the  
default.  
Changing the timeout value for active sessions does not become effective until the session is  
re accessed. Also, any keystroke activates the new timeout duration.  
Format  
Mode  
no sshcon timeout  
Privileged EXEC  
show ip ssh  
Use this command to display the ssh settings.  
Format  
show ip ssh  
Mode  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Administrative  
Mode  
This field indicates whether the administrative mode of SSH is enabled or disabled.  
Protocol Level  
The protocol level might have the values of version 1, version 2 or both versions 1 and  
version 2.  
SSH Sessions  
Currently Active  
The number of SSH sessions currently active.  
Management Commands  
638  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Max SSH  
Sessions  
Allowed  
The maximum number of SSH sessions allowed.  
SSH Timeout  
Keys Present  
The SSH timeout value in minutes.  
Indicates whether the SSH RSA and DSA key files are present on the device.  
Indicates whether RSA or DSA key files generation is currently in progress.  
Key Generation  
in Progress  
Management Security Commands  
This section describes commands you use to generate keys and certificates, which you can  
do in addition to loading them as before.  
crypto certificate generate  
Use this command to generate self-signed certificate for HTTPS. The generate RSA key for  
SSL has a length of 1024 bits. The resulting certificate is generated with a common name  
equal to the lowest IP address of the device and a duration of 365 days.  
Format  
Mode  
crypto certificate generate  
Global Config  
no crypto certificate generate  
Use this command to delete the HTTPS certificate files from the device, regardless of  
whether they are self-signed or downloaded from an outside source.  
Format  
Mode  
no crypto certificate generate  
Global Config  
crypto key generate rsa  
Use this command to generate an RSA key pair for SSH. The new key files will overwrite any  
existing generated or downloaded RSA key files.  
Format  
Mode  
crypto key generate rsa  
Global Config  
Management Commands  
639  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no crypto key generate rsa  
Use this command to delete the RSA key files from the device.  
Format  
Mode  
no crypto key generate rsa  
Global Config  
crypto key generate dsa  
Use this command to generate a DSA key pair for SSH. The new key files will overwrite any  
existing generated or downloaded DSA key files.  
Format  
Mode  
crypto key generate dsa  
Global Config  
no crypto key generate dsa  
Use this command to delete the DSA key files from the device.  
Format  
Mode  
no crypto key generate dsa  
Global Config  
Hypertext Transfer Protocol (HTTP) Commands  
This section describes the commands you use to configure HTTP and secure HTTP access  
to the switch. Access to the switch by using a Web browser is enabled by default. Everything  
you can view and configure by using the CLI is also available by using the Web.  
ip http server  
Use this command to enable access to the switch through the Web interface. When access is  
enabled, the user can login to the switch from the Web interface. When access is disabled,  
the user cannot login to the switch's Web server. Disabling the Web interface takes effect  
immediately. All interfaces are affected.  
Default  
enabled  
Format  
Mode  
ip http server  
Privileged EXEC  
Management Commands  
640  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no ip http server  
Use this command to disable access to the switch through the Web interface. When access  
is disabled, the user cannot login to the switch's Web server.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip http server  
Privileged EXEC  
ip http secure-server  
Use this command to enable the secure socket layer for secure HTTP.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
ip http secure-server  
Privileged EXEC  
no ip http secure-server  
Use this command to disable the secure socket layer for secure HTTP.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip http secure-server  
Privileged EXEC  
ip http java  
Use this command to enable the Web Java mode. The Java mode applies to both secure and  
unsecure web connections.  
Default  
Enabled  
Format  
Mode  
ip http java  
Privileged EXEC  
no ip http java  
Use this command to disable the Web Java mode. The Java mode applies to both secure  
and unsecure web connections.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip http java  
Privileged EXEC  
ip http session hard-timeout  
Use this command to configure the hard timeout for un-secure HTTP sessions in hours.  
Configuring this value to zero will give an infinite hard-timeout. When this timeout expires, the  
Management Commands  
641  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
user will be forced to reauthenticate. This timer begins on initiation of the web session and is  
unaffected by the activity level of the connection.  
Default  
24  
Format  
Mode  
ip http session hard-timeout <0-168>  
Privileged EXEC  
no ip http session hard-timeout  
Use this command to restore the hard timeout for unsecure HTTP sessions to the default  
value.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip http session hard-timeout  
Privileged EXEC  
ip http authentication  
Use this command to specify the authentication methods for http server users. The additional  
methods of authentication are used only if the previous method returns an error, not if it fails.  
To ensure that the authentication succeeds even if all methods return an error, specify none  
as the final method in the command line. For example If none specified as an authentication  
method after radius, no authentication is used if the radius server is down.  
Format  
Mode  
ip http authentication method1 [method2 ...]  
Global ConfigC  
Term  
Definition  
Local  
Uses the local username database for authentication.  
Uses the list of all RADIUS servers for authentication.  
Uses the list of all TACACS servers for authentication.  
Uses no authentication.  
Radius  
Tacacs  
None  
no ip http authentication  
Use this command to restore the authentication methods to the default.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip http authentication method1 [method2 ...]  
Global Config  
Management Commands  
642  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
ip http session maxsessions  
Use this command to limit the number of allowable unsecure HTTP sessions. Zero is the  
configurable minimum.  
Default  
16  
Format  
Mode  
ip http session maxsessions <0-16>  
Privileged EXEC  
no ip http session maxsessions  
Use this command to restore the number of allowable unsecure HTTP sessions to the default  
value.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip http session maxsessions  
Privileged EXEC  
ip http session soft-timeout  
Use this command to configure the soft timeout for unsecure HTTP sessions in minutes.  
Configuring this value to zero will give an infinite soft-timeout. When this timeout expires the  
user will be forced to reauthenticate. This timer begins on initiation of the Web session and is  
restarted with each access to the switch.  
Default  
Format  
Mode  
5
ip http session soft-timeout <0-60>  
Privileged EXEC  
no ip http session soft-timeout  
Use this command to reset the soft timeout for unsecure HTTP sessions to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip http session soft-timeout  
Privileged EXEC  
ip http secure-session maxsessions  
Use this command to limit the number of secure HTTP sessions. Zero is the configurable  
minimum.  
Default  
Format  
Mode  
16  
ip http secure-session maxsessions <0-16>  
Privileged EXEC  
Management Commands  
643  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no ip http secure-session maxsessions  
Use this command to restore the number of allowable secure HTTP sessions to the default  
value.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip http secure-session maxsessions  
Privileged EXEC  
ip http secure-session soft-timeout  
Use this command to configure the soft timeout for secure HTTP sessions in minutes.  
Configuring this value to zero will give an infinite soft-timeout. When this timeout expires, you  
are forced to reauthenticate. This timer begins on initiation of the Web session and is  
restarted with each access to the switch. The secure-session soft-timeout cannot be set to  
zero (infinite).  
Default  
5
Format  
Mode  
ip http secure-session soft-timeout <1-60>  
Privileged EXEC  
no ip http secure-session soft-timeout  
Use this command to restore the soft timeout for secure HTTP sessions to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip http secure-session soft-timeout  
Privileged EXEC  
ip http secure-session hard-timeout  
Use this command to configure the hard timeout for secure HTTP sessions in hours. When  
the timeout expires, the user is forced to reauthenticate. This timer begins on initiation of the  
Web session and is unaffected by the activity level of the connection. The secure-session  
hard-timeout cannot be set to zero (infinite).  
Default  
Format  
Mode  
24  
ip http secure-session hard-timeout <1-168>  
Privileged EXEC  
no ip http secure-session hard-timeout  
Use this command to reset the hard timeout for secure HTTP sessions to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip http secure-session hard-timeout  
Privileged EXEC  
Management Commands  
644  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
ip https authentication  
Use this command to specify the authentication methods for http server users. The additional  
methods of authentication are used only if the previous method returns an error, not if it fails.  
To ensure that the authentication succeeds even if all methods return an error, specify none  
as the final method in the command line. If noneis specified as an authentication method  
after radius, no authentication is used if the radius server is down.  
Format  
ip https authentication method1 [method2 ...]  
Mode  
Global ConfigC  
Term  
Definition  
Local  
Uses the local username database for authentication.  
Uses the list of all RADIUS servers for authentication.  
Uses the list of all TACACS servers for authentication.  
Uses no authentication.  
Radius  
Tacacs  
None  
no ip https authentication  
Use this command to restore the authentication methods to the default for http server users.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip https authentication method1 [method2 ...]  
Global Config  
ip http secure-port  
Use this command to set the SSL port where port can be 1-65535 and the default is port 443.  
Default  
443  
Format  
Mode  
ip http secure-port <portid>  
Privileged EXEC  
no ip http secure-port  
Use this command to reset the SSL port to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip http secure-port  
Privileged EXEC  
Management Commands  
645  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
ip http secure-protocol  
Use this command to set protocol levels (versions). The protocol level can be set to TLS1,  
SSL3 or to both TLS1 and SSL3.  
Default  
SSL3 and TLS1  
Format  
Mode  
ip http secure-protocol [SSL3] [TLS1]  
Privileged EXEC  
show ip http  
Use this command to display the http settings for the switch.  
Format  
Mode  
show ip http  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
HTTP Mode (Unsecure)  
Java Mode  
The unsecure HTTP server administrative mode.  
The java applet administrative mode which applies to both secure and  
unsecure web connections.  
Maximum Allowable HTTP  
Sessions  
The number of allowable unsecure http sessions.  
The hard timeout for unsecure http sessions in hours.  
The soft timeout for unsecure http sessions in minutes.  
HTTP Session Hard  
Timeout  
HTTP Session Soft  
Timeout  
HTTP Mode (Secure)  
Secure Port  
The secure HTTP server administrative mode.  
The secure HTTP server port number.  
Secure Protocol Level(s)  
The protocol level might have the values of SSL3, TSL1, or both SSL3 and  
TSL1.  
Maximum Allowable  
HTTPS Sessions  
The number of allowable secure http sessions.  
The hard timeout for secure http sessions in hours.  
The soft timeout for secure http sessions in minutes.  
HTTPS Session Hard  
Timeout  
HTTPS Session Soft  
Timeout  
Certificate Present  
Indicates whether the secure-server certificate files are present on the device.  
Indicates whether certificate generation is currently in progress.  
Certificate Generation in  
Progress  
Management Commands  
646  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Access Commands  
Use the commands in this section to close remote connections or to view information about  
connections to the system.  
disconnect  
Use the disconnectcommand to close HTTP, HTTPS, Telnet, or SSH sessions. Use all  
to close all active sessions, or use <session-id>to specify the session ID to close. To  
view the possible values for <session-id>, use the show loginsessioncommand.  
Format  
Mode  
disconnect {<session_id> | all}  
Privileged EXEC  
show loginsession  
Use this command to display current Telnet and serial port connections to the switch.  
Format  
Mode  
show loginsession  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
ID  
Definition  
Login Session ID.  
User Name  
The name the user entered to log on to the system.  
IP address of the remote client machine or EIA-232 for the serial port connection.  
Connection  
From  
Idle Time  
Time this session has been idle.  
Session Time  
Session Type  
Total time this session has been connected.  
Shows the type of session, which can be HTTP, HTTPS, telnet, serial, or SSH.  
User Account Commands  
This section describes the commands you use to add, manage, and delete system users.  
The 7000 series software has two default users: admin and guest. The admin user can view  
and configure system settings, and the guest user can view settings.  
Note: You cannot delete the admin user. There is only one user allowed  
with read/write privileges. You can configure up to five read-only  
users on the system.  
Management Commands  
647  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
username  
Use this command to add a new user to the local user database. The default privilege level is  
1. Using the encrypted keyword allows the administrator to transfer local user passwords  
between devices without having to know the passwords. When the password parameter is  
used along with encrypted parameter, the password must be exactly 128 hexadecimal  
characters in length. If the password strength feature is enabled, this command checks for  
password strength and returns an appropriate error if it fails to meet the password strength  
criteria. Giving the optional parameter override-complexity-check disables the validation of  
the password strength.  
Format  
username name {password password [encrypted  
[override-complexity-check] | level level [encrypted  
[override-complexity-check]] | override-complexity-check]} |  
{level level [override-complexity-check] password}  
Mode  
Global Config  
Term  
Definition  
Name  
The name of the user, up to 32 characters.  
Password  
level  
The password for the users 8-64 characters. This value can be zero if the no passwords  
min-length command has been executed. The special characters allowed in the  
password include: ! # $ % & ' ( ) * + , - . / : ; < = > @ [ \ ] ^ _ ` { | } ~.  
Specifies the user level. If not specified, the privilege level is 1. Level 0 can be assigned  
by a level 15 user to another user to suspend that user’s access. Range 0-15. Enter  
access level 1 for Read Access or 15 for Read/Write Access.  
encrypted  
Encrypted password you enter, copied from another device configuration.  
override-compl  
exity-check  
Disables the validation of the password strength.  
no username  
Use this command to remove a user account.  
Format  
Mode  
no username <username>  
Global Config  
Note: You cannot delete the “admin” user account.  
Management Commands  
648  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
username name nopassword  
Use this command to remove an existing user’s password (NULL password).  
Format  
username name nopassword [Level Level]  
Mode  
Global Config  
Parameter  
name  
Description  
The name of the user. Range: 1-32 characters.  
The authentication password for the user. Range 8-64 characters.  
password  
level  
The user level. Level 0 can be assigned by a level 15 user to another user to suspend  
that user's access. Range 0-15.  
username <username> unlock  
Use this command to unlock a user’s account. Only a user with read/write access can  
reactivate a locked user account.  
Format  
Mode  
username <username> unlock  
Global Config  
username snmpv3 accessmode  
Use this command to specify the snmpv3 access privileges for the specified login user. The  
valid accessmode values are readonlyor readwrite. The <username> is the login user  
name for which the specified access mode applies. The default is readwritefor the  
“admin” user and readonlyfor all other users. You must enter the <username>in the  
same case you used when you added the user. To see the case of the <username>, enter  
the show userscommand.  
Defaults  
• admin - readwrite  
• other - readonly  
Format  
Mode  
username snmpv3 accessmode <username> {readonly | readwrite}  
Global Config  
no username snmpv3 accessmode  
Use this command to set the snmpv3 access privileges for the specified user as readwrite  
for the “admin” user and readonly for all other users. The <username>value is the user  
name for which the specified access mode will apply.  
Format  
Mode  
no username snmpv3 accessmode <username>  
Global Config  
Management Commands  
649  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
username snmpv3 authentication  
Use this command to specify the authentication protocol to be used for the specified user.  
The valid authentication protocols are none, md5or sha. If you specify md5or sha, the login  
password is also used as the snmpv3 authentication password and therefore must be at least  
eight characters in length. The <username> is the user name associated with the  
authentication protocol. You must enter the <username>in the same case you used when  
you added the user. To see the case of the <username>, enter the show userscommand.  
Default  
no authentication  
Format  
Mode  
username snmpv3 authentication <username> {none | md5 | sha}  
Global Config  
no username snmpv3 authentication  
Use this command to set the authentication protocol to be used for the specified user to  
none. The <username>is the user name for which the specified authentication protocol is  
used.  
Format  
Mode  
no username snmpv3 authentication <username>  
Global Config  
username snmpv3 encryption  
Use this command to specify the encryption protocol used for the specified user. The valid  
encryption protocols are desor none.  
If you select des, you can specify the required key on the command line. The encryption key  
must be 8–64 characters long. If you select the desprotocol but do not provide a key, the  
user is prompted for the key. When you use the desprotocol, the login password is also used  
as the snmpv3 encryption password, so it must be a minimum of eight characters. If you  
select none, you do not need to provide a key.  
The <username>value is the login user name associated with the specified encryption. You  
must enter the <username>in the same case you used when you added the user. To see  
the case of the <username>, enter the show userscommand.  
Default  
no encryption  
Format  
Mode  
username snmpv3 encryption <username> {none | des[key]}  
Global Config  
Management Commands  
650  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no username snmpv3 encryption  
Use this command to set the encryption protocol to none. The <username>is the login user  
name for which the specified encryption protocol will be used.  
Format  
no username snmpv3 encryption <username>  
Mode  
Global Config  
show users  
Use this command to display the configured user names and their settings. This command is  
only available for users with Read/Write privileges. The SNMPv3 fields will only be displayed  
if SNMP is available on the system.  
Format  
show users  
Mode  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
User Name  
The name the user enters to login using the serial port, Telnet, or web.  
Access Mode  
Shows whether the user is able to change parameters on the switch (Read/Write) or is  
only able to view them (Read Only). As a factory default, the “admin” user has  
Read/Write access and the “guest” has Read Only access. There can only be one  
Read/Write user and up to five Read Only users.  
SNMPv3  
Access Mode  
The SNMPv3 Access Mode. If the value is set to ReadWrite, the SNMPv3 user is able  
to set and retrieve parameters on the system. If the value is set to ReadOnly, the  
SNMPv3 user is only able to retrieve parameter information. The SNMPv3 access mode  
might be different than the CLI and Web access mode.  
SNMPv3  
Authentication  
The authentication protocol to be used for the specified login user.  
The encryption protocol to be used for the specified login user.  
SNMPv3  
Encryption  
show users accounts  
Use this command to display the local user status about user account lockout and password  
aging.  
Format  
Mode  
show users accounts  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
User Name  
The local user account’s user name.  
The user’s privilege level (1-15).  
Privilege  
Password aging  
The password aging time for the local users.  
Management Commands  
651  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Lockout Status  
Indicates whether the user account is locked out (true or false).  
The current password expiration date in date format.  
Password  
Expiration Date  
show users accounts detail  
This command displays the local user status about user account lockout and password  
aging. It also includes information about Password strength and complexity.  
Format  
Mode  
show users accounts detail  
Privileged EXEC  
(Switch) #show users accounts detail  
UserName....................................... admin  
Privilege...................................... 15  
Password Aging................................. ---  
Password Expiry................................ ---  
Lockout........................................ False  
Override Complexity Check...................... Disable  
Password Strength.............................. ---  
UserName....................................... guest  
Privilege...................................... 1  
Password Aging................................. ---  
Password Expiry................................ ---  
Lockout........................................ False  
Override Complexity Check...................... Disable  
Password Strength.............................. ---  
show users long  
Use this command to display the user’s full name.  
Format  
Mode  
show users long  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
User Name  
The full name of the user.  
show users login-history  
Use this command to display the users who have logged in previously.  
Format  
Mode  
show users login-history [{user name}]  
Privileged EXEC  
Management Commands  
652  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Login Time  
The time at which the user logged in.  
The user name used to login.  
Username  
Protocol  
Location  
The protocol that the user used to login.  
The location of the user.  
passwords min-length  
Use this command to enforce a minimum password length for local users. The value also  
applies to the enable password. The valid range is 0–64.  
Default  
8
Format  
Mode  
passwords min-length <0-64>  
Global Config  
no passwords min-length  
Use this command to set the minimum password length to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no passwords min-length  
Global Config  
passwords history  
Use this command to set the number of previous passwords that shall be stored for each  
user account. When a local user changes his or her password, the user will not be able to  
reuse any password stored in password history. This ensures that users do not reuse their  
passwords often. The valid range is 0-10.  
Default  
0
Format  
Mode  
passwords history <0-10>  
Global Config  
no passwords history  
Use this command to set the password history to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no passwords history  
Global Config  
Management Commands  
653  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
passwords aging  
Use this command to implement aging on passwords for local users. When a user’s  
password expires, the user will be prompted to change it before logging in again. The valid  
range is 1-365. The default is 0, or no aging.  
Default  
0
Format  
Mode  
passwords aging <1-365>  
Global Config  
no passwords aging  
Use this command to set the password aging to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no passwords aging  
Global Config  
passwords lock-out  
Use this command to strengthen the security of the switch by locking user accounts that have  
failed login due to wrong passwords. When a lockout count is configured, a user that is  
logged in must enter the correct password within that count. Otherwise the user will be locked  
out from further switch access. Only a user with read/write access can reactivate a locked  
user account. Password lockout does not apply to logins from the serial console. The valid  
range is 1-5. The default is 0, or no lockout count enforced.  
Format  
Mode  
passwords lock-out <1-5>  
Global Config  
0
Default  
no passwords lock-out  
Use this command to set the password lock-out count to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no passwords lock-out  
Global Config  
passwords strength-check  
Use this command to enable the password strength feature. It is used to verify the strength of  
a password during configuration.  
Format  
passwords strength-check  
Management Commands  
654  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Mode  
Global Config  
Disable  
Default  
no passwords strength-check  
Use this command to disable the password strength-check.  
Format  
Mode  
no passwords strength-check  
Global Config  
passwords strength minimum uppercase-letters  
Use this command to enforce a minimum number of uppercase letters that a password  
should contain. The valid range is 0-16. The default is 2. Minimum of 0 means no restriction  
on that set of characters.  
Format  
Mode  
passwords strength minimum uppercase-letters  
Global Config  
2
Default  
no passwords strength minimum uppercase-letters  
Use this command to reset the minimum number of uppercase letters to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no passwords strength minimum uppercase-characters  
Global Config  
passwords strength minimum lowercase-letters  
Use this command to enforce a minimum number of lowercase letters that a password  
should contain. The valid range is 0-16. The default is 2. Minimum of 0 means no restriction  
on that set of characters.  
Format  
Mode  
passwords strength minimum lowercase-letters  
Global Config  
2
Default  
no passwords strength minimum lowercase-letters  
Use this command to reset the minimum number of lowercase letters to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no passwords strength minimum lowercase-characters  
Global Config  
Management Commands  
655  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
passwords strength minimum numeric-characters  
Use this command to enforce a minimum number of numeric characters that a password  
should contain. The valid range is 0-16. The default is 2. Minimum of 0 means no restriction  
on that set of characters.  
Format  
Mode  
passwords strength minimum numeric-letters  
Global Config  
2
Default  
no passwords strength minimum numeric-characters  
Use this command to reset the minimum number of numeric characters to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no passwords strength minimum numeric-characters  
Global Config  
passwords strength minimum special-characters  
Use this command to enforce a minimum number of special characters that a password  
should contain. The valid range is 0-16. The default is 2. Minimum of 0 means no restriction  
on that set of characters.  
Format  
Mode  
passwords strength minimum special-letters  
Global Config  
2
Default  
no passwords strength minimum special-letters  
Use this command to reset the minimum number of special letters to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no passwords strength minimum special-letters  
Global Config  
passwords strength maximum consecutive-characters  
Use this command to enforce a maximum number of consecutive characters that a password  
should contain. An example of consecutive characters is abcd. The valid range is 0-16. If a  
password has consecutive characters more than the configured limit, it fails to configure. The  
default is 0. A maximum of 0 means no restriction on that set of characters.  
Format  
Mode  
passwords strength maximum consecutive-characters  
Global Config  
0
Default  
Management Commands  
656  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no passwords strength maximum consecutive-characters  
Use this command to reset the maximum number of consecutive characters to the default  
value.  
Format  
Mode  
no passwords strength maximum consecutive-characters  
Global Config  
passwords strength maximum repeated-characters  
Use this command to enforce a maximum number of repeated characters that a password  
should contain. An example of repeated characters is aaaa. The valid range is 0-16. If a  
password has a repetition of characters more than the configured limit, it fails to configure.  
The default is 0. A maximum of 0 means no restriction on that set of characters.  
Format  
Mode  
passwords strength maximum repeated-characters  
Global Config  
0
Default  
no passwords strength maximum repeated-characters  
Use this command to reset the maximum number of repeated-characters to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no passwords strength maximum repeated-characters  
Global Config  
passwords strength minimum character-classes  
Use this command to enforce a minimum number of characters classes that a password  
should contain. Character classes are uppercase letters, lowercase letters, numeric  
characters, and special characters. The valid range is 0-4. The default is 4.  
Format  
Mode  
passwords strength minimum character-classes  
Global Config  
4
Default  
no passwords strength minimum character-classes  
Use this command to reset the minimum number of character classes to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no passwords strength minimum character-classes  
Global Config  
Management Commands  
657  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
passwords strength exclude-keyword  
Use this command to exclude the specified keyword while configuring the password. The  
password does not accept the keyword in any form (in between the string, case insensitive  
and reverse) as a substring. User can configure up to a maximum of 3 keywords.  
Format  
Mode  
passwords strength exclude-keyword keyword  
Global Config  
no passwords strength exclude-keyword  
Use this command to remove the exclude-keyword.  
Format  
Mode  
no passwords strength exclude-keyword  
Global Config  
show passwords configuration  
Use this command to display the configured password management settings.  
Format  
Mode  
show passwords configuration  
Privileged EXEC  
Termd  
Definition  
Minimum Password  
Length  
Minimum number of characters required when changing passwords.  
Password History  
Password Aging  
Lockout Attempts  
Number of passwords to store for reuse prevention.  
Length in days that a password is valid.  
Number of failed password login attempts before lockout.  
Minimum number of uppercase characters required when configuring passwords.  
Minimum Password  
Uppercase Letters  
Minimum Password  
Lowercase Letters  
Minimum number of lowercase characters required when configuring passwords.  
Minimum number of numeric characters required when configuring passwords.  
Minimum Password  
Numeric Characters  
Maximum Password  
Consecutive  
Characters  
Maximum number of consecutive characters required that the password should  
contain when configuring passwords.  
Maximum Password  
Repeated Characters  
Maximum number of repetitions of characters that the password should contain  
when configuring passwords.  
Management Commands  
658  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Termd  
Definition  
Minimum Password  
Character Classes  
Minimum number of character classes (uppercase, lowercase, numeric, and  
special) required when configuring passwords.  
Password Exclude-  
Keywords  
The set of keywords to be excluded from the configured password when strength  
checking is enabled.  
show passwords result  
Use this command to display the last password set result information.  
Format  
Mode  
show passwords result  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Last User Whose  
Password Is Set  
Shows the name of the user with the most recently set password.  
Shows whether password strength checking is enabled.  
Password Strength  
Check  
Last Password Set  
Result  
Shows whether the attempt to set a password was successful. If the attempt  
failed, the reason for the failure is included.  
aaa authentication login  
Use this command to set authentication at login. The default and optional list names that you  
create with the aaa authentication logincommand are used with the login  
authenticationcommand. Create a list by entering the aaa authentication login  
list-name methodcommand for a particular protocol, where list-nameis any character  
string used to name this list. The methodargument identifies the list of methods that the  
authentication algorithm tries, in the given sequence. The additional methods of  
authentication are used only if the previous method returns an error, not if it fails.  
An example of a method that returns an error is if a RADIUS server is not present, and an  
example of a method failing is when a RADIUS server cannot authenticate the client. If ‘local’  
method is listed first, since local authentication is always available, it only has the fail  
condition, not error. As such, if ‘local’ method is the first in the list, no other method will be  
tried.  
To ensure that the authentication succeeds even if all methods return an error, specify none  
as the final method in the command line. For example if noneis specified as an  
authentication method after radius, no authentication is used if the radius server is down.  
Format  
Mode  
aaa authentication login {default | list-name} method1 [method2...]  
Global Config  
Default Uses the listed authentication methods that follow this argument as the default list of  
methods when a user logs in.  
Management Commands  
659  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
list-name Character string used to name the list of authentication methods activated when a  
user logs in. Up to 12 characters.  
method1 [method2…] At least one from the following table:  
Keyword  
Description  
enable  
line  
Uses the enable password for authentication.  
Uses the line password for authentication.  
Uses the local username database for authentication.  
Uses no authentication.  
local  
none  
radius  
tacacs  
Uses the list of all RADIUS servers for authentication.  
Uses the list of all TACACS servers for authentication.  
Note: The local user database is checked. This has the same effect  
as the following command: aaa authentication login local  
no aaa authentication login  
Use this command to remove authentication at login.  
Format  
Mode  
no aaa authentication login {default | list-name}  
Global Config  
aaa authentication enable  
Use this command to set authentication when the user access higher privilege level, use the  
aaa authentication enable defaultcommand in global configuration mode. The default  
and optional list names that you create with the aaa authentication enablecommand are  
used with the enable authenticationcommand.  
Create a list by entering the aaa authentication enable list-name methodcommand  
where list-nameis any character string used to name this list. The methodargument  
identifies the list of methods that the authentication algorithm tries, in the given sequence.  
The additional methods of authentication are used only if the previous method returns an  
error, not if it fails. To ensure that the authentication succeeds even if all methods return an  
error, specify noneas the final method in the command line. For example, if noneis specified  
as an authentication method after radius, no authentication is used if the radius server is  
down. All aaa authentication enable defaultrequests sent by the switch to a RADIUS  
or TACACS server include the username "$enabx$.", where xis the requested privilege level.  
Format  
Mode  
aaa authentication enable {default | list-name} method1 [method2...]  
Global Config  
Management Commands  
660  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Default Uses the listed authentication methods that follow this argument as the default list of  
methods when a user accesses a higher privilege level.  
list-name Character string used to name the list of authentication methods activated when a  
user accesses a higher privilege level. Up to 12 characters.  
method1 [method2…] At least one from the following table:  
Keyword  
Description  
deny  
enable  
line  
Use to deny access.  
Uses the enable password for authentication.  
Uses the line password for authentication.  
Uses no authentication.  
none  
radius  
Uses the list of all RADIUS servers for authentication. Uses username  
"$enabx$."where x is the privilege level.  
tacacs  
Uses the list of all TACACS servers for authentication. Uses username  
"$enabx$." where x is the privilege level.  
Note: If the default list is not set, only the enable password is checked.  
This has the same effect as the following command:  
aaa authentication enable default enable  
On the console, the enable password is used if it exists. If no  
password is set, the process will succeed anyway. This has the  
same effect as the following command:  
aaa authentication enable default enable none  
no aaa authentication enable  
Use this command to remove the authentication method.  
Format  
Mode  
no aaa authentication enable {default | list-name} method1  
[method2...]  
Global Config  
aaa authentication dot1x  
Use this command to set authentication for dot1x users. The method argument identifies the  
list of methods that the authentication algorithm tries, in the given sequence. The additional  
methods of authentication are used only if the previous method returns an error, not if there is  
an authentication failure. To ensure that the authentication succeeds even if all methods  
return an error, specify noneas the final method in the command line. For example if noneis  
Management Commands  
661  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
specified as an authentication method after radius, no authentication is used if the radius  
server is down.  
Format  
Mode  
aaa authentication dot1x default method1  
Global Config  
method1: At least one from the following table:  
Keyword  
Description  
local  
none  
radius  
ias  
Uses the local username database for authentication.  
Uses no authentication.  
Uses the list of all RADIUS servers for authentication.  
Uses the internal authentication server users database for authentication.  
no aaa authentication dot1x  
Use this command to remove the authentication at login.  
Format  
Mode  
no aaa authentication dot1x default  
Global Config  
aaa accounting  
The command creates an accounting method list. This list is identified by “default” or a  
user-specified “list_name.” Accounting records, when enabled for a line-mode, can be sent at  
both the beginning and at the end (start-stop), or only at the end (stop-only). If “none” is  
specified, accounting is disabled for the specified list. If “tacacs” is specified as the  
Accounting method, Accounting records are notified to a TACACS+ server. If “radius” is the  
specified Accounting method, Accounting records are notified to a RADIUS server.  
For the same set of accounting type and list name, the administrator can change the record  
type or the methods list without having to first delete the previous configuration.  
Note the following:  
A maximum of five Accounting Method Lists can be created for each exec and commands  
type.  
The same list-name can be used for both exec and commands Accounting type.  
AAA Accounting for commands with RADIUS as the Accounting method is not supported.  
Format  
Mode  
aaa accounting {exec | commands } {default | list_name} {start-stop  
| stop-only |none} method1 [method2…]  
Global Config  
Management Commands  
662  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
exec  
Definition  
Provides accounting for user EXEC terminal sessions.  
Provides accounting for all user-executed commands.  
The default list of methods for accounting services.  
Character string used to name the list of accounting methods.  
commands  
default  
list-name  
start-stop  
Sends a start accounting notice at the beginning of a process and a stop  
accounting notice at the end of a process.  
stop-only  
none  
Sends a stop accounting notice at the end of the requested user process.  
Disables accounting services on this line.  
method  
(method1/method2…)  
Use either tacacs or radius server for accounting purpose.  
no aaa accounting  
This command deletes the accounting method list.  
Format  
Mode  
no aaa accounting {exec | commands} {list_name default}  
Global Config  
accounting (Console/Telnet/SSH)  
This command applies the accounting method list to a line config (console/telnet/ssh). Apply  
this command in Line Config mode.  
Format  
Mode  
accounting {exec | commands} [default | list_name]  
Line Config  
Term  
exec  
Definition  
This causes accounting for an EXEC session.  
This causes accounting for each command execution attempt.  
commands  
If a user is enabling accounting for exec mode for the current line-configuration  
type, they will be logged out.  
no accounting (Console/Telnet/SSH)  
This command is used to remove accounting from a line config mode.  
Format  
Mode  
no accounting { exec | commands }  
Line Config  
Management Commands  
663  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
ip http/https accounting  
This command applies user exec accounting list to the line methods HTTP and HTTPs  
methods.  
Format  
ip {http| https} accounting exec {default| <listname>}  
Mode  
Global Config  
Term  
Definition  
HTTP/HTTPS  
Line method for which the list needs to be applied.  
The default list of methods for authorization services.  
Alphanumeric character string used to name the list of authorization methods.  
default  
list-name  
no ip http/https accounting exec  
This command deletes the authorization method list.  
Format  
Mode  
no ip {http| https} accounting exec {default| <listname>}  
Global Config  
show accounting  
Use this command to display ordered methods for accounting lists.  
Format  
Mode  
show accounting  
Privileged EXEC  
Example: The following shows the CLI display output for the command:  
(switch) #show accounting  
Number of Accounting Notifications sent at beginning of an EXEC session:  
Errors when sending Accounting Notifications beginning of an EXEC session:  
Number of Accounting Notifications at end of an EXEC session:  
Errors when sending Accounting Notifications at end of an EXEC session:  
Number of Accounting Notifications sent at beginning of a command execution:  
Errors when sending Accounting Notifications at beginning of a command execution:  
Number of Accounting Notifications sent at end of a command execution:  
Errors when sending Accounting Notifications at end of a command execution:  
show accounting methods  
This command displays the configured accounting method lists.  
Format  
Mode  
show accounting methods  
Privileged EXEC  
Management Commands  
664  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Example:  
(switch) #  
(switch) #show accounting methods  
Acct Type  
Method Name  
Record Type  
Method Type  
---------- ------------  
------------ ------------  
Exec  
Commands  
Commands  
dfltExecList  
dfltCmdsList  
UserCmdAudit  
start-stop  
stop-only  
start-stop  
TACACS  
TACACS  
TACACS  
Line  
EXEC Method List  
Command Method List  
--------- -------------------- --------------------  
Console none  
none  
none  
none  
none  
none  
Telnet  
SSH  
none  
none  
none  
none  
HTTPS  
HTTP  
aaa authorization  
This command creates an authorization method list. This list is identified by “default” or a  
user-specified “list_name.” If “tacacs” is specified as the Authorization method, Authorization  
commands are notified to a TACACS+ server. If “none” is specified as the Authorization  
method, command authorization is not applicable. A maximum of five Authorization Method  
Lists can be created for “commands” type.  
Note: Local method is not supported for command Authorization. Also  
note that command authorization with RADIUS works only if the  
applied authentication method is also radius.  
Format  
aaa authorization {commands | exec } {default | <list_name>}  
method1[method2]  
Mode  
Global Config  
Term  
Definition  
commands  
Alphanumeric character string used to name the list of authorization methods.  
The default list of methods for authorization services.  
The default list of methods for authorization services.  
Alphanumeric character string used to name the list of authorization methods.  
TACACS+/RADIUS/Local and none are supported.  
Exec  
default  
list-name  
method  
Management Commands  
665  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no aaa authorization  
This command deletes the authorization method list.  
Format  
Mode  
no aaa authorization {commands | exec } {default | <list_name>}  
method1[method2]  
Global Config  
authorization(console/telnet/ssh)  
To apply the command authorization method list to an access method (console/telnet/ssh).  
Apply this command in the line configuration mode.  
Format  
Mode  
authorization {commands | exec }[default |<list_name>]  
• Line console  
• Line telnet  
• Line SSH  
no authorization(console/telnet/ssh)  
This command is used to remove command authorization from a line config mode.  
Format  
Mode  
no authorization {commands| exec}  
• Line console  
• Line telnet  
• Line SSH  
show authorization methods  
This command displays the configured authorization method lists.  
Format  
Mode  
show authorization methods  
Privileged EXEC  
Example:  
(Switch) #show authorization methods  
Command Authorization List  
----------------------------  
dfltCmdAuthList  
Method  
------------------------------  
none  
undefined undefined undefined  
Line  
Command Method List  
---------  
Console  
Telnet  
SSH  
---------------------  
dfltCmdAuthList  
dfltCmdAuthList  
dfltCmdAuthList  
Exec Authorization List  
Method  
Management Commands  
666  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
----------------------------  
dfltExecAuthList  
------------------------------  
none undefined undefined undefined  
Line  
Exec Method List  
---------  
---------------------  
Console  
Telnet  
SSH  
dfltExecAuthList  
dfltExecAuthList  
dfltExecAuthList  
domain-name  
Managed switch supports authentication based on domain name in addition to the username  
and password. This command allows the switch to be configured in a domain. Users can  
enable or disable domain functionality.  
Following are the two cases  
Domain enabled: In this case, when the user enters only the username, then the  
managed switch sends the username as the domain-name (configured on  
switch)\username to the RADIUS server. If the user enters the domain name and  
username, the managed switch sends the username input as the domain-name(as  
entered by the user)\username to the RADIUS server.  
Domain disabled: In this case, the domain name is not included when the user-name is  
sent to the RADIUS server.  
Note: If the user domain is already provided by the user/supplicant, the  
domain name is assumed to reach the managed switch along with  
the username in the following format:  
"Domainname \username"  
Format  
Mode  
domain-name <name>  
Global Config  
no domain-name  
This command is used to disable the domain-name in the managed switch.  
Format  
Mode  
no domain-name  
Global Config  
domain-name enable  
This command enables the domain name functionality.  
Format  
Mode  
domain-name enable  
Global Config  
Management Commands  
667  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no domain-name enable  
This command disables the domain name functionality.  
Format  
Mode  
no domain-name enable  
Global Config  
show domain-name  
This command displays the configured domain-name.  
Format  
Mode  
show domain-name  
Privileged EXEC  
Example:  
(switch) #  
(switch) #show domain-name  
Domain  
Domain-name  
: Enable  
:abc  
aaa ias-user username  
The Internal Authentication Server (IAS) database is a dedicated internal database used for  
local authentication of users for network access through the IEEE 802.1X feature. Use this  
command to add the specified user to the internal user database. This command also  
changes the mode to AAA User Config mode.  
Format  
Mode  
aaa ias-username <user>  
Global Config  
no aaa ias-user username  
Use this command to remove an ias user.  
Format  
Mode  
no aaa ias-username <user>  
Global Config  
Management Commands  
668  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
aaa session-id  
This global aaa command specifies whether the same session-id is used for Authentication,  
Authorization, and Accounting service type within a session.  
Default  
common  
Format  
Mode  
aaa session-id [common | unique]  
Global Config  
Parameter  
common  
Definition  
Use the same session-id for all AAA Service types.  
Use a unique session-id for AAA Service types.  
unique  
no aaa session-id  
This command resets the aaa session-idbehavior to default.  
Format  
Mode  
no aaa session-id [unique]  
Global Config  
password (AAA IAS User Configuration)  
Use this command to specify a password for a user in the IAS database.  
Format  
Mode  
password <password> [encrypted]  
AAA IAS User Config  
Parameter  
password  
Definition  
Password for this level. Range: 8-64 characters.  
Encrypted password to be entered, copied from another switch configuration.  
encrypted  
no password(AAA IAS User Configuration)  
Use this command to remove a password for a user in the IAS database.  
Format  
Mode  
no password  
AAA IAS User Config  
Management Commands  
669  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
clear aaa ias-users  
Use this command to remove all users from the IAS database.  
Format  
Mode  
clear aaa ias-users  
Privileged EXEC  
show aaa ias-users  
Use this command to display configured IAS users and their attributes. Passwords  
configured are not shown in the show command output.  
Format  
Mode  
show aaa ias-users  
Privileged EXEC  
SNMP Commands  
This section describes the commands you use to configure Simple Network Management  
Protocol (SNMP) on the switch. You can configure the switch to act as an SNMP agent so  
that it can communicate with SNMP managers on your network.  
snmp-server  
Use this command to set the name and the physical location of the switch and the  
organization responsible for the network. The range for <name>, <loc>and <con>is from 1  
to 31 alphanumeric characters.  
Default  
none  
Format  
Mode  
snmp-server {sysname <name> | location <loc> | contact <con>}  
Global Config  
snmp-server community  
Use this command to add (and name) a new SNMP community. A community <name>is a  
name associated with the switch and with a set of SNMP managers that manage it with a  
specified privileged level. The length of <name>can be up to 16 case-sensitive characters.  
Note: Community names in the SNMP Community Table must be unique.  
When making multiple entries using the same community name, the  
first entry is kept and processed and all duplicate entries are  
ignored.  
Management Commands  
670  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
           
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Default  
• Public and private, which you can rename.  
• Default values for the remaining four community names are blank.  
Format  
Mode  
snmp-server community <name>  
Global Config  
no snmp-server community  
Use this command to remove this community name from the table. The <name>is the  
community name to be deleted.  
Format  
Mode  
no snmp-server community <name>  
Global Config  
snmp-server community ipaddr  
Use this command to set a client IP address for an SNMP community. The address is the  
associated community SNMP packet sending address and is used along with the client IP  
mask value to denote a range of IP addresses from which SNMP clients might use that  
community to access the device. A value of 0.0.0.0 allows access from any IP address.  
Otherwise, this value is ANDed with the mask to determine the range of allowed client IP  
addresses. The name is the applicable community name.  
Default  
0.0.0.0  
Format  
Mode  
snmp-server community ipaddr <ipaddr> <name>  
Global Config  
no snmp-server community ipaddr  
Use this command to set a client IP address for an SNMP community to 0.0.0.0. The name is  
the applicable community name.  
Format  
Mode  
no snmp-server community ipaddr <name>  
Global Config  
snmp-server community ipmask  
Use this command to set a client IP mask for an SNMP community. The address is the  
associated community SNMP packet sending address and is used along with the client IP  
address value to denote a range of IP addresses from which SNMP clients might use that  
community to access the device. A value of 255.255.255.255 will allow access from only one  
Management Commands  
671  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
station, and will use that machine's IP address for the client IP address. A value of 0.0.0.0 will  
allow access from any IP address. The name is the applicable community name.  
Default  
0.0.0.0  
Format  
Mode  
snmp-server community ipmask <ipmask> <name>  
Global Config  
no snmp-server community ipmask  
Use this command to set a client IP mask for an SNMP community to 0.0.0.0. The name is  
the applicable community name. The community name might be up to 16 alphanumeric  
characters.  
Format  
Mode  
no snmp-server community ipmask <name>  
Global Config  
snmp-server community mode  
Use this command to activate an SNMP community. If a community is enabled, an SNMP  
manager associated with this community manages the switch according to its access right. If  
the community is disabled, no SNMP requests using this community are accepted. In this  
case the SNMP manager associated with this community cannot manage the switch until the  
Status is changed back to Enable.  
Default  
• private and public communities - enabled  
• other four - disabled  
Format  
Mode  
snmp-server community mode <name>  
Global Config  
no snmp-server community mode  
Use this command to deactivate an SNMP community. If the community is disabled, no  
SNMP requests using this community are accepted. In this case the SNMP manager  
associated with this community cannot manage the switch until the Status is changed back to  
Enable.  
Format  
Mode  
no snmp-server community mode <name>  
Global Config  
Management Commands  
672  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
snmp-server community ro  
Use this command to restrict access to switch information. The access mode is read-only  
(also called public).  
Format  
Mode  
snmp-server community ro <name>  
Global Config  
snmp-server community rw  
Use this command to restrict access to switch information. The access mode is read/write  
(also called private).  
Format  
Mode  
snmp-server community rw <name>  
Global Config  
snmp-server enable traps violation  
Use this command to enable sending new violation traps designating when a packet with a  
disallowed MAC address is received on a locked port.  
Note: For other port security commands, see Protected Ports Commands  
on page 64.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
snmp-server enable traps violation  
Interface Config  
no snmp-server enable traps violation  
Use this command to disable sending new violation traps.  
Format  
Mode  
no snmp-server enable traps violation  
Interface Config  
snmp-server enable traps  
Use this command to enable the Authentication Flag.  
Default  
enabled  
Management Commands  
673  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
         
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Format  
Mode  
snmp-server enable traps  
Global Config  
no snmp-server enable traps  
Use this command to disable the Authentication Flag.  
Format  
Mode  
no snmp-server enable traps  
Global Config  
Note: This command might not be available on all platforms.  
snmp-server enable traps linkmode  
Use this command to enable Link Up/Down traps for the entire switch. When enabled, link  
traps are sent only if the Link Trap flag setting associated with the port is enabled. For more  
Default  
enabled  
Format  
Mode  
snmp-server enable traps linkmode  
Global Config  
no snmp-server enable traps linkmode  
Use this command to disable Link Up/Down traps for the entire switch.  
Format  
Mode  
no snmp-server enable traps linkmode  
Global Config  
snmp-server enable traps multiusers  
Use this command to enable Multiple User traps. When the traps are enabled, a Multiple  
User Trap is sent when a user logs in to the terminal interface (EIA 232 or Telnet) and there  
is an existing terminal interface session.  
Default  
enabled  
Format  
Mode  
snmp-server enable traps multiusers  
Global Config  
Management Commands  
674  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no snmp-server enable traps multiusers  
Use this command to disable Multiple User traps.  
Format  
Mode  
no snmp-server enable traps multiusers  
Global Config  
snmp-server enable traps stpmode  
Use this command to enable sending new root traps and topology change notification traps.  
Default  
enabled  
Format  
Mode  
snmp-server enable traps stpmode  
Global Config  
no snmp-server enable traps stpmode  
Use this command to disable sending new root traps and topology change notification traps.  
Format  
Mode  
no snmp-server enable traps stpmode  
Global Config  
snmptrap  
Use this command to add an SNMP trap receiver. The maximum length of <name>is 16  
case-sensitive alphanumeric characters. The <snmpversion>is the version of SNMP. The  
version parameter options are snmpv1 or snmpv2. The SNMP trap address can be set using  
both an IPv4 address format as well as an IPv6 global address format.  
The following shows an example of the CLI command.  
(Netgear Switch)# snmptrap mytrap ip6addr 3099::2  
Note: The <name> parameter does not need to be unique, however; the  
<name> and <ipaddr | hostname> pair must be unique. Multiple  
entries can exist with the same <name>, as long as they are  
associated with a different <ipaddr | hostname>. The reverse  
scenario is also acceptable. The <name> is the community name  
used when sending the trap to the receiver, but the <name> is not  
directly associated with the SNMP Community Table, See  
“snmp-server community” on page39.”  
Management Commands  
675  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Default  
Format  
snmpv2  
snmptrap <name> {ipaddr <ipaddr|hostname> | ip6addr <ip6addr|  
hostname>} [snmpversion <snmpversion>]  
Mode  
Global Config  
no snmptrap  
Use this command to delete trap receivers for a community.  
Format  
Mode  
no snmptrap <name> {ipaddr <ipaddr|hostname> | ip6addr <ip6addr|  
hostname>}  
Global Config  
snmptrap snmpversion  
Use this command to modify the SNMP version of a trap. The maximum length of <name>is  
16 case-sensitive alphanumeric characters. The <snmpversion>parameter options are  
snmpv1 or snmpv2.  
Note: This command does not support a “no” form.  
Default  
snmpv2  
Format  
Mode  
snmptrap snmpversion <name> {<ipaddr | hostname> |<ip6addr|hostname>}  
{snmpv1|snmpv2}  
Global Config  
snmptrap ipaddr  
Use this command to assign an IP address to a specified community name. The name can  
use up to 16 case-sensitive alphanumeric characters.  
Note: IP addresses in the SNMP trap receiver table must be unique. If you  
make multiple entries using the same IP address, the first entry is  
retained and processed. All duplicate entries are ignored.  
Management Commands  
676  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Format  
Mode  
snmptrap ipaddr <name> <ipaddrold> <ipaddrnew | hostnamenew>  
Global Config  
snmptrap mode  
Use this command to activate or deactivate an SNMP trap. Enabled trap receivers are active  
(able to receive traps). Disabled trap receivers are inactive (not able to receive traps).  
Format  
Mode  
snmptrap mode <name> { <ipaddr | hostname> |<ip6addr |hostname>}  
Global Config  
no snmptrap mode  
Use this command to deactivate an SNMP trap. Disabled trap receivers are unable to receive  
traps.  
Format  
Mode  
no snmptrap mode <name> { <ipaddr | hostname> |<ip6addr |hostname>}  
Global Config  
snmp trap link-status  
Use this command to enable link status traps by interface.  
Note: This command is valid only when the Link Up/Down Flag is enabled.  
For more information, see snmp-server enable traps linkmode on  
Format  
Mode  
snmp trap link-status  
Interface Config  
no snmp trap link-status  
Use this command to disable link status traps by interface.  
Note: This command is valid only when the Link Up/Down Flag is enabled.  
Management Commands  
677  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Format  
Mode  
no snmp trap link-status  
Interface Config  
snmp trap link-status all  
Use this command to enable link status traps for all interfaces.  
Note: This command is valid only when the Link Up/Down Flag is enabled.  
For more information, see snmp-server enable traps linkmode on  
Format  
Mode  
snmp trap link-status all  
Global Config  
no snmp trap link-status all  
Use this command to disable link status traps for all interfaces.  
Note: This command is valid only when the Link Up/Down Flag is enabled.  
For more information, see snmp-server enable traps linkmode on  
Format  
Mode  
no snmp trap link-status all  
Global Config  
show snmpcommunity  
Use this command to display SNMP community information. Six communities are supported.  
You can add, change, or delete communities. The switch does not need to be reset for  
changes to take effect.  
The SNMP agent of the switch complies with SNMP Versions 1, 2 or 3. For more information  
about the SNMP specification, see the SNMP RFCs. The SNMP agent sends traps through  
Management Commands  
678  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
TCP/IP to an external SNMP manager based on the SNMP configuration (the trap receiver  
and other SNMP community parameters).  
Format  
show snmpcommunity  
Mode  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
SNMP  
Community  
Name  
The community string to which this entry grants access. A valid entry is a case-sensitive  
alphanumeric string of up to 16 characters. Each row of this table must contain a unique  
community name.  
Client IP  
Address  
An IP address (or portion thereof) from which this device will accept SNMP packets with  
the associated community. The requesting entity's IP address is ANDed with the Subnet  
Mask before being compared to the IP address. Note: If the Subnet Mask is set to  
0.0.0.0, an IP address of 0.0.0.0 matches all IP addresses. The default value is 0.0.0.0.  
Client IP Mask  
A mask to be ANDed with the requesting entity's IP address before comparison with IP  
address. If the result matches with IP address then the address is an authenticated IP  
address. For example, if the IP address = 9.47.128.0 and the corresponding Subnet  
Mask = 255.255.255.0 a range of incoming IP addresses would match, i.e. the incoming  
IP address could equal 9.47.128.0 - 9.47.128.255. The default value is 0.0.0.0.  
Access Mode  
Status  
The access level for this community string.  
The status of this community access entry.  
show snmptrap  
Use this command to display SNMP trap receivers. Trap messages are sent across a  
network to an SNMP Network Manager. These messages alert the manager to events  
occurring within the switch or on the network. Six trap receivers are simultaneously  
supported.  
Format  
Mode  
show snmptrap  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
SNMP Trap  
Name  
The community string of the SNMP trap packet sent to the trap manager. The string is  
case-sensitive and can be up to 16 alphanumeric characters.  
IP Address  
IPv6 Address  
SNMP Version  
Status  
The IPv4 address to receive SNMP traps from this device.  
The IPv6 address to receive SNMP traps from this device.  
SNMPv2  
The receiver's status (enabled or disabled).  
The following shows an example of the CLI command.  
(Netgear Switch)#show snmptrap  
Management Commands  
679  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Community Name IpAddress  
IPv6 Address  
2001::1  
Snmp Version  
SNMPv2  
Mode  
Mytrap  
0.0.0.0  
Enable show trapflags  
show trapflags  
Use this command to display trap conditions. The command’s display shows all the enabled  
OSPFv2 and OSPFv3 trapflags. Configure which traps the switch should generate by  
enabling or disabling the trap condition. If a trap condition is enabled and the condition is  
detected, the SNMP agent on the switch sends the trap to all enabled trap receivers. You do  
not have to reset the switch to implement the changes. Cold and warm start traps are always  
generated and cannot be disabled.  
Format  
show trapflags  
Mode  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Authentication  
Flag  
Can be enabled or disabled. The factory default is enabled. Indicates whether  
authentication failure traps will be sent.  
Link Up/Down  
Flag  
Can be enabled or disabled. The factory default is enabled. Indicates whether link status  
traps will be sent.  
Multiple Users  
Flag  
Can be enabled or disabled. The factory default is enabled. Indicates whether a trap will  
be sent when the same user ID is logged into the switch more than once at the same  
time (either through Telnet or the serial port).  
Spanning Tree  
Flag  
Can be enabled or disabled. The factory default is enabled. Indicates whether spanning  
tree traps are sent.  
ACL Traps  
Might be enabled or disabled. The factory default is disabled. Indicates whether ACL  
traps are sent.  
DVMRP Traps  
OSPFv2 Traps  
Can be enabled or disabled. The factory default is disabled. Indicates whether DVMRP  
traps are sent.  
Can be enabled or disabled. The factory default is disabled. Indicates whether OSPF  
traps are sent. If any of the OSPF trap flags are not enabled, the command displays  
disabled. Otherwise, the command shows all the enabled OSPF traps’ information.  
OSPFv3 Traps  
PIM Traps  
Can be enabled or disabled. The factory default is disabled. Indicates whether OSPF  
traps are sent. If any of the OSPFv3 trap flags are not enabled, the command displays  
disabled. Otherwise, the command shows all the enabled OSPFv3 traps’ information.  
Can be enabled or disabled. The factory default is disabled. Indicates whether PIM traps  
are sent.  
RADIUS Commands  
This section describes the commands you use to configure the switch to use a Remote  
Authentication Dial-In User Service (RADIUS) server on your network for authentication and  
accounting.  
Management Commands  
680  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
authorization network radius  
Use this command to enable the switch to accept VLAN assignment by the radius server.  
Default  
disable  
Format  
Mode  
authorization network radius  
Global Config  
no authorization network radius  
Use this command to disable the switch to accept VLAN assignment by the radius server.  
Format  
Mode  
no authorization network radius  
Global Config  
radius accounting mode  
Use this command to enable the RADIUS accounting function.  
Default  
disabled  
Format  
Mode  
radius accounting mode  
Global Config  
no radius accounting mode  
Use this command to set the RADIUS accounting function to the default value (disabled).  
Format  
Mode  
no radius accounting mode  
Global Config  
radius server attribute  
Use this command to specify the RADIUS client to use the NAS-IP Address attribute in the  
RADIUS requests. If the specific IP address is configured while enabling this attribute, the  
RADIUS client uses that IP address while sending NAS-IP-Address attribute in RADIUS  
communication.  
Format  
Mode  
radius server attribute <4> [<ipaddr>]  
Global Config  
Term  
4
Definition  
NAS-IP-Address attribute to be used in RADIUS requests.  
The IP address of the server.  
ipaddr  
Management Commands  
681  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no radius server attribute  
Use the noversion of this command to disable the NAS-IP-Address attribute global  
parameter for RADIUS client. When this parameter is disabled, the RADIUS client does not  
send the NAS-IP-Address attribute in RADIUS requests.  
Format  
Mode  
no radius server attribute <4> [<ipaddr>]  
Global Config  
The following shows an example of the command.  
(Switch) (Config) #radius server attribute 4 192.168.37.60  
(Switch) (Config) #radius server attribute 4  
radius server host  
Use this command to configure the IP address or DNS name to use for communicating with  
the RADIUS server of a selected server type. While configuring the IP address or DNS name  
for the authenticating or accounting servers, you can also configure the port number and  
server name. If the authenticating and accounting servers are configured without a name, the  
command uses the ‘Default_RADIUS_Auth_Server’ and ‘Default_RADIUS_Acct_Server’ as  
the default names, respectively. The same name can be configured for more than one  
authenticating servers and the name should be unique for accounting servers. The RADIUS  
client allows the configuration of a maximum 32 authenticating and accounting servers.  
If you use the <auth>parameter, the command configures the IP address or hostname to  
use to connect to a RADIUS authentication server. You can configure up to 3 servers per  
RADIUS client. If the maximum number of configured servers is reached, the command fails  
until you remove one of the servers by issuing the “no” form of the command. If you use the  
optional <port>parameter, the command configures the UDP port number to use when  
connecting to the configured RADIUS server. The <port>number range is 1 - 65535, with  
1812 being the default value.  
Note: To reconfigure a RADIUS authentication server to use the default  
UDP <port>, set the <port> parameter to 1812.  
If you use the <acct>token, the command configures the IP address or hostname to use for  
the RADIUS accounting server. You can only configure one accounting server. If an  
accounting server is currently configured, use the “no” form of the command to remove it from  
the configuration. The IP address or hostname you specify must match that of a previously  
configured accounting server. If you use the optional <port>parameter, the command  
configures the UDP port to use when connecting to the RADIUS accounting server. If a  
<port>is already configured for the accounting server, the new <port>replaces the  
previously configured <port>. The <port>must be a value in the range 0 - 65535, with  
1813 being the default.  
Management Commands  
682  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Note: To reconfigure a RADIUS accounting server to use the default UDP  
<port>, set the <port> parameter to 1813.  
Format  
Mode  
radius server host{auth | acct} {<ipaddr|dnsname>} [name  
<servername>] [port <0-65535>][server-type]  
Global Config  
Field  
Description  
ipaddr  
The IP address of the server.  
dnsname  
0-65535  
The DNS name of the server.  
The port number to use to connect to the specified RADIUS server.  
servername  
The alias name to identify the server.  
no radius server host  
Use the noversion of this command to delete the configured server entry from the list of  
configured RADIUS servers. If the RADIUS authenticating server being removed is the active  
server in the servers that are identified by the same server name, then the RADIUS client  
selects another server for making RADIUS transactions. If the 'auth' token is used, the  
previously configured RADIUS authentication server is removed from the configuration.  
Similarly, if the 'acct' token is used, the previously configured RADIUS accounting server is  
removed from the configuration. The <ipaddr|dnsname>parameter must match the IP  
address or dns name of the previously configured RADIUS authentication / accounting  
server.  
Format  
Mode  
no radius server host {auth | acct} {<ipaddr|dnsname>}  
Global Config  
The following shows an example of the command.  
(Switch) (Config) #radius server host acct 192.168.37.60  
(Switch) (Config) #radius server host acct 192.168.37.60 port 1813  
(Switch) (Config) #radius server host auth 192.168.37.60 name  
Network1_RADIUS_Auth_Server port 1813  
(Switch) (Config) #radius server host acct 192.168.37.60 name  
Network2_RADIUS_Auth_Server  
(Switch) (Config) #no radius server host acct 192.168.37.60  
Management Commands  
683  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
radius server key  
Use this command to configure the key to be used in RADIUS client communication with the  
specified server. Depending on whether the 'auth' or 'acct' token is used, the shared secret is  
configured for the RADIUS authentication or RADIUS accounting server. The IP address or  
hostname provided must match a previously configured server. When this command is  
executed, the secret is prompted.  
Text-based configuration supports Radius server’s secrets in encrypted and non-encrypted  
format. When you save the configuration, these secret keys are stored in encrypted format  
only. If you want to enter the key in encrypted format, enter the key along with the encrypted  
keyword. In the show running config command’s display, these secret keys are displayed in  
encrypted format. You cannot show these keys in plain text format.  
Note: The secret must be an alphanumeric value not exceeding 16  
characters.  
Format  
radius server key {auth | acct} {<ipaddr|dnsname>} encrypted  
<password>  
Mode  
Global Config  
Field  
Description  
ipaddr  
The IP address of the server.  
The DNS name of the server.  
The password in encrypted format.  
dnsname  
password  
The following shows an example of the CLI command.  
radius server key acct 10.240.4.10 encrypted <encrypt-string>  
radius server msgauth  
Use this command to enable the message authenticator attribute to be used for the specified  
RADIUS Authenticating server.  
Format  
Mode  
radius server msgauth <ipaddr|dnsname>  
Global Config  
Management Commands  
684  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Field  
Description  
ip addr  
The IP address of the server.  
The DNS name of the server.  
dnsname  
no radius server msgauth  
Use the noversion of this command to disable the message authenticator attribute to be  
used for the specified RADIUS Authenticating server.  
Format  
Mode  
no radius server msgauth <ipaddr|dnsname>  
Global Config  
radius server primary  
Use this command to designate a configured server as the primary server in the group of  
servers that have the same server name. Multiple primary servers can be configured for each  
number of servers that have the same name. When the RADIUS client has to perform  
transactions with an authenticating RADIUS server of specified name, the client uses the  
primary server that has the specified server name by default. If the RADIUS client fails to  
communicate with the primary server for any reason, the client uses the backup servers  
configured with the same server name. These backup servers are identified as the  
‘Secondary’ type.  
Format  
Mode  
radius server primary {<ipaddr|dnsname>}  
Global Config  
Field  
Description  
ip addr  
The IP address of the RADIUS Authenticating server.  
The DNS name of the server.  
dnsname  
radius server retransmit  
Use this command to configure the global parameter for the RADIUS client that specifies the  
number of transmissions of the messages to be made before attempting the fall back server  
upon unsuccessful communication with the current RADIUS authenticating server. When the  
maximum number of retries are exhausted for the RADIUS accounting server and no  
response is received, the client does not communicate with any other server.  
Default  
4
Format  
Mode  
radius server retransmit <retries>  
Global Config  
Management Commands  
685  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Field  
Description  
The maximum number of transmission attempts in the range of 1–15.  
retries  
no radius server retransmit  
Use this command to set the value of this global parameter to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no radius server retransmit  
Global Config  
radius server timeout  
Use this command to configure the global parameter for the RADIUS client that specifies the  
timeout value (in seconds) after which a request must be retransmitted to the RADIUS server  
if no response is received. The timeout value is an integer in the range of 1–30.  
Default  
5
Format  
Mode  
radius server timeout <seconds>  
Global Config  
Field  
Description  
retries  
Maximum number of transmission attempts in the range <1-30>.  
no radius server timeout  
Use this command to set the timeout global parameter to the default value.  
Format  
Mode  
no radius server timeout  
Global Config  
show radius  
Use this command to display the values configured for the global parameters of the RADIUS  
client.  
Format  
Mode  
show radius  
Privileged EXEC  
Management Commands  
686  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Number of Configured  
Authentication Servers  
The number of RADIUS Authentication servers that have been configured.  
The number of RADIUS Accounting servers that have been configured.  
The number of configured named RADIUS server groups.  
Number of Configured  
Accounting Servers  
Number of Named  
Authentication Server  
Groups  
Number of Named  
Accounting Server  
Groups  
The number of configured named RADIUS server groups.  
Number of Retransmits  
The configured value of the maximum number of times a request packet is  
retransmitted.  
Time Duration  
The configured timeout value, in seconds, for request retransmissions.  
RADIUS Accounting  
Mode  
A global parameter to indicate whether the accounting mode for all the servers  
is enabled or not.  
RADIUS Attribute 4 Mode  
RADIUS Attribute 4 Value  
A global parameter to indicate whether the NAS-IP-Address attribute has been  
enabled to use in RADIUS requests.  
A global parameter that specifies the IP address to be used in the  
NAS-IP-Address attribute to be used in RADIUS requests.  
The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(Switch)#show radius  
Number of Configured Authentication Servers............. 32  
Number of Configured Accounting Servers................. 32  
Number of Named Authentication Server Groups............ 15  
Number of Named Accounting Server Groups................ 3  
Number of Retransmits................................... 4  
Time Duration........................................... 10  
RADIUS Accounting Mode.................................. Disable  
RADIUS Attribute 4 Mode................................. Enable  
RADIUS Attribute 4 Value ............................... 192.168.37.60  
show radius servers  
Use this command to display the summary and details of RADIUS authenticating servers  
configured for the RADIUS client.  
Format  
Mode  
show radius servers [ { <ipaddr | dnsname> | name [<servername> ] } ]  
Privileged EXEC  
Management Commands  
687  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Field  
Description  
ipaddr  
The IP address of the authenticating server.  
The DNS name of the authenticating server.  
The alias name to identify the server.  
dnsname  
servername  
Current  
The ‘*’ symbol preceeding the server host address specifies that the server is  
currently active.  
Host Address  
Server Name  
Port  
The IP address of the host.  
The name of the authenticating server.  
The port used for communication with the authenticating server.  
Specifies whether this server is a primary or secondary type.  
The IP address of the currently active authenticating server.  
Type  
Current Host Address  
Secret Configured  
Yes or No Boolean value that indicates whether this server is configured with a  
secret.  
Number of  
Retransmits  
The configured value of the maximum number of times a request packet is  
retransmitted.  
Message  
Authenticator  
A global parameter to indicate whether the Message Authenticator attribute is  
enabled or disabled.  
Time Duration  
The configured timeout value, in seconds, for request retransmissions.  
RADIUS Accounting  
Mode  
A global parameter to indicate whether the accounting mode for all the servers is  
enabled or not.  
RADIUS Attribute 4  
Mode  
A global parameter to indicate whether the NAS-IP-Address attribute has been  
enabled to use in RADIUS requests.  
RADIUS Attribute 4  
Value  
A global parameter that specifies the IP address to be used in NAS-IP-Address  
attribute used in RADIUS requests.  
The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(Switch) #show radius servers  
Cur Host Address  
rent  
Server Name  
Port Type  
---- ------------------------ --------------------------------- ----- ----------  
* 192.168.37.200  
192.168.37.201  
192.168.37.202  
192.168.37.203  
Network1_RADIUS_Server  
Network2_RADIUS_Server  
Network3_RADIUS_Server  
Network4_RADIUS_Server  
1813 Primary  
1813 Secondary  
1813 Primary  
1813 Secondary  
(Switch) #show radius servers name  
Current Host Address  
Server Name  
Type  
-------------------------------------------------------------------192.168.37.200  
Network1_RADIUS_Server  
Secondary  
Management Commands  
688  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
192.168.37.201  
192.168.37.202  
192.168.37.203  
Network2_RADIUS_Server  
Network3_RADIUS_Server  
Network4_RADIUS_Server  
Primary  
Secondary  
Primary  
(Switch) #show radius servers name Default_RADIUS_Server  
Server Name............................ Default_RADIUS_Server  
Host Address........................... 192.168.37.58  
Secret Configured...................... No  
Message Authenticator ................. Enable  
Number of Retransmits.................. 4  
Time Duration.......................... 10  
RADIUS Accounting Mode................. Disable  
RADIUS Attribute 4 Mode................ Enable  
RADIUS Attribute 4 Value .............. 192.168.37.60  
(Switch) #show radius servers 192.168.37.58  
Server Name............................ Default_RADIUS_Server  
Host Address........................... 192.168.37.58  
Secret Configured...................... No  
Message Authenticator ................. Enable  
Number of Retransmits.................. 4  
Time Duration.......................... 10  
RADIUS Accounting Mode................. Disable  
RADIUS Attribute 4 Mode................ Enable  
RADIUS Attribute 4 Value .............. 192.168.37.60  
show radius accounting  
Use this command to display a summary of configured RADIUS accounting servers.  
Format  
Mode  
show radius accounting name [<servername>]  
Privileged EXEC  
Field  
Description  
servername  
An alias name to identify the server.  
RADIUS Accounting  
Mode  
A global parameter to indicate whether the accounting mode for all the servers is  
enabled or not.  
If you do not specify any parameters, only the accounting mode and the RADIUS accounting  
server details are displayed.  
Term  
Definition  
Host Address  
Server Name  
The IP address of the host.  
The name of the accounting server.  
Management Commands  
689  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Port  
Definition  
The port used for communication with the accounting server.  
Secret Configured  
Yes or No Boolean value indicating whether this server is configured with a  
secret.  
The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(Switch) #show radius accounting name  
Host Address  
Server Name  
Port  
Secret  
Configured  
----------------------- --------------------------------- -------- -----------  
192.168.37.200  
192.168.37.201  
192.168.37.202  
192.168.37.203  
Network1_RADIUS_Server  
Network2_RADIUS_Server  
Network3_RADIUS_Server  
Network4_RADIUS_Server  
1813  
1813  
1813  
1813  
Yes  
No  
Yes  
No  
(Switch) #show radius accounting name Default_RADIUS_Server  
Server Name............................ Default_RADIUS_Server  
Host Address........................... 192.168.37.200  
RADIUS Accounting Mode................. Disable  
Port .................................. 1813  
Secret Configured ..................... Yes  
show radius accounting statistics  
Use this command to display a summary of statistics for the configured RADIUS accounting  
servers.  
Format  
show radius accounting statistics {<ipaddr|dnsname> | name  
<servername>}  
Mode  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
ipaddr  
The IP address of the server.  
The DNS name of the server.  
The alias name to identify the server.  
The name of the accounting server.  
dnsname  
servername  
RADIUS  
Accounting Server  
Name  
Server Host  
Address  
The IP address of the host.  
Management Commands  
690  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Round Trip Time  
The time interval, in hundredths of a second, between the most recent  
Accounting-Response and the Accounting-Request that matched it from this  
RADIUS accounting server.  
Requests  
The number of RADIUS Accounting-Request packets sent to this server. This  
number does not include retransmissions.  
Retransmission  
Responses  
The number of RADIUS Accounting-Request packets retransmitted to this RADIUS  
accounting server.  
The number of RADIUS packets received on the accounting port from this server.  
Malformed  
Responses  
The number of malformed RADIUS Accounting-Response packets received from this  
server. Malformed packets include packets with an invalid length. Bad authenticators  
or signature attributes or unknown types are not included as malformed accounting  
responses.  
Bad Authenticators  
Pending Requests  
The number of RADIUS Accounting-Response packets containing invalid  
authenticators received from this accounting server.  
The number of RADIUS Accounting-Request packets sent to this server that have  
not yet timed out or received a response.  
Timeouts  
The number of accounting timeouts to this server.  
Unknown Types  
The number of RADIUS packets of unknown types, which were received from this  
server on the accounting port.  
Packets Dropped  
The number of RADIUS packets received from this server on the accounting port and  
dropped for some other reason.  
The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(Switch) #show radius accounting statistics 192.168.37.200  
RADIUS Accounting Server Name................. Default_RADIUS_Server  
Host Address.................................. 192.168.37.200  
Round Trip Time............................... 0.00  
Requests...................................... 0  
Retransmissions............................... 0  
Responses..................................... 0  
Malformed Responses........................... 0  
Bad Authenticators............................ 0  
Pending Requests.............................. 0  
Timeouts...................................... 0  
Unknown Types................................. 0  
Packets Dropped............................... 0  
(Switch) #show radius accounting statistics name Default_RADIUS_Server  
RADIUS Accounting Server Name................. Default_RADIUS_Server  
Host Address.................................. 192.168.37.200  
Round Trip Time............................... 0.00  
Requests...................................... 0  
Retransmissions............................... 0  
Responses..................................... 0  
Management Commands  
691  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Malformed Responses........................... 0  
Bad Authenticators............................ 0  
Pending Requests.............................. 0  
Timeouts...................................... 0  
Unknown Types................................. 0  
Packets Dropped............................... 0  
show radius statistics  
Use this command to display the summary statistics of configured RADIUS Authenticating  
servers.  
Format  
Mode  
show radius statistics {<ipaddr|dnsname> | name <servername>}  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
ipaddr  
The IP address of the server.  
The DNS name of the server.  
The alias name to identify the server.  
dnsname  
servername  
RADIUS Server Name  
Server Host Address  
Access Requests  
The name of the authenticating server.  
The IP address of the host.  
The number of RADIUS Access-Request packets sent to this server. This number  
does not include retransmissions.  
Access  
Retransmissions  
The number of RADIUS Access-Request packets retransmitted to this RADIUS  
authentication server.  
Access Accepts  
Access Rejects  
Access Challenges  
The number of RADIUS Access-Accept packets, including both valid and invalid  
packets, that were received from this server.  
The number of RADIUS Access-Reject packets, including both valid and invalid  
packets, that were received from this server.  
The number of RADIUS Access-Challenge packets, including both valid and  
invalid packets, that were received from this server.  
Malformed Access  
Responses  
The number of malformed RADIUS Access-Response packets received from this  
server. Malformed packets include packets with an invalid length. Bad  
authenticators or signature attributes or unknown types are not included as  
malformed access responses.  
Bad Authenticators  
Pending Requests  
Timeouts  
The number of RADIUS Access-Response packets containing invalid  
authenticators or signature attributes received from this server.  
The number of RADIUS Access-Request packets destined for this server that have  
not yet timed out or received a response.  
The number of authentication timeouts to this server.  
Management Commands  
692  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Definition  
Unknown Types  
The number of packets of unknown type that were received from this server on the  
authentication port.  
Packets Dropped  
The number of RADIUS packets received from this server on the authentication  
port and dropped for some other reason.  
The following shows example CLI display output for the command.  
(Switch) #show radius statistics 192.168.37.200  
RADIUS Server Name............................ Default_RADIUS_Server  
Server Host Address........................... 192.168.37.200  
Access Requests............................... 0.00  
Access Retransmissions........................ 0  
Access Accepts................................ 0  
Access Rejects................................ 0  
Access Challenges............................. 0  
Malformed Access Responses.................... 0  
Bad Authenticators............................ 0  
Pending Requests.............................. 0  
Timeouts...................................... 0  
Unknown Types................................. 0  
Packets Dropped............................... 0  
(Switch) #show radius statistics name Default_RADIUS_Server  
RADIUS Server Name............................ Default_RADIUS_Server  
Server Host Address........................... 192.168.37.200  
Access Requests............................... 0.00  
Access Retransmissions........................ 0  
Access Accepts................................ 0  
Access Rejects................................ 0  
Access Challenges............................. 0  
Malformed Access Responses.................... 0  
Bad Authenticators............................ 0  
Pending Requests.............................. 0  
Timeouts...................................... 0  
Unknown Types................................. 0  
Packets Dropped............................... 0  
TACACS+ Commands  
TACACS+ provides access control for networked devices via one or more centralized  
servers. Similar to RADIUS, this protocol simplifies authentication by making use of a single  
database that can be shared by many clients on a large network. TACACS+ is based on the  
TACACS protocol (described in RFC1492) but additionally provides for separate  
authentication, authorization, and accounting services. The original protocol was UDP based  
with messages passed in clear text over the network; TACACS+ uses TCP to ensure reliable  
delivery and a shared key configured on the client and daemon server to encrypt all  
messages.  
Management Commands  
693  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
debug tacacs packet  
Use the debug tacacs packetcommand to turn on TACACS+ packet debug.  
Default  
Disabled  
Format  
Mode  
debug tacacs packet [receive | transmit]  
Global Config  
no debug tacacs packet  
Use this command to turn off TACACS+ packet debug.  
Format  
Mode  
no debug tacacs packet  
Global Config  
tacacs-server host  
Use the tacacs-server hostcommand in Global Configuration mode to configure a  
TACACS+ server. This command enters into the TACACS+ configuration mode. The  
<ip-address|hostname>parameter is the IP address or hostname of the TACACS+  
server. To specify multiple hosts, multiple tacacs-server hostcommands can be used.  
Format  
Mode  
tacacs-server host <ip-address|hostname>  
Global Config  
no tacacs-server host  
Use the no tacacs-server hostcommand to delete the specified hostname or IP  
address. The <ip-address|hostname>parameter is the IP address of the TACACS+  
server.  
Format  
Mode  
no tacacs-server host <ip-address|hostname>  
Global Config  
tacacs-server key  
Use the tacacs-server keycommand to set the authentication and encryption key for all  
TACACS+ communications between the switch and the TACACS+ daemon. The  
<key-string>parameter has a range of 0–128 characters and specifies the authentication  
and encryption key for all TACACS communications between the switch and the TACACS+  
server. This key must match the key used on the TACACS+ daemon.  
Text-based configuration supports TACACS server’s secrets in encrypted and non-encrypted  
format. When you save the configuration, these secret keys are stored in encrypted format  
only. If you want to enter the key in encrypted format, enter the key along with the encrypted  
Management Commands  
694  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
keyword. In the show running config command’s display, these secret keys are displayed in  
encrypted format. You cannot show these keys in plain text format.  
Format  
Mode  
tacacs-server key[<key-string> | encrypted <key-string>]  
Global Config  
no tacacs-server key  
Use the no tacacs-server keycommand to disable the authentication and encryption  
key for all TACACS+ communications between the switch and the TACACS+ daemon. The  
<key-string>parameter has a range of 0–128 characters This key must match the key  
used on the TACACS+ daemon.  
Format  
Mode  
no tacacs-server key<key-string>  
Global Config  
tacacs-server keystring  
Use this command to set the global authentication encryption key used for all TACACS+  
communications between the TACACS+ server and the client.  
Format  
tacacs-server keystring  
Mode  
Global Config  
tacacs-server source interface  
Use this command in Global Configuration mode to configure the global source interface  
(Source IP selection) for all TACACS+ communications between the TACACS+ client and  
the server.  
Format  
tacacs-server source-interface {<slot/port> | loopback  
<loopback-id> | VLAN <vlan-id>}  
Mode  
Global Config  
Parameter  
slot/port  
Description  
The unit identifier assigned to the switch.  
The loopback interface. The range of the loopback ID is 0–7.  
The vlan id. The range of the vlan ID is 1–4,093.  
loopback-id  
vlan-id  
Management Commands  
695  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no tacacs-server source interface  
Use this command in Global Configuration mode to remove the global source interface  
(Source IP selection) for all TACACS+ communications between the TACACS+ client and  
the server.  
Format  
Mode  
no tacacs-server source-interface  
Privileged Exec  
tacacs-server timeout  
Use the tacacs-server timeoutcommand to set the timeout value for communication  
with the TACACS+ servers. The <timeout>parameter has a range of 1-30 and is the  
timeout value in seconds.  
Default  
5
Format  
Mode  
tacacs-server timeout <timeout>  
Global Config  
no tacacs-server timeout  
Use the no tacacs-server timeoutcommand to restore the default timeout value for all  
TACACS servers.  
Format  
Mode  
no tacacs-server timeout  
Global Config  
key  
Use the keycommand in TACACS Configuration mode to specify the authentication and  
encryption key for all TACACS communications between the device and the TACACS server.  
This key must match the key used on the TACACS daemon. The <key-string>parameter  
specifies the key name. For an empty string use “ ”. (Range: 0 - 128 characters).  
Text-based configuration supports TACACS server’s secrets in encrypted and non-encrypted  
format. When you save the configuration, these secret keys are stored in encrypted format  
only. If you want to enter the key in encrypted format, enter the key along with the encrypted  
keyword. In the show running config command’s display, these secret keys are displayed in  
encrypted format. You cannot show these keys in plain text format.  
Format  
Mode  
key[<key-string> | encrypted <key-string>]  
TACACS Config  
Management Commands  
696  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
port  
Use the portcommand in TACACS Configuration mode to specify a server port number.  
The server <port-number>range is 0 - 65535.  
Default  
49  
Format  
Mode  
port<port-number>  
TACACS Config  
priority  
Use the prioritycommand in TACACS Configuration mode to specify the order in which  
servers are used, where 0 (zero) is the highest priority. The <priority>parameter  
specifies the priority for servers. The highest priority is 0 (zero), and the range is 0 - 65535.  
Default  
0
Format  
Mode  
priority <priority>  
TACACS Config  
timeout  
Use the timeoutcommand in TACACS Configuration mode to specify the timeout value in  
seconds. If no timeout value is specified, the global value is used. The <timeout>  
parameter has a range of 1-30 and is the timeout value in seconds.  
Format  
Mode  
timeout<timeout>  
TACACS Config  
show tacacs  
Use the show tacacscommand to display the configuration and statistics of a TACACS+  
server.  
Format  
show tacacs [<ip-address|hostname>]  
Mode  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Host Address  
The IP address or hostname of the configured TACACS+ server.  
Port  
The configured TACACS+ server port number.  
TimeOut  
Priority  
The timeout in seconds for establishing a TCP connection.  
The preference order in which TACACS+ servers are contacted. If a server  
connection fails, the next highest priority server is contacted.  
Management Commands  
697  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Configuration Scripting Commands  
Configuration Scripting allows you to generate text-formatted script files representing the  
current configuration of a system. You can upload these configuration script files to a  
computer or UNIX system and edit them. Then, you can download the edited files to the  
system and apply the new configuration. You can apply configuration scripts to one or more  
switches with no or minor modifications.  
Use the show running-configcommand (see show running-config on page 530) to  
capture the running configuration into a script. Use the copycommand (see copy on  
page 553) to transfer the configuration script to or from the switch.  
You should use scripts on systems with default configuration; however, you are not prevented  
from applying scripts on systems with non-default configurations.  
Scripts must conform to the following rules:  
Script files are not distributed across the stack, and only live in the unit that is the master  
unit at the time of the file download.  
The file extension must be “.scr”.  
A maximum of ten scripts are allowed on the switch.  
The combined size of all script files on the switch shall not exceed 2048 KB.  
The maximum number of configuration file command lines is 2000.  
You can type single-line annotations at the command prompt to use when you write test or  
configuration scripts to improve script readability. The exclamation point (!) character flags  
the beginning of a comment. The comment flag character can begin a word anywhere on the  
command line, and all input following this character is ignored. Any command line that begins  
with the “!” character is recognized as a comment line and ignored by the parser.  
The following lines show an example of a script:  
! Script file for displaying management access  
show telnet !Displays the information about remote connections  
! Display information about direct connections  
show serial  
! End of the script file!  
Note: To specify a blank password for a user in the configuration script,  
you must specify it as a space within quotes. For example, to  
change the password for user janefrom a blank password to  
hello, the script entry is as follows:  
users passwd jane  
Management Commands  
698  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
" "  
hello  
hello  
script apply  
Use this command to apply the commands in the script to the switch. The <scriptname>  
parameter is the name of the script to apply.  
Format  
Mode  
script apply<scriptname>  
Privileged EXEC  
script delete  
Use this command to delete a specified script, where the <scriptname>parameter is the  
name of the script to delete. The <all>option deletes all the scripts present on the switch.  
Format  
script delete{<scriptname> | all}  
Mode  
Privileged EXEC  
script list  
Use this command to list all scripts present on the switch as well as the remaining available  
space.  
Format  
script list  
Mode  
Global Config  
Term  
Definition  
Configuration Script  
Size  
Name of the script.  
Privileged EXEC  
script show  
Use this command to display the contents of a script file, which is named <scriptname>.  
Format  
script show<scriptname>  
Mode  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
Output Format  
line<number>: <line contents>  
Management Commands  
699  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
script validate  
Use this command to validate a script file by parsing each line in the script file, where  
<scriptname>is the name of the script to validate. The validate option is intended to be  
used as a tool for script development. Validation identifies potential problems. It might not  
identify all problems with a given script on any given device.  
Format  
Mode  
script validate<scriptname>  
Privileged EXEC  
Pre-Login Banner and System Prompt Commands  
This section describes the commands you use to configure the pre-login banner and the  
system prompt. The pre-login banner is the text that displays before you login at the User:  
prompt.  
copy (pre-login banner)  
Use a copycommand option to upload or download the CLI Banner to or from the switch.  
You can specify local URLs by using TFTP, Xmodem, Ymodem, or Zmodem.  
Note: <ip6address> is also a valid parameter for routing packages that  
support IPv6.  
Format  
Mode  
copy <url> nvram:clibanner  
copy nvram:clibanner <url>  
Privileged EXEC  
set prompt  
Use this command to change the name of the prompt. The length of name might be up to 64  
alphanumeric characters.  
Format  
Mode  
set prompt <prompt_string>  
Privileged EXEC  
Management Commands  
700  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
       
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
set clibanner  
Use this command to add the CLI Banner. The banner message supports up to 2000  
characters.  
Format  
Mode  
set clibanner <line>  
Global Config  
no set clibanner  
Use this command to remove the CLI Banner downloaded through TFTP.  
Format  
Mode  
no set clibanner  
Global Config  
Switch Database Management (SDM) Templates  
You can use SDM templates to configure system resources in the switch and optimize  
support for specific features depending on how the switch is used in the network. You can  
select a template to provide the maximum system usage for a specific function. For example,  
you could use a routing template to optimize resources for IPv4 routing if the network  
environment does not use IPv6 routing.  
Note the following:  
If you configure an SDM template, you must reload the switch for the configuration to take  
effect.  
If you try to configure IPv6 routing without first selecting the dual IPv4-IPv6 routing  
template, a warning message appears.  
sdm prefer  
Use this command to specify the SDM template to use on the switch.  
Default  
Format  
ipv4-routing for IPv4 only builds, dual-ipv4-ipv6 for IPv6 builds  
sdm prefer {ipv4-routing {default | data-center} | dual-ipv4-and-ipv6  
{default}}  
Mode  
Global Config  
Management Commands  
701  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Parameter  
Description  
ipv4-routing  
Supports IPv4 routing only.  
-data-center: Support more ECMP next hops in IPv4 routes.  
-default: The routing template maximizes system resources for unicast routing,  
typically required for a router in the center of a network.  
dual-ipv4-and-ipv  
6
Supports both IPv4 and IPv6 routing.  
This option is visible only when the switch supports IPv6 and IPv4 routing.  
-default: Balance IPv4 and IPv6 Layer 2 and Layer 3 functionality.  
no sdm prefer  
Use this command to return to the default template.  
Format  
Mode  
no sdm prefer  
Global Config  
show sdm prefer  
Use this command to view the currently active SDM template and its scaling parameters, or  
to view the scaling parameters for an inactive template. When used with no optional  
keywords, this command lists the currently active template and the template that will become  
active on the next reboot, if it is different from the currently active template. If the system  
boots with a non-default template and you clear the template configuration either using no  
sdm preferor by deleting the startup configuration, show sdm preferlists the default  
template as the next active template.  
Use the optional keywords to list the scaling parameters of a specific template.  
Format  
Mode  
show sdm prefer [dual-ipv4-and-ipv6 default |  
ipv4-routing {default | data-center} ]  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Description  
ARP Entries  
The maximum number of entries in the IPv4 Address Resolution Protocol (ARP) cache  
for routing interfaces.  
IPv4 Unicast  
Routes  
The maximum number of IPv4 unicast forwarding table entries.  
IPv6 NDP Entries  
The maximum number of IPv6 Neighbor Discovery Protocol (NDP) cache entries.  
The maximum number of IPv6 unicast forwarding table entries.  
IPv6 Unicast  
Routes  
ECMP Next Hops  
The maximum number of next hops that can be installed in the IPv4 and IPv6 unicast  
forwarding tables.  
Management Commands  
702  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Description  
IPv4 Multicast  
Routes  
The maximum number of IPv4 multicast forwarding table entries.  
The maximum number of IPv6 multicast forwarding table entries.  
IPv6 Multicast  
Routes  
Example:  
#show sdm prefer  
Current template: Dual IPv4 and IPv6  
ARP Entries.................................... 4096  
IPv4 Unicast Routes............................ 6112  
IPv6 NDP Entries............................... 2048  
IPv6 Unicast Routes............................ 3072  
ECMP Next Hops................................. 4 I  
Pv4 Multicast Routes........................... 256  
IPv6 Multicast Routes.......................... 256  
IPv6 Management Commands  
IPv6 Management commands allow a device to be managed via an IPv6 address in a switch  
or IPv4 routing (that is, independent from the IPv6 Routing package). For Routing/IPv6 builds  
of Switch CLI dual IPv4/IPv6 operation over the service port is enabled. Switch CLI has  
capabilities such as:  
Static assignment of IPv6 addresses and gateways for the network ports.  
The ability to ping an IPv6 link-local address over the network port.  
Using IPv6 Management commands, you can send SNMP traps and queries via the  
network port.  
The user can manage a device via the network port (in addition to a routing interface).  
network ipv6 enable  
Use this command to enable IPv6 operation on the network port.  
Default  
enabled  
Format  
Mode  
network ipv6 enable  
Privileged EXEC  
no network ipv6 enable  
Use this command to disable IPv6 operation on the network port.  
Format  
Mode  
no network ipv6 enable  
Privileged EXEC  
Management Commands  
703  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
     
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
network ipv6 address  
Use this command to configure an IPv6 global address, enable or disable stateless global  
address autoconfiguration, and enable or disable dhcpv6 client protocol information for the  
network port. You can configure multiple IPv6 addresses on the network port.  
Format  
network ipv6 address {address/prefix-length [eui64] | autoconfig |  
dhcp}  
Mode  
Privileged EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
address  
IPv6 prefix in IPv6 global address format.  
IPv6 prefix length value.  
prefix-length  
eui64  
Formulate IPv6 address in eui64 format.  
Configure stateless global address autoconfiguration capability.  
Configure dhcpv6 client protocol.  
autoconfig  
dhcp  
no network ipv6 address  
Use this command to:  
Remove the manually configured IPv6 global address on the network port interface (with  
the addressoption).  
Disable the stateless global address autoconfiguration on the network port (with the  
autoconfigoption).  
Disable the dhcpv6 client protocol on the network port (with the dhcpoption).  
Format  
no network ipv6 address {address/prefix-length[eui64] | autoconfig  
| dhcp}  
Mode  
Privileged EXEC  
network ipv6 gateway  
Use this command to configure IPv6 gateway (default routers) information for the network  
port. The gateway address is in IPv6 global or link-local address format.  
Format  
Mode  
network ipv6 gateway <gateway-address>  
Privileged EXEC  
Management Commands  
704  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
no network ipv6 gateway  
Use this command to remove IPv6 gateways on the network port interface.  
Format  
Mode  
no network ipv6 gateway  
Privileged EXEC  
show network ndp  
Use this command to display NDP cache information for the network port.  
Default  
enabled  
Format  
Mode  
show network ndp  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Term  
Definition  
IPv6 Address  
The IPv6 address of the interface.  
MAC Address  
isRtr  
The MAC Address used.  
Specifies the router flag.  
Neighbor  
State  
The state of the neighbor cache entry. The possible values are: Reachable, Delay.  
Age Updated  
The time in seconds that has elapsed since an entry was added to the cache.  
The following shows sample CLI display output for the command:  
(switch) #show network ndp  
Neighbor  
State  
--------  
Reachable  
Delay  
Age  
IPv6 Address  
MAC Address  
isRtr  
-----  
Updated  
-------  
--------------------------  
3017::204:76FF:FE73:423A  
FE80::204:76FF:FE73:423A  
-----------------  
00:04:76:73:42:3a  
00:04:76:73:42:3a  
447535  
447540  
show network ipv6 dhcp statistics  
Use this command to display the statistics of the DHCPv6 client running on the network  
management interface.  
Format  
Mode  
show network ipv6 dhcp statistics  
• Privileged EXEC  
• User EXEC  
Management Commands  
705  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Term  
Description  
DHCPv6 Advertisement  
Packets Received  
The number of DHCPv6 Advertisement packets received on the network  
interface.  
DHCPv6 Reply Packets  
Received  
The number of DHCPv6 Reply packets received on the network interface.  
Received DHCPv6  
Advertisement Packets  
Discarded  
The number of DHCPv6 Advertisement packets discarded on the network  
interface.  
Received DHCPv6 Reply  
Packets Discarded  
The number of DHCPv6 Reply packets discarded on the network interface.  
DHCPv6 Malformed  
Packets Received  
The number of DHCPv6 packets that are received malformed on the network  
interface.  
Total DHCPv6 Packets  
Received  
The total number of DHCPv6 packets received on the network interface.  
The number of DHCPv6 Solicit packets transmitted on the network interface.  
The number of DHCPv6 Request packets transmitted on the network interface.  
The number of DHCPv6 Renew packets transmitted on the network interface.  
The number of DHCPv6 Rebind packets transmitted on the network interface.  
The number of DHCPv6 Release packets transmitted on the network interface.  
The total number of DHCPv6 packets transmitted on the network interface.  
DHCPv6 Solicit Packets  
Transmitted  
DHCPv6 Request  
Packets Transmitted  
DHCPv6 Renew Packets  
Transmitted  
DHCPv6 Rebind Packets  
Transmitted  
DHCPv6 Release  
Packets Transmitted  
Total DHCPv6 Packets  
Transmitted  
The following example shows CLI display output for the command:  
(switch)#show network ipv6 dhcp statistics  
DHCPv6 Client Statistics  
-------------------------  
DHCPv6 Advertisement Packets Received................. 0  
DHCPv6 Reply Packets Received......................... 0  
Received DHCPv6 Advertisement Packets Discarded....... 0  
Received DHCPv6 Reply Packets Discarded............... 0  
DHCPv6 Malformed Packets Received..................... 0  
Total DHCPv6 Packets Received......................... 0  
DHCPv6 Solicit Packets Transmitted.................... 0  
DHCPv6 Request Packets Transmitted.................... 0  
DHCPv6 Renew Packets Transmitted...................... 0  
DHCPv6 Rebind Packets Transmitted..................... 0  
DHCPv6 Release Packets Transmitted.................... 0  
Total DHCPv6 Packets Transmitted...................... 0  
Management Commands  
706  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
clear network ipv6 dhcp statistics  
Use this command to clear the DHCPv6 statistics on the network management interface.  
Format  
Mode  
clear network ipv6 dhcp statistics  
Privileged EXEC  
Management Commands  
707  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
12.  
Log Messages  
12  
This chapter lists common log messages, along with information regarding the cause of each  
message. There is no specific action that can be taken per message. When there is a  
problem being diagnosed, a set of these messages in the event log, along with an  
understanding of the system configuration and details of the problem will assist NETGEAR,  
Inc. in determining the root cause of such a problem.  
Note: This chapter does not contain a complete list of all syslog  
messages.  
This chapter contains the following sections:  
708  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Core  
Table 3. BSP Log Messages  
Component  
Message  
Cause  
BSP  
BSP  
Event(0xaaaaaaaa)  
Starting code...  
Switch has restarted.  
BSP initialization complete, starting 7000  
series application.  
Table 4. NIM Log Messages  
Component  
NIM  
Message  
Cause  
NIM: L7_ATTACH out of order for  
intIfNum(x) unit x slot x port x  
Interface creation out of order  
NIM  
NIM  
NIM  
NIM  
NIM: Failed to find interface at unit x slot x There is no mapping between the USP and  
port x for event(x)  
Interface number  
NIM: L7_DETACH out of order for  
intIfNum(x) unit x slot x port x  
Interface creation out of order  
NIM: L7_DELETE out of order for  
intIfNum(x) unit x slot x port x  
Interface creation out of order  
NIM: event(x),intf(x),component(x), in  
wrong phase  
An event was issued to NIM during the  
wrong configuration phase (probably Phase  
1, 2, or WMU)  
NIM  
NIM  
NIM  
NIM  
NIM  
NIM  
NIM  
NIM: Failed to notify users of interface  
change  
Event was not propagated to the system  
NIM message queue full or non-existent  
Interface not created  
NIM: failed to send message to NIM  
message Queue.  
NIM: Failed to notify the components of  
L7_CREATE event  
A component issued an interface event  
during the wrong initialization phase  
NIM: Attempted event (x), on USP x.x.x  
before phase 3  
NIM: incorrect phase for operation  
An API call was made during the wrong  
initialization phase  
NIM: Component(x) failed on event(x) for  
intIfNum(x)  
A component responded with a fail  
indication for an interface event  
NIM: Timeout event(x), intIfNum(x)  
remainingMask = “xxxx”  
A component did not respond before the  
NIM timeout occurred  
Log Messages  
709  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Table 5. System Log Messages  
Component  
SYSTEM  
Message  
Cause  
Configuration file Switch CLI.cfg size is 0  
(zero) bytes  
The configuration file could not be read.  
This message might occur on a system for  
which no configuration has ever been  
saved or for which configuration has been  
erased.  
SYSTEM  
could not separate  
SYSAPI_CONFIG_FILENAME  
The configuration file could not be read.  
This message might occur on a system for  
which no configuration has ever been  
saved or for which configuration has been  
erased.  
SYSTEM  
SYSTEM  
Building defaults for file <file name> version Configuration did not exist or could not be  
<version num>  
read for the specified feature or file.  
Default configuration values will be used.  
The file name and version are indicated.  
File <filename>: same version (version  
num) but the sizes (<version  
size>-><expected version size) differ  
The configuration file which was loaded  
was of a different size than expected for the  
version number. This message indicates  
the configuration file needed to be migrated  
to the version number appropriate for the  
code image. This message might appear  
after upgrading the code image to a more  
current release.  
SYSTEM  
Migrating config file <filename> from  
version <version num> to <version num>  
The configuration file identified was  
migrated from a previous version number.  
Both the old and new version number are  
specified. This message might appear after  
upgrading the code image to a more  
current release.  
SYSTEM  
SYSTEM  
Building Defaults  
Configuration did not exist or could not be  
read for the specified feature. Default  
configuration values will be used.  
sysapiCfgFileGet failed size = <expected  
Configuration did not exist or could not be  
size of file> version = <expected version> read for the specified feature. This  
message is usually followed by a message  
indicating that default configuration values  
will be used.  
Log Messages  
710  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Utilities  
Table 6. Trap Mgr Log Message  
Component  
Trap Mgr  
Message  
Cause  
Link Up/Down: slot/port  
An interface changed link state.  
Table 7. DHCP Filtering Log Messages  
Component  
Message  
Cause  
DHCP Filtering  
Unable to create r/w lock for DHCP  
Filtering  
Unable to create semaphore used for dhcp  
filtering configuration structure .  
DHCP Filtering  
DHCP Filtering  
DHCP Filtering  
Failed to register with nv Store.  
Unable to register save and restore  
functions for configuration save  
Failed to register with NIM  
Unable to register with NIM for interface  
callback functions  
Error on call to sysapiCfgFileWrite file  
Error on trying to save configuration .  
Table 8. NVStore Log Messages  
Component  
NVStore  
Message  
Cause  
Building defaults for file XXX  
A component’s configuration file does not  
exist or the file’s checksum is incorrect so  
the component’s default configuration file is  
built.  
NVStore  
NVStore  
NVStore  
Error on call to osapiFsWrite routine on file Either the file cannot be opened or the OS’s  
XXX  
file I/O returned an error trying to write to  
the file.  
File XXX corrupted from file system.  
Checksum mismatch.  
The calculated checksum of a component’s  
configuration file in the file system did not  
match the checksum of the file in memory.  
Migrating config file XXX from version Y to A configuration file version mismatch was  
Z
detected so a configuration file migration  
has started.  
Log Messages  
711  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Table 9. RADIUS Log Messages  
Component  
RADIUS  
Message  
Cause  
RADIUS: Invalid data length - xxx  
The RADIUS Client received an invalid  
message from the server.  
RADIUS  
RADIUS  
RADIUS  
RADIUS  
RADIUS  
RADIUS  
RADIUS  
RADIUS  
RADIUS  
RADIUS  
RADIUS  
RADIUS  
RADIUS  
RADIUS  
RADIUS  
RADIUS  
RADIUS: Failed to send the request  
A problem communicating with the  
RADIUS server.  
RADIUS: Failed to send all of the request A problem communicating with the  
RADIUS server during transmit.  
RADIUS: Could not get the Task Sync  
semaphore!  
Resource issue with RADIUS Client  
service.  
RADIUS: Buffer is too small for response  
processing  
RADIUS Client attempted to build a  
response larger than resources allow.  
RADIUS: Could not allocate accounting  
requestInfo  
Resource issue with RADIUS Client  
service.  
RADIUS: Could not allocate requestInfo  
Resource issue with RADIUS Client  
service.  
RADIUS: osapiSocketRecvFrom returned Error while attempting to read data from the  
error  
RADIUS server.  
RADIUS: Accounting-Response failed to  
validate, id=xxx  
The RADIUS Client received an invalid  
message from the server.  
RADIUS: User (xxx) needs to respond for An unexpected challenge was received for  
challenge a configured user.  
RADIUS: Could not allocate a buffer for the Resource issue with RADIUS Client  
packet  
service.  
RADIUS: Access-Challenge failed to  
validate, id=xxx  
The RADIUS Client received an invalid  
message from the server.  
RADIUS: Failed to validate  
Message-Authenticator, id=xxx  
The RADIUS Client received an invalid  
message from the server.  
RADIUS: Access-Accpet failed to validate, The RADIUS Client received an invalid  
id=xxx  
message from the server.  
RADIUS: Invalid packet length – xxx  
The RADIUS Client received an invalid  
message from the server.  
RADIUS: Response is missing  
Message-Authenticator, id=xxx  
The RADIUS Client received an invalid  
message from the server.  
RADIUS: Server address does not match  
configured server  
RADIUS Client received a server response  
from an unconfigured server.  
Log Messages  
712  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Table 10. TACACS+ Log Messages  
Component  
TACACS+  
Message  
Cause  
TACACS+: authentication error, no server TACACS+ request needed, but no servers  
to contact  
are configured.  
TACACS+  
TACACS+  
TACACS+  
TACACS+  
TACACS+  
TACACS+: connection failed to server  
x.x.x.x  
TACACS+ request sent to server x.x.x.x  
but no response was received.  
TACACS+: no key configured to encrypt  
packet for server x.x.x.x  
No key configured for the specified server.  
Received packet type that is not supported.  
Major version mismatch.  
TACACS+: received invalid packet type  
from server.  
TACACS+: invalid major version in  
received packet.  
TACACS+: invalid minor version in  
received packet.  
Minor version mismatch.  
Table 11. LLDP Log Message  
Component  
LLDP  
Message  
Cause  
lldpTask(): invalid message type:xx.  
xxxxxx:xx  
Unsupported LLDP packet received.  
Table 12. SNTP Log Message  
Component  
SNTP  
Message  
Cause  
SNTP: system clock synchronized on %s  
UTC  
Indicates that SNTP has successfully  
synchronized the time of the box with the  
server.  
Management  
Table 13. SNMP Log Message  
Component  
SNMP  
Message  
Cause  
EDB Callback: Unit Join: x.  
A new unit has joined the stack.  
Log Messages  
713  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Table 14. EmWeb Log Messages  
Component  
EmWeb  
Message  
Cause  
EMWEB (Telnet): Max number of Telnet  
login sessions exceeded  
A user attempted to connect via telnet  
when the maximum number of telnet  
sessions were already active.  
EmWeb  
EmWeb  
EMWEB (SSH): Max number of SSH login A user attempted to connect via SSH when  
sessions exceeded  
the maximum number of SSH sessions  
were already active.  
Handle table overflow  
All the available EmWeb connection  
handles are being used and the connection  
could not be made.  
EmWeb  
EmWeb  
EmWeb  
EmWeb  
EmWeb  
EmWeb  
EmWeb  
ConnectionType EmWeb socket accept()  
failed: errno  
Socket accept failure for the specified  
connection type.  
ewsNetHTTPReceive failure in  
NetReceiveLoop() - closing connection.  
Socket receive failure.  
EmWeb: connection allocation failed  
Memory allocation failure for the new  
connection.  
EMWEB TransmitPending :  
EWOULDBLOCK error sending data  
Socket error on send.  
ewaNetHTTPEnd: internal error - handle  
not in Handle table  
EmWeb handle index not valid.  
ewsNetHTTPReceive:recvBufCnt exceeds The receive buffer limit has been reached.  
MAX_QUEUED_RECV_BUFS!  
Bad request or DoS attack.  
EmWeb accept: XXXX  
Accept function for new SSH connection  
failed. XXXX indicates the error info.  
Table 15. CLI_UTIL Log Messages  
Component  
CLI_UTIL  
Message  
Cause  
Telnet Send Failed errno = 0x%x  
Failed to send text string to the  
telnet client.  
CLI_UTIL  
osapiFsDir failed  
Failed to obtain the directory  
information from a volume's  
directory.  
Log Messages  
714  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Table 16. WEB Log Messages  
Component  
WEB  
Message  
Cause  
Max clients exceeded  
This message is shown when the maximum  
allowed java client connections to the  
switch is exceeded.  
WEB  
WEB  
Error on send to sockfd XXXX, closing  
connection  
Failed to send data to the java clients  
through the socket.  
# (XXXX) Form Submission Failed. No  
Action Taken.  
The form submission failed and no action is  
taken. XXXX indicates the file under  
consideration.  
WEB  
ewaFormServe_file_download() - WEB  
Unknown return code from tftp download  
result  
Unknown error returned while downloading  
file using TFTP from web interface  
WEB  
WEB  
ewaFormServe_file_upload() - Unknown  
return code from tftp upload result  
Unknown error returned while uploading file  
using TFTP from web interface.  
Web UI Screen with unspecified access  
attempted to be brought up  
Failed to get application-specific  
authorization handle provided to  
EmWeb/Server by the application in  
ewsAuthRegister(). The specified web  
page will be served in read-only mode.  
Table 17. CLI_WEB_MGR Log Messages  
Component  
Message  
Cause  
CLI_WEB_MGR  
File size is greater than 2K  
The banner file size is greater than 2K  
bytes.  
CLI_WEB_MGR  
No. of rows greater than allowed maximum When the number of rows exceeds the  
of XXXX  
maximum allowed rows  
Table 18. SSHD Log Messages  
Component  
SSHD  
Message  
Cause  
SSHD: Unable to create the global (data)  
semaphore  
Failed to create semaphore for global data  
protection.  
SSHD  
SSHD: Msg Queue is full, event = XXXX  
Failed to send the message to the SSHD  
message queue as message queue is full.  
XXXX indicates the event to be sent  
Log Messages  
715  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Table 18. SSHD Log Messages  
Component  
SSHD  
Message  
Cause  
SSHD: Unknown UI event in message,  
event=XXXX  
Failed to dispatch the UI event to the  
appropriate SSHD function as it’s an invalid  
event. XXXX indicates the event to be  
dispatched.  
SSHD  
sshdApiCnfgrCommand: Failed calling  
sshdIssueCmd.  
Failed to send the message to the SSHD  
message queue  
Table 19. SSLT Log Messages  
Component  
SSLT  
Message  
Cause  
SSLT: Exceeded maximum,  
ssltConnectionTask  
Exceeded maximum allowed SSLT  
connections.  
SSLT  
SSLT  
SSLT: Error creating Secure server socket6 Failed to create secure server socket for  
IPV6.  
SSLT: Can't connect to unsecure server at Failed to open connection to unsecure  
XXXX, result = YYYY, errno = ZZZZ  
server. XXXX is the unsecure server socket  
address. YYYY is the result returned from  
connect function and ZZZZ is the error  
code.  
SSLT  
SSLT  
SSLT: Msg Queue is full, event=XXXX  
Failed to send the received message to the  
SSLT message queue as message queue  
is full. XXXX indicates the event to be sent.  
SSLT: Unknown UI event in message,  
event=XXXX  
Failed to dispatch the received UI event to  
the appropriate SSLT function as it’s an  
invalid event. XXXX indicates the event to  
be dispatched.  
SSLT  
SSLT  
ssltApiCnfgrCommand: Failed calling  
ssltIssueCmd.  
Failed to send the message to the SSLT  
message queue.  
SSLT: Error loading certificate from file  
XXXX  
Failed while loading the SSLcertificate from  
specified file. XXXX indicates the file from  
where the certificate is being read.  
SSLT  
SSLT  
SSLT  
SSLT: Error loading private key from file  
Failed while loading private key for SSL  
connection.  
SSLT: Error setting cipher list (no valid  
ciphers)  
Failed while setting cipher list.  
SSLT: Could not delete the SSL  
semaphores  
Failed to delete SSL semaphores during  
cleanup.of all resources associated with  
the OpenSSL Locking semaphores.  
Log Messages  
716  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Table 20. User_Manager Log Messages  
Component  
Message  
Cause  
User_Manager  
User Login Failed for XXXX  
Failed to authenticate user login. XXXX  
indicates the user name to be  
authenticated.  
User_Manager  
User_Manager  
Access level for user XXXX could not be  
determined. Setting to READ_ONLY.  
Invalid access level specified for the user.  
The access level is set to READ_ONLY.  
XXXX indicates the user name.  
Could not migrate config file XXXX from  
version YYYY to ZZZZ. Using defaults.  
Failed to migrate the config file. XXXX is  
the config file name. YYYY is the old  
version number and ZZZZ is the new  
version number.  
Switching  
Table 21. Protected Ports Log Messages  
Component  
Message  
Cause  
Protected Ports  
Protected Port: failed to save configuration Appears when the protected port  
configuration cannot be saved  
Protected Ports  
Protected Ports  
protectedPortCnfgrInitPhase1Process:  
Unable to create r/w lock for protectedPort Fails  
Appears when protectedPortCfgRWLock  
protectedPortCnfgrInitPhase2Process:  
Unable to register for VLAN change  
callback  
Appears when nimRegisterIntfChange with  
VLAN fails  
Protected Ports  
Protected Ports  
Protected Ports  
Protected Ports  
Protected Ports  
Cannot add intIfNum xxx to group yyy  
Appears when an interface could not be  
added to a particular group.  
Unable to set protected port group  
Appears when a dtl call fails to add  
interface mask at the driver level  
Cannot delete intIfNum xxx from group yyy Appears when a dtl call to delete an  
interface from a group fails  
Cannot update group YYY after deleting  
interface XXX  
This message appears when an update  
group for an interface deletion fails  
Received an interface change callback  
while not ready to receive it  
Appears when an interface change  
callback has come before the protected  
port component is ready.  
Log Messages  
717  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Table 22. IP Subnet VLANS Log Messages  
Component  
Message  
Cause  
IPsubnet vlans  
ERROR vlanIpSubnetSubnetValid :Invalid Occurs when an invalid pair of subnet and  
subnet  
netmask has come from the CLI  
IPsubnet vlans  
IPsubnet vlans  
IPsubnet vlans  
IP Subnet Vlans: failed to save  
configuration  
This message appears when save  
configuration of subnet vlans failed  
vlanIpSubnetCnfgrInitPhase1Process:  
Unable to create r/w lock for vlanIpSubnet fails  
Appears when a read/write lock creations  
vlanIpSubnetCnfgrInitPhase2Process:  
Unable to register for VLAN change  
callback  
Appears when this component unable to  
register for VLAN change notifications  
IPsubnet vlans  
IPsubnet vlans  
IPsubnet vlans  
IPsubnet vlans  
IPsubnet vlans  
vlanIpSubnetCnfgrFiniPhase1Process:  
could not delete avl semaphore  
Appears when a semaphore deletion of this  
component fails.  
vlanIpSubnetDtlVlanCreate: Failed  
Appears when a dtl call fails to add an entry  
into the table  
vlanIpSubnetSubnetDeleteApply: Failed  
Appears when a dtl fails to delete an entry  
from the table  
vlanIpSubnetVlanChangeCallback: Failed Appears when a dtl fails to add an entry for  
to add an Entry a VLAN add notify event.  
vlanIpSubnetVlanChangeCallback: Failed Appears when a dtl fails to delete an entry  
to delete an Entry  
for a VLAN delete notify event.  
Table 23. Mac-based VLANs Log Messages  
Component  
Message  
Cause  
Mac based  
VLANS  
MAC VLANs: Failed to save configuration This message appears when save  
configuration of Mac VLANs failed  
Mac based  
VLANS  
vlanMacCnfgrInitPhase1Process: Unable  
to create r/w lock for vlanMac  
Appears when a read/write lock creations  
fails  
Mac based  
VLANS  
Unable to register for VLAN change  
callback  
Appears when this component unable to  
register for VLAN change notifications  
Mac based  
VLANS  
vlanMacCnfgrFiniPhase1Process: could  
not delete avl semaphore  
Appears when a semaphore deletion of this  
component fails.  
Mac based  
VLANS  
vlanMacAddApply: Failed to add an entry  
Appears when a dtl call fails to add an entry  
into the table  
Mac based  
VLANS  
vlanMacDeleteApply: Unable to delete an Appears when a dtl fails to delete an entry  
Entry from the table  
Log Messages  
718  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Table 23. Mac-based VLANs Log Messages  
Component  
Message  
Cause  
Mac based  
VLANS  
vlanMacVlanChangeCallback: Failed to  
add an entry  
Appears when a dtl fails to add an entry for  
a VLAN add notify event.  
Mac based  
VLANS  
vlanMacVlanChangeCallback: Failed to  
delete an entry  
Appears when a dtl fails to delete an entry  
for an VLAN delete notify event.  
Table 24. 802.1x Log Messages  
Component  
802.1X  
Message  
Cause  
function: Failed calling dot1xIssueCmd  
802.1X message queue is full  
802.1X  
802.1X  
802.1X  
802.1X  
802.1X  
802.1X  
802.1X  
function: EAP message not received from RADIUS server did not send required EAP  
server  
message  
function: Out of System buffers  
802.1X cannot process/transmit message  
due to lack of internal buffers  
function: could not set state to  
<authorized/unauthorized>, intf xxx  
DTL call failed setting authorization state of  
the port  
dot1xApplyConfigData: Unable to  
<enable/disable> dot1x in driver  
DTL call failed enabling/disabling 802.1X  
dot1xSendRespToServer:  
Failed sending message to RADIUS server  
dot1xRadiusAccessRequestSend failed  
dot1xRadiusAcceptProcess: error calling  
radiusAccountingStart, ifIndex=xxx  
Failed sending accounting start to RADIUS  
server  
function: failed sending terminate cause,  
intf xxx  
Failed sending accounting stop to RADIUS  
server  
Table 25. IGMP Snooping Log Messages  
Component  
Message  
Cause  
IGMP Snooping  
function: osapiMessageSend failed  
IGMP Snooping message queue is full  
IGMP Snooping  
IGMP Snooping  
IGMP Snooping  
Failed to set global igmp snooping mode to Failed to set global IGMP Snooping mode  
xxx  
due to message queue being full  
Failed to set igmp snooping mode xxx for  
interface yyy  
Failed to set interface IGMP Snooping  
mode due to message queue being full  
Failed to set igmp mrouter mode xxx for  
interface yyy  
Failed to set interface multicast router  
mode due to IGMP Snooping message  
queue being full  
IGMP Snooping  
Failed to set igmp snooping mode xxx for  
VLAN yyy  
Failed to set VLAN IGM Snooping mode  
due to message queue being full  
Log Messages  
719  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Table 25. IGMP Snooping Log Messages  
Component  
Message  
Cause  
IGMP Snooping  
Failed to set igmp mrouter mode %d for  
interface xxx on VLAN yyy  
Failed to set VLAN multicast router mode  
due to IGMP Snooping message queue  
being full  
IGMP Snooping  
IGMP Snooping  
snoopCnfgrInitPhase1Process: Error  
allocating small buffers  
Could not allocate buffers for small IGMP  
packets  
snoopCnfgrInitPhase1Process: Error  
allocating large buffers  
Could not allocate buffers for large IGMP  
packets  
Table 26. GARP/GVRP/GMRP Log Messages  
Component  
Message  
Cause  
GARP/GVRP/  
GMRP  
garpSpanState, garpIfStateChange,  
GarpIssueCmd,  
The garpQueue is full, logs specifics of the  
message content like internal interface  
number, type of message, and so on.  
garpDot1sChangeCallBack,  
garpApiCnfgrCommand,  
garpLeaveAllTimerCallback,  
garpTimerCallback: QUEUE SEND  
FAILURE:  
GARP/GVRP/  
GMRP  
GarpSendPDU: QUEUE SEND FAILURE  
The garpPduQueue is full, logs specific of  
the GPDU, internal interface number, VLAN  
id, buffer handle, and so on.  
GARP/GVRP/  
GMRP  
garpMapIntfIsConfigurable,  
gmrpMapIntfIsConfigurable: Error  
accessing GARP/GMRP config data for  
A default configuration does not exist for  
this interface. Typically a case when a new  
interface is created and has no  
interface %d in garpMapIntfIsConfigurable. pre-configuration.  
GARP/GVRP/  
GMRP  
garpTraceMsgQueueUsage: garpQueue  
usage has exceeded fifty/eighty/ninety  
percent  
Traces the buildup of message queue.  
Helpful in determining the load on GARP.  
GARP/GVRP/  
GMRP  
gid_destroy_port: Error Removing port %d Mismatch between the gmd (gmrp  
registration for vlan-mac %d -  
database) and MFDB.  
%02X:%02X:%02X:%02X:%02X:%02X  
GARP/GVRP/  
GMRP  
gmd_create_entry: GMRP failure adding  
MFDB entry: vlan %d and address %s  
MFDB table is full.  
Log Messages  
720  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Table 27. 802.3ad Log Messages  
Component  
802.3ad  
Message  
Cause  
dot3adReceiveMachine: received default  
event %x  
Received a LAG PDU and the RX state  
machine is ignoring this LAGPDU  
802.3ad  
dot3adNimEventCompletionCallback,  
The event sent to NIM was not completed  
dot3adNimEventCreateCompletionCallbac successfully  
k: DOT3AD: notification failed for  
event(%d), intf(%d), reason(%d)  
Table 28. FDB Log Message  
Component  
FDB  
Message  
Cause  
fdbSetAddressAgingTimeOut: Failure  
Unable to set the age time in the hardware  
setting fid %d address aging timeout to %d  
Table 29. Double VLAN Tag Log Message  
Component  
Message  
Cause  
Double Vlan  
Tag  
dvlantagIntfIsConfigurable: Error accessing A default configuration does not exist for  
dvlantag config data for interface %d  
this interface. Typically a case when a new  
interface is created and has no  
pre-configuration.  
Table 30. IPv6 Provisioning Log Message  
Component  
Message  
Cause  
IPV6  
Provisioning  
ipv6ProvIntfIsConfigurable:Erroraccessing A default configuration does not exist for  
IPv6 Provisioning config data for interface this interface. Typically a case when a new  
%d  
interface is created and has no  
pre-configuration.  
Table 31. MFDB Log Message  
Component  
MFDB  
Message  
Cause  
mfdbTreeEntryUpdate: entry does not exist Trying to update a non-existing entry  
Log Messages  
721  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Table 32. 802.1Q Log Messages  
Component  
802.1Q  
Message  
Cause  
dot1qIssueCmd: Unable to send message dot1qMsgQueue is full.  
%d to dot1qMsgQueue for vlan %d - %d  
msgs in queue  
802.1Q  
802.1Q  
dot1qVlanCreateProcess: Attempt to  
create a vlan with an invalid vlan id %d ;  
Accommodates for reserved vlan ids. that  
is, 4094 - x  
VLAN %d not in range,  
dot1qMapIntfIsConfigurable: Error  
accessing DOT1Q config data for  
interface %d in  
A default configuration does not exist for  
this interface. Typically a case when a new  
interface is created and has no  
pre-configuration.  
dot1qMapIntfIsConfigurable.  
802.1Q  
802.1Q  
dot1qVlanDeleteProcess: Deleting the  
default VLAN  
Typically encountered during clear Vlan  
and clear config  
dot1qVlanMemberSetModify,  
If this vlan is a learnt via GVRP then, we  
cannot modify its member set via  
management.  
dot1qVlanTaggedMemberSetModify:  
Dynamic entry %d can only be modified  
after it is converted to static  
Table 33. 802.1S Log Messages  
Component  
802.1S  
Message  
Cause  
dot1sIssueCmd: Dot1s Msg Queue is  
full!!!!Event: %u, on interface: %u, for  
instance: %u  
The message Queue is full.  
802.1S  
802.1S  
dot1sStateMachineRxBpdu(): Rcvd BPDU The current conditions, like port is not  
Discarded  
enabled or we are currently not finished  
processing another BPDU on the same  
interface, does not allow us to process this  
BPDU  
dot1sBpduTransmit(): could not get a buffer Out of system buffers  
Table 34. Port Mac Locking Log Message  
Component  
Message  
Cause  
Port Mac  
Locking  
pmlMapIntfIsConfigurable: Error accessing A default configuration does not exist for  
PML config data for interface %d in  
pmlMapIntfIsConfigurable.  
this interface. Typically a case when a new  
interface is created and has no  
pre-configuration.  
Log Messages  
722  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Table 35. Protocol-based VLANs Log Messages  
Component  
Message  
Cause  
Protocol Based  
VLANs  
pbVlanCnfgrInitPhase2Process: Unable to Appears when nimRegisterIntfChange fails  
register NIM callback to register pbVlan for link state changes.  
Protocol Based  
VLANs  
pbVlanCnfgrInitPhase2Process: Unable to Appears when vlanRegisterForChange  
register pbVlan callback with vlans fails to register pbVlan for vlan changes.  
Protocol Based  
VLANs  
pbVlanCnfgrInitPhase2Process: Unable to Appears when nvStoreRegister fails to  
register pbVlan callback with nvStore  
register save and restore functions for  
configuration save.  
QoS  
Table 36. ACL Log Messages  
Component  
ACL  
Message  
Cause  
Total number of ACL rules (x) exceeds max The combination of all ACLs applied to an  
(y) on intf i.  
interface has resulted in requiring more  
rules than the platform supports.  
ACL  
ACL name, rule x: This rule is not being  
logged  
The ACL configuration has resulted in a  
requirement for more logging rules than the  
platform supports. The specified rule is  
functioning normally except for the logging  
action.  
ACL  
ACL  
aclLogTask: error logging ACL rule trap for The system was unable to send an SNMP  
correlator number  
trap for this ACL rule which contains a  
logging attribute.  
IP ACL number: Forced truncation of one While processing the saved configuration,  
or more rules during config migration  
the system encountered an ACL with more  
rules than is supported by the current  
version. This might happen when code is  
updated to a version supporting fewer rules  
per ACL than the previous version.  
Table 37. CoS Log Message  
Component  
COS  
Message  
Cause  
cosCnfgrInitPhase3Process: Unable to  
The COS component was unable to apply  
apply saved config -- using factory defaults the saved configuration and has initialized  
to the factory default settings.  
Log Messages  
723  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Table 38. DiffServ Log Messages  
Component  
DiffServ  
Message  
Cause  
diffserv.c 165: diffServRestore Failed to  
reset DiffServ. Recommend resetting  
device  
While attempting to clear the running  
configuration an error was encountered in  
removing the current settings. This might  
lead to an inconsistent state in the system  
and resetting is advised.  
DiffServ  
Policy invalid for service intf: "policy name, The DiffServ policy definition is not  
intIfNum x, direction y  
compatible with the capabilities of the  
interface specified. Check the platform  
release notes for information about  
configuration limitations.  
Routing/IPv6 Routing  
Table 39. DHCP Relay Log Messages  
Component  
DHCP relay  
Message  
Cause  
REQUEST hops field more than config  
value  
The DHCP relay agent has processed a  
DHCP request whose HOPS field is larger  
than the maximum value allowed. The relay  
agent will not forward a message with a  
hop count greater than 4.  
DHCP relay  
DHCP relay  
Request's seconds field less than the  
config value  
The DHCP relay agent has processed a  
DHCP request whose SECS field is larger  
than the configured minimum wait time  
allowed.  
processDhcpPacket: invalid DHCP packet The DHCP relay agent has processed an  
type: %u\n  
invalid DHCP packet. Such packets are  
discarded by the relay agent.  
Table 40. OSPFv2 Log Messages  
Component  
OSPFv2  
Message  
Cause  
Best route client deregistration failed for  
OSPF Redist  
OSPFv2 registers with the IPv4 routing  
table manager (“RTO”) to be notified of best  
route changes. There are cases where  
OSPFv2 deregisters more than once,  
causing the second deregistration to fail.  
The failure is harmless.  
OSPFv2  
XX_Call() failure in _checkTimers for  
thread 0x869bcc0  
An OSPFv2 timer has fired but the  
message queue that holds the event has  
filled up. This is normally a fatal error.  
Log Messages  
724  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Table 40. OSPFv2 Log Messages (Continued)  
Component  
OSPFv2  
Message  
Cause  
Warning: OSPF LSDB is 90% full (22648  
LSAs).  
OSPFv2 limits the number of Link State  
Advertisements (LSAs) that can be stored  
in the link state database (LSDB). When  
the database becomes 90 or 95 percent  
full, OSPFv2 logs this warning. The  
warning includes the current size of the  
database.  
OSPFv2  
The number of LSAs, 25165, in the OSPF When the OSPFv2 LSDB becomes full,  
LSDB has exceeded the LSDB memory  
allocation.  
OSPFv2 logs this message. OSPFv2  
reoriginates its router LSAs with the metric  
of all nonstub links set to the maximum  
value to encourage other routers to not  
compute routes through the overloaded  
router.  
OSPFv2  
OSPFv2  
Dropping the DD packet because of MTU  
mismatch  
OSPFv2 ignored a Database Description  
packet whose MTU is greater than the IP  
MTU on the interface where the DD was  
received.  
LSA Checksum error in LsUpdate,  
OSPFv2 ignored a received link state  
dropping LSID 1.2.3.4 checksum 0x1234. advertisement (LSA) whose checksum was  
incorrect.  
Table 41. OSPFv3 Log Messages  
Component  
OSPFv3  
Message  
Cause  
Best route client deregistration failed for  
OSPFv3 Redist  
OSPFv3 registers with the IPv6 routing  
table manager (“RTO6”) to be notified of  
best route changes. There are cases where  
OSPFv3 deregisters more than once,  
causing the second deregistration to fail.  
The failure is harmless.  
OSPFv3  
Warning: OSPF LSDB is 90% full (15292  
LSAs).  
OSPFv3 limits the number of Link State  
Advertisements (LSAs) that can be stored  
in the link state database (LSDB). When  
the database becomes 90 or 95 percent  
full, OSPFv3 logs this warning. The  
warning includes the current size of the  
database.  
OSPFv3  
OSPFv3  
The number of LSAs, 16992, in the OSPF When the OSPFv3 LSDB becomes full,  
LSDB has exceeded the LSDB memory  
allocation.  
OSPFv3 logs this message. OSPFv3  
reoriginates its router LSAs with the R-bit  
clear indicating that OSPFv3 is overloaded.  
LSA Checksum error detected for LSID  
1.2.3.4 checksum 0x34f5. OSPFv3  
Database might be corrupted.  
OSPFv3 periodically verifies the checksum  
of each LSA in memory. OSPFv3 logs this.  
Log Messages  
725  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Table 42. Routing Table Manager Log Messages  
Component  
Message  
Cause  
Routing Table  
Manager  
RTO is full. Routing table contains 8000  
best routes, 8000 total routes.  
The routing table manager, also called  
“RTO,” stores a limited number of best  
routes, based on hardware capacity. When  
the routing table becomes full, RTO logs  
this alert. The count of total routes includes  
alternate routes, which are not installed in  
hardware.  
Routing Table  
Manager  
RTO no longer full. Bad adds: 10. Routing When the number of best routes drops  
table contains 7999 best routes, 7999 total below full capacity, RTO logs this notice.  
routes.  
The number of bad adds might give an  
indication of the number of route adds that  
failed while RTO was full, but a full routing  
table is only one reason why this count is  
incremented.  
Table 43. VRRP Log Messages  
Component  
VRRP  
Message  
Cause  
Changing priority to 255 for virtual router  
with VRID 1 on interface 0/1  
When the router is configured with the  
address being used as the virtual router ID,  
the router’s priority is automatically set to  
the maximum value to ensure that the  
address owner becomes the VRRP master.  
VRRP  
VRRP  
Changing priority to 100 for virtual router  
with VRID 1 on interface 0/1  
When the router is no longer the address  
owner, Switch CLI reverts the router’s  
priority to the default.  
vrrpPacketValidate: Invalid TTL  
VRRP ignored an incoming message  
whose time to live (TTL) in the IP header  
was not 255.  
Table 44. ARP Log Message  
Component  
ARP  
Message  
Cause  
ARP received mapping for IP address xxx When we receive an ARP response with  
to MAC address yyy. This IP address might different MAC address from another station  
be configured on two stations.  
with the same IP address as ours. This  
might be a case of misconfiguration.  
Log Messages  
726  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Table 45. RIP Log Message  
Component  
RIP  
Message  
Cause  
RIP : discard response from xxx via  
unexpected interface  
When RIP response is received with a  
source address not matching the incoming  
interface’s subnet.  
Table 46. DHCP6 Log Message  
Component  
DHCP6  
Message  
Cause  
relay_to_server: Cannot relay to relay  
server intf xxx: not IPv6 enabled  
Relay is enabled but neither the outgoing  
interface nor the server IP address is  
specified.  
Multicast  
Table 47. Cache Log Messages  
Component  
Cache  
Message  
Cause  
Out of memory when creating entry.  
When we run out of memory while creating  
a new cache (MFC) entry  
Cache  
Out of memory when creating cache.  
When we run out of memory while creating  
the cache itself  
Table 48. IGMP Log Messages  
Component  
IGMP  
Message  
Cause  
Error creating IGMP pipe  
Error opening IGMP pipe  
When we fail to create / open IGMP pipe for  
Mcast control messages  
IGMP  
IGMP  
Error creating IGMP data pipe  
Error opening IGMP data pipe  
When we fail to create / open IGMP data  
pipe for Mcast data messages  
Error getting memory for source record  
When we are unable to allocate memory for  
a source record in the received IGMP V3  
report  
IGMP  
Failed getting memory for new group  
When we are unable to allocate memory for  
a group record in the received IGMP  
V3/V2/V1 report  
Log Messages  
727  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Table 49. IGMP-Proxy Log Messages  
Component  
IGMP-Proxy  
Message  
Cause  
Error getting memory for igmp host group  
record  
When we are unable to allocate memory for  
the IGMP group record in the Host (Proxy)  
table  
IGMP-Proxy  
Error getting memory for source record  
When we are unable to allocate memory for  
the IGMP source record in the Host (Proxy)  
table  
Table 50. PIM-SM Log Messages  
Component  
PIM-SM  
Message  
Cause  
PIM-SM not initialized  
This message arises when trying to  
activate pimsm interfaces or receiving  
pimsm packets when pimsm component is  
not initialized.  
PIM-SM  
Unable to take xxx semaphore  
This message is logged when failed to  
acquire semaphore to access source list or  
group list or candidate Rp list or virtual  
interface list. The xxx specifies the list for  
which the access is denied.  
PIM-SM  
PIM-SM  
PIM_SM  
Warning : Could not send packet type xxx this warning is logged when failed to send a  
(pimsm packet type) on rtrIfNum  
pimsm control packet on the specified  
router interface.  
add_kernel_cache : memory allocation  
failed  
This message is logged when there is  
insufficient memory to add a mroute entry  
into cache.  
Config error. Trying to add static RP.  
Dynamic RP with same ip addr exists  
Router learns RP-group mapping through  
Bootstrap messages received.This  
message pops when the static RP is  
configured which conflicts the mapping  
learnt dynamically through Bootstrap  
messages.  
PIM-SM  
Inner xxx(source/group) address of register This log message appears when a register  
message is invalid  
message is received with invalid inner ip  
source or group address.  
Log Messages  
728  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Table 51. PIM-DM Log Messages  
Component  
PIM-DM  
Message  
Cause  
Out of memory when creating xxx  
This message is logged when there is  
insufficient memory to accommodate a new  
neighbor/(S,G) Entry, Prune, Graft, Join  
etc.  
PIM-DM  
PIM-DM  
PIM-DM  
PIM-DM  
Error entry->ll_xxx LL creation error  
This message is logged when the SLL  
creation is Failed.  
pim_interface_set: Could not give  
taskSema  
This message is logged when Task  
synchronization Semaphore release fails.  
Error initializing CACHE  
This message is logged when the PIM-DM  
(S,G) entry Cache table initialization fails.  
Error creating PIM-DM pipe  
This message is logged when the PIM-DM  
Pipe (that receives control messages)  
creation fails.  
Table 52. DVMRP Log Messages  
Component  
DVMRP  
Message  
Cause  
dvmrp_send_graft: failed getting memory  
for graft  
Failed to allocate memory while sending a  
graft  
DVMRP  
DVMRP  
DVMRP  
DVMRP  
dvmrp_register_neighbor: failed getting  
memory for nbr  
Failed to allocate memory while registering  
a neighbor  
dvmrp_recv_prune: failed getting memory Failed to allocate memory while receiving a  
for prune  
prune  
dvmrp_new_route: failed getting memory  
for route  
Failed to get memory for a new route entry  
dvmrp_prepare_routes: failed getting  
memory for dvmrp_ann_rt  
Failed to get memory while announcing a  
new route entry  
Stacking  
Table 53. EDB Log Message  
Component  
EDB  
Message  
Cause  
EDB Callback: Unit Join: <num>.  
Unit <num> has joined the stack.  
Log Messages  
729  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Technologies  
Table 54. System General Error Messages  
Component  
OS  
Message  
Cause  
Invalid USP unit = x, slot = x, port =x  
A port was not able to be translated  
correctly during the receive.  
OS  
OS  
In hapiBroadSystemMacAddress call to  
'bcm_l2_addr_add' - FAILED : x  
Failed to add an L2 address to the MAC  
table. This should only happen when a  
hash collision occurs or the table is full.  
Failed installing mirror action - rest of the  
policy applied successfully  
A previously configured probe port is not  
being used in the policy. The release notes  
state that only a single probe port can be  
configured  
OS  
Policy x does not contain rule x  
The rule was not added to the policy due to  
a discrepancy in the rule count for this  
specific policy . Additionally, the message  
can be displayed when an old rule is being  
modified, but the old rule is not in the policy  
OS  
ERROR: policy x, tmpPolicy x, size x, data An issue installing the policy due to a  
x x x x x x x x  
possible duplicate hash  
OS  
OS  
OS  
ACL x not found in internal table  
ACL internal table overflow  
Attempting to delete a non-existent ACL  
Attempting to add an ACL to a full table  
In hapiBroadQosCosQueueConfig, Failed Attempting to configure the bandwidth  
to configure minimum bandwidth. Available beyond its capabilities  
bandwidth x  
OS  
USL: failed to put sync response on queue A response to a sync request was not  
enqueued. This could indicate that a  
previous sync request was received after it  
was timed out  
OS  
OS  
OS  
OS  
USL: failed to sync ipmc table on unit=x  
Either the transport failed or the message  
was dropped  
usl_task_ipmc_msg_send(): failed to send Either the transport failed or the message  
with x was dropped  
USL: No available entries in the STG table The Spanning Tree Group table is full in  
USL  
USL: failed to sync stg table on unit=x  
Could not synchronize unit x due to a  
transport failure or API issue on remote  
unit. A synchronization retry will be issued  
OS  
USL: A Trunk doesn't exist in USL  
Attempting to modify a Trunk that doesn’t  
exist  
Log Messages  
730  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Table 54. System General Error Messages  
Component  
OS  
Message  
Cause  
USL: A Trunk being created by bcmx  
already existed in USL  
Possible synchronization issue between  
the application, hardware, and sync layer  
OS  
OS  
OS  
USL: A Trunk being destroyed doesn't exist Possible synchronization issue between  
in USL  
the application, hardware, and sync layer.  
USL: A Trunk being set doesn't exist in  
USL  
Possible synchronization issue between  
the application, hardware, and sync layer.  
USL: failed to sync trunk table on unit=x  
Could not synchronize unit x due to a  
transport failure or API issue on remote  
unit. A synchronization retry will be issued  
OS  
OS  
OS  
USL: Mcast entry not found on a join  
USL: Mcast entry not found on a leave  
USL: failed to sync dvlan data on unit=x  
Possible synchronization issue between  
the application, hardware, and sync layer  
Possible synchronization issue between  
the application, hardware, and sync layer  
Could not synchronize unit x due to a  
transport failure or API issue on remote  
unit. A synchronization retry will be issued  
OS  
OS  
USL: failed to sync policy table on unit=x  
USL: failed to sync VLAN table on unit=x  
Invalid LAG id x  
Could not synchronize unit x due to a  
transport failure or API issue on remote  
unit. A synchronization retry will be issued  
Could not synchronize unit x due to a  
transport failure or API issue on remote  
unit. A synchronization retry will be issued  
OS  
OS  
OS  
OS  
Possible synchronization issue between  
the BCM driver and HAPI  
Invalid uport calculated from the BCM uport Uport not valid from BCM driver.  
bcmx_l2_addr->lport = x  
Invalid USP calculated from the BCM  
uport\nbcmx_l2_addr->lport = x  
USP not able to be calculated from the  
learn event for BCM driver.  
Unable to insert route R/P  
Route ‘R’ with prefix ‘P’ could not be  
inserted in the hardware route table. A retry  
will be issued.  
OS  
OS  
Unable to Insert host H  
Host ‘H’ could not be inserted in hardware  
host table. A retry will be issued.  
USL: failed to sync L3 Intf table on unit=x  
Could not synchronize unit x due to a  
transport failure or API issue on remote  
unit. A synchronization retry will be issued  
OS  
USL: failed to sync L3 Host table on unit=x Could not synchronize unit x due to a  
transport failure or API issue on remote  
unit. A synchronization retry will be issued  
Log Messages  
731  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Table 54. System General Error Messages  
Component  
OS  
Message  
Cause  
USL: failed to sync L3 Route table on unit= Could not synchronize unit x due to a  
x
transport failure or API issue on remote  
unit. A synchronization retry will be issued  
OS  
OS  
OS  
USL: failed to sync initiator table on unit=x Could not synchronize unit x due to a  
transport failure or API issue on remote  
unit. A synchronization retry will be issued  
USL: failed to sync terminator table on  
unit=x  
Could not synchronize unit x due to a  
transport failure or API issue on remote  
unit. A synchronization retry will be issued  
USL: failed to sync ip-multicast table on  
unit=x  
Could not synchronize unit x due to a  
transport failure or API issue on remote  
unit. A synchronization retry will be issued  
O/S Support  
Table 55. OSAPI Log Messages  
Component  
OSAPI  
Message  
Cause  
ftruncate failed – File resides on a  
read-only file system.  
ftruncate is called to correctly set the file’s  
size in the file system after a write. The file  
system is R/W so this msg indicates that  
the file system may be corrupted.  
OSAPI  
OSAPI  
OSAPI  
ftruncate failed – File is open for reading  
only.  
ftruncate is called to correctly set the file’s  
size in the file system after a write. The file  
is opened for R/W so this msg indicates  
that the file system may be corrupted.  
ftruncate failed – File descriptor refers to a ftruncate is called to correctly set the file’s  
file on which this operation is impossible.  
size in the file system after a write. This  
msg indicates that the file system may be  
corrupted.  
ftruncate failed – Returned an unknown  
code in errno.  
ftruncate is called to correctly set the file’s  
size in the file system after a write. This  
msg indicates that the file system may be  
corrupted.  
OSAPI  
OSAPI  
ping: bad host!  
The address requested to ping cannot be  
converted to an Internet address.  
osapiTaskDelete: Failed for (XX) error YYY The requested task cannot be deleted  
because: the requested deletion is called  
from an ISR, the task is already deleted, or  
the task ID is invalid.  
Log Messages  
732  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Table 55. OSAPI Log Messages (Continued)  
Component  
OSAPI  
Message  
Cause  
osapiCleanupIf: NetIPGet  
During the call to remove the interface from  
the route table, the attempt to get an ipv4  
interface address from the stack failed.  
OSAPI  
OSAPI  
OSAPI  
osapiCleanupIf: NetMaskGet  
osapiCleanupIf: NetIpDel  
osapiSemaTake failed  
During the call to remove the interface from  
the route table ,the attempt to get the ipv4  
interface mask from the stack failed.  
During the call to remove the interface from  
the route table, the attempt to delete the  
primary ipv4 address from the stack failed.  
The requested semaphore cannot be taken  
because: the call is made from an ISR or  
the semaphore ID is invalid.  
Log Messages  
733  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
13.  
Green Ethernet Commands  
13  
NETGEAR Managed Switch Release 10.0.1 supports the following Green Ethernet power  
saving modes:  
Energy Detect Mode  
EEE Mode  
The Green Ethernet commands supported depends on the switch model  
Table 56. Green feature support  
Model  
Energy-Detect EEE  
M4100-D10-POE  
M4100-D12G  
M4100-50G-POE+  
M4100-26G-POE  
M4100-50G  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
No  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
M4100-26G  
M4100-50-POE  
M4100-26-POE  
M7100-24x  
No  
Yes  
No  
M4100-12GF  
Yes  
M4100-D12G-POE+ Yes  
No  
M4100-24G-POE+  
M4100-12G-POE+  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
No  
734  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Energy-Detect Mode  
When Energy-Detect mode is enabled, if communication on a port stops, the port circuitry  
automatically shuts down for a short period. The port wakes up periodically to check for link  
activity. If activity is detected, the port circuitry remains active. This allows performing  
autonegotiation and saving power when there is no active link.  
Note: Combination ports support both copper and fiber media. Energy  
Detect mode only applies to copper media. If Energy Detect mode is  
configured on a combination port, it will only function when a copper  
media is active.  
Energy Efficient Ethernet (EEE)  
Energy Efficient Ethernet (EEE) combines MAC with ports that support operation in a  
Low-Power Mode. This feature is defined by the IEEE 802.3az Energy Efficient Ethernet  
Task Force. Lower Power Mode enables both send and receive sides of a link to disable  
some port functionality to save power when the port is lightly loaded. Transition to  
Low-Power Mode does not change the link status. Frames in transit are not dropped or  
corrupted during transition to and from Low-Power Mode. This transition time is transparent  
to upper layer protocols and applications.  
EEE operation is subject to the following conditions:  
Autonegotiation must be enabled to use any of the EEE modes. EEE mode is disabled  
automatically when autonegotiation is disabled.  
Enabling or Disabling EEE mode causes the port link to flap once as EEE capability  
needs to be advertised. This restarts autonegotiation.  
EEE must be disabled while running hardware or software cable diagnostics.  
Combo (Combination) ports: Combo ports support both copper and fiber media. EEE  
mode only applies to copper media. If Energy Detect mode is configured on a  
combination port, it will only function when a copper media is active. EEE LPI statistics  
are only collected if a copper media is used on the port. If the media on a port changes  
from copper to fiber while EEE is enabled, LPI statistics collection stops until the media  
changes back to copper. The showgreen-mode <u/s/p>and showgreen-mode  
eee-lpi-historyinterface<u/s/p>commands display updated LPI statistics  
only if the medium is copper.  
Green Ethernet Commands  
735  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
green-mode energy-detect  
Use this command enables energy-detect mode on an interface or on all the interfaces.  
Format  
green-mode energy-detect  
Mode  
Interface Config  
Interface Range Config  
Default  
Disabled  
no green-mode energy-detect  
This command disables energy-detect mode on an interface or on all the interfaces.  
Format  
Mode  
no green-mode energy-detect  
Interface Config  
Interface Range Config  
green-mode eee  
This command enables EEE low-power idle mode on an interface or on all interfaces. It  
allows both send and receive sides of a link to disable some functionality for power savings  
when the port is lightly loaded. Transition to Low-Power Mode does not change the link  
status. Frames in transit are not dropped or corrupted in transition to and from Low-Power  
Mode.  
Format  
Mode  
green-mode eee  
Interface Config  
Interface Range Config  
Default  
Disabled  
no green-mode eee  
This command disables EEE.  
Format  
Mode  
no green-mode eee  
Interface Config  
Interface Range Config  
Green Ethernet Commands  
736  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
clear green-mode statistics  
This command to clears the following for a specified <slot/port>, or for all ports:  
EEE LPI event count, and LPI duration  
EEE LPI history table entries  
Cumulative Power savings estimates  
Format  
Mode  
clear green-mode statistics {<slot/port> | all}  
Privileged Exec  
Example  
(switch) #clear green-mode statistics 0/1  
Are you sure you want to clear the green mode port stats? (y/n)y  
Green Mode Stats Cleared.  
(switch) #clear green-mode statistics all  
Are you sure you want to clear the green mode port stats? (y/n)y  
Green Mode Stats Cleared.  
show green-mode <slot/port>  
This command displays green mode configuration and operational status of a port. This  
command can also display the per port configuration and operational status of the  
green-mode. The status is shown only for the modes supported on the switch.  
Format  
Mode  
show green-mode <slot/port>  
Privileged Exec  
Table 57. Green-Mode status terms  
Term  
Definition  
Energy-detect admin  
mode  
Energy-detect mode is enabled or disabled.  
Energy-detect  
operational status  
Energy detect mode is currently active or inactive. The energy detect mode might be  
administratively enabled, but the operational status might be inactive. The reasons  
for the same are described below.  
ReasonforEnergy-detect The energy detect mode might be administratively enabled, but the operational  
current operational status status might be inactive. The reasons for the same are:  
- Port is currently operating in the fiber mode  
- Link is up.  
- Admin Mode Disabled  
- Interface Not Attached  
If the energy-detect operational status is active, the reason field displays  
Noenergy Detected  
Green Ethernet Commands  
737  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
   
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Table 57. Green-Mode status terms  
Term  
Definition  
EEE  
EEE Admin Mode  
Transmit Idle Time  
EEE Admin Mode is enabled or disabled.  
It is the time for which condition to move to LPI state is satisfied, at the end of which  
MAC TX transitions to LPI state. The Range is (0 to 0xffffffff).The default value is 0.  
Transmit Wake Time  
It is the time for which MAC / switch has to wait to go back to ACTIVE state from LPI  
state when it receives packet for transmission. The Range is (0 to 0xffff).The default  
value is 0.  
Rx Low Power Idle Event This field is incremented each time MAC RX enters LP IDLE state. Shows the total  
Count  
number of Rx LPI Events since EEE counters are last cleared  
Rx Low Power Idle  
Duration (microsec)  
This field indicates duration of Rx LPI state in 10-microsecond increments. Shows  
the total duration of Rx LPI since the EEE counters are last cleared.  
Tx Low Power Idle Event This field is incremented each time MAC TX enters LP IDLE state. Shows the total  
Count  
number of Tx LPI Events since EEE counters are last cleared.  
Tx Low Power Idle  
Duration (microsec)  
This field indicates duration of Tx LPI state in 10us increments. Shows the total  
duration of Tx LPI since the EEE counters are last cleared.  
Tw_sys_tx (microsec)  
Integer that indicates the value of Tw_sys that the local system can support. This  
value is updated by the EEE DLL Transmitter state diagram. This variable maps into  
the aLldpXdot3LocTxTwSys attribute.  
Tw_sys Echo (microsec) Integer that indicates the remote system's Transmit Tw_sys that was used by the  
local system to compute the Tw_sys that it wants to request from the remote system.  
This value maps into the aLldpXdot3LocTxTwSysEcho attribute.  
Tw_sys_rx (microsec)  
Integer that indicates the value of Tw_sys that the local system requests from the  
remote system. This value is updated by the EEE Receiver L2 state diagram. This  
variable maps into the aLldpXdot3LocRxTwSys attribute.  
Tw_sys_rx Echo  
(microsec)  
Integer that indicates the remote systems Receive Tw_sys that was used by the local  
system to compute the Tw_sys that it can support. This value maps into the  
aLldpXdot3LocRxTwSysEcho attribute.  
Fallback Tw_sys  
(microsec)  
Integer that indicates the value of fallback Tw_sys that the local system requests  
from the remote system. This value is updated by the local system software.  
Remote Tw_sys_tx  
(microsec)  
Integer that indicates the value of Tw_sys that the remote system can support. This  
value maps from the aLldpXdot3RemTxTwSys attribute.  
Remote Tw_sys Echo  
(microsec)  
Integer that indicates the value Transmit Tw_sys echoed back by the remote system.  
This value maps from the aLldpXdot3RemTxTwSysEcho attribute.  
Remote Tw_sys_rx  
(microsec)  
Integer that indicates the value of Tw_sys that the remote system requests from the  
local system. This value maps from the aLldpXdot3RemRxTwSys attribute.  
Remote Tw_sys_rx Echo Integer that indicates the value of Receive Tw_sys echoed back by the remote  
(microsec) system. This value maps from the aLldpXdot3RemRxTwSysEcho attribute.  
Remote Fallback Tw_sys Integer that indicates the value of fallback Tw_sys that the remote system is  
(microsec)  
advertising. This attribute maps to the variable RemFbSystemValue as defined in  
78.4.2.3.  
Tx_dll_enabled  
Initialization status of the EEE transmit Data Link Layer management function on the  
local system.  
Green Ethernet Commands  
738  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Table 57. Green-Mode status terms  
Term  
Definition  
Tx_dll_ready  
Data Link Layer ready: This variable indicates that the tx system initialization is  
complete and is ready to update/receive LLDPDU containing EEE TLV. This variable  
is updated by the local system software.  
Rx_dll_enabled  
Rx_dll_ready  
Status of the EEE capability negotiation on the local system.  
Data Link Layer ready: This variable indicates that the rx system initialization is  
complete and is ready to update/receive LLDPDU containing EEE TLV. This variable  
is updated by the local system software.  
Cumulative Energy  
Saving  
Estimated Cumulative energy saved on this port in (Watts * hours) due to all green  
modes enabled  
Time Since Counters  
Last Cleared  
Time Since Counters Last Cleared (since the time of power up, or after 'clear eee  
counters' is executed)  
Note: Executing 'clear green-mode statistics' only clears the EEE  
Transmit, Receive LPI event count, LPI duration, and Cumulative  
Energy Savings Estimates of the port. Other status parameters  
listed in above table will remain unaffected after 'clear green-mode  
statistics'.  
Example:  
The output of 'show green-mode <s/p>' is indicated below.  
(switch) #show green-mode 0/25  
EEE Admin Mode................................. Enabled  
Transmit Idle Time......................... 0  
Transmit Wake Time......................... 0  
Rx Low Power Idle Event Count.............. 0  
Rx Low Power Idle Duration (uSec).......... 0  
Tx Low Power Idle Event Count.............. 0  
Tx Low Power Idle Duration (uSec).......... 0  
Tw_sys_tx (usec)........................... XX  
Tw_sys_tx Echo (usec)...................... XX  
Tw_sys_rx (usec)........................... XX  
Tw_sys_rx Echo (usec)...................... XX  
Fallback Tw_sys (usec)..................... XX  
Tx DLL enabled............................. Yes  
Tx DLL ready............................... Yes  
Rx DLL enabled............................. Yes  
Rx DLL ready............................... Yes  
Green Ethernet Commands  
739  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Cumulative Energy Saving (W * H)............. XX  
Time Since Counters Last Cleared............... 1 day 20 hr 47 min 34 sec  
show green-mode  
Use this command to display green-mode configuration for the whole system. The status is  
shown only for the modes supported on the corresponding hardware platform whether  
enabled or disabled.  
Format  
Mode  
show green-mode  
Privileged Exec  
Table 58.  
Term  
Definition  
Energy Detect  
Energy-detect Config  
Energy-detect Opr  
Energy-detect Admin mode is enabled or disabled  
Energy detect mode is currently active or inactive. The energy detect mode might be  
administratively enabled, but the operational status might be inactive.  
EEE  
EEE Admin Mode is enabled or disabled.  
Global  
EEE Config  
Cumulative Energy  
Saving per Stack  
Estimated Cumulative energy saved per stack in (Watts * hours) due to all green  
modes enabled  
Current Power  
Power Consumption by all ports in stack in mWatts.  
Consumption per Stack  
Power Saving  
Estimated Percentage Power saved on all ports in stack due to Green mode(s)  
enabled.  
Unit  
Unit Index of given Stack member  
Green Ethernet Features List of Green Features supported on the given unit which could be one or more of the  
supported  
following: Energy-Detect (Energy Detect), Short-Reach (Short Reach), EEE (Energy  
Efficient Ethernet), LPI-History (EEE Low Power Idle History), LLDP-Cap-Exchg  
(EEE LLDP Capability Exchange), Pwr-Usg-Est (Power Usage Estimates).  
Green Ethernet Commands  
740  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Example:  
The output of 'show green-mode <u/s/p>' is indicated below.  
(switch) #show green-mode  
Current Power Consumption (mW).............. XX  
Power Saving (%)............................ XX  
Cumulative Energy Saving /Stack (W * H)... XX  
Unit Green Ethernet FeaturesSupported  
---- --------------------------------  
1
Energy-Detect EEE LPI-History LLDP-Cap-Exchg Pwr-Usg-Est  
Interface  
Energy-Detect  
Config Opr  
Short-Reach-Config  
Auto Forced  
Short-Reach  
Opr  
EEE  
Config  
--------- --------- --------- --------- --------- ----------- --------  
0/1  
Disabled Inactive  
Disabled Inactive  
Disabled Inactive  
Disabled Inactive  
Disabled Inactive  
Disabled Inactive  
Disabled Inactive  
Disabled Inactive  
Disabled Inactive  
Disabled Inactive  
Disabled Inactive  
Disabled Inactive  
Disabled Inactive  
Disabled Inactive  
Disabled Inactive  
Disabled Inactive  
Disabled Inactive  
Disabled Inactive  
Disabled Inactive  
Disabled Inactive  
Disabled  
Disabled  
Disabled  
Disabled  
Disabled  
Disabled  
Disabled  
Disabled  
Disabled  
Disabled  
Disabled  
Disabled  
Disabled  
Disabled  
Disabled  
Disabled  
Disabled  
Disabled  
Disabled  
Disabled  
0/2  
0/3  
0/4  
0/5  
0/6  
0/7  
0/8  
0/9  
0/10  
0/11  
0/12  
0/13  
0/14  
0/15  
0/16  
0/17  
0/18  
0/19  
0/20  
--More-- or (q)uit  
Green Ethernet Commands  
741  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Interface  
Energy-Detect  
Config Opr  
Short-Reach-Config  
Auto Forced  
Short-Reach  
Opr  
EEE  
Config  
--------- --------- --------- --------- --------- ----------- --------  
0/21  
0/22  
0/23  
0/24  
0/25  
Disabled Inactive  
Disabled Inactive  
Disabled Inactive  
Disabled Inactive  
Disabled Inactive  
Disabled  
Disabled  
Disabled  
Disabled  
Disabled  
green-mode eee-lpi-history {sampling-interval <30sec - 36000sec> |  
max-samples <1 - 168>}  
Configure Global EEE LPI history collection interval and buffer size using this command. This  
value is applied globally on all interfaces on the stack.  
Note: The Sampling interval configured by the user takes effect  
immediately. The current and future samples are collected at this  
new sampling interval.  
Format  
green-mode eee-lpi-history {sampling-interval <30sec - 36000sec>  
| max-samples <1 - 168>}  
Mode  
Global Config  
Default  
sampling-interval = 3600; max-samples = 168  
no green-mode eee-lpi-history {sampling-interval | max-samples }  
Use this command to set the sampling interval or max-samples values to default:  
sampling-interval = 3600  
max-samples = 168  
Format  
Mode  
no green-mode eee-lpi-history {sampling-interval | max-samples}  
Global Config  
Green Ethernet Commands  
742  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
show green-mode eee-lpi-history interface <slot/port>  
This command displays the interface green-mode EEE LPI history.  
Format  
Mode  
show green-mode eee-lpi-history interface <slot / port>  
Privileged Exec  
Table 59.  
Keyword  
Description  
Sampling Interval  
Interval at which EEE LPI statistics is collected.  
Maximum number of samples to keep  
Total No. of Samples to Keep  
Percentage LPI time per stack  
Percentage of Total time spent in LPI mode by all port in stack  
when compared to total time since reset.  
Sample No  
Sample Index  
Sample Time  
Time since last reset  
%time spent in LPI mode since last sample Percentage of time spent in LPI mode on this port when compared  
to sampling interval  
%time spent in LPI mode since last reset  
Percentage of total time spent in LPI mode on this port when  
compared to time since reset.  
Example:  
(switch)#show green-mode eee-lpi-history interface 0/1  
Sampling Interval (sec)........................ 30  
Total No. of Samples to Keep................... 168  
Percentage LPI time per stack.................. 29  
Percentage of  
Time spent in  
LPI mode since  
last sample  
Percentage of  
Sample  
No.  
Time Since  
The Sample  
Was Recorded  
Time spent in  
LPI mode since  
last reset  
------ -------------------- -------------- --------------  
10  
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0d:00:00:13  
0d:00:00:44  
0d:00:01:15  
0d:00:01:46  
0d:00:02:18  
0d:00:02:49  
0d:00:03:20  
0d:00:03:51  
0d:00:04:22  
0d:00:04:53  
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
3
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
1
1
1
Green Ethernet Commands  
743  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
14.  
Command List  
14  
ip vrrp (Global Config) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 249  
1583compatibility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264  
area virtual-link (OSPF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 269  
744  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Command List  
745  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Command List  
746  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Command List  
747  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Command List  
748  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
enable (OSPF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 263  
Command List  
749  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Command List  
750  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
ip ospf area . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 264  
Command List  
751  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Command List  
752  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Command List  
753  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Command List  
754  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Command List  
755  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
network area (OSPF) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 263  
Command List  
756  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Command List  
757  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
router ospf . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 263  
Command List  
758  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Command List  
759  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Command List  
760  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Command List  
761  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Command List  
762  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Command List  
763  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Command List  
764  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Command List  
765  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Command List  
766  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Command List  
767  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ProSafe M4100 and M7100 Managed Switches  
Command List  
768  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Milwaukee Power Hammer 5300120V User Manual
Multiquip Portable Generator DCA85usJ2 User Manual
Murphy Portable Generator Keystart 9700 User Manual
NEC Computer Monitor 61XM2 User Manual
NewAir Beverage Dispenser AW 180E User Manual
Nikon Digital Camera 26497 User Manual
Nintendo Video Games 70277A User Manual
Optimus Portable Radio 120 0604 User Manual
Oricom Cell Phone PMR1000R User Manual
Panasonic Laptop CF 31 SERIES User Manual